Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Ricoh MPC3001 Service Manual

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 1236

Model AT-C2.

5
Machine Code: D086/D087
Field Service Manual

1 November, 2010

Important Safety Notices


Prevention of Physical Injury
1. Before disassembling or assembling parts of the copier and peripherals, make sure that the copier
power cord is unplugged.
2. The wall outlet should be near the copier and easily accessible.
3. If any adjustment or operation check has to be made with exterior covers off or open while the main
switch is turned on, keep hands away from electrified or mechanically driven components.
4. The copier drives some of its components when it completes the warm-up period. Be careful to keep
hands away from the mechanical and electrical components as the copier starts operation.
5. The inside and the metal parts of the fusing unit become extremely hot while the copier is operating.
Be careful to avoid touching those components with your bare hands.

Health Safety Conditions


1. Toner and developer are non-toxic, but if you get either of them in your eyes by accident, it may cause
temporary eye discomfort. Immediately wash eyes with plenty of water. If unsuccessful, get medical
attention.
2. The copier, which use high voltage power source, can generate ozone gas. High ozone density is
harmful to human health. Therefore, the machine must be installed in a well-ventilated room.

Observance of Electrical Safety Standards


The copier and its peripherals must be serviced by a customer service representative who has completed
the training course on those models.

Keep the machine away from flammable liquids, gases, and aerosols. A fire or an explosion might
occur.

The Controller board on this machine contains a lithium battery. The danger of explosion exists if a
battery of this type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type
recommended by the manufacturer. Discard batteries in accordance with the manufacturer's
instructions and local regulations.
The optional fax and memory expansion units contain lithium batteries, which can explode if replaced
incorrectly. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Do

not recharge or burn the batteries. Used batteries must be handled in accordance with local
regulations.

Safety and Ecological Notes for Disposal


1. Do not incinerate toner bottles or used toner. Toner dust may ignite suddenly when exposed to an
open flame.
2. Dispose of used toner, the maintenance unit which includes developer or the organic photoconductor
in accordance with local regulations. (These are non-toxic supplies.)
3. Dispose of replaced parts in accordance with local regulations.
4. When keeping used lithium batteries in order to dispose of them later, do not put more than 100
batteries per sealed box. Storing larger numbers or not sealing them apart may lead to chemical
reactions and heat build-up.

Laser Safety
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based optical units
in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a location with the requisite
equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a qualified Customer Engineer. The laser
chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer engineers are therefore directed to return all chassis and
laser subsystems to the factory or service depot when replacement of the optical subsystem is required.
Use of controls, or adjustment, or performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual
may result in hazardous radiation exposure.

WARNING: Turn off the main switch before attempting any of the procedures in the Laser Optics
Housing Unit section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes.
CAUTION MARKING:

Warnings, Cautions, Notes


In this manual, the following important symbols and notations are used.
A Warning indicates a potentially hazardous situation. Failure to obey a Warning could result in
death or serious injury.

A Caution indicates a potentially hazardous situation. Failure to obey a Caution could result in minor
or moderate injury or damage to the machine or other property.

Obey these guidelines to avoid problems such as misfeeds, damage to originals, loss of valuable
data and to prevent damage to the machine.
This information provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine.

Symbols, Abbreviations and Trademarks


This manual uses several symbols and abbreviations. The meaning of those symbols and abbreviations are
as follows:
See or Refer to
Clip ring
Screw
Connector
Clamp
E-ring
SEF

Short Edge Feed

LEF

Long Edge Feed

Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United
States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of their
respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.

TABLE OF CONTENTS
Important Safety Notices...................................................................................................................................1
Prevention of Physical Injury..........................................................................................................................1
Health Safety Conditions...............................................................................................................................1
Observance of Electrical Safety Standards.................................................................................................1
Safety and Ecological Notes for Disposal...................................................................................................2
Laser Safety.....................................................................................................................................................2
Warnings, Cautions, Notes...........................................................................................................................3
Symbols, Abbreviations and Trademarks.........................................................................................................4
Trademarks.....................................................................................................................................................4

1. Product Information
Specifications....................................................................................................................................................17
Product Overview.............................................................................................................................................18
Component Layout.......................................................................................................................................18
Paper Path....................................................................................................................................................20
Drive Layout..................................................................................................................................................21
Machine Configuration....................................................................................................................................23
Guidance for Those Who are Familiar with Predecessor Products..............................................................27

2. Installation
Installation Requirements.................................................................................................................................29
Environment..................................................................................................................................................29
Machine Level..............................................................................................................................................30
Machine Space Requirements....................................................................................................................30
Machine Dimensions...................................................................................................................................31
Power Requirements....................................................................................................................................31
Optional Unit Combinations............................................................................................................................33
Machine Options.........................................................................................................................................33
Controller Options.......................................................................................................................................34
Other Options..............................................................................................................................................35
Fax Options..................................................................................................................................................35
Copier Installation............................................................................................................................................36
Power Sockets for Peripherals....................................................................................................................36
Installation Flow Chart.................................................................................................................................36
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................37
5

Moving the Machine...................................................................................................................................48


Transporting the Machine...........................................................................................................................48
Paper Feed Unit PB3080 (D387)...................................................................................................................49
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................49
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................49
Caster Table Type A (D446)...........................................................................................................................52
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................52
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................52
Paper Feed Unit PB3010 (D537)...................................................................................................................54
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................54
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................54
Envelope Feeder EF3000 (D547)..................................................................................................................57
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................57
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................57
LCIT RT3010 (D539).......................................................................................................................................59
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................59
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................59
Side Fence Position Change.......................................................................................................................62
LCIT PB3110 (D538).......................................................................................................................................64
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................64
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................64
ARDF DF3050 (D541)....................................................................................................................................67
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................67
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................67
ADF Handle Type B (D366)............................................................................................................................71
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................71
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................72
1 Bin Tray BN3080 (D536)...........................................................................................................................78
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................78
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................78
Internal Shift Tray SH3040 (D388)...............................................................................................................81
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................81
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................81

Side Tray Type C5501 (D542)......................................................................................................................84


Component Check.......................................................................................................................................84
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................85
Bridge Unit BU3030 (D386)..........................................................................................................................88
Component Check.......................................................................................................................................88
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................88
Finisher SR3050 (D372).................................................................................................................................92
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................92
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................93
SR790 (B408)..................................................................................................................................................95
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................95
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................96
Booklet Finisher SR3000 (B793)....................................................................................................................99
Accessory Check..........................................................................................................................................99
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................100
Punch Kit PU3000 (B807)............................................................................................................................104
Component Check....................................................................................................................................104
Installation..................................................................................................................................................105
Key Counter Bracket Type H (A674)...........................................................................................................112
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................112
Optional Counter Interface Unit Type A (B870).........................................................................................114
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................114
USB2.0/SD Slot Type F (D546)..................................................................................................................116
Accessory Check.......................................................................................................................................116
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................116
Testing the SD Card/USB Slot.................................................................................................................120
Card Reader Bracket Type C5501 (D547)................................................................................................122
Component Check....................................................................................................................................122
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................123
Anti-Condensation Heater (Scanner)...........................................................................................................125
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................125
Anti-Condensation Heater Type A...............................................................................................................127
Component Check....................................................................................................................................127

Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................127
Controller Options.........................................................................................................................................138
Overview....................................................................................................................................................138
SD Card Appli Move................................................................................................................................139
PostScript3 Unit Type C5501..................................................................................................................141
IPDS Unit Type C5501.............................................................................................................................142
File Format Converter Type E...................................................................................................................143
IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A.........................................................................................................144
IEEE 802.11a/g Interface Unit Type J....................................................................................................145
Bluetooth Interface Unit Type 3245........................................................................................................149
Camera Direct Print Card Type I..............................................................................................................150
Browser Unit Type E..................................................................................................................................151
Gigabit Ethernet Type B............................................................................................................................153
Check All Connections..............................................................................................................................154

3. Preventive Maintenance
Maintenance Tables......................................................................................................................................155
PM Parts Settings............................................................................................................................................156
Before Removing the Old PM Parts.........................................................................................................156
After installing the new PM parts..............................................................................................................157
Preparation before operation check........................................................................................................157
Operation check........................................................................................................................................157

4. Replacement and Adjustment


Beforehand.....................................................................................................................................................159
Special Tools..................................................................................................................................................160
Image Adjustment..........................................................................................................................................161
Scanning....................................................................................................................................................161
ARDF...........................................................................................................................................................162
Registration................................................................................................................................................164
Erase Margin Adjustment..........................................................................................................................165
Color Registration......................................................................................................................................166
Printer Gamma Correction........................................................................................................................167
Exterior Covers...............................................................................................................................................172
Front Door..................................................................................................................................................172

Controller Cover........................................................................................................................................173
Left Cover...................................................................................................................................................173
Rear Cover.................................................................................................................................................174
Right Rear Cover.......................................................................................................................................174
Operation Panel........................................................................................................................................175
Paper Exit Cover........................................................................................................................................176
Inner Tray...................................................................................................................................................176
Ozone Filter and Dust Filter......................................................................................................................177
Scanner Unit...................................................................................................................................................180
Exposure Glass..........................................................................................................................................180
Original Length Sensors............................................................................................................................180
Exposure Lamp..........................................................................................................................................181
Scanner Motor...........................................................................................................................................184
Sensor Board Unit (SBU)..........................................................................................................................184
Exposure Lamp Stabilizer.........................................................................................................................185
SIO (Scanner In/Out) Board...................................................................................................................186
Scanner HP Sensor....................................................................................................................................186
Platen Cover Sensor..................................................................................................................................187
Front Scanner Wire...................................................................................................................................188
Rear Scanner Wire....................................................................................................................................192
Touch Panel Position Adjustment..............................................................................................................193
Laser Optics....................................................................................................................................................195
Caution Decal Location............................................................................................................................195
LD Safety Switch........................................................................................................................................196
Laser Optics Housing Unit........................................................................................................................196
Polygon Mirror Motor and Drive Board..................................................................................................202
Airflow Fans...............................................................................................................................................203
Image Creation..............................................................................................................................................205
PCDU..........................................................................................................................................................205
Drum Unit and Development Unit............................................................................................................206
Toner Collection Bottle..............................................................................................................................211
Second Duct Fan.......................................................................................................................................212
Third Duct Fan............................................................................................................................................213

Toner Pump Unit........................................................................................................................................214


Toner End Sensor......................................................................................................................................220
Image Transfer...............................................................................................................................................221
Image Transfer Belt Unit............................................................................................................................221
Image Transfer Belt Cleaning Unit...........................................................................................................222
Image Transfer Belt....................................................................................................................................222
Paper Transfer................................................................................................................................................228
Paper Transfer Roller Unit.........................................................................................................................228
Paper Transfer Unit....................................................................................................................................228
ID Sensor Board........................................................................................................................................230
Temperature and Humidity Sensor..........................................................................................................232
Drive Unit........................................................................................................................................................233
Gear Unit...................................................................................................................................................234
Registration Motor.....................................................................................................................................239
Paper Feed Motor.....................................................................................................................................240
Drum/Development Motors for M, C, and Y.........................................................................................241
Drum/Development Motor-K...................................................................................................................242
ITB Drive Motor.........................................................................................................................................242
Fusing/Paper Exit Motor..........................................................................................................................243
Image Transfer Belt Contact Motor..........................................................................................................243
Duplex Inverter Motor...............................................................................................................................244
Pressure Roller Contact Motor..................................................................................................................246
Duplex/By-pass Motor.............................................................................................................................246
Paper Transfer Contact Motor..................................................................................................................248
Toner Transport Motor..............................................................................................................................250
Toner Collection Unit.................................................................................................................................250
Paper Feed Clutches.................................................................................................................................251
Development Clutch-Y..............................................................................................................................253
Development Clutches for M and C........................................................................................................254
Development Clutch-K..............................................................................................................................255
Fusing..............................................................................................................................................................257
Fusing Unit Maintenance Parts.................................................................................................................257
Fusing Unit..................................................................................................................................................257

10

Fusing Entrance Guide Plate.....................................................................................................................258


Fusing Exit Guide Plate Cleaning Procedure...........................................................................................259
Heating Roller and Heating Roller Bearing.............................................................................................260
Fusing Cleaning Felt..................................................................................................................................266
Fusing Lamp...............................................................................................................................................267
Pressure Roller and Pressure Roller Bearing............................................................................................268
Stripper Plates............................................................................................................................................272
Heating Roller Thermistor..........................................................................................................................273
Pressure Roller Thermostat........................................................................................................................275
Pressure Roller Thermistors........................................................................................................................276
Fusing Fan..................................................................................................................................................277
Paper Exit Fan............................................................................................................................................278
IH (Induction Heating) Inverter Fan.........................................................................................................278
Thermopile.................................................................................................................................................279
Pressure Roller HP Sensor.........................................................................................................................282
IH Coil Fan.................................................................................................................................................282
IH Coil Unit................................................................................................................................................283
Paper Feed.....................................................................................................................................................286
Paper Feed Unit.........................................................................................................................................286
Separation Roller, Feed Roller and Pick-Up Belt Unit............................................................................287
Tray Lift Motor............................................................................................................................................288
Vertical Transport, Paper Overflow, Paper End and Paper Feed Sensor.............................................288
Registration Sensor....................................................................................................................................289
By-pass Paper Size Sensor and By-pass Paper Length Sensor.............................................................290
By-pass Bottom Tray..................................................................................................................................292
By-pass Paper End Sensor........................................................................................................................294
By-pass Pick-up, Feed and Separation Roller, Torque Limiter...............................................................295
By-pass Feed Clutch..................................................................................................................................296
Paper Exit Unit...........................................................................................................................................297
Fusing Exit, Paper Overflow, Junction Paper Jam and Paper Exit Sensor............................................298
Duplex Unit.....................................................................................................................................................301
Duplex Unit................................................................................................................................................301
Duplex Door Sensor..................................................................................................................................302

11

Duplex Entrance Sensor............................................................................................................................303


Duplex Exit Sensor....................................................................................................................................304
Electrical Components...................................................................................................................................305
Boards........................................................................................................................................................305
Controller Unit...........................................................................................................................................307
Controller Box Right Cover.......................................................................................................................308
Controller Box............................................................................................................................................309
IOB (In/Out Board)..................................................................................................................................312
BICU...........................................................................................................................................................312
PSU.............................................................................................................................................................314
Power Relay Switch...................................................................................................................................315
ITB Power Supply Board...........................................................................................................................315
High Voltage Supply Board.....................................................................................................................316
High Voltage Supply Board Bracket.......................................................................................................316
IH Inverter..................................................................................................................................................317
Controller Board........................................................................................................................................317
HDD Fan....................................................................................................................................................319
HDD............................................................................................................................................................319
NVRAM Replacement Procedure............................................................................................................321
Using Dip Switches........................................................................................................................................323
Controller Board........................................................................................................................................323
BICU Board................................................................................................................................................323

5. System Maintenance
Service Program Mode.................................................................................................................................325
SP Tables....................................................................................................................................................325
Enabling and Disabling Service Program Mode....................................................................................325
Types of SP Modes....................................................................................................................................325
Remarks......................................................................................................................................................329
Main SP Tables-1..........................................................................................................................................331
SP1-XXX (Feed).........................................................................................................................................331
Main SP Tables-2..........................................................................................................................................357
SP2-XXX (Drum).........................................................................................................................................357
Main SP Tables-3..........................................................................................................................................427

12

SP3-XXX (Process).....................................................................................................................................427
Main SP Tables-4..........................................................................................................................................457
SP4-XXX (Scanner)....................................................................................................................................457
Main SP Tables-5..........................................................................................................................................475
SP5-XXX (Mode).......................................................................................................................................475
Main SP Tables-6..........................................................................................................................................538
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)...............................................................................................................................538
Main SP Tables-7..........................................................................................................................................548
SP7-XXX (Data Log)..................................................................................................................................548
Main SP Tables-8..........................................................................................................................................582
SP8-xxx: Data Log2..................................................................................................................................582
Main SP Tables-9..........................................................................................................................................627
Input Check Table.....................................................................................................................................627
Output Check Table..................................................................................................................................638
Printer Service Mode.................................................................................................................................648
Scanner SP Mode.....................................................................................................................................656
Firmware Update...........................................................................................................................................658
Type of Firmware.......................................................................................................................................658
Before You Begin.......................................................................................................................................659
Updating Firmware...................................................................................................................................659
Updating the LCDC for the Operation Panel..........................................................................................661
Update Procedure for App2Me Provider...............................................................................................662
Browser Unit Update Procedure..............................................................................................................664
Handling Firmware Update Errors...........................................................................................................665
Installing Another Language.........................................................................................................................667
Reboot/System Setting Reset.......................................................................................................................670
Software Reset...........................................................................................................................................670
System Settings and Copy Setting Reset..................................................................................................670
Downloading Stamp Data............................................................................................................................672
NVRAM Data Upload/Download..............................................................................................................673
Uploading Content of NVRAM to an SD card.......................................................................................673
Downloading an SD Card to NVRAM....................................................................................................673
Address Book Upload/Download..............................................................................................................675

13

Information List...........................................................................................................................................675
Download..................................................................................................................................................675
Upload.......................................................................................................................................................676
Using the Debug Log.....................................................................................................................................677
Overview....................................................................................................................................................677
Switching ON and Setting UP Save Debug Log.....................................................................................677
Retrieving the Debug Log from the HDD.................................................................................................681
Recording Errors Manually.......................................................................................................................681
Debug Log Codes.....................................................................................................................................682
Card Save Function.......................................................................................................................................683
Overview....................................................................................................................................................683
Procedure...................................................................................................................................................683
Error Messages..........................................................................................................................................687

6. Troubleshooting
SC Tables.......................................................................................................................................................689
Service Call Conditions.............................................................................................................................689
SC1xx: Scanning.......................................................................................................................................692
SC 2xx: Exposure......................................................................................................................................696
SC3xx: Image Processing 1..................................................................................................................701
SC3xx: Image Processing 2..................................................................................................................702
SC4xx: Image Processing - 3...................................................................................................................705
SC5xx: Paper Feed and Fusing................................................................................................................709
SC6xx: Device Communication...............................................................................................................727
SC7xx: Peripherals....................................................................................................................................736
SC8xx: Overall System.............................................................................................................................748
SC9xx: Miscellaneous..............................................................................................................................759
Process Control Error Conditions..................................................................................................................765
Developer Initialization Result..................................................................................................................765
Process Control Self-Check Result............................................................................................................766
Line Position Adjustment Result.................................................................................................................768
Troubleshooting Guide..................................................................................................................................770
Image Quality............................................................................................................................................770
Line Position Adjustment............................................................................................................................772

14

Stain on the Outputs..................................................................................................................................778


Stack Problem in the 1-Bin Tray...............................................................................................................779
Problem at Regular Intervals.....................................................................................................................779
Toner End Recovery Error.........................................................................................................................780
Solid Image or Halftone Image Error......................................................................................................783
Faulty Cleaning..........................................................................................................................................784
Jam Detection.................................................................................................................................................786
Paper Jam Display.....................................................................................................................................786
Jam Codes and Display Codes................................................................................................................786
Electrical Component Defects.......................................................................................................................794
Sensors.......................................................................................................................................................794
Blown Fuse Conditions..............................................................................................................................799
Scanner Test Mode........................................................................................................................................801
SBU Test Mode..........................................................................................................................................801

7. Energy Saving
Energy Save...................................................................................................................................................803
Energy Saver Modes................................................................................................................................803
Energy Save Effectiveness........................................................................................................................804
Paper Save.....................................................................................................................................................806
Effectiveness of Duplex/Combine Function............................................................................................806

INDEX...........................................................................................................................................................809

15

16

1. Product Information
Specifications

See "Appendices" for the following information:


General Specifications
Supported Paper Sizes
Software Accessories
Optional Equipment

17

1. Product Information

Product Overview
1

18

Component Layout

Product Overview

1. Scanner HP sensor
2. ADF exposure glass
3. 2nd scanner (2nd carriage)
4. Exposure glass
5. 1st scanner (1st carriage)
6. Scanner lamp
7. Original width sensor
8. Original length sensor
9. Scanner motor
10. Lens block
11. Sensor board unit (SBU)
12. Decurler roller
13. Duplex unit
14. Fusing unit

15. Paper transfer roller


16. Registration roller
17. By-pass feed table
18. Tray 2

19. Tray 1
20. Toner collection bottle
21. Laser optics housing unit
22. PCDU (4 colors)
23. Image transfer belt cleaning unit
24. Image transfer belt unit
25. Toner bottle (4 colors)
26. ID sensor
27. IH coil unit

19

1. Product Information

Paper Path

1. Original tray
2. Original exit tray
3. Duplex inverter
4. Duplex feed
5. By-pass tray feed
6. Tray 1 feed
7. Tray 2 feed
8. Tray 3: Optional paper feed unit/LCT

9. Tray 5: Optional LCT 1200


10. Tray 4: Optional paper feed unit
11. Finisher stapler (Optional)
12. Finisher punch (Optional)
13. Finisher lower tray (Optional)
14. Finisher proof tray (Optional)
15. Inner Tray

The 1000-sheet finisher and 1000-sheet booklet finisher require the bridge unit and one from the two-tray
paper feed unit or the LCT.

20

Product Overview

Drive Layout

1. Scanner motor:

Drives the scanner unit.

2. Toner supply clutch-K and -CMY:

Turns on/off the drive power to the toner supply unit (K and CMY).

3.ITB (Image Transfer Belt) contact


motor:

Moves the ITB into contact and away from the color PCUs.

4. Toner transport motor:

Drives the toner attraction pumps and the toner collection coils
from the PCUs, from the transfer belt unit, and inside the toner
collection bottle. Also rotates the toner bottles.

5. Development clutch (K, Y, M, C):

Turns on/off the drive power to the development unit (K, Y, M,


C).

21

1. Product Information

22

6. Drum/Development drive motor


(K, Y, M, C)

Drives the color drum unit and development unit (K, Y, M, C).

7. Paper feed clutch

Switches the drive power between tray 1 and tray 2.

8. Paper feed motor:

Drives the paper feed mechanisms (tray 1/tray 2).

9. By-pass feed clutch:

Turns on/off the drive power to the by-pass pick-up, feed and
separation rollers.

10. Registration motor:

Drives the registration roller.

11. By-pass/duplex feed motor:

Drives the by-pass pick-up, feed and separation roller, and


duplex transport rollers.

12. Paper transfer contact motor:

Moves the paper transfer roller in contact with the image transfer
belt.

13. ITB drive motor:

Drives the image transfer belt unit.

14. Duplex inverter motor

Drives the duplex inverter rollers and duplex transport rollers.

15. Fusing/paper exit motor:

Drives the fusing unit and paper exit section.

Machine Configuration

Machine Configuration
1

Machine
Code

Call
out

Mainframe

D086/D087

[1]

Platen cover

G329

[2]

ARDF

D541

[3]

500-sheet finisher

D372

[16]

Requires [14]

1000-sheet booklet
finisher

B793

[12]

One from [11], [12] and [16]; Requires [14] and


one from [7] and [8].

Punch unit: 3/2 holes

B807-17

Punch unit: 4/2 holes

B807-27

Punch unit: 4 holes

B807-30

Item

Remarks
One from the two

Requires [12].

23

1. Product Information

Machine
Code

Call
out

Remarks

B408

[11]

One from [11], [12] and [16]; Requires [14] and


one from [7] and [8].

D538-57/6
7

[7]

D537-57

[8]

One-tray paper feed


unit

D387

[9]

Envelope feeder

D547

[5]

Requires Tray 2 of the Mainframe or [8]

Caster table

D446

[10]

D539-57/6
7

[6]

Requires [7] or [8].

1-bin tray

D536

[4]

Shift tray

D388

[15]

Bridge unit

D386

[14]

Side tray

D542

[13]

Scanner accessibility
option

D423

ADF handle

B862

Card reader bracket

D547

Optional counter
interface unit

B870

Key counter bracket

A674

Item

1000-sheet finisher
2000-sheet LCT
Two-tray paper feed unit

1200-sheet LCT

24

One from the three;


The one-tray PFU requires [10].

One from the three

Machine Configuration

Item

Machine code

Call out

USB2.0/SD Slot

D422-01

[B]

In USB A (front)

Gigabit Ethernet

D546-23

[G]

IEEE 1284

B679-17

[D]

Wireless LAN

D377-01 (NA)

(IEEE 802.11a/g)

D377-02 (EU/AA)

[E]

Bluetooth

B826-17

[F]

File Format Converter

D377-04

[C]

Remark

You can only install one of these


at a time.

25

1. Product Information

D546-09 (NA)
PostScript 3

D546-10 (EU)

You can only install one from


the five (SD card slot 1)

D546-11 (AA)
Security SD Card (Standard)
PictBridge

D546-21

[A]

D546-05 (NA)
IPDS Unit

D546-06 (EU)
D546-07 (AA)

PDF Direct

This card is included in


[B] D546-23.
D403-05 (NA)

Browser Unit

D403-06 (EU)

Security SD Card (Data


Overwrite Security and HDD
Encryption) is in SD card slot 1
by default. If multiple
applications are required,
merge all applications in one
SD card with SP mode. (
p.139 "SD Card Appli Move")

In SD card slot 2
-

D403-07 (AA)

Remove it from slot 2 after


installing.
SD card slot 2

VM Card (Standard)

26

This SD card is not installed in


SD slot 2 by factory default. This
card should be installed in SD
slot 2 at machine installation.

Guidance for Those Who are Familiar with Predecessor Products

Guidance for Those Who are Familiar with


Predecessor Products
Machine D086/D087 is a successor model to Machine D023/D025. If you have experience with the
predecessor products, the following information will be of help when you read this manual.

Different Points from Predecessor Products


D086/D087

D023/D025

Security Card

Standard

Optional

VM Card

Standard

Optional

Safety shutdown function

Available

Not available

Induction Heating system

Fusing belt and fusing lamp

Fusing method

27

1. Product Information

28

2. Installation
Installation Requirements
Environment

1. Temperature Range: 10C to 32C (50F to 89.6F)


2. Humidity Range: 15% to 80% RH
3. Ambient Illumination: Less than 1500 lux (do not expose to direct sunlight)
4. Ventilation: 3 times/hr/person or more
5. Do not let the machine get exposed to the following:
1) Cool air from an air conditioner
2) Heat from a heater
6. Do not install the machine in areas that are exposed to corrosive gas.
7. Install the machine at locations lower than 2,000 m (6,560 ft.) above sea level.
8. Install the machine on a strong, level base. (Inclination on any side must be no more than 5 mm.)
9. Do not install the machine in areas that get strong vibrations.
Do not leave the toner bottle in a place directly exposed to sunlight.

29

2. Installation

The toner bottle must be kept at a temperature of 35C (95F) or less. Be careful not to leave the
toner bottle in a hot place when transporting or storing it.

Machine Level

Front to back: Within 5 mm (0.2")


Right to left: Within 5 mm (0.2")

Machine Space Requirements

This machine, which uses high voltage power sources, can generate ozone gas. High ozone density
is harmful to human health. Therefore, the machine must be installed in a well-ventilated room.

A: Over 100 mm (3.9")


B: Over 100 mm (3.9")
C: Over 100 mm (3.9")
D: Over 750 mm (29.5")
Put the machine near the power source with the clearance shown above.

30

Installation Requirements

Machine Dimensions

[A]: 670 mm (mainframe) + 260 mm (PFU) + 120 mm (ARDF)


[B]: 580 mm
[C]: 670 mm
[D]: 1107 mm
[E]: 535 mm

Power Requirements

Insert the plug firmly in the outlet.


Do not use an outlet extension plug or cord.
Ground the machine.
1. Input voltage level:
120 to 127 V, 60 Hz: More than 12 A
220 V to 240 V, 50 Hz/60 Hz: More than 8 A
2. Permissible voltage fluctuation: +8.66 %/ -10 %
31

2. Installation

3. Do not put things on the power cord.

32

Optional Unit Combinations

Optional Unit Combinations


Machine Options

No.

Options

Remarks

Main machine (D086/D087)

Platen cover

ARDF

1-bin tray unit

Envelope feeder*1

Requires Tray 2 of the Mainframe or No.8

1200-sheet LCT

Requires No.7 or No.8

One from No.2 or No.3

33

2. Installation

Large capacity tray

Two-tray paper feed unit

One-tray paper feed unit

10

Caster table

11

1000-sheet finisher

One from No.11, No.12 or No.16;

12

1000-sheet booklet finisher

Requires No.14 and one from No.7 or No.8

13

Side tray

14

Bridge unit

15

Shift tray

16

500-sheet finisher

One from No.7, No.8 or No.9


No.9 requires No. 10

One from No.13, No.14 or No.15

Requires No.14

*1: The Envelope Feeder EF3000 (D547) cannot be used in the one-tray paper feed unit (D387).

Controller Options
No.

34

Options

Remarks

Bluetooth

IEEE 802.11a/g

IEEE 1284

File Format Converter

I/F Slot B

Gigabit Ethernet

I/F Slot C

Security SD Card (Standard)

PostScript 3

PictBridge Option

IPDS Unit Type C5501

10

PDF Direct (child option for USB2.0/SD


Slot)

11

Browser Unit Type E

One from the three (I/F Slot A)

One from the five (SD card slot 1)


Security SD Card (Data Overwrite Security
and HDD Encryption) is in SD card slot 1 by
default. If multiple applications are required,
merge all applications in one SD card with SP
mode. ( p.139 "SD Card Appli Move")

SD card slot 2 (during installation only)

Optional Unit Combinations

SD card slot 2
12

VM Card (Standard)

This SD card is not installed in SD slot 2 by factory


default. This card should be installed in SD slot 2 at
machine installation.

For details about the slot locations, see Controller Options.

Other Options
No.

Options

Remarks

Optional Counter Interface Unit

USB2.0/SD Slot

ADF Handle Type B

Key Counter Bracket Type H

Card Reader Bracket Type C5501

One from No.3 or No.4


-

Fax Options
No.

Options

Remarks

Fax Option Type C5501

G3 Interface Unit Type C5000

Memory Unit Type B

Requires No.1

*Handset Type 1018

Requires No.1.

35

2. Installation

Copier Installation
Make sure that the image transfer belt is in its correct position (away from the PCDUs) before you
move the machine. Otherwise, the image transfer belt and the black PCDU can be damaged.

Power Sockets for Peripherals

Rating voltage for peripherals.


Make sure to plug the cables into the correct sockets.

Installation Flow Chart


This flow chart shows the best procedure for installation.

36

Copier Installation

You need the optional paper tray unit or the LCT if you want to install the finisher (B408 or B793) or 1200sheet LCT (D539).
The punch unit is for the booklet finisher (B793).

Installation Procedure

Remove the tape from the development units before you turn the main switch on. The development
units can be severely damaged if you do not remove the tape.
Put the machine on the paper tray unit or the LCT first if you install an optional paper tray unit or the optional
LCT at the same time. Then install the machine and other options.

37

2. Installation

Keep the shipping retainers after you install the machine. You may need them in the future if you
transport the machine to another location.

Tapes and Retainers

1. Remove all the tapes and retainers on the machine.


2. Remove all the tapes and retainers in trays 1 and 2, and then take out the power cord from tray 1 (if
applicable).
3. Remove the scanner unit stay [A].
4. Open the front door [B], and then remove the jam location sheet [C].
5. Keep the scanner unit stay [A] inside the front door [B].
6. Reattach the jam location sheet.
7. Close the front door.

38

Copier Installation

Developer and Toner Bottles

1. Open the front door [A].


GSA model (-57) and EU models (-27) do not require steps from 2 to 7. Skip to step 8 if you
install these models.
2. Remove the stopper [B] ( x 1).
This stopper locks the drum positioning plate lever.
3. Release the image transfer unit lock lever [C], and turn the drum positioning plate lever [D]
counterclockwise.
4. Open the drum positioning plate [E].
5. Remove all tapes [F] from the four development units.
When you remove the tape from the development unit, hold the development unit with your
hand, and then pull the tape.
6. Close the drum positioning plate. Then lock the image transfer unit lock and turn the drum positioning
plate lever clockwise.
7. Lock the drum positioning plate lever with the stopper [B] ( x 1).
8. Shake each toner bottle five or six times.

39

2. Installation

9. Install each toner bottle [G] in the machine.


The black toner bottle is unique for the D086/D087 models. The black toner bottle for the
previous models (D023/D025) cannot be used in the D086/D087 models.
The other color toner bottles are common with the previous models.
10. Close the front door.

Paper Trays
1. Pull each paper tray out. Then adjust the side guides and end guide to match the paper size.
To move the side guide, first pull out the tray fully. Then push down the green lock at the rear
inside the tray.

40

Copier Installation

2. Pull out the feeler [A] for the output tray full detection mechanism.

Emblem and Decals

1. Attach the correct emblem [A] and the cover [B] to the front door [C] of the machine, if the emblem
is not attached.
2. Attach the correct paper tray number and size decals to the paper trays [D].
Paper tray number and size decals are also used for the optional paper tray or the optional LCT.
Keep these decals for use with these optional units.

41

2. Installation

Initialize the Developer


1. Plug in the machine.
2. Make sure that the platen or ARDF is closed and the main power is turned off.

3. Turn the main power switch on. The machine automatically starts the initialization procedure. The Start
button LED ( ) turns green when this procedure has finished.
4. Make copies of image samples (text, photo, and text/photo modes).
5. Do the Automatic Color Calibration process (ACC) as follows:
1). Print the ACC test pattern (User tools > Maintenance > ACC > Start).
2). Put the printout on the exposure glass.
3). Put 10 sheets of white paper on top of the test chart.
4). Close the ARDF or the platen cover.
5). Press Start Scanning on the LCD panel. The machine starts the ACC.
6. Check that the sample image has been copied normally.

Settings Relevant to the Service Contract


Change the necessary settings for the following SP modes if the customer has made a service contract.
You must select one of the counter methods (developments/prints) in accordance with the contract
(* SP5-045-001).
The SP operation sound can be turned on or off. For details, see "SP Operation Sound On/Off Setting"
below.
Item
Counting
method

42

SP No.
SP5-045-001

Function
Specifies if the counting method used in
meter charge mode is based on
developments or prints.

Default
0: Developments

A3/11" x 17"
double
SP5-104-001
counting

Specifies whether the counter is doubled


for A3/11" x 17" paper. When you have No: Single
to change this setting, contact your
counting
supervisor.

Service Tel.
No. Setting

5812-002 programs the service station


fax number. The number is printed on the
counter list when the meter charge mode
is selected. This lets the user fax the counter
data to the service station.

SP5-812-001
through 004

Copier Installation

SP Operation Sound On/Off Setting

To turn off the SP Operation Sound


1. Enter the SP mode.
2. On the top menu screen [A], hold down the "Clear/Stop" button until you hear a beep sound. This
turns off the SP operation sound.
3. No SP operation sound can be heard in all levels [B] (SPx, SPx-xxx and SPx-xxx-xxx) of the SP mode.
To turn on the SP Operation Sound
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. On the top menu screen [A], hold down the "Clear/Stop" button again until you hear a beep sound.
This turns on the SP operation sound.
3. SP operation sound can be heard in all levels [B] (SPx, SPx-xxx and SPx-xxx-xxx) of the SP mode.

Settings for @Remote Service

Prepare and check the following check points before you visit the customer site. For details, ask the
@Remote key person.
Check points before making @Remote settings
1. The setting of SP5816-201 in the mainframe must be "0".
2. Device ID2 (SP5811-003) must be correctly programmed.
6 spaces must be put between the 3-digit prefix and the following 8-digit number (e.g.
xxx______xxxxxxxx).
ID2 (SP5811-003) and the serial number (SP5811-001) must be the same (e.g. ID2:
A01______23456789 = serial No. A0123456789)
3. The following settings must be correctly programmed.
Proxy server IP address (SP5816-063)
Proxy server Port number (SP5816-064)
43

2. Installation

Proxy User ID (SP5816-065)


Proxy Password (SP5816-066)
4. Get a Request Number
Execute the @Remote Settings

1. Enter the SP mode.


2. Input the Request number which you have obtained from @Remote Center GUI, and then enter [OK]
with SP5816-202.
3. Confirm the Request number, and then click [EXECUTE] with SP5816-203.
4. Check the confirmation result with SP5816-204.
Value

Meaning

Solution/ Workaround

Succeeded

Request number error

Check the request number again.

Communication error (proxy enabled) Check the network condition.

Communication error (proxy disabled) Check the network condition.

Proxy error (Illegal user name or


password)

Check Proxy user name and password.

Communication error

Check the network condition.

Other error

See "SP5816-208 Error Codes" below this.

Request number confirmation


executing

Processing Please wait.

5. Make sure that the screen displays the Location Information with SP5816-205 only when it has been
input at the Center GUI.
6. Click [EXECUTE] to execute the registration with SP5816-206.
7. Check the registration result with SP5816-207.
Value

44

Meaning

Solution/ Workaround

Succeeded

Request number error

Check the request number again.

Already registered

Check the registration status.

Communication error (proxy enabled) Check the network condition.

Copier Installation

Value

Meaning

Solution/ Workaround

Communication error (proxy disabled) Check the network condition.

Proxy error (Illegal user name or


password)

Check Proxy user name and password.

Other error

See "SP5816-208 Error Codes" below this.

Request number confirmation


executing

Processing Please wait.

8. Exit the SP mode.


SP5816-208 Error Codes
Cause

Operation Error,
Incorrect Setting

Code

Meaning

Solution/ Workaround

Inquiry, registration attempted


-12002
without acquiring Request No.

Obtain a Request Number


before attempting the Inquiry or
Registration.

-12003 Attempted registration without


execution of a confirmation and no
previous registration.

Perform Confirmation before


attempting the Registration.

-12004 Attempted setting with illegal entries


for certification and ID2.

Check ID2 of the mainframe.

-12005 @Remote communication is


prohibited. The device has an
Embedded RC gate-related
problem.

Make sure that "Remote


Service" in User Tools is set to
"Do not prohibit".

-12006 A confirmation request was made


after the confirmation had been
already completed.

Execute registration.

45

2. Installation

Cause

Code

Meaning

-12007 The request number used at


registration was different from the
one used at confirmation.
-12008

2
Operation Error,
Incorrect Setting

-12009

Update certification failed because


mainframe was in use.

Solution/ Workaround
Check Request No.
Check the mainframe condition.
If the mainframe is in use, try
again later.

Write a common certification,


ID2 mismatch between an individual and then execute the
certification and NVRAM
confirmation request to the
@Remote Center.

-12010
Certification area is not initialized.

Write a common certification


after initializing the certification
area, and then execute the
confirmation request to the
@Remote Center.

-2385 Other error


-2387 Not supported at the Service Center
-2389 Database out of service
-2390 Program out of service
-2391
Error Caused by
Response from
GW URL

Two registrations for the same


mainframe

Check the registration condition


of the mainframe

-2392 Parameter error


-2393 External RCG not managed
-2394 Mainframe not managed
-2395 Box ID for external RCG is illegal.
-2396

46

Mainframe ID for external RCG is


illegal.

-2397 Incorrect ID2 format

Check the ID2 of the mainframe.

-2398 Incorrect request number format

Check the Request No.

Copier Installation

VM Card Installation
The App2Me application must be enabled before it can be used. The VM SD card including App2Me is
provided with the main machine.
Do the following procedure if a customer wants to use "App2Me".
1. Turn off the machine if it is in use.

2. Remove the SD slot cover [A] (

x 1).

3. Insert the VM SD card [B] in slot 2.


4. Attach the SD slot cover [A] (

x 1).

5. Turn on the machine.

Enabling App2Me
The following procedure basically should be done by a customer.
1. Press the [User Tools] key on the operation panel.
2. Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice.
3. Touch the "App2Me" line under the Startup Setting tab.
4. Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on the LCD.
5. Touch the "App2Me" line.
6. Set "Auto Start" to "On".
7. Touch the "Exit" button.

47

2. Installation

8. Exit the "User Tools" settings.


Do not remove the VM card from Slot 2 (lower slot). The VM card must remain in the machine.

Moving the Machine


This section shows you how to manually move the machine from one floor to another floor. See the section
Transporting the Machine if you have to pack the machine and move it a longer distance.
1. Remove all trays from the optional paper feed unit or LCT.

Transporting the Machine


Main Frame
1. Do SP 4806-001 to move the scanner carriage from the home position. This prevents dust from falling
into the machine during transportation.
2. Remove the toner cartridges. This prevents toner flow into the toner supply tube, which is caused by
vibration during transport. This can also cause the tube to be clogged with toner.
3. Make sure there is no paper left in the paper trays. Then fix down the bottom plates with a sheet of
paper and tape.
4. Empty the toner collection bottle. Then attach securing tape to stop the toner bottle from coming out.
5. Do one of the following:
Attach shipping tape to the covers and doors.
Shrink-wrap the machine tightly.
After you move the machine, make sure you do the "Auto Color Registration" as follows. This optimizes
color registration.
1. Do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode c" (SP2-111-3).
2. Then do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode a" (SP2-111-1).
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed
at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
Make sure that the side fences in the trays are correctly positioned to prevent color registration errors.

48

Paper Feed Unit PB3080 (D387)

Paper Feed Unit PB3080 (D387)


Accessory Check
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Securing bracket

Screw (M4x10)

Spring washer screw

Knob screw

Installation Procedure

Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one
person, and may cause human injury or property damage.
Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.

The one-tray paper feed unit must be installed on the caster table (D446). Prepare the caster table
first before installing this unit.
The Envelope Feeder EF3000 (D547) cannot be used in this unit. Do not install the Envelope Feeder
EF3000 (D547) in this unit.

49

2. Installation

2
1. Remove all tape on the paper feed unit.
2. Remove the paper tray and remove all tapes and padding.

3. Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine.


4. Lift the copier and install it on the paper feed unit [C].
Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.

50

Paper Feed Unit PB3080 (D387)

5. Remove tray 1 and 2 of the machine.


6. Fasten the spring washer screw [D].
7. Reinstall all trays.
8. Attach the securing brackets [E] (M4x10; x 1 each).

One of the securing brackets is used as a securing tool (the cutout [F] is used in step 6). But the
cutout [G] is for attaching the tray heater. Therefore, attach the securing brackets [E] after
installing the tray heater if you install the tray heater.
9. Load paper into the paper feed unit.
10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
11. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality.

51

2. Installation

Caster Table Type A (D446)


Component Check

No.

Description

Caster Table

Stud Screw

Installation Procedure
1. Put the caster table on a flat place.

52

Qty

Caster Table Type A (D446)

2. Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine, if the copier is to be installed on the caster table.
3. Lift the copier or one-tray paper feed unit [C], and then install it on the caster table [D].
Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.
4. Pull out tray 2 of the mainframe or the tray of the one-tray paper feed unit.

5. Secure the machine or one-tray paper feed unit to the caster table (stud screw x 1)
6. Reinstall the tray in the mainframe or one-tray paper feed unit.
7. Adjust the five leveling adjustors of the caster table.

53

2. Installation

Paper Feed Unit PB3010 (D537)


Accessory Check

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Securing bracket

Screw (M4x10)

Spring Washer Screw

Installation Procedure

Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one
person, and may cause injury or property damage.
Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.

54

Paper Feed Unit PB3010 (D537)

1. Remove all tape on the paper feed unit.


2. Remove the paper trays and remove all tape and padding.

3. Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine.


4. Lift the copier and install it on the paper feed unit [C].
Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.

55

2. Installation

5. Remove trays 1 and 2 of the machine.


6. Fasten the spring washer screw [D].
7. Reinstall all trays.
8. Attach the securing brackets [E] (

x 1 each; M4x10).

One of the securing brackets is used as a securing tool (the cutout [F] is used in step 6). But the
cutout [G] is for attaching the tray heater. Therefore, attach the securing brackets [E] after
installing the tray heater if you install the tray heater.
9. Load paper into the paper feed unit.
10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
11. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality.

56

Envelope Feeder EF3000 (D547)

Envelope Feeder EF3000 (D547)


Accessory Check
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Envelope feeder

Paper size decal

Installation Procedure

This tray can be installed in tray 2 of the copier, or tray 3 or tray 4 of the paper feed unit (D537).
There is no automatic paper size detection in the envelope feeder (D547). Adjust the paper size for
the tray where the envelope feeder is to be installed with User Tools.
1. Remove all tape from the envelope feeder.

57

2. Installation

2. Pull out tray 2 [A] from the main machine.

3. Install the envelope feeder [A] into tray 2 of the main machine.
4. Press the "User/Tools" key on the operation panel.
5. Enter "Small Paper Size Tray" under "General Features".
Initial Settings > General Features > Small Paper Size Tray
6. Select "On" for the tray where the envelope feeder is installed.
7. Turn the main machine off and on.

58

LCIT RT3010 (D539)

LCIT RT3010 (D539)


Component Check
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Front Bracket

Rear Bracket

Stud Screw

Joint Pin

LCT

Installation Procedure

Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.

59

2. Installation

The Paper Tray Unit (D537) or LCT 2000-sheet (D538) must be installed before installing this 1200sheet LCT.

1. Unpack the LCT and remove the tapes.


2. Remove the stand covers [A].
3. Release the locks [B] of the front and rear caster stands.
4. Remove the caster stands [C].

5. Remove the paper path cover [A], connector cover [B] and six hole covers [C].

60

LCIT RT3010 (D539)

6. Insert the joint pins [A].


7. Attach the front [B] and rear brackets [C] (

x 2 each).

8. Pull out the front and rear rails [A], and then hang them on each bracket [B].
9. Connect the LCT cable [C] to the main machine.
10. Slide the LCT [D] into the main machine.
11. Make sure that the front and rear sides of the LCT are closely attached to the main machine.

61

2. Installation

Side Fence Position Change


1. Open the right door of the LCT.
2. Push the down switch to lower the tray bottom plate until it reaches its lowest position.

3. Remove the front and rear side fences [A, B] (

x 1 each).

4. Install the side fences in the correct position (A4 LEF/ LT LEF/ B5 LEF).

5. Pull the end fence [A] for B5 size paper as shown (


paper.

62

x 1) if the side fences are adjusted for B5 size

LCIT RT3010 (D539)

6. Close the right door.


7. Turn on the main power switch, and then go into the SP mode.
8. Input the correct paper size for the1200-sheet LCT with SP5181-018.

63

2. Installation

LCIT PB3110 (D538)


Accessory Check

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Securing bracket

Screw (M4x10)

Spring washer screw

Installation Procedure

Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one
person, and may cause injury or property damage.
Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.

64

LCIT PB3110 (D538)

2
1. Remove all tapes and retainers in the LCT.

2. Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine.


3. Lift the copier and install it on the LCT [C].
Hold the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine when you lift and move the machine.

65

2. Installation

4. Remove trays 1 and 2 of the machine.


5. Fasten the spring washer screw [D].
6. Reinstall all trays.
7. Attach the securing brackets [E] (

x 1 each; M4x10).

One of the securing brackets is used as a securing tool (the cutout [F] is used in step 5). But the
cutout [G] is for attaching the tray heater. Therefore, attach the securing brackets [E] after
installing the tray heater if you install the tray heater.
8. Load paper into the LCT.
9. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
10. Check the LCT operation and copy quality.

66

ARDF DF3050 (D541)

ARDF DF3050 (D541)


Component Check
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

ARDF

Stamp Cartridge

Knob Screw

Stud Screw

Attention Decal Top Cover

Installation Procedure

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

67

2. Installation

1. Remove all tapes and shipping retainers.


2. Remove the two screws already installed at the top rear of the machine.
3. Insert the two stud screws [A] on the top of the machine.

4. Mount the ARDF [B] by aligning the screw keyholes [C] in the ARDF support plate over the stud screws.
5. Slide the ARDF toward the front of the machine.
6. Secure the ARDF with the two knob screws [D].

68

ARDF DF3050 (D541)

7. Install the stamp cartridge [F] in the ARDF.

8. Peel off the platen sheet [G] and place it on the exposure glass.
9. Align the rear left corner of the platen sheet with the corner [H] on the exposure glass.
10. Close the ARDF.
11. Open the ARDF and check that the platen sheet is correctly attached.

69

2. Installation

12. Attach the decal [I] to the top cover as shown. Choose the language you want.
13. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the machine, and then check the ARDF operation.
14. Make a full size copy. Check that the registrations (side-to-side and leading edge) and image skew
are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations and image skew referring to "Copy Adjustments"
in the "Replacements and Adjustments section.

70

ADF Handle Type B (D366)

ADF Handle Type B (D366)


Component Check
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Handle Unit

Holder

Stud Bracket

Securing Bracket

Handle Bracket

Hinge Stopper - Right

Hinge Stopper - Left

Spacer

Bushing: M6

10

Bushing: 6MM

11

Tapping Screw: M3 x 12

12

Tapping Screw (Self Binding): M3 x 12

13

Screw: M3 x 8

14

Tapping Screw: M4 x 8

15

Operation Decal

16

Stud Decal

71

2. Installation

Installation Procedure

Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.

Preparing before Installing the DF Handle


1. Open the ADF unit.

72

ADF Handle Type B (D366)

2. Hold the securing bracket [A] at the location [B], inside the ADF cover.
3. Secure the stud bracket [C] to the outside of the ADF cover at location [D] with two screws ( x 2:
M3x8).
The two screws must go through the ADF cover and the securing bracket [A].

73

2. Installation

4. Make two screw holes [E] in the scanner right cover with an M3x12 tapping screw from the
accessories.

Installing the DF Handle

1. Attach the holder [A] to the scanner right cover (Tapping Screw - M3x12: x 2).
At first, secure the screw at the rear side (away from the operation panel) temporarily and then
at the front side temporarily. After that, secure them fully.

2. Install the bushing: 6MM [B] in the inside of the handle unit.
3. Attach the handle unit to the stud bracket on the left side of the ADF.

74

ADF Handle Type B (D366)

4. In the outside of the handle unit, install the bushing - M6 [C] first, and then the spacer [D].

5. Secure the handle unit with a screw ( x 1: M3x8).

6. Clean the handle unit with alcohol. Then attach the stud decal [E] at the location that was cleaned.

75

2. Installation

7. Attach the handle bracket [F] at the front right side on the bottom of the ADF unit (Tapping Screw [Self
Binding] x 2: M3x12).
8. Close the ADF unit.

9. Attach the hinge stoppers (left [G] and right [H]) to the left and right hinges (Tapping screw x 2: M4x8
each).

76

ADF Handle Type B (D366)

10. Clean the front side of the duplex unit with alcohol. Then attach the operation decal [I] at the location
that was cleaned.

11. Check the operation of the handle unit [J].

77

2. Installation

1 Bin Tray BN3080 (D536)


Component Check

Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

1 Bin Tray Unit

End-fence

Tray Support Bar

Screws (M3 x 16)

Tray

Installation Procedure

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
If the bridge unit (D386) or side tray (D542) has already been installed in the machine, remove it before
installing 1 bin tray unit (D536). This will make it easier for you to do the following procedure.
1. Remove all tapes.
2. Open the right door of the machine.

78

1 Bin Tray BN3080 (D536)

3. Remove the front right cover [A] (


4. Remove the inner cover [B] (

x 1).

x 1).

Keep this screw for step 5.

5. Install the 1 bin tray unit [C] (

x 1,

x 1,

x 1 [This screw was removed in step 4]).

79

2. Installation

2
6. Attach the tray support bar [D] to the tray [E] as shown, and then attach the end-fence [F].

7. Install the tray [G] (with the tray support bar) in the machine (M3 x 16:

x 2).

8. Reinstall the front right cover in the machine, and then close the right door of the machine.
9. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
10. Check the 1 bin tray unit operation.

80

Internal Shift Tray SH3040 (D388)

Internal Shift Tray SH3040 (D388)


Component Check
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Shift Tray Unit

Paper Guide - Small

Connector Cover

Installation Procedure

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.

81

2. Installation

1. Remove all tapes.


2. Remove the standard tray [A].
3. Remove the inner cover [B] (

x 1).

4. Install the small paper guides [C].

82

Internal Shift Tray SH3040 (D388)

5. Attach the connector cover [D] to the shift tray unit [E].
6. Install the shift tray unit [E] to the machine.
7. Push down the left edge [F] of the shift tray.
8. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
9. Check the shift tray unit operation.

83

2. Installation

Side Tray Type C5501 (D542)


Component Check

84

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Side Tray Unit

Sub Output Tray

Main Output Tray

Screw

Knob screw

Frame Cover

Holder bracket

Side Tray Type C5501 (D542)

Installation Procedure

Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.

If you will install the 1-bin tray (D536) on the machine, install the 1-bin tray first before installing the
side tray (D542). This makes it easier to do the following procedure.

1. Remove all tapes.


2. If the sensor feeler [A] is out, fold it into the machine.
3. Open the right door of the machine.

4. Remove the inner tray [B].


5. Remove the front right cover [C] (

x 1).

6. Remove the connector cover [D] (

x 1).
85

2. Installation

7. Attach the main output tray [A] and sub output tray [B] to the side tray unit.

8. Install the side tray unit [A] in the machine.

86

Side Tray Type C5501 (D542)

9. Open the side tray cover [A].


10. Secure the side tray unit with the knob screw [B].
11. Attach the frame cover [C].
12. Reinstall the front right cover to the machine, and then close the right door of the machine.
Open the side tray cover [A] when installing the front right cover. Otherwise, you cannot reinstall
it.
13. Install the holder bracket [D] (

x 1)

14. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.


15. Check the side tray operation.

87

2. Installation

Bridge Unit BU3030 (D386)


Component Check

Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.

Description

Bridge Unit

Frame Cover

Knob screw

Long knob screw

Holder bracket

Guide

Installation Procedure

Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
88

Qty

Bridge Unit BU3030 (D386)

1. If you will install the 1-bin tray (D536) in the machine, install the 1-bin tray before you install the
bridge unit (D386). This will make it easier for you to do the following procedure.
2. If you will install a finisher (B408, B804 or B805) in the machine, install the finisher after you install
the bridge unit (D386).

1. Remove all tapes.

2. If the sensor feeler [A] is out, fold it into the machine.


3. Open the right door of the machine.

4. Remove the inner tray [B].


5. Remove the front right cover [C] (

x 1).

6. Remove the connector cover [D] (

x 1).

89

2. Installation

7. Install the bridge unit [E] in the machine.

8. Secure the bridge unit with the knob screw [F] and screw [H].
9. Attach the frame cover [I].
10. Reinstall the front right cover in the machine. Then close the right door of the machine.
Open the bridge unit cover [J] when installing the front right cover. Otherwise, the bridge unit
cover is an obstacle for attaching the front right cover.
11. Install the optional finisher (refer to the finisher installation procedure).

90

Bridge Unit BU3030 (D386)

If you will not install the finisher at this time, install the holder bracket [G]. Otherwise, the customer
will damage the bridge unit if they pull up the bridge unit tray. When you install the finisher, you
will need this bracket during the installation procedure.

12. Pull the extension tray [K] only if the 1000-sheet finisher (B408) is to be installed in the main machine.
13. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
14. Check the bridge unit operation.

91

2. Installation

Finisher SR3050 (D372)


Accessory Check

92

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No

Description

Qty

Unit Holder

Shift Tray

Holder Bracket

Screw: M3 x 8

Screw: M3 x 6

Screw: M4 x 14

Screw: M4 x 20

Support Bracket

Support Bracket Cover

Finisher SR3050 (D372)

Installation Procedure

Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.

Before you install the 500-sheet finisher, the optional bridge unit (D386) must be installed.

1. Unpack the finisher and remove the tapes.

93

2. Installation

2. Install the unit holder [A] (

x 3 - M4 x 14).

3. Install the support brackets [B] (

x 2 each: M4 x 20)

4. Install the support bracket covers [C] (

x 1 each: M3 x 8)

5. Install the 500-sheet finisher [A].


6. Install the holder bracket [B] (

x 1; M3 x 6).

7. Connect the finisher cable [C].

8. Install the shift tray [A] (

x 2 - M3 x 8).

9. Turn on the main power switch and check the finisher operation.

94

SR790 (B408)

SR790 (B408)
Accessory Check
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Front Joint Bracket

Rear Joint Bracket (Not used)

Rear Joint Bracket

Grounding Plate

Copy Tray

Staple Position Decal

Screw - M4 x 14

Knob Screw - M4 x 10

Screw - M3 x 8

10

Knob Screw - M3 x 8

95

2. Installation

Installation Procedure

Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.

If this finisher will be installed on the D086 or D087 copier, the following options must be installed before
installing this finisher.
- Bridge Unit (D386)
- Paper Feed Unit (D537) or LCT (D538)

1. Unpack the finisher, and then remove the stopper [A] and tapes (

2. Install the front joint bracket [B], holder bracket [C] (


( x 2 - M4 x 14).
96

x 1).

x 2 - M4 x 14), and rear joint bracket [D]

SR790 (B408)

The holder bracket [C] must be placed outside the front joint bracket [B]. The holder bracket is
provided with the bridge unit (D386).

1. Install the grounding plate [E] on the finisher (

x 2 - M3 x 8).

Use the screw removed in step 1 and the screw from the accessory box.
2. Open the front door [F] of the finisher, and then pull the locking lever [G] (1 knob screw - M3 x 8).
3. Align the finisher on the joint brackets, and lock it in place by pushing the locking lever.
4. Secure the locking lever (1 knob screw - M3 x 8).
5. Close the front door.
6. Install the copy tray [H] (1 knob screw - M4 x 10).
7. Connect the finisher cable [I] to the main machine below the right rear handle.

97

2. Installation

2
8. Attach the staple position decal [J] to the ARDF as shown.
9. Turn on the main power switch and check the finisher operation.

98

Booklet Finisher SR3000 (B793)

Booklet Finisher SR3000 (B793)


Accessory Check
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Rear Joint Bracket

Front Joint Bracket

Grounding Plate

Upper Output Tray

Cushion

Lower Output Tray

Short Knob Screw

Long Knob Screw

Screw (M3 x 8)

10

Screw (M4 x 14)

99

2. Installation

Installation Procedure

Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
The bridge unit (D386) and optional paper feed unit (D537 or D538) must be installed before installing
this finisher (B793).

100

Booklet Finisher SR3000 (B793)

1. Unpack the finisher and remove all tapes and packing materials from the finisher.

2. Open the front door [A] of the 1000-sheet booklet finisher, and then pull out the jogger unit [B].
3. Remove all tapes and packing materials from the inside of the finisher.

4. Attach the cushions [C] to the finisher.


Make sure that the cushions are placed within 0 to 1 mm [D] from the edge of the cover or frame.
5. Install the ground plate [E] on the finisher (

x 2; M3 x 8).
101

2. Installation

6. Attach the rear joint bracket [F] (

x 2, M4 x 14).

7. Attach the front joint bracket [G] and the holder bracket [H] (

x 2; M4 x 14).

The holder bracket [H] must be placed outside the front joint bracket [G]. The holder bracket is
provided with the bridge unit (D386).

8. Pull the lock lever [I] (Long knob screw x 1).


9. Slowly push the finisher to the left side of the machine, keeping its front door open until the brackets
[J] [K] go into their slots.
10. Push the lock lever [I], and then secure it (Long knob screw x 1).

102

Booklet Finisher SR3000 (B793)

11. Close the front door of the finisher.


12. Connect the finisher connector [L] to the machine.

13. Install the upper output tray [M] (Short knob screw x 1).
14. Install the lower output tray [N].
15. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
16. Check the 1000-sheet booklet finisher operation.

103

2. Installation

Punch Kit PU3000 (B807)


Component Check

104

Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

Punch Unit

Punch Drive Motor

Hopper Full Sensor Arm

Sub-scan Registration Sensor Unit

Punch Unit Stay

Sub-scan Registration Sensor Guide

Hopper

Screw

Step Screw

10

Spring

Punch Kit PU3000 (B807)

Installation

Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure. If the 1000-sheet
booklet finisher has been installed, disconnect it and pull it away from the machine.

105

2. Installation

1. If the finisher is connected to the machine, disconnect it.


2. Open the top cover [A] and then release the guide arm [B] (
3. Open the front door [C].
4. Pull the hook [D] up then remove the knob [E].
5. Timing belt cover [F].

6. Rear cover of the 1000-sheet booklet finisher [G] (

106

x 2).

x 1).

Punch Kit PU3000 (B807)

7. Cover bracket [H] (

x 1)

8. Remove the paper guide plate [I] from the rear side (

9. Install the punch unit stay [J] from the front side (

x 4).

x 3).

10. Install the sub-scan registration sensor guide [K] from the top (

x 1).

107

2. Installation

11. Remove the bracket [L] from the punch unit (

x 1).

12. Install the punch unit [M] along the punch unit stay from the rear side.
13. Make sure to put the punch unit stay pin [N] through the hole [O].

108

Punch Kit PU3000 (B807)

14. Connect the harnesses [P] to the main PCB.


15. Put the harnesses [Q] through the hole [R] in the rear frame (

16. Install the punch drive motor [S] on the rear frame (

x 1).

x 2).

17. Connect the drive motor harness [T] to the harness from the punch unit (

x 1).

18. Connect the home position sensor harness from the punch unit to the home position sensor [U].

109

2. Installation

19. Install the sub-scan registration sensor unit [V] from the rear side (
20. Route and connect the harnesses as shown (

21. Install the hopper full sensor arm [W] (

x 2).

x 2).

x 1, spring x 1).

22. Connect the harness from the sub-scan registration sensor unit to the hopper full sensor [X].

110

Punch Kit PU3000 (B807)

23. Install the hopper [Y] from the front side.


24. Reinstall the timing belt cover and knob.
25. Reinstall the rear cover (

x 2).

26. Close the front door and top cover.


27. Install the 1000-sheet booklet finisher on the copier.
28. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
29. Check the 1000-sheet booklet finisher operation.

111

2. Installation

Key Counter Bracket Type H (A674)


Installation Procedure

1. Hold the key counter plate nuts [A] on the inside of the key counter bracket [B] and insert the key
counter holder [C].
2. Secure the key counter holder to the bracket (
3. Install the key counter cover [D] (
4. Rear cover (

p.174)

5. Cut off the part [E] of the rear cover.

112

x 2).

x 2).

Key Counter Bracket Type H (A674)

2
6. Connect the harness to the connector [F] inside the machine.

7. Peel off double sided tape on the key counter bracket and attach the key counter to the scanner right
cover [G].
8. Reassemble the machine.

113

2. Installation

Optional Counter Interface Unit Type A (B870)


Installation Procedure

1. Rear cover (
2. IOB bracket (

p.174)
p.309 "Controller Box")

3. Install the four stud stays in the location [A] in the controller box.
4. Install the key counter interface board on the four stud stays in the controller box.
5. Connect the harness to CN3 on the key counter interface board.

6. Close the IOB bracket and connect the other terminal to CN215 [B] on the IOB.

114

Optional Counter Interface Unit Type A (B870)

2
7. Cut off the part [C] of the rear cover.

8. Clamp the harness from the counter device with the clamp [D] and put it as shown by the blue arrow
( x 1).
9. Route the harness from the counter device in the same way as the other harnesses [E] (

x 3).

10. Connect the harness from the counter device to CN4 on the key counter interface board.
11. Reattach the IOB bracket (

p.309 "Controller Box").

12. Reassemble the machine.

115

2. Installation

USB2.0/SD Slot Type F (D546)


Accessory Check

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Qty

USB2.0/SD Slot

Ground Plate

USB Cable

Screw: M3 x 6 blue

Screw: M3 x 8

Screw: M3 x 6

Bracket

PDF Direct Card*1

*1: If the PostScript 3 option is used in this machine, this card is not necessary.

Installation Procedure

1. Connect the USB cable [B] to the USB slot [A] in the USB2.0/SD Slot as shown above.
2. Attach the ground plate [C] to the bracket of the USB2.0/SD Slot (

116

x 1: M3x6 blue).

USB2.0/SD Slot Type F (D546)

3. Rear cover of the machine (

x 8)

4. Remove the scanner left cover [A] (


5. Remove the left frame cover [B] (

x 2).
x 1).

6. Remove the part [A] of the left frame cover with pliers or a similar tool.
7. Reinstall the left frame cover (

x 1).

8. Remove the part [A] on the scanner left cover.

117

2. Installation

2
9. Make four holes in the scanner left cover with a screwdriver as shown [A].
Smooth the four holes in the scanner left cover as shown [B].

10. Route the USB cable [A] through the gaps in the left scanner cover.
11. Secure the USB2.0/SD Slot [B] with the left scanner cover as shown above (
Use the screw holes [C] as shown above.

118

x 4: M3x8).

USB2.0/SD Slot Type F (D546)

12. Attach the bracket [A] with its two hooks [B] as shown above (

x 1: M3x6).

13. Put the USB cable [A] through the cutout [B] of the left frame cover.
14. Attach the scanner left cover [C] to the mainframe, and then connect the USB cable [A] to USB-A
(front side) as shown above.
Make sure that the USB cable is inserted in USB-A (front side).
15. Reinstall the rear cover (

x 8).

If PostScript 3 is already installed, go to step 25. If not, follow the steps from 16 to 24.
119

2. Installation

16. Remove the SD slot cover (

x 1), and move the SD card from slot 1 to slot 2.

17. Insert the PDF direct card in slot 1.


18. Plug in and turn on the mainframe.
19. Enter the System SP mode.

20. Move HDD Security Applications (HDD Encryption unit and Data Overwrite Security Unit) from the
SD card in slot 2 to the SD card in slot 1 with SP5-873-001 "Move Exec".
21. Enter the Scanner SP mode, and then change the setting of SP1013-001 from 0 to 1.
22. Enter the Printer SP mode, and then change the setting of SP1110-001 from 0 to 1.
23. Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the machine.
24. Remove the SD card in slot 2, and then attach the SD slot cover (
Keep this card in the safe place (

x 1).

p.139 "SD Card Appli Move").

25. Check the operation of the USB2.0/SD Slot.

26. Attach the decal [A] to the USB2.0/SD Slot as shown above.

Testing the SD Card/USB Slot


1. Insert an SD card or USB memory device in the slot.
You can connect only one removable memory device at a time.
2. Close the media slot cover.
If you leave the cover open, static electricity conducted through an inserted SD card could cause the
machine to malfunction.
3. Make sure that no previous settings remain.
If a previous setting remains, press the [Clear Modes] key.
4. Place an original on the exposure glass.
5. Press [Store File].
120

USB2.0/SD Slot Type F (D546)

6. Press [Store to Memory Device].


7. Press [OK].
8. Press the [Start] key.
When writing is complete, a confirmation message appears.
9. Press [Exit].
10. Remove the memory device from the media slot.
Do not remove the memory device while writing is in process.

121

2. Installation

Card Reader Bracket Type C5501 (D547)


Component Check

Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.

Description

Screw: M3 x 8

Screw: M3 x 14

Screw: M3 x 25*1

Tapping Screw: M3 x 10

Upper Tray

Lower Tray

Tray Bracket

Clamp

*1: Not used in this machine

122

Qty

Card Reader Bracket Type C5501 (D547)

Installation Procedure

1. Remove the screw [A] on the scanner right cover.


2. Attach the tray bracket [B] to the scanner right cover (

[C] x 2: M3x10,

[D] x 1: M3x14).

For this model, use the screw holes marked "2" on the table bracket.

3. Attach the lower tray [A] to the tray bracket (

x 2: M3x8).

4. Attach the upper tray [B] to the tray bracket (

x 1: M3x8).

5. Use the clamps as necessary to clamp the cable of the card read/writer device.

123

2. Installation

The smart card reader must be placed on this card reader table. If not, some antenna or transmitter
in the main machine may be interrupted.

124

Anti-Condensation Heater (Scanner)

Anti-Condensation Heater (Scanner)


This option is provided as a service part.

Installation Procedure

1. Rear cover (

p.174 in the "Replacement and Adjustment" section)

2. Open the ARDF or platen cover.


3. Glass cover [A] (

x 4)

4. ARDF exposure glass [B]


5. Rear scale [C] (

x 3)

6. Exposure glass with left scale [D]

125

2. Installation

7. Move the scanner carriage to the right side by rotating the scanner motor [E].
8. Install the heater [F] in the scanner unit (

x 1, hook)

9. Put the connector [G] through the cutout.


10. Connect it to the connector [H] (blue and red cords) in the frame of the machine.
11. Reassemble the machine.

126

Anti-Condensation Heater Type A

Anti-Condensation Heater Type A


This option is provided as a service part.

Component Check
No.

Description

Qty

Tray heater

On-standby decal

Harness 2 (For D387)

Harness 1 (For D537/D538)

Screw M4 x 10

Installation procedure

1 (-90) or 2 (-91)

Installation Procedure

Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
127

2. Installation

Do the following procedure not to damage any harnesses.


Check that all harnesses are not damaged nor pinched after installation.

For installing the tray heater in the main machine

1. Remove trays 1 and 2 from the machine.


2. Remove the connector cover [A] (

x 1).

3. Connect the connector [B] of the heater to the connector of the main machine.
4. Install the heater [C] inside the machine (
5. Reassemble the machine.

128

x 1).

Anti-Condensation Heater Type A

For installing the tray heater in D537

1. Rear cover [A] (

x 8)

2. Pull out the two trays in the optional paper feed unit.

3. Install the tray heater [B] in the optional paper feed unit (

x 1).

129

2. Installation

4. Remove the two securing brackets [C] (


feed unit ( x 2).
5. Remove the harness cover bracket [E] (

x 1 each), and then the rear cover [D] of the optional paper
x 1).

6. Pull out tray 2 from the mainframe.


7. Replace the shoulder screw [F] with the washer screw [G], using securing bracket [H] (

130

x 1).

Anti-Condensation Heater Type A

8. Connect the harness [I] to the connector [J] of the tray heater.
9. Route the harness [I] as shown and clamp it with four clamps (

x 4).

10. Connect the harness [I] to the connector [K] of the mainframe.
11. Reassemble the mainframe and optional paper feed unit.

12. Attach the on/standby decal [L] to the right-hand side of the main power switch.

For Installing the Tray Heater in D538


1. Remove the rear cover of the mainframe (

step 1 in For Installing the Tray Heater in D537).

2. Pull out the LCT drawer.


If the right tray comes out with the left tray, push the right tray into the LCT.

131

2. Installation

2
3. Left tray [A] (

x 2)

4. Remove the right tray [B] while pressing down the stopper [C].
When reinstalling the right tray, set the right tray on the guide rail and carefully push the tray in,
making sure to keep the tray level.

132

Anti-Condensation Heater Type A

5. Install the tray heater [D] in the optional LCT (

6. Remove the two securing brackets [E] (


( x 2).
7. Remove the harness cover bracket [G] (

x 1).

x 1 each), and the then rear cover [F] of the optional LCT
x 1).

133

2. Installation

8. Pull out tray 2 from the mainframe.


9. Replace the shoulder screw [H] with the washer screw [I], using the securing bracket [J] (

x 1).

10. Connect the harness [K] to the connector [L] of the tray heater.
11. Route the harness [K] as shown and clamp it with four clamps (

x 4).

12. Connect the harness [K] to the connector [M] of the mainframe.
13. Reassemble the mainframe and optional LCT.

14. Reassemble the mainframe and optional paper feed unit.


15. Attach the on/standby decal [N] to the right-hand side of the main power switch.

For Installing the Tray Heater in D387


1. Remove the rear cover of the mainframe (
2. Pull out the tray in the optional paper tray.

134

step 1 in For Installing the Tray Heater in D537).

Anti-Condensation Heater Type A

3. Install the tray heater [A] in the optional paper tray (

4. Remove the two securing brackets [B] (


tray ( x 2).
5. Remove the harness cover bracket [D] (

x 1).

x 1 each), and then the rear cover [C] of the optional paper
x 1).

135

2. Installation

6. Pull out tray 2 from the mainframe.


7. Replace the shoulder screw [E] with the washer screw [F], using securing bracket [G] (

x 1).

1. Connect the harness [H] to the connector [I] of the tray heater.
2. Route the harness [H] as shown and clamp it with four clamps (

x 4).

Make sure that the harness [H] is placed below the harness [J].
3. Connect one harness [K] of the two-way harness to the connector [L] of the mainframe.
The harness [K] of the two-way harness, which has two binds, is for the connector of the
mainframe. The harness [M], which has one bind, is for another optional paper feed unit.
4. Clamp the other harness [M] of the two-way harness as shown [N] if you do not install another optional
paper feed unit.
5. Reassemble the mainframe and optional paper tray.

136

Anti-Condensation Heater Type A

2
6. Attach the on/standby decal [O] to the right-hand side of the main power switch.

137

2. Installation

Controller Options
Overview

This machine has I/F card slots for optional I/F connections and SD card slots applications.
After you install an option, check that the machine can recognize it (see "Check All Connections" at the
end of this section).

I/F Card Slots


Slot A is used for one of the optional I/F connections (only one can be installed): IEEE1284,
IEEE802.11a/g (Wireless LAN), Bluetooth or Remote Communication Gate.
Slot B is used for the File Format Converter or Remote Communication Gate.
Slot C is used for Gigabit Ethernet.

SD Card Slots
Slot 1 is already occupied by the Security SD Card by factory default, and is also used for optional
applications (e.g.: PostScript 3, PictBridge, IPDS unit, PDF direct, etc).
Slot 2 is used for installing the Browser Unit, VM card or for service only (for example, updating the
firmware).

138

Controller Options

SD Card Appli Move


Overview
The service program "SD Card Appli Move" (SP5-873) lets you move application programs from one SD
card to another SD card.
If more than one application is required, the applications must be moved to one SD card with SP5873-1
(PostScript 3, Security Application, PictBridge, IPDS unit, PDF Direct, etc.).

Be very careful when you do the SD Card Appli Move procedure:


The data necessary for authentication is transferred with the application program from an SD card to
another SD card. Authentication fails if you try to use the SD card after you move the application
program from one card to another card.
Do not use the SD card if it has been used before for other purposes. Normal operation is not
guaranteed when such an SD card is used.

Remove the cover [A] ( x 2), and then keep the SD card in the place [B] after you move the
application program from one card to another card. This is done for the following reasons:
The SD card can be the only proof that the user is licensed to use the application program.
You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a problem in the future.
You cannot move the PostScript or PDF Direct application to another SD card. You have to move the
other application (PictBridge, Security Applications, IPDS unit) to the SD card that stores the PostScript
or PDF Direct application.

Move Exec
The menu "Move Exec" (SP5-873-001) lets you move application programs from the original SD card to
another SD card.
139

2. Installation

Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine.
If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware
upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn the main switch off.

2. Make sure that a target SD card is in SD Card Slot 1. The application program is moved to this SD
card.
3. Insert the source SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 2.The application program
is copied from this source SD card.
4. Turn the main switch on.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-001 "Move Exec".
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn the main switch off.
9. Remove the source SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
10. Turn the main switch on.
11. Check that the application programs run normally.

Undo Exec
"Undo Exec" (SP5-873-002) lets you move back application programs from an SD card in SD Card Slot
1 to the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. You can use this program when, for example, you have
mistakenly copied some programs by using Move Exec (SP5-873-001).
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine.
If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware
upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn the main switch off.
2. Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back into this card.
3. Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 1.The application program is copied
back from this SD card.
4. Turn the main switch on.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-002 "Undo Exec."
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn the main switch off.
140

Controller Options

9. Remove the SD card from SD Card Slot 2.


10. Turn the main switch on.
11. Check that the application programs run normally.
12. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).

PostScript3 Unit Type C5501


The PostScript3 application and fonts cannot be moved to another SD card. However, other applications
can be moved onto the PostScript3 SD card.
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

1. Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots (

x 1).

2. Move the SD card (security applications) [B] from SD slot 1 to SD slot 2.


If the VM card is already in SD slot 2, first remove the VM card in SD slot 2.
3. Insert the SD card [C] (PostScript 3) in SD slot 1 with its label face towards the front of the machine.
Then push it slowly into SD slot 1 until you hear a click.

141

2. Installation

4. Attach the "Adobe PostScript 3" decal [A] to the front door.
5. Plug in, and then turn on the machine.
6. Move security applications from the SD card in SD slot 2 to the SD card in SD slot 1 with SP5-873-001.
7. Turn off the machine.
8. Remove the SD card from SD slot 2, and then keep it in a safe place (

SD Card Appli Move).

9. Insert the VM card in SD slot 2.


10. Attach the SD-card slot cover, and then turn on the machine (

x 1).

11. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).

IPDS Unit Type C5501

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

142

Controller Options

1. Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots (

x 1).

2. Move the SD card (security applications) [B] from slot 1 to slot 2.


If the VM card is already in slot 2, first remove the VM card in SD slot 2.
3. Insert the SD card [C] (IPDS Unit) in SD slot 1 with its label face towards the front of the machine.
4. Plug in, and then turn on the machine.
5. Move security applications from the SD card in SD slot 2 to the SD card in SD slot 1 with SP5-873-001.
6. Turn off the machine.
7. Remove the SD card from SD slot 2, and then keep it in a safe place (
Move").

p.139 "SD Card Appli

8. Insert the VM card in SD slot 2.


9. Attach the SD-card slot cover, and then turn on the machine (

x 1).

File Format Converter Type E

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

143

2. Installation

1. Remove the slot B cover [A] (

x 2).

2. Install the file format converter [B] into slot B and then fasten it with screws.
3. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
4. Check or set the following SP codes with the values shown below.
SP No.

Title

Setting

SP5-836-001

Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)

"1"

SP5-836-002

Panel Setting

"0"

5. Check the operation.


6. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).

IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A


Installation Procedure

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, (Wireless LAN),
IEEE1284, Bluetooth).

144

Controller Options

1. Remove the slot A cover [A] (

x 2).

2. Install the interface board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the slot A.


3. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).

IEEE 802.11a/g Interface Unit Type J


Installation Procedure

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at one time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, (Wireless LAN),
IEEE1284, Bluetooth).

145

2. Installation

1. Remove the slot cover [A] from the board slot (

x 2).

2. Install the wireless LAN board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the board slot.
3. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).

4. Peel off the double-sided tapes on the Velcro fasteners [A], and then attach them [A] at the front left
and rear left of the machine.
5. Attach "ANT1" (having a black ferrite core) [B] to the front left of the machine.
6. Attach "ANT2" (having a white ferrite core) [C] to the rear right of the machine.

146

Controller Options

"ANT1" is a transmission/reception antenna and "ANT2" is a reception antenna. Do not attach


them at the wrong places.
7. Attach the clamps as shown above.
8. Wire the cables and clamp them (

x 7).

Make sure that the cables are not slack. Keep them wired tightly along the covers.

You may have to move the machine if the reception is not clear.
Make sure that the machine is not located near an appliance or any type of equipment that generates
strong magnetic fields.
Put the machine as close as possible to the access point.
Installing Various Hardware Combinations

Refer to the above picture [A] when installing the handset.


Refer to the above picture [B] when installing the handset and the USB2.0/SD.

UP Mode Settings for Wireless LAN


Enter the UP mode. Then do the procedure below to perform the initial interface settings for IEEE 802.11
a/g. These settings take effect every time the machine is powered on.
You cannot use the wireless LAN if you use Ethernet.
1. Press the "User Tools/Counter" key.
2. On the touch panel, press "System Settings".
The Network I/F (default: Ethernet) must be set for either Ethernet or wireless LAN.

147

2. Installation

3. Select "Interface Settings".


4. Press "Wireless LAN". Only the wireless LAN options show.
5. Communication Mode. Select either "802.11 Ad hoc", "Ad hoc" or "Infrastructure".
6. SSID Setting. Enter the SSID setting. (The setting is case sensitive.)

7. Channel. You need this setting when Ad Hoc Mode is selected.


Range: 1 to 14 (default: 11)
The allowed range for the channel settings may vary for different countries.
8. WEP (Encryption) Setting. The WEP (Wired Equivalent Privacy) setting is designed to protect wireless
data transmission. The same WEP key is required on the receiving side in order to unlock encoded
data. There are 64 bit and 128 bit WEP keys.
WEP:
Selects "Active" or "Inactive" ("Inactive" is default.).
Range of Allowed Settings:
64 bit: 10 characters
128 bit: 26 characters
9. Transmission Speed. Press the Next button to show more settings. Then select the transmission speed
for the mode: Auto, 11 Mbps, 5.5 Mbps, 2 Mbps, 1 Mbps (default: Auto). This setting should match
the distance between the closest machine or access point. This depends on which mode is selected.
For the Ad Hoc Mode, this is the distance between the machine and the closest PC in the network.
For the Infrastructure Mode, this is the distance between the machine and the closest access
point.
11 Mbps: 140 m (153 yd.)
5.5 Mbps: 200 m (219 yd.)
2 Mbps: 270 m (295 yd.)
1 Mbps: 400 m (437 yd.)
10. Press "Return to Default" to initialize the wireless LAN settings.
Press "Yes" to initialize the following settings:
Transmission mode
Channel
Transmission Speed
WEP
SSID

148

Controller Options

WEP Key

SP Mode and UP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g Wireless LAN
The following SP commands and UP modes can be set for IEEE 802.11 a/g.
SP No.

Name

Function

5840-006

Channel MAX

Sets the maximum range of the channel settings for the country.

5840-007

Channel MIN

Sets the minimum range of the channels settings allowed for your
country.

5840-011

WEP Key Select

Used to select the WEP key (Default: 00).

UP mode

Name

Function

SSID

Used to confirm the current SSID setting.

WEP Key

Used to confirm the current WEP key setting.

WEP Mode

Used to show the maximum length of the string that can be used
for the WEP Key entry.

Bluetooth Interface Unit Type 3245

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g (Wireless LAN),
IEEE1284, Bluetooth).

149

2. Installation

1. Remove the slot cover [A] (

x 2).

2. Install the Bluetooth board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the slot A.


3. Insert the Bluetooth card into the Bluetooth card adaptor.
4. Install the Bluetooth card adaptor on the Bluetooth board.
5. Attach the antenna cap to the Bluetooth board.
6. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).

Camera Direct Print Card Type I

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

150

Controller Options

1. Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots (

x 1).

2. Move the SD card (security applications) [B] from SD slot 1 to SD slot 2.


If the VM SD card is already in SD slot 2, first remove the VM card in SD slot 2.
3. Insert the SD card [C] (PictBridge) in SD slot 1 with its label face to the front of the machine.
4. Plug in, and then turn on the machine.
5. Move security applications from the SD card in SD slot 2 to the SD card in SD slot 1 with SP5-873-001.
6. Turn off the machine.
7. Remove the SD card from slot SD 2, and then keep it in a safe place.
8. Insert the VM card in SD slot 2.
9. Attach the SD-card slot cover, and then turn on the machine (

x 1).

10. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).

Browser Unit Type E


Installation Procedure

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

151

2. Installation

1. Remove the slot cover [A] for SD cards (

x 1).

2. Remove the VM card [B] from SD slot 2.


3. Turn the SD-card label face [C] of the browser unit to the front of the machine. Then push it slowly into
SD slot 2 until you hear a click.
4. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
5. Push the "User Tools" key.
If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, step 5 and 6 are required. Otherwise,
skip to the step 7
6. Push the "Login/ Logout" key.
7. Login with the administrator user name and password.
8. Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
9. Touch "Install" on the LCD.
10. Touch "SD Card".
11. Touch the "Browser" line.
12. Under "Install to" touch "Machine HDD" and touch "Next".
13. When you see "Ready to Install", check the information on the screen to confirm your previous
selection.
14. Touch "OK". You will see "Installing the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed".
15. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen.

152

Controller Options

16. Touch "Change Allocation".


17. Touch the "Browser" line.
18. Press one of the hard keys, which you want to use for the Browser Unit. In default, this function is
assigned to the "Other Functions" key (bottom key of function keys).
19. Touch "OK".
20. Touch "Exit" twice to go back to the copy screen.
21. Turn off the main power switch.

22. Install the key for "Browser Unit" to the place, where you want.
23. Remove the SD card of the browser unit from SD slot 2.
24. Reinstall the VM card in SD slot 2.
25. Attach the slot cover [A] (

x 1).

26. Keep the SD card in the place ( p.139 "SD Card Appli Move") after you install the application
program from the card to HDD. This is because: The SD card can be the only proof that the user is
licensed to use the application program. You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a
problem in the future.

Gigabit Ethernet Type B

Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.

153

2. Installation

1. Remove the controller cover [A] (

x 3).

2. Pull out the controller board [B] (

x 5).

3. Remove the slot cover [A] (

x 1).

4. Attach the Gigabit Ethernet controller [A] into the slot [B] (

x 2).

5. Reassemble the machine.


6. Check the operation of the Gigabit Ethernet

Check All Connections


1. Plug in the power cord. Then turn on the main switch.
2. Enter the printer user mode. Then print the configuration page.
User Tools > Printer Settings > List Test Print > Config. Page
All installed options are shown in the "System Reference" column.

154

3. Preventive Maintenance
Maintenance Tables
See "Appendices" for the following information:
Preventive Maintenance Items
Other Yield Parts

155

3. Preventive Maintenance

PM Parts Settings
Before Removing the Old PM Parts
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Output the SMC logging data with SP5-990-004.

3. Set the following SPs to "1" before you turn the power off. Then, the machine will reset the PM counters
automatically. In the case of developer, the developer initialization will also be done automatically.
4. Exit the SP mode.
Item

SP
Black: 3902-005

Developer

Yellow: 3902-006
Cyan: 3902-007
Magenta: 3902-008
Black: 3902-009

Drum Unit

Yellow: 3902-010
Cyan: 3902-011
Magenta: 3902-012

Heating Roller and Pressure Roller (not necessary Heating roller: 3902-018
for complete fusing units; see below)
Pressure roller: 3902-019
Image Transfer Belt Cleaning Unit

3902-015

PTR Unit

3902-016

Toner Collection Bottle (if not full or near-full)

3902-017

For the following units, there is a new unit detection mechanism. It is not necessary to reset PM counters.
PCDU
Development unit
Toner Collection Bottle (if full or near-full)
Fusing unit

156

PM Parts Settings

After installing the new PM parts


1. Turn on the main power switch.
2. Output the SMC logging data with SP5-990-004 and check the counter values.
3. Make sure that the PM counters for the replaced units are "0" with SP7-803. If the PM counter for a
unit was not reset, then reset that counter with SP 7-804.
4. Make sure that the exchange counter counts up with SP7-853.
5. Make sure that the counters for the previous units (SP7-906) on the new SMC logging data list (from
step 2 above) are equal to the counters (SP7-803) for these units on the previous SMC logging data
list (the list that was output in the "Before removing the old parts" section).

6. Make sure that the unit replacement date is updated with SP7-950.

Preparation before operation check


1. Clean the exposure glasses (for DF and book scanning).
2. Enter the user tools mode.
3. Do the "Automatic Color Calibration(ACC)" for the copier mode & printer mode as follows:
Print the ACC test pattern (User Tools > Maintenance > ACC > Start).
Put the printout on the exposure glass.
Put 10 sheets of white paper on the test chart. This ensures the precise ACC adjustment.
Close the ARDF or the platen cover.
Press "Start Scanning" on the LCD. Then, the machine starts the ACC.
4. Exit the User Tools mode, and then enter the SP mode.
5. Do the "Forced line position adjustment" as follows.
First do SP2-111-3 (Mode c).
Then do SP2-111-1 (Mode a).
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is
displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
6. Exit the SP mode.

Operation check
Check if the sample image has been copied normally.

157

3. Preventive Maintenance

158

4. Replacement and Adjustment


Beforehand
Before installing options, please do the following:
If there is a fax unit in the machine, print out all messages stored in the memory, the lists of userprogrammed items, and the system parameter list.
If there are printer jobs in the machine, print out all jobs in the printer buffer.
Turn off the main switch and disconnect the power cord, the telephone line, and the network cable.

Always touch a grounded surface to discharge static electricity from your hands before you handle
SD cards, printed circuit boards, or memory boards.

159

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Special Tools
Part Number

Description

Q'ty

B645 5010

SD Card

B645 6705

PCMCIA Card Adapter

B645 6820

USB Reader/Writer

VSSM9000

Digital Multimeter FLUKE87

G021 9350

Loop-back Connector Parallel *NOTE

C401 9503

20X Magnification Scope

A257 9300

Grease Barrierta S552R

5203 9502

Silicone Grease G-501

A092 9503

C4 Color Test Chart (3 pcs/set)

A184 9501

Optics Adjustment Tool (2 pcs / set)

B679 5100

Plug - IEEE1284 Type A

B132 9700

Lubricant Powder

The "Loop-back ConnectorParallel" requires the "Plug-IEEE1284 Type A", and the optional
IEEE1284 interface option must also be installed.

160

Image Adjustment

Image Adjustment
Scanning
Check the printing registration/side-to-side adjustment and the blank margin adjustment before you do
the following scanner adjustments.
Use S-2-1 test chart to do the following adjustments.

Scanner sub-scan magnification

A: Sub-scan magnification
1. Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2. Check the magnification ratio. Adjust with SP4-008 if necessary.
Standard: 1.0%.

161

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Scanner leading edge and side-to-side registration

4
A: Leading Edge Registration
1. Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2. Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration. Adjust the following SP modes if necessary.
Standard: 0 2mm for the leading edge registration, 0 2.5mm for the side-to-side registration.
SP mode
Leading Edge Registration

SP4-010-001

Side-to-Side Registration

SP4-011-001

ARDF
ARDF side-to-side, leading edge registration and trailing edge

162

Image Adjustment

A: Leading edge registration


Use A3/DLT paper to make a temporary test chart as shown above.
1. Put the temporary test chart on the ARDF. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2. Check the registration. Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration. Adjust the following SP
modes if necessary.
Standard: 4.2 2 mm for the leading edge registration, 2 1 mm for the side-to-side registration.
Use the following SP modes to adjust if necessary.
SP Code

What It Does

Adjustment Range

SP6-006-001

Side-to-Side Regist: Front

3.0 mm

SP6-006-003

Leading Edge Registration

5.0 mm

SP6-006-005

Buckle: Duplex Front

3.0 mm

SP6-006-006

Buckle: Duplex Rear

2.5 mm

SP6-006-007

Rear Edge Erase (Trailing Edge)

10.0 mm

ARDF sub-scan magnification


1. Put the temporary test chart on the ARDF. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2. Check the magnification ratio. Adjust with SP6-017-001 if necessary.
Standard: 5.0%
Reduction mode: 1.0%
Enlargement mode: 1.0%

163

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Registration
Image Area

A = C = 5.2 mm (0.2"), B = 2.0 mm


Make sure that the registration is adjusted within the adjustment standard range as shown below.

Leading Edge
Adjusts the leading edge registration for each paper type and process line speed.

Side to Side
Adjusts the side-to-side registration for each paper feed station. Use SP mode (SP1-002) to adjust the sideto-side registration for the optional paper feed unit, LCT, and duplex unit.

Adjustment Standard
Leading edge (sub-scan direction): 5.2 2 mm
Side to side (main-scan direction): 2 1 mm

Paper Registration Standard


The registration in both main- and sub-scan directions can change within the following tolerance.
Sub-scan direction: 0 9 mm
Main-scan direction: 0 4 mm

164

Image Adjustment

Adjustment Procedure
1. Enter SP2-109-003.
2. Print out the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern) with SP2-109-003.
Registration can change slightly as shown on the previous page. Print some pages of the 1-dot
trimming pattern for step 3 and 4. Then average the leading edge and side-to-side registration
values, and adjust each SP mode.
3. Do the leading edge registration adjustment.
1) Check the leading edge registration and adjust it with SP1-001.
2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper type and process line speed).
3) Input the value. Then press the

key.

4) Generate a trim pattern to check the leading edge adjustment.


4. Do the side-to-side registration adjustment.
1) Check the side-to-side registration and adjust it with SP1-002.
2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper feed station).
3) Input the value. Then press the

key.

4) Generate a trim pattern to check the leading edge adjustment.

Erase Margin Adjustment

Adjust the erase margin C and D only if the registration (main scan and sub scan) cannot be adjusted
within the standard values. Do the registration adjustment after adjusting the erase margin C and D,
and then adjust the erase margin A and B.

165

4. Replacement and Adjustment

1. Enter SP2-109-003.
2. Print out the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern) with SP2-109-003.
3. Check the erase margin A and B. Adjust them with SP2-103-001 to -015 if necessary.
Leading edge: 0.0 to 9.0 mm (default: 4.2 mm)
Side-to-side: 0.0 to 9.0 mm (default: 2.0 mm)
Trailing edge: 0.0 to 9.0 mm (default: 4.2 mm)

Color Registration
Line Position Adjustment
The automatic line position adjustment usually is done for a specified condition to get the best color prints.
Do the following if color registration shifts:
Do "Auto Color Registration" as follows to do the forced line position adjustment.
1. First do SP2-111-3.
2. Then do SP2-111-1.
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed
at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
You should also do the line position adjustment at these times:

166

Image Adjustment

After you transport or move the machine (you should do the forced line position adjustment if
you install the machine at the user location.) if the machine is pre-installed at the workshop and
moved to the user location,
When you open the drum positioning plate
When you remove or replace the motors, clutches, and/or gears related to the drum/
development/transfer sections
When you remove or replace the image transfer belt, image transfer belt unit or laser optical
housing unit

Printer Gamma Correction

4
The ACC is usually sufficient to adjust the color balance to get the best print output. You only need
the printer gamma correction to fine-tune to meet user requirements.
Use SP modes if you want to modify the printer gamma curve created with ACC. You can adjust the gamma
data for the following:
Highlight
Middle
Shadow areas
IDmax.
The adjustable range is from 0 to 30 (31 steps).

Copy Mode
- KCMY Color Balance Adjustment The adjustment uses only "Offset" values.
Never change "Option" values (default value is 0).
Highlight (Low ID)

Levels 2 through 5 in the C4 chart 10-level scale

Middle (Middle ID)

Levels 3 through 7 in the C4 chart 10-level scale

Shadow (High ID)

Levels 6 through 9 in the C4 chart 10-level scale

ID max

Level 10 in the C4 chart 10-level scale (affects the entire image density.)

Offset

The higher the number in the range associated with the low ID, middle ID,
high ID, and ID max, the greater the density.
167

4. Replacement and Adjustment

There are four adjustable modes (can be adjusted with SP4-918-009):


Copy Photo mode
Copy Letter mode
Copy Letter (Single Color) mode
Copy Photo (Single Color) mode

- Adjustment Procedure 1. Copy the C-4 chart in the mode that you want to adjust.
2. Enter the SP mode.
3. Select "System SP."
4. Select SP4-918-009.
5. Adjust the offset values until the copy quality conforms to the standard (see the table below).
1. Never change "Option" value (default value is "0").
2. Adjust the density in this order: "ID Max", "Middle", "Shadow", "Highlight".
- Photo Mode, Full Color Item to Adjust
1

168

ID max:
(K, C, M, and Y)

Level on the C-4 chart

Adjustment Standard
Adjust the offset value so that the
density of level 10 matches that
of level 10 on the C-4 chart.

Image Adjustment

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 6 matches that of
level 6 on the C-4 chart.

Middle (Middle ID)


(K, C, M, and Y)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 8 matches that of
level 8 on the C-4 chart.

Shadow (High ID)


(K, C, M, and Y)

Adjust the offset value so that dirty


background does not show on
the copy and the density of level
3 is slightly lighter than that of
level 3 on the C-4 chart.

Highlight (Low ID)


(K, C, M, and Y)

Adjust the offset value so that the


color balance of black scale
levels 3 through 5 in the copy is
seen as gray (no C, M, or Y
should be visible). If the black
scale contains C, M, or Y, do
steps 1 to 4 again.

K Highlight (Low ID)


(C,M, and Y)
<on the full color copy>

- Photo Mode, Single Color Item to Adjust

Level on the C-4 chart

Adjustment Standard

ID max: (K)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 10 matches that
of level 10 on the C-4 chart.

Middle (Middle ID) (K)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 6 matches that of
level 6 on the C-4 chart.

Shadow (High ID) (K)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 8 matches that of
level 8 on the C-4 chart.

Highlight (Low ID) (K)

Adjust the offset value so that dirty


background does not show on
the copy and the density of level
3 is slightly lighter than that of
level 3 on the C-4 chart.

- Text (Letter) Mode, Full Color 169

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Item to Adjust
1

4
4

Level on the C-4 chart (K)

Adjustment Standard
Adjust the offset value so that the
density of level 10 matches that
of level 10 on the C-4 chart.

ID max: (K, C, M, and


Y)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 6 matches that of
level 6 on the C-4 chart.

Middle (Middle ID)


(K, C, M, and Y)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 8 matches that of
level 8 on the C-4 chart.

Shadow (High ID)


(K, C, M, and Y)

Adjust the offset value so that dirty


background does not show on
the copy and the density of level
3 is slightly lighter than that of
level 3 on the C-4 chart.

Highlight (Low ID)


(K, C, M, and Y)

- Text (Letter) Mode, Single Color Item to Adjust

Adjustment Standard

ID max: (K)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 10 matches that
of level 10 on the C-4 chart.

Middle (Middle ID) (K)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 6 matches that of
level 6 on the C-4 chart.

Shadow (High ID) (K)

Adjust the offset value so that the


density of level 8 matches that of
level 8 on the C-4 chart.

Highlight (Low ID) (K)

Adjust the offset value so that dirty


background does not show on
the copy and the density of level
3 is slightly lighter than that of
level 3 on the C-4 chart.

170

Level on the C-4 chart (K)

Image Adjustment

Text parts of the test pattern cannot be printed clearly after you adjust "shadow" as shown above. At
this time, check if the 5 line/mm pattern at each corner is printed clearly. If it is not, adjust the offset
value of "shadow" again until it is.

Printer Mode
There are six adjustable modes (select these modes with printer SP1-102-001):
1200 x 1200 photo mode
1200 x 1200 text mode
2400 x 600 photo mode

2400 x 600 text mode


1800 x 600 photo mode
1800 x 600 text mode
600 x 600 photo mode
600 x 600 text mode
K
Highlight
Shadow
Middle
IDmax

SP1-104-1

SP1-104-21

SP1-104-41

SP1-104-61

SP1-104-2

SP1-104-22

SP1-104-42

SP1-104-62

SP1-104-3

SP1-104-23

SP1-104-43

SP1-104-63

SP1-104-4

SP1-104-24

SP1-104-44

SP1-104-64

- Adjustment Procedure 1. Do ACC for the printer mode.


2. Turn the main power off and on.
3. Enter SP mode.
4. Select "Printer SP".
5. Select SP1-102-001. Then select the necessary print mode to adjust.
6. Choose SP1-103-1 to print out a tone control test sheet if you want to examine the image quality for
these settings.
7. Adjust the color density with SP1-104. Compare the tone control test sheet with the C4 test chart.
Adjust the density in this order: "ID Max", "Shadow", "Middle", "Highlight".
8. Use SP1-105-001 to keep the adjusted settings.
171

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Exterior Covers
Front Door

1. Open the front door [A].

2. Remove the two pins [B], and then remove the front cover.

172

Exterior Covers

Controller Cover

1. Controller cover [A] (

x 3)

Left Cover
1. Controller cover (

2. Left cover [A] (

p.173)

x 6)

173

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Rear Cover

1. Rear cover [A] (

x 8)

Right Rear Cover


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Scanner right cover (


3. Right top cover (

174

p.177 "Ozone Filter and Dust Filter")

p.177 "Ozone Filter and Dust Filter")

Exterior Covers

4. Open the right door [A].


5. Right rear cover [B] (

x 3)

Operation Panel

175

4. Replacement and Adjustment

1. Top left front cover [A] (

x 2)

2. Open the right door.


3. Front right cover [B] (

x 1)

4. Clip table cover [C] (

x 1)

5. Top front cover [D] (

x 3)

6. Operation panel [A] (

x 2,

x 1,

x 1)

Paper Exit Cover


1. Front right cover (

p.175 "Operation Panel")

2. Paper exit cover [A] (

x 1)

Inner Tray
1. Image transfer belt unit (
176

p.221)

Exterior Covers

2. Paper exit cover (


3. Left cover (

p.176)

p.173)

4. Toner cartridge cover [A] (

x 2)

5. Inner tray [B]

Ozone Filter and Dust Filter


Ozone filters for the scanner unit

1. Scanner right cover [A] (

x 2)

Loosen the top-right screw of the rear cover.


2. Right top cover [B] (

x 1)

177

4. Replacement and Adjustment

3. Ozone filters [A] in the right top cover.

Ozone filter and dust filter for the IH inverter

1. IH inverter fan cover [A] (hook)

178

Exterior Covers

2. Dust filter [A]


3. Ozone filter [B]

179

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Scanner Unit
Exposure Glass

1. Glass cover [A] (

x 4)

2. ARDF exposure glass [B]


3. Rear scale [C] (

x 3)

4. Exposure glass with left scale [D]


Position the white marker [E] at the rear-left corner and the black or blue marker at the front-left
corner when you reattach the ARDF exposure glass.

Original Length Sensors


1. Exposure glass with left scale (

180

p.180)

Scanner Unit

2. Original length sensor bracket [A] (

x 1,

x1,

x 2)

3. Original length sensors [A] (hooks)

Exposure Lamp
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Operation panel (
3. Exposure glass (

p.175)
p.180)

181

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4. Scanner rear cover [A] (


5. Scanner left cover [B] (

x 1)
x 2)

6. Scanner right cover [C] (

x 2)

7. Disconnect the connector [A] from the lamp stabilizer [B].


8. SIO [C] (

182

x 4,

x All)

Scanner Unit

9. Release three clamps.

4
10. Release the clamp [A] (

x 1).

11. Remove the pulley [B].


12. Hold down the snap [C], and then slide the exposure lamp [D] to the front side.
13. Exposure lamp [D]

Reassembling

Run the cable so there is no slack. Slide the clamp [A] to adjust the cable slack.

183

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Scanner Motor

4
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Scanner motor assembly [A] (


3. Scanner motor [B] (

x 2,

x 2, spring x 1)
x 1,)

Sensor Board Unit (SBU)

1. Exposure glass (

p.180)

2. Original length sensor bracket (


3. SBU cover bracket [A] (

184

x 9)

p.180 "Original Length Sensors")

Scanner Unit

4. Sensor board unit [A] (

x 4, Grand screw x 1,

x 2,

x 2)

When reassembling
Adjust the following SP modes after you replace the sensor board unit:
SP4008 (Sub Scan Mag): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4010 (Sub Mag Reg.): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4011 (Main Scan Reg): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4688 (DF: Density Adjustment): Use this to adjust the density level if the ID of outputs made in the
DF and Platen mode is different.

Exposure Lamp Stabilizer


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

185

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4
2. Exposure lamp stabilizer [A] (

x 2,

x 2)

SIO (Scanner In/Out) Board


1. Rear cover (

2. SIO [A] (

p.174)

x 4,

x All)

Scanner HP Sensor
1. Scanner left cover and scanner rear cover (
2. Exposure glass (
186

p.180)

p.181 "Exposure Lamp")

Scanner Unit

3. Move the 1st scanner carriage [A] to the right side.

4. Remove the mylar [A]


5. Remove the scanner HP sensor [B] (

x 1, three snaps)

Platen Cover Sensor


1. Scanner left cover and scanner rear cover (

p.181 "Exposure Lamp")

187

4. Replacement and Adjustment

2. Platen cover sensor [A] (

x 1,

Front Scanner Wire


1. Exposure glass (

p.180)

2. Scanner left stay [A] (


3. Front frame [B] (

188

x 5)

x 3)

x 1)

Scanner Unit

4
4. Front scanner wire clamp [A]
5. Front scanner wire bracket [B] (

x 1)

6. Front scanner wire and scanner drive pulley [C] (

x 1)

Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire

1. Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.
2. Pass the right end (with the ball) [B] through the square hole. Pass the left end (with the ring) [C] through
the notch.

189

4. Replacement and Adjustment

3. Wind the right end counterclockwise (shown from the machines front) five times. Wind the left end
clockwise twice.
The two red marks [D] come together when you have done this. Stick the wire to the pulley with
tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation.

4. Install the drive pulley on the shaft [A].


Do not attach the pulley to the shaft with the screw at this time.
5. Insert the left end into the slit [B]. The end should go via the rear track of the left pulley [C] and the
rear track of the movable pulley [D].

190

Scanner Unit

4
6. Hook the right end onto the front scanner wire bracket [A]. The end should go via the front track of
the right pulley [B] and the front track of the movable pulley [C].
Do not attach the scanner wire bracket with the screw at this time.

7. Remove the tape from the drive pulley.


8. Insert a scanner-positioning pin [A] through the 2nd carriage hole [B] and the left holes [C] in the front
rail. Insert another scanner positioning pin [D] through the 1st carriage hole [E] and the right holes in
the front rail [F].
191

4. Replacement and Adjustment

9. Insert two more scanner positioning pins through the holes in the rear rail.
10. Screw the drive pulley to the shaft [G].
11. Screw the scanner wire bracket to the front rail [H].
12. Install the scanner wire clamp [I].
13. Pull out the positioning pins.
Make sure the 1st and 2nd carriages move smoothly after you remove the positioning pins. Do
steps 8 through 13 again if they do not.

Rear Scanner Wire


1. Exposure glass (
2. Scanner left stay (

p.180)
p.188 "Front Scanner Wire")

3. Scanner rear frame [A] (

x 9, ground screw x 2,

x All)

4. Follow the steps 3 through 5 in the Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire Section. You can remove
the rear scanner wire with the same manner for replacing the front scanner wire.

192

Scanner Unit

Reinstalling the Rear Scanner Wire

4
1. Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.
2. Pass the left end (with the ball) [B] through the drive pulley notch. Pass the right end (with the ring) [C]
through the drive pulley hole.
3. Wind the left end [B] clockwise (shown from the machines front) five times. Wind the right end [C]
counterclockwise three times.
The two red marks [D] come together when you do this. Attach the wire to the pulley with tape.
This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation.
4. Install the drive pulley on the shaft.
Do not attach the pulley on the shaft with the screw at this time.
5. Install the wire.
The winding of the wire on the three pulleys at the rear of the scanner should be the same as the
winding on the three pulleys at the front. This must show as a mirror image.
Example: At the front of the machine, the side of the drive pulley with the three windings must face the
front of the machine. At the rear of the machine, it must face the rear.
6. Do steps 7 through 13 again in the Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire Section.

Touch Panel Position Adjustment

It is necessary to calibrate touch panel at the following times:


193

4. Replacement and Adjustment

When you replace the operation panel.


When you replace the controller board.
When the touch panel detection function does not operate correctly
Do not use items [2] to [9] on the Self-Diagnostic Menu. These items are for design use only.
1. Press

, press "1", "9", "9", "3", then press

5 times to open the Self-Diagnostics menu.

4
2. On the touch screen press Touch Screen Adjust (or press "1").
3. Use a pointed (not sharp) tool to press the upper left mark "

4. Press the lower right mark when "

".

" shows.

5. Press [#] OK on the screen (or press

) when you are finished.

6. Touch [#] Exit on the screen to close the Self-Diagnostic menu. Save the calibration settings.

194

Laser Optics

Laser Optics
Turn off the main switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.
Laser beams can cause serious eye injury.

Caution Decal Location


Caution decals are placed as shown below.

Be sure to turn off the main switch and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet before
beginning any disassembly or adjustment of the laser unit. This copier uses a class IIIb laser beam
with a wavelength of 655 nm and an output of 7 mW. The laser can cause serious eye injury.

195

4. Replacement and Adjustment

LD Safety Switch

A relay on the PSU ensures technician and user safety. It also prevents the laser beam from turning on
during servicing. This relay turns off when the front cover, upper left cover, or right door is opened. At this
time it cuts the power (+5V) supplied to the LD board for each color through the BICU.
Two safety switches are turned on or off by the front door or right door, and this opens the relay.
LD Driver: Precise Pulse Modulation ASIC on C-MOS technology
LDB: LD Drive Board (included in the LD Unit)

Error Messages
Along with other switches, the LD safety switches help show error messages related to external covers.
When one or more covers are open, the messages, "Cover is open." and "Close the indicated cover," show
with a diagram. The diagram shows which cover is open.

Laser Optics Housing Unit

Before installing a new laser optics housing unit, remove the sponge padding and the tag from the
new unit.

196

Laser Optics

A new laser optics housing unit has a bracket to protect the LD units. When you install the new unit,
do not remove the bracket until near the end of the installation procedure (the correct time is stated
in the manual).
This bracket protects a capacitor on the unit. If the bracket is removed too early, you could break the
capacitor on the corner of the main frame when you install the new unit.

Preparing the new laser optics housing unit

1. Polygon motor cover [A] of the laser optics housing unit (

x 4)

2. Sponge padding [B]


3. Tag [C]
4. Reinstall the polygon motor cover [A].

Before removing the old laser optics housing unit


Do the following settings before removing the laser optics housing unit. These are adjustments for skew
adjustment motors in the laser optics housing unit.
1. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the copier.
2. Enter the SP mode.
3. Execute SP2220-001 to clear the L2 lens positioning motor setting for Magenta.
4. Execute SP2220-002 to clear the L2 lens positioning motor setting for Cyan.
5. Execute SP2220-003 to clear the L2 lens positioning motor setting for Yellow.
6. Exit the SP mode.
197

4. Replacement and Adjustment

7. Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord of the copier.

Recovery procedure for no replacement preparation of laser optics housing unit


If you did not do the procedure in Before removing the old laser optics housing before removing the old
laser optics housing unit, you must do the following.
1. Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord of the copier.
2. Remove the left cover and harness cover bracket (see the following "Removing the old laser optics
housing unit")

3. Disconnect the harness [A] of the skew correction motor.


4. Do steps 1 to 7 of "Before removing the old laser optics housing unit".
5. Connect the harness [A] and reinstall the harness bracket and left cover.
6. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

198

Laser Optics

Removing the old laser optics housing unit

1. Controller cover [A] (


2. Left cover [B] (

x 3)

x 6)

3. Airflow fan bracket [A] for the laser housing optics unit (

x 4,

x 2)

199

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4. Remove the old laser optics housing unit [A] (

x 2, All

's,

x 3)

Installing a new Laser Optics Housing Unit

A new laser optics housing unit has a bracket to protect the LD units. When you install the new unit,
do not remove the bracket until near the end of the installation procedure (the correct time is stated
in the manual).
This bracket protects a capacitor on the unit. If the bracket is removed too early, you could break the
capacitor on the corner of the main frame when you install the new unit.

1. Push the new laser optics housing unit [A] slowly into the copier until the bracket [B] bumps against
the frame of the copier.
2. Remove the bracket [B], and then push the new laser optics housing unit fully into the copier (
All
's, x 3).
3. Reassemble the machine.

200

x 2,

Laser Optics

After installing the new laser optics housing unit


Do the following adjustment after installing the new laser optics housing unit.
1. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.

2. Adjust the main scan magnification for K, M, C, Y.


Input the standard values [C] provided with a new laser optics housing unit for the main scan
magnification adjustment with SP2-102-013, 014, 015, 016.
The values [C] are different for each laser optics housing unit.
3. Adjust the main scan magnification only for black (K).
Input the standard value [A] provided with a new laser optics housing unit for the main scan
magnification adjustment with SP2-185-001.
The value [A] is different for each laser optics housing unit.
Print the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern in the SP2-109-003).
Check that the left and right trim margin is within 4 1 mm. If not, change the standard value for
the main scan magnification adjustment.
4. Adjust the main scan registration only for black (K).
Input the registration value [B] provided with a new laser optics housing unit for the main scan
registration adjustment with SP2101-001.
The value [B] is different for each laser optics housing unit.
201

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Print the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern in the SP2-109-003).
Check that the left trim margin is within 2 1 mm. If not, change the registration value for the
main scan registration adjustment.
5. Select "0" with SP2-109-003 after printing the "1-dot trimming pattern.
6. Do the line position adjustment.
First do SP2-111-3.
Then do SP2-111-1.
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is
displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.

7. Exit the SP mode.


After you replace the housing unit, do the adjustments in the following section of the manual: Image
Adjustment Registration.

Polygon Mirror Motor and Drive Board

1. Laser optics housing unit [A] (

202

p.196)

Laser Optics

2. Polygon mirror motor cover [A] of the laser optics housing unit (

3. Polygon mirror motor holder [A] (


4. Polygon mirror motor [B] (

x 4,

x 4)

x 2)
x 1)

After installing the polygon mirror motor:


1) Do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode c" (SP2-111-3).
2) Then do the "Forced Line Position Adj. Mode a" (SP2-111-1).
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed at
the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
After you replace the motor, do the adjustments in the following section of the manual: Image Adjustment
Registration.

Airflow Fans
1. Controller cover (

p.173)

203

4. Replacement and Adjustment

2. Left cover (

p.173)

4
3. Airflow fan bracket [A] for the laser housing optics unit (

4. Airflow fans [A]


There are two airflow fans on the baracket.

204

x 4,

x 2)

Image Creation

Image Creation
PCDU

Do not touch the OPC drum. Do not let metal objects touch the development sleeve.
1. Open the front door.

2. Lever lock [A] (

x 1)

3. Turn the drum positioning plate lever [B] and the image transfer unit lock lever [C] counter-clockwise.
4. Open the drum positioning plate [D].

5. Pull out the PCDU (hold the grip while you pull it out).

205

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Drum Unit and Development Unit


The new drum unit has a front cover and a front joint. When you attach the new drum unit to the development
unit, remove a front cover and a front joint at first.
And use them for reassembling the new drum unit and development unit.
1. If you install a new drum unit, set SP 3902-xxx to "1".
Black: 3902-009
Yellow: 3902-010
Cyan: 3902-011

Magenta: 3902-012
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the drum unit automatically, after
you turn the power on again.
2. Turn the machine power off.
3. PCDU (

p.205)

4. Front cover [A] (

206

x 2)

Image Creation

4
Do not touch the bearing [A] after removing the front cover. The bearing is properly applied with
lubricant.

5. Remove the bushing [A] of the development roller at the rear of the PCDU (

x 1).

Do not put too much weight on the PCDU. Otherwise, the plastic frame [B] of the development
unit may be damaged.

207

4. Replacement and Adjustment

6. Remove the front joint [A] (

x 2,

x 1).

The front joint [A] is firmly set. Remove it with a flat screwdriver.

7. Drum unit [A] and Development Unit [B]


When the development unit is removed from the drum unit, clean the entrance mylar [C] with a
vacuum.

208

Image Creation

8. Rotate the development roller [A] five or six times in the counterclockwise direction.

This step removes developer that has stuck to the development roller, which would cause color
unevenness.
9. If you change the development unit, do the ACC procedure.
10. Execute the drum phase adjustment with SP1902-001 twice.
When reassembling the PCDU:

Make sure that the harness [A] is hooked as shown.

Developer
1. Set SP 3902-xxx to "1".
Black: 3902-005
Yellow: 3902-006
Cyan: 3902-007
209

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Magenta: 3902-008
2. Turn the machine power off.
3. Development unit (

p.206)

4
4. Hopper cover [A] (4 hooks)
Release the three hooks first in the correct order (from to ).
Put the head of a screwdriver in the groove gap [B] as shown, and then release the hook
Follow the correct order
breaks easily.

to

. Otherwise, the hopper cover may be damaged. The hook

5. Shake a bag of developer and pour it into the development hopper [A].
6. Reattach the hopper cover (hook x 3).
Keep the developer off at both ends of the development unit enclosed in red lines in the diagram.

210

Image Creation

7. Turn the machine power on. The machine initializes the developer and resets the PM counter for the
developer. (For details of the developer initialization result, see "Developer Initialization Result" in the
"Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions" chapter.
8. Do the ACC procedure.

Toner Collection Bottle


If you will install a new bottle, and the old bottle is not in a full or near-full condition, then set SP 3902-017
to 1.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the bottle automatically, after you turn
the power on again.

If the bottle is in a full or near-full condition, it is not necessary to do this.


1. Turn off the main power switch.

2. Open the front door and remove the screw [A].


3. Close the front door.
4. Pull out tray 1 [B].
5. Open the toner collection bottle door [C].
6. Pull out the toner collection bottle [D].

211

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Second Duct Fan


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (

p.174)

3. Open the controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box")

4. Second duct [A] (

x 2,

x 1,

5. Split the second duct (4 hooks).

212

x 2)

Image Creation

6. Second duct fan [A]

When reinstalling the second duct fan


Make sure that the second duct fan is installed with its decal facing to the front of the machine.

Third Duct Fan


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (

p.174)

3. Open the controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box")

4. Third duct [A] ( x 2, x 1)

213

4. Replacement and Adjustment

5. Third duct fan [A] (3 hooks)

When reinstalling the third duct fan


Make sure that the third duct fan is installed with its decal facing to the upper side of the machine.

Toner Pump Unit


There are four pump units inside the machine. This procedure describes the replacement procedure only
for one unit. If you need to replace another unit, do the same as this procedure.
Put some sheets of paper on the floor before doing this procedure. Toner may fall on the floor.

1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Image transfer belt unit (


3. All PCDUs (

214

p.205)

p.221)

Image Creation

4. Put a sheet of paper (A3/DLT) inside the machine as shown and on the floor.
The sheet of paper on the floor is used in a later step.

4
5. Release the harness [A] from the clamp (
the harness.

x 1 for YCM,

x 2 for K) and hook, and then disconnect

Avoid touching these spring terminals [B].


6. Release the toner supply tube [C].

7. Remove the toner pump unit [A] (

x 2)

215

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Make sure that a sheet of paper is attached to the frame of the rear side. The picture on the left
shows a sheet of paper that is correctly set, but the picture on the right shows a sheet of paper
that is not correctly set. This sheet of paper prevents toner and screws from falling into the laser
optics housing unit through cutouts.

8. Slowly remove the toner supply tube [A] from the toner pump unit by pulling the tube right and left.
9. Turn up the openings of the toner pump unit and toner supply tube just after removing the tube.
If not, the toner may scatter away and fall down.

216

Image Creation

10. Put the toner pump unit on the sheet of paper, which has been put in step 4, with its opening [A] up.

11. Keep the opening [A] of the toner supply tube up, and then clip the opening of the toner supply.

When you install the new toner pump unit


Before installing the new toner pump unit, mask the opening of the old toner pump unit with tape. Dispose
of it following local rules.

217

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4
1. Put a sheet of paper (A3/DLT) inside the machine.
2. Turn up the opening of the toner supply tube, and then remove the object that was used to clip the
opening of the toner supply tube.
3. Insert the opening of the toner pump unit [A] into the opening of the toner supply tube [B] as far as
possible.

4. Connect the harness [A] to the connector of the machine.

218

Image Creation

On the above picture, the magnified picture of the connector shows the easiest way to connect
it.
5. Clamp the harness [A] (

x 1 for YCM,

x 2 for K).

Avoid touching these spring terminals [B].

6. Pass the harness of the toner pump unit behind the hook [A], while pressing at [B].
7. Secure the toner supply tube with the holder [C], lifting up the edge of the holder "very gently".
Be careful when you lift the edge of the holder, because the holder is easily broken.

8. Insert the toner pump unit [A] into the rear frame of the machine (

x 2).

219

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Toner End Sensor

4
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Open the controller box (


3. Toner end sensor [A] (

p.309 "Controller Box")


x 1, 2 hooks each)

A toner end sensor is not installed in the entrance of the toner supply tube for black.

220

Image Transfer

Image Transfer
Image Transfer Belt Unit
1. Open the right door.
2. Open the front door.
3. Open the drum positioning plate. (

p.205 "PCDU")

4. Turn the image transfer belt unit lock lever [A] counterclockwise.
5. Pull out the image transfer belt unit [B] halfway.

221

4. Replacement and Adjustment

6. Grasp the handles [A], and then pull out the image transfer belt unit fully.

Image Transfer Belt Cleaning Unit


1. If you will install a new belt cleaning unit, then set SP 3902-015 to 1.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the belt cleaning unit automatically,
after you turn the power on again.
Do not use SP3902-015 or 013 if you replace the complete ITB unit.

2. Turn off the main power switch.


3. Open the right door.
4. Open the front door.
5. Open the drum positioning plate. (

p.205)

6. Loosen the screw [A].


7. Turn the lock lever [B] clockwise
8. Pull out the image transfer belt cleaning unit [C].

Image Transfer Belt


1. Image transfer belt cleaning unit (
2. Image transfer belt unit (

222

p.221)

p.222)

Image Transfer

3. Turn the image transfer unit contact lever [A] counterclockwise (as seen from the rear).

4. Gear [B] (hook x 1)


5. Turn the gear cover [C] clockwise (as seen from the rear) (

6. Three stays [A] (

x 1).

x 6)

223

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4
7. Guide plate [A] (as seen from the right side of the machine) (

x 2)

8. Remove the two screws and then the rear holder bracket [A] (as seen from the rear).

224

Image Transfer

9. Remove the two screws and then the front holder bracket [A] (as seen from the front).

4
10. Put the front side of the image transfer belt unit on a corner of the table or a box as shown.

11. Pull the tension roller [A] as shown.

225

4. Replacement and Adjustment

12. Image transfer belt [A]

When reinstalling the image transfer belt


Clean all rollers with dry cloth before installing the image transfer belt.

There is a rim [A] at each edge of the transfer belt. The ends of all the rollers ([B] for example) in the
transfer belt unit must be between the two rims.
There are two rims (width [C]: about 5 mm) on the underside of the front and rear edges of the
image transfer belt.

226

Image Transfer

This belt must be installed the correct way around. When you reinstall the image transfer belt unit,
install it with the number [A] on the belt at the rear side of the unit.

Put "Lubricant Powder" (B132 9700) on the surface of the image transfer belt [A], while you turn the
drive gear [B] at a constant speed, as shown. (The straight arrow in the picture shows belt movement
direction.) Lubricant powder prevents the image transfer cleaning blade from turning up.
Do not put the lubricant powder at the right side of the image transfer belt unit (the above picture
is taken from the rear). Otherwise, lubricant powder may damage the encoder sensor.

227

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Paper Transfer
Paper Transfer Roller Unit
If you will install a new paper transfer unit, then set SP 3902-016 to 1.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the paper transfer unit automatically,
after you turn the power on again.
1. Open the right door.

2. Release the white hook.


3. Paper transfer roller unit [A]

Paper Transfer Unit


If you will install a new paper transfer unit, then set SP3-902-016 to 1.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the paper transfer unit automatically,
after you turn the power on again.
1. Turn off the main power switch.

228

Paper Transfer

4
2. Open the duplex door [A].
3. Open the by-pass tray [B]
4. Right door cover [C] (

x 4)

5. Open the right door.

6. Right door inner cover [A] (

x 1)

229

4. Replacement and Adjustment

7. Pivot bracket [A] (

x 1)

8. Paper transfer unit [B] (

x 1, 2 springs)

ID Sensor Board
1. K PCDU (

p.205)

2. Open the right door.


3. Fusing unit (

p.257)

4. Image transfer belt unit (

5. ID sensor unit [A] (

230

x 2,

p.221)

x 2,

x 1)

Paper Transfer

6. ID sensor cover [A] (

x 4)

7. ID sensor board [B] (

x 2)

Cleaning for ID sensors


ID sensors require a cleaning procedure every EM. Do the following steps for ID sensor cleaning.

1. K PCDU (
2. Fusing unit (

p.205)
p.257)

3. Image transfer belt unit (

p.221)

4. Slide the ID sensor shutter [A] to the left side.


5. Clean the ID sensors keeping the ID sensor shutter to the left.

After installing a new ID sensor unit/board


Do the following adjustment after installing a new ID sensor unit/board.

231

4. Replacement and Adjustment

1. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the copier.


2. Enter the SP mode.

3. Input two correction coefficients [A] for the ID sensor with SP3-362-013 and SP3-362-016 on the
barcode sheet provided with the new ID sensor unit/board.
For example, input "1.03" with SP3-362-013.
SP numbers other than SP3-362-013 and -016 are not required for this procedure.
4. Exit the SP mode.

Temperature and Humidity Sensor


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (

p.174)

3. Temperature and humidity sensor [A] (

232

x 1,

x 1)

Drive Unit

Drive Unit

The drawing above shows the drive unit layout.


1. Fusing/paper exit motor
2. Development clutches
3. Image transfer belt contact motor
4. Toner transport motor
5. Drum/Development drive motors
6. Paper feed clutch Tray 1

7. Paper feed clutch Tray 2


8. Paper feed motor
9. Registration motor
10. Paper transfer contact motor
11. ITB drive motor

There are some motors and clutches that are not shown in the above drawing:
Tray lift motor 1 and 2

Junction gate 1 motor

Duplex inverter motor

Shutter motor

Duplex/By-pass Motor

By-pass clutch

233

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Gear Unit
1. All PCU's
2. Image transfer belt unit (
3. Rear cover (

p.221)

p.174)

4. Controller box (

p.309)

5. Toner sump cover [A] (hooks)


6. Third duct (

p.213)

7. Left cover (

p.173)

8. PSU bracket (

p.314 "PSU")

9. Remove the rear stay [A] (

234

x 3).

Drive Unit

10. Remove ten clamps (blue arrows).

11. Release seven clamps and turn each harness aside.

12. Disconnect four connectors (red arrows).

235

4. Replacement and Adjustment

13. Disconnect two connectors (red arrows) and put these harnesses inside the machine.

14. Disconnect each connector (red circles) from the drum/development drive motors (
each).
15. Disconnect each connector (blue circles) from the development clutches (

16. Cover [A] (


236

x 2)

x 1,

x 1 each).

x1

Drive Unit

17. Disconnect eight connectors from the high voltage supply board (

x 8,

x 2).

18. Release four clamps (red circles) and turn the harnesses aside.

19. Disconnect five connectors (red circles) (


20. Toner transport motor [A] (

x 5).

x 3)
237

4. Replacement and Adjustment

21. Pulley [A] (timing belt)

22. Gear unit [A] (

238

x 8)

Drive Unit

When installing the drive unit

4
Make sure that the bushing [A] is fully set in the frame of the gear unit before installing the timing belt and
pulley to the shaft [B].

Adjustment after replacing the gear unit


Do the following procedures after replacing the gear unit.
1. Turn on the main power switch.
2. Enter "System SP" in the SP mode.
3. Do Amplitude Control" with SP1-902-001.
4. Check the result of the Amplitude Control with SP1-902-002.
0: Success, 2: Failure due to no sampling data,
3: Failure due to insufficient number of pattern detections
When the result of this adjustment is "2" or "3":
Check that all the PCUs are correctly set and that the image transfer belt unit is correctly set.
Do "Amplitude Control " again after checking the PCUs and image transfer belt unit.
When the result is still "2" or "3" after checking the PCUs and image transfer belt unit:
Check that the gear unit is installed correctly.
5. Exit the SP mode.

Registration Motor
1. Rear cover (

p.174)
239

4. Replacement and Adjustment

2. Right rear cover (

p.174)

3. Ventilation duct (

p.314 "PSU")

4. Turn the harnesses aside (

x 5)

5. Fusing power supply board fan bracket [A] (


6. Registration motor assembly [B] (
7. Registration motor [C] (

x 2, timing belt)

Paper Feed Motor


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (

p.174)

3. Release the two clamps (


240

x 3,

x 2)

x 2,
x 1)

x 1)

Drive Unit

4. Paper feed motor [A] (

x 1,

x 2, timing belt)

Drum/Development Motors for M, C, and Y


1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

3. Open the controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box").

4. Drum/Development motors (three motors, one each for MCY) [A] (

x 4,

x 1 each)

241

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Drum/Development Motor-K
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. PSU bracket (

p.314 "PSU")

3. Controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box")

4. Third duct [A] (

x 2,

x 1)

5. Drum/Development motor-K [B] (

x 4,

ITB Drive Motor


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Controller box (

242

p.309 "Controller Box")

x 1)

Drive Unit

4
3. ITB drive motor [A] (

x 4,

x 1)

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box")

3. Fusing/paper exit motor [A] (

x 3,

x 1)

Image Transfer Belt Contact Motor


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box")


243

4. Replacement and Adjustment

3. Transfer belt contact motor [A] (

x 2,

x 2)

Duplex Inverter Motor


1. Open the right door.
2. Right door cover (

p.292 "By-pass Bottom Tray")

3. Duplex door [A] (2 hooks)


4. Duplex guide plate [B] (

244

x 3, 2 hooks)

Drive Unit

5. Duplex inverter motor bracket cover [A] (

6. Duplex inverter motor bracket [A] (

7. Gear [A] (

x 3,

x 2,

x 1,

x 2)

x 1)

x 1, belt x 1)

8. Duplex inverter motor [B] (

x 4)

245

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Pressure Roller Contact Motor


1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

3. Open the controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box").

4
4. Disconnect the connector [A] (

x 1).

5. Pressure roller contact motor [A] (

x 4)

Duplex/By-pass Motor
1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

3. Open the controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box").

4. Pressure roller contact motor (

246

p.246)

Drive Unit

5. Disconnect the connector [A] (

x 1,

6. Duplex/by-pass motor bracket [A] (

x 1)

x 2)

247

4. Replacement and Adjustment

7. Duplex/by-pass motor [A] (

x 4, belt x 1)

Paper Transfer Contact Motor


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. PSU bracket (

p.314 "PSU")

3. Open the controller box (

4. Stay [A] (

p.309 "Controller Box").

x 4)

5. Pressure roller contact motor (


6. Duplex/by-pass motor bracket (

248

p.246)
p.246)

Drive Unit

7. Disconnect the connector [A] (

x 1)

8. Paper transfer contact motor [A] (

x 2)

NOTE:
The picture below shows how to use the screwdriver to remove the screws of the paper transfer
contact motor.

249

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Toner Transport Motor


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Open the controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box").

3. Toner transport motor [A] (

Toner Collection Unit


1. Gear Unit (

250

p.234)

x 3,

x 1)

Drive Unit

2. Toner collection unit [A] (

x 6,

x 1)

Paper Feed Clutches


1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

3. Release five clamps, and then turn the harness [A] aside.

251

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4. Paper feed clutch 1 bracket [A] (

x 2,

x 1,

x 1,

x 2,

x 1,

x 1)

5. Paper feed clutch 1 [A]

6. Paper feed clutch 2 bracket [A] (

252

x 1)

Drive Unit

7. Paper feed clutch 2 [A]

Development Clutch-Y
1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

3. Open the controller box. (

p.309 "Controller Box").

4. Drum/development motor-Y (

p.241)

5. Disconnect the connector [A] (

x 1).

253

4. Replacement and Adjustment

6. Remove the pulley and bushing [A].

7. Turn the development clutch unit [A] counter-clockwise and then pull it out (
8. Development clutch-Y [B] (

x 1)

Development Clutches for M and C


1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

3. Open the controller box. (

p.309 "Controller Box").

4. Drum/development motors for M and C (

p.241)

5. Disconnect the connector for each development clutch (

254

x 1).

x 1).

Drive Unit

4
6. Turn the development clutch unit [A] counter-clockwise and then pull it out (
7. Development clutches for M and C [B] (

x 1).

x 1)

Development Clutch-K
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. PSU bracket (
3. Controller box (

p.314 "PSU")
p.309 "Controller Box")

4. Drum/development motor-K (

p.242)

5. Turn the development clutch unit [A] counter-clockwise and then pull it out (

x 1).

255

4. Replacement and Adjustment

256

6. Development clutch-K [A] (

x 1)

Fusing

Fusing
Fusing Unit Maintenance Parts
In the fusing unit, there are some maintenance parts. However, these parts are defined as EM parts. Refer
to the following list to check the maintenance parts.
Maintenance Parts

Replacement Procedure

Heating Roller

p.260

-Bearing

p.260

Pressure Roller

p.268

-Bearing

p.268

Fusing Unit

Turn off the main switch and wait until the fusing unit cools down before beginning any of the
procedures in this section. The fusing unit can cause serious burns.
1. If you will replace the heating roller or pressure roller in the fusing unit (at PM for example), then reset
each counter.
Set SP 3902-018 to "1" for the heating roller replacement.
Set SP 3902-019 to "1" for the pressure roller replacement.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the heating roller or pressure roller
automatically, after you turn the power on again.
It is not necessary to clear the PM counter for the fusing unit with SP mode when you replace the
fusing unit. This is because the fusing unit has a new unit detection mechanism.
2. Turn off the main power switch.
3. Open the right door.

257

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4. Front fusing stopper [A] (

x 1)

5. Rear fusing stopper [B] (

x 1)

6. Release the lock levers [A].


7. Hold the fusing unit handles [B], and then pull out the fusing unit.

Fusing Entrance Guide Plate


1. Fusing unit (

258

p.257)

Fusing

2. Fusing entrance guide plate [A] (

x 2)

Cleaning Requirement

The fusing entrance guide plate requires cleaning maintenance every fusing unit maintenance interval.
Clean the fusing entrance guide plate at the place shown above with a dry cloth, and then clean the fusing
entrance guide plate again with a cloth moistened with alcohol.

Fusing Exit Guide Plate Cleaning Procedure


The fusing exit guide plate requires cleaning maintenance every fusing unit maintenance interval.
1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

259

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4
2. Open the exit guide plate [A].
3. Clean the exit guide plate with a dry cloth, and then clean the exit guide plate again with a cloth
moistened with alcohol at the points shown above.

Heating Roller and Heating Roller Bearing


1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

2. Open the jam removal door [A].

260

Fusing

3. Front fusing cover [B] (

x 2; Stepped screws)

4. Rear fusing cover [C] (

x 2; Stepped screws)

4
5. Fusing right cover [A] (

x 2; Stepped screws)

6. Pressure roller contact shaft actuator [A] and pressure roller contact shaft gear [B] (

x 1,

x 1)

7. Turn both pressure levers [A] [B], and pull out pins [C] [D].
261

4. Replacement and Adjustment

If the pins [C] [D] are not pulled out in this step, the fusing unit frames may become bent.

262

8. Front bracket [A] (

x 4)

9. Rear bracket [A] (

x 4)

Fusing

4
10. Top stay [A] (

x 4)

11. Heating roller bearing [A] at the front side (C-ring x 1)

12. Fusing drive gear [A]


263

4. Replacement and Adjustment

13. Heating roller gear [A] (C-ring x 1)

4
14. Heating roller bearing [A] at the rear side

15. Keep the heating roller stripper plate [A] open, and then remove the heating roller [B].

16. Heating roller [A]

264

Fusing

The surface of the heating roller is fragile, so the heating roller must be covered with a sheet of
paper when it is placed on a table or floor.

When re-installing the heating roller

1. Apply three spots of "Barrierta S552R" (the diameter of each spot must be about 3 mm in diameter,
and approximately 0.1 g in weight) to the front shaft of the heating roller at 2 - 3 mm from the notch
[A].
2. Apply three spots of "Barrierta S552R" (the diameter of each spot must be about 3 mm in diameter,
and approximately 0.1 g in weight) to the rear shaft of the heating roller at 2 - 3 mm from the edge
[B] (rear side of the heating roller).

Do not wipe off the grease of the new fusing drive gear when replacing the fusing drive gear
[A].

265

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Heating Roller Stripper Plate Installation

The heating roller stripper plate may come off the fusing unit frame after removing the heating roller.
When reinstalling the heating roller stripper plate:
1. Set the heating roller stripper plate [A] on the fusing frame first.
2. Attach the springs [B] (front and rear) correctly as shown above.
3. Turn the springs as shown above so that the springs hook the fusing unit frame and heating roller
stripper plate.
4. Hold the heating roller stripper plate, and then install the heating roller.
The heating roller stripper plate is not supported before installing the heating roller in the fusing
unit frame. If you stop holding, the heating roller stripper plate can fall down.

Fusing Cleaning Felt


1. Fusing unit (
2. Heating roller (

266

p.257)
p.260)

Fusing

3. Remove the fusing cleaning felt [A].

When attaching a new fusing cleaning felt

4
Attach the fusing cleaning felt [A], aligning both edges of the fusing cleaning felt with the red lines on the
bottom cover.
Make sure that the fusing cleaning felt is correctly attached to the frame. Otherwise, dust from the IH
coil unit may fall on the paper in the fusing unit and the output becomes dirty.

Fusing Lamp
1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

2. Front bracket (

p.260)

3. Rear bracket (

p.260)

267

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4. Front terminal of the fusing lamp (

x 1)

5. Rear terminal of the fusing lamp (

x 1,

4
6. Fusing lamp rear bracket [A] (

x 3)

x 1)

7. Fusing lamp [A]


Remove the fusing lamp without touching the glass part [B].
Pay attention to the direction of the fusing lamp during the re-installation.

Pressure Roller and Pressure Roller Bearing


1. Heating roller(
2. Fusing lamp (

268

p.260)
p.267)

Fusing

3. One-way clutch gear [A]


4. Pressure roller gear [B] at the rear side

5. Pressure roller bearing [A] at the rear side (C-ring x 1)

6. Front terminal [A] (

x 1)

7. Lamp holder front bracket [B] (

x 1)
269

4. Replacement and Adjustment

8. Pressure roller bearing [C] at the front side (C-ring x 1)

4
9. Keep the pressure roller stripper plate [A] open.
10. Pressure roller [B]

When re-installing the pressure roller

270

Fusing

1. Apply "Barrierta S552R" to the front shaft of the pressure roller at 2 mm from the notch [A], and to
the rear shaft of the pressure roller at 2 mm from the edge [B]. (Apply the lubricant to half of the
circumference of the pressure roller, as shown in the lower of the three above diagrams.)

4
2. Make sure that pressure roller bearing [C] at the front side is set as shown above.
Pressure Roller Stripper Plate Installation

When reinstalling the pressure roller stripper plate:


1. Set the springs [A] (front and rear) correctly as shown above.
2. Install the pressure roller stripper plate [B] in the fusing unit frame as shown above.

271

4. Replacement and Adjustment

3. Turn the pressure roller stripper plate [B].


4. Hold the pressure roller stripper plate, and then install the pressure roller.
The pressure roller stripper plate is not supported before installing the pressure roller in the fusing
unit frame. If you stop holding, the pressure roller stripper plate can fall down.

Stripper Plates
1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

2. Heating roller (

p.260)

3. Heating roller stripper plate [A] (spring x 2)


4. Pressure roller (

272

p.268)

Fusing

4
5. Pressure roller stripper plate [A] (spring x 2)

Cleaning Requirement

The stripper plates require cleaning maintenance every fusing unit maintenance interval. Clean the stripper
plates with a dry cloth, and then clean the stripper plates again with a cloth moistened with alcohol at the
points shown above.

Heating Roller Thermistor


1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

2. Fusing right cover (

p.267 "Fusing Lamp")

273

4. Replacement and Adjustment

3. Fusing bottom cover [A] (

x 5)

4. Heating roller thermistor with bracket [A] (

5. Heating roller thermistor [A] (

274

x 1)

x 1,

x 1)

Fusing

Pressure Roller Thermostat


1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

2. Fusing right cover (


3. Fusing bottom cover (

p.260 "Heating Roller and Heating Roller Bearing")


p.273 "Heating Roller Thermistor")

4. Entrance guide plate [A] (

x 2)

The entrance guide plate must be removed with the orientation of the fusing unit as shown above,
to protect the surface of the heating roller from damage.

5. Pressure roller thermostats [A] (

x 4)

275

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Pressure Roller Thermistors


Pressure Roller Thermistor: Center
1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

2. Fusing bottom cover (

p.273 "Heating Roller Thermistor")

3. Thermistor base [A] (

x 1)

4. Pressure roller thermistor: center [A] (hooks)

Pressure Roller Thermistor: End


1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

2. Fusing right cover (


3. Fusing bottom cover (

276

p.260 "Heating Roller and Heating Roller Bearing")


p.273 "Heating Roller Thermistor")

Fusing

4. Pressure roller thermistor: end bracket [A] (

x 1,

x 1)

Fusing Fan
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (

3. Fusing duct [A] (

p.174)

x 1,

x 1)

277

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4. Fusing fan [A] (hook x 5)

When installing the fusing fan


Make sure that the fusing fan is installed with its decal facing the right side of the machine.

Paper Exit Fan


1. Open the right door.
2. Front right cover (

p.175 "Operation Panel")

3. Paper exit fan [A] (

x 1, hook x 3)

When installing the paper exit fan

Make sure that the paper exit fan is installed with its decal facing the rear of the machine.

IH (Induction Heating) Inverter Fan


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (

278

p.174)

Fusing

3. IH inverter fan bracket [A] (

4. IH inverter fan [B] (

x 2,

x 1)

x 2)

When installing the IH inverter fan


Make sure that the IH inverter fan is installed with its decal facing the upper side of the machine.

Thermopile
1. Open the right door.
2. Front right cover (

p.175 "Operation Panel")

3. Pull out trays 1 and 2, and the image transfer belt unit.

279

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4. Right front cover [A] and front inner cover [B]

5. Bracket [A] (

x 1)

6. IH coil unit [A]


First, release the front side of the IH coil unit.

280

Fusing

7. Thermopile bracket [A] (


8. Thermopile (

x 2,

x 1,

x 3)

x 2)

When cleaning the lens of the thermopile

Do this cleaning procedure after the fusing unit has completely cooled down. Otherwise, you may
get a serious burn.
Do not push the thermostats on the IH coil unit. If you do, the thermostats will be opened. In that case,
the IH coil unit must be replaced.

1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

281

4. Replacement and Adjustment

2. Clean with a cotton-swab dipped in alcohol.

Pressure Roller HP Sensor


1. Open the right door.
2. Fusing unit (

p.257)

3. Pressure roller HP sensor (

x 1,

x 1)

IH Coil Fan
1. Open the right door.
2. Front right cover (

p.175 "Operation Panel")

3. Pull out trays 1 and 2, and the image transfer belt unit (
4. Right front cover and front inner cover (

282

p.279)

p.279)

Fusing

5. IH coil fan bracket [A] (


6. IH coil fan (

x 1,

x 1,

x 1)

x 2)

IH Coil Unit

Do not push the thermostats on the IH coil unit. If you do, the thermostats will be opened. In that case,
the IH coil unit must be replaced.

1. Fusing unit (

p.257)

2. Rear cover (

p.174)

3. Right rear cover (

p.174)

4. Open the controller box (


5. Fusing duct (
6. IH inverter (

p.309 "Controller Box").

p.277)
p.317)

283

4. Replacement and Adjustment

7. IH inverter bracket [A]


8. Ground cable [B] (

x 3)
x 1,

x 1)

9. Remove the connector [A].

10. Pull the Harness [A] in the arrow direction.

284

Fusing

11. Bracket [A] (

x 1)

12. IH coil unit [A] (First, release the front side of the IH coil unit.)

285

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Paper Feed
Paper Feed Unit
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (


3. Duplex unit (

p.174)

p.301)

4. Pull out tray 1 and tray 2.

5. Paper guide plate [A] (tab x 2)

6. Harness cover [A] (

286

x 1)

Paper Feed

7. Paper feed unit [A] (

x 2,

x 1)

Separation Roller, Feed Roller and Pick-Up Belt Unit


Tray 1 and Tray 2
1. Paper feed unit (

p.286)

2. Separation roller [A] (


3. Roller holder [B] (

x 1)

x 1)

287

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4
4. Feed roller [A]
5. Pick-up belt unit [B]

Tray Lift Motor


1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

3. High voltage supply board bracket (

4. Tray lift motor 1 [A] or 2 [B] (

x 2,

p.316)

x 3,

x 1 each)

Vertical Transport, Paper Overflow, Paper End and Paper Feed Sensor
1. Rear cover (

288

p.174)

Paper Feed

2. Right rear cover (


3. Paper feed unit (

p.174)
p.286)

4. Paper overflow sensor [A]


5. Paper end feeler [B] and paper end sensor [C] (hook,
6. Vertical transport sensor bracket [D] (
7. Vertical transport sensor [E] (
8. Paper feed sensor bracket [F] (
9. Paper feed sensor [G] (

x 1,

x 1 each)

x 1)

x 1, hook)
x 1)

x 1, hook)

Registration Sensor
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (

p.174)

289

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4
3. Paper guide plate 1 [A] and 2 [B] (
4. Registration sensor [C] (

x 2 each)

x 1, hook)

By-pass Paper Size Sensor and By-pass Paper Length Sensor

1. Open the by-pass tray [A].


2. Move the side fences to the center.
3. By-pass tray cover [B] (

290

x 4)

Paper Feed

4. By-pass paper size sensor [A] (


5. By-pass paper length sensor [B] (

x 1).
x 1)

When reinstalling the by-pass paper size sensor

1. Adjust the projection [A] of the left side fence bar (it must be centered).
2. Install the by-pass paper size detection switch so that the hole [B] in this switch faces the projection
[C] of the left side fence bar.
3. Reassemble the copier.
4. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
5. Check this switch operation with SP5803-011 (By-pass paper size < Input Check).
- Display on the LCD Paper Size

Display

Paper Size

Display

A3 SEF

00001110

A5 SEF

00001011

291

4. Replacement and Adjustment

B4 SEF

00001100

B6 SEF

00000011

A4 SEF

00001101

A6 SEF

00000111

B5 SEF

00001001

Smaller A6 SEF

00001111

By-pass Bottom Tray


1. Open the right door.
2. By-pass tray cover (

p.290 "By-pass Paper Size Sensor and By-pass Paper Length Sensor")

3. Open the duplex door [A].


4. Right door cover [B] (

292

x 4)

Paper Feed

5. Right door rear cover [A] (

x 3)

4
6. Remove the screw at the front side (

x 1).

7. Remove the cover [A] (2 hooks).

293

4. Replacement and Adjustment

8. Remove the screw at the rear side.

9. Release the front [A] and rear [B] arms (

x 1 each).

10. By-pass bottom tray [A]

By-pass Paper End Sensor


1. Right door cover (

294

p.292 "By-pass Bottom Tray")

Paper Feed

4
2. By-pass feed unit cover [A] (

x 2).

3. By-pass paper end sensor [B] (

x 1, hook)

By-pass Pick-up, Feed and Separation Roller, Torque Limiter


1. Right door cover (

p.292 "By-pass Bottom Tray")

2. By-pass pick-up roller [A] (hook)

295

4. Replacement and Adjustment

3. By-pass feed roller [A] (


4. By-pass feed unit cover (

x 1)
p.294 "By-pass Paper End Sensor")

5. By-pass separation roller [A] (

x 1)

6. Torque limiter [B]

By-pass Feed Clutch


1. Open the right door.
2. Right door rear cover (

296

p.292 "By-pass Bottom Tray")

Paper Feed

4
3. By-pass feed clutch holder [A] (
4. By-pass feed clutch [B] (

x 2)

x 1,

x 1)

Paper Exit Unit


1. Fusing Unit (

p.257)

2. Front right cover (

p.175 "Operation Panel")

3. Image transfer belt unit (


4. Inner Tray (

p.176)

5. Thermopile (

p.279)

6. Rear cover (

p.174)

7. Right rear cover (


8. Fusing duct (

p.221)

p.174)

p.277 "Fusing Fan")

9. Open the controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box").

297

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4
10. Gear cover [A] (
11. Paper exit unit [B] (

x 1)
x 2,

x 2)

Fusing Exit, Paper Overflow, Junction Paper Jam and Paper Exit Sensor

1. Paper exit unit (

298

p.297)

Paper Feed

2. Fusing exit sensor bracket [A] (

x 1,

x 1)

3. Remove the fusing exit sensor from the fusing exit sensor bracket (

4. Paper overflow sensor [A] (

x 1)

x 1, hook)

5. Junction paper jam sensor bracket [A] (

x 1,

x 1)

299

4. Replacement and Adjustment

6. Remove the junction paper jam sensor from the junction paper jam sensor bracket (hook)
7. Paper exit sensor bracket [B] (

x 1,

x 1)

8. Remove the paper exit sensor from the paper exit sensor bracket (hook)

300

Duplex Unit

Duplex Unit
Duplex Unit
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (

p.174)

3. Right door cover (

p.228 "Paper Transfer Unit")

4. Close the right door [A].


5. Remove the spring [B].
6. Open the right door [A].

7. Release the front link [A] (

x 1).

8. Keep the right door fully open.

301

4. Replacement and Adjustment

9. Hold the right door, and then release the wire [A] (

x 1).

Keep holding the right door before removing the right door completely. Otherwise, the right
door can fall down and injure you.
10. Press the projection [B] to pull the right door shaft into the unit, and then remove the duplex unit [C]
x 1,
x 4, ground cable x 1).
( x 1,

Duplex Door Sensor


1. Right door cover (
2. Open the right door.

302

p.228 "Paper Transfer Unit")

Duplex Unit

4
3. Duplex door sensor [A] (

x 1, hook)

Duplex Entrance Sensor


1. Right door cover (

p.228 "Paper Transfer Unit")

2. Open the right door.

3. Duplex entrance guide [A] (

x1, stepped screw x 2)

4. Duplex entrance sensor bracket [B] (

x 1,

x 1)

303

4. Replacement and Adjustment

5. Duplex entrance sensor [C] (hook)

Duplex Exit Sensor


1. Paper transfer unit (

p.228)

2. Guide plate [A] (two hooks)


3. Duplex exit sensor [B] (

304

x 1, hook)

Electrical Components

Electrical Components
Boards
Controller Box closed

[A]

IOB

[B]

FCU (Option)

[C]

G3 Interface Unit (Option)

[D]

PSU

[E]

High Voltage Supply Board (Behind the PSU [D] )

305

4. Replacement and Adjustment

Behind the IOB, FCU and G3 Interface Unit

306

[F]

BICU

[G]

Controller Board

[H]

HDD

Electrical Components

Controller Box Open

[I]

ITB Power Supply Board

Controller Unit
1. Control cover (

p.173)

307

4. Replacement and Adjustment

2. Controller unit [A] (

x 5)

Controller Box Right Cover


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Scanner rear cover (

308

p.181 "Exposure Lamp")

Electrical Components

4
3. Controller box right cover [A] (

x 8)

Controller Box
When opening the controller box
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Scanner rear cover (

p.181 "Exposure Lamp")

3. Remove seven screws.

309

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4
4. Open the controller box [A].

When removing the controller box


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Scanner rear cover (


3. Right rear cover (

p.181 "Exposure Lamp")


p.174)

4. Controller box right cover (

310

p.308)

Electrical Components

5. Remove the controller box stay [A] (

x 4).

4
6. Move the IOB bracket [A] aside (

x 4,

x All).

7. Disconnect the scanner interface cable [A] (ground cable)


8. Release all clamps on the controller box frame.
9. Disconnect all connectors on the BICU [B] board.
10. Disconnect the connector [C] at the outer controller box and at the inner controller box.

311

4. Replacement and Adjustment

11. Lift up the controller box [A], and then remove it.

IOB (In/Out Board)


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Scanner rear cover (

p.181 "Exposure Lamp")

3. Controller box right cover (

4. IOB [A] (

x 6, All

p.308)

s)

BICU
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Scanner rear cover (

312

p.181 "Exposure Lamp")

Electrical Components

3. Controller box right cover (

p.308)

4. Disconnect the harness (CN225) on the IOB board.


5. Move the IOB bracket aside (

p.309 "Controller Box")

6. BICU [A] (

x 5,

x All)

Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the BICU. Insert the NVRAM in the NVRAM slot
with the "half-moon" pointing [B] to the upward side.

When installing the new BICU


Remove the NVRAM from the old BICU. Then install it on the new BICU after you replace the BICU. Replace
the NVRAM ( "NVRAM Replacement Procedure" in the Appendices) if the NVRAM on the old BICU is
defective.
Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data") before you replace
the NVRAM.
Keep NVRAMs away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage
NVRAM data.
Make sure that the DIP-switch settings on the old BICU are the same for the new BICU when. Do not
change the DIP switches on the BICU in the field.
Make sure the serial number is input in the machine for the NVRAM data; if not, SC 995-001 occurs.

313

4. Replacement and Adjustment

PSU
PSU bracket
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Ventilation duct [A] (


3. PSU bracket [B] (

x 2)
x 6,

x All,

x All)

PSU board
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Ventilation duct (see "PSU bracket")

3. PSU board [A] (

314

x 11, all

s, all

s)

Electrical Components

Power Relay Switch


1. PSU bracket (

p.314 "PSU")

1. Pull out tray 2.

4
2. Tray left rail cover [A] (

x 1)

3. Take aside the cords and ferrite core [B] (

4. Power relay switch [A] (

x 2).

x 2)

ITB Power Supply Board


1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Scanner rear cover (

p.181 "Exposure Lamp")

3. Open the controller box (

p.309 "Controller Box")

315

4. Replacement and Adjustment

4. ITB power supply board [A] (

x 5,

x 6)

High Voltage Supply Board


1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

3. High voltage supply board [A] (

x 8, All

High Voltage Supply Board Bracket


1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (

316

p.174)
p.314 "PSU")

s,

x 2)

Electrical Components

3. High voltage supply board bracket [A] (

x 3,

x All,

x 2)

IH Inverter
1. Rear cover (

p.174)

2. Right rear cover (


3. Fusing duct (

p.174)

p.277 "Fusing Fan")

4. IH inverter [A] (

x 6,

x 5)

Controller Board
1. Controller unit (

p.307)

317

4. Replacement and Adjustment

2. Controller board [A] (

x 7,

x 3)

3. Interface rails [A], NV-RAM [B], RAM-DIMM [C]

318

Electrical Components

When installing the new controller board


Remove the NVRAM from the old controller board. Then install it on the new controller board after you
replace the controller board. Replace the NVRAM if the NVRAM on the old controller board is defective.
Make sure you print out the SMC reports ("SP Mode Data" and "Logging Data") before you replace
the NVRAM.
Keep NVRAMs away from any objects that can cause static electricity. Static electricity can damage
NVRAM data.
Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the controller board.
Make sure that the DIP-switch settings on the old controller board are the same for the new controller
board. Do not change the DIP switches on the controller board in the field.

HDD Fan
1. Controller unit (

2. HDD fan [A] (

p.307)

x 2,

x 1)

HDD
1. Controller unit (

p.307)

319

4. Replacement and Adjustment

2. Remove the HDD [A] with the bracket (

x 4,

3. Remove the HDD from the bracket [A] (

x 4).

x 2).

When installing a new HDD unit


1. Turn the main power switch on. The disk is automatically formatted.
2. Install the stamp data using "SP5853".
3. Switch the machine off and on to enable the fixed stamps for use.

Disposal of HDD Units


Never remove an HDD unit from the work site without the consent of the client.
If the customer has any concerns about the security of any information on the HDD, the HDD must
remain with the customer for disposal or safe keeping.
The HDD may contain proprietary or classified (Confidential, Secret) information. Specifically, the
HDD contains document server documents and data stored in temporary files created automatically

320

Electrical Components

during copy job sorting and jam recovery. Such data is stored on the HDD in a special format so it
cannot normally be read but can be recovered with illegal methods.

Reinstallation
Explain to the customer that the following information stored on the HDD is lost when the HDD is replaced:
Document server documents
Custom-made stamps
Document server address book
The address book and document server documents (if needed) must be input again.
If you previously backed up the address book to an SD card with SP5846 051, you can use SP 5846
052 to copy the data from the SD card to the hard disk.

If the customer is using the Data Overwrite Security feature, the DOS function must be set up again. For
more, see Section 1 (Installation).
If the customer is using the optional Browser Unit, this unit must be installed again. For more, see Section
1 (Installation).

NVRAM Replacement Procedure


NVRAM on the BICU
1. Make sure that you have the SMC report (factory settings). This report comes with the machine.
2. Output the SMC data (

SP5-990-001) if possible.

3. Turn the main switch off.


4. Install an SD card into SD card slot 3. Then turn the main power on.
5. Copy the NVRAM data to an SD card (

SP5-824-001) if possible.

6. Turn off the main switch. Then unplug the power cord.
7. Replace the NVRAM on the BICU and reassemble the machine.
8. Plug in the power cord. Then turn the main switch on.
9. Select a paper-size type (

SP5-131-001).

10. Specify the serial number and destination code of the machine.
Contact your supervisor for details on how to enter the serial number and destination code.
SC 999 or "Fusing Unit Setting Error" can be shown until the serial number and destination code
are correctly programmed.

321

4. Replacement and Adjustment

11. Turn the main switch off and on.


12. Copy the data from the SD card to the NVRAM (
them to the SD card.

SP5-825-001) if you have successfully copied

13. Turn the main switch off. Then remove the SD card from SD card slot 3.
14. Turn the main switch on.
15. Specify the SP and UP mode settings.
16. Do the process control self-check.
17. Do ACC for the copier application program.
18. Do ACC for the printer application program.

322

Using Dip Switches

Using Dip Switches


Controller Board
DIP SW No.

OFF

ON

Boot-up from Flash Memory

Boot-up from SD card

2 to 8

Factory Use Only: Do not change the switch settings.

BICU Board
DIP SW No.

OFF

ON

1 and 2

Factory Use Only: Do not change the switch settings.

323

4. Replacement and Adjustment

324

5. System Maintenance
Service Program Mode
Make sure that the data-in LED ( ) is not on before you go into the SP mode. This LED indicates that
some data is coming to the machine. When the LED is on, wait for the copier to process the data.

SP Tables
See "Appendices" for the following information:
System SP Tables
Printer SP Tables

Scanner SP Tables

Enabling and Disabling Service Program Mode

The Service Program Mode is for use by service representatives only. If this mode is used by anyone
other than service representatives for any reason, data might be deleted or settings might be changed.
In such case, product quality cannot be guaranteed any more.

Entering SP Mode
For details, ask your supervisor.

Exiting SP Mode
Press "Exit" on the LCD twice to return to the copy window.

Types of SP Modes
System SP: SP modes related to the engine functions
Printer SP: SP modes related to the controller functions
Scanner SP: SP modes related to the scanner functions
Fax SP: SP modes related to the fax functions
325

5. System Maintenance

Select one of the Service Program modes (System, Printer, Scanner, or Fax) from the touch panel as shown
in the diagram below after you access the SP mode. This section explains the functions of the System/
Printer/Scanner SP modes. Refer to the Fax service manual for the Fax SP modes.

5
SP Mode Button Summary
Here is a short summary of the touch-panel buttons.

326

Opens all SP groups and sublevels.

Closes all open groups and sublevels and restores the initial SP mode display.

Service Program Mode

Opens the copy window (copy mode) so you can make test copies. Press SP Mode (highlighted)
in the copy window to return to the SP mode screen,

Enter the SP code directly with the number keys if you know the SP number. Then press . (The
required SP Mode number will be highlighted when pressing . If not, just press the required
SP Mode number.)

Press two times to leave the SP mode and return to the copy window to resume normal operation.

Press any Class 1 number to open a list of Class 2 SP modes.

Press to scroll the show to the previous or next group.

Press to scroll to the previous or next display in segments the size of the screen display (page).

Press to scroll the show the previous or next line (line by line).

10

Press to move the highlight on the left to the previous or next selection in the list.

Switching Between SP Mode and Copy Mode for Test Printing


1. In the SP mode, select the test print. Then press "Copy Window".
2. Use the copy window (copier mode), to select the appropriate settings (paper size, etc.) for the test
print.
3. Press Start

to start the test print.

4. Press SP Mode (highlighted) to return to the SP mode screen and repeat from step 1.

Selecting the Program Number


Program numbers have two or three levels.
1. Refer to the Service Tables to find the SP that you want to adjust before you begin.
2. Press the Group number on the left side SP Mode window that contains the SP that you want to adjust.
3. Use the scrolling buttons in the center of the SP mode window to show the SP number that you want
to open. Then press that number to expand the list.
4. Use the center touch-panel buttons to scroll to the number and title of the item that you want to set and
press it. The small entry box on the right activates and shows the below default or the current settings.

327

5. System Maintenance

Refer to the Service Tables for the range of allowed settings.


5. Do this procedure to enter a setting:
Press to toggle between plus and minus and use the keypad to enter the appropriate number.
The number you enter writes over the previous setting.
Press

to enter the setting. (The value is not registered if you enter a number that is out of range.)

Press "Yes" when you are prompted to complete the selection.


6. If you need to perform a test print, press Copy Window to open the copy window and select the
settings for the test print. Press Start and then press SP Mode (highlighted) in the copy window to
return to the SP mode display.
7. Press Exit two times to return to the copy window when you are finished.

Exiting Service Mode


Press the Exit key on the touch-panel.

Service Mode Lock/Unlock


At locations where the machine contains sensitive data, the customer engineer cannot operate the machine
until the Administrator turns the service mode lock off. This function makes sure that work on the machine is
always done with the permission of the Administrator.
1. If you cannot go into the SP mode, ask the Administrator to log in with the User Tool and then set
"Service Mode Lock" to OFF after he or she logs in:
User Tools > System Settings > Administrator Tools > Service Mode Lock > OFF
This unlocks the machine and lets you get access to all the SP codes.

328

Service Program Mode

The CE can service the machine and turn the machine off and on. It is not necessary to ask the
Administrator to log in again each time the machine is turned on.
2. Go into the SP mode and set SP5169 to "1" if you must use the printer bit switches.
3. After machine servicing is completed:
Change SP5169 from "1" to "0".
Turn the machine off and on. Tell the administrator that you have completed servicing the
machine.
The Administrator will then set the "Service Mode Lock" to ON.

Remarks
Display on the Control Panel Screen
The maximum number of characters which can show on the control panel screen is limited to 30 characters.
For this reason, some of the SP modes shown on the screen need to be abbreviated. The following are
abbreviations used for the SP modes for which the full description is over 20 characters.

Paper Weight
Thin paper: 52-59 g/m2
Plain Paper: 60-90 g/m2, 16-24lb.
Middle Thick: 91-105 g/m2, 24-28lb.
Thick Paper 1: 106-169 g/m2, 28.5-44.9lb.
Thick Paper 2: 170-220 g/m2, 45-58lb.
Thick Paper 3: 221-256 g/m2, 59lb-68lb
Thick 4: 257 g/m2-300 g/m2, 68.4-79.8lb
Paper Type
N: Normal paper
MTH: Middle thick paper
TH: Thick paper

Paper Feed Station


P: Paper tray
B: By-pass table

329

5. System Maintenance

Color Mode [Color]


[K]: Black in B&W mode
[Y], [M], or [C]: Yellow, Magenta, or Cyan in Full Color mode
[YMC]: Only for Yellow, Magenta, and Cyan
[FC]: Full Color mode
[FC, K], [FC, Y], [FC, M], or [FC, C]: Black, Yellow, Magenta, or Cyan in full color mode

Print Mode

Process Speed

S: Simplex

L: Low speed (77 mm/s)

D: Duplex

M: Middle speed (154 mm/s)

Others
The following symbols are used in the SP mode tables.
FA: Factory setting
(Data may be adjusted from the default setting at the factory. Refer to the factory setting sheets enclosed.
You can find it under the jammed paper removal decal.)
DFU: Design/Factory Use only
Do not touch these SP modes in the field.
A sharp (#) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that the main switch must be turned
off and on to effect the setting change.
An asterisk (*) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that this mode is stored in the
NVRAM. If you do a RAM clear, this SP mode will be reset to the default value. "ENG" and "CTL" show
which NVRAM contains the data.
ENG: NVRAM on the BICU board
CTL: NVRAM on the controller board
The settings of each SP mode are explained in the right-hand column of the SP table in the following way.
[Adjustable range / Default setting / Step] Alphanumeric
If "Alphanumeric" is written to the right of the bracket as shown above, the setting of the SP mode
shows on the screen using alphanumeric characters instead of only numbers. However, the settings
in the bracket in the SP mode table are explained by using only the numbers.
SSP: This denotes a "Special Service Program" mode setting.

330

Main SP Tables-1

Main SP Tables-1
SP1-XXX (Feed)
[Leading Edge Registration] Leading Edge Registration Adjustment
1001

(Tray Location, Paper Type, Color Mode), Paper Type -> Plain, Thick 1or Thick 2
Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration motor operation timing for
each mode.

002 Tray: Plain

*ENG

003 Tray: Middle Thick

*ENG

004 Tray: Thick 1

*ENG

005 Tray: Thick 2

*ENG

007 By-pass: Plain

*ENG

008 By-pass: Middle Thick

*ENG

009 By-pass: Thick 1

*ENG

010 By-pass: Thick 2

*ENG

011 By-pass: Thick 3

*ENG

013 Duplex: Plain

*ENG

014 Duplex: Middle Thick

*ENG

015 Duplex: Thick 1

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

331

5. System Maintenance

016 Tray: Thick 3

*ENG

017 Tray: Plain:1200

*ENG

018 Tray: Middle Thick:1200

*ENG

019 Tray: Thick 1:1200

*ENG

020 By-pass: Plain:1200

*ENG

021 By-pass: Middle Thick:1200

*ENG

022 By-pass: Thick 1:1200

*ENG

023 Duplex: Plain:1200

*ENG

024 Duplex: Middle Thick:1200

*ENG

025 Duplex: Thick 1:1200

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

[Side to Side Reg.] Side-to-Side Registration Adjustment


1002

Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each
mode.

001 By-pass Table

*ENG

002 Paper Tray 1

*ENG

003 Paper Tray 2

*ENG

004 Paper Tray 3

*ENG

005 Paper Tray 4

*ENG

006 Duplex

*ENG

007 Paper Tray 5

*ENG

008 Large Capacity Tray

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

[Paper Buckle] Paper Buckle Adjustment


1003

(Tray Location, Paper Type), Paper Type: N: Normal, TH: Thick


Adjusts the amount of paper buckle at the registration roller by changing the paper feed
timing.

002 Paper Tray1: Plain


332

*ENG

[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

Main SP Tables-1

003 Tray1: Middle Thick

*ENG

004 Paper Tray1: Thick1

*ENG

007 Paper Tray2/3/4/5/LCT: Plain

*ENG

008 Tray 2/3/4/5/LCT: Middle Thick

*ENG

[9 to 5 / -1 / 1 mm/step]

009 Paper Tray2/3/4/5/LCT: Thick 1

*ENG

[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

012 By-pass: Plain

*ENG

013 By-pass: Middle Thick

*ENG

014 By-pass: Thick 1

*ENG

018 Duplex: Plain

*ENG

019 Duplex: Middle Thick

*ENG

020 Duplex: Thick 1

*ENG

021 Paper Tray1: Plain: 1200

*ENG

022 Tray1: Middle Thick: 1200

*ENG

023 Tray 2/3/4/5LCT: Plain: 1200

*ENG

024 Tray 2/3/4/5LCT: Mid: 1200

*ENG

025 By-pass: Plain: 1200

*ENG

026 By-pass: Middle Thick: 1200

*ENG

027 Paper Tray1: Thick1: 1200

*ENG

028 Paper Tray2/3/4/5/LCT: Thick 1:1200 *ENG


029 By-pass: Thick 1: 1200

*ENG

030 Duplex: Plain: 1200

*ENG

031 Duplex: Middle Thick: 1200

*ENG

032 Duplex: Thick 1: 1200

*ENG

1007

[9 to 5 / -1 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

[By-Pass Size Detection] By-Pass Size Detection Display

333

5. System Maintenance

LG
001

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection function of the by-pass tray.
This SP determines what paper size the machine detects if the detected size is less than 8.5.
0: OFF (Letter/SEF), 1: ON (Legal/SEF)

1101

[Reload Permit Setting]


Specifies the settings of the reload permit for cold temperature in color mode.

001 Pre-rotation Start Temp.

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

002 Reload Target Temp.:Center

*ENG

[120 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

003 Reload Target Temp.:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

004 Temp.:Delta:Cold:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

005 Temp.:Delta:Cold:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

006 Temp.:Delta:Cold:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]

[Forced Ready Set]


Specifies the setting of the forced reload permit for cold temperature in color mode.
007 Time:Cold

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

[Reload Permit Setting]


Specifies the settings of the reload permit for warm temperature in color mode.
008 Temp.:Delta:Warm:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

009 Temp.:Delta:Warm:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

010 Temp.:Delta:Warm:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]

[Forced Ready Set]


Specifies the setting of the forced reload permit for warm temperature in color mode.
011 Time:Warm

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

[Reload Permit Setting]


Specifies the settings of the reload permit for hot temperature in color mode.
012 Temp.:Delta:Hot:Center

334

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

Main SP Tables-1

013 Temp.:Delta:Hot:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

014 Temp.:Delta:Hot:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]

[Forced Ready Set]


Specifies the setting of the forced reload permit for hot temperature in color mode.
015 Time:Hot

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

[Reload Permit Setting Temp.]


Specifies the settings of the reload permit for cold temperature in BW mode.
016 Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

017 Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

018 Temp.Delta:Cold:BW:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 70 / 1 deg/step]

[Forced Ready Set]

Specifies the setting of the forced reload permit for cold temperature in BW mode.
019 Time:Cold:BW

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

[Reload Permit Setting]


Specifies the settings of the reload permit for cold temperature in BW mode 2.
020

Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW2:Cent
er

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

021 Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW2:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

022 Temp.Delta:Cold:BW2:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

[Forced Ready Set]


Specifies the setting of the forced reload permit for cold temperature in BW mode 2.
023 Time:Cold:BW2

1102

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

[Feed Permit Setting]


Specified the settings of the paper feeding timing.

001 Temp.:Lower Delta:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

002 Temp.:Lower Delta:End

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

003 Temp.:Upper Delta:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]


335

5. System Maintenance

004 Temp.:Upper Delta:End

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

005 Temp.:Lower Delta:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

006 Rotation Time

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

010 Temp.:Upper Delta:End:Sp.1

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

011 Temp.:Lower Delta:Press:Sp.1

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]

012 Rotation Time:Sp.1

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

016 Temp.:Upper Delta:End:Sp.2

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

017 Temp.:Lower Delta:Press:Sp.2

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

018 Rotation Time:Sp2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

019 Feed Permit Time

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 120 / 1 sec/step]

007

Temp.:Lower
Delta:Center:Sp.1

008 Temp.:Lower Delta:End:Sp.1


009

013

Temp.:Upper
Delta:Center:Sp.1

Temp.:Lower
Delta:Center:Sp.2

014 Temp.:Lower Delta:End:Sp.2


015

1105

Temp.:Upper
Delta:Center:Sp.2

[Print Target Temp]


(Printing Mode, Roller Type, [Color], Simplex/Duplex)
Roller Type > Center and Ends: Heating roller, Pressure > Pressure roller
Paper Type -> Plain, Thin, Thick, OHP, Middle Thick, Special

001

336

Plain1:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.

Main SP Tables-1

002

003

004

005

006

007

008

Plain1:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing..
Plain1:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain1:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain2:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Plain2:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full coloe printing.
Plain2:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain2:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.

009 Thin:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

010 Thin:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

011 Thin:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

012 Thin:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

013 M-thick:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

014 M-thick:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

015 M-thick:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

016 M-thick:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

017 Thick1:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

018 Thick1:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

019 Thick1:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

020 Thick1:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]


337

5. System Maintenance

021 Thick2:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

022 Thick2:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

023 Thick2:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

024 Thick2:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

025 Thick3:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 170 / 1 deg/step]

026 Thick3:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

027 Thick3:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

028 Thick3:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

029 Special1:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

030 Special1:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

031 Special1:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

032 Special1:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

033 Special2:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

034 Special2:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

035 Special2:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

036 Special2:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

037 Special3:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

038 Special3:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

039 Special3:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

040 Special3:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

041 Envelop:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 180 / 1 deg/step]

042 Envelop:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

101 Plain1:FC:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

102 Plain1:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

103

338

Plain1:BW:Center:Low
Speed

Main SP Tables-1

104 Plain1:BW:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

105 Plain2:FC:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

106 Plain2:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Plain2:BW:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

108 Plain2:BW:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

M-thick:FC:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

110 M-thick:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

112 M-thick:BW:Press:Low Speed *ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

113 Thick1:FC:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

114 Thick1:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Thick1:BW:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

116 Thick1:BW:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

107

109

111

115

M-thick:BW:Center:Low
Speed

117

Special1:FC:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

118

Special1:FC:Press:Low
Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

119

Special1:BW:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 130 / 1 deg/step]

120

Special1:BW:Press:Low
Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

121

Special2:FC:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

122

Special2:FC:Press:Low
Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

339

5. System Maintenance

123

Special2:BW:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

124

Special2:BW:Press:Low
Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

125 Plain1:Glossy:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

126 Plain1:Glossy:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

127 Plain2:Glossy:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

128 Plain2:Glossy:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

129 M-thick:Glossy:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

130 M-thick:Glossy:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

131 OHP:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

132 OHP:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

133 Envelop:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 170 / 1 deg/step]

134 Envelop:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

135 Thin:FC:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

136 Thin:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

137 Thin:BW:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 130 / 1 deg/step]

138 Thin:BW:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

139 Thick4:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 175 / 1 deg/step]

140 Thick4:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

141 Thick4:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

142 Thick4:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

001 Center

[-10 to 250 / - / 1 deg/step]

002 End

Displays the temperature of the heating roller.

1106

340

[Fusing Temp. Display]

Main SP Tables-1

003 Pressure

[-10 to 250 / - / 1 deg/step]

004 Pressure End

Displays the temperature of the heating roller.

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 15 / 1 sec/step]

1107

[Standby Target Temp. Setting]


Standby Heater Off Time

001 Specifies the time that the fusing heater turns off after the fusing unit temperature has reached
its target temperature.
002

004

006

007

008

1108
001

002

1111

Stanby/Preheat1: Press

*ENG

[0 to 125 / 90 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the ready or energy save 1 mode.
Preheat2:Press

*ENG

[0 to 125 / 90 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the energy save 2 mode.
Low Power:Press

*ENG

[0 to 125 / 60 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the low power mode.
Print Ready:Center

*ENG

[120 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the heating roller for the print ready condition.
Print Ready:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the print ready condition.
[After Reload/Job Target Temp.]
Center

*ENG

[120 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the heating roller after re-load or job.


Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller after re-load or job.


[Environment Correction:Fusing]
Temp.: Threshold: Low

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 17 / 1 deg/step]

001 Specifies the threshold temperature for low temperature. If the fusing temperature is 17C
or less, the machine executes the fusing mode for low temperature.

341

5. System Maintenance

Temp.: Threshold: High

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 deg/step]

002 Sepcifies the threshold temperature for high temperature. If the fusing temperature is 30C
or more, the machine executes the fusing mode for high temperature.
Low Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

003 Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature. If the fusing temperature is
in low temperature condition, this temperature is added to the taraget temperature.
High Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

004 Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature. If the fusing temperature is
in high temperature condition, this temperature is added to the taraget temperature.

005 Job Low Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.1 deg/step]

006 Job High Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

007 Job Low Temp. Correction:Sp. *ENG


008

1113

001

Job High Temp.


Correction:Sp.

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 0.1 deg/step]


[0 to 100 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

[Curl Correction]
Execute Pattern

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On (No Decurl), 2: On

Selects the curl correction type.


002

003

Humidity:Threshold:M-humid

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 1 / 1 %/step]

Specifies the threshold between low and middle humidity.


Humidity:Threshold:H-humid

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]

Specifies the threshold between middle and high humidity.

Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:M004 humid

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:H005 humid

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 50 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in high humidity.
342

Main SP Tables-1

006

Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:Mhumid:No Decurl

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 50 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for the no curl control in middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:H007 humid:No Decurl

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 40 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for the no curl control in high humidity.
CPM:M-humid

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %/step]

008 Specifies the CPM ratio of the decurl control against to the normal operation in middle
humidity.
009

CPM:H-humid

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]

Specifies the CPM ratio of the decurl control against to the normal operation in high humidity.
CPM:M-humid:No Decurl

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %/step]

010 Specifies the CPM ratio against of the no decurl control to the normal operation in middle
humidity.
CPM:H-humid:No Decurl

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]

011 Specifies the CPM ratio against of the no decurl control to the normal operation in high
humidity.
1115
001

1124

[Target Temp. Correction]


Temp.:Delta:End

*ENG

[-100 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the different temperature between end and center of the heating roller.
[CPM Down Setting]
Specifies the settings for the CPM down mode.

001 Low:Down Temp.

*ENG

[-50 to 0 / -20 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the CPM down threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature decreases -20C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM down mode.
002 Low:Up Temp.

*ENG

[-50 to 0 / -15 / 1 deg/step]

343

5. System Maintenance

Specifies the CPM up threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature increases -15C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM up mode.
003 Low :1st CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 80 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
004 Low :2nd CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 65 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 2nd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
005 Low :3rd CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 50 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.

006 High :1st CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 75 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
007 High:2nd CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 50 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
008 High:3rd CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 25 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
009

High:1st CPM Down


Temp.:A3

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 230 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A3 paper size.
010

High:2nd CPM Down


Temp.:A3

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 233 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A3 paper size.
011

High:3rd CPM Down


Temp.:A3

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 235 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A3 paper size.
012

High:1st CPM Down


Temp.:A4

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 180 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A4 paper size.

344

Main SP Tables-1

013

High:2nd CPM Down


Temp.:A4

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 183 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A4 paper size.
014

High:3rd CPM Down


Temp.:A4

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 185 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A4 paper size.
015

High:1st CPM Down


Temp.:B5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 175 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of B5 paper size.
016

High:2nd CPM Down


Temp.:B5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 180 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of B5 paper size.
017

High:3rd CPM Down


Temp.:B5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 185 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of B5 paper size.
018

High:1st CPM Down


Temp.:A5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 180 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A5 paper size.
019

High:2nd CPM Down


Temp.:A5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 185 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A5 paper size.
020

High:3rd CPM Down


Temp.:A5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 190 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A5 paper size.
021

High:1st CPM Down


Temp.:A6:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A6 paper size.
022

High:2nd CPM Down


Temp.:A6:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A6 paper size.
345

5. System Maintenance

023

High:3rd CPM Down


Temp.:A6:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 170 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A6 paper size.
024 Judging Interval

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 5 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the interval for CPM down judgement.


1141

[Fusing SC Issue Time Info]

001 SC Number

*ENG

Displays the issued SC number.

002 SC Cause

*ENG

[0 to 9 / - / 1/step]

101 Htg Roller:Ctr Diff1

*ENG

102 Htg Rolloer:Ctr Det1

*ENG

103 Htg Roller:Ctr Corr1

*ENG

104 Htg Roller:End Diff1

*ENG

105 Htg Roller:End Det1

*ENG

106 Htg Roller:End Corr1

*ENG

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Displays the temperature at the center of
the heating roller when an SC was issued.
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Displays the temperature at the end of the
heating roller when an SC was issued.
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

346

107 Press Roller Temp Value1

*ENG

151 Htg Roller:Ctr Diff2

*ENG

152 Htg Rolloer:Ctr Det2

*ENG

153 Htg Roller:Ctr Corr2

*ENG

154 Htg Roller:End Diff2

*ENG

155 Htg Roller:End Det2

*ENG

156 Htg Roller:End Corr2

*ENG

157 Press Roller Temp Value2

*ENG

Displays the temperature at the pressure


roller when an SC was issued.

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

Main SP Tables-1

201 Htg Roller:Ctr Diff3

*ENG

202 Htg Rolloer:Ctr Det3

*ENG

203 Htg Roller:Ctr Corr3

*ENG

204 Htg Roller:End Diff3

*ENG

205 Htg Roller:End Det3

*ENG

206 Htg Roller:End Corr3

*ENG

207 Press Roller Temp Value3

*ENG

1142

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[Fusing Jam Detection]


SC Display

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]

001 Enables or disables the fusing consecutive jam (three times) SC detection.

0: No detection, 1: Detection
1151

[Pressure Setting]
Pressure Change ON/OFF

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

001 Enables or disables the pressure switching control for the fusing unit.
0: OFF , 1: ON
002

003

004

Pressure Position1

*ENG

[0 to 10,000 / 420 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 1.
Pressure Position2

*ENG

[0 to 10,000 / 660 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 2.
Pressure Position3

*ENG

[0 to 10,000 / 2130 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 3.
Depressure Position

*ENG

[0 to 10,000 / 220 / 10 msec/step]

005 Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the depression position (no
pressure).

347

5. System Maintenance

Shift Time

*ENG

[0 to 3600 / 5 / 1 sec/step]

010 Specifies the timing for depressing the fusing unit. If the machine does not get any jobs for
specified time by this SP after copying or printing, the machine depresses the fusing unit.
101 Pressure:Plain1/2

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for each paper type in normal speed.
0: Depression position (no pressure)
1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)

102 Pressure:Thin

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

103 Pressure:M-thick

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

104 Pressure:Thick1

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

105 Pressure:Thick2

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

106 Pressure:Thick3

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

107 Pressure:Special1

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

108 Pressure:Special2

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

109 Pressure:Special3

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

110 Pressure:Envelope

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1 / 1 /step]

151 Pressure:Plain1/2:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for each paper type in low speed.
0: Depression position (no pressure)
1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)

348

152 Pressure:M-thick:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

153 Pressure:Thick1:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

154 Pressure:Special1:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

155 Pressure:Special2:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

Main SP Tables-1

156 Pressure:Plain1/2:Glossy

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

157 Pressure:M-thick:Glossy

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

158 Pressure:OHP

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

159 Pressure:Envelope:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1 / 1 /step]

160 Pressure:Thin:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

Pressure:Thick4

Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for thick 4 paper.
161

0: Depression position (no pressure)


1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2

3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)


201

1152

Filler Edge Detection Counter

ENG

[0 to 9,000,000 / - / 1 /step]

Displays the detection time for the edge of the pressure roller actuator.
[Fusing Nip Band Check]

001 Execute

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]

Executes the nip band measurement between heating roller and pressure roller.
If the nip band width is not 8 mm, and fusing is not good, replace the pressure roller or install
a new fusing unit.
002

003

004

1153

Pre-Idling Time

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 240 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the fusing rotation time before executing SP1109-001.


Stop Time

* ENG

[5 to 30 / 20 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the time for measuring the nip.


Pressure Position

* ENG

[1 to 3 / 3 / 1 ]

Specifies the pressure position for measuring the nip.


[Fuser Cleaning]

001 Compulsion execution

Execute the fusing cleaning mode.

349

5. System Maintenance

Operation interval

*ENG

[1 to 300 / 0 / 1 K/step]

002 Adjusts the execution interval for the fusing cleaning mode.
1K= 100 sheets
003

004

1801

350

Control Temp.

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 180 / 1C/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for the fusing cleaning mode.
Page Count

*ENG

[1 to 300000 / - / 1 page/step]

Displays the page counter for the fusing cleaning mode.


[Motor Speed Adj.] FA

001 Registration:Plain:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

002 Registration:Plain:High

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

003 Registration:Middle Thick:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

004 Registration:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

005 Registration:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

006 Registration:Thick 1:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

007 Registration:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

008 Registration:Thick 2:Low

*ENG

009 Registration:Thick 3:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

Main SP Tables-1

010 Duplex CW:Plane:Low

*ENG

011 Duplex CW:Normal:High

*ENG

012 Duplex CW:Middle Thick:Low

*ENG

013 Duplex CW:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

014 Duplex CW:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

015 Duplex CW:Thick1:Low

*ENG

016 Duplex CW:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

017 Duplex CW:Thick2:Low

*ENG

018 Duplex CW:Thick3:Low

*ENG

019 Duplex CCW:Normal:High

*ENG

020 Duplex CCW:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

021 Duplex CCW:Middle Thick:high

*ENG

023 Duplex CCW:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

024 Reverse CW:Normal:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0.5 / 0.1%/step]

025 Reverse CW:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

026 Reverse CW:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0.5 / 0.1%/step]

028 Reverse CW:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

029 Reverse CCW:Normal:High

*ENG

030 Reverse CCW:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

031 Reverse CCW:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

033 Reverse CCW:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

034 Feed:Plain:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

035 Feed:Plain:High

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

036 Feed:Middle thick:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

037 Feed:Middle thick:Mid

*ENG

038 Feed:Middle thick:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 %/step]

5
[4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

351

5. System Maintenance

352

039 Feed:Thick 1:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

040 Feed:Thick 1:Mid

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

041 Feed:Thick 2:Low

*ENG

042 Feed:Thick 3:Low

*ENG

043 Bridge Motor:Low

*ENG

044 Bridge Motor:Mid

*ENG

045 Bridge Motor:High

*ENG

060 KOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

061 KOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

062 KOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

063 MOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]

064 MOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]

065 MOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]

066 COpcDevMot:High

*ENG

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]

067 COpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]

068 COpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]

069 YOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]

070 YOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]

071 YOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]

072 Fusing: High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.9 / 0.01 %/step]

073 Fusing: Mid

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.4 / 0.01 %/step]

074 Fusing: Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.7 / 0.01 %/step]

075 TransferMot:High

*ENG

076 TransferMot:Mid

*ENG

077 TransferMot:Low

*ENG

078 TonerMot

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.01 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0.2 / 0.01 %/step]

[30 to 30 / 10 / 5 %/step]

Main SP Tables-1

079 Fusing Exit Motor: 1200

100

Drum Adjust

*ENG
*ENG

[4 to 4 / 2.1 / 0.01 %/step]


[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Off, 1: On

Enables or disables the drum amplitude adjustment.


101 MOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

102 COpcDevMot:High

*ENG

103 YOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

104 MOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

105 COpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

106 YOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

107 MOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

108 COpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

109 YOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

110 MOpcDevMot:1200

*ENG

111 COpcDevMot:1200

*ENG

[7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]

[7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]

5
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]

[ 7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]

112 YOpcDevMot:1200

*ENG

120 Long:Registration:Plain:High

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

121 Long:Registration:Plain:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

122 Long:Registration:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

123

Long:Registration:Middle
Thick:Middle

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

124 Long:Registration:Middle Thick:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

125 Long:Registration:Thick 1:Middle

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1 / 0.1 %/step]

126 Long:Registration:Thick 1:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

127 Long:Registration:Thick 2:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

128 Long:Registration:Thick 3:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

353

5. System Maintenance

129 Long:Fusing:Plain:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.9 / 0.01 %/step]

130 Long:Fusing:Plain:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 2.1 / 0.01 %/step]

131 Long:Fusing:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.9 / 0.01 %/step]

132 Long:Fusing:Middle Thick:Middle

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.4 / 0.01 %/step]

133 Long:Fusing:Middle Thick:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 2.1 / 0.01 %/step]

134 Long:Fusing:Thick 1:Middle

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 2.0 / 0.01 %/step]

135 Long:Fusing:Thick 1:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.7 / 0.01 %/step]

136 Long:Fusing:Thick 2:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.7 / 0.01 %/step]

137 Long:Fusing:Thick 3:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.7 / 0.01 %/step]

1902

[Amplitude Control]

001 Execute

Execute the drum phase adjustment.


[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
Displays the result of the drum phase adjustment.

002 Result

*ENG

0: Successfully done
2: Sampling failure
3: Insufficient detection number
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

003 Auto Execution

*ENG

Turns the automatic drum phase adjustment on or off.


0: Off, 1: On

1950

354

[Fan Cooling Time Set]


Adjust the rotation time for each fan motor after a job end.

Main SP Tables-1

002 Fusing Exit Fan

*ENG

006 Main Suction Fan

*ENG

007 Paper Exit Fan

*ENG

008 PSU Fan

*ENG

009 Fusing IH Coil Fan

*ENG

010 IH Power Supply Fan

*ENG

011 Second Duct Fan

*ENG

012 Third Duct Fan

*ENG

1951

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

[Fan Start Time Set]


Adjust the start time for each fan motor after a job end.

002 Fusing Exit Fan

*ENG

[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

006 Main Suction Fan

*ENG

[0 to 900 / 120 / 1 sec/step]

007 Paper Exit Fan

*ENG

[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

008 PSU Fan

*ENG

[0 to 900 / 120 / 1 sec/step]

009 Fusing IH Coil Fan

*ENG

010 IH Power Supply Fan

*ENG

011 Second Duct Fan

*ENG

012 Third Duct Fan

*ENG

1952

[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

[Fan Control Off Mode Time Set]


Specifies the time for fan control off mode.

001 -

1953

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 min./step]

[Extra Fan Control]


Configures the settings of extra fan control.

355

5. System Maintenance

001

Extra Fan Cooling State

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On

Displays the extra fan cooling is On or Off.

002

Extra Fan Cooling: Time:


Threshold

003

Extra Fan Cooling: Rotat:


Threshold

[0 to 180 / C2.5a: 110, C2.5b: 100 / 1 min./


step]

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 min./step]

004 Extra Fan Cooling: Start Date

*ENG

Displays the execution time and date of the extra


fan cooling.

Extra Fan Cooling Time

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 30 / 0.1 min./step]

005

1954

356

*ENG

Specifies the execution time for the extra fan cooling.


[Extra Fan Control]
Configures the settings of extra fan control.

002

Fan Cooling Time:Fusing Exit


Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

006

Fan Cooling Time:Main


Suction Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

007

Fan Cooling Time:Paper Exit


Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

008

Fan Cooling Time:PSU


Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

009

Fan Cooling Time:Fusing IH


Coil Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

010

Fan Cooling Time:IH Power


Supply Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

011

Fan Cooling Time:Second


Duct Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

012

Fan Cooling Time:Third Duct


Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

Main SP Tables-2

Main SP Tables-2
SP2-XXX (Drum)
[Charge DC Voltage] Charge Roller DC Voltage Adjustment
2005

(Paper Type, Process Speed, Color)


Paper Type > Plain, Thick 1, Thick 2
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&FINE: Low speed
Adjusts the DC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes.
Charge bias (DC component) is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore,
adjusting these settings does not effect while process control mode (SP3-041-1 Default: ON)
is activated. When deactivating process control mode with SP3-041-1, the values in these
SP modes are used for printing.

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2&FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2&FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2&FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2&FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 690 / 10 V/step]

[Charge DC: Correction]


013 PCU:Plain

*ENG

[100 to 100 / -29 / 1 V/step]

014 PCU:Thick 1

*ENG

[100 to 100 / -28 / 1 V/step]

357

5. System Maintenance

015 PCU:Thick 2&FINE

*ENG

[100 to 100 / -28 / 1 V/step]

016 HVP:Plain

*ENG

[100 to 100 / 20 / 1 V/step]

017 HVP:Thick 1

*ENG

[100 to 100 / 20 / 1 V/step]

018 HVP: Thick 2&FINE

*ENG

[100 to 100 / 29 / 1 V/step]

[Charge AC Voltage] Charge Roller AC Voltage Adjustment


(Paper Type, Process Speed, Color)
Paper Type > Plain, Thick 1, Thick 2
2006

Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&FINE: Low speed
Adjusts the AC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes.

Charge bias (AC component) is adjusted by environment correction (SP2-007-xxx to


SP2-011-xxx). These SPs are activated only when SP2-012-1 is set to "1: manual control".
001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.9 / 0.01 KV/step]

002 Plain: M

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

003 Plain: C

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.9 / 0.01 KV/step]

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

009 Thick 2&FINE: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.9 / 0.01 KV/step]

010 Thick 2&FINE: M

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

011 Thick 2&FINE: C

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

012 Thick 2&FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

2012

358

[Charge Output Control]

Main SP Tables-2

Selects the AC voltage control type.


[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 AC Voltage

*ENG

0: Process control
1: Manual control (AC voltages are decided
with SP2006.)

2013

[Environmental Correction: PCU]


Displays the environmental condition, which is
measured in absolute humidity.
[1 to 5 / / 1 /step]

Current Environmental:
001
Display

*ENG

1: LL (LL <= 4.3 g/m3)


2: ML (4.3 < ML <= 11.3 g/m3)
3: MM (11.3 < MM <= 18.0 g/m3)

4: MH (18.0 < MH <= 24.0 g/m3)


5: HH (24.0 g/m3 < HH)
Selects the environmental condition manually.
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 /step]
002 Forced Setting

*ENG

0: The environmental condition is determined


automatically.
1: LL, 2: ML, 3: MM, 4: MH, 5: HH

Absolute Humidity: Threshold


003
1

Absolute Humidity: Threshold


004
2

Absolute Humidity: Threshold


005
3

Absolute Humidity: Threshold


006
4

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold between LL and


ML.
[0 to 100 / 3.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold between ML


and MM.
[0 to 100 / 8.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold between MM


and MH.
[0 to 100 / 15.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold between MH


and HH.
[0 to 100 / 15.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

359

5. System Maintenance

007 Current Temp.: Display

*ENG

008

Current Relative Humidity:


Display

*ENG

009

Current Absolute Humidity:


Display

*ENG

010

Previous Environmental:
Display

*ENG

Displays the current temperature.


[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
Displays the current relative humidity.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1%RH/step]
Displays the absolute humidity.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Displays the previous environmental condition,
which is measured in absolute humidity.
[1 to 5 / / 1 /step]
1: LL, 2: ML, 3: MM, 4: MH, 5: HH

011 Previous Temp.: Display

*ENG

012

Previous Relative Humidity:


Display

*ENG

013

Previous Absolute Humidity:


Display

*ENG

2015

Displays the previous temperature.


[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
Displays the previous relative humidity.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1%RH/step]
Displays the previous absolute humidity.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

[Charge AC Adj: Result]

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Success
1: Out of tolerance range
2: Out of adjustable range
3: Adjustment incompleted

[Color Registration Correction] FA


2101

360

These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment and are adjusted
at the factory. However, you must input a value for SP2101-001 after replacing the laser
optics housing unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and
Adjustment" section. The value should be provided with the new laser optics housing unit.

Main SP Tables-2

001 Main Dot: Bk

*ENG

002 Main Dot: Ma

*ENG

003 Main Dot: Cy

*ENG

004 Main Dot: Ye

*ENG

005 Sub Line: Bk

*ENG

006 Sub Line: Ma

*ENG

007 Sub Line: Cy

*ENG

008 Sub Line: Ye

*ENG

2103

[512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

[Erase Margin Adjustment] (Area, Paper Size)


Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins.

001 Lead Edge Width

*ENG

002 Trail. Edge Width

*ENG

003 Left

*ENG

004 Right

*ENG

006 Duplex Trail. L Size

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1 mm/step]

007 Duplex Trail. M Size

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1 mm/step]

008 Duplex Trail. S Size

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1 mm/step]

009 Duplex Left Edge

*ENG

010 Duplex Right Edge

*ENG

011 Duplex Trail. L Size:Thick

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1 mm/step]

012 Duplex Trail. M Size:Thick

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1 mm/step]

013 Duplex Trail. S Size:Thick

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1 mm/step]

014 Duplex Left Edge:Thick

*ENG

015 Duplex Right Edge:Thick

*ENG

2105

[0 to 9.9 / 4.2 / 0.1 mm/step]

[0 to 9.9 / 2 / 0.1 mm/step]

[0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1 mm/step]

[0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1 mm/step]

[LD Power Adj.] (Process Speed, Color)


361

5. System Maintenance

Adjusts the LD power of each color for each process speed.


Each LD power setting is decided by process control.
001 High Speed: Bk

[50 to 120 / 100 / 1%/step]


Decreasing a value makes lines thinner on the
output.

002 High Speed: Ma

*ENG

003 High Speed: Cy

*ENG

004 High Speed: Ye

*ENG

Increasing a value makes lines thicker on the


output.

005 Middle Speed: Bk

*ENG

[50 to 120 / 100 / 1%/step]

006 Middle Speed: Ma

*ENG

007 Middle Speed: Cy

*ENG

Decreasing a value makes lines thinner on the


output.

008 Middle Speed: Ye

*ENG

Increasing a value makes lines thicker on the


output.

009 Low Speed: Bk

*ENG

[50 to 120 / 100 / 1%/step]

010 Low Speed: Ma

*ENG

011 Low Speed: Cy

*ENG

Decreasing a value makes lines thinner on the


output.

012 Low Speed: Ye

*ENG

2109

Increasing a value makes lines thicker on the


output.

[Test Pattern]
Generates the test pattern using "COPY Window" tab in the LCD.

003 Pattern Selection

362

*ENG

[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]

Main SP Tables-2

0 None

11. Independent Pattern (1dot)

1: Vertical Line (1dot)

12. Independent Pattern (2dot)

2: Vertical Line (2dot)

13. Independent Pattern (4dot)

3: Horizontal (1dot)

14. Trimming Area

4: Horizontal (2dot)

16: Hounds Tooth Check (Horizontal)

5: Grid Vertical Line

17: Band (Horizontal)

6: Grid Horizontal Line

18: Band (Vertical)

7: Grid pattern Small

19: Checker Flag Pattern

8: Grid pattern Large

20: Grayscale Vertical Margin

9: Argyle Pattern Small

21: Grayscale Horizontal Margin

10: Argyle Pattern Large

23: Full Dot Pattern


Specifies the color for the test pattern.

005 Color Selection

[1 to 4 / 1 / 1/step]

1: All colors, 2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan


006 Density: Bk

007 Density: Ma

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

008 Density: Cy

0: Lightest density

009 Density: Ye

2111

Specifies the color density for the test pattern.

15: Darkest density

[Forced Line Position Adj.]


Executes the fine line position adjustment twice.

001 Mode a

If this SP is not completed (NG is displayed), do


SP2111-003 first and then try this SP again.
Executes the fine line position adjustment once.

002 Mode b

If this SP is not completed, do SP2111-003 first and


then try this SP again.
Executes the rough line position adjustment once.

003 Mode c

After doing this SP, make sure to execute


SP2111-001 or -002. Otherwise, the line position
adjustment is not perfectly done.

363

5. System Maintenance

2112

[TM/ID Sensor Check] ID Sensor Check FA


[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP is used to check the ID sensors at the factory.
The results of this SP are displayed in SP2140 to
SP2145.

001 Execute

[Skew Adjustment]
2117

These SPs must be used when a new laser optics housing unit is installed or when SC2.585
occurs. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and Adjustment"
section.

001 Pulse: M

*ENG

002 Pulse: C

*ENG

003 Pulse: Y

*ENG

2118

[50 to 50 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[Skew Adjustment]

001 Execute: M

*ENG

002 Execute: C

*ENG

003 Execute: Y

*ENG

2119

364

Specifies a skew adjustment value for the skew motor M, C or Y.

Changes the current skew adjustment values to the


values specified with SP2117.
These SPs must be used when a new laser optics
housing unit is installed or when SC2.585 occurs.
For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the
"Replacement and Adjustment" section.

[Skew Adjustment Display]


Displays the current skew adjustment value for each skew motor.

001 M

*ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 Y

*ENG

[50 to 50 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

Main SP Tables-2

[Area Mag. Correction] LD Pulse Area Correction (Color, Area) FA

2150

Adjusts the magnification for each area. The main scan (297 mm) is divided into 8 areas.
Area 1 is at the front side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 8 is at the rear
side of the machine (right side of the image).
Decreasing a value makes the image shift to the left side on the print.
Increasing a value makes the image shift to the right side on the print.
1 pulse = 1/16 dot

027 Area 0: Bk

*ENG

[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1sub-dot/step]

028 Area 1: Bk

*ENG

029 Area 2: Bk

*ENG

030 Area 3: Bk

*ENG

031 Area 4: Bk

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0.

032 Area 5: Bk

*ENG

[256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step ]

033 Area 6: Bk

*ENG

034 Area 7: Bk

*ENG

035 Area 8: Bk

*ENG

036 Area 9: Bk

*ENG

037 Area 10: Bk

*ENG

038 Area 11: Bk

*ENG

039 Area 12: Bk

*ENG

079 Area 0: Ma

*ENG

Not used

080 Area 1: Ma

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0. [255to


255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

Not used

365

5. System Maintenance

366

081 Area 2: Ma

*ENG

082 Area 3: Ma

*ENG

083 Area 4: Ma

*ENG

084 Area 5: Ma

*ENG

085 Area 6: Ma

*ENG

086 Area 7: Ma

*ENG

087 Area 8: Ma

*ENG

088 Area 9: Ma

*ENG

089 Area 10: Ma

*ENG

090 Area 11: Ma

*ENG

091 Area 12: Ma

*ENG

131 Area 0: Cy

*ENG

132 Area 1: Cy

*ENG

133 Area 2: Cy

*ENG

134 Area 3: Cy

*ENG

135 Area 4: Cy

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0.

136 Area 5: Cy

*ENG

[256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

137 Area 6: Cy

*ENG

138 Area 7: Cy

*ENG

139 Area 8: Cy

*ENG

140 Area 9: Cy

*ENG

141 Area 10: Cy

*ENG

142 Area 11: Cy

*ENG

143 Area 12: Cy

*ENG

183 Area 0: Ye

*ENG

[256to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

Not used

Not used

Not used

Not used

Main SP Tables-2

184 Area 1: Ye

*ENG

185 Area 2: Ye

*ENG

186 Area 3: Ye

*ENG

187 Area 4: Ye

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0.

188 Area 5: Ye

*ENG

[256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

189 Area 6: Ye

*ENG

190 Area 7: Ye

*ENG

191 Area 8: Ye

*ENG

192 Area 9: Ye

*ENG

193 Area 10: Ye

*ENG

194 Area 11: Ye

*ENG

195 Area 12: Ye

*ENG

Not used

[Area Shad. Correct. Setting] FA


Adjusts the area correction value for each LD power.
2152

The main scan is divided into 16 areas. However, the image areas are limited from area 1
to area 14.
For BK and Magenta, area 1 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image) and
area 14 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image).
For Cyan and Yellow, area 1 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image) and
area 14 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image).

367

5. System Maintenance

368

001 Area 0: Bk

*ENG

002 Area 1: Bk

*ENG

003 Area 2: Bk

*ENG

004 Area 3: Bk

*ENG

005 Area 4: Bk

*ENG

006 Area 5: Bk

*ENG

007 Area 6: Bk

*ENG

008 Area 7: Bk

*ENG

009 Area 8: Bk

*ENG

010 Area 9: Bk

*ENG

011 Area 10: Bk

*ENG

012 Area 11: Bk

*ENG

013 Area 12: Bk

*ENG

014 Area 13: Bk

*ENG

015 Area 14: Bk

*ENG

016 Area 15: Bk

*ENG

033 Area 0: M

*ENG

This is for the synchronizing detection board.


[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area.


[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
This is for the synchronizing detection board.

Main SP Tables-2

034 Area 1: M

*ENG

035 Area 2: M

*ENG

036 Area 3: M

*ENG

037 Area 4: M

*ENG

038 Area 5: M

*ENG

039 Area 6: M

*ENG

040 Area 7: M

*ENG

041 Area 8: M

*ENG

042 Area 9: M

*ENG

043 Area 10: M

*ENG

044 Area 11: M

*ENG

045 Area 12: M

*ENG

046 Area 13: M

*ENG

047 Area 14: M

*ENG

048 Area 15: M

*ENG

065 Area 0: C

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area.


[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
This is for the synchronizing detection board.
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

369

5. System Maintenance

370

066 Area 1: C

*ENG

067 Area 2: C

*ENG

068 Area 3: C

*ENG

069 Area 4: C

*ENG

070 Area 5: C

*ENG

071 Area 6: C

*ENG

072 Area 7: C

*ENG

073 Area 8: C

*ENG

074 Area 9: C

*ENG

075 Area 10: C

*ENG

076 Area 11: C

*ENG

077 Area 12: C

*ENG

078 Area 13: C

*ENG

079 Area 14: C

*ENG

080 Area 15: C

*ENG

097 Area 0: Y

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area.


[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
This is for the synchronizing detection board.
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

Main SP Tables-2

098 Area 1: Y

*ENG

099 Area 2: Y

*ENG

100 Area 3: Y

*ENG

101 Area 4: Y

*ENG

102 Area 5: Y

*ENG

103 Area 6: Y

*ENG

104 Area 7: Y

*ENG

105 Area 8: Y

*ENG

106 Area 9: Y

*ENG

107 Area 10: Y

*ENG

108 Area 11: Y

*ENG

109 Area 12: Y

*ENG

110 Area 13: Y

*ENG

111 Area 14: Y

*ENG

112 Area 15: Y

*ENG

2160

[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area.

[Vertical Line Width] DFU


Adjusts the width of the vertical line.

001 600dpi:Bk

*ENG

002 600dpi:Ma

*ENG

003 600dpi:Cy

*ENG

004 600dpi:Ye

*ENG

005 1200dpi:Bk

*ENG

006 1200dpi:Ma

*ENG

007 1200dpi:Cy

*ENG

008 1200dpi:Ye

*ENG

[10 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

371

5. System Maintenance

2181

[Line Position Adj. Result]


Displays the values for each correction.
"Paper Int. Mag: Subdot" indicates the magnification correction value between two
sheets of paper.
"Mag.Cor. Subdot" indicates the magnification correction value.
"M. Scan Erro." indicates the shift correction value in the main scan direction.
"S. Scan Erro." Indicates the shift correction value in the sub scan direction.
"M. Cor.: Dot" indicates the dot correction value in the main scan direction.
"M. Cor.: Subdot" indicates the sub dot correction value in the main scan direction.
Bk: Black, M: Magenta, C: Cyan, Y: Yellow

372

001 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: Bk

*ENG

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

002 Mag.Cor. Subdot: Bk

*ENG

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

003 Skew: M

*ENG

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

005 M. Scan Erro.: Left: M

*ENG

006 M. Scan Erro.: Center: M

*ENG

007 M. Scan Erro.: Right: M

*ENG

008 S. Scan Erro.: Left: M

*ENG

009 S. Scan Erro.: Center: M

*ENG

010 S. Scan Erro.: Right: M

*ENG

011 M. Cor.: Dot: M

*ENG

[512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

012 M. Cor.: Subdot: M

*ENG

[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

013 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: M

*ENG

014 Mag.Cor. Subdot: M

*ENG

015 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

016 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

017 S. Cor.: 600 Line: M

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

018 S. Cor.: 600 Sub: M

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

019 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: M

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

Main SP Tables-2

020 S. Cor.: 1200 Sub: M

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

021 Skew: C

*ENG

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

023 M. Scan Erro.: Left: C

*ENG

024 M. Scan Erro.: Center: C

*ENG

025 M. Scan Erro.: Right: C

*ENG

026 S. Scan Erro.: Left: C

*ENG

027 S. Scan Erro.: Center: C

*ENG

028 S. Scan Erro.: Right: C

*ENG

029 M. Cor.: Dot: C

*ENG

[512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

030 M. Cor.: Subdot: C

*ENG

[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

031 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: C

*ENG

032 Mag.Cor. Subdot: C

*ENG

033 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

034 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

035 S. Cor.: 600 Line: C

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

036 S. Cor.: 600 Sub: C

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

037 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: C

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

038 S. Cor.: 1200 Sub: C

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

039 Skew: Y

*ENG

041 M. Scan Erro.: Left: Y

*ENG

042 M. Scan Erro.: Center: Y

*ENG

043 M. Scan Erro.: Right: Y

*ENG

044 S. Scan Erro.: Left: Y

*ENG

045 S. Scan Erro.: Center: Y

*ENG

046 S. Scan Erro.: Right: Y

*ENG

047 M. Cor.: Dot: Y

*ENG

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

[512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]


373

5. System Maintenance

048 M. Cor.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

049 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: Y

*ENG

050 Mag.Cor. Subdot: Y

*ENG

051 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

052 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

053 S. Cor.: 600 Line: Y

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

054 S. Cor.: 600 Sub: Y

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

055 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: Y

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

056 S. Cor.: 1200 Sub: Y

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

2182

[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[Line Position Adj. Offset]


(Color) M. Scan: Main scan, S. Scan: Sub-scan

001 M Magnification

*ENG

002 C Magnification

*ENG

003 Y Magnification

*ENG

Adjusts the line position manually.


[-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001%/step]

When line shifts are not corrected by the automatic line position adjustment, do this SP.
Increasing a value reduces the image in the main scan direction.
Decreasing a value enlarges the image in the main scan direction.

374

004 M. Scan: High: Dot: M

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

005 M. Scan: High: Subdot: M

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

006 M. Scan: Medium: Dot: M

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

007 M. Scan: Medium: Subdot: M

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

008 M. Scan: Low: Dot: M

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

009 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: M

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

010 M. Scan: High: Dot: C

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

011 M. Scan: High: Subdot: C

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

012 M. Scan: Medium: Dot: C

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

Main SP Tables-2

013 M. Scan: Medium: Subdot: C

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

014 M. Scan: Low: Dot: C

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

015 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: C

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

016 M. Scan: High: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

017 M. Scan: High: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

018 M. Scan: Medium: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

019 M. Scan: Medium: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

020 M. Scan: Low: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

021 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

022 S. Scan: High: Line: M

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

023 S. Scan: High: Subline: M

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

024 S. Scan: Medium: Line: M

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

025 S. Scan: Medium: Subline: M

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

026 S. Scan: Low: Line: M

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

027 S. Scan: Low: Subline: M

*ENG

Not used

028 S. Scan: High: Line: C

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

029 S. Scan: High: Subline: C

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

030 S. Scan: Medium: Line: C

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

031 S. Scan: Medium: Subline: C

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

032 S. Scan: Low: Line: C

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

033 S. Scan: Low: Subline: C

*ENG

Not used

034 S. Scan: High: Line: Y

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

035 S. Scan: High: Subline: Y

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

036 S. Scan: Medium: Line: Y

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

037 S. Scan: Medium: Subline: Y

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

038 S. Scan: Low: Line: Y

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

375

5. System Maintenance

039 S. Scan: Low: Subline: Y

*ENG

Not used

[Main Scan Length Detection Disp.]

2185

Displays/adjusts the target value for the main scan magnification correction of the line
position adjustment.
After replacing the laser optics housing unit, input the standard value for Bk provided with
the new unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement Adjustment"
section. It is not necessary to input the values for the other colors; these are automatically
adjusted after doing the line position adjustment.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

2193

001

[0 to 266667 / 249449 / 1 sub-dot/step]

[MUSIC Condition Set] Line Position Adjustment: Condition Setting


Auto Execution

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

Enables/disables the automatic line position adjustment


Page: Job End: BW+FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 500 / 1 page/step]

002 Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode after job
end.
003

Page: Job End: FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode after job end.
Page: Interrupt: BW+FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

004 Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode during
job.
005

376

Page: Interrupt: FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode during jobs.

Main SP Tables-2

Page: Stand-By: BW

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 100 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode.
006 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW printing mode reaches
the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is
satisfied.
Page: Stand-By: FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 100 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for FC printing mode in stand-by mode.
007 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in color printing mode
reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009
is satisfied.
Temp.

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 1deg/step]

008 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment
once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions.
Time

*ENG

[1 to 1440 / 300 / 1 minute/step]

009 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment once). The
timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions.
Magnification

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 0.1 / 0.01%/step]

010 Adjusts the magnification threshold for line position adjustment. If the length of the main scan
is changed by this amount since the previous MUSIC, then MSUIC is done again.
Temp. 2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 1deg/step]

011 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment
twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions.
Time 2

*ENG

[1 to 9999 / 600 / 1 minute/step]

012 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment twice). The
timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions.
Page: Power ON:BW+FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and FC printing mode at power013 on. The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW and color printing
mode reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or
SP2-193-009 is satisfied.

377

5. System Maintenance

2194
001

002

003

004

005

006

[MUSIC Execution Result] Line Position Adjustment: Execution Result


Year

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 year/step]

Displays the year of the last MUSIC execution.


Month

*ENG

[1 to 12 / 1 / 1 month/step]

Displays the month of the last MUSIC execution.


Day

*ENG

[1 to 31 / 1 / 1 day/step]

Displays the date of the last MUSIC execution.


Hour

*ENG

[0 to 23 / 0 / 1 hour/step]

Displays the time (hour) of the last MUSIC execution.


Minute

*ENG

[0 to 59 / 0 / 1 minute/step]

Displays the time (minute) of the last MUSIC execution.


Temperature

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

Displays the temperature of the last MUSIC execution.


[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

007 Execution Result

*ENG

008 Number of Execution

*ENG

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]

009 Number of Failure

*ENG

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]

010 Error Result: M

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]

011 Error Result: C

*ENG

0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed

0: Not done
1: Completed successfully
2: Cannot detect patterns
3: Fewer lines on the pattern than the target

012 Error Result: Y

*ENG

4: Not used
5: Out of the adjustment range
6 to 9: Not used

2198

378

[Music A/D Interval]


ADC Trigger Counter

Main SP Tables-2

001 ADC Trigger Counter

2220

*ENG

[7.5 to 20 / 10 / 0.1 s/step]

[Skew Origin Set]


Executes the skew motor initialization in the laser optics unit.

001 M: Skew Motor

002 C: Skew Motor

003 Y: Skew Motor

[LD Power] LD Power Control


2221

Adjusts the fixed LD power for each line speed and color.
These SPs are activated only when SP3-041-002 is set to "0".
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1%/step]

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

Increasing this value makes the image density


darker.

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2&FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2&FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2&FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2&FINE: Y

*ENG

379

5. System Maintenance

[Development DC Vias] Development DC Bias Adjustment


Adjusts the development bias.
2229

Development bias is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore, adjusting these
settings has no effect while Process Control (SP3-041-001 Default: ON) is activated.
After deactivating Process Control with SP3-041-001, the values in these SP modes are used
for printing.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2&FINE:Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2&FINE:M

*ENG

011 Thick 2&FINE:C

*ENG

012 Thick 2&FINE:Y

*ENG

2241

[Temperature/Humidity: Display]
Displays the environment temperature and humidity.

001 Temperature

[1280 to 1270 / - / 0.1deg/step]

002 Relative Humidity

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1 %RH/step]

003 Absolute Humidity

[0 to 100 / - / 0.01 g/m3/step]

2302

380

[0 to 800 / 550 / 10 V/step]

[Environmental Correction: Transfer]


Environmental Correction: Image Transfer Belt Unit

Main SP Tables-2

001

Current Environmental
Display

Displays the current environment condition.


Sets the environment condition manually.
[0 to 6 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Automatic environment control

002 Forced Setting

*ENG

1: LL (Low temperature/ Low humidity)


2: ML (Middle temperature/ Low humidity)
3: MM (Middle temperature/ Middle humidity)
4: MH (Middle temperature/ High humidity)
5: HH (High temperature/ High humidity)

003

Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 1

*ENG

004

Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 2

*ENG

005

Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 3

*ENG

006

Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 4

*ENG

007 Temp Threshold

2308

*ENG

Adjusts the threshold value between LL and ML.


[0 to 100 / 4 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

Adjusts the threshold value between ML and MM.


[0 to 100 / 8 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between MM and MH.
[0 to 100 / 16 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between MH and HH.
[0 to 100 / 24 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
[5 to 30 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

[Paper Size Correction]


Adjusts the threshold value for the paper size correction.
[0 to 350 / 297 / 1 mm/step]

001 Threshold 1

*ENG

Threshold 1 paper:
Paper is detected as "S1" size.
[0 to 350 / 257 / 1 mm/step]

002 Threshold 2

*ENG

Threshold 2 paper Threshold 1:


Paper is detected as "S2" size.

381

5. System Maintenance

[0 to 350 / 210 / 1 mm/step]


003 Threshold 3

*ENG

Threshold 3 paper Threshold 2:


Paper is detected as "S3" size.
[0 to 350 / 148 / 1 mm/step]
Threshold 4 paper Threshold 3:

004 Threshold 4

*ENG

Paper is detected as "S4" size.


Paper Threshold 4:
Paper is detected as "S5" size.

2311

[Non Image Area: Bias]

001 Image Transfer

*ENG

Adjusts the bias of the image transfer belt between


images. This value is added to the value of the
image transfer belt bias.
[10 to 250 / 100 / 5 %/step]

002 Paper Transfer

*ENG

Adjusts the bias of the paper transfer roller between


images.
[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 V/step]

2326
001

002

[Transfer Roller CL: Bias] Transfer Roller Cleaning: Bias Adjustment


Positive

*ENG

[0 to 2100 / 500 / 100 V /step]

Adjusts the positive voltage of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
Negative

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 10 %/step]

Adjusts the negative current of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
Positive

*ENG

[0 to 2100 / 2000 / 100 V/step]

003 Adjusts the negative current limit of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer
roller.
004 Negative

2351

382

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 10 %/step]

[Common: BW: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: B/W: Bias Adjustment


Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

Main SP Tables-2

001

002

003

2357

001

002

003

004

005

006

007

008

ITB unit: Plain

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 2 paper or FINE mode.
[Common: FC: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: Full Color: Bias Adjustment
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
ITB unit: Plain: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: M

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: C

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 28 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: M

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: C

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 14 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for thick 1 paper.

383

5. System Maintenance

009

ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for Thick 2 and fine.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: M

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]

010 Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for Thick 2 and
fine.
011

ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: C

*ENG

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for Thick 2 and fine.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 14 / 1 A]

012 Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for Thick 2 and
fine.
2360

384

[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]

[Common: BW Environment Correction]

001 ITB unit: Plain

*ENG

002 ITB unit: Thick 1

*ENG

003 ITB unit: Thick 2

*ENG

004 ITB unit: Plain: Bk

*ENG

005 ITB unit: Plain: M

*ENG

006 ITB unit: Plain: C

*ENG

007 ITB unit: Plain: Y

*ENG

008 ITB unit: Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

009 ITB unit: Thick 1: M

*ENG

010 ITB unit: Thick 1: C

*ENG

011 ITB unit: Thick 1: Y

*ENG

012 ITB unit: Thick 2: Bk

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 31 / 1 /step]

013 ITB unit: Thick 2: M

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]

014 ITB unit: Thick 2: C

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

015 ITB unit: Thick 2: Y

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 13/ 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 31 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]

Main SP Tables-2

[Plain: Bias]
2401

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for plain paper.


Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Page

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

004 Separation DC: 1200: 2nd side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[Plain: Bias: BW]


2403

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 7 / 1 A /step]

004

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

[Plain: Bias: FC]


2407

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 27 / 1 A /step]

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]

004

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

385

5. System Maintenance

[Plain: Paper Size Correction]


2411

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

386

001

Paper Transfer: Plain : 1st


Side: S1

*ENG

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S1

*ENG

003

Separation DC: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

004

Separation DC: 1200: 2nd


Side

*ENG

005

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side:


S2

*ENG

006

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S2

*ENG

007

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side: S2

*ENG

008

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


Side: S2

*ENG

009

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side:


S3

*ENG

010

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S3

*ENG

011

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side: S3

*ENG

012

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


Side: S3

*ENG

013

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side:


S4

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)

[100 to 600 / 105 / 5%/step]


297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 150 / 5%/step]
[100 to 600 / 110 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)

[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]


275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)

[100 to 600 / 300 / 5%/step]


[100 to 600 / 115 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)

Main SP Tables-2

014

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S4

*ENG

015

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side: S4

*ENG

016

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


Side: S4

*ENG

017

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side:


S5

*ENG

018

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S5

*ENG

019

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side: S5

*ENG

020

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


Side: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]


210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 240 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 340 / 5%/step]
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 300 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[100 to 600 / 400 / 5%/step]

[Plain: Leading Edge Correction] Plain Paper: Leading Edge Correction


Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.

2421

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2422.


001

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st


Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


004
side

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


*ENG

387

5. System Maintenance

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2401 is multiplied by these SPs values.

2421
005-008

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2422.


005

Separation DC: Plain: 1st


Side

*ENG

006

Separation DC: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

Separation DC: 1200: 1st


007
Side

*ENG

008

Separation DC: 1200: 2nd


Side

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

*ENG

[Plain: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2422

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side


002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

004

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

388

*ENG

*ENG

006

Separation DC: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

007

Separation DC: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

008

Separation DC: 1200: 2nd


Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

Main SP Tables-2

[Plain: Trailing Edge Correction] Plain Paper: Trailing Edge Correction


2423

Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2424.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

004

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006

Separation DC: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

007

Separation DC: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

008

Separation DC: 1200: 2nd


Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Plain: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2424

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

389

5. System Maintenance

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

008 Separation DC: 1200: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thin: Bias]
2451

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thin paper.


Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 2000 / 10 V/
step]

[Thin: Bias: BW]


2453

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

[Thin: Bias: FC]


2457

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

390

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

Main SP Tables-2

[Thin: Paper Size Correction]


2461

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

009 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper
width)

[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]


013 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Pape r


width)

017 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]

[Thin: Leading Edge Correction] Thin Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2471

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2471

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2451 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.

391

5. System Maintenance

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thin: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2472

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed,

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thin: Trailing Edge Correction] Thin Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2473

Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2474.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thin: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2474

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

392

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

Main SP Tables-2

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2480

[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Thin: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 2000 / 10 V/step]

2481
001

2482
001

2483
001

2484

[Glossy: Bias]
Separation DC: 1st Side

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for glossy paper.


[Glossy: Bias: BW]
Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for glossy paper in black-and-white mode.
[Glossy: Bias: FC]
Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for glossy paper in full color mode.
[Glossy: Paper Size Correction]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

393

5. System Maintenance

013 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

017 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

005 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]]

2485

2486

[Glossy: Leading Edge Correction]

[Glossy: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2487

[Glossy: Trailing Edge Correction]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2488

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5 %/step]

[Glossy: Switch Trail. Edge]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2489

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Glossy: Environment Correction]

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[Thick 1: Bias]
2501

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick 1 paper.


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

394

Main SP Tables-2

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 1000 / 10 V/step]

[Thick 1: Bias: BW]


2502

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 24 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

[Thick 1: Bias: FC]


2507

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thick 1: Paper Size Correction]


2511

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 105 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)

395

5. System Maintenance

[100 to 600 / 130 / 5%/step]


006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

007 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 110 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 115 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Plain 1: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 190 / 5%/step]

014 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

396

015 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

017 Paper Transfer: Plain 1: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

019 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 220 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

Main SP Tables-2

[Thick 1: Leading Edge Correction] Thick 1 Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2521

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2522.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 1: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2522

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain 1: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain 1: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain 1: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

397

5. System Maintenance

[Thick 1: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2523

Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2524.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 1: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2524

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2530

398

[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Thick 1: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

Main SP Tables-2

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW:2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

2551

[Thick 2: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick 2 paper.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

2553

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[Thick 2: Bias: BW]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 2 paper in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 7 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

2558

[Thick 2: Bias: FC]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 2 paper in full color mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 16 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thick 2: Paper Size Correction]


2561

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)

399

5. System Maintenance

[100 to 600 / 105 / 5%/step]


003 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 110 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 260 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

007 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 430 / 5%/step]

008 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

009 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 600 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick 2: Leading Edge Correction] Thick 2 Paper: Leading Edge Correction


2571

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.

400

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Main SP Tables-2

2571

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2551 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 2: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2572

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

5
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2mm/step]

[Thick 2: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 2 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction


2573

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2574.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 2: Switch Trailing Edge Correction]


2574

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

401

5. System Maintenance

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

2580

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 2 Environment Correction]

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 53 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

2601

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for OHP.


*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[OHP: Bias: BW]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for OHP in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer

2608

[0 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[OHP: Bias]

001 Separation DC

2603

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

[OHP: Bias: FC]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for OHP in full color mode.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[OHP: Paper Size Correction]


2611

402

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.

Main SP Tables-2

001 Paper Transfer: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: S2

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: S3

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: S4

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 200 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 260 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 330 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[OHP: Leadin Edge Correction] OHP: Leading Edge Correction


2621

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.

001 Paper Transfer

2621

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2601 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.

002 Separation DC

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[OHP: Switch Timing: Leadn. Edge]


2622

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

002 Separation DC

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

403

5. System Maintenance

[OHP: Trailing Edge Correction] OHP: Trailing Edge Correction


2623

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2624.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

002 Separation DC

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[OHP: Trailing Edge Correction]


2624

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[100 to 0 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

002 Separation DC

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

001 Separation DC

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

002 Paper Transfer: BW

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

003 Paper Transfer: FC

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

2630

2650

[OHP: Environment Correction]

[Thick3: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick paper 3.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

2651

404

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

[0 to 4000 / 1000 / 10 V/step]

[Thick3: Bias: BW]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

Main SP Tables-2

2652

[Thick3: Bias: FC]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in full color mode.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thick3: Paper Size Correction]


2653

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


003 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

004 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 260 / 5%/step]
S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

007 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 430 / 5%/step]

008 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)

405

5. System Maintenance

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


009 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 600 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick 3: Leading Edge Correction] Thick 3 Paper: Leading Edge Correction


2654

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2654

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2650 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 3: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2655

406

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

Main SP Tables-2

[Thick 3: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 3 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction


2656

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2657.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 3: Trailing Edge Correction]


2657

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 3: Environment Correction] Thick 3 Paper: MM Environment Coefficient Adjustment


2660

Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2650 is multiplied by these SP values.
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 55 / 1 /step]

407

5. System Maintenance

006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2st Side

2670

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[Thick4: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick paper 4.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

2671

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[Thick4: Bias: BW]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 4 in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

2672

[Thick4: Bias: FC]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 4 in full color mode.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thick4: Paper Size Correction]


2673

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S3

408

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)

Main SP Tables-2

[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]


004 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

007 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 260 / 5%/step]
S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 430 / 5%/step]

008 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


009 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 600 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick 4: Leading Edge Correction] Thick 4 Paper: Leading Edge Correction


2674

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2675.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2674

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2670 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.

409

5. System Maintenance

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 4: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2675

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 4: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 4 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction


2676

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2677.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 4: Trailing Edge Correction]


2677

410

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

Main SP Tables-2

[Thick 4: Environment Correction] Thick 4 Paper: MM Environment Coefficient Adjustment


2680

Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2670 is multiplied by these SP values.
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd Side:

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 55 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[Special1: Bias]
2751

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for special paper 1.


Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step

[Special1: Bias: BW]


2753

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode.
P Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

411

5. System Maintenance

[Special1: Bias: FC]


2757

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Special1: Paper Size Correction]


2761

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)

009 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

412

014 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

017 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

Main SP Tables-2

[Special 1: Leading Edge Correction] Special 1 Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2771

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

2771

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2751 is multiplied by these SP values.

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.


005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 1: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2772

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

413

5. System Maintenance

[Special 1: Trailing Edge Correction] Special 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2773

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2774.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 1: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2774

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2780

414

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Special 1: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]

Main SP Tables-2

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW:2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[Special2: Bias]
2801

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for special paper 2.


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[Special2: Bias: BW]


2803

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 A /step]

[Special2: Bias: FC]


2807

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
415

5. System Maintenance

[Special2: Paper Size Correction]


2811

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)


[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

013 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

416

014 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

017 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

Main SP Tables-2

[Special 2: Leading Edge Correction] Special 2 Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2821

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

2821

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2801 is multiplied by these SP values.

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.


005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 12001st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 2: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2822

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

417

5. System Maintenance

[Special 2: Trailing Edge Correction] Special 2 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2823

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2824.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 2: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2824

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2830

418

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Special 2: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]

Main SP Tables-2

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]

007 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[Special 3: Bias]
2851

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for special paper 3.


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[Special 3: Bias: BW]


2852

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

[Special 3: Bias: FC]


2857

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
419

5. System Maintenance

[Special 3: Paper Size Correction]


2861

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed

001 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)


[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

010 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

420

014 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

017 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

Main SP Tables-2

[Special 3: Leading Edge Correction] Special 3 Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2871

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2871

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2851 is multiplied by these SP values.

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.


005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 3: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2872

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Page

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

421

5. System Maintenance

[Special 3: Trailing Edge Correction] Special 3 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2873

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2874.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Page

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 3: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2874

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Page

*ENG

2880

422

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Special 3: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]

Main SP Tables-2

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW:2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC:2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[Dev Rvs Time] Development Roller Reverse Time


2905

Specified the time of the development roller reverse rotation after the development unit has
stopped. The reverse rotation of the development roller is used for removing dust from the
development roller.

001 K

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 80 / 10 msec/step]

[Dev Rvs Threshold Counter]


005

All

*ENG

[0 to 400000 / 4000/ 10 mm/step]

Specified the threshold distance for the development roller reverse mode. This sp refers to
the counters for SP2905-006 to -009.
[Dev Rvs Counter]
006 K

*ENG

007 M

*ENG

008 C

*ENG

009 Y

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step]

423

5. System Maintenance

[ACS Setting (FC to Bk)]

2907

Adjusts the threshold for moving away the image transfer belt from the color PCDUs. This SP
moves the image transfer belt away from the color PCDUs when the number of B/W image
printouts reaches the number of sheets specified with this SP after consecutive full color image
printouts in the full color mode.
If this SP is set to "0", the image transfer belt does not move away.

001 Continuous Bk Pages


2920

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

[Transfer Motor Control]


0: Encorder 1 :FG

*ENG

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 Selects the speed control mode for the ITB.


If SC443 occurs and machine does not recover, change this setting to "1".
SC443 Count

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]

002 Displays the number of the ITB encodre error. SC443 is displayed if this counter counts to
"3".
[SecondaryFB: Threshold] Paper Transfer Roller Feed-back: Threshold Adjustment
2930

Adjusts the threshold between high resistance (division 1) and low resistance (division 2) at
the paper transfer roller. This SP affects SP2931 to SP2939.

001 Voltage
2960
001

2970

[0 to 7000 / 6000 / 10 V/step]

[Process Interval]
Additional Time

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

Adjusts the additional time for ending the machine's process.


[Cleaning After JOB]
No Refresh

001

*ENG

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 50 / 1 /step]
0: No cleaning

Specifies the threshold sheets for the cleaning of the paper transfer roller without the refresh
mode.

424

Main SP Tables-2

002 Refresh

2971
001

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: No cleaning, 1: Cleaning

T1 Non Image Area ON Timing


Standard Speed

*ENG

[400 to 290 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

Adjusts the timing for the non-image area bias of the image transfer roller.

002 Medium Speed

*ENG

[790 to 410 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

003 Low Speed

*ENG

[790 to 410 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

001 Standard Speed

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

002 Medium Speed

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

003 Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

*ENG

[0 to 5000 / 0 / 10 page/step]

001 Standard Speed

*ENG

[0 to 940 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

002 Medium Speed

*ENG

[0 to 940 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

003 Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 940 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

001 Continuous Job Page

*ENG

[0 to 300 / 100 / 10 page/step]

002 OPC Drum Idling Time BW

*ENG

[0 to 600 / 30 / 10 sec/step]

003 OPC Drum Idling Time FC

*ENG

[0 to 600 / 30 / 10 sec/step]

2972

2973

B/W Image Request Timing

Forced Process Down Threshold

001 2974

2980

2990

OPC PreCharge Time Control

Print Duty Control

425

5. System Maintenance

426

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 Duty Control State

*ENG

002 Duty Control Thresh Time

*ENG

[0 to 195 / 30 / 10 min./step]

003 Duty Control Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

0: No limit, 1: Limit

004

Forced CPM Down Thresh:


No Duty Control

*ENG

[0 to 5000 / 0 / 1 page/step]

005

Drum Stop Time: No Duty


Control

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 500 / 10 msec/step]

006

ITB Stop Time: No Duty


Control

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 500 / 10 msec/step]

007

Forced CPM Down Thresh:


Duty Control

*ENG

[0 to 5000 / 1 / 1 page/step]

008 Drum Stop Time: Duty Control

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 1500 / 10 msec/step]

009 ITB Stop Time: Duty Control

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 1500 / 10 msec/step]

010 Duty Control: Start Time

*ENG

Displays the time of the duty control execution.

Main SP Tables-3

Main SP Tables-3
SP3-XXX (Process)
3011

[Process Cont. Manual Execution]

001 Normal

002 Density Adjustment

Executes the normal process control manually


(potential control).
Check the result with SP3-325-001 and
3-012-001 after executing this SP.
Executes the toner density adjustment manually.
Executes the process control that is normally done
before ACC.

003 Pre-ACC

004 Full MUSIC

Executes the process control that is normally done


at the same time as MUSIC. This SP does the
MUSIC (line position adjustment) twice.

Executes the process control that is normally done


at the same time as MUSIC. This SP does the
MUSIC (line position adjustment) once.

005 Normal MUSIC

The type of process control is selected with


SP3-041-004.

[Process Cont. Check Result] Process Control Self-check Result


Displays the result of the latest process control self-check.
3012

All colors are displayed. The results are displayed in the order Y C M K
e.g., 11 (Y) 99 (C) 11 (M) 11 (K): The self-check for Cyan failed but the others were
successful.
See the "Error Condition Tables" in the "Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions" section
for details.

427

5. System Maintenance

001 History: Latest

*ENG

002 Result: Latest 1

*ENG

003 Result: Latest 2

*ENG

004 Result: Latest 3

*ENG

005 Result: Latest 4

*ENG

006 Result: Latest 5

*ENG

007 Result: Latest 6

*ENG

008 Result: Latest 7

*ENG

009 Result: Latest 8

*ENG

010 Result: Latest 9

*ENG

3013

[T Sensor Initial Set: Execution] Developer Initialization Setting

001 Execution: ALL

002 Execution: COL

003 Execution: Bk

004 Execution: M

005 Execution: C

006 Execution: Y

3014

[1111 to 99999999 / 99999999 / 1/step]

Executes the developer initialization for each color.

[T Sensor Initial Set Result: Display]


Developer Initialization Result: Display
Display: YCMK

*ENG

[0 to 9999 / 9999 / 1 /step ]


1: Success, 2 to 9: Failure

Displays the developer initialization result. See section "Developer Initialization Result" in the
001 "Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions" section for details on the meaning of each
code.
All colors are displayed. Values are displayed in the order Y C M Bk.
e.g., 1 (Y) 2 (C) 1 (M) 1 (Bk): Initialization of Cyan failed but the others succeeded.

428

Main SP Tables-3

3015

[Forced Toner Supply: Execute] Forced Toner Supply ([Color])

001 Execution: ALL

002 Execution: COL

003 Execution: Bk

004 Execution: M

005 Execution: C

006 Execution: Y

3016

Executes the manual toner supply to the


development unit.

[Forced Toner Supply: Setting] Forced Toner Supply Setting ([Color])


Specifies the manual toner supply time for each color.

001 Supply Time: Bk

*ENG

002 Supply Time: M

*ENG

003 Supply Time: C

*ENG

004 Supply Time: Y

*ENG

3041

[0 to 30 / 4 / 1 sec/step]

[Process Control Type]


[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step ] Alphanumeric

001

Voltage Control

*ENG

0: FIXED (Use the fixed values for the charge DC bias


and development DC bias set with SP2-005 and
SP2-229.)
1: CONTROL

Enables or disables potential control.


[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
002

LD Power Control

*ENG

0: FIXED (at the value in SP2221-xxx)


1: CONTROL (adjusted by process control)

Selects the LD power control mode.

429

5. System Maintenance

AutoControl Prohibition
003 Set

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Permit, 1: Forbid

Enables or disables the automatic process control prohibition.


[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
0: Not Executed
004

Pre-ACC

*ENG

1: Process Control
2: TC Control (TD Adjustment)
3: Not used

Selects the process control mode that is done before ACC.


[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]

Pattern Calculation
005 Method

*ENG

0: FIXED
1: INITIALIZED
2: CALCULATED

Selects the process control method.


3043

[TD Adjustment Mode]


Repeat Number: Power ON

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at power on.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
001 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat Number: Initialization

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at the developer
initialization.
002

0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,


4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled

430

Main SP Tables-3

Repeat Number: Non-use

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment in stand by mode.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
003 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat Number: ACC

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at ACC.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
004 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)

6 to 9: Disabled
005

Repeat Number: Recovery

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]

Not used
Repeat Number: Job End

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at job end.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
006 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat: Interrupt

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]

007 Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment during printing.
DFU
008

Toner Supply Coefficient

*ENG

[0 to 25.5 / 10 / 0.1 sec/step]

Adjusts the time for the toner supply mode when a toner density is detected to be low.

431

5. System Maintenance

Consumption pattern: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

009 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the black toner density when toner density
is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: M

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

010 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the magenta toner density when toner
density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: C

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

011 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the cyan toner density when toner density
is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: Y

*ENG

012 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the yellow toner density when toner
density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
013

014

015

016

017

T1 Bias: Bk

*ENG

018

[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Black.


T2 Bias: M

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Magenta.


T3 Bias: C

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Cyan.


T4 Bias: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 28 / 1 A/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Yellow.


Developer Mixing Time

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the developer mixing time at the toner density adjustment.


Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: Bk

432

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-001) exceed the target values (SP3611-005) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).

Main SP Tables-3

Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: M


019

*ENG

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-002) exceed the target values (SP3611-006) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: C

020

*ENG

3044

In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-003) exceed the target values (SP3611-007) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.

In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-004) exceed the target values (SP3611-008) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
[Toner Supply Type] Toner Supply Type ([Color])
Selects the toner supply method type.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

3045

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.

Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: Y


021

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
0: FIXED (with the supply rates stored with SP 3401)
1: PID (Vtref_Fixed)
2: PID (Vtref_Control)
3: Not used

[Toner End Detection: Set]


Enables/disables the toner alert display on the LCD.

001 ON/OFF

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step] 0: Detect, 1: Not Detect

[Toner End Recovery]


3102

Adjusts the number of times toner supply is attempted for each color when the TD sensor
continues to detect toner end during toner recovery.

433

5. System Maintenance

001 Repeat: Bk

*ENG

002 Repeat: M

*ENG

003 Repeat: C

*ENG

004 Repeat: Y

*ENG

3131

[TE Count m: Display]


Display the number of toner end detections for each color.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

3201

[1 to 20 / 5 / 1 time/step]

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 time/step]

[TD Sensor: Vt Display]


Display the current voltage of the TD sensor for each color.

001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: M

*ENG

003 Current: C

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0.01 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vt Shift: Display/Set]


3211

Adjusts the Vt correction value for each line speed.


Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

434

001 Thick 1 Shift: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.35 / 0.01 V/step]

002 Thick 1 Shift: M

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.33 / 0.01 V/step]

003 Thick 1 Shift: C

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.28 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Thick 1 Shift: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.29 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Thick 2 & FINE Shift: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.35 / 0.01 V/step]

Main SP Tables-3

3221

006 Thick 2 & FINE Shift: M

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.33 / 0.01 V/step]

007 Thick 2 & FINE Shift: C

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.28 / 0.01 V/step]

008 Thick 2 & FINE Shift: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.29 / 0.01 V/step]

009 Mid TCShift: Bk

*ENG

010 Mid TCShift: M

*ENG

011 Mid TCShift: C

*ENG

012 Mid TCShift: Y

*ENG

013 Low TCShift: Bk

*ENG

014 Low TCShift: M

*ENG

015 Low TCShift: C

*ENG

016 Low TCShift: Y

*ENG

[-0.5 to 0.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[-0.5 to 0.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtcnt: Display/Set]
Displays or adjusts the current Vtcnt value for each color.
001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: M

*ENG

003 Current: C

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

[2 to 5 / 3.86 / 0.01 V/step]

005-008 Displays or adjusts the Vtcnt value for each color at developer initialization. DFU

3222

005 Initial: Bk

*ENG

006 Initial: M

*ENG

007 Initial: C

*ENG

008 Initial: Y

*ENG

[2 to 5 / 3.86 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtref: Display/Set]
Displays or adjusts the current Vtref value for each color.

435

5. System Maintenance

001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: M

*ENG

003 Current: C

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 3 / 0.01 V/step]

005-008 Displays or adjusts the Vtref value for each color at developer initialization. DFU

005 Initial: Bk

*ENG

006 Initial: M

*ENG

007 Initial: C

*ENG

008 Initial: Y

*ENG

009-012 Displays and adjusts Vtref correction by pixel coverage for each color. DFU

3239

009 Pixel Correction: Bk

*ENG

010 Pixel Correction: M

*ENG

011 Pixel Correction: C

*ENG

012 Pixel Correction: Y

*ENG

[-5 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtref Correction: Setting]


Adjusts the parameter for Vtref correction at the process control.
001 (+)Consumption: Bk

*ENG

002 (+)Consumption: M

*ENG

003 (+)Consumption: C

*ENG

004 (+)Consumption: Y

*ENG

005 (-)Consumption: Bk

*ENG

006 (-)Consumption: M

*ENG

007 (-)Consumption: C

*ENG

008 (-)Consumption: Y

*ENG

009-012 Threshold for development gamma rank.

436

[0 to 5.5 / 3 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 1 / 0.05 / 0.01 V/step]

Main SP Tables-3

009 P Rank 1 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0.2 / 0.1 /step]

010 P Rank 2 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0.05 / 0.1 /step]

011 P Rank 3 Threshold

*ENG

[-2 to 0 / -0.05 / 0.1 /step]

012 P Rank 4 Threshold

*ENG

[-2 to 0 / -0.2 / 0.1 /step]

013-014 Threshold for image density rank on the image transfer belt.

3241

013 T Rank 1 Threshold

*ENG

[-1 to 0 / -0.2 / 0.01 V/step]

014 T Rank 2 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.2 / 0.01 V/step]

[Background Potential Setting]

001 Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

002 Coefficient: M

*ENG

These are parameters for calculating the charge


bias referring to the development bias at process
control.

003 Coefficient: C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 0 / 1 /step]

004 Coefficient: Y

*ENG

DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 + 0.001


x these vales) + SP3-241-005 to -008

005 Offset: Bk

*ENG

006 Offset: M

*ENG

These are additional values for calculating the


charge bias referring to the development bias at
process control.

007 Offset: C

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 140 / 1 V/step]

008 Offset: Y

*ENG

DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 + 0.001


x SP3-241-001 to -004) + these values

3242

[LD Power Setting]


Adjusts the coefficient for LD power control value at the process control.

001 StdSpd:Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 101 / 1 /step]

002 StdSpd:Coefficient: M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 62 / 1 /step]

003 StdSpd:Coefficient: C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 99 / 1 /step]

004 StdSpd:Coefficient: Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 74 / 1 /step]

005 StdSpd:Offset: Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 69 / 1 /step]

006 StdSpd:Offset: M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 95 / 1 /step]

437

5. System Maintenance

007 StdSpd:Offset: C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 63 / 1 /step]

008 StdSpd:Offset: Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 82 / 1 /step]

009 MidSpd:coef:Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 101 / 1 /step]

010 MidSpd:coef:M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 62 / 1 /step]

011 MidSpd:coef:C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 99 / 1 /step]

012 MidSpd:coef:Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 74 / 1 /step]

013 MidSpd:offset:Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 69 / 1 /step]

014 MidSpd:offset:M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 95 / 1 /step]

015 MidSpd:offset:C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 63 / 1 /step]

016 MidSpd:offset:Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 82 / 1 /step]

017 LowSpd:Coef:Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 81 / 1 /step]

018 LowSpd:Coef:M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 61 / 1 /step]

019 LowSpd:Coef:C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 86 / 1 /step]

020 LowSpd:Coef:Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 67 / 1 /step]

021 LowSpd:offset:Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 82 / 1 /step]

022 LowSpd:offset:M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 92 / 1 /step]

023 LowSpd:offset:C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 68 / 1 /step]

024 LowSpd:offset:Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 87 / 1 /step]

3251

438

[Coverage]
These (-001 to -016) are coefficients for SP3-222-009 to -012.
001 Latest Pixel: Bk

*ENG

002 Latest Pixel: M

*ENG

Displays the latest coverage for each color.

003 Latest Pixel: C

*ENG

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]

004 Latest Pixel: Y

*ENG

Main SP Tables-3

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
005-008 "Average S" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-017.
005 Average S: Bk

*ENG

006 Average S: M

*ENG

007 Average S: C

*ENG

008 Average S: Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
009-012 "Average M" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-018.
009 Average M: Bk

*ENG

010 Average M: M

*ENG

011 Average M: C

*ENG

012 Average M: Y

*ENG

5
[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
013-016 "Average L" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3-251-019.
013 Average L: Bk

*ENG

014 Average L: M

*ENG

015 Average L: C

*ENG

016 Average L: Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

017-019 Adjusts the threshold for SP3-251-005 to -016.


017 Total Page Setting: S

*ENG

[1 to 100 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

018 Total Page Setting: M

*ENG

[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

019 Total Page Setting: L

*ENG

[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]

020-023 Adjusts the threshold for SP3-251-024 to -027.


020 Total Page Setting: S2

*ENG

[1 to 100 / 40 / 1 sheet/step]

439

5. System Maintenance

021 Total Page Setting: M2

*ENG

[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

022 Total Page Setting: L2

*ENG

[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]

024-027 Displays the latest coverage ratio for each color.


024 Latest Coverage: Bk

*ENG

025 Latest Coverage: M

*ENG

026 Latest Coverage: C

*ENG

027 Latest Coverage: Y

*ENG

028

5
3311

[0 to 100 / - / 0.01 %/step]

Displays the threshold of whether to perform developer churning or not.


DevMix Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]

[ID Sensor Detection Value: Voffset]


Displays the ID sensor (regular) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.
001 Voffset reg: Bk

*ENG

002 Voffset reg: M

*ENG

003 Voffset reg: C

*ENG

004 Voffset reg: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

005-007 Displays the ID sensor (diffusion) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.
005 Voffset dif: M

*ENG

006 Voffset dif: C

*ENG

007 Voffset dif: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

008-010 Displays the ID sensor offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.

3321

440

008 Voffset TM (Front)

*ENG

009 Voffset TM (Center)

*ENG

010 Voffset TM (Rear)

*ENG

[Vsg Adjustment: Execution]

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

Main SP Tables-3

010 P/TM Sensor All

3322

Execute the ID sensor initialization setting for


all sensors

[Vsg Adjustment Result: Vsg]


Displays the result value of the Vsg adjustment for each sensor.

001 Vsg reg: Bk

*ENG

002 Vsg reg: M

*ENG

003 Vsg reg: C

*ENG

004 Vsg reg: Y

*ENG

005 Vsg dif: M

*ENG

006 Vsg dif: C

*ENG

007 Vsg dif: Y

*ENG

008 Vsg TM (Front)

*ENG

009 Vsg TM (Center)

*ENG

010 Vsg TM (Rear)

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vsg Adjustment Result]


3325

Displays the result of the Vsg adjustment.


The displayed numbers mean the result of each sensor (sensor for Front, sensor for Bk, sensor
for Cyan, sensor for Center, sensor for Magenta, sensor for Yellow and sensor for Rear).

441

5. System Maintenance

001 History: Latest

*ENG

002 Result: Latest 1

*ENG

003 Result: Latest 2

*ENG

004 Result: Latest 3

*ENG

005 Result: Latest 4

*ENG

006 Result: Latest 5

*ENG

007 Result: Latest 6

*ENG

008 Result: Latest 7

*ENG

009 Result: Latest 8

*ENG

010 Result: Latest 9

*ENG

3401

9: Unexpected error
3: Offset voltage error
2: Vsg adjustment value error
1: O.K

[Fixed Supply Mode]


Adjusts the toner supply rate in the fixed toner supply mode.

001 Fixed Rate: Bk

*ENG

002 Fixed Rate: M

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 %/step]

003 Fixed Rate: C

*ENG

These SPs are used only when SP3-044 is set to


"1".

004 Fixed Rate: Y

*ENG

3411

[Toner Supply Rate: Display]


Displays the current toner supply rate.

001 Latest: Bk

*ENG

002 Latest: M

*ENG

003 Latest: C

*ENG

004 Latest: Y

*ENG

3421

442

[111 to 999 / 999 / 1 /step]

[Toner Supply Range]

[0 to 100 / - / 1 %/step]

Main SP Tables-3

001 Upper Limit: Bk

*ENG

002 Upper Limit: M

*ENG

Adjusts the toner supply rate during


printing.

003 Upper Limit: C

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 100 / 1%/step]

004 Upper Limit: Y

*ENG

005 Minimum Supply Time: Bk

*ENG

006 Minimum Supply Time: M

*ENG

Adjusts the minimum toner supply time.

007 Minimum Supply Time: C

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]

008 Minimum Supply Time: Y

*ENG

3501

[Process Control Target M/A]


Adjusts the target M/A.

001 Maximum M/A: Bk

*ENG

002 Maximum M/A: M

*ENG

003 Maximum M/A: C

*ENG

004 Maximum M/A: Y

*ENG

3510

[0 to 1 / 0.444 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]

[Pixel Adj. Sheet Counter: Display]


Displays the total page counter for each adjustment mode.

001 Potential Control: BW

*ENG

002 Potential Control: FC

*ENG

003 Power ON: BW

*ENG

004 Power ON: FC

*ENG

005 MUSIC: BW

*ENG

006 MUSIC: FC

*ENG

007 Vsg Adj.

*ENG

008 Charge AC Control

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]

443

5. System Maintenance

009 MUSIC: Power ON: BW

*ENG

010 MUSIC: Power ON: FC

*ENG

3511

444

[Execution Interval: Setting]


Adjusts the threshold for each adjustment mode.

001 Job End: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]

002 Job End: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]

003 Interrupt: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

004 Interrupt: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]

005 Initial: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]

006 Initial: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]

007 Vsg Adj. Counter

*ENG

008 Charge AC Control Counter

*ENG

019 Environmental Correction

*ENG

020 Gamma Correction

*ENG

021 Non-use Time Correction

*ENG

022 Correction Coefficient 1: JE: BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.2 / 0.01 page/step]

023 Correction Coefficient 2: JE: BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

024 Correction Coefficient 1: JE: FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]

025 Correction Coefficient 2: JE: FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Not Correct (OFF), 1: Correct (ON)
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Not Correct (OFF), 1: Correct (ON)
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Not Correct (OFF), 1: Correct (ON)

026

Correction Coefficient 1: Interrupt:


BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01/step]

027

Correction Coefficient 2: Interrupt:


BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

Main SP Tables-3

028

Correction Coefficient 1: Interrupt:


FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.01/step]

029

Correction Coefficient 2: Interrupt:


FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

030 Max. Number Correction Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 5 / 1/step]

031 Max. Number Correction Counter

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]

3512

[Image Quality Adj.: Interval]


Adjusts the timing for execution of process control and line position adjustment.

001 During Job

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 page/step]

002 During Stand-by

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 minute/step]

[PCU Motor Stop Time: Bk]


3513

Displays the last time that the PCDU motors stopped.


These are used for process control execution timing.

001 Year

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1/step]

002 Month

*ENG

[1 to 12 / 1 / 1/step]

003 Date

*ENG

[1 to 31 / 1 / 1/step]

004 Hour

*ENG

[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]

005 Minute

*ENG

[0 to 59 / 0 / 1/step]

[Environmental Display: Job End]


3514

Displays the environmental conditions for the last job.


These are used for process control execution timing.

001 Temperature

*ENG

[-1280 to 1270 / 0 / 0.1C/step]

002 Relative Humidity

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1%RH/step]

003 Absolute Humidity

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1 g/cm3/step]

445

5. System Maintenance

[Execution Interval: Display]


3515

Displays the current interval for process control execution.


When the machine calculates the timing for process control, it uses a number of conditions.
These are the results after considering all the conditions.

001

Job End: Potential Control:


BW

002 Job End: Potential Control: FC


003

Interrupt: Potential Control:


BW

004 Interrupt: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]

[Blade damage prevention mode]


3517

Adjusts the threshold temperature for preventing the cleaning blade in the transfer belt
cleaning unit from being damaged. If the temperature is above this value, toner is applied
to the transfer belt at set intervals during the job to prevent the blade from flipping over.

001 Execution Temp. Threshold

3519

[0 to 50 / 40 / 1C/step]

[Toner End Prohibition Setting]


Enables or disables each adjustment at toner near end.

001 Process Control

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]

002 MUSIC

*ENG

0: Permit (adjustment is done even toner near


end condition)

003 TC Adj.

*ENG

1: Forbid (adjustment is not done at toner near


end condition)

3520

446

*ENG

[ITB Idling Number]


Specifies the number of the ITB idling rotation for each condition.

Main SP Tables-3

001 Temperature: H

*ENG

002 Temperature: M

*ENG

003 Temperature: L

*ENG

004 Temperature: L: Power ON

*ENG

[0 or 3 / 0 / 1 revolution/step]

[Temperature Threshold]
3521

Specifies the threshold temperature for each condition. These settings affect the conditions
of SP3-520.
t1: Threshold between L (low temp.) and M (medium temp.)
t2: Threshold between M (medium temp.) and H (high temps)

001 Threshold: t2

*ENG

[20 or 30 / 25 / 1 deg/step]

002 Threshold: t1

*ENG

[0 or 15 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

[Initial Process Control Setting]


3522

Adjusts the threshold for the process control at power on.


When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when
compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process control at power on is
executed.

002 Non-use Time Setting

*ENG

[0 to 1440 / 360 / 1 minute/step]

003 Temperature Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1C/step]

004 Relative Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

005 Absolute Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

[Rapi_timer]
100 Time Setting

Adjusts the time-out time for the Rapi timer.

447

5. System Maintenance

[Non-use Time Process Control Setting]


3531

When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when
compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process control at stand-by is
executed.

001 Non-use Time Setting

*ENG

[0 to 1440 / 360 / 1 minute/step]

002 Temperature Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1C/step]

003 Relative Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

004 Absolute Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]

*ENG

Adjusts the maximum execution time for the


process control at stand-by.

005 Maximum Execution Number

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 time/step]
3611

448

Adjusts the threshold for the process control at stand-by.

[Development Gamma: Display/Set]

001 Bk (Current)

*ENG

002 M (Current)

*ENG

Displays the current development gamma for


each color.

003 C (Current)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / - / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

004 Y (Current)

*ENG

005 Bk (Target Display)

*ENG

006 M (Target Display)

*ENG

Displays the target development gamma for


each color.

007 C (Target Display)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.91 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

008 Y (Target Display)

*ENG

009 Bk (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

010 M (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

Displays the standard target development


gamma for each color.

011 C (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

012 Y (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

Main SP Tables-3

013 Environmental Correction

*ENG

Turns on or off the environmental correction for


target development gamma.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not Correct, 1: Correct

014 K (Max Correction)

*ENG

015 M (Max Correction)

*ENG

016 C (Max Correction)

*ENG

017 Y (Max Correction)

*ENG

018 K (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

019 M (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

020 C (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

Adjusts the maximum humidity correction


value for each color. These SPs are effective
only when the setting of SP3-611-013 is set
to "1".

021 Y (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

[1 to 99 / 20 / 1 g/m3/step]

3612

Adjusts the maximum correction value for each


color. These SPs are effective only when the
setting of SP3-611-013 is set to "1".
[0 to 5 / 0.15 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kv/ step]

[Vk Display]
Displays Vk for each color.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[-300 to 300 / - / 1 V/step]

[Development DC Control: Display]


3621

Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the development DC bias adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 700 / 550 / 1 -V/step]

449

5. System Maintenance

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2 & FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2 & FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2 & FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 700 / 550 / 1 -V/step]

[0 to 700 / 550 / 1 -V/step]

[Charge DC Control: Display]


3631

Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the charge DC voltage adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.

450

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1 & FINE: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1 & FINE: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1& FINE: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2 & FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2 & FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2 & FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 690 / 1 -V/step]

[0 to 2000 / 690 / 1 -V/step]

[0 to 2000 / 690 / 1 -V/step]

Main SP Tables-3

[Charge AC Control: Display]


3641

Plain: High speed


Displays the charge AC voltage adjusted with the process control for each color.

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.75 / 0.01 kV/step]

[LD Power Control: Display]


3651

Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the LD power adjusted for each environment.

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2 & FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2 & FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2 & FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 %/step]

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 %/step]

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 %/step]

[HST Concentration Control: Set]


3710

TD Sensor: Toner Concentration Control Setting


Selects the toner concentration control method by HST memory, which is in the TD sensor.

451

5. System Maintenance

001 Control Method: Selection

3711

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: Not Use, 1: Use

[HST Concentration Control: Bk]


Displays the factory settings of the black PCDU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3712

452

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.05 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[HST Concentration Control: M]


Displays the factory settings of the magenta PCDU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.05 / 0.01 V/step]

Main SP Tables-3

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3713

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[HST Concentration Control: C]


Displays the factory settings of the cyan PCDU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 2.55 / 1.05 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

453

5. System Maintenance

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3714

Displays the factory settings of the yellow PCDU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3800

454

[HST Concentration Control: Y]

[0 to 2.55 / 1.05 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[Toner Collection Bottle Full Detection]


Displays/ adjusts the toner collection bottle detection settings. These SPs are used for NRS.

001 Condition

*CTL

[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]

002 Detection Times

*CTL

[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]

003 Print Page After Near Full

*CTL

[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

004 Pixel Count After Near Full

*CTL

[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]

Main SP Tables-3

005 Pixel Count After Replacement

*CTL

Displays the pixel counter after replacement


of toner collection bottle.
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]

008 Coefficient

*ENG

[0.5 to 1.5 / 1 / 0.1 /step]


Enables or disables the calling for @Remote.

Notice Setting

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Enable @Remote calling
1: Disable @Remote calling

011
NOTE:

If the toner collection bottle has been replaced before the machine detects used toner near
full when this setting is set to "0", the machine cannot detect toner collection bottle near full.
In that case, set SP3-902-017 to "1".
Day Threshold: Toner
Collection bottle:NF

*ENG

[1 to 30 / 5 / 1 day/step]

012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the toner collection bottle is
displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the toner collection
bottle.
013 Total:Toner Collection Bottle

014

3900

Mechanism Full Detection


Date

*ENG

Displays the total amount of the used toner.


[0 to 999999999 / - / 1]
Displays the date of the full detection fot the
toner collection bottle.

[Waste Toner Full Detection]


Turns toner collection bottle full detection on or off.

001 ON/OFF Setting

3901

*ENG

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

[New PCU Detection]


Turns new PCDU detection on or off.

001 ON/OFF Setting

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

455

5. System Maintenance

[Manual New Unit Set]


3902

Turns the new unit detection flag for each PM unit on or off.
The use of these counters is explained in the PM section and in the relevant parts of section
3 (Replacement and Adjustment).

001 Development Unit: Bk

*ENG

002 Development Unit: Y

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

003 Development Unit: C

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

004 Development Unit: M

*ENG

005 Developer: Bk

*ENG

006 Developer: Y

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

007 Developer: C

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

008 Developer: M

*ENG

009 PCU (Drum Unit): Bk

*ENG

010 PCU (Drum Unit): Y

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

011 PCU (Drum Unit): C

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

012 PCU (Drum Unit): M

*ENG

013 Image Transfer Unit

*ENG

014 Fusing Unit

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

015 Cleaning Unit

*ENG

Do not use 3902-013 if you only change the


cleaning unit.

016 Paper Transfer Unit

*ENG

017 Toner Collection Bottle

*ENG

3902-015: This is for the image transfer belt


cleaning unit.

018 Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

019 Pressure Roller

456

*ENG

"Fusing Roller" is designated as "Heating Roller"


in this manual.

Main SP Tables-4

Main SP Tables-4
SP4-XXX (Scanner)

4008

[Sub Scan Magnification Adjustment]


Adjusts the sub-scan magnification by changing the scanner motor speed.

001

*ENG

[-1.0 to 1.0 / 0 / 0.1%/step] FA

[L-Edge Regist Adjustment]


4010

Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the scanning start timing in the sub-scan
direction.

001 -

*ENG

[-2.0 to 2.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step] FA

[S-to-S Regist Adjustment]


4011

Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the scanning start timing in the main scan
direction.

001 -

*ENG

[-2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

[Scanner Erase Margin: Scale] Scanner: Erase Margin: Scale


4012

Sets the blank margin at each side for erasing the original shadow caused by the gap
between the original and the scale.

001 Book: Leading Edge


002 Book: Trailing Edge
003 Book: Left

*ENG

[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

*ENG

[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

004 Book: Right


005 ADF: Leading Edge
007 ADF: Right
008 ADF: Left

457

5. System Maintenance

[Scanner Free Run]


4013

Performs the scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off in the following mode.
Full color mode / Full Size / A3 or DLT

001 Lamp: OFF


002 Lamp: ON

4014

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

[Scan]
Execute the scanner free fun with each mode.

001 HP Detection Enable

Scanner free run with HP sensor check.

002 HP Detection Disable

Scanner free run without HP sensor check.

4020

[Dust Check]
Turns the ADF scan glass dust check on/ off.

001 Detection: ON/OFF

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Selects the detect level.

002 Detection: Level

*ENG

[0 to 8 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: lowest detection level
8: highest detection level
Selects the level of the sub scan line correction
when using the ARDF.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]

003 Correction Level

*ENG

0: Off
1: Weakest
2: Weak
3: Strong
4: Strongest

458

011 Dust Detect:On/Off:Rear

*ENG

Not used

012 Dust Detect:Lvl:Rear

*ENG

Not used

Main SP Tables-4

[APS Operation Check]


4301

Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original sensors. (See "Input
Check Table" in this section.)

001 APS Operation Check

4303

[APS Min Size (A5/HLT/16K)]


Specifies the result of the detection when the outputs from the original sensors are all OFF.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]

001

APS Min. Size (A5/HLT/


16K)

*ENG

0: No Original
1: A5-Lengthwise (16K SEF if 4305 is set to 3)
2: A5-Sideways (16K LEF if 4305 is set to 3)

[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]

4305

[8K/16K Detection]

*ENG

0: Normal Detection (the machine detects A4/LT


size as A4 or LT, depending on the paper size
setting)
1: A4-Sideways LT-Lengthwise
2: LT-Sideways A4-Lengthwise
3: 8K 16K

001 This program enables the machine to automatically recognize the 8K/16K size.
4308

[Scan Size Detection]


[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Detection ON/OFF

*ENG

0: OFF
1: ON

001

Turns on or off the CCD original size detection. This detection is used only when an original
is scanned in book scanning mode.
4309

[Scan Size Detect:Setting]

459

5. System Maintenance

Original Density Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 32 / 1 digit/step]

001 Specifies the threshold between an original area and non-original area for the scan original
size detection in book scanning mode.
002 Detection Time

*ENG

[20 to 100 / 60 / 20 msec/step]

Specifies the detection time for the scan original size detection in book scanning mode.
003 Lamp ON:Delay Time

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec/step]

Specifies the lamp on timing for the scan original size detection in book scanning mode.
[Scan Size Detect Value]
4310

Displays the detected value by CCD. Each detection point for paper size and color is
displayed on the LCD.

001 S1:R

*ENG

002 S1:G

*ENG

003 S1:B

*ENG

004 S2:R

*ENG

005 S2:G

*ENG

006 S2:B

*ENG

007 S3:R

*ENG

008 S3:G

*ENG

009 S3:B

*ENG

[Scanner Erase Margin]


4400

[0 to 255 / - / 1 digit/step]

*ENG

Set the Mask for Original.


These SPs set the area to be masked during platen (book) mode scanning.

460

Main SP Tables-4

001 Book: Leading Edge


002 Book: Trailing Edge
003 Book: Left
004 Book: Right

[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]

005 ADF: Leading Edge


007 ADF: Right
008 ADF: Left

4417

[IPU Test Pattern]


Selects the IPU test pattern.

001 Test Pattern Selection

[0 to 24 / 0 / 1/step ]

0: Scanned image

13: Grid pattern CMYK

1: Gradation main scan A

14: Color patch CMYK

2: Gradation main scan B

15: Gray pattern (1)

3: Gradation main scan C

16: Gray pattern (2)

4: Gradation main scan D

17: Gray Pattern (3)

5: Gradation sub scan (1)

18: Shading pattern

6: Grid pattern

19: Thin line pattern

7: Slant grid pattern

20: Scanned + Grid pattern

8: Gradation RGBCMYK

21: Scanned + Gray scale

9: UCR pattern

22: Scanned + Color patch

10: Color patch 16 (1)

23: Scanned + Slant Grid C

11: Color patch 16 (2)

24: Scanned + Slant Grid D

12: Color patch 64


4429

[Illegal Copy Output]

001 Copy
002 Scanner

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

003 Fax

461

5. System Maintenance

4450

[Scan Image Path Selection]


001

002

4501

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

Uses or does not use the black reduction image path.


SH ON/OFF

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: ON, 1: OFF

Uses or does not use the shading image path.


[ACC Target Density]
Selects the ACC result.

001 Copy: K: Text

*ENG

002 Copy: C: Text

*ENG

003 Copy: M: Text

*ENG

004 Copy: Y: Text

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]

005 Copy: K: Photo

*ENG

10: Darkest density

006 Copy: C: Photo

*ENG

007 Copy: M: Photo

*ENG

008 Copy: Y: Photo

*ENG

4505

462

Black Subtraction ON/OFF

[ACC Cor:Bright]
Adjusts the offset correction for light areas of the ACC pattern.

001 Text:K

*ENG

002 Text:C

*ENG

003 Text:M

*ENG

004 Text:Y

*ENG

005 Photo:K

*ENG

006 Photo:C

*ENG

007 Photo:M

*ENG

008 Photo:Y

*ENG

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

Main SP Tables-4

4506

[ACC Cor:Dark]
Adjusts the offset correction for dark areas of the ACC pattern.

001 Text:K

*ENG

002 Text:C

*ENG

003 Text:M

*ENG

004 Text:Y

*ENG

005 Photo:K

*ENG

006 Photo:C

*ENG

007 Photo:M

*ENG

008 Photo:Y

*ENG

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

[Printer Vector Correction]


4540

This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4 Colors [R, G, B,
Option]) for a total of 48 parameters.

001-004 RY Phase: Option/R/G/B


005-008 YR Phase: Option/R/G/B
009-012 YG Phase: Option/R/G/B
013-016 GY Phase: Option/R/G/B
017-020 GC Phase: Option/R/G/B
021-024 CG Phase: Option/R/G/B
025-028 CB Phase: Option/R/G/B

*ENG

Specifies the printer vector correction


value.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

029-032 BC Phase: Option/R/G/B


033-036 BM Phase: Option/R/G/B
037-040 MB Phase: Option/R/G/B
041-044 MR Phase: Option/R/G/B
045-048 RM Phase: Option/R/G/B

463

5. System Maintenance

4600

001 SBU_ID

Displays the ID of the SBU.

002 GASBU-N_ID

Displays the ID of the GASBU.

003 VSP5100_ID

Displays t he ID of the VSP5100.

001 Scanner Memory Access

Enables the read and write check for the SBU


registers.

002 Address Set

003 Data Set

4602

[SBU Version Display]

4603

[Scanner Memory Access]

[AGC Execution]

001 HP Detection Enable

Executes the AGC.

002 HP Detection Disable

DFU

4609

[Gray Balance Set: R]

001 Book Read

[-512 to 511 / -46 / 1 digit/step]

002 DF Read

[-512 to 511 / -46 / 1 digit/step]

4610

[Gray Balance Set: G]

001 Book Read


002 DF Read
4611

002 DF Read

4623

[-512 to 511 / -20 / 1 digit/step]

[-512 to 511 / -28 / 1 digit/step]

[Gray Balance Set: B]

001 Book Read

464

Not used

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

Main SP Tables-4

001 Latest: RE Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the even red signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Latest: RO Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4624

[Black Level Rough Adj. Display]


GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

001 Latest: GE Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the even green signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).

[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Latest: GO Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4625

[Black Level Rough Adj. Display]


BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

001 Latest: BE Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the


even blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Latest: BO Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the


odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4628

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

001 Latest: R Color

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
465

5. System Maintenance

4629

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

001 Latest: G Color

4630

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

002 Latest: RO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

001 Latest: GE Color

002 Latest: GO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Adjustment]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

001 Latest: BE Color

002 Latest: BO Color

4645

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]

4633

466

001 Latest: RE Color

4632

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjustment]

001 Latest: B Color

4631

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Scan Adjust Error]

001 White level

002 Black level

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

Main SP Tables-4

4647

[Read Hard Error]


Displays the result of the SBU connection check.
[0 to 35535 / 0 / 1digit /step]

001 Power-ON

0: OK, Other: SBU connection check failure


If the SBU connection check fails, SC144 occurs.

4654

001

[Black Level Adj. Display]


RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

Last Correct Value: RE


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value for the even red


signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

Last Correct Value: RO


002
Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value for the odd red


signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4655

001

[Black Level Adj. Display]


GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

Last Correct Value: GE


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value for the even green


signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002

Last Correct Value: GO


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value for the odd green


signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4656

[Black Level Adj. Display]


BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

467

5. System Maintenance

001

Last Correct Value: BE


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value for the even blue


signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002

Last Correct Value: BO


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value for the odd blue


signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4658

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

001 Last Correct Value: RE Color

4659

Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: RE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: RO Color

*ENG

4662

468

*ENG

[Analog Gain Adjustment]

001 Last Correct Value: BE Color

4661

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjustment]

001 Last Correct Value: GE Color

4660

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: GE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: GO Color

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

Main SP Tables-4

4663

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: BE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: BO Color

*ENG

4673

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Adj. Display]


RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

001 Factory Setting: RE Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment for the even red signal in the CCD circuit
board (color printing speed)..
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Factory Setting: RO Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit
board (color printing speed).

[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4674

[Black Level Adj. Display]


GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

001 Factory Setting: GE Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment for the even green signal in the CCD
circuit board (color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Factory Setting: GO Color *ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment for the odd green signal in the CCD
circuit board (color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4675

[Black Level Adj. Display]


BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

001 Factory Setting: BE Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment for the even blue signal in the CCD
circuit board (color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

469

5. System Maintenance

002 Factory Setting: BO Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment for the odd blue signal in the CCD circuit
board (color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4677

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Red.

001 Factory Setting: RE Color

4678

Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green.

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
*ENG

002 Factory Setting: RO Color

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment ]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

001 Factory Setting: GE Color

*ENG

002 Factory Setting: GO Color

*ENG

4682

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue.

001 Factory Setting: RE Color

4681

470

*ENG

[Analog Gain Adjustment]

001 Factory Setting: BE Color

4680

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjustment]

001 Factory Setting: GE Color

4679

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

Main SP Tables-4

001 Factory Setting: BE Color

*ENG

002 Factory Setting: BO Color

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Scan Image Density Adjustment]


4688

Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF or 1-pass DF.
Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.

001 ARDF

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 98 / 1%/ step ]

002 1-pass DF

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 98 / 1%/ step ]

4690

[White Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.

001 RE

002 RO

4691

Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.


-

002 GO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[White Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.

001 BE

002 BO

4693

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[White Level Peak Read]

001 GE

4692

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 RE

002 RO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

471

5. System Maintenance

4694

Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 GE

002 GO

4695

[Black Level Peak Read]

[Black Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 BE

002 BO

4802

002 Lamp ON

Executes the scanner free run of shading movement


with exposure lamp on or off.
Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free
run lasts.

[Home Position]

001 4806

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[DF Shading FreeRun]

001 Lamp OFF

4804

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

Executes the scanner HP detection.

[Carriage Save]
Moves the carriage from the scanner home
position.

001 -

4807

472

[SBU Test Pattern Change]

Dust may fall through the DF exposure glass.


Therefore, do this SP when you transport the
machine a long distance.

Main SP Tables-4

[0 to 250 / 0 / 1 /step]
1: Grid pattern
001 -

2: Gradation main scan


3: Gradation sub scan
4 to 250: Default (Scanning Image)

4808

[Factory Setting Input]

002 Execution Flag

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

[ACC Data Display]


4902

This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution.
A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data.

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 R DATA1

*ENG

Photo C Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

002 G DATA1

*ENG

Photo M Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

003 B DATA1

*ENG

Photo Y Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

004 R DATA2

*ENG

Photo C Patch Level 17 (8-bit)

005 G DATA2

*ENG

Photo M Patch Level 17(8-bit)

006 B DATA2

*ENG

Photo Y Patch Level 17 (8-bit)

[Manual Gamma Adj]


4918

Adjusts the offset data of the printer gamma for yellow in Photo mode.
See Printer Gamma Correction" in the Replacement and Adjustment for how to use.

009 -

4954

Enter the manual gamma adjustment screen (-001


to 008). For details, see the "Printer Gamma
Correction" in the section "Replace and
Adjustment".

[Read/Restore Std]

001 Read New Chart

Execute the scanning of the A4 chart.

473

5. System Maintenance

002 Recall Prev Chart

Clear the data of the scanned A4 chart.

003 Read Std Chart

Execute the scanning of the A4 standard chart.

004 Set Std Chart

Overwrite the standard data.

[IPU Image Path Selection ]


4991

Selects the image path.


Enter the number to be selected using the 10-key pad.
RGB Frame Memory

*ENG

[0 to 11 / 2 / 1 /step ]

0: Scanner input RGB images

001

1: Scanner I/F RGB images


2: RGB images done by Shading correction (Shading ON, Black offset ON)
3: Shading data
4 to 11: Not used

4993

[High Light Correction]


Selects the Highlight correction level.

001 Sensitivity Selection

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest sensitivity
9: strongest sensitivity
Selects the range level of Highlight correction.

002 Range Selection

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest skew correction,
9: strongest skew correction

4994

[Text/Photo Detection Level Adj.]


Selects the definition level between Text and Photo for high compression PDF.
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]

001

PDF Sensitivity Level text/


photo

*ENG

0: Text priority
1: Normal
2: Photo priority

474

Main SP Tables-5

Main SP Tables-5
SP5-XXX (Mode)

5024

[mm/inch Display Selection]


Display units (mm or inch) for custom paper sizes.

001 0:mm 1:inch

*CTL

0: mm (Europe/Asia)
1: inch (USA)

[Accounting Counter]
5045

Selects the counting method.


NOTE: The counting method can be changed only once, regardless of whether the counter
value is negative or positive.

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 Counter Method

*CTL

0: Developments
1: Prints

5047

[Paper Display]
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.

001 -

5051

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

[TonerRefillDetectionDisplay]
Enables or disables the toner refill detection display.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] Alphanumeric

5051 1 Toner Refill Detection Display

*CTL

0: ON
1: OFF

5055

[Display IP Address]
Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.

475

5. System Maintenance

001 -

5056

476

0: OFF 1: ON

Display or does not display the coverage counter on the LCD.


*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display

[Toner Remaining Icon Display Change]


Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD.

001 -

5062

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

[Coverage Counter Display]

001 -

5061

*CTL

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display

[Parts Replacement Alert Display]


Display or does not display the PM part yield on the LCD.

001 Drum Unit: Bk

*CTL

002 Drum Unit: M

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

003 Drum Unit: C

*CTL

0: Not display, 1: Display

004 Drum Unit: Y

*CTL

005 Development Unit: Bk

*CTL

006 Development Unit: M

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

007 Development Unit: C

*CTL

0: Not display, 1: Display

008 Development Unit: Y

*CTL

009 Developer: Bk

*CTL

010 Developer: M

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

011 Developer: C

*CTL

0: Not display, 1: Display

012 Developer: Y

*CTL

Main SP Tables-5

013 Image Transfer Belt

*CTL

014 Image Transfer Cleaning Unit

*CTL

015 Fusing Unit

*CTL

016 Paper Transfer Roller Unit

*CTL

017 Waster Toner Bottle

*CTL

018 Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)

*CTL

019 Pressure Roller

*CTL

5066

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display

[Parts PM Menu Display Setting]


Display or does not display the "PM parts" button on the LCD.

001 -

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

0: Not display, 1: Display

[Parts PM System Setting]


5067

Selects the service maintenance or user maintenance for each PM parts.


If the user service is selected, PM alert is displayed on the LCD.

001 PCU (Drum Unit):Bk

*CTL

002 PCU (Drum Unit):M

*CTL

003 PCU (Drum Unit):C

*CTL

004 PCU (Drum Unit):Y

*CTL

005 Dev Unit:Bk

*CTL

006 Dev Unit:M

*CTL

007 Dev Unit:C

*CTL

008 Dev Unit:Y

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

[0: Service] or [1: User]

477

5. System Maintenance

009 Developer:Bk

*CTL

010 Developer:M

*CTL

011 Developer:C

*CTL

012 Developer:Y

*CTL

013 Int Trans Unit

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

014 Belt Cleaning Unit

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

015 Fusing Unit

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

016 Transfer Roller

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

017 WasteToner Bottle

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

018 Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

019 Pressure Roller

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

5104*

[0: Service] or [1: User]

A3/DLT Double Count (SSP)


Specifies whether the counter is doubled for A3/DLT. "Yes" counts except from the bypass
tray. When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are counted twice, that is A4 x2 and LT
x2 respectively.

5071

[Set Bypass Paper Size]


-

001

5113

478

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up prevents
mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation panel and an actual paper
size on the by-pass tray.
[Optional Counter Type]

Main SP Tables-5

This program specifies the counter type.


0: None, 1: Key card (RK 3, 4)
001

Default Optional Counter


Type

*CTL

2: Key card (down), 3: Prepaid card


4: Coin rack, 5: MF key card
8: Key counter + Vendor
9: Bar-code Printer
This program specifies the external counter type.

External Optional Counter


002
Type

0: None
*CTL

1: Expansion Device 1
2: Expansion Device 2
3: Expansion Device 3

5114

[Optional Counter I/F]

001 MF Key Card Extension

5118

[Disable Copying]

*CTL

[0: Not installed/ 1: Installed (scanning


accounting)]

*CTL

[0: Not disabled/ 1: Disabled]

*CTL

[0: Yes (removed)/ 1: Standby (installed but not


used)/ 2: No (not removed)]

001 This program disables copying.

5120
001

5121
001

[Mode Clear Opt. Counter


Removal]

This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you install or remove
an optional counter, check the settings.
[Counter Up Timing]

*CTL

[0: Feed/ 1: Exit]

This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to "paper feed" and
"paper exit" respectively.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]

5126

[F Size Original Setting]

*ENG

0: 8 1/2" x 13" (Foolscap)


1: 8 1/4" x 13" (Folio)
2: 8" x 13" (F)

479

5. System Maintenance

001 Selects F size original setting.


5127

[APS Mode]

*CTL

[0: Not disabled/ 1: Disabled]

001 This program disables the APS.


5131
001

5148

[Paper Size Type Selection]

*ENG

[0: JP (Japan)/ 1: NA / 2: EU]

The program selects a paper size system from the following alternatives: the AB system (0),
the LT system (1), and the AF system (2).
Size Detection Off

*CTL

[0: OFF/ 1: ON]

0: Detecte

1: Not Detecte
5150

[By-Pass Length Setting]

*CTL

[0: OFF/ 1: ON]

Determines whether the transfer sheet from the by-pass tray is used or not.
001 Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is limited to 600
mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.
5162

[App. Switch Method]

*CTL

[0: Soft Key Set/ 1: Hard Key Set]

001 This program specifies the switch that selects an application program.
[Fax Printing Mode at Optional]
5167

Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device. This SP is used
when the receiving fax is accounted by an external accounting device.

Fax Printing Mode at Optional


001
*CTL
Counter Off

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Automatic printing
1: No automatic printing

[CE Login]
5169

480

If you will change the printer bit switches, you must log in to service mode with this SP before
you go into the printer SP mode.

Main SP Tables-5

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 CE Login

*CTL

0: Disabled
1: Enabled

5181

[Size Adjust]
Adjusts the paper size for each tray.

001 Paper TRAY 1

*ENG

002 TRAY 2: 1

*ENG

003 TRAY 2: 2

*ENG

004 TRAY 2: 3

*ENG

005 TRAY 2: 4

*ENG

006 TRAY 3/T-LCT: 1

*ENG

007 TRAY 3: 2

*ENG

008 TRAY 3: 3

*ENG

009 TRAY 3: 4

*ENG

010 TRAY 4: 1

*ENG

011 TRAY 4: 2

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / 1 /step]


0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF, 2: B5 LEF, 3: A5 LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT

[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT

481

5. System Maintenance

012 TRAY 4: 3

*ENG

013 TRAY 4: 4

*ENG

018 LCT

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 to 2 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4LEF, 1: LTLEF, 2: B5LEF

[RK 4]
5186

Enables or disables the prevention for RK4 (accounting device) disconnection.


If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is set to "1 (Enable)", the machine
automatically jams a sheet of paper and stops.

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 -

*ENG

0: Disable
1: Enable

5188

[Copy NvVersion]
Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.

001 5193

[External Controller Info. Settings]


-

Sets the external controller type. This setting is appropriately adjusted if an external controller
is installed in the machine.
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1/step]
001 0: No external controller installed
1: EFI controller
2: Ratio controller
3: Egret controller
4 to 10: Reserved
5199

482

[Paper Exit After Staple End.]

Main SP Tables-5

001 -

[ 0 or 1 / 0 / -]

*CTL

0: OFF, 1: ON

Enables or disables the paper feeding out from the finisher without stapling.
If this setting is "1: ON", paper is fed out without stapling at the maximum number of
the finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum
number).
If this setting is "0: OFF", paper is fed out with stapling at the maximum number of the
finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum number).
5212

[Page Numbering]

*CTL

This program adjusts the position of the second side page numbers.
A " value" moves the page number positions to the left edge. A "+ value" moves the page
number positions to the right edge.
003

Duplex Printout Right/Left


Position

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

004

Duplex Printout High/Low


Position

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Set Time]
Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone.
Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.)
DOM: +540 (Tokyo)
5302

NA: -300 (New York)


EU: + 60 (Paris)
CH: +480 (Peking)
TW: +480 (Taipei)
AS: +480 (Hong Kong)

002 Time Difference

5307

*CTL
#

[-1440 to 1440 / Area / 1 min./step ]

[Summer Time]

483

5. System Maintenance

[ 0 to 1 / NA, EU, ASIA / 1 /step]


Setting
001

0: Disabled
1: Enabled
NA and EUR: 1, ASIA: 0

Enables or disables the summer time mode.


Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise, this SP is not
activated even if this SP is set to "1".
Rule Set (Start)
Specifies the start setting for the summer time mode.
There are 8 digits in this SP. For months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input in the first digit, so the
eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit setting.

1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]


003

3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5]


4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour /step]
8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step]
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".
For example: 3500010 (EU default)
The timer is advanced by 1 hour at am 0:00 on the 5th Sunday in March

484

Main SP Tables-5

Rule Set (End)

Specifies the end setting for the summer time mode.


There are 8 digits in this SP.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
004

3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to 5]


4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
The 7th and 8 digits must be set to "00".
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".

5404

[User Code Count Clear]


001 UCodeCtrClr

5411

Clears all counters for users.

[LDAP Certification]

004 Easy Certification

*CTL

Determines whether easy LDAP certification is


done.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -] 1: On, 0: Off
This SP is referenced only when SP5411-4 is set to
"1" (On).

005 Password Null Not Permit

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Password NULL not permitted.
1: Password NULL permitted.

006 Detail Option

*CTL

Determines whether LDAP option (anonymous


certification) is turned on or off.
Bit0
0: OFF, 1: ON

5413

[Lockout Setting]

485

5. System Maintenance

001 Lockout On/Off

*CTL

Switches on/off the lock on the local address book


account.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

002 Lockout Threshold

*CTL

Sets a limit on the frequency of lockouts for account


lockouts.
[1 to 10 / 5 / 1/step]
Determines whether the system waits the prescribed
time for input of a correct user ID and password
after an account lockout has occurred.

003 Cancellation On/Off

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off (no wait time, lockout not cancelled)

1: On (system waits, cancels lockout if correct user


ID and password are entered.

004 Cancellation Time

*CTL

Determines the length of time that the system waits


for correct input of the user ID and password after
a lockout has occurred. This setting is used only if
SP5413-3 is set to "1" (on).
[1 to 999 / 60 / 1 min./step]

005 Counter Clear Time


5414

*CTL

Not Used

[Access Mitigation]

001 Mitigation On/Off

*CTL

Switches on/off masking of continuously used IDs


and passwords that are identical.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

002 Mitigation Time

*CTL

Sets the length of time for excluding continuous


access for identical user IDs and passwords.
[0 to 60 / 15 / 1 min./step]

5415

486

[Password Attack]

Main SP Tables-5

001 Permissible Number

*CTL

Sets the number of attempts to attack the system with


random passwords to gain illegal access to the
system.
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 attempt/step]

002 Detect Time

*CTL

Sets the time limit to stop a password attack once


such an attack has been detected.
[1 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec./step]

5416

[Access Information]

001 Access User Max Num

*CTL

Limits the number of users used by the access


exclusion and password attack detection functions.
[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 users/step]

002 Access Password Max Num *CTL

Limits the number of passwords used by the access


exclusion and password attack detection functions.

[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 password/step]

003 Monitor Interval

*CTL

Sets the processing time interval for referencing


user ID and password information.
[1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec./step]

5417

[Access Attack]

001 Access Permissible Number

*CTL

Sets a limit on access attempts when an excessive


number of attempts are detected for MFP features.
[0 to 500 / 100 / 1/step]

002 Attack Detect Time

*CTL

Sets the length of time for monitoring the frequency


of access to MFP features.
[10 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec./step]

003 Productivity Fall Wait

*CTL

Sets the wait time to slow down the speed of


certification when an excessive number of access
attempts have been detected.
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 sec./step]

487

5. System Maintenance

004 Attack Max Num

*CTL

Sets a limit on the number of requests received for


certification in order to slow down the certification
speed when an excessive number of access
attempts have been detected.
[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 attempt/step]

[User Authentication]
5420

These settings should be done with the System Administrator.


Note: These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has been enabled.

001 Copy

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the copy applications.
[0 to 1 / 0 /1]
0: On, 1: Off

Color Security Setting

*CTL

Enables or disables the color copy limitation for each copy mode when the user
authentication is "ON".
0: Enable (default), 1: Disable
002

Bit0: B/W mode


Bit1: Mono color mode
Bit2: Two colors mode
Bit3: Full color mode
Bit4: Automatic color mode
Bit5 to 7: Reserved

011 DocumentServer

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the document server.
[0 or 1/ 0 /1]
0: On, 1: Off

021 Fax

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the fax application.
[0 or 1/ 0 /1]
0: On, 1: Off

488

Main SP Tables-5

031 Scanner

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the scan applications.
[0 or 1/ 0 /1]
0: On, 1: Off

041 Printer

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the printer applications.
[0 or 1/ 0 /1]
0: On, 1: Off

051 SDK1
061 SDK2

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
*CTL

071 SDK3

5481

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the SDK application.

[Authentication Error Code]


These SP codes determine how the authentication failures are displayed.

001 System Log Disp

*CTL

Determines whether an error code appears in the


system log after a user authentication failure occurs.
[0 or 1/ 0 /1]
0: Off, 1: On

002 Panel Disp

*CTL

Determines whether an error code appears on the


operation panel after a user authentication failure
occurs.
[0 or 1/ 1 /1]
1: On, 0: Off

5490

[MF KeyCard (Japan only)]


Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
001 Job Permit Setting

*CTL

0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user


code.
1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user code.

002 Count Mode Setting

*CTL

489

5. System Maintenance

5501

[PM Alarm]

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 PM Alarm Level

0: Alarm off
1 to 9999: Alarm goes off when Value (1 to 9999) x 1000
> PM counter
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]

002 Original Count Alarm

5504

[Jam Alarm]

0: No alarm sounds
1: Alarm sounds after the number of originals passing
through the ARDF > 10,000
*CTL

Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included).
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
001

0: Zero (Off)
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)
3: High (6K jams)
[Error Alarm]
Sets the error alarm level.
The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the error alarm
counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a set number of copied sheets
(for example, default 1500 sheets).

5505

The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5".
001 -

5508*
001*

490

*CTL

[0 to 255 / C2.5a: 25, C2.5b: 35 / 100 copies /


step]

[CC Call]

*CTL -

Jam Remains

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call for an unattended paper jam.

Main SP Tables-5

002*

003*

Continuous Jams

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call for consecutive paper jams.


Continuous Door Open

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call when the front door remains open.


Jam Detection: Time Length

[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute /step]

011* Sets the time a jam must remain before it becomes an "unattended paper jam". This setting
is enabled only when SP5508-004 is set to "1".
Jam Detection: Continuous Count

[2 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]

012* Sets the number of consecutive paper jams required to initiate a call. This setting is enabled
only when SP5508-004 is set to "1".
Door Open: Time Length

[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 /step]

013* Sets the length of time the door remains open before the machine initiates a call.
This setting is enabled only when SP5-508-004 is set to "1".
[SC/Alarm Setting]

*CTL

5515

With NRS (New Remote Service) in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when
an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when an SC error
occurs.

001

SC Call

002

Service Parts Near End Call

003

Service Parts End Call

004

User Call

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Off
1: On

491

5. System Maintenance

006

Communication Test Call

007

Machine Information Notice

008

Alarm Notice

009

Non Genuine Tonner Alarm

010

Supply Automatic Ordering Call

011

Supply Management Report Call

012

Jam/Door Open Call

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

[Individual PM Part Alarm


Call]

5516

0: Off
1: On

*CTL

With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an PM alarm call when one of SP
parts reaches its yield.
001

Disable/Enable Setting (0: Not send, 1:


Send)

004 Percent yield for triggering PM alert


5610

005

006

001

0: Not send, 1: Send


[1 to 255 / 75 / 1 %/step]

[Base Gamma Control Point: Command]


004

5611

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

Factory Setting

Recalls the factory settings.


Restore

Overwrites the current values onto the factory settings.


Restore

Recalls the previous settings.


[Toner Color in 2C]
B-C

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.

492

Main SP Tables-5

B-M

002

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
G-C

003

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
G-Y

004

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
R-M

005

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
R-Y

006

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
5618

[Color Mode Display Selection]


[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
001

*CTL

0: ACS, Colour, Black & White, Two Colour, Single


colour
1: ACD, Full Colour, Black & White

Selects the color selection display on the LCD.

Memory Clear (SP5-801)


The following tables list the items that are cleared. The serial number information, meter charge setting
and meter charge counters (SP8-581, 582, 583, 584, and 586) are not cleared.
5801

[Memory Clear]

493

5. System Maintenance

001 All Clear

Resets all correction data for process control and all


software counters, and returns all modes and adjustments
to their default values.

002 Engine

Clears the engine settings.

003 SCS

Initializes default system settings, SCS (System Control


Service) settings, operation display coordinates, and ROM
update information.

004 IMH Memory Clr

Initializes the IMH settings.

005 Mcs

Initializes the Mcs settings.

006 Copier Application

Initializes all copier application settings.

007 Fax Application

Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX settings,
local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer.
The following service settings:
Bit switches
Gamma settings (User & Service)
Toner Limit

008 Printer Application

The following user settings:


Tray Priority
Menu Protect
System Setting except for setting of Energy Saver
I/F Setup (I/O Buffer and I/O Timeout)
PCL Menu

009 Scanner Application

Initializes the scanner defaults for the scanner and all the
scanner SP modes.

010 Web Service

Deletes the network file application management files and


thumbnails, and initializes the job login ID.

011 NCS

012 R-Fax
014 Clear DCS Setting

494

All setting of Network Setup (User Menu)


(NCS: Network Control Service)
Initializes the job login ID, SmartDeviceMonitor for
Admin, job history, and local storage file numbers.
Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings.

Main SP Tables-5

015 Clear UCS Setting

Initializes the UCS (User Information Control Service)


settings.

016 MIRS Setting

Initializes the MIRS (Machine Information Report Service)


settings.

017 CCS

Initializes the CCS (Certification and Charge-control


Service) settings.

018 SRM Memory Clr

Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager) settings.

019 LCS

Initializes the LCS settings.

020 Web Uapli

Initializes the web user application settings.

021 ECS

Initializes the ECS settings.

[FreeRun]
Performs a free run on the copier engine.
5802

The machine starts free run in the same condition as the sequence of A4/LT, A3 or
A4 SEF printing from the 1st or 2nd tray. Therefore, the correct paper should be
loaded in the 1st tray or 2nd tray, but paper is not fed.
The main switch has to be turned off and on after using the free run mode for a test.
001 B/W A4 LEF

002 FC A4 LEF

003 FC A3 LEF

5803

[Input Check]

5804

[Output Check]

5805

[Anti-Condensation Heater]
002 0:OFF / 1:ON

*ENG

See p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section.


See p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section.

495

5. System Maintenance

[SC Reset]
5810

Resets a type A service call condition.


Turn the main switch off and on after resetting the SC code.
001 Fusing SC Reset

5811

5812

[MachineSerial] Machine Serial Number Display


002 Display

Displays the machine serial number.

004 BICU

Inputs

[Service Tel. No. Setting]


Service

*CTL

001 Sets the telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List, which can be printed with the users "Counter" menu.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Facsimile

*CTL

002 Sets the fax or telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Supply

*CTL

003 Use this to input the telephone number of your supplier for consumables. Enter the number
and press #.
Operation

*CTL

004 Use this to input the telephone number of your sales agency. Enter the number and press
#.
5816

496

[Remote Service]

*CTL

Main SP Tables-5

I/F Setting
Selects the remote service setting.
001

[0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step]
0: Remote service off
1: CSS remote service on
2: NRS remote service on
CE Call
Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service.

002

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Start of the service
1: End of the service
NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to "2".

Function Flag
Enables or disables the remote service function.
003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
SSL Disable

007

Controls if RCG (Remote Communication Gate) confirmation is done by SSL during an


RCG send for the @Remote over a network interface.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Yes. SSL not used.
1: No. SSL used.
RCG Connect Timeout

008 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the time-out when the RCG (Remote Communication
Gate) connects during a call via the @Remote network.
[1 to 90 / 30 / 1 second /step]

497

5. System Maintenance

RCG Write Timeout


009 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the time-out when sent data is written to the RCG during
a call over the @Remote network.
[1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]
RCG Read Timeout
010 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the timeout when sent data is written from the RCG
during a call over the @Remote network.
[1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]
Port 80 Enable

011

Controls if permission is given to get access to the SOAP method over Port 80 on the
@Remote network.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
0: No. Access denied
1: Yes. Access granted.
RFU Timing

Selects the timing for the remote firmware updating.


013 [0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Any status of a target machine
1: Sleep or panel off mode only
RCG C Registed
021

This SP displays the RCG-N installation end flag.


0: Installation not completed
1: Installation completed
RCG C Regist Detail
This SP displays the RCG device installation status.

022 0: RCG device not registered


1: RCG device registered
2: Device registered

498

Main SP Tables-5

Connect Type (N/M)


This SP displays and selects the RCG-N connection method.
023 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step
0: Internet connection
1: Dial-up connection
061 Cert. Expire Timing DFU

Proximity of the expiration of the certification.

062 Use Proxy

This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the


machine communicates with the service center.

Proxy Host
This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between the RCG
device and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the customer proxy server address.
063

The address is necessary to set up the embedded RCG-N.

The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128
character are ignored.
This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy PortNumber
This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication between the
embedded RCG-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to set up the embedded
064
RCG-N.
This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy User Name
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name.
065
The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.

499

5. System Maintenance

Proxy Password
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password.
066
The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
067

500

CERT:Up State
Displays the status of the certification update.
0

The certification used by RCG-N is set correctly.

The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW
URL and certification is presently being updated.

The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
successful update.

The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update.

The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being
sent to the GW URL.

11

A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting
is in progress for the rescue GW connection.

12

The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
certification update request.

13

The notification of the request for certification update has completed successfully,
and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW
URL.

14

The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW
controller, and the certification is being stored.

15

The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful
completion of this event.

16

The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the
failure of this event.

Main SP Tables-5

17

The certification update request has been received from the GW URL, the GW URL
was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but an certification
error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded.

18

The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being
notified of the failure of the certification update.

CERT:Error
Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the
certification.

068

Normal. There is no request for certification update in progress.

Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired.

An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired.

Notification of shift from a common authentication to an individual certification.

Notification of a common certification without ID2.

Notification that no certification was issued.

Notification that GW URL does not exist.

069 CERT:Up ID

The ID of the request for certification.

083 FirmUp Status

Displays the status of the firmware update.

085 Firm Up User Check

This SP setting determines if the operator can confirm the


previous version of the firmware before the firmware update
execution. If the option to confirm the previous version is
selected, a notification is sent to the system manager and the
firmware update is done with the firmware files from the URL.

086 Firmware Size

Allows the service technician to confirm the size of the


firmware data files during the firmware update execution.

087 CERT: Macro Version

Displays the macro version of the @Remote certification.

088 CERT: PAC Version

Displays the PAC version of the @Remote certification.

089 CERT: ID2 Code

Displays ID2 for the @Remote certification. Spaces are


displayed as underscores (_). Asteriskes (****) indicate that
no @Remote certification exists.

501

5. System Maintenance

090 CERT: Subject

Displays the common name of the @Remote certification


subject. CN = the following 17 bytes. Spaces are displayed
as underscores (_). Asterisks (****) indicate that no DESS
exists.

091 CERT: Serial Number

Displays serial number for the NRS certification. Asterisks


(****) indicate that no DESS exists.

092 CERT: Issuer

Displays the common name of the issuer of the @Remote


certification. CN = the following 30 bytes. Asteriskes (****)
indicate that no DESS exists.

093 CERT: Valid Start

Displays the start time of the period for which the current
@Remote certification is enabled.

094 CERT: Valid End

Displays the end time of the period for which the current
@Remote certification is enabled.

Selection Country
Select the country where embedded RCG-M is installed in the machine. After selecting the
country, you must also set the following SP codes for embedded RCG-M:
150

SP5816-153
SP5816-154
SP5816-161
0: Japan, 1: USA, 2: Canada, 3: UK, 4: Germany, 5: France, 6: Italy,
7: Netherlands, 8: Belgium, 9: Luxembourg, 10: Spain
Line Type AutomaticJudgment
Press [Execute].

Setting this SP classifies the telephone line where embedded RCG-M is connected as either
dial-up (pulse dial) or push (DTMF tone) type, so embedded RCG-M can automatically
151 distinguish the number that connects to the outside line.
The current progress, success, or failure of this execution can be displayed with
SP5816-152.
If the execution succeeded, SP5816-153 will display the result for confirmation and
SP5816-154 will display the telephone number for the connection to the outside line.

502

Main SP Tables-5

Line Type Judgment Result


Displays a number to show the result of the execution of SP5816 151. Here is a list of what
the numbers mean.
0: Success
1: In progress (no result yet). Please wait.
2: Line abnormal
152 3: Cannot detect dial tone automatically
4: Line is disconnected
5: Insufficient electrical power supply
6: Line classification not supported
7: Error because fax transmission in progress ioctl() occurred.
8: Other error occurred
9: Line classification still in progress. Please wait.

Selection Dial/Push
This SP displays the classification (tone or pulse) of the telephone line to the access point
for embedded RCG-M. The number displayed (0 or 1) is the result of the execution of
SP5816-151. However, this setting can also be changed manually.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
153 0: Tone Dialing Phone
1: Pulse Dialing Phone
Inside Japan "2" may also be displayed:
0: Tone Dialing Phone
1: Pulse Dialing Phone 10PPS
2: Pulse Dialing Phone 20PPS

503

5. System Maintenance

Outside LineOutgoing Number


The SP sets the number that switches to PSTN for the outside connection for embedded
RCG-M in a system that employs a PBX (internal line).
154

If the execution of SP5816-151 has succeeded and embedded RCG-M has


connected to the external line, this SP display is completely blank.
If embedded RCG-M has connected to an internal line, then the number of the
connection to the external line is displayed.
If embedded RCG-M has connected to an external line, a comma is displayed with
the number. The comma is inserted for a 2 sec. pause.
The number setting for the external line can be entered manually (including commas).
Dial Up User Name

156

Use this SP to set a user name for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules when setting
a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation
marks (").
Dial Up Password

157

Use this SP to set a password for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules when setting
a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation
marks (").
Local Phone Number

161 Use this SP to set the telephone number of the line where embedded RCG-M is connected.
This number is transmitted to and used by the Call Center to return calls.
Limit: 24 numbers (numbers only)
Connection Timing Adjustment: Incoming
When the Call Center calls out to an embedded RCG-M modem, it sends a repeating ID
tone (*#1#). This SP sets the time the line remains open to send these ID tones after the
162 number of the embedded RCG-M modem is dialed up and connected.
[0 to 24 / 1 / 1 /step]
The actual amount of time is this setting x 2 sec. For example, if you set "2" the line will
remain open for 4 sec.

504

Main SP Tables-5

Access Point
This is the number of the dial-up access point for RCG-M. If no setting is done for this SP
163 code, then a preset value (determined by the country selected) is used.
Default: 0
Allowed: Up to 16 alphanumeric characters
164 Line Connecting
This SP sets the connection conditions for the customer. This setting dedicates the line to
RCG-M only, or sets the line for sharing between RCG-M and a fax unit.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Sharing Fax
1: No Sharing Fax

If this setting is changed, the copier must be cycled off and on.
SP5816 187 determines whether the off-hook button can be used to interrupt a RCGM transmission in progress to open the line for fax transaction.
173 Modem Serial Number

This SP displays the serial number registered for the RCG-M.

Retransmission Limit
Normally, it is best to allow unlimited time for certification and ID2 update requests, and
for the notification that the certification has been completed. However, RCG-M generates
174 charges based on transmission time for the customer, so a limit is placed upon the time
allowed for these transactions.
If these transactions cannot be completed within the allowed time, do this SP to cancel the
time restriction.
FAX TX Priority

This SP determines whether pushing the off-hook button will interrupt a RCG-M transmission
in progress to open the line for fax transaction. This SP can be used only if SP5816 164 is
187
set to "0".
[0 or 1/ 0 / - ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
200 Manual Polling

Executes the manual polling.

505

5. System Maintenance

Regist: Status
Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the registered device by the external nor embedded RCG device is set.
1: The embedded RCG device is being set. Only Box registration is completed. In this status,
this
unit cannot answer a polling request from the external RCG.
201
2. The embedded RCG device is set. In this status, the external RCG unit cannot answer a
polling request.
3. The registered device by the external RCG is being set. In this status the embedded RCG
device cannot be set.
4 The registered module by the external RCG has not started.

202 Letter Number

Allows entry of the number of the request needed for the RCGN device.

203 Confirm Execute

Executes the inquiry request to the @Remote GW URL.

204 Confirm Result


Displays a number that indicates the result of the inquiry executed with SP5816 203.
0: Succeeded
1: Inquiry number error
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Inquiry executing
Confirm Place
205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the GW URL in answer to the
inquiry request. Displayed only when the result is registered at the GW URL.
206 Register Execute

506

Executes "Embedded RCG Registration".

Main SP Tables-5

Register Result
Displays a number that indicates the registration result.
0: Succeeded
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
207 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Registration executing

208 Error Code


Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either SP5816-204
or SP5816-207 was executed.
Cause

Code

Meaning

-11001

Chat parameter error

Illegal Modem Parameter -11002

Chat execution error

-11003

Unexpected error

-12002

Inquiry, registration attempted without


acquiring device status.

-12003

Attempted registration without execution of an


inquiry and no previous registration.

Operation Error, Incorrect


Setting
-12004

-12005

Attempted setting with illegal entries for


certification and ID2.
@Remote communication is prohibited. The
device has an Embedded RC gate-related
problem.

507

5. System Maintenance

-12006

A confirmation request was made after the


confirmation had been already completed.

-12007

The request number used at registration was


different from the one used at confirmation.

Operation Error, Incorrect


Setting
-12008

-12009

ID2 mismatch between an individual


certification and NVRAM

-12010

Certification area is not initialized.

-2385

Attempted dial up overseas without the correct


international prefix for the telephone number.

-2387

Not supported at the Service Center

-2389

Database out of service

-2390

Program out of service

-2391

Two registrations for same device

Error Caused by Response -2392


from GW URL
-2393

5821

Parameter error
Basil not managed

-2394

Device not managed

-2395

Box ID for Basil is illegal

-2396

Device ID for Basil is illegal

-2397

Incorrect ID2 format

-2398

Incorrect request number format

209 Instal Clear

Releases the machine from its embedded RCG setup.

250 CommLog Print

Prints the communication log.

[Remote Service Address]


002 RCG IP Address

508

Update certification failed because mainframe


was in use.

*CTL

Sets the IP address of the RCG (Remote


Communication Gate) destination for call
processing at the remote service center.

Main SP Tables-5

[NV-RAM Data Upload]


5824

Uploads the UP and SP mode data (except for counters and the serial number) from the
NVRAM to an SD card. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in this
section.
001 NV-RAM Data Upload

[NV-RAM Data Download]


5825

Downloads the UP and SP mode data from an SD card to the NVRAM. For details, see the
"NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in this section.
001 NV-RAM Download

5828

[Network Setting]
1284 Compatibility
050
(Centro)

*CTL

Enables or disables 1284 Compatibility.


[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Enables or disables ECP Compatibility.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]

052 ECP (Centro)

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
This SP is activated only when SP5-828-50 is set to "1".
Enables/disables Job Spooling.

065 Job Spooling

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

Job Spooling Clear: Start


066
Time

Treatment of the job when a spooled job exists at power on.


0: ON (Data is cleared)
1: OFF (Automatically printed)

509

5. System Maintenance

Validates or invalidates the job spooling function for each


protocol.
0: Validates
1: Invalidates
bit0: LPR
069 Job Spooling (Protocol)

bit1: FTP
bit2: IPP
bit3: SMB
bit4: BMLinkS
bit5: DIPRINT
bit6: sftp
bit7: (Reserved)

Enables or disables the Telnet protocol.


090 TELNET (0: OFF 1: ON)

[0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Enables or disables the Web operation.

091 Web (0: OFF 1: ON)

[0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

145

510

Active IPv6 Link Local


Address

This is the IPv6 local address link referenced on the Ethernet


or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:
"Link Local Address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8
blocks of 16 bits each.

Main SP Tables-5

147

Active IPv6 Stateless


Address 1

149

Active IPv6 Stateless


Address 2

151

Active IPv6 Stateless


Address 3

Active IPv6 Stateless


153
Address 4
155

These SPs are the IPv6 status addresses (1 to 5) referenced


on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:
"Status Address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8
blocks of 16 bits each.

Active IPv6 Stateless


Address 5
This SP is the IPv6 manually set address referenced on the
Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:

156 IPv6 Manual Address

"Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length"

The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8


blocks of 16 bits each.
158 IPv6 Gateway Address

This SP is the IPv6 gateway address referenced on the Ethernet


or wireless LAN (802.11b). The IPv6 address consists of a
total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.
Enables or disables the automatic setting for IPv6 stateless.

161 IPv6 Stateless Auto Setting [0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]


0: Disable, 1: Enable
Displays or does not display the Web system items.
[0 x 0000 to 0 x ffff / 0 x ffff] 0: Not displayed, 1: Displayed
236 Web Item visible

bit0: Net RICOH


bit1: Consumable Supplier
bit2-15: Reserved (all)

237 Web shopping link visible

Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on the top
page and link page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display

511

5. System Maintenance

238 Web supplies Link visible

Displays or does not display the link to Consumable Supplier


on the top page and link page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display

239 Web Link1 Name

This SP confirms or changes the URL1 name on the link page


of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL name
are 31 characters.

240 Web Link1 URL

This SP confirms or changes the link to URL1 on the link page


of the web system. The maximum characters for the URL are
127 characters.

241 Web Link1 visible

Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top page
of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display

5832

512

242 Web Link2 Name

Same as "-239"

243 Web Link2 URL

Same as "-240"

244 Web Link2 visible

Same as "-241"

[HDD] HDD Initialization

*CTL

Main SP Tables-5

001 HDD Formatting (ALL)


002 HDD Formatting (IMH)
003 HDD Formatting (Thumbnail)
004 HDD Formatting (Job Log)
005 HDD Formatting (Printer Fonts)
006 HDD Formatting (User Info)
007 Mail RX Data

Initializes the hard disk. Use this SP mode only if there


is a hard disk error.

008 Mail TX Data


009

HDD Formatting (Data for a


Design)

010 HDD Formatting (Log)


011 HDD Formatting (Ridoc I/F)
5836

[Capture Settings]
Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)

*CTL

0: Disable, 1: Enable

001 With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot be initialized,
displayed, or selected.
002

Panel Setting

0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed

Displays or does not display the capture function buttons.


5836-71 to 5836-78, Copier and Printer Document Reduction
The following 6 SP modes set the default reduction for stored documents sent to the
document management server via the MLB.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.

071 Reduction for Copy Color

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4, 6: 2/3

073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4, 6: 2/3

074 Reduction for Printer Color

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

075 Reduction for Printer B&W

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4, 6: 2/3


513

5. System Maintenance

076 Reduction for Printer B&W HQ

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

077 Reduction for Printer Color 1200

1: 1/2, 3: 1/4, 4: 1/6, 5: 1/8 (2: skipped) ,


6: 2/3

078 Reduction for Printer B&W 1200

1: 1/2, 3: 1/4, 4: 1/6, 5: 1/8 (2: skipped) ,


6: 2/3

5836-81 to 5836-86, Stored document format


The following 6 SP modes set Sets the default format for stored documents sent to the
document management server via the MLB.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,

081 Format for Copy Color

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
This SP is not used in this model.

082 Format for Copy B&W Text

083 Format Copy B&W Other

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,

084 Format for Printer Color

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
This SP is not used in this model.

085 Format for Printer B&W

086 Format for Printer B&W HQ


Default for JPEG

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]

091 Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document management server via
the MLB with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.

514

Main SP Tables-5

101 Primary srv IP address

Sets the IP address for the primary capture server. This is


basically adjusted by the remote system.

102 Primary srv scheme

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

103 Primary srv port number

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

104 Primary srv URL path

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

111 Secondary srv IP address

Sets the IP address for the secondary capture server. This is


basically adjusted by the remote system.

112 Secondary srv scheme

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

113 Secondary srv port number This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
114 Secondary srv URL path

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

120 Default Reso Rate Switch

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

Reso: Copy (Color)

[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]

121 Selects the resolution for color copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi
Reso: Copy (Mono)

[0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]

122 Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
Reso: Print (Color)
123

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for color print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi
Reso: Print (Mono)

124

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi

515

5. System Maintenance

Reso: Fax (Color)


125

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 6 / 4 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for color fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi

126 Reso: Fax (Mono)

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Reso: Scan (Color)

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 6 / 4 / 1/step]

127 Selects the resolution for color scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Reso: Scan (Mono)

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]

128 Selects the resolution for BW scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
5840

[IEEE 802.11]
[1 to 11 or 13 / 11 or 13 / 1 /step]
Channel Max

*CTL

Europe/Asia: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11

Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
006 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum
number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting.

516

Main SP Tables-5

[1 to 11 or 13 / 1 / 1 /step]
Channel Min

*CTL

Europe: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11

Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
007 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum
number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting.
0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -]
0 x FF to Auto [Default]
0 x 11 - 55M Fix
0 x 10 - 48M Fix

0 x 0F - 36M Fix
0 x 0E - 18M Fix
0 x 0D - 12M Fix
008 Transmission Speed

*CTL

0 x 0B - 9M Fix
0 x 0A - 6M Fix
0 x 07 - 11M Fix
0 x 05 - 5.5M Fix
0 x 08 - 1M Fix
0 x 13 - 0 x FE (reserved)
0 x 12 - 72M (reserved)
0 x 09 - 22M (reserved)
Selects the WEP key.
[00 to 11 / 00 / 1 binary]

011 WEP key Select

*CTL

00: Key #1
01: Key #2 (Reserved)
10: Key #3 (Reserved)
11: Key #4 (Reserved)

517

5. System Maintenance

Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11


card.
042 Fragment Thresh

*CTL

[256 to 2346 / 2346 / 1]


This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11
card is installed.
Determines whether the CTS self function is turned
on or off.

043 11g CTS to Self

*CTL

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11
card is installed.

044 11g Slot Time

*CTL

Selects the slot time for IEEE802.11.


[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: 20 m, 1: 9 m
Selects the debug level for WPA authentication
application.

045 WPA Debug Lvl

*CTL

[1 to 3 / 3 / 1] 1: Info, 2: warning, 3: error


This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11
card is installed.

5841

518

[Supply Name Setting]

Main SP Tables-5

001

Toner Name Setting: Black

002

Toner Name Setting: Cyan

003

Toner Name Setting: Yellow

004

Toner Name Setting: Magenta

007

OrgStamp

011

Staple Std1

012

Staple Std2

013

Staple Std3

014

Staple Std4

021

Staple Bind 1

022

Staple Blind2

023

Staple Blind 3

5844

[USB]

001

Transfer Rate

*CTL

Specifies supply names. These appear on


the screen when the user presses the
Inquiry button in the user tools screen.

*CTL

0x01: Full speed


0x04: Auto Change

Adjusts the USB transfer rate.


002 Vendor ID

*CTL

Displays the vendor ID. DFU

003 Product ID

*CTL

Displays the product ID. DFU

004 Device Release Number

*CTL

Displays the development release version number.


DFU

[Delivery Server Setting]

5845

*CTL

Provides items for delivery server settings.


001

FTP Port No.

[0 to 65535 / 3670 / 1 /step]

Sets the FTP port number used when image files to the Scan Router Server.

519

5. System Maintenance

IP Address (Primary)

Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255

002 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab
can be referenced by the initial system setting.
Delivery Error Display Time

[0 to 999 / 300 / 1 second /step]

006 Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a
test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external
device.
IP Address (Secondary)

Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255

008 Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary
delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without
reference to the DNS setting.
Delivery Server Model

[0 to 4/ 0 / 1 /step]

Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device.
0: Unknown
009 1: SG1 Provided
2: SG1 Package
3: SG2 Provided
4: SG2 Package
010 Delivery Svr. Capability

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits


Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible
Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible
Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists
Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists
Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists
Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists
Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set
to "0")

520

Changes the capability of


the registered that the I/O
device registered.

Main SP Tables-5

Delivery Svr Capability (Ext)

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
011

Bit7 = 1 Address book usage limitation (Limitation for each authorized user)
Bit6 = 1 RDH authorization link
Bit5 to 0: Not used

013

014

015

016

017

018

Server Scheme (Primary) DFU


This is used for the scan router program.
Server Port Number (Primary) DFU
This is used for the scan router program.

Server URL Path (Primary) DFU


This is used for the scan router program.
Server Scheme (Secondary) DFU
This is used for the scan router program.
Server Port Number (Secondary) DFU
This is used for the scan router program.
Server URL Path (Secondary) DFU
This is used for the scan router program.
Rapid Sending Control

022

Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error.
[0 to 1 / 0 / -]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

5846

[UCS Settings]

*CTL

Machine ID (For Delivery Server)

Displays ID

001 Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only
displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI.
The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary.

521

5. System Maintenance

Machine ID Clear (For Delivery Server)

Clears ID

002 Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute
this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the ID,
the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on.
Maximum Entries

[2000 to 20000/ 2000 /1 /step]

003 Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle.
If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the
data (excluding user code information) is displayed.
Delivery Server Retry Timer

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

006 Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server
address book.
Delivery Server Retry Times

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

007 Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server
address book.
Delivery Server Maximum Entries

[2000 to 50000 / 2000 / 1/step]

008 Sets the maximum number account entries of the delivery server user information managed
by UCS.
010

020

040

522

LDAP Search Timeout

[1 to 255 / 60 / 1 /step]

Sets the length of the timeout for the search of the LDAP server.
WSD Maximum Entries

[5 to 250 / 250 / 1 /step]

Sets the maximum entries for the address book of the WSD (WS-scanner).
Addr Book Migration (USB => HDD)
Not used in this machine.

Main SP Tables-5

Fill Addr Acl Info.


This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine
that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD
installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it
onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only by
the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician immediately
after power on grants full address book access to all users.
041

Procedure
1. Turn the machine off.
2. Install the new HDD.
3. Turn the machine on.
4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically.
5. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system administrator
or key operator.

6. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846-041. After this SP executes successfully, any user can
access the address book.
Displays the slot number where an address book data is in.
[0 to 30 / - /1]
0: Unconfirmed
043 Addr Book Media

1: SD Slot 1
2: SD Slot 2
4: USB Flash ROM
20: HDD
30: Nothing

047

Initialize Local Addr


Book

Clears the local address book information, including the user


code.

048

Initialize Delivery Addr Clears the distribution address book information, except the user
Book
code.

049

Initialize LDAP Addr


Book

Clears the LDAP address book information, except the user code.

050 Initialize All Addr Book

Clears all directory information managed by UCS, including all


user codes.

051 Backup All Addr Book

Uploads all directory information to the SD card.

523

5. System Maintenance

052 Restore All Addr Book

Downloads all directory information from the SD card.


Deletes the address book data from the SD card in the service slot.
Deletes only the files that were uploaded from this machine.
This feature does not work if the card is write-protected.

053 Clear Backup Info


After you do this SP, go out of the SP mode, and then turn
the power off.
Do not remove the SD card until the Power LED stops flashing.
Search option
This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book.

Bit: Meaning
060

0: Checks both upper/lower case characters


1: Japan Only
2: Japan Only
3: Japan Only
4 to 7: Not Used
Complexity option 1
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case and sets the length of the
password.

062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP does not normally require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password
policy to control access to the address book.
063 Complexity Option 2 DFU
064 Complexity Option 3 DFU
065 Complexity Option 4 DFU

091 FTP Auth Port Setting

Specifies the FTP port for getting a distribution server


address book that is used in the identification mode.
[0 to 65535 / 3671 / 1 /step]

524

Main SP Tables-5

094 Encryption Stat

Shows the status of the encryption function for the


address book data.

[Rep Resolution Reduction]

5847

*CTL

SP5847-1 through SP5847-8 changes the default settings of image data transferred
externally by the Net File page reference function. [ 0 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]
SP5847-21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files handled by NetFile.
"Net files" are jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the
DeskTopBinder software.
001 Rate for Copy Color

0: 1x

002 Rate for Copy B&W Text

1: 1/2x

003 Rate for Copy B&W Other

2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x

004 Rate for Printer Color

4: 1/6x

005 Rate for Printer B&W

5: 1/8x

0: 1x
1: 1/2x
006 Rate for Printer Color 1200dpi

2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
0: 1x
1: 1/2x

007 Rate for Printer B&W 1200dpi

2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x

Network Quality Default for JPEG


021 Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages. This function
is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option installed.
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]

525

5. System Maintenance

[Web Service]

*CTL

5848 2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. Setting of 0001 has
no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router.

5848

5848 100 sets the maximum size allowed for downloaded images. The default is equal
to 1 gigabyte.
Access Ctrl: Repository (only
002
Lower 4 bits)

003

Access Control: Doc. Svr. Print


(Lower 4 bits)

004

Access Control: User Directory


(Lower 4 bits)

007

Access Ctrl: Comm. Log Fax


(Lower 4 bits)

0000: No access control


0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder.
0010: No writing control

Switches access control on and off.

0000: No access control


009 Access Ctrl: Job Ctrl (Lower 4 bits) 0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder.
011 Access Ctrl: Device management
021 Access Ctrl: Delivery (Lower 4 bits)
022
99

Access Ctrl: uAdministration


(Lower 4bits)
Repository: Download Image
Setting

Repository: Download Image


100
Max. Size

526

DFU
Specifies the max size of the image data that the
machine can download.
[1 to 1024 / 1024 / 1 MB /step]

Main SP Tables-5

210 Setting: LogType: Job1


211 Setting: LogType: Job2
212 Setting: LogType: Access
213 Setting: Primary Srv

NIA

214 Setting: Secondary Srv


215 Setting: Start Time
216 Setting: Interval Time
217 Setting: Timing
5849

[Installation Date]

5849 1 Display

*CTL

The "Counter Clear Day" has been changed to


"Installation Date" or "Inst. Date".

Determines whether the installation date is printed on


the printout for the total counter.
5849 2 Switch to Print

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF (No Print)
1: ON (Print)

003 Total Counter


5850

[Address Book Function]

*CTL

Replacement of Circuit Classification Japan Only


003 The machine is sold ready to use with a G3 line. This SP allows you to switch all at once
to convert to G4 after you add a G4 line. Conversely, if for some reason the G4 line
becomes unusable, you can easily switch back to G3.
[Bluetooth ]
5851

Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key.
[0:Public] [1: Private]

527

5. System Maintenance

[Stamp Data Download]


Use this SP to download the fixed stamp data stored in the firmware of the ROM and copy
it to the HDD. This SP can be executed as many times as required. This SP must be executed
after replacing or formatting the hard disks.

5853

This SP can be executed only with the hard disks installed.


[Remote ROM Update]
5856

Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware using a local port (IEEE1284) when
updating the remote ROM.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]

002 Local Port

*CTL

0: Disable
1: Enable

5857

[Save Debug Log]

*CTL

On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF)

0: OFF, 1: ON

001 Switches the debug log feature on and off. The debug log cannot be captured until this
feature is switched on.
Target (2: HDD 3: SD)

2: HDD, 3: SD Card

002 Selects the storage device to save debug logs information when the conditions set with
SP5-858 are satisfied.
[ 2 to 3 / 2 / 1 /step]
Save to HDD
005

006

Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the HDD.
A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card.
Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to
each SD Card.
Save to SD Card
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the SD card.

009 Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB)


010 Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB Any Key)
528

Main SP Tables-5

011 Erase HDD Debug Data


012 Erase SD Card Debug Data
013 Free Space on SD Card
014 Copy SD to SD (Latest 4 MB)
015 Copy SD to SD (Latest 4 MB Any Key)
016 Make HDD Debug
017 Make SD Debug
[Debug Save When]
5858

001

002

*CTL

These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination
selected by SP5857-002.
SP5858-3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes.
Engine SC Error
(0: OFF, 1: ON)
Controller SC Error
(0: OFF, 1: ON)

Turns on/off the debug save for SC codes generated by


copier engine errors.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]
Turns on/off the debug save for SC codes generated by
GW controller errors.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]

003 Any SC Error

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]

004 Jam (0: OFF, 1: ON)

Turns on/off the debug save for jam errors.

5859

[Debug Save Key No.]

*CTL

529

5. System Maintenance

001 Key 1
002 Key 2
003 Key 3
004 Key 4

These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for
functions that use common memory on the controller
board.

005 Key 5
006 Key 6

[9999999 to 9999999 / 0 / ]

007 Key 7
008 Key 8

009 Key 9
010 Key 10
5860

[SMTP/POP3/IMAP4]

*CTL

020 Partial Mail Receive Timeout

[1 to 168 / 72 / 1 hour/step]

Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The
received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this
prescribed time.
021 MDN Response RFC2.5298 Compliance

[0 to 1 / 1 / ]

Determines whether RFC2.5298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply mail.


0: No
1: Yes
022 SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement

[0 to 1 / 0 / ]

Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the validated account
after the SMTP server is validated.
0: No. "From" item not switched.
1: Yes. "From item switched.
025 SMTP Auth. Direct Setting

530

[0 or 1 / 0 / ]

Main SP Tables-5

Selects the authentication method for SMPT.


Bit switch:
Bit 0: LOGIN
Bit 1: PLAIN
Bit 2: CRAM MD5
Bit 3: DIGEST MD5
Bit 4 to 7: Not used
This SP is activated only when SMTP authorization is enabled by UP mode.
Selects the MIME header type of an E-mail sent by
S/MIME.
026

S/MIME: MIME Header


Setting

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard

1: Internet Draft standard


2: RFC standard
5870

[Common Key Info Writing]

001 Writing

*CTL

Writes to flash ROM the common proof for


validating the device for @Remote specifications.

003 Initialize

*CTL

Initializes the data area of the common proof for


validating.

5873

[SD Card Appli Move]

001 Move Exec

This SP copies the application programs from the original SD card in


SD card slot 2 to an SD card in SD card slot 1.

002 Undo Exec

This SP copies back the application programs from an SD card in SD


Card Slot 2 to the original SD card in SD card slot 1. Use this menu
when you have mistakenly copied some programs by using "Move
Exec" (SP5873-1).

5875

[SC Auto Reboot]

531

5. System Maintenance

Enables or disables the automatic reboot function when


an SC error occurs.
[0 or 1/ 0 / ]

001 Reboot Setting

0: The machine reboots automatically when the


machine issues an SC error and logs the SC error code.
If the same SC occurs again, the machine does not
reboot.

*CTL

1: The machine does not reboot when an SC error


occurs.
The reboot is not executed for Type A or C SC codes.
Selects the reboot method for SC.
002 Reboot Type

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]

0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot


5878

[Option Setup]

001 Data Overwrite Security

Enables the Data Overwrite Security unit. Press


"EXECUTE" on the operation panel. Then turn the
machine off and on.

002 HDD Encryption

Installs the HDD Encryption unit.

Deletes the fixed phrase.

5881

[Fixed Phrase Block Erasing]

001 -

5883

[Line Speed Selection]


Selects the line speed for middle thick paper.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]

001 Middle Thick

5885

532

*ENG

0: MID CARD: Half Speed (115 mm/sec)


1: MID CARD: Normal Speed (C2.5c: 154,
C2.5d: 205 mm/sec)

[Set WIM Function] Web Image Monitor Settings


Close or disclose the functions of web image monitor.

Main SP Tables-5

0: OFF, 1: ON
Bit Meaning
0: Forbid all document server access (1)
1: Forbid user mode access (1)
020 Document Server ACC Ctrl

*CTL

2: Forbid print function (1)


3: Forbid fax TX (1)
4: Forbid scan sending (1)
5: Forbid downloading (1)
6: Forbid delete (1)
7: Reserved
Selects the display type for the document box list.

050 Document Server List Def. Lines *CTL

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details

051 DocSvr Trans

*CTL

Sets the number of documents to be displayed in


the document box list.
[5 to 20 / 10 / 1]
Selects whether the signature is added to the
scanned documents with the WIM when they are
transmitted by an e-mail.

100 Signature Setting

*CTL

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Setting for each e-mail
1: Signature for all
2: No signature

101 Encryption Setting

*CTL

Determines whether the scanned documents with


the WIM are encrypted when they are transmitted
by an e-mail.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not encrypted, 1:Encryption

200 Memory Leak Detect Stting


201

DocSrv Session Time Out


Setting

*CTL

Not Used

*CTL

Not Used

533

5. System Maintenance

5887

[SD Get Counter]


This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated.

001 -

*CTL

This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in


SD card Slot 2 (lower slot). The operation stores.
The file is stored in a folder created in the root
directory of the SD card called SD_COUNTER.
The file is saved as a text file (*.txt) prefixed with
the number of the machine.
1. Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower
slot).
2. Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE].
Touch [Execute] in the message when you are
prompted.

5
5888

[Personal Information Protect]


Selects the protection level for logs.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1}

001 -

*CTL

0: No authentication, No protection for logs


1: No authentication, Protected logs (only an
administrator can see the logs)

5893

[SDK Application Counter]

002 SDK-2
003 SDK-3
004 SDK-4
005 SDK-5
006 SDK-5

534

Displays the counter name of each SDK application.

001 SDK-1

5894

*CTL

[Test Name1]
Test Name1_1

Main SP Tables-5

001 Switch Charge Mode

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]

[Application Invalidation]
5895

Enables or disables the printer or scanner application.


These SPs are used only when an external controller is installed in the machine.

001

Printer

*CTL

002

Scanner

*CTL

5907

[Plug & Play Maker/Model Name]

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Enable
1: Disable

Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information
is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these names should be registered again.

After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting
is completed, the beeper sounds five times.
5913

[Switchover Permission Time]


Print Application Timer

*CTL

[3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second /step]

002 Sets the amount of time to elapse while the machine is in standby mode (and the operation
panel keys have not been used) before another application can gain control of the display.
5967

[Copy Server Set Function]

*CTL

0: ON, 1: OFF

Enables and disables the document server. This is a security measure that prevents image
data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must
switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting.

5974

[Cherry Server]
Specifies which version of ScanRouter, "Lite" or "Full", is installed.

001 Cherry Server

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / ] 0: Lite, 1: Full

535

5. System Maintenance

[Device Setting]
5985

The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this SP to enable
and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller
board, these SP codes must be set to "1".
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation
When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is limited only
for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
001 On Board NIC
Other network applications than NRS or LDAP/NT
authentication are not available when this SP is set to "2". Even
though you can change the initial settings of those network
applications, the settings do not work.

5
002 On Board USB

5987

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

[Mech. Counter]
001 0: OFF / 1: ON

5990

536

[SP print mode]


Prints out the SMC sheets.

This SP detects that a mechanical counter device is removed. If


it is detected, SC610 occurs.

Main SP Tables-5

001 All (Data List)

002 SP (Mode Data List)

003 User Program

004 Logging Data

005 Diagnostic Report

006 Non-Default

007 NIB Summary

008 Capture Log

021 Copier User Program

022 Scanner SP

023 Scanner User Program

024 SDK/J Summary

025 SDK/J Application Info

5998

5
-

[Fusing Cont mode] Fusing Control Mode


Turns the silent fusing warm-up mode on or off.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

001 fast/silent

*ENG

0: Silent (less noise)


1: Fast (less time)

537

5. System Maintenance

Main SP Tables-6
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
6006

[ADF Adj.] ADF Adjustment


Adjusts the side-to-side and leading registration of originals with the ARDF.

001 Side-to-Side Registration


002 Side-to-Side Registration
003 Leading Edge Registration

*ENG

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

*ENG

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

Adjusts the amount of paper buckle to correct original skew for the front and rear sides.
005 Buckle: Duplex Front
006 Buckle: Duplex Rear

*ENG

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]


[-2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

Adjusts the erase margin at the original trailing edge.


007 Rear Edge Erase

*ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

[ADF INPUT Check]


6007

Displays the signals received from the sensors and switches of the ARDF. Only Bit 0 is used
for ADF input check ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[ADF OUTPUT Check]

6008

Activates the electrical components for functional check.


It is not possible to activate more than one component at the same time (
SP Tables-9" in this section).

6009

538

[ADF Free Run]


Performs a DF free run in simplex, duplex mode or stamp mode.

001 Free Run Simplex Motion

002 Free Run Duplex Motion

003 Free Run Stamp Motion

p.627 "Main

Main SP Tables-6

6010

[Stamp Position Adj.] Fax Stamp Position Adjustment


Adjusts the horizontal position of the stamp on the scanned originals.

6010 1 Stamp Position Adj.

*ENG

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Original Size Detection Priority] Original Size Detection Priority


6016

Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since original sensors
cannot recognize all sizes.
*ENG

001

Original Size Detection


Priority

NA

EU/
ASIA

6017

0: Setting 1, 1: Setting 2
Setting 1

Setting 2

DLT SEF

Folio SEF 11" x 15"

LG SEF

Foolscap SEF

LT SEF

US EXE 8" x 10"

LT LEF

US EXE LEF

DLT SEF

8K 267 x 390 mm

LT SEF

16K 195 x 267 mm

LT LEF

16K 267 x 195 mm

[DF Magnification Adj.] DF Magnification Adjustment


Adjusts the magnification in the sub-scan direction for the ARDF.

001 DF Magnification Adj.

6020

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

*CTL

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

[Skew Correction Moving Setting]


Turns the original skew correction in the ARDF for all original sizes on or off.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

001 -

*ENG

0: Off (only for small original sizes)


1: On (for all original sizes)

539

5. System Maintenance

6128

001

Adjusts the punching position in the sub scan direction.


1.Domestic 2Hole (Europe
2Hole)

*ENG

002 2.North America 3Hole

*ENG

003 3.Europe 4Hole

*ENG

004 4.North Europe 4Hole

*ENG

005 5.North Europe 2Hole

*ENG

6129

001

[-7.5 to 7.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm/step]

[Punch Position: Main Scan]


Adjusts the punching position in the main scan direction.
1.Domestic 2Hole (Europe
2Hole)

*ENG

002 2.North America 3Hole

*ENG

003 3.Europe 4Hole

*ENG

004 4.North Europe 4Hole

*ENG

005 5.North Europe 2Hole

*ENG

6130

540

[Punch Position: Sub Scan]

[-2.0 to 2.0 / 0 / 0.4 mm/step]

[Skew Correction: Buckle Adj.]


Adjusts the paper buckle for each paper size.

Main SP Tables-6

001 A3T

*ENG

002 B4T

*ENG

003 A4T

*ENG

004 A4Y

*ENG

005 B5T

*ENG

006 B5Y

*ENG

007 DLT-T

*ENG

008 LG-T

*ENG

009 LT-T

*ENG

010 LT-Y

*ENG

011 12" x 18"

*ENG

012 Other

*ENG

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.25 mm/step]

[Skew Correction Control]


6131

Selects the skew correction control for each paper size. These are only activated for B804/
B805.

541

5. System Maintenance

001 A3T

*ENG

002 B4T

*ENG

003 A4T

*ENG

004 A4Y

*ENG

005 B5T

*ENG

006 B5Y

*ENG

007 DLT-T

*ENG

008 LG-T

*ENG

009 LT-T

*ENG

010 LT-Y

*ENG

011 12" x 18"

*ENG

012 Other

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: No (No skew correction)
1: Roller Stop Skew Correction

[Jogger Fence Fine Adj]


6132

542

This SP adjusts the distance between the jogger fences and the sides of the stack on the
finisher stapling tray in the (Booklet) Finisher B804/B805. The adjustment is done
perpendicular to the direction of paper feed.

Main SP Tables-6

001 A3T

*ENG

002 B4T

*ENG

003 A4T

*ENG

004 A4Y

*ENG

005 B5T

*ENG

[-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm/step]

006 B5Y

*ENG

007 DLT-T

*ENG

+ Value: Increases distance between jogger


fences and the sides of the stack.

008 LG-T

*ENG

009 LT-T

*ENG

010 LT-Y

*ENG

011 12" x 18"

*ENG

012 Other

*ENG

- Value: Decreases the distance between the


jogger fences and the sides of the stack.

[Staple Position Adjustment]


6133

Adjusts the staple position for each finisher (B408/B804/B805).


+ Value: Moves the staple position to the rear side.
- Value: Moves the staple position to the front side.

001

6134

Finisher (B408/B804/
B805)

*EN
G

[-3.5 to 3.5 / 0 / 1/step]

[Saddle Stitch Position Adjustment]


Use this SP to adjust the stapling position of the booklet stapler when paper is stapled and
folded in the Booklet Finisher B804.

543

5. System Maintenance

001 A3T
002 B4T
003 A4T
004 B5T

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.2 mm/step]


+ Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease.
- Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease.

005 DLT-T
006 LG-T
007 LT-T
008 12" x 18"

009 Other
6135

[Folder Position Adj.]


This SP corrects the folding position when paper is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher
B804.
001 A3T
002 B4T
003 A4T
004 B5T

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.2 mm/step]


+ Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease.
- Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease.

005 DLT-T
006 LG-T
007 LT-T
008 12" x 18"
009 Other
6136

[Folding Number]
Sets the number of times that folding is done in the Booklet Finisher B804.
001 -

544

[2 to 30 / 2 / 1 time/step]

Main SP Tables-6

6138

[FIN (TIG) INPUT Check] Finisher (B793) Input Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Main SP Tables-9" in this section)

6139

[FIN (KIN) INPUT Check] Finisher (B408) Input Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Main SP Tables-9" in this section)

6143

p.627

[FIN (KIN) OUPUT Check] Finisher (B408) Output Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Main SP Tables-9" in this section)

6145

p.627

[FIN (TIG) OUPUT Check] Finisher (B793) Output Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Main SP Tables-9"in this section)

6144

p.627

p.627

[FIN (ELB) INPUT Check] Finisher (D372) Input Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 500-sheet finisher. (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section)

6146

[FIN (ELB) OUPUT Check] Finisher (D372) Output Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 500-sheet finisher. (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section)
[Max. Pre-Stack Sheet]

6149

*ENG

Number of Pre-Stack Sheets

This SP sets the number of sheets sent to the pre-stack tray.


Note:
You may need to adjust this setting or switch it off when feeding thick or slick paper.

001 -

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheet/step]

545

5. System Maintenance

[INPUT Check]
6150

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the bridge unit (D386)/ side tray
(D542) ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[OUTPUT Check]

6151

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the bridge unit (D386)/ side tray
(D542) ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[INPUT Check]

6152

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the shift tray (D388) (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[OUTPUT Check]

6153

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the shift tray (D388) (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[INPUT Check]

6154

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 1 bin tray (D536) (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[OUTPUT Check]

6155

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 1 bin tray (D536) (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section)

001 1 bin: Junction Solenoid


[INPUT Check]
6160

546

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the two-tray paper feed unit
(D537), LCT 2000 (D538) and LCT 1200 (D539) ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this
section)

Main SP Tables-6

[OUTPUT Check]
6161

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the two-tray paper feed unit
(D537), LCT 2000 (D538) and LCT 1200 (D539) ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this
section)

547

5. System Maintenance

Main SP Tables-7
SP7-XXX (Data Log)

7401

[Total SC Counter]
Displays the number of SC codes detected.

001 SC Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step ]

[SC History]

7403

Logs the SC codes detected.


The 10 most recently detected SC Codes are not displayed on the screen, but can be seen
on the SMC (logging) outputs.

001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
006 Latest 5

*CTL

007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9

7502

[Total Paper Jam Counter]


Displays the total number of jams detected.

001 Total Jam

548

* CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]

Main SP Tables-7

7503

[Total Original Jam Counter]


Displays the total number of original jams.

001 Original Jam counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 original/step ]

[Paper Jam Location]


7504

ON: On check, OFF: Off Check


Displays the number of jams according to the location where jams were detected.
NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station.
001 At Power On

*CTL

003 Tray 1: ON

*CTL

004 Tray 2: ON

*CTL

005 Tray 3: ON

*CTL

006 Tray 4: ON

*CTL

007 LCT : ON

*CTL

008 Bypass: ON

*CTL

009 Duplex: ON

*CTL

011 Vertical Transport 1: ON

*CTL

012 Vertical Transport 2: ON

*CTL

5
For details, (
Detection")

p.786 "Jam

549

5. System Maintenance

013 Bank: Transport Sn1

*CTL

014 Bank: Transport Sn2

*CTL

017 Registration: ON

*CTL

018 Fusing Entrance: ON

*CTL

019 Fusing Exit: ON

*CTL

020 Paper Exit: ON

*CTL

021 Bridge Exit: ON

*CTL

022 Bridge Transport: ON

*CTL

024 Junction Gate Sensor : On

*CTL

025 Duplex Exit: ON

*CTL

026 Duplex Entrance: ON (Out)

*CTL

027 Duplex Entrance: ON (Out)

*CTL

051 Vertical Transport 1: Off

*CTL

052 Vertical Transport 2: Off

*CTL

053 Bank Transport 1: Off

*CTL

054 Bank Transport 2: Off

*CTL

057 Registration Sensor: Off

*CTL

058 LCT Feed Sensor : Off

550

060 Paper Exit Off

*CTL

061 Bridge Exit: Off

*CTL

062 Bridge Transport: Off

*CTL

For details, (
Detection")

p.786 "Jam

For details, (
Detection")

p.786 "Jam

Main SP Tables-7

064 Junction Gate Sensor : Off

*CTL

065 Duplex Exit: Off

*CTL

066 Duplex Entrance: Off (In)

*CTL

067 Duplex entrance : Off (Out)

*CTL

100 Finisher Entrance: KIN

*CTL

101 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: KIN

*CTL

102 Finisher Staple: KIN

*CTL

103 Finisher Exit: KIN

*CTL

105 Finisher Tray Lift Motor: KIN

*CTL

106 Finisher Jogger Motor: KIN

*CTL

107 Finisher Shift Motor: KIN

*CTL

108 Finisher Staple Motor: KIN

*CTL

109 Finisher Exit Motor: KIN

*CTL

191 Finisher Entrance: EUP

*CTL

192 Finisher Proof Exit: EUP

*CTL

193 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: EUP

*CTL

194 Finisher Stapler Exit: EUP

*CTL

195 Finisher Exit: EUP

*CTL

198 Finisher Folder: EUP

*CTL

199 Finisher Tray Motor: EUP

*CTL

200 Finisher Jogger Motor: EUP

*CTL

201 Finisher Shift Motor: EUP

*CTL

202 Finisher Staple Moving Motor: EUP

*CTL

203 Finisher Staple Motor: EUP

*CTL

204 Finisher Folder Motor: EUP

*CTL

206 Finisher Punch Motor: EUP

*CTL

For details, (
Detection")

p.786 "Jam

For details, (
Detection")

p.786 "Jam

551

5. System Maintenance

7505

[Original Jam Detection]


Displays the total number of original jams by location.

001 At Power On
003 Skew Correction: On
004 Registration Sensor: On
005 Original Exit Sensor: On

*CTL

053 Skew Correction: Off


054 Registration Sensor: Off

055 Original Exit Sensor: Off

7506

552

[Jam Count by Paper Size]


Displays the number of jams according to the paper size.
005 A4 LEF

*CTL

006 A5 LEF

*CTL

014 B5 LEF

*CTL

038 LT LEF

*CTL

044 HLT LEF

*CTL

132 A3 SEF

*CTL

133 A4 SEF

*CTL

134 A5 SEF

*CTL

141 B4 SEF

*CTL

142 B5 SEF

*CTL

160 DLT SEF

*CTL

164 LG SEF

*CTL

166 LT SEF

*CTL

172 HLT SEF

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]

Main SP Tables-7

255 Others

7507

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]

[Plotter Jam History]


Displays the 10 most recently detected paper jams.
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
006 Latest 5

*CTL

007 Latest 6

008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9

7508

[Original Jam History]


Displays the 10 most recently detected original jams.
001 Latest
002 Latest-1
003 Latest-2
004 Latest-3
005 Latest-4
006 Latest-5

*CTL

007 Latest-6
008 Latest-7
009 Latest-8
010 Latest-9
553

5. System Maintenance

7624

Part Replacement Operation ON/OFF


Selects the PM maintenance for each part.
001 K Drum Unit
002 M Drum Unit
003 C Drum Unit
004 Y Drum Unit
005 K Dev Unit
[0 or 1 / 1 -]

006 M Dev Unit

0: Not PM maintenance

007 C Dev Unit

1: PM maintenance

008 Y Dev Unit


009 K Developer
010 M Developer
011 C Developer
012 Y Developer
013 ITB Unit
014 Belt Cleaning Unit
015 Fusing Unit

[0 or 1 / 1 -]
0: Not PM maintenance

016 PTR Unit

1: PM maintenance

017 Waste Toner Bottle


018 Fusing Roller
019 Pressure Roller
7801

[ROM No/ Firmware Version]


255 Engine

554

*CTL

Displays all versions and ROM numbers in the


machine.

Main SP Tables-7

7803

[PM Counter Display]


(Page, Unit, [Color])
Displays the number of sheets printed for each current maintenance unit.
PM counters click up based on the number of A4 (LT) LEF size sheets printed. Therefore,
the A3 (DLT) Double Count is activated. The Double Count cannot be deactivated.
When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-1 to 10) and is reset to 0.
The total number of sheets printed with the last unit replaced can be checked with
SP7-906-1 to 10.
NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station.
001 Paper

*CTL

*ENG

002 Page: K Drum Unit

003 Page: M Drum Unit


004 Page: C Drum Unit
005 Page: Y Drum Unit
006 Page: K Dev Unit
007 Page: M Dev Unit
008 Page: C Dev Unit
009 Page: Y Dev Unit

555

5. System Maintenance

010 Page: K Developer


011 Page: M Developer
012 Page: C Developer
013 Page: Y Developer
014 Page: ITB Unit
015 Page: Belt Cleaning Unit

*ENG

016 Page: Fusing Unit


017 Page: PTR Unit

018 Page: Toner Collection Bottle


019 Page: Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)
020 Page: Pressure Roller
Displays the number of revolutions of motors or clutches for each current maintenance unit.
[ 0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 revolution/step ]
When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-11 to 20) and is reset to 0. The total number of revolutions made with the last
unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-11 to 20.

556

Main SP Tables-7

031 Rotation: K Drum Unit


032 Rotation: M Drum Unit
033 Rotation: C Drum Unit
034 Rotation: Y Drum Unit
035 Rotation: K Dev Unit
036 Rotation: M Dev Unit
037 Rotation: C Dev Unit

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]

038 Rotation: Y Dev Unit


039 Rotation: K Developer

040 Rotation: M Developer


041 Rotation: C Developer
042 Rotation: Y Developer
043 Rotation: ITB Unit

*ENG

044 Rotation: Cleaning Unit

*ENG

045 Rotation: Fusing Unit

*ENG

046 Rotation: PTR Unit

*ENG

047 Measurement: Toner Collection bottle

*ENG

048 Rotation: Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)

*ENG

049 Rotation: Pressure Roller

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]

Displays the value given by the following formula:


(Current revolution Target revolution) 100. This shows how much of the units expected
lifetime has been used up.
The Rotation% counter is based on rotations, not prints. If the number of rotations reaches
the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the print count lifetime is reached
first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the R% counter is still less than
100%.

557

5. System Maintenance

061 Rotation (%): K Drum Unit


062 Rotation (%): M Drum Unit
063 Rotation (%): C Drum Unit
064 Rotation (%): Y Drum Unit
065 Rotation (%): K Dev Unit
066 Rotation (%): M Dev Unit
067 Rotation (%): C Dev Unit

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

068 Rotation (%): Y Dev Unit

069 Rotation (%): K Developer


070 Rotation (%): M Developer
071 Rotation (%): C Developer
072 Rotation (%): Y Developer
073 Rotation (%): ITB Unit
074 Rotation (%): Cleaning Unit
075 Rotation (%): Fusing Unit
076 Rotation (%): PTR Unit
077 Measurement (%): Toner Collection bottle
078 Rotation (%): Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)
079 Rotation (%): Pressure Roller
Displays the value given by the following formula:
(Current printouts Target printouts) 100. This shows how much of the units expected
lifetime has been used up.
The Page% counter is based on printouts, not revolutions. If the number of printouts reaches
the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the revolution count lifetime is
reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the Page% counter
is still less than 100%.

558

Main SP Tables-7

091 Page (%): K PCU (Drum Unit)


092 Page (%): M PCU (Drum Unit)
093 Page (%): C PCU (Drum Unit)
094 Page (%): Y PCU (Drum Unit)

*ENG

095 Page (%): K Dev Unit

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

096 Page (%): M Dev Unit


097 Page (%): C Dev Unit
098 Page (%): Y Dev Unit
099 Page (%): K Developer

100 Page (%): M Developer


101 Page (%): C Developer
102 Page (%): Y Developer
103 Page (%): ITB Unit

*ENG

104 Page (%): Cleaning Unit

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

105 Page (%): Fusing Unit


106 Page (%): PTR Unit
107 Page (%): Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)
108 Page (%): Pressure Roller

7804

[PM Counter Reset] PM Counter Clear


(Unit, [Color])
Clears the PM counter.
Press the Enter key after the machine asks Execute?, which will store the PM counter value
in SP7-906 (PM Counter - Previous) and reset the value of the current PM counter
(SP7-803) to 0.
002 PCU (Drum Unit): Bk

003 PCU (Drum Unit): M

559

5. System Maintenance

7807

004 PCU (Drum Unit): C

005 PCU (Drum Unit): Y

006 PCU (Drum Unit): All

007 Development Unit: Bk

008 Development Unit: M

009 Development Unit: C

010 Development Unit: Y

011 Development Unit: All

012 Developer: Bk

013 Developer: M

014 Developer: C

015 Developer: Y

016 Developer: All

017 ITB Unit

018 Cleaning Unit

019 Fusing Unit

020 PTR Unit

021 Toner Collection Bottle

023 Fusing Roller(Heating Roller)

024 Pressure Roller

100 All

[SC/Jam Counter Reset]


Clears the counters related to SC codes and paper jams.

001 SC/Jam Clear

560

Main SP Tables-7

7832

[Self-Diagnose Result Display]


Displays the result of the diagnostics.

001 Diag. Result


7835

*CTL -

[ACC Counter]

001 Copy ACC

*CTL

002 Printer ACC

*CTL

7836

Displays the ACC exectuion times for each mode.

Total Memory Size


Displays the memory capacity of the controller system.
[DF Scan Glass Dust Check Counter]

7852

Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on the scanning
glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1
(ADF Scan Glass Dust Check) is switched on.

001 Dust Detection Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]

002 Dust Detection Clear Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]

7853

[Replacement Counter]
Displays the PM parts replacement number.

561

5. System Maintenance

562

001 K Drum Unit

*CTL

002 M Drum Unit

*CTL

003 C Drum Unit

*CTL

004 Y Drum Unit

*CTL

005 K Dev Unit

*CTL

006 M Dev Unit

*CTL

007 C Dev Unit

*CTL

008 Y Dev Unit

*CTL

009 K Developer

*CTL

010 M Developer

*CTL

011 C Developer

*CTL

012 Y Developer

*CTL

013 ITB Unit

*CTL

014 Belt Cleaning Unit

*CTL

015 Fusing Unit

*CTL

016 PTR Unit

*CTL

017 Toner Collection Bottle

*CTL

018 Fusing Roller(Heating Roller)

*CTL

019 Pressure Roller

*CTL

[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]

Main SP Tables-7

[Coverage Range]
Sets the color coverage threshold.
Coverage rate = Coverage per page / A4 full coverage (dots) x 100
There are three coverage counters: Color 1, Color 2, and Color 3
[A] 5% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-001.
[B] 20% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-002.

7855

The setting value [B] must be set larger than [A].


The total numbers of printouts (BW printing plus color printing) for each coverage range
are displayed with the following SPs.

Color1 counter: SP8601-021


Color2 counter: SP8601-022
Color3 counter: SP8601-023
001 Coverage Range 1

*CTL

[1 to 200 / 5 /1]

002 Coverage Range 2

*CTL

[1 to 200 / 20 /1]

[Prev. Unit PM Counter]


7906

(Page or Rotations, Unit, [Color]), Dev.: Development Unit


Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance units.

563

5. System Maintenance

001 Page: K Drum Unit


002 Page: M Drum Unit
003 Page: C Drum Unit
004 Page: Y Drum Unit
005 Page: K Dev Unit
006 Page: M Dev Unit
007 Page: C Dev Unit

*ENG

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 page/step ]

*ENG

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 page/step ]

008 Page: Y Dev Unit

009 Page: K Developer


010 Page: M Developer
011 Page: C Developer
012 Page: Y Developer
013 Page: ITB Unit
014 Page: Cleaning Unit
015 Page: Fusing Unit
016 Page: PTR Unit
017 Page: Toner Collection Bottle
018 Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)
019 Pressure Roller
Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units.

564

Main SP Tables-7

031 Rotation: K Drum Unit


032 Rotation: M Drum Unit
033 Rotation: C Drum Unit
034 Rotation: Y Drum Unit
035 Rotation: K Dev Unit
036 Rotation: M Dev Unit
037 Rotation: C Dev Unit

*ENG

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]

038 Rotation: Y Dev Unit


039 Rotation: K Developer

040 Rotation: M Developer


041 Rotation: C Developer
042 Rotation: Y Developer
043 Rotation: ITB Unit
044 Rotation: Cleaning Unit
045 Rotation: Fusing Unit
046 Rotation: PTR Unit

*ENG

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]

047 Measurement: Toner Collection bottle


048

Rotation: Fusing Roller (Heating


Roller)

049 Rotation: Pressure Roller


Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance unit or toner cartridge.

565

5. System Maintenance

061 Rotation (%): K Drum Unit


062 Rotation (%): M Drum Unit
063 Rotation (%): C Drum Unit
064 Rotation (%): Y Drum Unit
065 Rotation (%): K Dev Unit

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]

066 Rotation (%): M Dev Unit


067 Rotation (%): C Dev Unit
068 Rotation (%): Y Dev Unit

069 Rotation (%): K Developer


070 Rotation (%): M Developer
071 Rotation (%): C Developer
072 Rotation (%): Y Developer
073 Rotation (%): ITB Unit
074 Rotation (%): Cleaning Unit
075 Rotation (%): Fusing Unit
076 Rotation (%): PTR Unit
077

Measurement (%): Toner Collection


bottle

078

Rotation: Fusing Roller (Heating


Roller)

079 Rotation: Pressure Roller


Displays the value given by the following formula:
(Current count Yield count) x 100, where Current count is the current values in the counter
for the part, and Yield count is the recommended yield.

566

Main SP Tables-7

091 Page (%): K Drum Unit


092 Page (%): M Drum Unit
093 Page (%): C Drum Unit
094 Page (%): Y Drum Unit
095 Page (%): K Dev Unit
096 Page (%): M Dev Unit
097 Page (%): C Dev Unit

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]

098 Page (%): Y Dev Unit


099 Page (%): K Developer

100 Page (%): M Developer


101 Page (%): C Developer
102 Page (%): Y Developer
103 Page (%): ITB Unit
104 Page (%): Cleaning Unit
105 Page (%): Fusing Unit
106 Page (%): PTR Unit

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]

107 Page (%): Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)


108 Page (%): Pressure Roller

7931

[Toner Bottle Bk]


Displays the toner bottle information for Bk.

567

5. System Maintenance

001 Machine Serial ID


002 Cartridge Ver
003 Brand ID
004 Area ID
005 Product ID
006 Color ID
007 Maintenance ID
008 New Product Information
009 Recycle Counter

010 Date
011 Serial No.

*ENG

012 Toner Remaining


013 EDP Code
014 End History
015 Refill Information
016 Attachment: Total Counter
017 Attachment: Color Counter
018 End: Total Counter
019 End: Color Counter
020 Attachment Date
021 End Date

7932

568

[Toner Bottle M]
Displays the toner bottle information for M.

Main SP Tables-7

001 Machine Serial ID


002 Cartridge Ver
003 Brand ID
004 Area ID
005 Product ID
006 Color ID

*ENG

007 Maintenance ID
008 New Product Information
009 Recycle Counter

010 Date
011 Serial No.
012 Toner Remaining
013 EDP Code
014 End History
015 Refill Information
016 Attachment: Total Counter
017 Attachment: Color Counter

*ENG

018 End: Total Counter


019 End: Color Counter
020 Attachment Date
021 End Date

7933

[Toner Bottle C]
Displays the toner bottle information for C.

569

5. System Maintenance

001 Machine Serial ID


002 Cartridge Ver
003 Brand ID
004 Area ID
005 Product ID
006 Color ID

*ENG

*ENG

007 Maintenance ID
008 New Product Information
009 Recycle Counter

010 Date
011 Serial No.
012 Toner Remaining
013 EDP Code
014 End History
015 Refill Information
016 Attachment: Total Counter
017 Attachment: Color Counter
018 End: Total Counter
019 End: Color Counter
020 Attachment Date
021 End Date

7934

570

[Toner Bottle Y]
Displays the toner bottle information for Y.

Main SP Tables-7

001 Machine Serial ID


002 Cartridge Ver
003 Brand ID
004 Area ID
005 Product ID
006 Color ID

*ENG

007 Maintenance ID
008 New Product Information
009 Recycle Counter

010 Date
011 Serial No.
012 Toner Remaining
013 EDP Code
014 End History
015 Refill Information
016 Attachment: Total Counter
017 Attachment: Color Counter

*ENG

018 End: Total Counter


019 End: Color Counter
020 Attachment Date
021 End Date
7935

[Toner Bottle Log 1: Bk]

571

5. System Maintenance

001 Serial No.


002 Attachment Date
003 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 1 for Bk.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 2 for Bk.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 3 for Bk.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 4 for Bk.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 5 for Bk.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 1 for M.

004 Refill Information


011 Serial No.
012 Attachment Date
013 Attachment: Total Counter
014 Refill Information
021 Serial No.

022 Attachment Date


023 Attachment: Total Counter
024 Refill Information
031 Serial No.
032 Attachment Date
033 Attachment: Total Counter
034 Refill Information
041 Serial No.
042 Attachment Date
043 Attachment: Total Counter
044 Refill Information
7936

[Toner Bottle Log 1: M]


001 Serial No.
002 Attachment Date
003 Attachment: Total Counter
004 Refill Information

572

Main SP Tables-7

011 Serial No.


012 Attachment Date
013 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 2 for M.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 3 for M.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 4 for M.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 5 for M.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 1 for C.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 2 for C.

014 Refill Information


021 Serial No.
022 Attachment Date
023 Attachment: Total Counter
024 Refill Information
031 Serial No.
032 Attachment Date
033 Attachment: Total Counter

034 Refill Information


041 Serial No.
042 Attachment Date
043 Attachment: Total Counter
044 Refill Information
7937

[Toner Bottle Log 1: C]


001 Serial No.
002 Attachment Date
003 Attachment: Total Counter
004 Refill Information
011 Serial No.
012 Attachment Date
013 Attachment: Total Counter
014 Refill Information

573

5. System Maintenance

021 Serial No.


022 Attachment Date
023 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 3 for C.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 4 for C.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 5 for C.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 1 for Y.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 2 for Y.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 3 for Y.

024 Refill Information


031 Serial No.
032 Attachment Date
033 Attachment: Total Counter
034 Refill Information
041 Serial No.

042 Attachment Date


043 Attachment: Total Counter
044 Refill Information
7938

[Toner Bottle Log 1: Y]


001 Serial No.
002 Attachment Date
003 Attachment: Total Counter
004 Refill Information
011 Serial No.
012 Attachment Date
013 Attachment: Total Counter
014 Refill Information
021 Serial No.
022 Attachment Date
023 Attachment: Total Counter
024 Refill Information

574

Main SP Tables-7

031 Serial No.


032 Attachment Date
033 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 4 for Y.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information


log 5 for Y.

034 Refill Information


041 Serial No.
042 Attachment Date
043 Attachment: Total Counter
044 Refill Information

7950

[Unit Replacement Date]


Displays the replacement date of each PM unit.

001 Image Transfer Belt


002 Cleaning Unit
003 Paper Transfer Unit
004 Fusing Unit
005 Toner Collection Bottle
006 K PCU (Drum Unit)

*ENG

007 M PCU (Drum Unit)


008 C PCU (Drum Unit)
009 Y PCU (Drum Unit)
010 Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)
011 Pressure Roller

7951

[Remaining Day Counter]


Displays the remaining unit life of each PM unit.

575

5. System Maintenance

001 Page: K Drum Unit


002 Page: M Drum Unit
003 Page: C Drum Unit
004 Page: Y Drum Unit
005 Page: K Dev Unit
006 Page: M Dev Unit
007 Page: C Dev Unit

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step]

008 Page: Y Dev Unit

009 Page: K Developer


010 Page: M Developer
011 Page: C Developer
012 Page: Y Developer
013 Page: ITB Unit
014 Page: Cleaning Unit
015 Page: Fusing Unit
016 Page: PTR Unit
017 Page: Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)
018 Page: Pressure Roller

576

Main SP Tables-7

031 Rotation: K Drum Unit


032 Rotation: M Drum Unit
033 Rotation: C Drum Unit
034 Rotation: Y Drum Unit
035 Rotation: K Dev Unit
036 Rotation: M Dev Unit

*ENG

037 Rotation: C Dev Unit

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step]

038 Rotation: Y Dev Unit


039 Rotation: K Developer

040 Rotation: M Developer


041 Rotation: C Developer
042 Rotation: Y Developer
043 Rotation: ITB Unit
044 Rotation: Cleaning Unit
045 Rotation: Fusing Unit
046 Rotation: PTR Unit
Measurement: Toner Collection
047
bottle
048

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step]

Rotation: Fusing Roller (Heating


Roller)

049 Rotation: Pressure Roller

7952

[PM Yield Setting]


Adjusts the unit yield of each PM unit.

001 Rotation: ITB Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 256597000 / 1 mm/step]

002 Rotation: Cleaning Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 128299000 / 1 mm/step]

003 Rotation: Fusing Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 155595000 / 1 mm/step]

577

5. System Maintenance

004 Rotation: Paper Transfer Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 192448000/ 1 mm/step]

011 Page: ITB Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 320000 / 1 sheet/step]

012 Page: Cleaning Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet/step]

013 Page: Fusing Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 160000 / 1 sheet/step]

014 Page: Paper Transfer Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 240000/ 1 sheet/step]

021 Day: K Drum Unit


022 Day: M Drum Unit
023 Day: C Drum Unit

024 Day: Y Drum Unit


025 Day: K Dev Unit
026 Day: M Dev Unit
027 Day: C Dev Unit

*CTL

Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each
PM unit.
[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
These threshold days are used for @Remote alarms.

028 Day: Y Dev Unit


029 Day: K Developer
030 Day: M Developer
031 Day: C Developer
032 Day: Y Developer
033 Day: ITB Unit
034 Day:Cleaning Unit
035 Day: Fusing Unit

*CTL

036 Day: PTR Unit

Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each
PM unit.
[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
These threshold days are used for @Remote alarms.

037 Day: Toner Collection Botte


038 Rotation: PCU (Drum Unit): Bk
039 Rotation: PCU (Drum Unit): M
040 Rotation: PCU (Drum Unit): C
041 Rotation: PCU (Drum Unit): Y
578

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

Main SP Tables-7

042 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk


043 Rotation: Development Unit: M
044 Rotation: Development Unit: C

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

045 Rotation: Development Unit: Y


046 Rotation: Developer: Bk
047 Rotation: Developer: M
048 Rotation: Developer: C
049 Rotation: Developer: Y
050 Page: PCU (Drum Unit): Bk
051 Page: PCU (Drum Unit): M
052 Page: PCU (Drum Unit): C

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

053 Page: PCU (Drum Unit): Y


054 Page: Development Unit: Bk
055 Page: Development Unit: M
056 Page: Development Unit: C
057 Page: Development Unit: Y
058 Page: Developer: Bk
059 Page: Developer: M
060 Page: Developer: C
061 Page: Developer: Y
7953

[Operation Env. Log: PCU: Bk]


Displays the PCDU rotation distance in each specified operation environment.
T: Temperature (C), H: Relative Humidity (%)

579

5. System Maintenance

001 T<=0
002 0<T<=5:0<=H<30
003 0<T<=5: 30<=H<70
004 0<T<=5: 70<=H<=100
005 5<T<15: 0<=H<30
006 5<T<15: 30<=H<55

*CTL

[0 to 99999999 / - / 1 mm/step]

*CTL

[0 to 99999999 / - / 1 mm/step]

007 5<T<15: 55<=H<80


008 5<T<15: 80<=H<=100
009 15<=T<25: 0<=H<30

010 15<=T<25: 30<=H<55


011 15<=T<25: 55<=H<80
012 15<=T<25: 80<=H<=100
013 25<=T<30: 0<=H<30
014 25<=T<30: 55<=H<55
015 25<=T<30: 55<=H<80
016 25<=T<30: 80<=H<=100
017 30<=T: 0<=H<30
018 30<=T: 30<=H<55
019 30<=T: 55<=H<80
020 30<=T: 80<=H<=100
[Operation Env. Log Clear]

7954

Clears the operation environment log.


001

7955

580

Fusing Stop

Main SP Tables-7

001

002

003

004

Near End: Page

[1 to 999999 / 318000 / 1 sheet/step]

Displays the threshold sheet for the heating roller near end.
End: Page

[1 to 999999 / 330000 / 1 sheet/step]

Displays the threshold sheet for the heating roller end.


Near End: Rotation

[0 to 999999999 / 999999999 / 1 mm/step]

Displays the threshold distance for the heating roller near end.
End: Rotation

[0 to 999999999 / 999999999 / 1 mm/step]

Displays the threshold distance for the heating roller end.

581

5. System Maintenance

Main SP Tables-8
SP8-xxx: Data Log2
Many of these counters are provided for features that are currently not available, such as sending color
faxes, and so on. However, here are some Group 8 codes that when used in combination with others, can
provide useful information.
SP Numbers

What They Do

SP8211 to SP8216

The number of pages scanned to the document server.

SP8401 to SP8406

The number of pages printed from the document server

SP8691 to SP8696

The number of pages sent from the document server

Specifically, the following questions can be answered:


How is the document server actually being used?
What application is using the document server most frequently?
What data in the document server is being reused?
Most of the SPs in this group are prefixed with a letter that indicates the mode of operation (the mode of
operation is referred to as an "application"). Before reading the Group 8 Service Table, make sure that
you understand what these prefixes mean.
Prefixes

582

What it means

T:

Total: (Grand Total).

C:

Copy application.

F:

Fax application.

P:

Print application.

S:

Scan application.

Grand total of the items counted for all applications (C, F, P,


etc.).

Totals (pages, jobs, etc.) executed for each application when


the job was not stored on the document server.

Main SP Tables-8

L:

Local storage (document


server)

Totals (jobs, pages, etc.) for the document server. The L:


counters work differently case by case. Sometimes, they
count jobs/pages stored on the document server; this can be
in document server mode (from the document server
window), or from another mode, such as from a printer driver
or by pressing the Store File button in the Copy mode
window. Sometimes, they include occasions when the user
uses a file that is already on the document server. Each
counter will be discussed case by case.

O:

Other applications
(external network
applications, for
example)

Refers to network applications such as Web Image Monitor.


Utilities developed with the SDK (Software Development Kit)
will also be counted with this group in the future.

The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on the small
LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations below and refer to it
again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand.

Key for Abbreviations


Abbreviation

What it means

"By", e.g. "T:Jobs/Apl" = Total Jobs "by" Application

>

More (2> "2 or more", 4> "4 or more"

AddBook

Address Book

Apl

Application

B/W

Black & White

Bk

Black

Cyan

ColCr

Color Create

ColMode

Color Mode

Comb

Combine

Comp

Compression

Deliv

Delivery

583

5. System Maintenance

Abbreviation

584

What it means

DesApl

Designated Application. The application (Copy, Fax, Scan, Print) used to


store the job on the document server, for example.

Dev Counter

Development Count, no. of pages developed.

Dup, Duplex

Duplex, printing on both sides

Emul

Emulation

FC

Full Color

FIN

Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.)

Full Bleed

No Margins

GenCopy

Generation Copy Mode

GPC

Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does not count
up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number
that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page job, the counter counts up
11-10 =1)

IFax

Internet Fax

ImgEdt

Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border
removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.

Black (YMCK)

LS

Local Storage. Refers to the document server.

LSize

Large (paper) Size

Mag

Magnification

MC

One color (monochrome)

NRS

New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor machines


remotely. "NRS" is used overseas, "CSS" is used in Japan.

Org

Original for scanning

OrgJam

Original Jam

Palm 2

Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows print jobs
to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files
to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats.

Main SP Tables-8

Abbreviation

What it means

PC

Personal Computer

PGS

Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original. Duplex pages
count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two pages if the A3/DLT
counter SP is switched ON.

PJob

Print Jobs

Ppr

Paper

PrtJam

Printer (plotter) Jam

PrtPGS

Print Pages

Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2 only. This
machine is under development and currently not available.

Rez

Resolution

SC

Service Code (Error SC code displayed)

Scn

Scan

Sim, Simplex

Simplex, printing on 1 side.

S-to-Email

Scan-to-E-mail

SMC

SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8 counters are recorded
in the SMC report.

Svr

Server

TonEnd

Toner End

TonSave

Toner Save

TXJob

Send, Transmission

YMC

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan

YMCK

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan, Black

All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801 1 Memory All Clear.

585

5. System Maintenance

T:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 002

C:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 003

F:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 004

P:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 005

S:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 006

L:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 001

These SPs count the number of times each application is used


to do a job.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: The L: counter is the total number of times the other
applications are used to send a job to the document server,
plus the number of times a file already on the document server
is used.

These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages processed.
When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.

Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer using the
SP modes are not counted.
When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is counted at
the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified.
A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.
When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not (the
document server is not used).
A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are not
counted separately).
A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one
transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission has been
completed.
A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.
The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.
When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a print job
stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.
When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters both
increment.
When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.
When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server, only the
L: counter increments.
When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server, only the
L: counter increments.

586

Main SP Tables-8

When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.
When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However,
for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter increments.
8 011

T:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 012

C:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 013

F:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 014

P:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 015

S:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 016

L:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 017

O:Jobs/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of jobs stored to the document


server by each application, to reveal how local storage is
being used for input.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from within
the document server mode screen at the operation panel.

When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document
server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.
When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.
When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.
When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.
When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.
8 021

T:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 022

C:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 023

F:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 024

P:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 025

S:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 026

L:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 027

O:Pjob/LS

*CTL

These SPs reveal how files printed from the document


server were stored on the document server originally.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.

When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter
increments.
When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document server
with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment.
When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter
increments.
587

5. System Maintenance

When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter
increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter
increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed
with another application, the O: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image
Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.
When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.

8 031

T:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 032

C:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 033

F:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 034

P:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 035

S:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 036

L:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 037

O:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

These SPs reveal what applications were used to output


documents from the document server.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs printed from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.

When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application
that started the print job is incremented.
When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.)
the L: counter increments.
8 041

T:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 042

C:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 043

F:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 044

P:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 045

S:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 046

L:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 047

O:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the applications that stored files on the


document server that were later accessed for
transmission over the telephone line or over a network
(attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax).
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted
separately.
The L: counter counts the number of jobs scanned from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.

When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an email, the O: counter increments.

588

Main SP Tables-8

8 051

T:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 052

C:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 053

F:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 054

P:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 055

S:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 056

L:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 057

O:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

These SPs count the applications used to send files from


the document server over the telephone line or over a
network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by
I-Fax). Jobs merged for sending are counted
separately.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs sent from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.

If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter
increments.
8 061

T:FIN Jobs

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
F:FIN Jobs

8 063

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by the application.
C:FIN Jobs

8 062

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time.
P:FIN Jobs

8 064

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
S:FIN Jobs

8 065

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.

589

5. System Maintenance

L:FIN Jobs
8 066

*CTL

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode
screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window
within document server mode.
O:FIN Jobs

8 067

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external application, over the
network. The finishing method is specified by the application.

8 06x 1 Sort

Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored copy job is set for Sort
and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments. (See SP8
066 1)

8 06x 2 Stack

Number of jobs started out of Sort mode.

8 06x 3 Staple

Number of jobs started in Staple mode.

8 06x 4 Booklet

Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the machine is in staple mode,


the Staple counter also increments.

8 06x 5 Z-Fold

Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Z-fold).

8 06x 6 Punch

Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch is set for a print job,
the P: counter increments. (See SP8 064 6.)

8 06x 7 Other

Reserved. Not used.

T:Jobs/PGS
8 071

8 072

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
F:Jobs/PGS

8 073

*CTL

These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in the job,
regardless of which application was used.
C:Jobs/PGS

590

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the number of
pages in the job.

Main SP Tables-8

P:Jobs/PGS
8 074

*CTL

These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
S:Jobs/PGS

8 075

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of pages in the job.
O:Jobs/PGS

8 077

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
L:Jobs/PGS

8 076

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs (Web Image
Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job.
8 07x 1 1 Page

8 07x 8

21 to 50 Pages

8 07x 2 2 Pages

8 07x 9

51 to 100 Pages

8 07x 3 3 Pages

8 07x 10

101 to 300 Pages

8 07x 4 4 Pages

8 07x 11

301 to 500 Pages

8 07x 5 5 Pages

8 07x 12

501 to 700 Pages

8 07x 6 6 to 10 Pages

8 07x 13

701 to 1000 Pages

8 07x 7 11 to 20 Pages

8 07x 14

1001 to Pages

For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode,
the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.
Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).
Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.
If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the time the
error occurs.
For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the number
of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)
The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of pages of the
copy job (SP 8072).

591

5. System Maintenance

When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted.
T:FAX TX Jobs
8 111

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax, either
directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
F: FAX TX Jobs

8 113

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax directly
on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.

8 11x 1 B/W

8 11x 2 Color
These counters count jobs, not pages.
This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including documents stored
on the document server.
If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job started.
If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where both are
available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (8 12x) also increments.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
T:IFAX TX Jobs
8 121

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, either directly
or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
F: IFAX TX Jobs

8 123

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not stored on the
document server), as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.

8 12x 1 B/W
8 12x 2 Color
These counters count jobs, not pages.

592

Main SP Tables-8

The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at this time.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
T:S-to-Email Jobs
8 131

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and
attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not.
S: S-to-Email Jobs

8 135

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached
to e-mail, without storing the original on the document server.

8 13x 1 B/W
8 13x 2 Color

8 13x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color or blackand-white then counted.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be
sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC, or if one
job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For example, if the same
document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is counted twice (once for Scan-toEmail and once for Scan-to-PC).
T:Deliv Jobs/Svr
8 141

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
to a Scan Router server.
S: Deliv Jobs/Svr

8 145

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned in scanner mode
and sent to a Scan Router server.

8 14x 1 B/W
8 14x 2 Color

593

5. System Maintenance

8 14x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router server
cannot be confirmed.
If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a "Color"
job.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be
delivered, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.

T:Deliv Jobs/PC
8 151

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC).
Note: At the present time, 8 151 and 8 155 perform identical counts.
S:Deliv Jobs/PC

8 155

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
with Scan-to-PC.

8 15x 1 B/W
8 15x 2 Color
8 15x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted.
If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.

594

Main SP Tables-8

8 161

T:PCFAX TX Jobs

*CTL

These SPs count the number of PC Fax transmission


jobs. A job is counted from when it is registered for
sending, not when it is sent.

8 163

F:PCFAX TX Jobs

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.

This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to the
destination from the PC through the copier.
8 171

T:Deliv Jobs/WSD

*CTL

These SPs count the pages scanned by WS.

8 175

S:Deliv Jobs/WSD

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

-001 B/W

-002 Color
-003 ACS
8 181

T:Scan to Media Jobs

*CTL

These SPs count the scanned pages in a media by the


scanner application.

8 185

S:Scan to Media Jobs

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

-001 B/W
-002 Color
-003 ACS
8 191

T:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

8 192

C:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

8 193

F:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

8 195

S:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

8 196

L:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

These SPs count the pages scanned by each


application that uses the scanner to scan images.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

SP 8 191 to 8 196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages.
These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.
Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.

595

5. System Maintenance

A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.
Scans made in SP mode are not counted.
Examples
If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S: count
is 4.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File button
in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
T:LSize Scan PGS

8 201

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan and copy
jobs. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
F: LSize Scan PGS

8 203

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for fax transmission.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
S:LSize Scan PGS

8 205

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan jobs only.
Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.

8 211

T:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 212

C:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 213

F:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 215

S:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 216

L:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages scanned into the


document server .
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen

Reading user stamp data is not counted.


If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted.
If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4.
If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change.

596

Main SP Tables-8

If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the
L: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
8 221

ADF Org Feeds

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back side scanning.
Number of front sides fed for scanning:

8 221 1

Front

With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is
the same as the number of pages fed for either simplex or duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count
is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The
front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.)
Number of rear sides fed for scanning:

8 221 2

Back

With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the
same as the number of pages fed for duplex scanning.

With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is
the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning.
When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.
If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the
pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.
Scan PGS/Mode
8 231

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to determine the
work load on the ADF.

8 231 1 Large Volume

Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot be loaded in the


ADF at one time.

8 231 2 SADF

Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the ADF.

8 231 3 Mixed Size

Selectable. Select "Mixed Sizes" on the operation panel.

8 231 4 Custom Size

Selectable. Originals of non-standard size.

8 231 5 Platen

Book mode. Raising the ADF and placing the original


directly on the platen.

8 231 6 Mixed 1side/ 2side

Simplex and Duplex mode.

597

5. System Maintenance

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the original's
page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.
If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled.
In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the
Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.
T:Scan PGS/Org
8 241

8 242

8 243

8 245

*CTL

These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all jobs,
regardless of which application was used.
C:Scan PGS/Org

*CTL

598

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy jobs.
F:Scan PGS/Org

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax jobs.
S:Scan PGS/Org

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan jobs.
L:Scan PGS/Org

8 246

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document
server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within
the Copy mode screen
8 241

8 242

8 243

8 245

8 246

8 24x 1: Text

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 2: Text/Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 3: Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 4: GenCopy, Pale

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

8 24x 5: Map

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

8 24x 6: Normal/Detail

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

8 24x 7: Fine/Super Fine

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

8 24x 8: Binary

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

Main SP Tables-8

8 24x 9: Grayscale

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

8 24x 10: Color

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

8 24x 11: Other

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
8 251

T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 252

C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 254

P:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 255

S : Scan PGS/ImgEdr

*CTL

8 256

L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

These SPs show how many times Image Edit features


have been selected at the operation panel for each
application. Some examples of these editing features
are:
Erase> Border
Erase> Center

Image Repeat
Centering
Positive/Negative

8 257

O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: The count totals the number of times the edit
features have been used. A detailed breakdown of
exactly which features have been used is not given.

The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.
8 261

T:Scan PGS/ColCr

*CTL

8 262

C:Scan PGS/ ColCr

*CTL

8 265

S:Scn PGS/Color

*CTL

8 266

L:Scn PGS/ColCr

*CTL

8 26x 1 Color Conversion


8 26x 2 Color Erase
8 26x 3 Background

These SPs show how many times color creation features


have been selected at the operation panel.

8 26x 4 Other

599

5. System Maintenance

8 281

T:Scan PGS/TWAIN

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages scanned using a


TWAIN driver. These counters reveal how the TWAIN
driver is used for delivery functions.

8 285

S:Scan PGS/TWAIN

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.

8 291

T:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

8 293

F:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages stamped with the


stamp in the ADF unit.

8 295

S:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

5
T:Scan PGS/Size
8 301

600

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan application.
Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP
8-445].
L:Scan PGS/Size

8 306

*CTL

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax application. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-443].
S:Scan PGS/Size

8 305

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application.
Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page
size [SP 8-442].
F:Scan PGS/Size

8 303

*CTL

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all applications. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size
[SP 8-441].
C:Scan PGS/Size

8 302

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored from within the
document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size
(scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446].

Main SP Tables-8

8 30x 1 A3
8 30x 2 A4
8 30x 3 A5
8 30x 4 B4
8 30x 5 B5
8 30x 6 DLT
8 30x 7 LG

8 30x 8 LT
8 30x 9 HLT

8 30x 10 Full Bleed


8 30x 254 Other (Standard)
8 30x 255 Other (Custom)
T:Scan PGS/Rez
8 311

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
S: Scan PGS/Rez

8 315

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
Note: At the present time, SP8-311 and SP8-315 perform identical counts.

8 31x 1

1200dpi <

8 31x 2

600dpi to 1199dpi

8 31x 3

400dpi to 599dpi

8 31x 4

200dpi to 399dpi

8 31x 5

< 199dpi

Copy resolution settings are fixed so they are not counted.


The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done for the Fax
application.
601

5. System Maintenance

8 381

T:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 382

C:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 383

F:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 384

P:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 385

S:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 386

L:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 387

O:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed by the


customer. The counter for the application used for
storing the pages increments.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.

When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as
2.

When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages
are not counted as printed pages:
- Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
- Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
- Reports printed to confirm counts.
- All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
- Test prints for machine image adjustment.
- Error notification reports.
- Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.
LSize PrtPGS
8 391

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also
displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.

602

Main SP Tables-8

8 401

T:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 402

C:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 403

F:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 404

P:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 405

S:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 406

L:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed from the


document server. The counter for the application used
to print the pages is incremented.
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.
Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.

8 411

Prints/Duplex

*CTL

This SP counts the amount of paper (front/back


counted as 1 page) used for duplex printing. Last
pages printed only on one side are not counted.

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 421

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the printer application.
S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 425

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 424

*CTL

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the copier application.
F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 423

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 422

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the scanner application.

603

5. System Maintenance

L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation
panel.

8 426

O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 427

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by Other applications

8 42x 1 Simplex> Duplex


8 42x 2 Duplex> Duplex
8 42x 3 Book> Duplex

8 42x 4 Simplex Combine


8 42x 5 Duplex Combine
8 42x 6 2>

2 pages on 1 side (2-Up)

8 42x 7 4>

4 pages on 1 side (4-Up)

8 42x 8 6>

6 pages on 1 side (6-Up)

8 42x 9 8>

8 pages on 1 side (8-Up)

8 42x 10 9>

9 pages on 1 side (9-Up)

8 42x 11 16>

16 pages on 1 side (16-Up)

8 42x 12 Booklet
8 42x 13 Magazine
These counts (SP8 421 to SP8 427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their
compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.
Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.
Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:
Booklet

604

Magazine

Original Pages

Count

Original Pages

Count

Main SP Tables-8

T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 431

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document server mode
window at the operation panel with the three features below.
O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 437

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
print application.
L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 436

*CTL

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
copy application.
P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 434

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below,
regardless of which application was used.
C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 432

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with
Other applications.

8 43x 1 Cover/Slip Sheet

Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The count for a


cover printed on both sides counts 2.

8 43x 2 Series/Book

The number of pages printed in series (one side) or printed as


a book with booklet right/left pagination.

8 43x 3 User Stamp

The number of pages printed where stamps were applied,


including page numbering and date stamping.

605

5. System Maintenance

8 441

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 443

F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 447

606

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the printer
application.
*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the scanner
application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 446

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax application.

S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 445

*CTL

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy
application.

P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 444

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 442

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.
O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other applications.

Main SP Tables-8

8 44x 1 A3
8 44x 2 A4
8 44x 3 A5
8 44x 4 B4
8 44x 5 B5
8 44x 6 DLT
8 44x 7 LG
8 44x 8 LT
8 44x 9 HLT

8 44x 10 Full Bleed


8 44x 254 Other (Standard)
8 44x 255 Other (Custom)
These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF.
8 451

PrtPGS/Ppr Tray

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station.

8 451 1 Bypass Tray

Bypass Tray

8 451 2 Tray 1

Copier

8 451 3 Tray 2

Copier

8 451 4 Tray 3

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

8 451 5 Tray 4

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

8 451 6 Tray 5

LCT (Option)

8 451 7 Tray 6

Currently not used.

8 451 8 Tray 7

Currently not used.

8 451 9 Tray 8

Currently not used.

8 451 10 Tray 9

Currently not used.

607

5. System Maintenance

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications.
8 461

These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is based on
feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However,
these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page printed
on one side counts as 1.

8 462

8 463

8 464

C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy application.
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8 466

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel.

8 46x 1 Normal
8 46x 2 Recycled
8 46x 3 Special
8 46x 4 Thick
8 46x 5 Normal (Back)
8 46x 6 Thick (Back)
8 46x 7 OHP
8 46x 8 Other

8 471

608

PrtPGS/Mag

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed.

Main SP Tables-8

8 471 1 < 49%


8 471 2 50% to 99%
8 471 3 100%
8 471 4 101% to 200%
8 471 5 201% <
Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but performed
remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification adjustment as
well.
Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also
counted.
Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document server
are not counted.

Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are


counted.
The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate of
100%.
8 481

T:PrtPGS/TonSave

*CTL

8 484

P:PrtPGS/TonSave

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on.
Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 491

T:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 492

C:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 493

F:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 496

L:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 497

O:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed in the


Color Mode by each application.

8 49x 1 B/W
8 49x 2 Single Color

609

5. System Maintenance

8 49x 3 Two Color


8 49x 4 Full Color
8 501

T:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 504

P:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 507

O:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed in the


Color Mode by the print application.

8 50x 1 B/W
8 50x 2 Mono Color
8 50x 3 Full Color

8 50x 4 Single Color


8 50x 5 Two Color

8 511

8 514

610

T:PrtPGS/Emul

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed.
P:PrtPGS/Emul

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed.

Main SP Tables-8

8 514 1

RPCS

8 514 2

RPDL

8 514 3

PS3

8 514 4

R98

8 514 5

R16

8 514 6

GL/GL2

8 514 7

R55

8 514 8

RTIFF

8 514 9

PDF

8 514 10

PCL5e/5c

8 514 11

PCL XL

8 514 12

IPDL-C

8 514 13

BM-Links

8 514 14

Other

Japan Only

SP8 511 and SP8 514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.
Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.
8 521

T:PrtPGS/FIN

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy
application.
F:PrtPGS/FIN

8 523

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications.
C:PrtPGS/FIN

8 522

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Fax
application.
NOTE: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available.

611

5. System Maintenance

P:PrtPGS/FIN
8 524

*CTL

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print
application.
S:PrtPGS/FIN

8 525

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Scanner
application.
L:PrtPGS/FIN

8 526

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.

8 52x 1 Sort

8 52x 2 Stack
8 52x 3 Staple
8 52x 4 Booklet
8 52x 5 Z-Fold
8 52x 6 Punch
8 52x 7 Other

If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still
counted.
The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted.
8 531

Staples

T:Counter
8 581

This SP counts the amount of staples used by the machine.


[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the
application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.

8 581 1 Total
8 581 2 Total: Full Color
612

*CTL

Main SP Tables-8

8 581 3 B&W/Single Color


8 581 4 Development: CMY
8 581 5 Development: K
8 581 6 Copy: Color
8 581 7 Copy: B/W
8 581 8 Print: Color
8 581 9 Print: B/W
8 581 10 Total: Color
8 581 11 Total: B/W

8 581 12 Full Color: A3


8 581 13 Full Color: B4 JIS or Smaller
8 581 14 Full Color Print
8 581 15 Mono Color Print
8 581 16 Full Color GPC
8 581 17 Twin Colour Mode Print
8 581 18 Full Colour Print (Twin)
8 581 19 Mono Colour Print (Twin)
8 581 20 Full Colour Total (CV)
8 581 21 Mono Colour Total (CV)
8 581 22 Full Colour Print (CV)
8 582

C:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the copy application broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W
8 582 2 Single Color
8 582 3 Two Color

613

5. System Maintenance

8 582 4 Full Color


8 583

F:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the fax application broken down by color output.
8 583 1 B/W
8 583 2 Single Color
8 584

P:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the print application broken down by color output.

8 584 1 B/W
8 584 2 Mono Color
8 584 3 Full Color
8 584 4 Single Color
8 584 5 Two Color
8 586

L:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the local storage broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W
8 582 2 Single Color
8 582 3 Two Color
8 582 4 Full Color
O:Counter
8 591

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages printed, and
the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:) applications only.

8 591 1 A3/DLT
8 591 2 Duplex

614

*CTL

Main SP Tables-8

Coverage Counter
8 601

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total coverage for each color and the total printout pages for each
printing mode.

8 601 1 B/W
8 601 2 Color
8 601 11 B/W Printing Pages
8 601 12 Color Printing Pages

8 601 21 Coverage Counter 1


8 601 22 Coverage Counter 2

8 601 23 Coverage Counter 3

8 617

SDK Apli Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK applicaion.

8 617 1 SDK-1
8 617 2 SDK-2
8 617 3 SDK-3
8 617 4 SDK-4

8 617 5 SDK-5
8 617 6 SDK-6

8 631

8 633

T:FAX TX PGS

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
F:FAX TX PGS

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.

8 63x 1 B/W
8 63x 2 Color

615

5. System Maintenance

If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
T:IFAX TX PGS
8 641

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using
I-Fax.
F:IFAX TX PGS

8 643

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax images using
I-Fax.

8 64x 1 B/W
8 64x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
T:S-to-Email PGS
8 651

616

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for both
the Scan and document server applications.

Main SP Tables-8

S:S-to-Email PGS
8 655

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for the
Scan application only.

8 65x 1 B/W
8 65x 2 Color

The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is
cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.
If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are
sent to the same SMTP server together).
If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent
to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).

Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large
number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page
document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also
10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20.).
T:Deliv PGS/Svr
8 661

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server
by both Scan and LS applications.
S:Deliv PGS/Svr

8 665

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server
by the Scan application.

8 66x 1 B/W
8 66x 2 Color

The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router
server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done.
The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server.

617

5. System Maintenance

T:Deliv PGS/PC
8 671

*CTL

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on a PC (Scanto-PC) with the Scan and LS applications.
S: Deliv PGS/PC

8 675

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with Scan-to-PC with the
Scan application.

8 67x 1 B/W
8 67x 2 Color

8 681

T:PCFAX TXPGS

*CTL

8 683

F:PCFAX TXPGS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC Fax.


These SPs are provided for the Fax application only, so
the counts for SP8 681 and SP8 683 are the same.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the
destination.
When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only
counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes
up by 10, not 20.)
8 691

T:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 692

C:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 693

F:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 694

P:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 695

S:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 696

L:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages sent from the


document server. The counter for the application that was
used to store the pages is incremented.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the operation
panel. Pages stored with the Store File button from within
the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.

Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.
If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages
sent to each destination.

618

Main SP Tables-8

TX PGS/Port
8 701

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send them. For
example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN
(G3, G4) is 12.

8 701 1 PSTN-1
8 701 2 PSTN-2
8 701 3 PSTN-3
8 701 4 ISDN (G3,G4)
8 701 5 Network
8 711
8 715

T:Scan PGS/Comp

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

S:Scan PGS/Comp

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages sent by each compression mode.

8 715 1 JPEG/JPEG2000
8 715 2 TIFF(Multi/Single)
8 715 3 PDF
8 715 4 Other
8 715 5 PDF/Comp
8 721
8 725

T:Deliv PGS/WSD

*CTL

S: Dvliv PGS/WSD

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode.
x 1 B/W

x 2 Color

619

5. System Maintenance

8 731

8 735

8 741

T:Scan PGS/Media

*CTL

S:Scan PGS/Media

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by each scanner
mode.
x 1 B/W

x 2 Color

RX PGS/Port

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to receive them.

8 741 1 PSTN-1

8 741 2 PSTN-2

8 741 3 PSTN-3

8 741 4 ISDN (G3,G4)

8 741 5 Network

Dev Counter
8 771

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the development rollers) for
black and other color toners.

8 771 1 Total
8 771 2 K
8 771 3 Y
8 771 4 M
8 771 5 C
Toner_Bottle_Info.
8 781

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of already replaced toner bottles.


NOTE: Currently, the data in SP7-833-011 through 014 and the data in SP8-781-001
through 004 are the same.

620

Main SP Tables-8

8 781 1 Toner: BK

The number of black-toner bottles

8 781 2 Toner: Y

The number of yellow-toner bottles

8 781 3 Toner: M

The number of magenta-toner bottles

8 781 4 Toner: C

The number of cyan-toner bottles

8 791

LS Memory Remain

*CTL

This SP displays the percent of space available


on the document server for storing documents.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

Toner Remain
8 801

*CTL

[0 to 100/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP allows the user
to check the toner supply at any time.

Note: This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better than
other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10% steps).
8 801 1 K
8 801 2 Y
8 801 3 M
8 801 4 C
CVr Cnt: 0-10%
8 851

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 0% to 10%.

8 851 11 0 to 2%: BK

8 851 31 5 to 7%: BK

8 851 12 0 to 2%: Y

8 851 32 5 to 7%: Y

8 851 13 0 to 2%: M

8 851 33 5 to 7%: M

8 851 14 0 to 2%: C

8 851 34 5 to 7%: C

8 851 21 3 to 4%: BK

8 851 41 8 to 10%: BK

8 851 22 3 to 4%: Y

8 851 42 8 to 10%: Y

8 851 23 3 to 4%: M

8 851 43 8 to 10%: M

621

5. System Maintenance

8 851 24 3 to 4%: C
CVr Cnt: 11-20%
8 861

8 851 44 8 to 10%: C
*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 11% to 20%.

8 861 1 BK
8 861 2 Y
8 861 3 M
8 861 4 C

CVr Cnt: 21-30%


8 871

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 21% to 30%.

8 871 1 BK
8 871 2 Y
8 871 3 M
8 871 4 C
CVr Cnt: 31%8 881

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is 31% or higher.

8 881 1 BK
8 881 2 Y
8 881 3 M
8 881 4 C

8 891

Page/Toner Bottle

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner for each color.

8 891 1 BK
622

*ENG

Main SP Tables-8

8 891 2 Y
8 891 3 M
8 891 4 C

8 901

Page/Toner_prev1

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner for each color.

8 901 1 BK
8 901 2 Y
8 901 3 M

8 901 4 C

8 911

Page/Toner_prev2

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner for each color.

8 911 1 BK
8 911 2 Y
8 911 3 M
8 911 4 C

8 921

Cvr Cnt/Total

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.

623

5. System Maintenance

8 921 1 Coverage (%) Bk


8 921 2 Coverage (%) Y
8 921 3 Coverage (%) M
8 921 4 Coverage (%) C
8 921 11 Coverage /P: Bk
8 921 12 Coverage /P: Y
8 921 13 Coverage /P: M
8 921 14 Coverage /P: C

624

Machine Status
8 941

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation mode. These
SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for
improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards.

8 941 1 Operation Time

Engine operation time. Does not include time while controller


is saving data to HDD (while engine is not operating).

8 941 2 Standby Time

Engine not operating. Includes time while controller saves


data to HDD. Does not include time spent in Energy Save,
Low Power, or Off modes.

8 941 3 Energy Save Time

Includes time while the machine is performing background


printing.

8 941 4 Low Power Time

Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on. Includes


time while machine is performing background printing.

8 941 5 Off Mode Time

Includes time while machine is performing background


printing. Does not include time machine remains powered off
with the power switches.

8 941 6 SC

Total time when SC errors have been staying.

8 941 7 PrtJam

Total time when paper jams have been staying during


printing.

8 941 8 OrgJam

Total time when original jams have been staying during


scanning.

Main SP Tables-8

8 941 9 Supply PM Unit End

8 951

AddBook Register

Total time when toner end has been staying


*CTL

These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data registration.

8 951 1 User Code/User ID User code registrations.


8 951 2 Mail Address

Mail address registrations.

8 951 3 Fax Destination

Fax destination registrations.

8 951 4 Group

Group destination registrations.

8 951 5 Transfer Request

Fax relay destination registrations


for relay TX.

8 951 6 F-Code

F-Code box registrations.

8 951 7 Copy Program

Copy application registrations with


the Program (job settings) feature.

8 951 8 Fax Program

Fax application registrations with the


Program (job settings) feature.

8 951 9 Printer Program

Printer application registrations with [0 to 255 / 0 / 255]


the Program (job settings) feature.

8 951 10 Scanner Program

8 999

Admin. Counter List

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Scanner application registrations


with the Program (job settings)
feature.
*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.

625

5. System Maintenance

8 999 1 Total
8 999 2 Copy: Full Color
8 999 3 Copy: BW
8 999 4 Copy: Single Color
8 999 5 Copy: Two Color
8 999 6 Printer Full Color
8 999 7 Printer BW
8 999 8 Printer Single Color

8 999 9 Printer Two Color


8 999 10 Fax Print: BW
8 999 12 A3/DLT
8 999 13 Duplex
8 999 14 Coverage: Color (%)
8 999 15 Coverage: BW (%)
8 999 16 Coverage: Color Print Page (%)
8 999 17 Coverage: BW Print Page (%)
8 999 101 Transmission Total: Color
8 999 102 Transmission Total: BW
8 999 103 FAX Transmission
8 999 104 Scanner Transmission: Color
8 999 105 Scanner Transmission: BW

626

Main SP Tables-9

Main SP Tables-9
Input Check Table
When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit corresponds to a
different device as shown in the table.
Bit No.

Result

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

Copier

5803

Description

5803 1 2nd Tray Size Detection


5803 2 1st Tray Set Detection

Reading
0

See table 2 following this table.


Set

Not set

5803 3 1st Tray Paper Height Sensor1

See table 1 following this table.

5803 4 1st Tray Paper Height Sensor2

See table 1 following this table.

5803 5 2nd Tray Paper Height Sensor1

See table 1 following this table.

5803 6 2nd Tray Paper Height Sensor2

See table 1 following this table.

5803 7 1st Tray Paper End Detection

No paper

Paper remaining

5803 8 2nd Tray Paper End Detection

No paper

Paper remaining

5803 9 1st Tray Upper Limit Sensor

Not upper limit

Upper limit

5803 10 2nd Tray Upper Limit Sensor

Not upper limit

Upper limit

5803 11 Bypass Paper Width Detection


5803 12 Bypass Paper End Detection
5803 13 Bypass Paper Length Detection

See table 3 following this table.


No paper

Paper remaining

See table 3 following this table.

5803 14 1st Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 15 2nd Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected


627

5. System Maintenance

5803 16 Exit Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Paper not full

Paper full

Paper not detected

Paper detected

5803 19 Fusing Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 20 1st Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 21 2nd Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 22 Duplex Exit Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 23 Registration Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 24 Duplex Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 25 Junction Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Set

Not set

5803 30 Toner End Sensor: Bk

Toner end

Toner remaining

5803 31 Toner End Sensor: M

Toner end

Toner remaining

5803 32 Toner End Sensor: C

Toner end

Toner remaining

5803 33 Toner End Sensor: Y

Toner end

Toner remaining

5803 34 Drum Phase Sensor: Bk

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 35 Drum Phase Sensor: M

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 36 Drum Phase Sensor: C

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 37 Drum Phase Sensor: Y

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 38 Interlock Release Detection 1

Front door open

Front door closed

5803 39 Interlock Release Detection 2

Front door open

Front door closed

5803 40 Right Door

Closed

Open

5803 41 Duplex Cover

Closed

Open

5803 17 Tray Full Exit Sensor


5803 18 Fusing Exit Sensor

5803 26 2nd Tray Set Detection

628

Main SP Tables-9

5803 42 Toner Collection Bottle Set

Set

Not set

5803 43 Toner Collection Full Sensor

Not full

Full

5803 46 ITB New Unit Detection

Not new

New

5803 50 Airflow Fan: Front: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 51 Airflow Fan: Rear: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 52 Fusing Exit Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 53 2nd Duct Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 54 3rd Duct Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 55 Paper Exit Fan:Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 56 Fusing Coil Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 57 IH Power Supply Cooling Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 60 ITB Contact Motor Position

Not contact

Contact

5803 61 Paper Transfer Contact Motor Position

Not contact

Contact

5803 62 Toner Relay Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 63 ITB Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 64 K Drum/Development Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 65 M Drum/Development Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 66 C Drum/Development Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 67 Y Drum/Development Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 68 Fusing Exit Motor:Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 80 HVPS:TTS:SC Detection

SC detected

No SC

5803 81 HVPS:CB:SC Detection

SC detected

No SC

5803 82 HVPS:D:SC Detection

SC detected

No SC

5803 83 Fusing Destination Detection: DOM (Dom)

Set

Not set

5803 84 Fusing Destination Detection: NA

Set

Not set

New

Not new

5803 87 Fusing New Unit Detection

629

5. System Maintenance

5803 90 Zero-cross Signal

5803 91 Fusing Rotation Sensor

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 92 Fusing Pressue Release Sensor

Not contact

Contact

Closed

Open

(LD5V ON)

(LD5V OFF)

5803 100 Keycard: Set

Set

Not set

5803 101 Mechanical Counter Bk: Set

Set

Not set

5803 102 Mechanical Counter FC: Set

Set

Not set

5803 103 Key Counter: Set

Set

Not set

5803 200 Scanner HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

5803 201 Platen Cover Sensor

Open

Closed

5803 94 GAVD Open/Close Detection

5803 110 IOB Version

Table 1: Paper Height Sensor


0: Deactivated, 1: Activated (actuator inside sensor)
Remaining paper

Paper height sensor 1

Paper height sensor 2

Full

Nearly full

Near end

Almost empty

Table 2: Paper Size Switch (Tray 2)


Switch 1 is used for tray set detection.
0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed
Models
North America
630

Switch Location
Europe/Asia

4 (bit0)

3 (bit1)

2 (bit2)

Main SP Tables-9

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(A3 SEF)

(11" x 17" SEF)

8.5" x 14" SEF*2

B4 SEF*2

(B4 SEF)

(8.5" x 14" SEF)

A4 SEF

A4 SEF

8.5" x 11" SEF

8.5" x 11" SEF

B5 SEF

B5 SEF

11" x 81/2" LEF*3

A4 LEF*3

(A4 LEF)

(11" x 81/2" LEF)

10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4

B5 LEF*4

(B5 LEF)

(10.5" x 7.25" LEF)

A5 LEF

A5 LEF

*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003.
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004.
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002.
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-005.

Table 3: Paper Size (By-pass Table)


0: ON, 1: OFF
By-pass Paper Size Sensor

Length Sensor

NA

EU/ASIA

HLT SEF

A6 SEF

HLT SEF

A6 SEF

HLT SEF

A5 SEF

HLT SEF

A5 SEF

LT/LG SEF*1

A4 SEF

LT/LG SEF*1

A5 LEF

bit3

Bit2

Bit1

Bit0

631

5. System Maintenance

By-pass Paper Size Sensor

Length Sensor

NA

EU/ASIA

LT/LG SEF*1

A4 SEF

LT/LG SEF*1

A5 LEF

DLT SEF

A3 SEF

LT LEF

A4 LEF

DLT SEF

A3 SEF

LT LEF

A4 LEF

bit3

Bit2

Bit1

Bit0

*1: The paper size (LT or LG) can be selected with SP1-007-001.

ARDF (D540)

6007

632

Description

Reading
0

6007 1 Original Length 1 (B5 Detection Sensor)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 2 Original Length 2 (A4 Detection Sensor)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 3 Original Length 3 (LG Detection Sensor)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 4 Original Width 1

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 5 Original Width 2

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 6 Original Width 3

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 7 Original Width 4

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 8 Original Width 5

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 9 Original Detection

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 10 Separation Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 11 Skew Correction

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 12 Scan Entrance Secsor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Main SP Tables-9

6007 13 Registration Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 14 Exit Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 15 Feed Cover Sensor

ADF cover close

ADF cover open

6007 16 Lift Up Sensor

ADF cover close

ADF cover open

6007 17 Inverter Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

Original not detected

Original detected

6007 18 Pick-Up Roller HP Sensor


6007 19 Original Set HP Sensor
6007 23 Rear Edge Detection (Not used)

2000/3000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (B804, B805)

6140

Bit

Description

Reading
0

6140 1 Entrance Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6140 2 Proof Exit Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Not Full

Full

Paper not detected*1

Paper detected*1

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6140 6 Shift HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6140 7 Shift Exit Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6140 11 Paper Full Sensor: 2000-Sheet

Not Full

Full

6140 12 Oscillating Back Roller HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6140 13 Jogger HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6140 3 Proof Full Detection Sensor


6140 4 Trailing Edge Detection: Shift
6140 5 Staple Exit Sensor

6140 8 Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor


6140 9 Paper Detection Sensor: Staple
6140 10 Paper Detection Sensor: Shift

633

5. System Maintenance

6140 14 Exit Junction Gate HP Sensor

HP

Not HP

6140 15 Staple Tray Paper Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6140 16 Staple Moving HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6140 17 Skew HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6140 18 Limit SW

Not Limit

Limit

6140 19 DOOR SW

Closed

Open

6140 20 Stapler 1 Rotation

Not HP

HP

6140 21 Staple Detection

Staple not detected

Staple detected

6140 22 Staple Leading Edge Detection

Staple not detected

Staple detected

6140 23 Punch Moving HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6140 24 Punch Registration HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6140 26 Punch Chad Full Sensor

Not Full

Full

6140 27 Punch HP

Not HP

HP

6140 25 Punch Registratioin Detection Sensor

6140 28 Punch Selection DIPSW 1

See *1

6140 29 Punch Selection DIPSW 2

See *1

6140 30

Stack Junction Gate Open/Closed HP


Sensor

Not HP

HP

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Not HP

HP

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6140 34 Rear Edge Fence HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6140 35 Folder Cam HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6140 36 Folder Plate HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Paper not detected*2

Paper detected*2

6140 31 Leading Edge Detection Sensor


6140 32 Drive Roller HP Sensor
6140 33 Arrival Sensor

6140 37 Folder Pass Sensor


6140 38 Saddle Full Sensor: Front

634

Main SP Tables-9

6140 39 Saddle Full Sensor: Rear


6140 40 Saddle Stitch Stapler 1 Rotation: Front
6140 41 Saddle Stitch Detection: Front
6140 42

Saddle Stitch Leading Edge Detection:


Front

6140 43 Saddle Stitch Stapler 1 Rotation: Rear


6140 44 Saddle Stitch Detection: Rear
6140 45

Saddle Stitch Leading Edge Detection:


Rear

6140 46 Full Sensor: 3000-Sheet

Paper not detected*2

Paper detected*2

Not HP

HP

Staple not detected

Staple detected

Staple not detected

Staple detected

Not HP

HP

Staple not detected

Staple detected

Staple not detected

Staple detected

Not Full

Full

*1: Combination of DIP SW 1 and SW 2


DIP SW 1

DIP SW 2

Punch Type

Japan

Europe

North America

North Europe

*2: Please refer to "Lower Tray (B804 Only)" in the Service Manual for the "2000/3000 (Booklet)
Finisher".

1000-Sheet Finisher (B408)

6139

Description

6139 1 Entrance Sensor


6139 2

Shift Exit Sensor


(Lower Tray Exit Sensor)

Reading
0

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Paper not detected

Paper detected

635

5. System Maintenance

6139 3

6139 4

6139 5

Staple Entrance Sensor


(Stapler Tray Entrance Sensor)
Staple Moving HP Sensor
(Stapler HP Sensor)
Jogger HP Sensor
(Jogger Fence HP Sensor)

6139 6 Stack Feed-out Belt HP Sensor


6139 7 Staple Tray Paper Sensor
6139 8

Staple Rotation Sensor


(Staple Rotation HP Sensor)

6139 9 Staple Sensor


6139 10 Staple READY Detection
6139 11

Exit Guide Plate HP


(Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor)

6139 12 Shift HP Sensor


6139 13

6139 14

6139 15

Paper Sensor
(Stack Height Sensor)
Tray Lower Sensor
(Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor)
Proof Full Sensor
(Paper Limit Sensor)

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Not home position

Home position

Not home position

Home position

Home position

Not home position

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Not home position

Home position

Staple detected

Staple not detected

Staple detected

Staple not detected

Not home position

Home position

Not home position

Home position

Output tray not


detected

Output tray
detected

Lower limit

Not lower limit

Not full

Full

Bridge Unit (D386)/ Side Tray (D542)

6150

636

Description

Reading
0

6150 1 Bridge/Left: Exit Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

6150 2 Bridge/Left: Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Main SP Tables-9

6150 3 Bridge/Left: Set Detection

Set

Not set

6150 4 Bridge/Left: Exit Cover Detection

Closed

Open

6150 5 Bridge/Left: Feed Cover Detection

Closed

Open

Internal Shift Tray (D388)

6152

Description

6152 2 Shift: Position Sensor

Reading
0

Tray position: Front

Tray position: Rear

1 Bin Tray (D536)

6154

Description

Reading
0

6154 1 1 bin: Set Detection

Set

Not set

6154 2 1 bin: Paper Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Two-Tray PFU (D537)/ LCIT 2000 (D538)/ LCIT 1200 (D539)

6160

Description

Reading
0

6160 1 Bank: Tray3: Feed Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 2 Bank: Tray4: Feed Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 3 Bank: Tray5: Feed Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 4 Bank: Tray3: Relay Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 5 Bank: Tray4: Relay Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 6 Bank: Tray5: Relay Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Closed

Open

6160 7 Bank: Feed Cover Detection

637

5. System Maintenance

6160 11 Bank: Palau: Paper Supply Switch

Closed

Open

6160 12 Bank: Palau: Slide Switch

Closed

Open

Output Check Table


Copier
5804

638

Display

Description

5804 3 Drum/Dev Motor: K: HighSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-K: High


Speed

5804 4 Drum/Dev Motor: K: MiddleSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-K:


Middle Speed

5804 5 Drum/Dev Motor: K: LowSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-M: Low


Speed

5804 10 Drum/Dev Motor: M: HighSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor- C: High


Speed

5804 11 Drum/Dev Motor: M: MiddleSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y:


Middle Speed

5804 12 Drum/Dev Motor: M: LowSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Low


Speed

5804 17 Drum/Dev Motor: C: HighSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor- C: High


Speed

5804 18 Drum/Dev Motor: C: MiddleSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y:


Middle Speed

5804 19 Drum/Dev Motor: C: LowSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Low


Speed

5804 24 Drum/Dev Motor: Y: HighSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor- C: High


Speed

5804 25 Drum/Dev Motor: Y: MiddleSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y:


Middle Speed

Main SP Tables-9

5804 26 Drum/Dev Motor: Y: LowSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Low


Speed

5804 31 Fusing Exit Motor: HighSpeed

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor: High Speed

5804 32 Fusing Exit Motor: MiddleSpeed

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor: Middle Speed

5804 33 Fusing Exit Motor: LowSpeed

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor: Low Speed

5804 35 Fusing Exit Motor: LLowSpeed

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor: LLow Speed

5804 37 Toner Relay Motor

Toner Transport Motor

5804 40 Image Transfer Motor: HighSpeed

ITB Drive Motor: High Speed

5804 41 Image Transfer Motor: MiddleSpeed

ITB Drive Motor: Middle Speed

5804 42 Image Transfer Motor: LowSpeed

ITB Drive Motor: Low Speed

5804 50 Feed Motor: HighSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: High Speed

5804 51 Feed Motor: IncreaseSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Increase Speed

5804 52 Feed Motor: MiddleSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Middle Speed

5804 53 Feed Motor: MiddleIncreaseSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Middle Increase


Speed

5804 54 Feed Motor: LowSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Low Speed

5804 55 Feed Motor: LowInceraseSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Low Incerase Speed

5804 60 Regist Motor: HighSpeed

Registration Motor: High Speed

5804 61 Regist Motor: MiddleSpeed

Registration Motor: Middle Speed

5804 62 Regist Motor: LowSpeed

Registration Motor: Low Speed

5804 67 Duplex Feed M:CW:HighSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CW: High Speed

5804 68 Duplex Feed M:CW:MiddleSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CW: Middle


Speed

5804 69 Duplex Feed Motor: CW: LowSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CW: Low Speed

5804 74 Duplex Feed M:CCW:HighSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CCW:


High Speed

639

5. System Maintenance

5804 75 Duplex Feed M:CCW:MiddleSpeed

5804 76 Duplex Feed Motor: CCW: LowSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CCW:


Low Speed
Duplex Inverter Motor: CW: High Speed

5804 82 Duplex Reverse M:CW:MiddleSpeed

Duplex Inverter Motor: CW: Middle


Speed

5804 83 Duplex Reverse Motor: CW: LowSpeed

Duplex Inverter Motor: CW: Low Speed

5804 89 Duplex Reverse M:CCW:MiddleSpeed

5804 90 Duplex Reverse Motor: CCW: LowSpeed

640

Middle Speed

5804 81 Duplex Reverse M:CW:HighSpeed

5804 88 Duplex Reverse M:CCW:HighSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CCW:

Duplex Inverter Motor: CCW:


High Speed
Duplex Inverter Motor: CCW:
Middle Speed
Duplex Inverter Motor: CCW:
Low Speed

5804 95 ITB Contact Motor

Image Transfer Belt Contact Motor

5804 96 Paper Transfer Contact Motor

Paper Transfer Contact Motor

5804 97 1st Tray Lift Motor: Up

Tray Lift Motor 1: Lift Up

5804 98 1st Tray Lift Motor: Down

Tray Lift Motor 1: Lift Down

5804 99 2nd Tray Lift Motor: Up

Tray Lift Motor 2: Lift Up

5804 100 2nd Tray Lift Motor: Down

Tray Lift Motor 2: Lift Down

5804 102 Fusing Pressue Release Motor

Pressure Roller Contact Motor

5804 104 Polygon Moter: LL

Polygon Motor: LL

5804 105 Polygon Moter: L

Polygon Motor: L

5804 107 Polygon Moter: HH

Polygon Motor: HH

5804 110 Air Flow Fan: Front

Ventilation Fan - Front

5804 111 Air Flow Fan:Rear

Ventilation Fan - Rear

5804 112 Fusing Fan:H

Fusing Fan: High Speed

Main SP Tables-9

5804 113 Fusing Fan:L

Fusing Fan: Low Speed

5804 114 PSU Cooling Fan

PSU Fan 1: High Speed

5804 115 2nd Duct Fan: H

Duct Fan 2: High Speed

5804 117 3rd Duct Fan: H

Duct Fan 3: High Speed

5804 119 Paper Exit Fan:H

Paper Exit Fan: High Speed

5804 121 Fusing Coil Fan

IH Coil Fan

5804 122 IH Power Supply Cooling Fan

IH Inverter Fan

5804 126 Development Clutch: Bk

Development Clutch-K

5804 127 Development Clutch: M

Development Clutch-M

5804 128 Development Clutch: C

Development Clutch-C

5804 129 Development Clutch: Y

Development Clutch-Y

5804 130 Toner Bottle Clutch: Bk

Toner Bottle Clutch-K

5804 131 Toner Bottle Clutch: M

Toner Bottle Clutch-M

5804 132 Toner Bottle Clutch: C

Toner Bottle Clutch-C

5804 133 Toner Bottle Clutch:Y

Toner Bottle Clutch-Y

5804 134 Toner Supply Pump: Bk

Toner Supply Clutch: Bk

5804 135 Toner Supply Pump: M

Toner Supply Clutch: M

5804 136 Toner Supply Pump: C

Toner Supply Clutch: C

5804 137 Toner Supply Pump: Y

Toner Supply Clutch: Y

5804 138 1st Paper Feed Clutch

Paper Feed Clutch 1

5804 139 2nd Paper Feed Clutch

Paper Feed Clutch 2

5804 140 Bypass Feed Clutch

By-pass Feed Clutch

5804 141 Bypass Pickup Solenoid

Bypass Pickup Solenoid

5804 143 TD Sensor Shutter Solenoid

ID Sensor Shutter Solenoid

5804 144 Exit Junction Solenoid

Junction Gate 1 Solenoid

5804 145 1st Feed Pickup Solenoid

1st Pickup Solenoid

641

5. System Maintenance

5804 146 2st Feed Pickup Solenoid

2nd Pickup Solenoid

5804 161 PCL: Bk


5804 162 PCL: M
5804 163 PCL: C
5804 164 PCL: Y

642

5804 166 HST Sensor:Bk

TD Sensor:Bk

5804 167 HST Sensor: M

TD Sensor: M

5804 168 HST Sensor: C

TD Sensor: C

5804 169 HST Sensor: Y

TD Sensor: Y

5804 170 Toner End Sensor: Bk

Toner End Sensor: Bk

5804 171 Toner End Sensor: M

Toner End Sensor: M

5804 172 Toner End Sensor: C

Toner End Sensor: C

5804 173 Toner End Sensor: Y

Toner End Sensor: Y

5804 174 TM Sensor: Front

ID Sensor: Front

5804 175 TM Sensor: Center

ID Sensor: Center

5804 176 TM Sensor: Rear

ID Sensor: Rear

5804 177 TM Sensor: M

ID Sensor: M

5804 178 TM Sensor: C

ID Sensor: C

5804 179 TM Sensor: Y

ID Sensor: Y

5804 181 PP:Charge AC:Y:HighSpeed

5804 182 PP:Charge AC:Y:MiddleSpeed

5804 183 PP:Charge AC:Y:LowSpeed

5804 186 PP:Development:K

5804 187 PP:Development:M

5804 188 PP:Development:C

5804 189 PP:Development:Y

Main SP Tables-9

5804 190 PP:Separation

5804 192 RFID ON/OFF: K

5804 193 RFID ON/OFF: Y

5804 194 RFID ON/OFF: C

5804 195 RFID ON/OFF: M

5804 196 RFID COM ON:K

5804 197 RFID COM ON: Y

5804 198 RFID COM ON: C

5804 199 RFID COM ON: M

5804 202 Scanner Lamp

5804 216 LD1: K

5804 217 LD2: K

5804 218 LD1: M

5804 219 LD2: M

5804 220 LD1: C

5804 221 LD2: C

5804 222 LD1: Y

5804 223 LD2: Y

5804 224 PP:ITB:K

PP: Image Transfer Roller: K

5804 225 PP:ITB:M

PP: Image Transfer Roller: M

5804 226 PP:ITB:C

PP: Image Transfer Roller: C

5804 227 PP:ITB:Y

PP: Image Transfer Roller: Y

5804 228 PP:PTR:+

PP: Paper Transfer Roller:+

5804 229 PP:PTR:-

PP: Paper Transfer Roller:-

5804 231 HVPS: ChargeDC: K

5804 232 HVPS: ChargeDC: M

643

5. System Maintenance

5804 233 HVPS: ChargeDC: C

5804 234 HVPS: ChargeDC: Y

5804 237 PP:Charge AC:K:HighSpeed

5804 238 PP:Charge AC:K:MiddleSpeed

5804 239 HVPS: ChargeAC: K: LowSpeed

5804 244 PP:Charge AC:M:HighSpeed

5804 245 PP:Charge AC:M:MiddleSpeed

5804 246 HVPS: ChargeAC: M: LowSpeed

5804 251 PP:Charge AC:C:HighSpeed

5804 252 PP:Charge AC:C:MiddleSpeed

5804 253 HVPS: ChargeAC: C: LowSpeed

ARDF (D540)
6008

Display

Description

6008 1 Pick-Up Motor Forward


6008 2 Pick-Up Motor Reverse

644

6008 3 Feed Motor Forward

Feed Motor-Forward rotation

6008 4 Feed Motor Reverse

Feed Motor-Reverse rotation

6008 5 Relay Motor Forward

Transport Motor- Forward rotation

6008 7 Inverter Motor Reverse

Transport Motor- Forward rotation

6008 8 Inverter Motor Reverse

6008 11 Inverter Solenoid

6008 12 Stamp

Stamp Solenoid

6008 13 Fan Motor

6008 14 Feed Clutch

Main SP Tables-9

6008 15 Feed Solenoid

1000-Sheet Finisher (B408)


6144

Display

Description

6144 1 Relay Up Motor

Upper Transport Motor

6144 2 Relay Down Motor

Lower Transport Motor

6144 3 Exit Motor

6144 4 Proof Junction Gate SOL

Tray Junction Gate Solenoid

6144 5 Tray Up Motor

Lower Tray Lift Motor

6144 6 Jogger Motor

Jogger Fence Motor

6144 7 Staple Moving Motor

Stapler Motor

6144 8 Staple Motor

Stapler Hammer

6144 9 Staple Junction Gate SOL

Stapler Junction Gate Solenoid

6144 10 Positioning Roller Solenoid

Positioning Roller Solenoid

6144 11 Stack Feed-out Motor

6144 12 Shift Motor

6144 13 Exit Guide Plate Motor

2000/3000-Sheet (Booklet) Finisher (B804/B805)


6145

Display

Description

6145 1 Entrance Motor

Finisher Entrance Motor

6145 2 Upper Feed Motor

Upper Transport Motor

6145 3 Lower Feed Motor

Lower Transport Motor

6145 4 Exit Motor

Upper/Proof Tray Exit Motor

6145 5 Knock Roller Motor

Clamp Roller Retraction Motor

645

5. System Maintenance

6145 6 Shift Motor

Shift Roller Motor

6145 7 Exit Guide Plate Open/Close Motor Exit Guide Plate Motor

6145 8 Tray Lift Motor

Upper Tray Lift Motor

6145 9 Oscillating Back Roller Motor

Stacking Sponge Roller Motor

6145 10 Jogger Motor

Jogger Fence Motor

6145 11 Stack Feed-out Motor

Feed Out Belt Motor

6145 12 Staple Moving Motor

Corner Stapler Movement Motor

6145 13 Staple Skew Motor

Corner Stapler Rotation Motor

6145 14 Staple Motor

Corner Stapler EH530

6145 15 Upper Junction Gate Solenoid

Proof Junction Gate Solenoid

6145 16 Lower Junction Gate Solenoid

Stapling Tray Junction Gate Solenoid

6145 17 Knock Solenoid

Stapling Edge Pressure Plate Solenoid

6145 18 Trailing Edge Hold Solenoid

Positioning Roller Solenoid

6145 19 Saddle Stitch Hold Solonoid

Booklet Pressure Roller Solenoid

6145 20

646

Stack Junction Gate Open/Close


Motor

Stack Junction Gate Motor

6145 21 Trailing Edge Fence Moving Motor

Fold Unit Bottom Fence Lift Motor

6145 22 Saddle Stitch Staple Motor: Front

Booklet Stapler EH185R: Front

6145 23 Saddle Stitch Staple Motor: Rear

Booklet Stapler EH185R: Rear

6145 24 Folder Plate Motor

Fold Plate Motor

6145 25 Folder Roller Motor

Fold Roller Motor

6145 26 Drive Roller Oscillating Motor

Positioning Roller Motor

6145 27 Punch Motor

Punch Drive Motor

6145 28 Punch Moving Motor

Punch Movement Motor

6145 29 Punch Registration Detection Motor

Paper Position Sensor Slide Motor

Main SP Tables-9

Bridge Unit (D386)/ Side Tray (D542)


6151
6151 1

Display
Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: Current
Selection

Description
Bridge: Feed Motor: Current switching signal

6151 2 Bridge/Left: Feed Motor:Reset

Bridge: Feed Motor:Reset

6151 3 Bridge/Left: Feed Motor:Enable

Bridge: Feed Motor:Enable

6151 6 Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: High Speed

Bridge: Feed Motor: High Speed

6151 7

Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: Middle


Speed

6151 8 Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: Low Speed


6151 11 Bridge/Left: Junction Solenoid

Bridge: Feed Motor: Middle Speed


Bridge: Feed Motor: Low Speed
Bridge: Junction Solenoid

Shift Tray (D388)


6153

Display

6153 1 Shift Tray: Motor

Description
-

1 Bin Tray (D536)


6155

Display

6155 1 1 bin: Junction Solenoid

Description
-

Two-Tray PFU (D537)/ LCIT 2000 (D538)/ LCIT 1200 (D539)


6161

Display

6161 5 Bank1: Feed Motor:300mm/s

6161 6 Bank1: Feed Motor:265mm/s

Description
Feed Motor:High Speed
(D537/D538/D387)
Feed Motor: Increase Speed
(D537/D538/D387)

647

5. System Maintenance

6161 8 Bank1: Feed Motor:230mm/s

6161 9 Bank1: Feed Motor:215mm/s

(D537/D538/D387)
Feed Motor: Low Speed
(D537/D538/D387)

6161 10 Bank1: Feed Motor:205mm/s

Feed Motor:Low Increase Speed (D537/


D538/D387)

6161 15 Bank2: Feed Motor:300mm/s

Feed Motor:High Speed (D537)

6161 16 Bank2: Feed Motor:265mm/s

Feed Motor: Increase Speed (D537)

6161 18 Bank2: Feed Motor:230mm/s

Feed Motor: Middle Speed (D537)

6161 19 Bank2: Feed Motor:215mm/s

Feed Motor: Low Speed (D537)

6161 20 Bank2: Feed Motor:205mm/s

Feed Motor: Low Increase Speed (D537)

6161 30 Bank:Tray3: PU Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid (D537/ D538)

6161 31 Bank:Tray4: PU Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid (D537/ D539)

6161 32 Bank:Tray5: PU Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid (D539)

6161 35 Bank:Tray3: Feed Clutch

Pick-up Solenoid (D537/ D538)

6161 36 Bank:Tray4: Feed Clutch

Pick-up Solenoid (D537/ D539)

6161 37 Bank:Tray5: Feed Clutch

Pick-up Solenoid (D539)

Printer Service Mode


SP1-XXX (Service Mode)
1001

648

Feed Motor: Middle Speed

Bit Switch

Main SP Tables-9

001 Bit Switch 1

bit 0

DFU

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

DFU

bit 3

No I/O Timeout

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur.
bit 4

SD Card Save Mode

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot (* Card Save
Function in "System Maintenance Reference" section of the Field Service Manual).
bit 5

DFU

bit 6

DFU

bit 7

[RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the
printable area.
1001

Bit Switch

649

5. System Maintenance

002 Bit Switch 2

bit 0

DFU

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

Applying a collation Type

Shift Collate

Normal Collate

A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a
Collate Type configured.
If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect.
bit 3

0: Enable

1: Disable

Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job.

Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto PDL switching
is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly.

1001

650

[PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching

bit 4

DFU

bit 5

DFU

bit 6

DFU

bit 7

DFU

Bit Switch

Main SP Tables-9

003 Bit Switch 3

bit 0

DFU

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

[PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000.
In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "<ESC>*r0A") will be changed
to "<ESC>*r1A"

1001

bit 3

DFU

bit 4

DFU

bit 5

DFU

bit 6

DFU

bit 7

DFU

Bit Switch

004 Bit Switch 4 DFU


1001

Bit Switch

651

5. System Maintenance

005 Bit Switch 5


Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and "Punch
Type" buttons on the operation panel.
bit 0

Disable

Enable

If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type
from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured
options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:
"User Tools > Printer Features > System"

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

DFU

bit 3

[PS] PS Criteria

Pattern3

Pattern1

Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to determine whether a


job is PS data or not.
Pattern3: includes most PS commands.
Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers
bit 4

Increase max number of the stored jobs to 1000


jobs.

Disable
(100)

Enable (1000)

Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job
Type settings to 1000. The default is 100.
bit 5

Face-up output

Disable

Enable

Enable: All print jobs will be output face-up in the destination tray.

1001

bit 6

DFU

bit 7

DFU

Bit Switch

006 Bit Switch 6 DFU


1001

Bit Switch

007 Bit Switch 7 DFU

652

Main SP Tables-9

1001

Bit Switch

008 Bit Switch 8

bit 0

DFU

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

DFU

bit 3

[PCL,PS]: Allow BW jobs to print without requiring


User Code

Disable

Enable

Enable: BW jobs submitted without a user code will be printed even if usercode
authentication is enabled.

Color jobs will not be printed without a valid user code.


bit 4

DFU

bit 5

DFU

bit 6

[PS]: Orientation Auto Detect Function

Enable

Disable

Disable: Automatically chooses page orientations of PostScript jobs (Landscape or


Portrait) based on the content printed on the page.
bit 7

[PDF]: Orientation Auto Detect Function

Enable

Disable

Automatically chooses page orientations of PDF jobs (Landscape or Portrait) based on


the content printed on the page.
1003
1003 1

[Clear Setting]
Initialize Printer System
Initializes settings in the System menu of the user mode.

1003 3 Delete Program


1004
1004 1

[Print Summary]
Print Summary
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).

653

5. System Maintenance

1005
1005 1

1006

[Display Version]
Disp. Version
Displays the version of the controller firmware.
[Sample/Locked Print]

*CTL

0: Linked, 1: On

Enables and disables the document server. When you select 0, the document server is
1006 1 enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select
1, the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.
[Data Recall]

1101

Recalls a set of gamma settings. This can be either a) the factory setting, b) the previous
setting, or c) the current setting.

1101 1 Factory
1101 2 Previous
1101 3 Current

*CTL

1101 4 ACC

1102

1102 1

1103

[Resolution Setting]
Selects the printing mode (resolution) for the printer gamma adjustment.
2400x600 Photo, 1800x600 Photo, 600 x 600 Photo, 2400x600 Text, 1800x600, Text,
600x600 Text
[Test Page]
Prints the test page to check the color balance before and after the gamma adjustment.

1103 1 Color Gray Scale


1103 2 Color Pattern

1104

654

[Gamma Adjustment]
Adjusts the printer gamma for the mode selected in the Mode Selection menu.

Main SP Tables-9

1104 1 Black: Highlight


1104 2 Black: Shadow
1104 3 Black: Middle
1104 4 Black: IDmax
1104 21 Cyan: Highlight
1104 22 Cyan: Shadow
1104 23 Cyan: Middle
1104 24 Cyan: IDmax
1104 41 Magenta: Highlight

*CTL

[0 to 30 / 15 / 1/step ]

1104 42 Magenta: Shadow


1104 43 Magenta: Middle
1104 44 Magenta: IDmax
1104 61 Yellow: Highlight
1104 62 Yellow: Shadow
1104 63 Yellow: Middle
1104 64 Yellow: IDmax
[Save Tone Control Value]
1105

Stores the print gamma adjusted with the Gamma Adj. menu item as the current setting.
Before the machine stores the new current setting", it moves the data currently stored as the
current setting to the previous setting memory storage location.

1105 1 Save Tone Control Value

1106

[Toner Limit]
Adjusts the maximum toner amount for image development.

1106 1 Toner Limit Value

*CTL

[100 to 400 / 260 / 1 %/step ]

655

5. System Maintenance

Scanner SP Mode
SP1-xxx (System and Others)

1004

[Compression Type]
Selects the compression type for binary picture processing.

1004 1 Compression Type

*CTL

[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step ]
1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR

[Erase margin]

1005

Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image.


If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This SP is activated
only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.

1005 1 Range from 0 to 5 mm

1009

[Remote scan disable]

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: enable, 1: disable

1009 1 Enable or disable remote scan.

1010

[Non Display Clear Light PDF] *CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Display, 1: No display

1010 1 Enable or disable remote scan.

SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality)


[Compression Level (Gray-scale)]
2021

656

Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the three settings that
can be selected at the operation panel.

Main SP Tables-9

2021 1 Level 3 (Middle Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ]

2021 2 Level 2 (High Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step ]

2021 3 Level 4 (Low Image Quality)

*CTL

[5 to 95 / 30 / 1 /step ]

2021 4 Level 1 (Highest Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 60 / 1 /step ]

2021 5 Level 5 (Lowest Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

[Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF]


2024

Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at
the operation panel.

2024 1 Compression Ratio (Normal image)


2024 2 Compression Ratio (High comp image)

*CTL

[5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

657

5. System Maintenance

Firmware Update
To update the firmware for this machine, you must have the new version of the firmware downloaded onto
an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into SD Card Slot 2 on the left rear side of the controller
box.

Type of Firmware
There are several types of firmware as shown below.

658

Type of firmware

Function

Location of firmware

Message shown

Engine

Printer engine control

BICU Flash ROM

Engine

System/Copy
Application

Operating system

Flash ROM on the


controller board

System/Copy

Lcdc

Panel control

LCDC

Lcdc

ADF

ADF control

ADF Main Control


Board

ADF

NetworkSupport

Controller Board

NetworkSupport

Language 1

LCDC

Language1

Language 2

LCDC

Language2

RPCS

Controller Board

RPCS

MediaPrint:JPEG/TIFF

Controller Board

MediaPrint:JPEG/
TIFF

FONT

Controller Board

FONT

FONT1

Controller Board

FONT1

NetworkDocBox

Controller Board

NetworkDocBox

Printer

Controller Board

Printer

Scanner

Controller Board

Scanner

Websupport

Controller Board

Websupport

WebUapl

Controller Board

WebUapl

Firmware Update

Before You Begin


An SD card is a precision device. Always observe the following precautions when you handle SD cards:
Always switch the machine off before you insert an SD card. Never insert the SD card into the slot
with the power on.
Do not remove the SD card from the service slot after the power has been switched on.
Never switch the machine off while the firmware is downloading from the SD card.
Keep SD cards in a safe location where they are not exposed to high temperature, high humidity, or
exposure to direct sunlight.
Always handle SD cards with care. Do not bend or scratch them. Do not let the SD card get exposed
to shock or vibration.
Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked when you download an application to
it. If not, downloading fails and a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware
upgrade.
Keep the following points in mind when you use the firmware update software:

"Upload" means to send data from the machine to the SD card. "Download" means to send data from
the SD card to the machine.
To select an item on the LCD, touch the appropriate button on the soft touch-screen of the LCD, or,
press the appropriate number key on the 10-key pad of the operation panel. For example, when "Exit
(0)" shows on the screen you can touch the Exit button on the screen, or, press the "0" button on the
operation panel of the copier.
Make sure that the machine is disconnected from the network to prevent a print job for arriving while
the firmware update is in progress before you start the firmware update procedure.

Updating Firmware
Preparation
If the SD card is blank, copy the entire "romdata" folder onto the SD card.
If the card already contains the "romdata" folder, copy the "D086" folder onto the card.
If the card already contains folders up to "D086", copy the necessary firmware files (e.g. D086xxxx.fwu)
into this folder.
Do not put multiple machine firmware programs on the same SD card. Copy the only model firmware
you want.

659

5. System Maintenance

Updating Procedure
1. Turn the main power switch off.
2. Remove the slot cover (

x 1).

3. Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2. Make sure the label on the SD card faces the front side of the
machine.
4. Slowly push the SD card into the slot so it locks in place. You will hear it click. Make sure the SD card
locks in place.
To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock. Then release it so it pops out of the slot.
5. Disconnect the network cable from the copier if the machine is connected to a network.

6. Switch the main power switch on. After about 45 seconds, the initial version update screen appears
on the LCD in English.
7. On the screen, touch the button or press the corresponding number key on the operation panel to
select the item in the menu that you want to update.
ROM/NEW

What it means

ROM:

Tells you the number of the module and name of the version currently installed.
The first line is the module number, the second line the version name.

NEW:

Tells you the number of the module and name version on the SD card. The first
line is the module number, the second line the version name.

Controller, engine and operation panel firmware cannot be updated at the same time. It is
recommended to update firmware modules one by one.
8. Touch "UpDate (#)" (or

) to start the update.

The progress bar does not show for the operation panel firmware after you touch "OpPanel".
The power on key flashes on and off at 0.5 s intervals when the LCDC firmware is updating. The
power key flashes on and off at 3 s intervals when the update is finished.
9. The "Update is Done" message appears on the operation panel after completing the updating. The
message differs depending on the firmware that has been updated.
10. Switch the copier main power switch off when you see the "Update is Done" message or follow the
procedure that is displayed on the operation panel.
11. Press in the SD card to release it. Then remove it from the slot.
12. Switch the copier on for normal operation.

660

Firmware Update

Error Messages
An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during the download.
The error code consists of the letter "E" and a number. The example above shows error "E24" displayed.
For details, refer to the Error Message Table. ( "Handling Firmware Update Error")

Firmware Update Error


If a firmware update error occurs, this means the update was cancelled during the update because the
module selected for update was not on the SD card.

Recovery after Power Loss


If the ROM update is interrupted as a result of accidental loss of power while the firmware is updating,
then the correct operation of the machine cannot be guaranteed after the machine is switched on again.
If the ROM update does not complete successfully for any reason, then in order to ensure the correct
operation of the machine, the ROM update error will continue to show until the ROM is updated successfully.
In this case, insert the card again and switch on the machine to continue the firmware download
automatically from the card without the menu display.

Updating the LCDC for the Operation Panel


Do the following procedure to update the LCDC (LCD Control Board).
1. Turn the copier main switch off.
2. Remove the SD slot cover (

x 1).

3. Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2.

661

5. System Maintenance

4. Switch the copier main switch on.


5. The initial screen opens in English after about 45 seconds.
6. Touch "Ope Panel.xx".
7. "xx" differs depending on the destination.
8. Touch "UpDate(#) or (

) to start the update.

9. Downloading starts after about 9 seconds.


10. The operation panel goes off and the main power on key flashes in red at 0.5 s intervals when the
data is downloading. The same key starts flashing in green at 1 s intervals when the update is finished.
11. Switch the copier main power switch off and remove the SD card. Then switch the copier on.

Update Procedure for App2Me Provider

Follow this procedure to update App 2 Me if a new version is available.


1. Push the [User/Tools] key on the operation panel.
2. If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, Step 3 and Step 4 are required. Otherwise,
skip to step 5.
3. Push [Login/Logout] on the operation panel.
4. Login with the administrator user name and password.
5. Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
6. Touch each of the applications until the status changes to "Stop".
7. Turn the machine off, and then remove the VM Card.

662

Firmware Update

8. Prepare the newer App2Me Provider zip file from the Firmware Download Center, and then unzip
the zip file. (The folder name is "337051920".)
9. Copy the App2Me Provider folder into the specified path for the VM card. The path is:
"SD_Card Drive\ sdk\dsdk\dist\337051920"
10. Turn the SD card label face to the front of the machine, and then push it slowly into Slot 2 (lower slot)
until you hear a click.
11. Turn the main power switch on.
12. Press [User Tools] on the operation panel.
13. Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice.
14. Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on the LCD.
15. Touch the "App2Me" line.
16. Set the setting of the "Auto Start" to "On".
17. Touch the "Exit" button.
18. Exit the [User Tools/Counter] settings.

App2Me and all other running applications on the VM card must be shut down before removing the
VM card in order to update the firmware, back up NVRAM, install the browser unit, or execute
application move or undo with SP5873.
After the VM card is re-inserted, App2Me (and any other VM card applications used by the customer)
must be switched on after the machine is switched on.

663

5. System Maintenance

Browser Unit Update Procedure

1. Remove the slot cover [A] for SD cards (

x 1).

1. Remove the VM card [B] from slot 2.


2. Turn the SD-card label face of the browser unit to the front of the machine. Then push it slowly into
slot 2 [C] until you hear a click.
3. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
4. Push the "User Tools" key.
If an administrator setting is registered for the machine, step 5 and 6 are required. Otherwise,
skip to the step 7
5. Push the "Login/ Logout" key.
6. Login with the administrator user name and password.
7. Touch "Extended Feature Settings" twice on the LCD.
8. Touch "Uninstall" on the LCD.
9. Touch the "Browser" line
10. Confirmation message appears on the LCD.
11. Touch "Yes" to proceed.
12. Reconfirmation message appears on the LCD.
13. Touch "Yes" to uninstall the browser unit.

664

Firmware Update

14. You will see "Uninstalling the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed".
15. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen.
16. Exit "User/Tools" setting, and then turn off the main power switch.
17. Remove the SD card of the browser unit from SD card slot 2.
18. Overwrite the updated program in the "sdk" folder of the browser unit application with PC.
19. Do the "Installation Procedure" to install the browser unit.

Handling Firmware Update Errors


An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during a download. The error code consists of
the letter "E" and a number ("E20", for example).

Error Message Table


Code

Meaning

Solution

20

Cannot map logical address

Make sure the SD card is inserted correctly.

21

Cannot access memory

HDD connection incorrect or replace hard disks.

22

Cannot decompress compressed


data

Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is corrupted.

23

Error occurred when ROM update Controller program abnormal. If the second attempt fails,
program started
replace controller board.

24

SD card access error

30

No HDD available for stamp data


HDD connection incorrect or replace hard disks.
download

31

Data incorrect for continuous


download

Insert the SD card with the remaining data required for


the download, the re-start the procedure.

32

Data incorrect after download


interrupted

Execute the recovery procedure for the intended module


download, then repeat the installation procedure.

33

Incorrect SD card version

Incorrect ROM data on the SD card, or data is corrupted.

34

Module mismatch - Correct


module is not on the SD card)

SD update data is incorrect. Acquire the correct data


(Japan, Overseas, OEM, etc.) then install again.

Make sure SD card inserted correctly, or use another SD


card.

665

5. System Maintenance

666

35

Module mismatch Module on


SD card is not for this machine

SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD card is


for another machine. Acquire correct update data then
install again.

36

Cannot write module Cause


other than E34, E35

SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD card is


for another machine. Acquire correct update data then
install again.

40

Engine module download failed

Replace the update data for the module on the SD card


and try again, or replace the BICU board.

42

Operation panel module


download failed

Replace the update data for the module on the SD card


and try again, or replace the LCDC.

43

Stamp data module download


failed

Replace the update data for the module on the SD card


and try again, or replace the hard disks.

44

Controller module download


failed

Replace the update data for the module on the SD card


and tray again, or replace controller board.

50

Electronic confirmation check


failed

SD update data is incorrect. The data on the SD card is


for another machine. Acquire correct update data then
install again.

Installing Another Language

Installing Another Language


Many languages are available. But you can only switch between two languages at a time. Do the following
procedure to select the two languages you want. You can select both of the languages you want from the
user interface on the operation panel.
1. Switch the copier main power switch off.
2. Remove the SD slot cover (

x 1).

3. Insert the SD card with the language data into SD Card Slot 2.
4. Switch the copier main power switch on. The initial screen opens after about 45 seconds.
5. Touch "Language Data (2)" on the screen (or press the "2" key).

6. Touch "LANG. 1(1)" or "LANG. 2(2)"


Key

What it does

LANG. 1(1)

Touch this button on the screen (or press the "1" key on the 10-key pad) to
open the next screen so you can select the 1st language.

LANG. 1(2)

Touch this button on the screen (or press the "2" key on the 10-key pad) to
open the next screen so you can select the 2nd language.

Exit (0)

Touch this key on the screen (or press the "0" key on the 10-key pad) to
quit the update procedure and return to normal screen.

7. Touch "LANG 1(1)" to select the 1st Language. Touch "LANG (2)" to select the 2nd Language.

667

5. System Maintenance

8. Touch the appropriate button on the screen (or press the number on the 10-keypad) to select a
language as the 1st (or 2nd) language.
If a language is already selected, it will show in reverse.
Touching "Exit (0)" returns you to the previous screen.
9. If you do not see the language that you want to select, touch " (7)" or " (9)" on the screen (or press
the "7" or "9" key) to show more choices.
The Download Screen opens after you select a language.
The 1st or 2nd language selected for updating shows.
The following show to right of the selection:
1. The first column shows the language currently selected.
2. The 2nd column shows the language selected to replace that language.
The example below shows that the download will replace "Japanese" with "Italian" as the 1st
language.

668

Installing Another Language

10. Touch "Update(#)" on the screen (or press

) to start the download.

Another screen with a progress bar does not show when the language is downloading.

The following occur at the time the language is downloading:


The operation panel switches off.
The LED on the power on key flashes rapidly.
11. After the message of installation completed has shown on the LCD, switch the copier main power
switch off. Then remove the SD card from the slot.
12. Switch the copier main power switch on to resume normal operation.

669

5. System Maintenance

Reboot/System Setting Reset


Software Reset
You can reboot the software with one of the following two procedures:
1. Turn the main power switch off and on.
2. Press and hold down and together for over 10 seconds. When the machine beeps once, release
both buttons. After Now loading. Please wait shows for a few seconds, the copy window will open.
The machine is ready for normal operation.

System Settings and Copy Setting Reset

System Setting Reset


The system settings in the UP mode can be reset to their defaults. Use the following procedure.
1. Press User Tools/Counter
2. Hold down

and then press System Settings.

You must press

first.

3. Press yes when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the system settings.
4. Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.

Copier Setting Reset


Use the following procedure to reset the copy settings in the UP mode to their defaults.
1. Press User Tools/Counter
2. Hold down

670

and then press Copier/Document Server Settings.

Reboot/System Setting Reset

You must press

first.

5
3. Press Yes when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the Copier Document
Server settings.
4. Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.

671

5. System Maintenance

Downloading Stamp Data


The stamp data should be downloaded from the controller firmware to the hard disks at the following times:
After the hard disks have been replaced.
The print data contains the controller software. Execute SP 5853 to download the fixed stamp data required
by the hard disks.
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Select SP5853 and then press "EXECUTE". The following screen opens while the stamp data is
downloading.

The download is finished when the message prompts you to close.

3. Press the "Exit" button. Then turn the copier off and on again.

672

NVRAM Data Upload/Download

NVRAM Data Upload/Download


Uploading Content of NVRAM to an SD card
Do the following procedure to upload SP code settings from NVRAM to an SD card.
This data should always be uploaded to an SD card before the NVRAM is replaced.
Make sure that the write protection of an SD card is unlocked
1. Do SP5990-001 (SMC Print) before you switch the machine off. You will need a record of the NVRAM
settings if the upload fails.
2. Switch the copier main power switch off.
3. Remove the SD slot cover (

x 1).

4. Insert the SD card into SD card slot 2. Then switch the copier on.

5. Execute SP5824-001 (NVRAM Data Upload) and then press the Execute key.
6. The following files are coped to an NVRAM folder on the SD card when the upload procedure is
finished. The file is saved to the path and the following filename:
NVRAM\<serial number>.NV
Here is an example with Serial Number K5000017114:
NVRAM\K5000017114.NV
7. In order to prevent an error during the download, be sure to mark the SD card that holds the uploaded
data with the number of the machine from which the data was uploaded.
You can upload NVRAM data from more than one machine to the same SD card.

Downloading an SD Card to NVRAM


Do the following procedure to download SP data from an SD card to the NVRAM in the machine.
The NVRAM data down load may fail if the SD card with the NVRAM data is damaged, or if the
connection between the controller and BICU is defective.
Do the download procedure again if the download fails.
Do the following procedure if the second attempt fails:
Enter the NVRAM data manually using the SMC print you created before uploading the NVRAM
data.
1. Switch the copier main power switch off.

673

5. System Maintenance

2. Remove the SD slot cover (

x 1).

3. Insert the SD card with the NVRAM data into SD Card Slot 2.
4. Switch the copier main power switch on.
5. Do SP5825-001 (NVRAM Data Download) and press the Execute key.
The serial number of the file on the SD card must match the serial number of the machine for the
NVRAM data to download successfully. The download fails if the serial numbers do not match.
This procedure does not download the following data to the NVRAM:
Total Count
C/O, P/O Count

674

Address Book Upload/Download

Address Book Upload/Download


Information List
The following information is possible to be uploaded and downloaded.
Information
Registration No.
User Code
E-mail
Protection Code
Fax Destination
Fax Option
Group Name
Key Display

Select Title
Folder
Local Authentication
Folder Authentication
Account ACL
New Document Initial ACL

LDAP Authentication

Download
1. Prepare a formatted SD card.
2. Make sure that the write-protection on the SD card is off.
3. Turn off the main power switch of the main machine.
4. Remove the SD slot cover at the left rear side of the machine (

x 1).

5. Install the SD card into the SD card slot 2 (for service use).
6. Turn on the main power switch.
7. Enter the SP mode.
8. Do SP5-846-051 (Backup All Addr Book).
9. Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.
10. Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2.
11. Install the SD slot cover.
If the capacity of SD card is not enough to store the local user information, an error message is
displayed.
Carefully handle the SD card, which contains user information. Do not take it back to your
location.
675

5. System Maintenance

Upload
1. Turn off the main power switch of the main machine.
2. Remove the SD slot cover at the left rear side of the machine (

x 1).

3. Install the SD card, which has already been uploaded, into the SD card slot 2.
4. Turn on the main power switch.
5. Enter the SP mode.
6. Do SP5-846-052 (Restore All Addr Book).
7. Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.
8. Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2.
9. Install the SD slot cover.

The counter in the user code information is initialized after uploading.


The information of an administrator and supervisor cannot be downloaded nor uploaded.
If there is no data of address book information in the SD card, an error message is displayed.

676

Using the Debug Log

Using the Debug Log


Overview
This machine provides a Save Debug Log feature that allows the Customer Engineer to save and retrieve
error information for analysis.
Every time an error occurs, debug information is recorded in volatile memory. But this information is lost
when the machine is switched off and on.
To capture this debug information, the Save Debug Log feature provides two main features:
Switching on the debug feature so error information is saved directly to the HDD for later retrieval.
Copying the error information from the HDD to an SD card.
Do the following procedure below to set up the machine so the error information is saved automatically to
the HDD when a user has problems with the machine. Then ask the user to reproduce the problem.

Switching ON and Setting UP Save Debug Log


The debug information cannot be saved until the Save Debug Log function has been switched on and a
target has been selected.
1. Enter the SP mode and switch the Save Debug Log feature on.
Enter the SP mode.
Touch System SP.
On the LCD panel, open SP5857.
2. Under 5857 Save Debug Log, touch 1 On/Off.

3. On the control panel keypad, press 1. Then press

. This switches the Save Debug Log feature on.

677

5. System Maintenance

The default setting is 0 (OFF). This feature must be switched on in order for the debug
information to be saved.

4. Select the target destination where the debug information will be saved. Under 5857 Save Debug
Log, touch 2 Target, enter 2 with the operation panel key to select the hard disk as the target
destination. Then press .
Select 3 SD Card to save the debug information directly to the SD card if it is inserted in the
service slot.
5. Now touch 5858 and specify the events that you want to record in the debug log. SP5858 (Debug
Save When) provides the following items for selection.
1

Engine SC Error

Saves data when an engine-related SC code is


generated.

Controller SC Error

Saves debug data when a controller-related SC Code


is generated.

Any SC Error

Saves data only for the SC code that you specify by


entering code number.

Jam

Saves data for jams.

More than one event can be selected.


Example 1: To Select Items 1, 2, 4
Touch the appropriate items(s). Press ON for each selection. This example shows Engine SC Error
selected.

678

Using the Debug Log

Example 2: To Specify an SC Code


Touch 3 Any SC Error, enter the 3-digit SC code number with the control panel number keys. Then
press . This example shows an entry for SC670.

For details about SC code numbers, please refer to the SC tables in Section 4. Troubleshooting.
6. Select one or more memory modules for reading and recording debug information. Touch 5859.
Under 5859 press the necessary key item for the module that you want to record.
Enter the appropriate 4-digit number. Then press

Refer to the two tables below for the 4-digit numbers to enter for each key.
The example below shows Key 1 with 2222 entered.

679

5. System Maintenance

The following keys can be set with the corresponding numbers. (The initials in parentheses indicate
the names of the modules.)
4-Digit Entries for Keys 1 to 10
Key No.

Copy

Printer

Scanner

2222 (SCS)

14000 (SRM)

256 (IMH)

1000 (ECS)

1025 (MCS)

Web

4848 (COPY)

4400 (GPS)

5375 (Scan)

5682 (NFA)

2224 (BICU)

4500 (PDL)

5682 (NFA)

6600 (WebDB)

4600 (GPS-PM)

3000 (UCS)

3300 (PTS)

2000 (NCS)

2000 (NCS)

6666 (WebSys)

10

2224 (BICU)

4126 (DCS)

2000 (NCS)

The default settings for Keys 1 to 10 are all zero (0).


Key to Acronyms

680

Acronym

Meaning

Acronym

Meaning

ECS

Engine Control Service

NFA

Net File Application

GPS

GW Print Service

PDL

Printer Design Language

GSP-PM

GW Print Service Print Module PTS

Print Server

IMH

Image Memory Handler

SCS

System Control Service

MCS

Memory Control Service

SRM

System Resource
Management

NCS

Network Control Service

WebDB

Web Document Box


(Document Server)

Using the Debug Log

7. The machine is now set to record the debugging information automatically on the HDD (the target
selected with SP5857-002) for the events that you selected with SP5858 and the memory modules
selected with SP5859.
Please keep the following important points in mind when you do this setting:
Note that the number entries for Keys 1 to 5 are the same for the Copy, Printer, Scanner, and Web
memory modules.
The initial settings are all zero.
These settings remain in effect until you change them. Be sure to check all the settings, especially the
settings for Keys 6 to 10. To switch off a key setting, enter a zero for that key.
You can select any number of keys from 1 to 10 (or all) by entering the corresponding 4-digit numbers
from the table.
You cannot mix settings for the groups (COPY, PRINTER, etc.) for 006 to 010. For example, if you
want to create a PRINTER debug log you must select the settings from the 9 available selections for
the PRINTER column only.
One area of the disk is reserved to store the debug log. The size of this area is limited to 4 MB.

Retrieving the Debug Log from the HDD


Retrieve the debug log by copying it from the hard disk to an SD card.
1. Insert the SD card into slot 2 (service slot) of the copier.
2. Enter the SP mode and execute SP5857-009 (Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB)) to write the
debugging data to the SD card.
3. Use a card reader to copy the file and send it for analysis to your local Ricoh representative by email.
You can also send the SD card by regular mail if you want.

Recording Errors Manually


SC errors and jams only are recorded to the debug log automatically. Please instruct the user to do the
following immediately after occurrence to save the debug data for any other errors that occur while the
customer engineer is not on site. Such problems also include a controller or panel freeze.
You must previously switch on the Save Debug Feature (SP5857-001) and select the hard disk as
the save destination (SP5857-002) if you want to use this feature.
1. Press

(Clear Modes).on the operation panel when the error occurs.

2. On the control panel, enter 01. Then hold down for at least 3 seconds until the machine beeps
and then release it. This saves the debug log to the hard disk for later retrieval with an SD card by the
service representatives.
681

5. System Maintenance

3. Switch the machine off and on to resume operation.


The debug information for the error is saved on the hard disk. This lets the service representative retrieve
it on their next visit by copying it from the HDD to an SD card.

Debug Log Codes


SP5857-015 Copy SD Card-to-SD Card: Any Desired Key

This SP copies the log on an SD card (the file that contains the information written directly from shared
memory) to a log specified by key number. The copy operation is executed in the log directory of the SD
card inserted in the same slot. (This function does not copy from one slot to another.) Each SD card can
hold up to 4 MB of file data. Unique file names are created for the data during the copy operation to
prevent overwriting files of the same name. This means that log data from more than one machine can be
copied onto the same SD card. This command does not execute if there is no log on the HDD for the name
of the specified key.

SP5857-016 Create a File on HDD to Store a Log


This SP creates a 32 MB file to store a log on the HDD. However, this is not a completely empty file. The
created file will hold the number 2225 as the SCS key number and other non-volatile information. Even
if this SP is not executed, a file is created on the HDD when the first log is stored on the HDD (it takes some
time to complete this operation). This creates the possibility that the machine may be switched off and on
before the log can be created completely. If you execute this SP to create the log file beforehand, this will
greatly reduce the amount of time required to acquire the log information and save onto the HDD. With
the file already created on the HDD for the log file, the data only needs to be recorded. A new log file
does not need to be created. To create a new log file, do SP5857-011 to delete the debug log data from
the HDD. Then do SP5857-016.

SP5857-017 Create a File on SD Card to Store a Log


This SP creates a 4 MB file to store a log on an SD card. However, this is not a completely empty file. The
created file will hold the number 2225 as the SCS key number and other non-volatile information. Even
if this SP is not executed, a file is created on the SD card when the first log is stored on the SD card (it takes
some time to complete this operation). This creates the possibility that the machine may be switched off and
on before the log can be created completely. If you execute this SP to create the log file beforehand, this
will greatly reduce the amount of time required to acquire the log information and save onto the SD card.
With the file already created on the SD card for the log file, the data only needs to be recorded; a new
log file does not require creation. To create a new log file, do SP5857-012 to delete the debug log data
from the SD card. Then do SP5857-017.

682

Card Save Function

Card Save Function


Overview
Card Save:
The Card Save function is used to save print jobs received by the printer on an SD card with no print
output. Card Save mode is toggled using printer Bit Switch #1 bit number 4. Card Save will remain
enabled until the SD card becomes full, or until all file names have been used.
Captures are stored on the SD card in the folder /prt/cardsave. File names are assigned sequentially
from PRT00000.prn to PRT99999.prn. An additional file PRT.CTL will be created. This file contains a
list of all files created on the card by the card save function.
Previously stored files on the SD card can be overwritten or left intact. Card Save SD has Add and
New menu items.

Card Save (Add): Appends files to the SD Card. Does not overwrite existing files. If the card
becomes full or if all file names are used, an error will be displayed on the operation panel.
Subsequent jobs will not be stored.
Card Save (New): Overwrites files in the card's /prt/cardsave directory.
Limitation:
Card Save cannot be used with PJL Status Readback commands. PJL Status Readbacks will not work.
In addition they will cause the Card Save to fail.

Procedure
1. Turn the main power switch OFF.
2. Insert the SD card into slot 2. Then turn the power ON.
3. Enter SP mode.
4. Select the Printer Sp.
5. Select SP-1001 "Bit Switch.

683

5. System Maintenance

6. Select Bit Switch 1 Settings and use the numeric keypad to turn bit 4 ON and then press the #
button to register the change. The result should look like: 00010000. By doing this, Card Save option
will appear in the List/Test Print menu.

7. Press Exit to exit SP Mode.


8. Press the User Tools/Counter button.

9. Select Printer Features.

684

Card Save Function

10. Card Save (Add) and Card Save (New) should be displayed on the screen. Select Card Save (Add)
or Card Save (New).

11. Press OK and then exit the User Tools/Counter menu.

12. Press the Printer button.

685

5. System Maintenance

13. Card Save should be displayed in the top left of the display panel.

14. Send a job to the printer. The Communicating light should start blinking as shown below.

15. As soon as the printer receives the data, it will be stored on the SD card automatically with no print
output. Nothing is displayed on the screen, indicating that a Card Save operation was successful.
16. Press Offline and then the Clear/Stop button to exit Card Save mode.

686

Card Save Function

17. Change the Bit Switch Settings back to the default 00000000. Press the # button in the numeric
keypad to register the changes.
18. Remove the SD card after the main power switch is turned off.

Error Messages
Card Save error messages:

Init error: A card save process (e.g. card detection, change to kernel mode) failed to initialize.
Card not found: Card cannot be detected in the slot.
No memory: Insufficient working memory to process the job.
Write error: Failed to write to the card.
Other error: An unknown error occurred.
If an error occurs, pressing OK will cause the device to discard the job and return to the ready state.

687

5. System Maintenance

688

6. Troubleshooting
SC Tables
Service Call Conditions
Summary
The SC Table section shows the SC codes for controller errors and other errors. The latter (not controller
errors) are put into four types. The type is determined by their reset procedures. The table shows the
classification of the SC codes.
Key
Controller
errors

Other errors

CTL

Definition
The error has occurred in the
controller.

Reset Procedure
See "Troubleshooting Procedure" in the
table.

The error involves the fusing unit. The Turn the main switch off and on. Reset
machine operation is disabled. The the SC (set SP5-810-1). Turn the main
user cannot reset the error.
switch off and on.

The error involves one or some


specific units. The machine operates Turn the operation switch off and on.
as usual, excluding the related units.

The error is logged. The SC-code


history is updated. The machine
operates as usual.

The machine operation is disabled.


You can reset the machine by turning
Turn the operation switch or main
the operation switch or main switch
power switch off and on.
off and on. If the error occurs again,
the same SC code is displayed.

The SC will not show. Only the SC


history is updated.

After you turn the main power switch off, wait for one second or more before you turn the main power
switch on ( SC 672). All SCs are logged. The print log data (SP5-990-004) in SP mode can check the
latest 10 SC codes detected and total counters when the SC code is detected.
If the problem concerns electrical circuit boards, first disconnect then reconnect the connectors before
you replace the PCBs.
689

6. Troubleshooting

If the problem concerns a motor lock, first check the mechanical load before you replace motors or
sensors.

SC Code Classification
The table shows the classification of the SC codes:
Class 1
1XX

2XX

Section
Scanning

Laser exposure

3XX

4XX

690

Image development 1

Image development 2

SC Code

Detailed section

100 -

Scanner

190 -

Unique for a specific model

200 -

Polygon motor

220 -

Synchronization control

230 -

FGATE signal related

240 -

LD control

280 -

Unique for a specific model

290 -

Shutter

300 -

Charge

330 -

Drum potential

350 -

Development

380 -

Unique for a specific model

400 -

Image transfer

420 -

Paper separation

430 -

Cleaning

440 -

Around drum

460 -

Unit

480 -

Others

SC Tables

Class 1

5XX

5XX

6XX

7XX

8XX

9XX

Section

Paper feed / Fusing

Paper feed / Fusing

Communication

Peripherals

Controller

Others

SC Code

Detailed section

500 -

Paper feed

515 -

Duplex

520 -

Paper transport

530 -

Fan motor

540 -

Fusing

560 -

Others

570 -

Unique for a specific model

600 -

Electrical counters

620 -

Mechanical counters

630 -

Account control

640 -

CSS

650 -

Network

670 -

Internal data processing

680 -

Unique for a specific model

700 -

Original handling

720 -

Two-tray finisher

740 -

Booklet finisher

800 -

Error after ready condition

820 -

Diagnostics error

860 -

Hard disk

880 -

Unique for a specific model

900 -

Counter

920 -

Memory

990 -

Others

691

6. Troubleshooting

SC1xx: Scanning
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Exposure lamp error
The peak white level is less than 64/255 digits (8 bits) when scanning the shading
plate.
Exposure lamp defective
Lamp stabilizer defective
Exposure lamp connector defective

101

Standard white plate dirty


Scanner mirror or scanner lens out of position or dirty
1. Check and clean the scanner mirror(s) and scanner lens.
2. Check and clean the shading plate.

3. Replace the exposure lamp.


4. Replace the lamp stabilizer.
5. Replace the scanner mirror(s) or scanner lens.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Scanner home position error 1
The scanner home position sensor does not detect the "OFF" condition during
operation.
Scanner motor driver defective
Scanner motor defective

120

Harness between SIO board and scanner motor disconnected


Scanner HP sensor defective
Harness between SIO and HP sensor disconnected
1. Check the cable connection between the SIO board and scanner motor.
2. Check the cable connection between the SIO and HP sensor.
3. Replace the scanner motor.
4. Replace the HP sensor.

692

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Scanner home position error 2
The scanner home position sensor does not detect the "ON" condition during
operation.
Scanner motor driver defective
Scanner motor defective

121

Harness between SIO board and scanner motor disconnected


Scanner HP sensor defective
Harness between SIO and HP sensor disconnected
1. Check the cable connection between the SIO board and scanner motor.
2. Check the cable connection between the SIO and HP sensor.
3. Replace the scanner motor.
4. Replace the HP sensor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Black level detection error
The black level cannot be adjusted within the target value during the zero clamp.

141

Harness disconnected
Defective SBU
1. Check the cable connection
2. Replace the SBU.

693

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


White level detection error
The white level cannot be adjusted within the target during auto gain control.
Dirty exposure glass or optics section
SBU board defective
Exposure lamp defective
Lamp stabilizer defective

142

Scanner motor defective


1. Clean the exposure glass, white plate, mirrors, and lens.
2. Check if the exposure lamp is lit during initialization.
3. Check the harness connection between SBU and BICU.
4. Replace the exposure lamp.

5. Replace the scanner motor.


6. Replace the SBU board.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


SBU communication error
The SBU connection cannot be detected at power on or recovery from the energy
save mode.
Defective SBU

144

Defective harness
Defective detection port on the BICU
1. Replace the harness.
2. Replace the SBU.
3. Replace the BICU.

No.
161

694

Type
D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


IPU error

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


The error result of self-diagnostic by the ASIC on the BICU is detected.
Defective BICU
Defective connection between BICU and SBU

001

1. Check the connection between BICU and SBU.


2. Replace the BICU.
The machine detects an error during an access to the Ri.
002

Defective BICU board


Replace the BICU board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Copy Data Security Unit error
The copy data security board is not detected when the copy data security
function is set "ON" with the initial setting.

165

A device check error occurs when the copy data security function is set "ON"
with the initial setting.
Incorrect installation of the copy data security board
Defective copy data security board
1. Reinstall the copy data security board.
2. Replace the copy data security board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Serial Number Mismatch
Serial number stored in the memory does not have the correct code.

195

NVRAM defective
BICU replaced without original NVRAM
1. Check the serial number with SP5-811-002.
2. If the stored serial number is incorrect, contact your supervisor.

695

6. Troubleshooting

SC 2xx: Exposure
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Polygon motor error 1: ON timeout
The polygon mirror motor does not reach the targeted operating speed within the
specified time after turning on or changing speed
Defective or disconnected harness to polygon motor driver board

202

Defective polygon motor driver board


Defective polygon motor.
1. Replace the polygon motor.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the harness.
4. Replace the BICU.

6
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Polygon motor error 2: OFF timeout
The polygon mirror motor does leave the READY status within 3 seconds after the
polygon motor switches off.

203

Disconnected or defective harness to polygon motor driver board


Defective polygon motor driver board
Defective polygon motor
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the polygon motor.

696

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Polygon motor error 3: XSCRDY signal error
The SCRDY_N signal goes HIGH (inactive) while the laser diode is firing.
Disconnected or defective harness to polygon motor driver board

204

Defective polygon motor


Defective polygon motor driver board
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the polygon motor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

210

Laser synchronizing detection error: end position [K]

211

Laser synchronizing detection error: end position [Y]

212

Laser synchronizing detection error: end position [M]

213

Laser synchronizing detection error: end position [C]

The laser synchronizing detection signal for the end position of LDB [K], [Y], [M],
[C] is not detected for one second after the LDB unit turned on when detecting the
main scan magnification.
Disconnected or defective harness to synchronizing detector for end position
Defective synchronizing detector board
-

Defective LD board or driver


Defective BICU
1. Replace the harness of the LD board.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the BICU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

220

Laser synchronizing detection error: start position [K]: LD0

222

Laser synchronizing detection error: start position [Y]: LD0

226

Laser synchronizing detection error: start position [C]: LD0

697

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


The laser synchronizing detection signal for the start position of the LDB [K], [Y], [C]
is not output for two seconds after LDB unit turns on while the polygon motor is
rotating normally.
Disconnected cable from the laser synchronizing detection unit or defective
connection
Defective laser synchronizing detector

Defective LDB
Defective BICU
1. Check the connectors.
2. Replace the laser-synchronizing detector.
3. Replace the LDB.
4. Replace the BICU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


FGATE ON error: K
The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for start position [K].
Defective ASIC (Lupus)

230

Poor connection between controller and BICU.


Defective BICU
1. Check the connection between the controller board and the BICU.
2. Replace the BICU.
3. Replace the controller board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


FGATE OFF error: K

231

The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for end position [K].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

698

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


FGATE ON error: Y

232

The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for start position [Y].
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


FGATE OFF error: Y

233

The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for end position [Y].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

FGATE ON error: M
234

The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for start position [M].
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


FGATE OFF error: M

235

The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for end position [M].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

699

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


FGATE ON error: C

236

The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for start position [C].
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


FGATE OFF error: C

237

The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for end position [C].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

240

LD error: K

241

LD error: Y

242

LD error: M

243

LD error: C
The BICU detects LDB error a few times consecutively when LDB unit turns on after
LDB initialization.
Worn-out LD

Disconnected or broken harness of the LD


1. Replace the harness of the LD.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the BICU.

700

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Line position adjustment (MUSIC) error
Line position adjustment fails four consecutive times.
Pattern sampling error ( insufficient image density )
Defective ID sensors for the line position adjustment
Defective image transfer belt unit
Defective PCDU(s)

285

Defective laser optics housing unit


1. Check and reinstall the image transfer belt unit and PCDUs.
2. Check if each toner bottle has enough toner.
3. Replace the ID sensor.
4. Replace the image transfer belt unit.
5. Replace the PCDU(s).
6. Replace the laser optics housing unit.

SC3xx: Image Processing 1


No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

312

Charge P.P. output error [K]

313

Charge P.P. output error [M]

314

Charge P.P. output error [C]

315

Charge P.P. output error [Y]


The feedback voltage of the charge AC for each color is 0.3 V or less for 0.2 seconds
after the charge AC has turned on.
Disconnected or broken harnesses of the HVPS

Defective PCDU
Defective HVPS
1. Check or replace the harnesses of the HVPS.
2. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
3. Replace the HVPS.
701

6. Troubleshooting

SC3xx: Image Processing 2


No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

360

TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: K

361

TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: M

362

TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: C

363

TD sensor (Vt high) error 1: Y


The Vt value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor exceeds the
specified value (default: 4.7V) with SP3020-002 for twenty counts.
The [Vt - Vtref] value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor exceeds
the specified value (default: 5.0V) with SP3020-001.
Black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor disconnected

Harness between TD sensor and PCDU defective

Defective TD sensor.
1. Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector and harness
between the TD sensor and PCDU for damage.
2. Check the drawer connector.
3. Replace the defective PCDU.
No.

702

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

364

TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: K

365

TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: M

366

TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: C

367

TD sensor (Vt low) error 2: Y

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


The Vt value of the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor is below the specified
value with SP3020-004 (default: 0.5V) for 10 counts.
TD sensor harness disconnected, loose, defective
A drawer connector disconnected, loose, defective

TD sensor defective

1. Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector and harness
between the TD sensor and PCDU for damage.
2. Check the drawer connector.
3. Replace the defective PCDU.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

372

TD sensor adjustment error: K

373

TD sensor adjustment error: M

374

TD sensor adjustment error: C

375

TD sensor adjustment error: Y

During TD sensor initialization, the output value of the black, magenta, cyan, or
yellow TD sensor is not within the range of the specified value with SP3238-001 to
-004 (default: 2.5V) 0.2V
Heat seal not removed from a new developer pack
-

TD harness sensor disconnected, loose or defective

TD sensor defective
Harness between TD sensor and drawer disconnected, defective
1. Remove the heat seal from each PCDU.
2. Replace the defective PCDU.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

380

Drum gear position sensor error: K

381

Drum gear position sensor error: M

382

Drum gear position sensor error: C

703

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

383

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Drum gear position sensor error: Y
The machine does not detect the drum position signal for 3 seconds at the drum
phase adjustment.
Dirty or defective drum gear position sensor
1. Clean the drum gear position sensor.
2. Check the harness connection.
3. Replace the drum gear position sensor.
4. Replace the PCDU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

396

Drum/Development motor error: K

397

Drum/Development motor error: M

398

Drum/Development motor error: C

399

Drum/Development motor error: Y


The machine detects a High signal from the drum/development motor for 2 seconds
after the drum/development motor turned on.
Overload on the drum/development motor
Defective drum/development motor

Defective harness
Shorted 24 V fuse on the PSU
Defective interlock system
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the drum/development motor.
3. Replace the 24V fuse on the PSU.

704

SC Tables

SC4xx: Image Processing - 3


No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


ID sensor adjustment error
When the Vsg error counter reaches "3", the machine detects "SC400".
The Vsg error counter counts "1" when the Vsg detected by ID sensor is more than
the value (default: 4.5V) specified with SP3324-005 or less than the value (default:
3.5V) specified with SP3324-006.
Dirty or defective ID sensor
Defective ID sensor shutter

400

1. Check the harness of the ID sensor.


2. Clean or replace the ID sensor.
After replacing the ID sensor, input the ID sensor correction coefficient
with SP3362-013 to -018. For details, refer to "ID sensor board" in the
Replacement and Adjustment section.

3. Replace the IOB.


4. Replace the image transfer belt unit.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Image transfer unit motor error
The motor LOCK signal is not detected for more than two seconds while the motor
START signal is on.

441

Motor overload
Defective image transfer unit motor
1. Replace the image transfer belt unit.
2. Replace the IOB.

705

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Image transfer belt contact motor error
The image transfer belt contact sensor does not detect the movement of actuator at
the sensor while the polygon motor rotates.
Dirty image transfer belt contact sensor

442

Defective image transfer belt contact motor


Disconnected connector of image transfer belt contact sensor or motor
Disconnected cable
1. Replace the image transfer belt contact sensor.
2. Replace the image transfer belt contact motor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Image transfer unit error
The machine detects the encoder sensor error.
Defective encoder sensor

443

Image transfer unit installation error


Defective image transfer unit motor
1. Check if the image transfer unit is correctly set.
2. Replace the image transfer unit motor.
3. Replace the image transfer unit.

706

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Paper transfer unit contact error
The paper transfer unit contact sensor does not detect the movement of actuator at
the sensor while the polygon motor rotates.
Defective paper transfer unit contact sensor
Defective paper transfer unit contact motor

452

Broken +24V fuse on PSU


Defective IOB
1. Check the connection between the paper transfer unit and PSU.
2. Replace the paper transfer unit contact sensor.
3. Replace the paper transfer unit contact motor.
4. Replace the +24V fuse on the PSU.
5. Replace the IOB.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Separation power pack output error
An interrupt checks the status of the power pack every 20 ms. This SC is issued if the
BICU detects a short in the power pack 10 times at D(ac).

460

Damaged insulation on the high-voltage supply cable


Damaged insulation around the high-voltage power supply.
1. Replace the high-voltage supply cable.
2. Replace the high-voltage power supply unit.
3. Replace the IOB.

707

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Toner transport motor error
The LOCK signal is not detected for 2 seconds when the transport motor turns on.
Toner transport motor overload
Disconnected or broken harness
Defective toner transport motor

490

Opened +24V fuse on the PSU


Defective interlock switch
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the toner transport motor.
3. Replace the +24V fuse on the PSU.
4. Replace the interlock switch.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


High voltage power: Drum/ development bias output error
An error signal is detected for 0.2 seconds when charging the drum or development.
High voltage leak
Broken harness

491

Defective drum unit or development unit


Defective high voltage supply unit
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the drum unit or paper transfer unit.
3. Replace the high voltage supply unit.

708

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


High voltage power: Image transfer/ paper transfer bias output error
An error signal is detected for 0.2 seconds when charging the separation, image
transfer bet or paper transfer roller.
High voltage leak

492

Broken harness
Defective image transfer belt unit or paper transfer unit
Defective high voltage supply unit
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the image transfer belt unit or paper transfer unit.
3. Replace the high voltage supply unit.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Temperature and humidity sensor error 2

The thermistor output of the temperature sensor was not within the prescribed
range (0.2V to 3.5V).
498

The thermistor output of the humidity sensor was not within the prescribed range
(0.01V to 2.4V).
Temperature and humidity sensor harness disconnected, loose, defective
Temperature and humidity sensor defective
1. Check the connector and harness.
2. Replace the temperature/humidity sensor.

SC5xx: Paper Feed and Fusing


No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

501

Paper Tray 1 error

502

Paper Tray 2 error

709

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


When the tray lift motor rotates counterclockwise, (if the upper limit is not
detected within 10 seconds), the machine asks the user to reset the tray.
When the tray lift motor rotates clockwise, (if the upper limit is not detected
within 1.5 seconds), the machine asks the user to reset the tray.
If one of these conditions occurs three consecutive times, the SC is generated.
Disconnected or defective paper lift sensor
Disconnected or defective tray lift motor

Defective bottom plate lift mechanism


Too much paper in the tray
Defective IOB
1. Check if the paper is not loaded too much.

710

2. Check if the bottom plate smoothly moves up and down manually.


3. Check and/or replace the tray lift motor/ paper lift sensor.
4. Replace the IOB.

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Tray 3 error (Paper Feed Unit or LCT)
For the paper feed unit:
When the tray lift motor is turned on, the upper limit is not detected within 10
seconds
For the LCT:
SC 503-01 occurs if the upper or lower limit is not detected within 8 seconds
when the tray lift motor is turned on to lift or lower the tray.
For the paper feed unit:

503-0
1

Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection


Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection
For the LCT:
Defective stack transport clutch or connector disconnection
Defective tray motor or connector disconnection
Defective end fence home position sensor or connector disconnection

Defective upper limit sensor or connector disconnection


Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection
1. Check the cable connections.
2. Check and/or replace the defective component.

711

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Tray 3 error (Paper Feed Unit or LCT)
This SC is generated if the following condition occurs 3 consecutive times.
For the paper feed unit:
When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec.
For the LCT:
When the main switch is turned on or when the LCT is set, if the end fence is
not in the home position (home position sensor ON), the tray lift motor stops.

503-0
2

If the upper limit does not go off for 1.5 seconds even the tray lift motor turns
on to lower the tray after the upper limit has been detected at power on.
B

For the paper feed unit:


Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection

Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection


For the LCT:
Defective stack transport clutch or connector disconnection
Defective tray motor or connector disconnection
Defective end fence home position sensor or connector disconnection
1. Check the cable connections.
2. Check and/or replace the defective component.

712

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Tray 4 error (Paper Feed Unit or LCT)
For the two-tray paper feed unit
When the tray lift motor is turned on, the upper limit is not detected within 10 seconds.
If this condition occurs three consecutive times, the SC is generated.
For the LCT

504-0
1

If the upper or lower limit is not detected within 8 seconds when the tray lift motor is
turned on to lift up or lower the tray
Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection
Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection
1. Check the cable connections.
2. Check and/or replace the defective component.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

Tray 4 error (3 Tray Paper Feed Unit)


This SC is generated if the following condition occurs 3 consecutive times.
For the two-tray paper feed unit
When the tray lowers, the tray lift sensor does not go off within 1.5 sec.
504-0
2

For the LCT


B

If the upper limit does not go off for 1.5 seconds even the tray lift motor turns
on to lower the tray after the upper limit has been detected at power on.
Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection
Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection
1. Check the cable connections.
2. Check and/or replace the defective component.

No.
505

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


5th tray lift malfunction (optional LCT)

713

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


This SC is generated if the following condition occurs:
When the tray lift sensor of the LCT 1200-sheet does not go on after the tray
lift motor has turned on to lift the paper tray.
When the tray lift sensor of the LCT 1200-sheet does not go off after the tray
lift motor has turned on to lower the paper tray.

-01

When the tray lift sensor of the LCT 1200-sheet does not go on after the pickup roller solenoid has turned on at power on.
Tray lift motor defective or disconnected
Tray lift sensor defective or disconnected
1. Check the harness connections.
2. Replace the tray lift motor.
3. Replace the tray lift sensor.

Both tray lift sensor and lower limit sensor are turned on at the same time when the
main power is turned on or the right door is closed.
Tray lift motor defective or disconnected
Tray lift sensor defective or disconnected
-02

Lowe limit sensor defective or disconnected


1. Check the harness connections.
2. Replace the tray lift motor.
3. Replace the tray lift sensor.
4. Replace the lower limit sensor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Fusing fan error
The IOB does not receive the lock signal 10 seconds after turning on the fusing fan.

530

Defective fusing fan motor or connector disconnection


Defective IOB
Check the connector and/or replace the fusing fan motor.

714

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Ventilation fan (at the left side of the machine) motor-front/rear error
The IOB does not receive the lock signal for 10 seconds after turning on the
ventilation fan motor-front/rear.

531

Defective ventilation fan motor-front or rear


Defective IOB
1. Replace the ventilation fan (at the left side of the machine) motor-front or rear.
2. Replace the IOB.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


IH coil fan error
The machine does not detect the fan motor lock signal for 10 seconds while the IH
coil fan turns on.
Disconnected harness

532

Overload on the IH coil fan motor


Defective IH coil fan motor
Defective IOB
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the IH coil fan.
3. Replace the IOB.

715

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


IH inverter fan error
The machine does not detect the fan motor lock signal for 10 seconds while the IH
inverter fan turns on.
Disconnected harness

533

Overload on the IH inverter fan motor


Defective IH inverter fan motor
Defective IOB
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the IH inverter fan.
3. Replace the IOB.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Second duct fan error
The machine does not detect the fan motor lock signal for 10 seconds while the
second duct fan turns on.
Disconnected harness

534

Overload on the second duct fan motor


Defective second duct motor
Defective IOB
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the second duct fan.
3. Replace the IOB.

716

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Paper exit fan error
The machine does not detect the fan motor lock signal for 10 seconds while the
paper exit fan turns on.
Disconnected harness

535

Overload on the paper exit fan motor


Defective paper exit motor
Defective IOB
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the paper exit fan.
3. Replace the IOB.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Third duct fan error

The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal
was first detected.
Defective third duct fan motor
536

Disconnected or defective harness


Defective IOB
1. Replace the third duct fan motor.
2. Check or replace the harness.
3. Replace the IOB.

717

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Fusing/Paper exit motor error
The IOB does not receive the lock signal 2 seconds after turning on the fusing/paper
exit motor.

540

Motor overload
Defective fusing/paper exit motor
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the fusing/paper exit motor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller thermopile error
The temperature detected by the heating roller thermopile does not reach 0C for
6 seconds.

6
541

Loose connection of the heating roller thermopile


Defective heating roller thermopile
Defective thermopile
1. Check if the heating roller thermopile is firmly connected.
2. Replace the heating roller thermopile.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller warm-up error 1
The heating roller temperature does not reach 80C for 20 seconds after the
IH inverter turned on.
The center temperature of the heating roller does not reach the ready
temperature for 90 seconds after the IH inverter turned on.

542

Dirty or defective thermopile


Defective IH coil unit
1. Check if the heating roller thermopile is firmly connected.
2. Replace the thermopile.
3. Replace the IH coil unit.

718

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 1 (software error)
The temperature detected by the heating roller thermopile stays at 230C for 1
second.
Defective PSU

543

Defective IOB
Defective BICU
Related SC code: SC 553
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 1 (hardware error)

During stand-by mode or a print job, the temperature detected by the heating roller
thermopile reaches 250 C.
Defective PSU
Defective IOB
544

Defective BICU
Defective fusing control system
Related SC code: SC 543
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.

719

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller fusing lamp consecutive full power 1
When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the heating roller fusing
lamp keeps on full power for 8 seconds.

545

Broken heating roller fusing lamp


Related SC code: SC 555
1. Replace the heating roller fusing lamp.
2. Replace the PSU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Zero cross error
The zero cross signal is detected three times even though the heater relay is off
when turning on the main power.

The zero cross signal is not detected for 2 seconds even though the heater relay
is on after turning on the main power or closing the front door.
547

The detection error occurs twice or more in the 11 zero cross signal detections.
This error is defined when the detected zero cross signal is less than 45.
Defective fusing lamp relay
Defective fusing lamp relay circuit
Unstable power supply
1. Check the power supply source.
2. Replace the PSU

720

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller thermistor error
The temperature at the end of the heating roller measured by the heating roller
thermistor does not reach 0C for 7 seconds.

551

Loose connection of pressure roller thermistor


Defective heating roller thermistor
Related SC code: SC 541
1. Check that the heating roller thermistor is firmly connected.
2. Replace the heating roller thermistor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller warm-up error 2
The heating roller temperature does not reach 80C for 20 seconds after the
IH inverter on.

The temperature at the end of the heating roller does not reach the ready
temperature for 89 seconds after the IH inverter turned on.
552

Defective heating roller thermistor


Defective IH inverter
Related SC code: SC 542
1. Check if the heating roller thermistor is firmly connected.
2. Replace the IH inverter.

721

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 2 (software error)
The temperature detected by the heating roller thermistor stays at 230C or more
for 1 second.
Defective PSU

553

Defective IOB
Defective BICU
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller fusing lamp overheat 2 (hardware error)
The temperature detected by the heating roller thermistor reaches 250C or more.
Defective PSU
Defective IOB

554

Defective BICU
Defective fusing control system
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Heating roller lamp consecutive full power 2
The heating roller-fusing lamp stays ON for 15 seconds or more while the fusing
unit is in the ready condition.

555

Broken heating roller fusing lamp


1. Replace the heating roller fusing lamp.
2. Replace the PSU.

722

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Zero cross frequency error
When the zero cross signal is 66 or more and it is detected 10 times or more in 11
detections, the machine determines that input 60 Hz and SC557 occurs.

557

Noise (High frequency)


Defective PSU
1. Check the power supply source.
2. Replace the PSU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Consecutive fusing jam
The paper jam counter for the fusing unit reaches 3 times. The paper jam counter is
cleared if the paper is fed correctly.

559

This SC is activated only when SP1159-001 is set to "1" (default "0").

Paper jam in the fusing unit.


Remove the paper that is jammed in the fusing unit. Then make sure that the fusing
unit is clean and has no obstacles in the paper feed path.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Pressure roller thermistor error
The temperature detected by the pressure roller thermistor does not reach 0 C for
20 seconds.
Loose connection of the pressure roller thermistor

561

Defective thermopile
Defective pressure roller thermistor
1. Check if the pressure roller thermistor is firmly connected.
2. Replace the thermopile.
3. Replace the pressure roller thermistor.

723

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Pressure roller overheat (software error)
The temperature detected by the pressure roller thermistor stays at 230C or more
for 1 second.
Defective PSU

563

Defective IOB
Defective BICU
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Pressure roller overheat (hardware error)
The temperature detected by the pressure roller thermistor detects 250C or more.
Defective PSU
Defective IOB

564

Defective BICU
Defective fusing control system
1. Replace the thermistor.
2. Replace the PSU.
3. Replace the IOB.
4. Replace the BICU.

724

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Pressure roller fusing lamp consecutive full power
When the fusing unit is not running in the ready condition, the pressure roller fusing
lamp keeps ON full power for 300 seconds or more.

565

Broken pressure roller fusing lamp


Defective pressure roller thermistor
1. Replace the pressure roller lamp.
2. Replace the pressure roller thermistor.
3. Replace the PSU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Pressure roller contact sensor error
Pressure roller contact sensor does not detect the pressure roller position three times.

Broken or defective pressure roller contact sensor


Deformed or broken pressure roller contact sensor feeler
569

Defective pressure roller contact motor


Defective fusing unit
1. Check or replace the harness of the pressure roller contact sensor.
2. Replace the pressure roller contact sensor.
3. Replace the pressure roller contact motor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Pressure roller thermistor error: Center
The temperature at the center of the pressure roller measured by the thermistor does
not reach 0C for 37 seconds.

571

Loose connection of the thermistor


Defective thermistor
1. Check if the thermistor is firmly connected.
2. Replace the center thermistor.

725

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


IH inverter input voltage error
The IH inverter detects 70 V or less/150 V or more for 10 seconds.
The IH inverter detects 160 V or less/300 V or more for 10 seconds.
Unusual input voltage

581

Defective IH inverter
1. Check if the power supply voltage of the customer site is within the proper
power voltage range.
2. Check CN981 on the IH inverter.
3. Replace the IH inverter.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


IH inverter current error at power on
The output current from the IH inverter does not reach the proper value when the IH
inverter turns on.
Disconnected power input terminal 1 and 2
Defective IH inverter

582

Defective IH coil unit


Defective fusing unit
1. Check the power input terminals 1 and 2.
2. Replace the IH inverter.
3. Replace the IH coil unit.
4. Replace the fusing unit.

726

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


IH coil unit full power (1250W) error
The IH coil unit full power (1250W) continues for 200 seconds or more.
Defective IH inverter
Defective BICU
Defective IOB

585

Broken connection between IH inverter and IOB


Defective thermopile
1. Replace the IH inverter.
2. Replace the BICU.
3. Replace the IOB.
4. Check the connection between IH inverter and IOB.
5. Replace the thermopile.

SC6xx: Device Communication


No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

610

Mechanical counter error: K

611

Mechanical counter error: FC


This SC is only for NA models.
The machine detects the mechanical counter error when SP5987-001 is set to "1".

Disconnected mechanical counter


Defective mechanical counter
Check or replace the mechanical counter.

727

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


ARDF communication error
After the ARDF is detected, the break signal occurs or communication timeout occurs.
Incorrect installation of ARDF
ARDF defective

620

BICU board defective


External noise
1. Check the cable connection of the ARDF.
2. Shut out the external noise.
3. Replace the ARDF.
4. Replace the BICU board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

621

Finisher communication error

622

Paper tray unit communication error


While the IOB communicates with an optional unit, an SC code is displayed if one
of following conditions occurs.
The IOB receives the break signal which is generated by the peripherals only
just after the main switch is turned on.
When the IOB does not receive an OK signal from a peripheral 100ms after
sending a command to it. The IOB resends the command. The IOB does not
receive an OK signal after sending the command 3 times.
Cable problems

IOB problems
BICU problems
PSU problems in the machine
Main board problems in the peripherals
1. Check if the cables of peripherals are correctly connected.
2. Replace the PSU if no power is supplied to peripherals.
3. Replace the IOB or main board of peripherals.
4. Replace the BICU.

728

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


2nd Paper Bank communication error
This SC is not issued for this machine.

623

When a communication error signal between the 1st paper bank and 2nd paper
bank is received.
Loose or disconnected connector
Check the connection between the main machine and paper feed unit.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Counter device error 1

632

CTL
B

After 3 attempts to send a data frame to the optional counter device via the serial
communication line, no ACK signal was received within 100 ms.
Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board and copier
control board is disconnected or damaged

Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter device.
Check the connection between the main machine and optional counter device.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Counter device error 2
After communication is established, the controller receives the brake signal from the
accounting device.

633

CTL
B

Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board and copier
control board is disconnected or damaged
Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter device.
1. Check if the setting of the SP5113 is correctly set.
2. Check the connection between the main machine and optional counter device.

729

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Counter device error 3

634

CTL
B

A backup RAM error was returned by the counter device.


Counter device control board defective
Backup battery of counter device defective
Replace the counter device.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Counter device error 4

635

CTL
B

A backup battery error was returned by the counter device.


Counter device control board defective
Backup battery of counter device defective
Replace the counter device.

No.
636

Type
CTL

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


SD Card Error
Expanded authentication module error
There is no expanded authentication module in the machine.
The SD card or the file of the expanded authentication module is broken.
There is no DESS module in the machine.

-01

No expanded authentication module


Defective SD card
No DESS module
1. Install the expanded authentication module.
2. Install the SD card.
3. Install the DESS module.

730

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Version error

-02

The version of the expanded authentication module is not correct.


Incorrect module version
Install the correct file of the expanded authentication module.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


BICU control data transfer abnormal
A sampling of the control data sent from the BICU reveals an abnormality.

CTL

641

Controller board defective


External noise
BICU board defective
1. Replace the controller board.

2. Replace the BICU.


No.

Type
CTL

650

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Communication error of the remote service modem (Embedded RCG-M)
Authentication error
The authentication for the Embedded RCG-M fails at a dial up connection.

-001

Incorrect SP settings
Disconnected telephone line
Disconnected modem board
Check and set the correct user name (SP5816-156) and password (SP5816-157).
Incorrect modem setting

-004

Dial up fails due to the incorrect modem setting.


Same as -001
Check and set the correct AT command (SP5819-160).

731

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Communication line error

-005

The supplied voltage is not sufficient due to the defective communication line or
defective connection.

Same as -001
Consult with the user's local telephone company.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Incorrect dial up connection
-001: Program parameter error

651

CTL
C

-002: Program execution error


An unexpected error occurs when the modem (Embedded RCG-M) tries to call the
center with a dial up connection.
Caused by a software bug
No action required because this SC does not interfere with operation of the machine.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


EEPROM error

669

Retry of EEPROM communication fails three times after the machine has detected
the EEPROM error.
Caused by noise
Turn the main power switch off and on.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Engine start up error

670

CTL
D

The ready signal from the engine board is not detected.


Defective BICU.
Replace the BICU.

732

SC Tables

Engine board mismatch error


Engine board and controller mismatch detected.
671

CTL
D

Wrong engine board installed.


Wrong controller board installed.
Check the type of engine board and controller board.
1. Replace the BICU.
2. Replace the controller board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Controller-to-operation panel communication error at startup
After powering on the machine, the communication circuit between the controller
and the operation panel is not opened, or communication with controller is
interrupted after a normal startup.

672

CTL
D

Controller stall

Controller board installed incorrectly


Controller board defective
Operation panel connector loose or defective
1. Check the harness connection.
2. Replace the controller board.

733

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


RFID: Communication error
Communication error occurs when the RFID starts to communicate with the RFID
receptor.
Retry of RFID communication fails three times after the machine has detected
the RFID communication error.

681

Defective RFID reader and writer


Disconnected ASAP I/F
No memory chip on the toner cartridge
Noise
1. Replace the RFID controller board.
2. Replace the toner cartridge.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Memory chip at TD sensor: Communication error
Retry of memory chip communication fails three times after the machine has detected
the memory chip communication error.
Damaged memory chip data

682

Disconnected inter face


No memory chip on the development unit
Noise
1. Replace the PCDU.
2. Replace the BICU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


RFID: Unit check error

683

The machine gets RFID communication error even the toner cartridges have not been
installed in the machine.
Caused by noise
Turn the main power switch off and on.

734

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Memory address command error
The BICU does not receive a memory address command from the controller 120
seconds after paper is in the position for registration.
Loose connection

687

Defective controller
Defective BICU
1. Check if the controller is firmly connected to the BICU.
2. Replace the controller.
3. Replace the BICU.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


GAVD communication error
The I2C bus device ID is not identified during initialization.

A device-status error occurs during I2C bus communication.


The I2C bus communication is not established due to an error other than a
buffer shortage.
690

Loose connection
Defective BICU
Defective LD controller board
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Check the cable connection.
3. Replace the laser optics-housing unit.
4. Replace the BICU board.

735

6. Troubleshooting

SC7xx: Peripherals
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher jogger motor error
The jogger fences move out of the home position but the HP sensor output does not
change within the specified number of pulses.

721

The 1st failure issues an original jam message, and the 2nd failure issues this SC
code.

Jogger HP sensor disconnected, defective


Jogger motor disconnected, defective
Jogger motor overloaded due to obstruction
Finisher main board and jogger motor
1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.

2. Check for blockages in the jogger motor mechanism.


3. Replace the jogger HP sensor and/or jogger motor.
4. Replace the finisher main board.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Stack feed-out motor error
The stack feed-out HP sensor does not detect the home position of the stack
feed-out belt 3000ms after the stack feed-out belt has moved to its home
position.
The stack feed-out HP sensor does not turn off 200 ms after the stack feed-out
belt has moved from its home position.

723

The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC
code.
Defective stack feed-out HP sensor
Overload on the stack feed-out motor
Defective stack feed-out motor
Defective main board
Disconnected or defective harness

736

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
2. Check for blockages in the stack feed-out motor mechanism.
3. Replace the stack feed-out HP sensor and/or stack feed-out motor.
4. Replace the finisher main board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher exit guide plate motor error
After moving away from the guide plate position sensor, the exit guide is not
detected at the home position within the prescribed time. The 1st detection failure
issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
Guide plate motor disconnected, defective

725

Guide plate motor overloaded due to obstruction


Guide plate position sensor disconnected, defective

1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
2. Check for blockages in the guide plate motor mechanism.
3. Replace the guide plate position sensor and/or guide plate motor
4. Replace the finisher main board.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher Tray 1 shift motor error
The shift roller HP sensor of the upper tray does not activate within the prescribed
time after the shift tray starts to move toward or away from the home position. The
1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
Shift tray HP sensor of the upper tray disconnected, defective

730

Shift tray motor of the upper tray is disconnected, defective


Shift tray motor of the upper tray overloaded due to obstruction
1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
2. Check for blockages in shift motor mechanism.
3. Replace the shift tray HP sensor and/or shift motor
4. Replace the finisher main board.

737

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher corner stapler motor error
The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
For 1000-sheet (booklet) finisher
The stapler motor does not switch off within the prescribed time after operating.
The HP sensor of the staple unit does not detect the home position after the
staple unit moves to its home position.

740

The HP sensor of the staple unit detects the home position after the staple unit
moves from its home position.
Staple jam
Motor overload
Defective stapler motor
1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.

2. Replace the HP sensor and/or stapler motor


3. Replace the finisher main board.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher stapler movement motor error
For 1000-sheet (booklet) finisher
The stapler HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the stapler
motor turned on. (first detection: jam error, consecutive twice detection SC
code).
Motor overload

742

Loose connection of the stapler home position sensor


Loose connection of the stapler movement motor
Defective stapler home position sensor
Defective stapler movement motor
1. Check the connection of the stapler movement motor.
2. Check the connection of the stapler home position sensor.
3. Replace the stapler home position sensor.
4. Replace the stapler movement motor.

738

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


1000-sheet booklet finisher: Stack feed motor error
The stack feed HP sensor does not detect "ON" twice (once: jam error) for
specified time after the stack feed motor has turned on.
The stack feed HP sensor does not detect "OFF" twice (once: jam error) for
specified time after the stack feed motor has turned on.
Motor overload

746

Loose connection of the stack feed motor


Defective stack feed motor
1. Check the connections and cables for the stack feed motor and HP sensor.
2. Check for blockages in the stack feed motor mechanism.
3. Replace the stack feed HP sensor and/or stack feed motor
4. Replace the finisher main board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

1000-sheet (booklet) finisher: Tray lift motor error


Motor overload
750

Loose connection of the shift tray motor


Defective shift tray motor
1. Check the connections to the shift tray motor.
2. Replace the shift tray motor.

739

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher punch motor error
The punch HP sensor is not activated within the specified time after the punch motor
turned on. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this
SC code.
Punch HP sensor disconnected, defective

760

Punch motor disconnected or defective


Punch motor overload due to obstruction
1. Check the connections and cables for the punch motor and HP sensor.
2. Check for blockages in the punch motor mechanism.
3. Replace the punch HP sensor and/or punch motor
4. Replace the finisher main board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher folder plate motor error
The folder plate moves but is not detected at the home position within the specified
time. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC
code.
Folder plate HP sensor disconnected, defective

761

Folder plate motor disconnected, defective


Folder plate motor overloaded due to obstruction.
1. Check the connections and cables for the folder plate motor and HP sensor.
2. Check for blockages in the folder plate motor mechanism.
3. Replace the folder plate HP sensor and/or folder plate motor
4. Replace the finisher main board.

740

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Punch movement motor error
The punch unit moves but is not detected at the home position within the specified
time. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC
code.

763

Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective


Defective motor
1. Check the connections to the punch movement motor.
2. Defective punch movement motor

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Paper position sensor slide motor error
The paper position sensor moves but is not detected at the home position within the
specified time. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues
this SC code.

764

Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective


Defective motor
1. Check the connections to the paper position sensor slide motor.
2. Defective paper position sensor slide motor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Paper position sensor slide motor error
The paper position sensor moves but is not detected at the home position within the
specified time. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues
this SC code.

765

Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective


Defective motor
1. Check the connections to the paper position sensor slide motor.
2. Defective paper position sensor slide motor.

741

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Paper position sensor slide motor error
The paper position sensor moves but is not detected at the home position within the
specified time. The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues
this SC code.

766

Motor harness disconnected, loose, defective


Defective motor
1. Check the connections to the paper position sensor slide motor.
2. Defective paper position sensor slide motor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Shift motor error

The shift motor HP sensor does not detect any change for 1.86 seconds after the
shift motor has turned on at power on or during its operation.
770

Defective shift motor


Defective shift motor HP sensor
1. Check the connections to the shift motor and the shift motor HP sensor.
2. Defective shift motor or the shift motor HP sensor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Bridge unit error
The machine recognizes the finisher, but does not recognize the bridge unit.

791

Defective connector
Broken harness
1. Check the connections between the bridge unit and the machine.
2. Install a new bridge unit.

742

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher error
The machine does not recognize the finisher, but recognizes the bridge unit.
Defective connector

792

Defective harness
Incorrect installation
1. Check the connections between the finisher and the machine.
2. Install a new finisher.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Upper limit switch error (D372)
The upper limit switch of the 500-sheet finisher (D372) is pushed due to tray lift error
or some problems.

798
-1

Upper limit switch pulled up


Defective upper limit swtich
Check the harness.
1. Check for blockage around the upper limit switch.
2. Replace the upper limit switch.

743

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher jogger motor error (D372)
The jogger fences of the 500-sheet finisher (D372) move out of the home position
but the HP sensor output does not change within the specified number of pulses.
The 1st failure issues an original jam message, and the 2nd failure issues this SC
code.
Jogger HP sensor disconnected, defective

798
-02

Jogger motor disconnected, defective


Jogger motor overloaded due to obstruction
Finisher main board and jogger motor
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Check for blockages in the jogger motor mechanism.
3. Replace the jogger HP sensor.

4. Replace the jogger motor.


5. Replace the finisher main board.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Rear fence motor error (D372)
The rear jogger fence motor of the 500-sheet finisher (D372) is not operating.
Rear jogger motor drive is obstructed (jammed paper, paper scraps, etc.)
The rear jogger fence motor harness loose or broken

798
-03

Rear jogger fence HP sensor dirty, loose, defective


Rear jogger fence motor defective
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Check for blockages in the rear jogger motor drive mechanism.
3. Replace the rear jogger fence HP sensor.
4. Replace the rear jogger fence motor.

744

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Stack feed-out motor error
The stack feed-out HP sensor does not detect the home position of the stack feedout belt for a certain time after the stack feed-out belt has moved to its home position.
The stack feed-out HP sensor does not turn off for a certain time after the stack feedout belt has moved from its home position.
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code.
Defective stack feed-out HP sensor

798
-04

Overload on the stack feed-out motor


Defective stack feed-out motor
Defective main board
Disconnected or defective harness
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Check for blockages in the stack feed-out mechanism.

3. Replace the stack feed-out HP sensor.


4. Replace the stack feed-out motor.
5. Replace the main board.

745

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Positioning roller arm motor error
The positioning roller HP sensor does not turn on or off for a certain time at poweron.
The positioning roller HP sensor does not turn on or off for a certain time when the
positioning roller returns to its home position from the lower position.
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC code.

798
-05

Disconnected or defective harness


Overload on the positioning roller arm motor
Defective positioning roller arm motor
Defective positioning roller HP sensor
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Check for blockages in the positioning roller arm mechanism.

3. Replace the positioning roller arm motor.


4. Replace the positioning roller HP sensor.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher corner stapler motor error
The 1st detection failure issues a jam error, and the 2nd failure issues this SC code.
For 500-sheet finisher
The stapler HP sensor does not detect "ON"/"OFF" signal even the stapler
moves from the "OFF"/"ON" position for 0.6 seconds.

798
-06

The stapler HP sensor does not detect "ON" when a stapling job is commanded
or the stapler moves.
Staple jam
Motor overload
Defective stapler motor
1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
2. Replace the HP sensor and/or stapler motor
3. Replace the finisher main board.

746

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Finisher stapler movement motor error
For 500-sheet finisher
The stapler HP sensor does not detect "OFF" signal even the stapler moves
from the "ON" position for 0.35 seconds.
The stapler HP sensor does not detect "ON" signal even the stapler moves from
the "OFF" position for 5.5 seconds.

798
-07

Motor overload
B

Loose connection of the stapler home position sensor


Loose connection of the stapler movement motor
Defective stapler home position sensor
Defective stapler movement motor
1. Check the connection of the stapler movement motor.
2. Check the connection of the stapler home position sensor.

3. Replace the stapler home position sensor.


4. Replace the stapler movement motor.
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


500-sheet finisher: Tray lift motor error
Motor overload

798
-08

Loose connection of the shift tray motor


Defective shift tray motor
1. Check the connections to the tray lift motor.
2. Replace the tray lift motor.

747

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Stack pressure solenoid error
The stack pressure solenoid in the finisher is not operating.
Solenoid harness loose, broken
Solenoid obstructed

798
-09

Stack height sensor dirty, harness loose, broke


Solenoid defective
Stack height sensor defective
1. Check or replace the solenoid harness.
2. Check for blockages in the stack pressure mechanism.
1. Replace the stack height sensor.

SC8xx: Overall System


No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Energy saving I/O sub-system error

816

CTL
D

The energy saving I/O sub-system detects an error.


Controller board defective
Replace the controller board.

No.

819

748

Type
CTL
C

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Fatal kernel error
Due to a control error, a RAM overflow occurred during system processing. One
of the following messages was displayed on the operation panel.

[0x5032]

HAIC-P2 error

[0x5245]

vm_pageout: VM is full

Controller board defective

[0x5355]

L2 status time out

Optional board defective

[554C]

USB error

System program defective

Replace controller firmware

SC Tables

No.
820

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

CTL

Self-diagnostics error: CPU

[XXXX]: Detailed error code


Cut-in in ASIC occurs.
Defective ASIC

[0612]

Defective devices in which ASIC detects cut-in.


Replace the controller board.

No.
833

[0F30]
[0F31]

[0F41]

Type
CTL
C

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Self-diagnostic error 8: Engine I/F ASIC
ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI
configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.

Replace the BICU.


ASIC (Mandolin) for system control could not be detected. After the PCI
configuration, the device ID for the ASIC could not be checked.
Replace the BICU
Could not initialize or read the bus connection.

[50B1]

Check for loose connections at the mother board.


Replace the mother board
Value of the SSCG register is incorrect.

[50B2]

Check for loose connections at the mother board.


Replace the mother board

749

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


IEEE1394 interface error
The 1394 interface is unusable.

851

CTL
B

Defective IEEE1394
Defective controller.
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Replace the IEEE1394 interface board.
3. Replace the controller.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Wireless LAN card not detected

853

CTL
B

The wireless LAN card is not detected before communication is established, though
the wireless LAN board is detected.
Loose connection
Check the connection.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Wireless LAN/Bluetooth card not detected

854

CTL
B

The wireless LAN/Bluetooth card is not detected after communication is established,


but the wireless LAN board is detected.
Loose connection
Check the connection.

750

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Wireless LAN/Bluetooth card error
An error is detected in the wireless LAN/Bluetooth card.

855

CTL

856

Loose connection
Defective wireless LAN/Bluetooth card
1. Check the connection.
2. Replace the wireless LAN/Bluetooth card.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


USB interface error
The USB interface cannot be used due to a driver error.

857

CTL
B

Defective USB driver


Loose connection

1. Check the connection.


2. Replace the controller board.
No.

858

Type
CTL
C

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD Encryption unit error 1
A serious error occurs when data is encrypted to update an encryption key with the
HDD encryption unit.
Encryption key acquisition error:
[0]

The controller fails to get a new encryption key.


Defective controller board
1. Replace the controller board.
Encryption key setting for HDD error:

[1]

The controller fails to copy a new encryption key to the HDD.


Defective SATA chip on the controller board
1. Replace the controller board.

751

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


NVRAM data encryption error 1:
[2]

An error occurs while the NVRAM data is encrypted.


Defective NVRAM on the controller board
1. Replace the NVRAM.
NVRAM data encryption error 2:

[30]

An error occurs before the NVRAM data is encrypted.


Defective controller board
1. Replace the controller board.
Other error:

[31]

752

A serious error occurs while the data is encrypted.


Same as SC991

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD Encryption unit error 2
A serious error occurs when the HDD data is encrypted to update an encryption key
with the HDD encryption unit.
HDD check error:
The HDD is not correctly installed.
No HDD installed
[8]

859

Unformatted HDD
The encryption key on the controller is different from the one on the
HDD

CTL

1. Install the HDD correctly.

1. Initialize the HDD.


Power failure during the data encryption:
[9]

The data encryption (NVRAM and HDD) has not been completed.

Power failure during the data encryption


1. Initialize the HDD.
Data read/write error:

[10]

The DMAC error is detected twice or more.


Same as SC863

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD: Initialization error
The controller detects that the hard disk fails.

860

CTL
B

HDD not initialized


Defective HDD
1. Reformat the HDD.
2. Replace the HDD.

753

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD: Reboot error
The HDD does not become ready within 30 seconds after the power is supplied to
the HDD.
Loose connection

861

CTL
D

Defective cables
Defective HDD
Defective controller
1. Check the connection between the HDD and controller.
2. Check and replace the cables.
3. Replace the HDD.
4. Replace the controller.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD: Read error
The data stored in the HDD cannot be read correctly.

863

CTL
D

Defective HDD
Defective controller
1. Replace the HDD.
2. Replace the controller.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD: CRC error

864

CTL
D

While reading data from the HDD or storing data in the HDD, data transmission
fails.
Defective HDD
Replace the HDD.

754

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD: Access error

865

CTL
D

An error is detected while operating the HDD.


Defective HDD
Replace the HDD.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


SD card authentication error

866

CTL
B

A correct license is not found in the SD card.


SD-card data is corrupted.
Store correct data in the SD card.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

SD card error
867

CTL
D

The SD card is ejected from the slot.


1. Install the SD card.
2. Turn the main switch off and on.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


SD card access error
-13 to -3: File system error
Other number: Device error

868

CTL
D

An error report is sent from the SD card reader.


An error is detected in the SD card.
1. For a file system error, format the SD card on your PC.
2. For a device error, turn the mains switch off and on.
3. Replace the SD card.
4. Replace the controller.

755

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Address book error
An error is detected in the data copied to the address book over a network.
Defective software program

870

CTL
B

Defective HDD
Incorrect path to the server
1. Initialize the address book data (SP5-846-050).
2. Initialize the user information (SP5-832-006).
3. Replace the HDD.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD mail data error

An error is detected in the HDD at machine initialization.


872

CTL
B

Defective HDD
Power failure during an access to the HDD
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-007).
3. Replace the HDD.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD mail transfer error
An error is detected in the HDD at machine initialization.

873

CTL
B

Defective HDD
Power failure during an access to the HDD
1. Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-008).
2. Replace the HDD.

756

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Delete All error 1: HDD
An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted physically by
the Data Overwrite Security Unit (D377).

874

CTL
D

Data Overwrite Security Unit (SD card) not installed


Defective HDD
1. Install the Data Overwrite Security Unit (D377).
2. Replace the HDD.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Delete All error 2: Data area

875

CTL
D

An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted logically by the
Data Overwrite Security Unit (D377).
The logical format for the HDD fails.

Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again
No.

876

Type
CTL
D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Log Data Error
An error was detected in the handling of the log data at power on or during machine
operation. This can be caused by switching the machine off while it is operating.
Log Data Error 1

-001

Damaged log data file in the HDD


Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.
Log Data Error 2

-002

An encryption module not installed


1. Disable the log encryption setting with SP9730-004 ("0" is off.)
2. Install the DESS module.

757

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Log Data Error 3

-003

Invalid log encryption key due to defective NVRAM data


1. Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.
2. Disable the log encryption setting with SP9730-004 ("0" is off.)
Log Data Error 4

-004

Unusual log encryption function due to defective NVRAM data


Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.
Log Data Error 5

-005

Installed NVRAM or HDD which is used in another machine


1. Reinstall the previous NVRAM or HDD.

2. Initialize the HDD with SP5832-004.


Log Data Error 99
-099

Other than the above causes


Ask your supervisor.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


HDD Data Overwrite Security SD card error
The 'all delete' function cannot be executed but the Data Overwrite Security Unit
(D377) is installed and activated.

877

CTL
D

Defective SD card (D377)


SD card (D377) not installed
1. Replace the NVRAM and then install the new SD card (D377).
2. Check and reinstall the SD card (D377).

758

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


TPM system authentication error

878

CTL
D

The system firmware is not authenticated by TPM (security chip).


Incorrect updating for the system firmware
Defective flash ROM on the controller board
Replace the controller board.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


File format converter error

880

CTL
D

The file format converter does not respond.


Defective file format converter
Replace the file format converter.

SC9xx: Miscellaneous
No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Electric counter error
Abnormal data in the counters.

900

CTL
D

Defective NVRAM
Defective controller
1. Check the connection between the NVRAM and controller.
2. Replace the NVRAM.
3. Replace the controller.

759

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

910

External Controller Error 1

911

External Controller Error 2


CTL

912

External Controller Error 3

913

External Controller Error 4

914

External Controller Error 5

No.

The external controller alerted the machine about an error.


Please refer to the instructions for the external controller (application).
Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


External Controller Error 6

6
919

CTL
D

While EAC (External Application Converter), the conversion module, was operating
normally, the receipt of a power line interrupt signal from the FLUTE serial driver was
detected, or BREAK signal from the other station was detected.
Power outage at the EFI controller
EFI controller was rebooted
Connection to EFI controller loose

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Printer application error
An error is detected in the printer application program.

920

CTL
D

Defective software
Unexpected hardware resource (e.g., memory shortage)
1. Software defective; switch off/on, or change the controller firmware if the
problem is not solved
2. Insufficient memory

760

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Printer font error

921

CTL
D

A necessary font is not found in the SD card.


A necessary font is not found in the SD card.
The SD card data is corrupted.
Check that the SD card has the correct data.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Software performance error
The software makes an unexpected operation.
Defective software

990

CTL
D

Defective controller
Software error

1. Turn the main switch off and on.


2. Reinstall the controller and/or engine main firmware.

See Note 1 at the end of the SC table.


No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Software continuity error

991

CTL
C

The software has attempted to perform an unexpected operation. However, unlike


SC 990, the object of the error is continuity of the software.
Software program error
Internal parameter incorrect, insufficient working memory.
This SC is not displayed on the LCD (logging only).

761

6. Troubleshooting

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Undefined error

992

CTL
D

Defective software program


An error undetectable by any other SC code occurred

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Operation panel management records exceeded

994

CTL
C

An error occurred because the number of records exceeded the limit for images
managed in the service layer of the firmware. This can occur if there if there are too
many application screens open on the operation panel.
No action required because this SC does not interfere with operation of the
machine.

No.
995

Type
D

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


CPM setting error
Defective BICU
NVRAM Replacement error

-001

1. Install the previous NVRAM.


2. Input the serial number with SP5811-004, and turn the main power switch off/
on.
Defective NVRAM
Defective controller

-002

1. Update the controller firmware.


2. Install a new NVRAM, and turn off and on the main power switch after
SC995-002 has occurred.
Incorrect type controller installed

-003

Defective controller
1. Replace the controller with the correct type.

-004

762

Incorrect model controller installed.


1. Replace the controller with the correct model.

SC Tables

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)


Application function selection error
The application selected by the operation panel key does not start or ends
abnormally.
Software (including the software configuration) defective
An option required by the application (RAM, DIMM, board) is not installed

997

CTL
B

Nesting of the fax group addresses is too complicated


1. Check the devices necessary for the application program. If necessary devices
have not been installed, install them.
2. Check that application programs are correctly configured.
3. For a fax operation problem, simplify the nesting of the fax group addresses.
4. Take necessary countermeasures specific to the application program. If the
logs can be displayed on the operation panel, see the logs.

No.

Type

Details (Symptom, Possible Cause, Troubleshooting Procedures)

Application start error


No applications start within 60 seconds after the power is turned on.
Loose connection of RAM-DIMM, ROM-DIMM
Defective controller
998

CTL
D

Software problem
1. Check the setting of SP5875-001. If the setting is set to "1 (OFF)", change it
to "0 (OFF)".
2. Check if the RAM-DIMM and ROM-DIMM are correctly connected.
3. Reinstall the controller system firmware.
4. Replace the controller.

Note 1
If a problem always occurs in a specific condition (for example. printer driver setting, image file), the
problem may be caused by a software error. In this case, the following data and information needs to be
sent back to your product specialist. Please understand that it may take some time to get a reply on how
to solve the problem, because in some cases the design staff in Japan must analyze the data.
Symptom / Possible Causes / Action taken
Summary sheet (SP mode "Printer SP", SP1-004 [Print Summary])
763

6. Troubleshooting

SMC - All (SP5-990-001)


SMC - Logging (SP5-990-004)
Printer driver settings used when the problem occurs
All data displayed on the screen (SC code, error code, and program address where the problem is
logged.)
Image file which causes the problem, if possible

764

Process Control Error Conditions

Process Control Error Conditions


Developer Initialization Result
SP-3-014-001 (Developer Initialization Result)
No.
1

Result
Successfully
completed

Description
Developer initialization is
successfully completed.

Possible Causes/Action
A cover was opened or the main switch was
turned off during the initialization.

Forced
termination

Developer initialization
was forcibly terminated.

1. Do the developer initialization again when


done in SP mode. Reinstall the engine main
firmware if the result is the same.
2. Turn the main switch off and on when done
at unit replacement.

Vt error

Vcnt error 1

Vcnt error 2

Vt is more than 0.7V when


Vcnt is 4.3V.
Vcnt is less than 4.7V
when Vcnt is Vt target
0.2V.
Vt is more than 0.7V when
Vcnt is 4.3V and Vcnt is
less than 4.7V when Vcnt
is Vt target 0.2V.

1. Make sure that the heat seal on the


development unit is not removed.
2. Defective TD sensor
1. Defective TD sensor
2. Vt target settings are not correct.
3. Toner density error
1. Make sure that the heat seal on the
development unit is not removed.
2. Defective TD sensor
1. Make sure that the heat seal on the
development unit is not removed

Vcnt error 3

Vcnt is less than 4.7V.

1. Defective TD sensor
2. Vt target settings are not correct.
3. Toner density error

765

6. Troubleshooting

The machine starts developer initialization after you set Enable in SP3-902-005, 006, 007, or
008. Developer initialization automatically resumes when you open and close the front door or turn
the main switch off and on if an error other than Error 8 occurs.

Process Control Self-Check Result


Displayed number shows results of each color sensor check.
00000000 = YYCCMMKK
SP3-012-001 to -010 (Process Control Self-check Result)
No. Result
11

Successfully
completed

Description

Possible Causes/Action

Process control self-check Check the Vsg adjustment. See the "Vsg
successfully completed.
Adjustment Result" following this table.
Defective development unit

Vt maximum error and an image is faint:


1. Replace the toner supply pump unit.
41

Vt error

Vt maximum or minimum
error is detected.

Vt maximum error and an image is O.K:


1. Replace the development unit.
2. Replace the IOB board.
Vt minimum error:
1. Replace the development unit.
2. Replace the IOB board.
Solid image is not sufficient density:
1. Retry the process control.
2. Replace the ID sensors.
3. Replace the IOB board.

53

ID sensor
coefficient (K5)
detection error

Not enough data can be


sampled.

Solid image is O.K.


1. Replace the ID sensors.
2. Replace the IOB board.
ID sensor is dirty:
1. Clean the ID sensors.
2. Retry the process control.

766

Process Control Error Conditions

No. Result

Description

Possible Causes/Action

54

ID sensor
coefficient (K5)
maximum/
minimum error

When the K5 is more than


the value of
ID sensor pattern density is too high or low.
SP3-362-003 or less
ID sensor or shutter is defective.
than the value of
SP3-362-004, the error Same as 53
54 is displayed.

55

Gamma error:
Maximum

Gamma is out of range.


5.0 < Gamma

ID sensor pattern density is too high.


Hardware defective.
Same as 53
ID sensor pattern density is too low.

56

Gamma error:
Minimum

Gamma is out of range.

Hardware defective.

Gamma < 0.15

1. Same as 53
2. Replace the toner supply pump unit.

57

Vk error:
Maximum

Vk is out of range.
150 < Vk

ID sensor pattern density is too low.

Hardware defective.
Same as 53
ID sensor pattern density is too high.

58

Vk error:
Minimum

Vk is out of range.

Background dirty

Vk < 150

Hardware defective
Same as 53

59

99

Sampling data
error during
gamma
correction

Not enough data can be


sampled during the
gamma correction.

Unexpected
error

Process control fails.

ID sensor pattern density is too high or low.


Hardware defective
Same as 53
Power Failure
Check the power source.

767

6. Troubleshooting

Vsg Adjustment Result


SP3-325-001 to -010 (Vsg Adjustment Result)
No. Result

Description

Possible Causes/Action

Vsg adjustment is
correctly done.

O.K

Dirty ID sensor (toner, dust, or foreign material)


Dirty transfer belt
Scratched image transfer belt
Defective ID sensor
Poor connection
2

ID sensor
adjustment
error

Vsg cannot be
adjusted within 4.0
0.5V.

Defective IOB
1. Clean the ID sensor.
2. Check the belt cleaning. Clean or replace the transfer
belt.
3. Replace the image transfer belt.
4. Replace the ID sensor.
5. Check the connection.
6. Replace the IOB board.
Defective ID sensor

ID sensor
output error

ID sensor output is
more than "Voffset
Threshold" (SP3-32
4-004)

Poor connection
Defective IOB
1. Replace the ID sensor.
2. Check the connection.
3. Replace the IOB board.

Vsg
Adjustment
error

Vsg adjustment has


not been
completed.

Other cases
Retry SP3-321-010.

Line Position Adjustment Result


SP2-194-010 to -012 (Line Position Adjustment Result: M, C, Y)
This SP shows the number as a line position adjustment result on the LCD. It shows which color has an error
(M, Y or C).
768

Process Control Error Conditions

No.

Result

Description

Note

Not done

Line position adjustment has not been done.

Completed
successfully

Line position adjustment has correctly been done,

Cannot detect
patterns

ID sensors have not detected the patterns for line position


See Note
adjustment.

Fewer lines on the


pattern than the
target

The patterns, which ID sensors have detected, are not


enough for line position adjustment.

See Note

More lines on the


pattern than the
target

Not used in this machine.

Out of the
adjustment range

ID sensors have correctly detected the patterns for line


position adjustment, but a shift of patterns is out of
adjustable range.

See Note

Not used

6-9

For details, see the "Troubleshooting Guide - Line Position Adjustment" section.

769

6. Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Guide
Image Quality
The following work-flow shows the basic troubleshooting steps for the image quality problems on this
product.

770

Troubleshooting Guide

771

6. Troubleshooting

Line Position Adjustment


When there are color registration errors on the output, do the line position adjustment as follows.
Use A3/DLT size paper for this adjustment.

Test
1. Do SP2-111-003 (Mode c: rough adjustment).
2. Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed
successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to Countermeasure list for color registration
errors.
3. Do SP2-111-001 (Mode a: fine adjustment twice).

4. Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed
successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to Countermeasure list for color registration
errors.
5. Put some A3/DLT paper on the by-pass tray.
When you print a test pattern, use the by-pass tray to feed the paper.
6. Print out test pattern "7" with SP2-109-003.
7. Check the printed output with a loupe.
8. If there are no color registration errors on the output, the line position adjustment is correctly done. If
not, refer to the countermeasure list for color registration errors.

Countermeasure list for color registration errors


After Executing SP2-111-003
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
Result: "2" or "3" (Line pattern detection failure) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012

772

Troubleshooting Guide

Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective laser optics housing unit shutter
Defective image processing unit
Low density of test pattern

White image, Abnormal image, Low


density

Defective BICU
1. Replace the shutter motor.
2. Replace the high voltage power supply unit.
3. Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply
some toner (SP3-015-xxx).
4. Replace the BICU.
Defective ID sensor shutter
Defective ID sensor

Normal image, but with color


registration errors

Defective BICU
1. Replace the ID sensor shutter solenoid.
2. Replace the ID sensor.

3. Replace the BICU.


After Executing SP2-111-003
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
One of results: "5" (Out of adjustable range) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012.
Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective laser optics housing unit

The main scan registrations of M, C, Y


are shifted by more than 15 mm from
the main scan registration of K.

Defective BICU
1. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
2. Replace the BICU.
Defective image transfer belt
Defective drive units

The sub scan registrations of M, C, Y


are shifted by more than 20 mm from
the sub scan registration of K.

Defective BICU
1. Replace the image transfer belt.
2. Replace the drum motor.
3. Replace the BICU.

773

6. Troubleshooting

Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective ID sensor at center
Deformed center area on the image transfer belt

The main scan registration is shifted by


more than 0.66 mm, but only at the
central area of the image on the output.

Defective BICU
1. Replace the ID sensor.
2. Replace the image transfer belt.
3. Replace the BICU.
Defective PCDU
Defective laser optics housing unit

The skew for M, C, Y is more than


0.75 mm from the main scan
registration of K

Defective BICU
1. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the BICU.

Skew correction upper limit error


Defective BICU
Defective laser optics housing unit

Others

1. Replace the BICU.


2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
After Executing SP2-111-003
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
Result: "0" in SP2-194-010, -011, -012.
Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure
Do SP2-111-001 or -002.

After Executing SP2-111-001


Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
Result: "2" or "3" (Line pattern detection failure) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012

774

Troubleshooting Guide

Test pattern check

Possible cause/Countermeasure

White image, Abnormal image,

Defective laser optics housing unit shutter

Low density

Defective image processing unit


Low density of test pattern
Defective BICU
1. Replace the shutter motor.
2. Replace the high voltage power supply unit.
3. Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply
some toner (SP3-015-xxx).
4. Replace the BICU.

Normal image, but with color


registration errors

Defective ID sensor shutter


Defective ID sensor
Defective BICU
1. Replace the ID sensor shutter solenoid.
2. Replace the ID sensor.

3. Replace the BICU.


After Executing SP2-111-001
Result: "1" in SP2-194-007
Result: "5" (Out of adjustable range) in SP2-194-010, -011, -012
Test pattern check
Low image density on the output

Possible cause/Countermeasure
Low pattern density
Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some
toner (SP3-015-xxx).

The main scan registrations of M, C, Y


are shifted by more than 1.4 mm from
the main scan registration of K.

No defective component
Defective laser optics housing unit
Defective BICU
1. Do SP2-111-003 again.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the BICU.

775

6. Troubleshooting

Test pattern check


The sub scan registrations of M, C, Y
are shifted by more than 1.4mm from
the sub scan registration of K.

Possible cause/Countermeasure
No defective component
Defective image transfer belt
Defective drive units
Defective BICU
1. Do SP2-111-003 again.
2. Replace the image transfer belt.
3. Replace the drum motor.
4. Replace the BICU.

The main scan registration is shifted by


more than 0.66 mm, but only at the
central area of the image on the output.

Defective ID sensor at center


Deformed center area on the image transfer belt
Defective BICU
1. Replace the ID sensor.

2. Replace the image transfer belt.


3. Replace the BICU.
The skew for M, C, Y is more than
0.75 mm from the main scan
registration of K. at the end of the scan
line?

Defective PCDU
Defective laser optics housing unit
Defective BICU
1. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the BICU.

Others

Skew correction upper limit error


Defective BICU
Defective laser optics housing unit
1. Replace the BICU.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.

After Executing SP2-111-001


Result: "0" in SP2-194-007
Result: No color registration errors in SP2-194-010, -011, -012

776

Troubleshooting Guide

Test pattern check


The main scan registration of K is
shifted.
The main scan length of K is shifted.

Possible cause/Countermeasure
Abnormal SP setting value of main scan: K
Adjust the value with SP2-101-001.
Abnormal SP setting value of main scan length detection:
K
Adjust the value with SP2-185-001.

After Executing SP2-111-001


Result: "0" in SP2-194-007
Result: Color registration errors in SP2-194-010, -011, -012
Test pattern check
Low image density on the output

Possible cause/Countermeasure
Low pattern density
Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some
toner (SP3-015-xxx).

The main scan registration is shifted, but


only at the central area of the image on
the output.

Defective ID sensor at center


Deformed center area on the image transfer belt
Defective BICU
1. Replace the ID sensor.
2. Replace the image transfer belt.
3. Replace the BICU.

The main scan registrations of M, C, Y


are shifted.

Defective laser optics housing unit


Defective ID sensor
Defective BICU
Incorrect SP value
1. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
2. Replace the ID sensor.
3. Replace the BICU.
4. Adjust the value with SP2-182-004 to -021.

777

6. Troubleshooting

Test pattern check


The sub scan registrations of M, C, Y
are shifted.

Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective image transfer belt
Defective drive units
Defective ID sensor
Defective BICU
Incorrect SP value
1. Replace the image transfer belt.
2. Replace the ID sensor.
3. Replace the drum motor.
4. Replace the BICU.
5. Adjust the value with SP2-182-022 to -039.

The skew of M, C, Y is different.

Defective PCDU
Defective laser optics housing unit

Defective IOB
1. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the IOB.
The sub scan lines are shifted. Shifted
lines appear cyclically.

Defective PCDU
Defective drive unit
Drum phase adjustment error
1. Do SP1-902-001 (Drum phase adjustment); see
Replacement and Adjustment Drive Unit Gear Unit for
details.
2. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
3. Check or replace the drive unit.

Stain on the Outputs


If a stain appears at the edge of the output, do the following procedure.
1. Execute the fusing cleaning mode with SP1123-002.
It takes 160 seconds to complete the fusing cleaning mode.

778

Troubleshooting Guide

2. Make a sample copy, and then check if a stain appears on the output.

Stack Problem in the 1-Bin Tray


If a stack problem occurs on the 1-bin tray, raise the guide on the 1-bin tray.

If a stack problem occurs;


Push the guide to lift the guide [A].
If another type or size of paper is used;
Press down the guide [B].

Problem at Regular Intervals


Image problems may appear at regular intervals that depend on the circumference of certain components.
The following diagram shows the possible symptoms (black or white dots at regular intervals).

779

6. Troubleshooting

[A]: Paper feed direction


[B]: Problems at regular intervals
Colored spots at 47-mm intervals: Development roller
Abnormal image at 51-mm intervals: ITB drive or bias roller

Abnormal image at 85-mm intervals: Paper transfer roller


Colored spots at 119-mm intervals: Drum
Abnormal image at 101-mm intervals: Fusing unit (Pressure roller)
Abnormal image at 107-mm intervals: Fusing unit (Heating roller)

Toner End Recovery Error


If the toner end message on the LCD is displayed in the following conditions, there are some possible
causes. Check the machine referring to the flow chart for the toner end recovery error.
After a new toner bottle has been installed in the machine
When a displayed color toner bottle still has toner inside

780

Troubleshooting Guide

Flow Chart for the Toner End Recovery Error

781

6. Troubleshooting

6
Countermeasure 1
1. Check if the toner supply tube is bent or disconnected.
1. Straighten the toner supply tube or connect it correctly.
Countermeasure 2
1. Remove the target color toner bottle.
1. Disconnect the toner supply tube from the toner pump unit.
2. Remove the blocked toner in the toner supply tube with a vacuum cleaner.
Countermeasure 3
Replace the toner pump unit (
Countermeasure 4
Replace the PCDU (

782

p.205).

p.214).

Troubleshooting Guide

Solid Image or Halftone Image Error

The toner density of a solid image or halftone image may not be uniform ([A]: problem output, [B]: normal
output) if a large amount of sheets is printed at low coverage. If this occurs, follow the countermeasure
below.

Recovery Procedure
1. Enter the SP mode.
1. Set SP3-044-xxx (Toner Supply Type) to "1: PID (Vref Fixed)".
Chose a target color SP number from -001 (Bk), -002 (Magenta), -003 (Cyan), and -004
(Yellow).
2. Set SP3-222-xxx (Vtref: Display/Set) to "4V".
Chose a target color SP number from -001 (Bk), -002 (Magenta), -003 (Cyan), and -004
(Yellow).
3. Set SP2-109-003 (Test Pattern; Pattern Selection) to "23: Full Dot Pattern".
4. Set SP2-109-005 (Test Pattern; Color Selection) to "1: All Color (black)", "2: Magenta", "3: Cyan",
or "4: Yellow".
Chose a target color selection number.
5. Press "Copy Window" on the LCD.
6. Copy 20 sheets for A4 size or 30 sheets for A3 size, and then check the setting of SP3-222-xxx (Vtref:
Display/Set).
If the setting of this SP is more than 4V, go to next step. If not, copy again until the setting of this
SP is more than 4V.
7. Return the setting of SP3-044-xxx (Toner Supply Type) to "4: MBD (Vref_Control)".
Return the setting of the SP which you have changed in step 2 before.
783

6. Troubleshooting

8. Execute SP3-015-xxx (Forced Toner Supply: Execute) twice.


Chose a target color SP number from -003 (Bk), -004 (Magenta), -005 (Cyan) and -006
(Yellow).
9. Execute the SP3-011-002 (Process Cont. Manual Execution; Density Adjustment).

Problem Prevention Procedure


Set the setting of SP3-516-025 (Refresh Mode; Job End Area Coefficient) to "0.5".

Faulty Cleaning
Black or color lines (2-3mm)

Possible Cause:
Wear of the cleaning blade at a specific point by image creation in the same place many times.
Solution:
Replace the drum unit.

784

Troubleshooting Guide

Band Image Between 20mm and 30mm

6
Possible Cause:
Developer wear with time
Solution:
Replace the developer or the development unit.

785

6. Troubleshooting

Jam Detection
Paper Jam Display
SP7-507 shows the paper jam history.

CODE: Indicates the jam code.


SIZE: Indicates the paper Size Code.

TOTAL: Indicates the total counter (SP7-502-001).


DATE: indicates the date when the jam occurred.

Jam Codes and Display Codes


SP7-504 shows how many jams occurred at each location.

786

LCD
Display

Jam Code SP Display

Description

7504 3

Tray 1: ON

Paper is not fed from tray 1.

7504 4

Tray 2: ON

Paper is not fed from tray 2.

7504 5

Tray 3: ON

Paper is not fed from tray 3 (LCT).

7504 6

Tray 4: ON

Paper is not fed from tray 4.

7504 7

LCT: ON

Paper is not fed from LCT.

7504 8

Bypass: ON

Paper is not fed from the by-pass tray.

7504 9

Duplex: ON

Paper is jammed at the duplex unit.

7504 10

7504 11

Vertical Transport 1: ON

Vertical transport sensor 1 does not detect


paper from tray 1.

Jam Detection

LCD
Display

Jam Code SP Display

Description

7504 12

Vertical Transport 2: ON

Vertical transport sensor 2 does not detect


paper from tray 2.

7504 13

Bank Transport 1

Vertical transport sensor 1 or relay sensor does


not detect paper from tray 3 (LCT).

7504 15

7504 16

7504 17

Registration: ON

Registration sensor does not detect paper.

7504 18

Fusing Entrance: ON

Fusing entrance sensor does not detect paper.

7504 19

Fusing Exit: ON

Fusing exit sensor does not detect paper.

7504 20

Paper Exit: ON

Paper exit sensor does not detect paper.

7504 21

Relay Exit: ON

Tray exit sensor (bridge unit) does not detect


paper.

7504 22

Relay Transport: ON

Relay sensor (bridge unit) does not detect


paper.

7504 23

7504 24

Junction Gate Feed: ON

Junction gate jam sensor does not detect paper.

7504 25

Duplex Exit: ON

Duplex exit sensor does not detect paper.

7504 26

Duplex Entrance: ON (In) Duplex entrance sensor does not detect paper.

7504 27

Duplex Entrance: ON
(Out)

Duplex entrance sensor does not detect paper


again after paper has passed this sensor.

7504 28

7504 51

SEF Sensor 1

Vertical transport sensor 1 does not turn off.

7504 52

SEF Sensor 2

Vertical transport sensor 2 does not turn off.

7504 53

Bank SEF Sensor 1

Vertical transport sensor or relay sensor 1 does


not turn off.

7504 54

Bank SEF Sensor 2

Vertical transport sensor 2 does not turn off.

787

6. Troubleshooting

Description

7504 55

7504 56

7504 57

Regist Sensor

Registration sensor does not turn off.

7504 58

LCT Sensor

LCT sensor does not turn off.

7504 59

LCD
Display

Jam Code SP Display

7504 60

Exit Sensor

Paper exit sensor does not turn off.

7504 61

Relay Exit Sensor

Tray exit sensor (bridge unit) does not turn off.

7504 62

Relay Sensor

Relay sensor (bridge unit) does not turn off.

7504 63

7504 64

Junction Gate Feed: OFF

Junction gate jam sensor does not turn off.

7504 65

Duplex Exit Sensor

Duplex exit sensor does not turn off.

7504 66

Duplex Entrance: OFF (In) Duplex entrance sensor does not turn off.

7504 67

Duplex Entrance: OFF


(Out)

Duplex entrance sensor does not turn off after


paper has passed this sensor.

7504 68

7504 100

Finisher Entrance (B408)

Paper does not reach to the entrance sensor or


stay at the entrance sensor.

R1-R2

7504 101

Finisher Shift Tray Exit


(B408)

Paper does not reach to the lower tray exit


sensor or stay at the lower tray exit sensor.

R1-R2

7504 102

Finisher Staple (B408)

Paper does not reach to the staple tray entrance


sensor or stay at the staple tray entrance sensor.

R3-R5

Lower tray exit sensor does not detect paper


after the stack feed-out belt has fed paper.

788

7504 103

Finisher Exit (B408)

Lower tray exit sensor still detects paper after


the stack feed-out belt has returned to the home
position.

7504 104

R3-R5

Jam Detection

Jam Code SP Display

7504 105

7504 106

7504 107

7504 108

Finisher Tray Lift Motor


(B408)

Finisher Jogger Motor


(B408)

Finisher Shift Motor


(B408)

Finisher Staple Motor


(B408)

Description
Stack height sensor does not detect paper after
the lower tray has lifted up.
Stack height sensor still detects paper after the
lower tray has lifted down.
Jogger fence HP sensor does not turn off after
the jogger fence has moved from its home
position.
Jogger fence HP sensor does not turn on after
the jogger fence has returned to its home
position.
Shift roller HP sensor does not turn off after the
shift roller has moved from its home position.
Shift roller HP sensor does not turn on after the
shift roller has returned to its home position.
Stapler HP sensor does not turn off after the
stapler has moved from its home position.
Stapler HP sensor does not turn on after the
stapler has returned to its home position.
Stack feed-out belt HP sensor does not turn off
after the stack feed-out belt has moved from its
home position.

LCD
Display

R1-R2

R3-R5

R1-R2

R3-R5

7504 109

Finisher Exit Motor (B408)

7504 191

Finisher Entrance: EUP


(B804/B805)

Paper does not reach the finisher entrance


sensor or stays at the finisher entrance sensor.

R1-R4

7504 192

Finisher Proof Exit: EUP


(B804/B805)

Paper does not reach the proof tray exit sensor


or stays at the proof tray exit sensor.

R1-R4

7504 193

Finisher Shift Tray Exit:


EUP (B804/B805)

Paper does not reach the upper tray exit sensor


or stays at the upper tray exit sensor.

R1-R4

Stack feed-out belt HP sensor does not turn on


after the stack feed-out belt has returned to its
home position.

R3-R5

789

6. Troubleshooting

Jam Code SP Display

7504 194

Finisher Stapler Exit: EUP


(B804/B805)

Description
Stapling tray paper sensor does not turn on
after the finisher entrance sensor has turned on.
Stapling tray paper sensor does not turn off
after it has turned on.

LCD
Display

R5-R7

Upper tray exit sensor does not turn on while


the stack feed-out belt is turned on.

7504 195

Finisher Exit: EUP (B804/


Upper tray exit sensor does not turn off after the
B805)
stack feed-out belt has returned to its home
position.

R8-R12

7504 196

7504 197

Fold bottom fence HP sensor does not turn on


after the fold roller motor has stopped.

6
7504 198

Finisher Folder: EUP


(B804 only)

Fold unit exit sensor does not turn on after the


fold rollers have stopped.

R8-R12

Fold unit exit sensor does not turn off after the
fold rollers have stopped.

7504 199

Finisher Tray Motor: EUP


(B804/B805)

7504 200

Finisher Jogger Motor:


EUP (B804/B805)

Upper tray limit sensor does not turn on after the


upper tray has lifted up.
Upper tray limit sensor does not turn off after the
upper tray has moved down.
Jogger fence HP sensor does not turn on/off
after the jogger motor has turned on.
Stack feed out belt HP sensor does not turn on/
off after the feed out belt motor has turned on.

R1-R4

R8-R12

Shift roller HP sensor does not turn on/off after


the shift roller motor has turned on.
7504 201

790

Finisher Shift Motor: EUP


(B804/B805)

Exit guide plate HP sensor does not turn on/off


after the exit guide plate motor has turned on.
Stacking roller HP sensor does not turn on/off
after the stacking sponge roller motor has
turned on.

R1-R4

Jam Detection

Jam Code SP Display

7504 202

7504 203

Finisher Staple Moving


Motor: EUP (B804/
B805)

Finisher Staple Motor:


EUP (B804/B805)

Description
Corner stapler HP sensor does not turn on/off
after the corner stapler movement motor has
turned on.
Stapler rotation HP sensor does not turn on/off
after the corner stapler rotation motor has
turned on.
Corner stapler does not finish stapling after a
specified time.
Booklet stapler does not finish stapling after a
specified time.

LCD
Display

R8-R12

R8-R12

Fold plate HP sensor does not turn on/off after


the fold plate motor has turned on.

7504 204

Finisher Folder Motor:


EUP (B804 only)

Clamp roller HP sensor does not turn on/off


after the clamp roller retraction motor has
turned on.
Fold bottom fence HP sensor does not turn on/
off after the fold unit bottom fence lift motor has
turned on.

6
R8-R12

Stack junction gate HP sensor does not turn on/


off after the stack junction gate motor has turned
on.
7504 205

Punch encoder sensor does not turn on/off after


the punch drive motor has turned on.

7504 206

Punch movement HP sensor does not turn on/


Finisher Punch Motor: EUP off after the punch movement motor has turned
on.
(B804/B805)

R1-R4

Paper position slide HP sensor does not turn


on/off after the paper position sensor slide
motor has turned on.

791

6. Troubleshooting

Paper Size Code


Size Code

792

Paper Size

Size Code

Paper Size

05

A4 LEF

141

B4 SEF

06

A5 LEF

142

B5 SEF

14

B5 LEF

160

DLT SEF

38

LT LEF

164

LG SEF

44

HLT LEF

166

LT SEF

132

A3 SEF

172

HLT SEF

133

A4 SEF

255

Others

134

A5 SEF

Jam Detection

Sensor Locations

793

6. Troubleshooting

Electrical Component Defects


Sensors

The CN numbers in the following table are the connector numbers on the IOB.
No.

SW1

S9

Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name

Right Door Open Switch

Activ
e

794

CN204/1

Duplex Door

ID Sensor: M

ID Sensor: C

ID Sensor: Y

ID Sensor: Front

CN211/1

ID Sensor: Center and K

CN211/2

ID Sensor: Rear

CN211/3

Registration Sensor

CN224/A2

S1

S12

CN

CN232/B9

Condition

Symptom

Open

"Open Cover" is displayed.

Shorted

"Open cover" cannot be


detected.

Open

"Open Cover" is displayed.

Shorted

"Open cover" cannot be


detected.

CN211/

Open/

7, 11

Shorted

CN211/

Open/

8, 12

Shorted

CN211/

Open/

9, 13

Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted

SC400

SC258

SC400 / SC258

SC258

Open

Jam A (Jam8, 17)

Shorted

Jam A, B (Jam1)

Electrical Component Defects

No.

Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name

Activ
e

CN

S28

Drum Gear Position


Sensor-K

CN222/A2

S29

Drum Gear Position


Sensor-M

CN222/ A5

S30

Drum Gear Position


Sensor-C

CN222/ A8

S31

Drum Gear Position


Sensor-Y

CN222/ A11
CN207/A1

S24

Toner End Sensor - K

S25

Toner End Sensor - Y

S26

Toner End Sensor - C

S27

Toner End Sensor - M

CN207/B9
L

Condition
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open

Symptom

SC380/SC396

SC381/SC397

SC382/SC398

SC383/SC399
Toner end cannot be
detected.

CN207/
B12
CN207/

Shorted

Toner end is detected when


there is enough toner.

B15
S32

Image Transfer Belt


Rotation Sensor

S18

Vertical Transport Sensor


1

S21

Paper End

S24

Sensor 1, 2

S20
S23
S21

H/L

CN208/11

CN230/A7

Paper Lift Sensor 1, 2

Vertical Transport Sensor


2

Open/
Shorted
Open

Jam A (Jam3, 11)

Shorted

Jam A, B (Jam1)

Open

Paper end is not detected


when there is no paper in
the paper tray.

Shorted

Paper end is detected when


there is paper in the paper
tray.

CN230/
A10, B10

CN230/

Open/

A13, B13

Shorted

CN230/B7

SC443

SC501, SC502

Open

Jam A (Jam4, 12)

Shorted

Jam A, B (Jam1)

795

6. Troubleshooting

No.
S14
S15
S16
S17

SW4

S11

Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name

Activ
e

Tray 1 Paper Height


Sensor 1, 2

Tray 2 Paper Height


Sensor 1, 2

Tray 1 Set Switch

By-pass Paper Size


Sensor

796

By-pass Paper Detection


Sensor

Condition

CN224/

Open/

B2, B5

Shorted

CN224/

Open/

B10, B13

Shorted

B16, B17,
B19, B20

Tray 1 is detected when tray


1 is not set.

Open/
Shorted

Paper on the by-pass tray is


not detected when paper is
set.

Shorted

Paper on the by-pass tray is


detected when paper is not
set.

Open

B12

Shorted

S8

Fusing Entrance Sensor

CN232/B6

S6

Duplex Entrance Sensor

CN232/A8

S7

Duplex Exit Sensor

S35

TD Sensor - K

Paper size error

Open

CN232/

Remaining paper volume


on the LCD is wrong.

Shorted

A15

By-pass Paper Length


Sensor

Remaining paper volume


on the LCD is wrong.

Tray 1 is not detected when


tray 1 is set.

CN232/

S10

Symptom

Open
CN224/A9

CN232/

6
SW2

CN

Paper size error

Open

Jam C (Jam 18)

Shorted

Jam C (Jam 1)

Open

Jam Z (Jam 26/27)

Shorted

Jam Z (Jam 1)

CN232/

Open

Jam Z (Jam 25)

A11

Shorted

Jam Z (Jam 1)

CN227/A7

Open/
Shorted

SC372

Electrical Component Defects

No.

Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name

Activ
e

S36

TD Sensor - M

S37

TD Sensor - C

S38

TD Sensor - Y

S4

Fusing Exit Sensor

S13

SW4

Waste Toner Sensor

Waste Toner Bottle Set


Switch

CN
CN227/

Open/

A15

Shorted

CN227/B7

Tray 2 Paper Size Switch

Open/
Shorted

CN227/

Open/

B15

Shorted

CN204/12

SC373

SC374

SC375
Jam C (Jam 19)

Shorted

Jam C (Jam 1)

Open

Waste toner near full


indicated when it is not near
full.

Shorted

Waste toner near full


cannot be detected when
the waste toner bottle is
nearly full.

Open

Waste toner bottle is not


detected when the waste
toner bottle is set.

Shorted

Waste toner bottle is


detected when the waste
toner bottle is not set.

CN224/A7

A11, A12,
A13, A15

Symptom

Open

CN224/A5

CN224/
SW6

Condition

Open/
Shorted

Paper size error

SC498
S33

Temperature/
Humidity Sensor

CN231/

Open/

25, 27

Shorted

Printed image has some


problems such as rough
image, dirty background,
weak image or poor fusing.

797

6. Troubleshooting

No.

S34

TH2

TH1

S3

Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name
Thermopile
Thermistor
- Heating Roller
Thermistor
- Pressure Roller
Paper Exit Sensor

Activ
e

CN

CN209/16

CN212/22

CN212/18

CN204/9

6
S5

Paper Overflow Sensor

Original Width Sensor 1

Original Width Sensor 2

Original Length Sensor 1

Original Length Sensor 2

S43

Original Length Sensor 3

S39

Scanner HP Sensor

S41

S42

798

Condition
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted

Symptom

SC541

SC551

SC561

Open

Jam C (Jam 20)

Shorted

Jam C (Jam 1)

Open

Paper overflow message is


not displayed when the
paper overflow condition
still remains.

Shorted

Paper overflow message is


displayed when the paper
overflow condition does not
remain.

CN204/15

CN313/14

Open/

SIO

Shorted

CN313/11

Open/

SIO

Shorted

CN313/8

Open/

SIO

Shorted

CN313/5

Open/

SIO

Shorted

CN313/2

Open/

SIO

Shorted

Original paper size cannot


be detected.

CN318/2

Open

SC120

SIO

Shorted

SC121

Original paper size cannot


be detected.
Original paper size cannot
be detected.
Original paper size cannot
be detected.
Original paper size cannot
be detected.

Electrical Component Defects

No.

Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name

Activ
e

S40

Platen Cover Sensor

S2

Junction Paper Jam


Sensor

CN

Condition

CN318/5

Open/

SIO

Shorted

CN204/6

Open/
Shorted

Symptom
Platen cover open cannot
be detected.
Jam C (Jam 24/64)

Blown Fuse Conditions


Power Supply Unit

Fuse

Rating

Symptom when turning on the main switch

115V

220V - 240V

FU1

15A/125V

8A/250V

FU2

10A/125V

6.3A/250V

FU3

2A/250V

1A/250V

5V power to the scanner heater and tray heater is not


supplied.

FU4

1A/250V

1A/250V

5V power to the SIO and heater is not supplied.

FU5

5A/250V

5A/250V

5V power to the IOB not supplied.

FU6

2A/250V

2A/125V

5VS power to the BICU not supplied.

FU7

10A/125V

10A/125V

24VS power to the IOB not supplied.

FU8

10A/125V

10A/125V

24VS power to the IOB not supplied.

FU9

6.3A/125V

6.3A/125V

24V power to the IOB not supplied.

FU10

6.3A/125V

6.3A/125V

24V power to the SIO not supplied.

FU11

6.3A/125V

6.3A/125V

24V power to the BICU and MB not supplied.

FU12

6.3A/125V

6.3A/125V

24V power to the PFU or LCT not supplied.

FU13

6.3A/125V

6.3A/125V

24V power to the finisher not supplied.

No response. (5V power to the PSU is not supplied.)

No response. (5V power to the BICU and controller is not


supplied.)

799

6. Troubleshooting

Fuse
FU14

Rating
115V

220V - 240V

5A/250V

5A/250V

Symptom when turning on the main switch


5V power to the BICU not supplied.

IH Inverter

Fuse

FU1

Rating
115V

220V - 240V

15A/125V

8A/250V

Symptom when turning on the main switch


15V power to the IH coil unit is not supplied.
SC689 occurs.

FU2

115C

No response

FU3

115C

No response

FU4

1A/250V

15V power to the IH coil unit is not supplied.


SC689 occurs.

For continued protection against risk of fire, replace only with same type and rating of fuse.

800

Scanner Test Mode

Scanner Test Mode


SBU Test Mode
Output the SBU test pattern with SP4-807-001 to make sure the scanner SBU control operates correctly.
The SBU test pattern prints out after you have set the SP mode settings and pressed the start key.
The CCD on the SBU board may be defective if the copy is abnormal and the SBU test pattern is
normal.
The followings can be the cause if the copy is normal and the SBU test pattern is abnormal:
The harness may not be correctly connected between the SBU and the BICU.
The BICU or SBU board may be defective.

801

6. Troubleshooting

802

7. Energy Saving
Energy Save
Energy Saver Modes
Customers should use energy saver modes properly, to save energy and protect the environment.

7
The area shaded grey in this diagram represents the amount of energy that is saved when the timers are
at the default settings. If the timers are changed, then the energy saved will be different. For example, if
the timers are all set to 240 min., the grey area will disappear, and no energy is saved before 240 min.
expires.

Timer Settings
The user can set these timers with User Tools (System settings > Timer setting)
Panel off timer (10 sec 240 min): Panel Off Mode. Default setting: 60 sec.
Energy saver timer (1 240 min): Low Power Mode. Default setting: 15 min.
Auto off timer (1 240 min): Off/Sleep Mode. Default setting: 30 min.
Normally, Panel Off timer < Energy Saver timer < Auto Off timer. But, for example, if Auto Off timer < or
= Panel Off timer and Energy Saver timer, the machine goes immediately to Off mode when the Auto Off
timer expires. It skips the Panel Off and Energy Saver modes.
Example
Panel off: 1 min.

803

7. Energy Saving

Low power: 15 min.


Auto Off: 1 min.
The machine goes to Off mode after 1 minute. Panel Off and Low Power modes are not used.

Return to Stand-by Mode


Low Power Mode
The recovery time depends on the model and the region.
10 to 15.7 sec.
Off/Sleep Mode
Recovery time.
15 sec.

Recommendation
We recommend that the default settings should be kept.

If the customer requests that these settings should be changed, please explain that their energy costs
could increase, and that they should consider the effects on the environment of extra energy use.
If it is necessary to change the settings, please try to make sure that the Auto Off timer is not too long.
Try with a shorter setting first, such as 30 min., then go to a longer one (such as 60 min.) if the customer
is not satisfied.
If the timers are all set to the maximum value, the machine will not begin saving energy until 240
minutes has expired after the last job. This means that after the customer has finished using the machine
for the day, energy will be consumed that could otherwise be saved.
If you change the settings, the energy consumed can be measured using SP8941, as explained below.

Energy Save Effectiveness


SP 8941 (Machine Status) keeps a record of the amount of time that the machine spends in each mode.
8941-001: Operating mode
8941-002: Standby mode
8941-003: Panel off mode
8941-004: Low power mode
8941-005: Off/sleep mode
With this data, and the power consumption values from the specifications, we can estimate the amount of
energy that is used by the machine.

804

Energy Save

This should only be used as a reference value, because the power consumption specifications are measured
in a controlled environment with a constant power supply.
To get an exact measurement at the customers site, a watt meter must be used to measure the actual energy
consumed.
To use SP8941 to calculate the energy consumed:
At the start of the measurement period, read the values of SP8941 001 to 005.
At the end of the measurement period, read the values of SP8941 001 to 005 again.
Find the amount of time spent in each mode (subtract the earlier measurement from the later
measurement).
Multiply this by the power consumption spec for each mode.
Convert the result to kWh (kilowatt hours)
Here is an example calculation.
Machine

SP8941:

Condition

Machine
Status

Time at Start
(min.)

Time at End
(min.)

Running
time
(hour)

Power
consumption
Spec. (W)

( - )/
60 =
Operating

Power
consumption
(KWH)
(

)/1000
=

001:
Operatin
g Time

21089.0

21386.0

5.0

1081.8

5.35

002:
Standby
Time

306163.0

308046.0

31.4

214.0

6.72

003:
Energy save
Energy
(Panel off)
Save Time

71386.0

75111.0

62.1

214.0

13.29

Low power

004: Low
Power
Time

154084.0

156340.0

37.6

146.0

5.49

Off/Sleep

005: Off
Mode
Time

508776.0

520377.0

193.4

7.0

1.35

Stand by
(Ready)

Total

32.20

805

7. Energy Saving

Paper Save
Effectiveness of Duplex/Combine Function
Duplexing and the combine functions reduce the amount of paper used. This means that less energy overall
is used for paper production, which improves the environment.

1. Duplex:
Reduce paper volume in half!

7
2. Combine mode:
Reduce paper volume in half!

3. Duplex + Combine:
Using both features together can further reduce paper volume by 3/4!

806

Paper Save

To check the paper consumption, look at the total counter and the duplex counter.
The total counter counts all pages printed.
For one duplex page, the total counter goes up by 2.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the total counter goes up by 3.
The duplex counter counts pages that have images on both sides.
For one duplex page, the duplex counter goes up by 1.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the duplex counter will only increase by 1, even though
two sheets are used.

How to calculate the paper reduction ratio

How to calculate the paper reduction ratio, when compared with Single-sided copying, with no 2-in-1
combine mode
Paper reduction ratio (%) = Number of sheets reduced: A/Number of printed original images: B x 100
Number of sheets reduced: A
= Output pages in duplex mode/2 + Number of pages in Single-sided with combine mode + Number
of pages in Duplex with combine mode x 3/2
A = ((2) + (3) + (4))/2 + (5) + (6) x 3/2
Number of printed original images: B
= Total counter6 + Number of pages in Single-sided with combine mode + Number of pages in Duplex
with combine mode
B = (1) + (5) + (6)
(1) Total counter: SP 8581 001 (pages)
(2) Single-sided with duplex mode: SP 8421 001 (pages)
(3) Double-sided with duplex mode: SP 8421 002 (pages)
(4) Book with duplex mode: SP 8421 003 (pages)
(5) Single-sided with combine mode: SP 8421 004 (pages)

807

7. Energy Saving

(6) Duplex with combine mode: SP 8421 005 (pages)

808

Model AT-C2.5
Machine Code: D086/D087
Appendices

1 November, 2010

TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. Appendix: Specifications
General Specifications.......................................................................................................................................3
Main Frame....................................................................................................................................................3
Printer...............................................................................................................................................................7
Scanner...........................................................................................................................................................9
Supported Paper Sizes....................................................................................................................................10
Paper Feed...................................................................................................................................................10
Paper Exit......................................................................................................................................................13
Platen/ARDF Original Size Detection........................................................................................................18
Software Accessories.......................................................................................................................................20
Printer Drivers...............................................................................................................................................20
Scanner and LAN Fax drivers.....................................................................................................................20
Utility Software.............................................................................................................................................21
Optional Equipment.........................................................................................................................................22
ARDF (D541)...............................................................................................................................................22
Paper Feed Unit (D537)..............................................................................................................................22
LCT 2000-sheet (D538)..............................................................................................................................23
LCT 1200-sheet (D539)..............................................................................................................................23
1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher & Punch Unit (B793)..................................................................................24
1000-Sheet Finisher (B408).......................................................................................................................25
500-Sheet Finisher (D372).........................................................................................................................26
Bridge Unit (D386)......................................................................................................................................28
Shift Tray (D388).........................................................................................................................................29
1-bin Tray Unit (D536)...............................................................................................................................29

2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables


Maintenance Tables........................................................................................................................................31
Preventive Maintenance Items....................................................................................................................31
Others Yield Parts.........................................................................................................................................37

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables


System SP1-xxx................................................................................................................................................39
SP1-XXX (Feed)............................................................................................................................................39
System SP2-xxx................................................................................................................................................71
SP2-XXX (Drum)...........................................................................................................................................71
1

System SP3-xxx..............................................................................................................................................155
SP3-XXX (Process).....................................................................................................................................155
System SP4-xxx..............................................................................................................................................207
SP4-XXX (Scanner)....................................................................................................................................207
System SP5-xxx..............................................................................................................................................233
SP5-XXX (Mode).......................................................................................................................................233
System SP6-xxx..............................................................................................................................................301
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)...............................................................................................................................301
System SP7-xxx..............................................................................................................................................311
SP7-XXX (Data Log)..................................................................................................................................311
System SP8-xxx..............................................................................................................................................346
SP8-xxx: Data Log2..................................................................................................................................346
Input and Output Check................................................................................................................................392
Input Check Table.....................................................................................................................................392
Output Check Table..................................................................................................................................403
Printer Service Mode.....................................................................................................................................414
SP1-XXX (Service Mode)..........................................................................................................................414
Scanner SP Mode..........................................................................................................................................421
SP1-xxx (System and Others)...................................................................................................................421
SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality)..........................................................................................................421
Test Pattern Printing........................................................................................................................................423

INDEX...........................................................................................................................................................425

1. Appendix: Specifications
General Specifications

Main Frame
Configuration:
Print Process:
Number of scans:
Resolution:

Gradation:

Desktop
Laser beam scanning & Dry electrostatic transfer system
4 drums tandem method
1
Scan: 600 dpi
Print: 600 dpi
Scan: 600dpi / 10bits/pixel
Print: 600dpi / 4 bits/pixel

Original type:

Sheets, book, objects

Maximum original size:

A3/11" x 17"

Original reference
position:

Left rear corner, ad hoc lists

1. Appendix: Specifications

Plain (ADF 1 to 1, LT/ A4 LEF)


C2.5a: 30 cpm (color/black & white)
C2.5b: 35 cpm (color/black & white)

Thick 1 (169 g/m2 or less)


C2.5a: 17.5 cpm (color/black & white)
C2.5b 17.5 cpm (color/black & white)
Thick 2 (220 g/m2 or less)
C2.5a: 17.5 cpm (color/black & white)
Copy speed:

C2.5b 17.5 cpm (color/black & white)


Thick 3 (256 g/m2 or less)
C2.5a: 17.5 cpm (color/black & white)
C2.5b 17.5 cpm (color/black & white)
Thick 4 (300 g/m2 or less)
C2.5a: 15 cpm (color/black & white) from By-pass
C2.5b: 15 cpm (color/black & white) from By-pass
OHP, Glossy (1200 dpi)
C2.5a: 17.5 cpm (color/black & white)
C2.5b 17.5 cpm (color/black & white)
C2.5a/ b

First copy (normal mode):

Color: 8 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF)


Black & white: 5 seconds or less (A4/LT LEF)

Warm-up time:

26 seconds or less (23C)


Standard tray: 550 sheets x 2 + 100

Print Paper Capacity:

By-pass tray: 100 sheets (Normal), 40 sheets (Thick 1: 106 - 169g/m2),


20 sheets (Thick 2/3: 170 - 256 g/m2), 35 sheets (Postcard)

(80 g/m2, 20 lb)

Optional paper feed tray: 550 sheets x 2


2000-sheet LCT: 2000 sheets
1200-sheet LCT: 1200 sheets

General Specifications

(Refer to Supported Paper Sizes.)


-

Minimum

Tray 1
Tray 2
Print Paper Size:

By-pass
Optional Tray

A4/8.5" x 11" (LEF)


A5 (LEF)/
8.5" x 11"
90 x 148 mm
A5 (LEF)/
8.5" x 11"

2000-sheet LCT
1200-sheet LCT

Maximum

A3/11" x 17"
305 x 600 mm
A3/11" x 17"

A4/8.5" x 11" (LEF)


B5 (LEF)/

A4 (LEF)/

257 x 182mm

297 x 210mm

Standard tray: 60 to 256 g/m2 (16 to 68 lb.)


Optional paper tray: 60 to 256 g/m2 (16 to 68 lb.)
Printing Paper Weight:

By-pass tray: 60 to 300 g/m2 (16 to 79.8 lb.)


Duplex unit: 60 to 169 g/m2 (16 to 45 lb.)
LCT 1200: 60 to 216 g/m2 (10 to 571Ib)
Standard exit tray: 500 sheets or more (face down)*1
Shift Tray: 250 sheets (80 g/m2)
1-bin Tray: 125 (80 g/m2)

Output Paper Capacity:

500-sheet finisher 500 (80 g/m2)


1000-sheet finisher: 250 + 1000 sheets (80 g/m2)
1000-sheet booklet finisher: 100 + 1000 sheets (80 g/m2)
*1: T6200, A4 LEF

Continuous copy:

Up to 999 sheets

1. Appendix: Specifications

Arbitrary: From 25 to 400% (1% step)


Fixed:

Zoom:

Memory:
Power Source:

North America

Europe

25%

25%

50%

50%

65%

61%

73%

71%

78%

82%

85%

87%

93%

93%

100%

100%

121%

115%

129%

122%

155%

141%

200%

200%

400%

400%

Standard: 1.5 GB
120 V, 60 Hz: More than 12A (for North America)
220 V 240 V, 50/60 Hz: More than 8A (for Europe/ASIA)
-

Power Consumption:

Maximum
Energy Saver
( Sleep Mode )

120V

220 - 240V

1584 W or less

1700 W or less

2.0 W or less

2.0 W or less

General Specifications

Model

State

Standby

Mainframe

Complete system
(*1)

40 dB(A)

44 dB(A)

or Less

or Less

B/W: 66.5 dB(A)

C2.5a

or Less

Operating

Color: 67.0 dB(A) or Color: 70.4 dB(A) or


Less
Less

Noise Emission:
(Sound Power Level)
Standby

40 dB(A)

46.9 dB(A)

or Less

or Less

B/W: 68.3 dB(A)

C2.5b

or Less

Operating

Color: 68.5 dB(A) or Color: 71.9 dB(A) or


Less
Less
(*1) The complete system consists of mainframe, ARDF, finisher, and LCT.
The above measurements were made in accordance with Ricoh standard methodology.
Dimensions (W x D x H):
Copier: 670 x 671 x 760 mm (26.4" x 26.4" x 29.9")
Copier + PFU or LCT: 670 x 671 x 1020 mm (26.4" x 26.4" x 40.2")
Weight:

Less than 120 kg (265 lb.) [with ARDF excluding toner]

Printer
PCL 6/5c
RPCS (Refined Printing Command Stream)
Adobe PostScript 3 (optional)
Printer Languages:

PDF Direct (optional)


IPDS (optional)
PictBridge (optional)
MediaPrint: JPEG/TIFF (optional)

1. Appendix: Specifications

PCL 5c:
300 x 300 dpi : Available only in B/W mode
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits), Fine (4 bits)

PCL 6:
Resolution and
Gradation:

600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits), Fine (4 bits) / 1200 x 1200
dpi
RPCS:
600 x 600 dpi, 1,800 x 600 dpi*, 9600 dpi x 600 dpi*
*1,800 x 600 dpi = 600 x 600 dpi (2 bits)
*9600 dpi x 600 dpi* = 600 x 600 dpi (4 bits)
PS3:
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits), Fine (4 bits)
C2.5a:
30 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode

Printing speed:

17.5 ppm in Thick/OHP mode (depending on paper type)


C2.5b:
35 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode
17.5 ppm in Thick/OHP mode (depending on paper type)
PCL 6/5c (Standard):
45 Compatible fonts
13 International fonts

Resident Fonts:

1 Bitmap font
Adobe PostScript 3 (Optional):
136 fonts (24 Type 2 fonts, 112 Type 14 fonts)
IPDS (Optional):
108 fonts

General Specifications

USB2.0 Type A and Type B: Standard


USB Host (PictBridge): Optional
Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T): Standard
Host Interfaces:

Gigabit Ethernet (1000 Base-T): Optional

IEEE1284 parallel x 1: Optional


IEEE802.11a/g (Wireless LAN): Optional
Bluetooth (Wireless): Optional
Network Protocols:

TCP/IP (IPv4, IPv6), IPX/SPX, AppleTalk (Auto Switching)

Scanner
Standard Scanner
Resolution:

Main scan/Sub scan


600 dpi
Twain Mode:

Available scanning
Resolution Range:

100 to1200 dpi


Delivery Mode:
100/200/300/400/600 dpi

Grayscales:
Scanning Throughput
(ARDF mode):

Interface:

Compression Method:

1 bit or 8 bits/pixel each for RGB


Scan to E-mail / Folder:
BW: 51 ipm (A4LEF / BW Text (Print) / 200dpi /Compression: On (MH))
FC: 51 ipm (A4LEF / FC Text / Photo / 200dpi / Compression: Standard)
Ethernet (100 Base-TX/10 Base-T/1000 Base-T for TCP/IP), Wireless LAN,
GigaEthernet
B&W: TIFF (MH, MR, MMR)
Gray Scale, Full Color: JPEG

1. Appendix: Specifications

Supported Paper Sizes


1

Paper Feed
North America
BT: By-pass Tray, T1: Tray 1, T2/3/4: Tray 2/3/4, LCT 2000: Large Capacity Tray: 2000-sheet, LCT
1200: Large Capacity Tray: 1200-sheet, DU: Duplex Unit
Paper

10

Size
(W x L)

BT

T1

T2/3/
4

LCT

LCT

2000

1200

DU

A3 W

12" x 18"

A3 SEF

297 x 420mm

A4 SEF

210 x 297mm

A4 LEF

297 x 210mm

A5 SEF

148 x 210mm

A5 LEF

210 x 148mm

A6 SEF

105 x 148mm

B4 SEF

257 x 364mm

B5 SEF

182 x 257mm

B5 LEF

257 x 182mm

B6 SEF

128 x 182mm

Ledger

11" x 17"

Letter SEF

8.5" x 11"

Letter LEF

11" x 8.5"

Legal SEF

8.5" x 14"

Government
Legal SEF

8.25" x 14"

Half Letter SEF

5.5" x 8.5"

Supported Paper Sizes

Paper

Size
(W x L)

BT

T1

T2/3/
4

LCT

LCT

2000

1200

DU

Executive SEF

7.25" x 10.5"

Executive LEF

10.5" x 7.25"

8" x 13"

8.5" x 13"

8.25" x 13"

11" x 15"

10" x 14"

8" x 10"

8K

267 x 390mm

16K SEF

195 x 267mm

16K LEF

267 x 195mm

F SEF
Foolscap SEF

Folio SEF

Custom
Com10 Env.

4.125" x 9.5"

Monarch Env.

3.875" x 7.5"

C6 Env.

114 x 162mm

C5 Env.

162 x 229mm

DL Env.

110 x 220mm

Remarks:
A

Supported: the sensor detects the paper size.

Supported: the user specifies the paper size.

Supported: depends on a technician adjustment

Not supported

11

1. Appendix: Specifications

Europe/ Asia

BT: By-pass Tray, T1: Tray 1, T2/3/4: Tray 2/3/4, LCT 2000: Large Capacity Tray: 2000-sheet, LCT
1200: Large Capacity Tray: 1200-sheet, DU: Duplex Unit
Paper

(W x L)

BT

T1

T2/3/
4

LCT

LCT

2000

1200

DU

A3 W

12" x 18"

A3 SEF

297 x 420mm

A4 SEF

210 x 297mm

A4 LEF

297 x 210mm

A5 SEF

148 x 210mm

A5 LEF

210 x 148mm

A6 SEF

105 x 148mm

B4 SEF

257 x 364mm

B5 SEF

182 x 257mm

B5 LEF

257 x 182mm

B6 SEF

128 x 182mm

Ledger

11" x 17"

Letter SEF

8.5" x 11"

Letter LEF

11" x 8.5"

Legal SEF

8.5" x 14"

Government
Legal SEF

8.25" x 14"

Half Letter SEF

5.5" x 8.5"

Executive SEF

7.25" x 10.5"

Executive LEF

10.5" x 7.25"

8" x 13"

8.5" x 13"

F SEF
Foolscap SEF
12

Size

Supported Paper Sizes

BT

T1

T2/3/
4

LCT

LCT

2000

1200

8.25" x 13"

11" x 15"

10" x 14"

8" x 10"

8K

267 x 390mm

16K SEF

195 x 267mm

16K LEF

267 x 195mm

Paper

Folio SEF

Size
(W x L)

Custom

DU

Com10 Env.

4.125" x 9.5"

Monarch Env.

3.875" x 7.5"

C6 Env.

114 x 162mm

C5 Env.

162 x 229mm

DL Env.

110 x 220mm

Remarks:
A

Supported: the sensor detects the paper size.

Supported: the user specifies the paper size.

Supported: depends on a technician adjustment

Not supported

Paper Exit
1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher
MF: Main Frame, Prf: Proof, Clr: Clear, Shf: Shift, Stp: Staple, SS: Saddle Stitch,
2/3 P: 2/3 Holes Punch, 4 P: 4 Holes Punch, N4P: North Europe 4 Holes Punch

13

1. Appendix: Specifications

Paper

MF

1000-sheet booklet finisher


Prf

Clr

Shf

Stp

SS

2/3 P

4P

N4P

A3 W

12" x 18"

A3 SEF

297 x 420 mm

30

30

A4 SEF

210 x 297 mm

50

50

A4 LEF

297 x 210 mm

50

50

A5 SEF

148 x 210 mm

A5 LEF

210 x 148 mm

A6 SEF

105 x 148 mm

B4 SEF

257 x 364 mm

30

30

B5 SEF

182 x 257 mm

50

50

B5 LEF

257 x 182 mm

50

50

B6 SEF

128 x 182 mm

Ledger

11" x 17"

30

30

Letter SEF

8.5" x 11"

50

50

Letter LEF

11" x 8.5"

50

Legal SEF

8.5" x 14"

30

30

8.25" x 14"

30

30

Half Letter SEF

5.5" x 8.5"

Executive SEF

7.25" x 10.5"

50

Executive LEF

10.5" x 7.25"

50

F SEF

8" x 13"

30

Foolscap SEF

8.5" x 13"

30

Government
Legal SEF

14

Size (W x L)

Supported Paper Sizes

Paper

Size (W x L)

MF

1000-sheet booklet finisher


Prf

Clr

Shf

Stp

SS

2/3 P

4P

N4P

8.25" x 13"

30

11" x 15"

30

10" x 14"

30

8" x 10"

30

8K

267 x 390 mm

30

16K SEF

195 x 267 mm

50

16K LEF

267 x 195 mm

50

Folio SEF

Custom
Com10 Env.

4.125" x 9.5"

Monarch Env.

3.875" x 7.5"

C6 Env.

114 x 162 mm

C5 Env.

162 x 229 mm

DL Env.

110 x 220 mm

Remarks:
Y

Supported

30

Output up to 30 sheets

50

Output up to 50 sheets

Not supported

1000-Sheet Finisher and 500-Sheet Finisher


MF: Main Frame, Prf: Proof, Clr: Clear, Shf: Shift, Stp: Staple

15

1. Appendix: Specifications

Paper

(W x L)

MF

1000-sheet finisher

500-sheet finisher

Prf

Clr

Shf

Stp

Clr

Shf

Stp

1-Bin

Shift

A3 W

12" x 18"

A3 SEF

297 x
420 mm

30

30

A4 SEF

210 x
297 mm

50

50

A4 LEF

297 x
210 mm

50

50

A5 SEF

148 x
210 mm

A5 LEF

210 x
148 mm

A6 SEF

105 x
148 mm

B4 SEF

257 x
364 mm

30

30

B5 SEF

182 x
257 mm

50

50

B5 LEF

257 x
182 mm

50

50

B6 SEF

128 x
182 mm

Ledger

11" x 17"

30

30

Letter SEF

8.5" x 11"

50

50

Letter LEF

11" x 8.5"

50

50

Legal SEF

8.5" x 14"

30

30

8.25" x
14"

30

Government
Legal SEF

16

Size

Supported Paper Sizes

Paper

Size
(W x L)

MF

1000-sheet finisher

500-sheet finisher

Prf

Clr

Shf

Stp

Clr

Shf

Stp

1-Bin

Shift

Half Letter SEF

5.5" x
8.5"

Executive SEF

7.25" x
10.5"

50

50

Executive LEF

10.5" x
7.25"

50

50

F SEF

8" x 13"

30

30

8.5" x 13"

30

30

8.25" x
13"

30

30

11" x 15"

30

30

10" x 14"

30

30

8" x 10"

30

30

8K

267 x
390 mm

30

30

16K SEF

195 x
267 mm

50

50

16K LEF

267 x
195 mm

50

50

Foolscap SEF

Folio SEF

Custom
Com10 Env.

4.125" x
9.5"

Monarch Env.

3.875" x
7.5"

C6 Env.

114 x
162 mm

C5 Env.

162 x
229 mm

17

1. Appendix: Specifications

Size

Paper

(W x L)
110 x
220 mm

DL Env.

1000-sheet finisher

MF

500-sheet finisher

Prf

Clr

Shf

Stp

Clr

Shf

Stp

1-Bin

Shift

Remarks:
Y

Supported

30

Output up to 30 sheets

50

Output up to 50 sheets

Not supported

Platen/ARDF Original Size Detection

18

Size

Platen

ARDF

Platen

ARDF

(width x length) [mm]

Inches

Inches

Metric

Metric

A3 (297 x 420) L

Y*3

B4 (257 x 364) L

Y*3

A4 (210 x 297) L

Y*1

Y*3

A4 (297 x 210) S

Y*3

Y*3

B5 (182 x 257) L

Y*3

B5 (257 x 182) S

Y*3

A5 (148 x 210) L

-*1

A5 (210 x 148) S

-*1

B6 (128 x 182) L

B6 (182 x 128) S

11" x 17" (DLT)

Y*2

Y*2

11" x 15"

Y*2

Supported Paper Sizes

10" x 14"

8.5" x 14" (LG)

Y*2

8.5" x 13" (F4)

Y*2

Y*4

Y*4

8.25" x 13"

Y*4

Y*4

8" x 13"(F)

Y*4

Y*4

8.5" x 11" (LT)

Y*3

Y*2

Y*3

Y*2

11" x 8.5" (LT)

Y*3

Y*2

Y*3

Y*2

Y*2

5.5" x 8.5" (HLT)

-*1

8.5" x 5.5" (HLT)

-*1

8K (267 x 390)

Y*3

Y*2

16K L (195 x 267)

Y*3

Y*2

16K S (267 x 195)

Y*3

Y*2

7.25" x 10.5" (Executive)

10.5" x 7.25" (Executive)

Y*2

8" x 10"

*1: Use SP4-303 to detect original sizes as A5 lengthwise/HLT when the message Can-t detect original
size shows.
*2: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP6-016-1.
*3: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP4-305-1.
*4: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP5-126-1.

19

1. Appendix: Specifications

Software Accessories
1

The printer drivers and utility software are provided as following two CD-ROMs
1: Printer Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM
2: Scanner/PostScript Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM.
An auto-run installer lets you to select the components you want to install.

Printer Drivers

Printer Language

MacOS8.6 to 9.x,
MacOSX10.1

Windows 2000, XP, Server 2003, Vista,


Server 2008, 7

or later

PCL5c
/ PCL6

Yes

No

PS3

Yes

Yes

RPCS

No

No

The PCL5c/6 and PS3 drivers are provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM
The PS3 drivers are all genuine Adobe PS drivers, except for Windows 2000/XP/2003/Vista/7.
Windows 2000 uses Microsoft PS. A PPD file for each operating system is provided with the driver.
The PPD installer for Macintosh supports Mac OS X 10.1 or later versions.
The LAN Fax driver lets you fax documents directly form your PC. Address Book Editor and Cover
Sheet Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.)

Scanner and LAN Fax drivers


Windows 2000, XP, Server
2003, Vista, 7

MacOS8.6 to 9.x, MacOSX10.1

Network TWAIN

Yes

No

LAN-FAX

Yes

No

Printer Language

20

or later

Software Accessories

The Network TWAIN and LAN Fax drivers are provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM.
This software lets you fax documents directly form your PC. Address Book Editor and Cover Sheet
Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.)

Utility Software
Software

Description

Font Manager

A font management utility with screen fonts for the printer

(2000/XP/Server 2003/7)

This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM

Smart Device Monitor for Admin


(2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista/7)

A printer management utility for network administrators. NIB


setup utilities are also available.
This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM
A printer management utility for client users.

DeskTopBinder SmartDeviceMonitor
for Client (2000/XP/Server 2003/
Vista/7)

A utility for peer-to-peer printing over a NetBEUI or TCP/IP


network.
A peer-to-peer print utility over a TCP/IP network. This
provides the parallel printing and recovery printing features.
This is provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM

Printer Utility for Mac


(Mac)

A utility for peer-to-peer printing over a NetBEUI or TCP This


software provides several convenient functions for printing
from Macintosh clients.
This is provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM

DeskTopBinder Lite
(2000/XP/Server 2003/7)

DeskTopBinder Lite itself can be used as personal document


management software and can manage both image data
converted from paper documents and application files saved
in each clients PC.
This is provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM

21

1. Appendix: Specifications

Optional Equipment
1

ARDF (D541)

Simplex
Paper Size/Weight:
Duplex

Size

A3 to A5, DLT to HLT

Weight

40 to 128 g/m2 (10 to 34 lb.)

Size

A3 to A5, DLT to HLT

Weight

52 to 105 g/m2 (14 to 28 lb.)

Table Capacity:

50 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb)

Original Standard Position:

Rear left corner

Separation:

Feed belt and separation roller

Original Transport:

Roller transport

Original Feed Order:

From the top original


Copy

Supported Magnification Ratios:

Fax

32 to 200 %

Color

32.6 to 200 %

Black & white

48.9 to 200 %

Power Source:

DC 24V, 5V from the scanner unit

Power Consumption:

50 W or less

Dimensions (W D H) :

550 mm x 491 mm x 120 mm (21.7" x 19.3" x 4.7")

Weight:

10 kg (22 lb.)

Paper Feed Unit (D537)

22

Paper Feed System:

FRR

Paper Height Detection:

5 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, 10% (Near end), and Empty)

Capacity:

500 sheets x 2 trays

Paper Weight:

60 to 256 g/m2 (16 to 68 lb.)

Optional Equipment

Paper Size:

A3 SEF to A5, DLT SEF to HLT

Power Source:

DC 24V, 5V (from the main frame)

Power Consumption:

Less than 60 W (Max.)/ Less than 35 W (Ave,)

Dimensions (W x D x H):

580 mm x 620 mm x 260 mm (22.8" x 24.4" x 10.2")

Weight:

26 kg (57.3 lb.)

LCT 2000-sheet (D538)


Paper Size:

A4 LEF/LT LEF

Paper Weight:

60 g/m2 to 256 g/m2 (16 lb. to 68 lb.)

Tray Capacity:

2,000 sheets (80 g/m2, 20lb.)

Remaining Paper Detection:

5 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, 10%, Empty): Right Tray


4 steps (100%, 70%, 30%, Empty): Left Tray

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from copier/printer)

Power Consumption:

55 W (Max.)/30 W (Ave.)

Weight:

26 kg (57.3 lb.)

Size (W x D x H):

580 mm x 620 mm x 260 mm (22.8" x 24.4" x 10.2")

LCT 1200-sheet (D539)


Paper Size:

A4 LEF/ LT LEF/ B5 LEF

Paper Weight:

60 g/m2 to 216 g/m2 (16 lb to 57 lb.)

Tray Capacity:

1,200 sheets (80 g/m2, 20lb)

Remaining Paper Detection:

5 steps (100%, 75%, 30%, 10%, End)

Power Source:

24 Vdc, 5 Vdc (from copier/printer)

Power Consumption:

55 W (Max)/ 25 W (Ave.)

Weight:

14 kg (30.8 lb.)

23

1. Appendix: Specifications

Size (W x D x H):

348 mm x 540 mm x 290 mm


(13.7" x 21.3" x 11.4")

1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher & Punch Unit (B793)


No punch mode:
A3/11" x 17" to A5/8.5" x 5.5" (LEF)
Punch mode:
2 holes: A3/11" x 17" to B6/5.5" x 8.5" (SEF) or A4/8.5" x 11"
to A5/8.5" x 5.5" (LEF)
3 holes:
Print Paper Size:

A3, B4, 11" x 17" (SEF) or A4, B5, 8.5" x 11" (LEF)
4 holes (Europe):
A3, B4, 11" x 17" (SEF) or A4, B5, 8.5" x 11" (LEF)
4 holes (North Europe):
A3/11" x 17" to B6/5.5" x 8.5" (SEF)
Staple mode:
A3/11" x 17" to B5/8.5" x 11"
No punch mode:
52 to 256 g/m2 (14 to 68 lb.) (Shift tray)
52 to 105 g/m2 (14 to 28 lb.) (Proof tray)

Paper Weight:

Punch mode:
52 to 163 g/m2 (14 to 43 lb.)
Staple mode:
64 to 90 g/m2 (17 to 24 lb.)
Label/Thick paper/OHP cannot be stapled
[Proof tray]
100 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or less

Tray Capacity:

50 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14" or more


[Shift tray]
1000 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" (LEF) or smaller
500 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger

24

Optional Equipment

Single size:
Staple capacity:

50 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller


30 sheets: B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger
3 positions

Staple position:

1-staple: 2 positions (Top Left, Top Right)


2-staples: 1 positions

Staple replenishment:

Cartridge (5000 staples)

Power consumption:

60 W

Dimensions (W x D x H):

535 mm x 600 mm x 930 mm (21.1" x 23.6" x 36.6")

Weight

Without punch unit:

48 kg (105.8 lb.)

With punch unit:

50 Kg (110.3 lb.)

1000-Sheet Finisher (B408)


Upper Tray
Paper Size:

A3 to A6
11" x 17" to 5.5" x 8.5"

Paper Weight:

60 to 157 g/m2 (16 to 42 lb.)


250 sheets (A4 LEF/8.5" x 11" SEF or smaller)

Paper Capacity:

50 sheets (A4, 8.5" x 11" or smaller)


30 sheets (B4, 8.5" x 14" or larger)

Lower Tray
No staple mode:
Paper Size:

A3 to B5, DLT to HLT


Staple mode:
A3, B4, A4, B5, DLT to LT

25

1. Appendix: Specifications

Paper Weight:

Stapler Capacity:

No staple mode: 60 to 157 g/m2 (16 to 42 lb)


Staple mode: 64 to 90 g/m2 (17 to 24 lb)
30 sheets (A3, B4, DLT, LG)
50 sheets (A4, B5 LEF, LT)
No staple mode:
1,000 sheets (A4/LT or smaller: 80 g/m2, 20 lb.)
500 sheets (A3, B4, DLT, LG: 80 g/m2, 20 lb.)
Staple mode: (80 g/m2, 20 lb., number of sets)
Set Size

Paper Capacity:

Staple positions:

Size

2 to 9

10 to 30

31 to 50

A4/LT LEF
B5 LEF

100

100 to 20

100 to 20

A4/LT SEF

100

50 to 10

50 to 10

A3, B4, DLT, LG

50

50 to 10

1 Staple: 2 positions (Front, Rear)


2 Staples: 2 positions (Upper, Left)

Staple Replenishment:

Cartridge (5,000 staples/cartridge)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier/printer)

Power Consumption:

50 W

Weight:

25 kg (55.2 lbs)

Dimensions (W x D x H):

527 x 520 x 790 mm (20.8" x 20.5" x 31.1")

500-Sheet Finisher (D372)


Paper Size:

A3 to B6 (SEF)

Paper Weight:

52 to 128 g/m2 (14 to 34 lb.)

Tray Capacity:

26

10 to 50

500 sheets: A4, LT or smaller


250 sheets: B4, LG or larger

Optional Equipment

30 sheets (A3, B4, DLT, LG)

Staple capacity:

50 sheets (A4, LT or smaller)


3 positions

Staple position:

1-staple: 2 positions (Top right-oblique, Top left-oblique)

2-staples: 1 positions (Left)


Staple replenishment:

Cartridge (5000 staples)

500-Sheet Finisher
Target Line Speed

77 mm/sec. to 205 mm/sec

Target CPM

35 cpm
12"x18", A3 SEF to A6 SEF, DLT to HLT SEF

Face-down Output Size

Shift sizes: A3 SEF to B5 SEF


A5, B6, A6 SEF labels possible
52 g/m2 (45 K) to 157 g/m2 (135 K)

Paper Thickness

Up to 253 g/m2 (220K) without shift

Stapling
Stack Height for Stapling

50 sheets: A4, LT and smaller


30 sheets: B4, LG and larger

Size A3 SEF to B5 SEF (can be mixed if same width)


Stack Thickness 64g/m2 (45 K) to 157 g/m (135 K)
Stapling Positions

Front/Oblique: 1, Front/Parallel: 1
Rear/Oblique: 1, Rear/Parallel: 1, 2 locations

Output Tray Capacity


Non-staple Mode 500 sheets: A4, LT and smaller
250 sheets: B4, LG
Staple Mode and larger

Stacks

Size

Stack Size (Stapling)

27

1. Appendix: Specifications

Stacking

2 to 9 Sheets

55 to 46

10 to 50 Sheets

45 to 10

2 to 9 Sheets

55 to 27

10 to 50 Sheets

25 to 8

2 to 9 Sheets

55 to 27

10 to 30 Sheets

25 to 8

Non-Stapling Mode

A4, B5, LT LEF

A4, B5, LT SEF

A3, B4, DLT, LG

Vertical: 15 mm or less
Horizontal: 15 mm or less

Jogging Precision
2 to 30 Sheets 2 mm
31 to 50 Sheets 3 mm
Dimensions (W x D x H)

396 x 551 x 276 mm (15.6 x 21.7 x 10.9 in.)

Weight

12 kg (26.4 lb)

Bridge Unit (D386)


Standard sizes
A6 SEF to A3, HLT to DLT
Paper Size:

Non-standard sizes
Width: 90 to 305 mm
Length: 148 to 600 mm

28

Paper Weight:

52 g/m2 to 256 g/m2, 16 lb. to 68 lb.

Paper Capacity:

125 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb.): B4 or larger


250 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb.): A4 or smaller

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (form the copier/printer)

Dimensions (W x D x H):

415 mm x 412 mm x 111 mm (16.3" x 16.2" x 4.4")

Weight

5 kg (11 lb.)

Optional Equipment

Shift Tray (D388)


Paper Capacity:

250 sheet (A4/ 81/2" x 111/2" or smaller: 80g/m2/ 20 lbs)


125 sheet (B4 81/2" x 111/2" or larger: 80g/m2/ 20 lbs)

Standard sizes
A6 SEF to A3, HLT to DLT
Paper Size:

Non-standard sizes
Width: 90 to 305 mm
Length: 148 to 600 mm

Paper Weight:

52-256 g/m2/ 14 - 68 lbs

Power Consumption:

Max 10W (Power is supplied from the mainframe.)

Dimension (W x D x H):

423 mm x 468 mm x 114 mm (16.7" x 18.4" x 4.5")

Weight:

Approx. 2kg (4.4lbs)

1-bin Tray Unit (D536)


Paper Size:

Standard Size:
A3 /DLT to A5/ HLT SEF

Paper Weight:

60 to 169 g/m2, 16 to 45 lb.

Tray Capacity:

125 sheets (80 g/m2, 20 lb., A4)

Power Source:

DC 24 V, 5 V (from the copier)

Power Consumption:

Less than 1 W

Weight:

1.7 kg

Size (W x D x H):

565 mm x 410 mm x 115 mm (22.2" x 16.1" x 4.5")

29

1. Appendix: Specifications

30

2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance


Tables
Maintenance Tables

Preventive Maintenance Items


Chart: A4 (LT)/5%
Mode: 3 copies / original (prints/job)
Ratio 30%
Environment: Normal temperature and humidity
Yield may change depending on circumstances and print conditions.
Symbol keys: C: Clean, R: Replace, L: Lubricant, I: Inspect

Mainframe
Item

150K

200K

300K

450K

EM

Remarks

Scanner
Reflector

Optics cloth

1st/2nd/3rd mirrors

Optics cloth

Front and Rear Rails

Dry cloth

Exposure Glass

Dry cloth; alcohol

ADF Exposure Glass

Dry cloth; alcohol

APS Sensor

Dry cloth

PCDU
Dev. UnitK

R: 600K

Dev. Unit C, M, Y
Drum Unit-K,
Drum Unit-C, M, Y

R
R
R

31

2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables

Item

150K

200K

Developer-K

300K

EM

Remarks

Developer-C, M, Y

450K

Transfer
Image Transfer Beltcleaning Unit

Image Transfer Belt Unit

R: 600K

Paper Transfer Roller Unit


Toner Collection Bottle

R
R:
150K

Fusing
Heating Roller
-Bearing
Pressure Roller
-Bearing

R
R/L

S552R

R
R/L

Entrance guide plate

Exit guide plate

Exit separate plate

Thermopile

S552R

Cotton swab with


alcohol

Paper Path

32

Registration Roller

Damp cloth

Registration Sensor

Dry cloth

Vertical Transport Roller

Damp cloth

Vertical Transport Sensor

Dry cloth

Paper Feed Sensor

Dry cloth

Pick-up Belt

Dry cloth

Maintenance Tables

Item

150K

200K

300K

450K

EM

Remarks

Feed Roller

Dry cloth

Separation Roller

Dry cloth

Fusing Entrance Sensor

Dry cloth

Fusing Exit Sensor

Dry cloth

Paper Dust Container

Duplex Unit
Inverter Roller

Damp cloth

Transport Roller

Damp cloth

Duplex Entrance Sensor

Dry cloth

Duplex Exit Sensor

Dry cloth

Miscellaneous
Ozone Filter

Exhaust Filter

Dust Glass

ID Sensor

Blower Brush

*1: Clean this thermistor only when it gets paper dust.

ARDF (D541)
Item

120K

EM

Remarks

Sensors

Blower brush

Platen Sheet Cover

Damp cloth; alcohol (Replace if


required.)

White Plate

Dry or damp cloth

Drive Gear

Grease G501

Transport Roller

Damp cloth; alcohol

33

2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables

Item

120K

EM

Remarks

Exit Roller

Damp cloth; alcohol

Inverter Roller

Damp cloth; alcohol

Idle Rollers

Damp cloth; alcohol

Two-tray Paper Feed Unit (D537)


Item

EM

Remarks

Feed Roller

Dry cloth

Separation Roller

Dry cloth

Pick-up Belt

Dry cloth

Paper Feed Sensor

Dry cloth

Relay Sensor

Dry cloth

Relay Roller

Damp cloth

Bottom Plate Pad

Damp cloth

1200-sheet LCT (D539)


Item

34

EM

Remarks

Feed Roller

Dry cloth

Separation Roller

Dry cloth

Pick-up Roller

Dry cloth

Paper Feed Sensor

Dry cloth

Relay Sensor

Dry cloth

Relay Roller

Damp cloth

Bottom Plate Pad

Damp cloth

Maintenance Tables

2000-sheet LCT (D538)


Item

EM

Remarks

Feed Roller

Dry cloth

Separation Roller

Dry cloth

Pick-up Belt

Dry cloth

Paper Feed Sensor

Dry cloth

Relay Sensor

Dry cloth

Relay Roller

Damp cloth

Bottom Plate Pad

Damp cloth

1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher (B793)


Items

EM

Remarks

Rollers

Damp cloth

Discharge Brush

Dry cloth

Sensors

Blower brush

1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher Punch Kit (B807)


Items
Punch Chads

EM
C

Remarks
Discard chads.

1000-Sheet Finisher (B408)


Items

EM

Remarks

Rollers

Damp cloth

Discharge Brush

Dry cloth

Sensors

Blower brush

35

2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables

1 Bin Tray (D536)


Items

EM

Remarks

Rollers

Damp cloth

Tray

Damp cloth

Sensor

Blower brush

Bearing

S552R

Bridge Unit (D386)


Items
Rollers

EM
C

Remarks
Damp cloth

Shift Tray (D388)


Items
Tray

EM
C

Remarks
Damp cloth

One-tray Paper Feed Unit (D387)


Item

36

EM

Remarks

Feed Roller

Dry cloth

Separation Roller

Dry cloth

Pick-up Roller

Dry cloth

Paper Feed Sensor

Dry cloth

Relay Sensor

Dry cloth

Relay Roller

Damp cloth

Bottom Plate Pad

Damp cloth

Maintenance Tables

Side Tray (D542)


Items

EM

Remarks

Rollers

Damp cloth

Sensors

Blower brush

Others Yield Parts


The parts mentioned in these tables have a target yield. However, the total copy/print volume made by
the machine will not reach the target yield within the machines targeted lifetime if the machine is used
under the target usage conditions (ACV, color ratio, P/J, and C/O). So, these parts are categorized not
as PM parts but as yield parts (EM parts).

Mainframe
Item

120K

240K

Dev. UnitC, M, Y

480K

600K

Remarks

Developer- C, M, Y

ITB Unit

ARDF
Item

80K

120K

240K

Remarks

Pick-up Roller

Number of originals

Feed Belt

Number of originals

Separation Roller

Number of originals

37

2. Appendix: Preventive Maintenance Tables

38

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables


System SP1-xxx
SP1-XXX (Feed)
[Leading Edge Registration] Leading Edge Registration Adjustment
1001

(Tray Location, Paper Type, Color Mode), Paper Type -> Plain, Thick 1or Thick 2

Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration motor operation timing
for each mode.
002 Tray: Plain

*ENG

003 Tray: Middle Thick

*ENG

004 Tray: Thick 1

*ENG

005 Tray: Thick 2

*ENG

007 By-pass: Plain

*ENG

008 By-pass: Middle Thick

*ENG

009 By-pass: Thick 1

*ENG

010 By-pass: Thick 2

*ENG

011 By-pass: Thick 3

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

39

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

013 Duplex: Plain

*ENG

014 Duplex: Middle Thick

*ENG

015 Duplex: Thick 1

*ENG

016 Tray: Thick 3

*ENG

017 Tray: Plain:1200

*ENG

018 Tray: Middle Thick:1200

*ENG

019 Tray: Thick 1:1200

*ENG

020 By-pass: Plain:1200

*ENG

021 By-pass: Middle Thick:1200

*ENG

022 By-pass: Thick 1:1200

*ENG

023 Duplex: Plain:1200

*ENG

024 Duplex: Middle Thick:1200

*ENG

025 Duplex: Thick 1:1200

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

[Side to Side Reg.] Side-to-Side Registration Adjustment


1002

40

Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each
mode.
001 By-pass Table

*ENG

002 Paper Tray 1

*ENG

003 Paper Tray 2

*ENG

004 Paper Tray 3

*ENG

005 Paper Tray 4

*ENG

006 Duplex

*ENG

007 Paper Tray 5

*ENG

008 Large Capacity Tray

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 mm/step]

System SP1-xxx

[Paper Buckle] Paper Buckle Adjustment


1003

(Tray Location, Paper Type), Paper Type: N: Normal, TH: Thick


Adjusts the amount of paper buckle at the registration roller by changing the paper feed
timing.

1007

002 Paper Tray1: Plain

*ENG

[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

003 Tray1: Middle Thick

*ENG

[9 to 5 / -1 / 1 mm/step]

004 Paper Tray1: Thick1

*ENG

007 Paper Tray2/3/4/5/LCT: Plain

*ENG

[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

008 Tray 2/3/4/5/LCT: Middle Thick *ENG

[9 to 5 / -1 / 1 mm/step]

009 Paper Tray2/3/4/5/LCT: Thick 1 *ENG

[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

012 By-pass: Plain

*ENG

013 By-pass: Middle Thick

*ENG

014 By-pass: Thick 1

*ENG

018 Duplex: Plain

*ENG

019 Duplex: Middle Thick

*ENG

020 Duplex: Thick 1

*ENG

021 Paper Tray1: Plain: 1200

*ENG

022 Tray1: Middle Thick: 1200

*ENG

023 Tray 2/3/4/5LCT: Plain: 1200

*ENG

024 Tray 2/3/4/5LCT: Mid: 1200

*ENG

025 By-pass: Plain: 1200

*ENG

026 By-pass: Middle Thick: 1200

*ENG

030 Duplex: Plain: 1200

*ENG

031 Duplex: Middle Thick: 1200

*ENG

[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]

[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[By-Pass Size Detection] By-Pass Size Detection Display

41

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

LG

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

001 Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection function of the by-pass tray.
This SP determines what paper size the machine detects if the detected size is less than 8.5".
0: OFF (Letter/SEF), 1: ON (Legal/SEF)

1101

001

002

003

[Reload Permit Setting]


Specifies the settings of the reload permit for cold temperature in color mode.
Pre-rotation Start Temp.

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pre-rotation start temperature.


Reload Target Temp.:Center

*ENG

[120 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the reload target temperature of the heating roller.


Reload Target Temp.:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the reload target temperature of the pressure roller.


Temp.:Delta:Cold:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

004 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) when the fusing unit is
determined as cold state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

005 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) when the fusing unit is
determined as cold state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]

006 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller when the fusing unit is determined
as cold state.
Time:Cold

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

007 Specifies the threshold time for the fusiing reload when the fusing unit is determined as cold
state.
Temp.:Delta:Warm:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

008 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) when the fusing unit is
determined as warm state.

42

System SP1-xxx

Temp.:Delta:Warm:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

009 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) when the fusing unit is
determined as warm state.
Temp.:Delta:Warm:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]

010 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller when the fusing unit is determined
as warm state.
Time:Warm

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

011 Specifies the threshold time for the fusing reload when the fusing unit is determined as warm
state.
Temp.:Delta:Hot:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

012 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) when the fusing unit is
determined as hot state.
Temp.:Delta:Hot:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

013 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) when the fusing unit is
determined as hot state.
Temp.:Delta:Hot:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]

014 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller when the fusing unit is determined
as hot state.
Time:Hot

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

015 Specifies the threshold time for the fusing reload when the fusing unit is determined as hot
state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

016 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as cold state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

017 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as cold state.
Temp.Delta:Cold:BW:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 70 / 1 deg/step]

018 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller in the black and white mode when
the fusing unit is determined as cold state.
43

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Time:Cold:BW

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

019 Specifies the threshold time for the fusing reload in black and white mode when the fusing
unit is determined as cold state.

020

Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW2:Cent
er

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as warm state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW2:End

*ENG

[40 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

021 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as warm state.
Temp.Delta:Cold:BW2:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

022 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller in the black and white mode when
the fusing unit is determined as warm state.
Time:Cold:BW2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

023 Specifies the threshold time for the fusing reload in black and white mode when the fusing
unit is determined as warm state.

1102

[Feed Permit Setting]


Specified the settings of the paper feeding timing.
Temp.:Lower Delta:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

001 Specifies the subtractive temperature of the heating roller (center) for the paper feed
permission.
002

Temp.:Lower Delta:End

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the subtractive temperature of the heating roller (end) for the paper feed permission.
Temp.:Upper Delta:Center

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

003 Specifies the additional temperature of the heating roller (center) for the paper feed
permission.
004

44

Temp.:Upper Delta:End

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the additional temperature of the heating roller (end) for the paper feed permission.

System SP1-xxx

005

006

007

Temp.:Lower Delta:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the subtractive temperature of the pressure roller for the paper feed permission.
Rotation Time

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the threshold time of the pre-rotation for the paper feed permission.
Temp.:Lower
Delta:Center:Sp.1

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

010 Temp.:Upper Delta:End:Sp.1

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

011 Temp.:Lower Delta:Press:Sp.1

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]

012 Rotation Time:Sp.1

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

016 Temp.:Upper Delta:End:Sp.2

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

017 Temp.:Lower Delta:Press:Sp.2

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 deg/step]

018 Rotation Time:Sp2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

019 Feed Permit Time

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 120 / 1 sec/step]

008 Temp.:Lower Delta:End:Sp.1


009

013

Temp.:Upper
Delta:Center:Sp.1

Temp.:Lower
Delta:Center:Sp.2

014 Temp.:Lower Delta:End:Sp.2


015

1105

Temp.:Upper
Delta:Center:Sp.2

[Print Target Temp]


(Printing Mode, Roller Type, [Color], Simplex/Duplex)
Roller Type > Center and Ends: Heating roller, Pressure > Pressure roller
Paper Type -> Plain, Thin, Thick, OHP, Middle Thick, Special

001

Plain1:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.

45

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

002

003

004

3
005

006

007

008

46

Plain1:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing..
Plain1:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain1:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain2:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Plain2:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full coloe printing.
Plain2:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain2:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.

009 Thin:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

010 Thin:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

011 Thin:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

012 Thin:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

013 M-thick:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

014 M-thick:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

015 M-thick:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

016 M-thick:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

017 Thick1:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

018 Thick1:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

019 Thick1:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

020 Thick1:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

System SP1-xxx

021 Thick2:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

022 Thick2:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

023 Thick2:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

024 Thick2:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

025 Thick3:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 170 / 1 deg/step]

026 Thick3:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

027 Thick3:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

028 Thick3:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

029 Special1:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

030 Special1:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

031 Special1:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

032 Special1:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

033 Special2:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

034 Special2:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

035 Special2:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

036 Special2:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

037 Special3:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

038 Special3:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

039 Special3:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 155 / 1 deg/step]

040 Special3:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

041 Envelop:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 180 / 1 deg/step]

042 Envelop:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

101 Plain1:FC:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

102 Plain1:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

103

Plain1:BW:Center:Low
Speed

47

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

104 Plain1:BW:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

105 Plain2:FC:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

106 Plain2:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Plain2:BW:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

108 Plain2:BW:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

M-thick:FC:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

110 M-thick:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

112 M-thick:BW:Press:Low Speed *ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

113 Thick1:FC:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

114 Thick1:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Thick1:BW:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

116 Thick1:BW:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

107

109

111

115

48

M-thick:BW:Center:Low
Speed

117

Special1:FC:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

118

Special1:FC:Press:Low
Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

119

Special1:BW:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 130 / 1 deg/step]

120

Special1:BW:Press:Low
Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

121

Special2:FC:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

122

Special2:FC:Press:Low
Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

System SP1-xxx

123

Special2:BW:Center:Low
Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

124

Special2:BW:Press:Low
Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

125 Plain1:Glossy:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 140 / 1 deg/step]

126 Plain1:Glossy:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

127 Plain2:Glossy:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 145 / 1 deg/step]

128 Plain2:Glossy:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

129 M-thick:Glossy:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

130 M-thick:Glossy:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

131 OHP:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

132 OHP:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

133 Envelop:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 170 / 1 deg/step]

134 Envelop:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

135 Thin:FC:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 135 / 1 deg/step]

136 Thin:FC:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

137 Thin:BW:Center:Low Speed

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 130 / 1 deg/step]

138 Thin:BW:Press:Low Speed

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

139 Thick4:FC:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 175 / 1 deg/step]

140 Thick4:FC:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

141 Thick4:BW:Center

*ENG

[120 to 200 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

142 Thick4:BW:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

001 Center

[-10 to 250 / - / 1 deg/step]

002 End

Displays the temperature of the heating roller.

1106

[Fusing Temp. Display]

49

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003 Pressure

[-10 to 250 / - / 1 deg/step]

004 Pressure End

Displays the temperature of the heating roller.

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 15 / 1 sec/step]

1107

[Standby Target Temp. Setting]


Standby Heater Off Time

001 Specifies the time that the fusing heater turns off after the fusing unit temperature has reached
its target temperature.
002

004

006

007

008

1108
001

002

1111

Stanby/Preheat1: Press

*ENG

[0 to 125 / 90 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the ready or energy save 1 mode.
Preheat2:Press

*ENG

[0 to 125 / 90 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the energy save 2 mode.
Low Power:Press

*ENG

[0 to 125 / 60 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the low power mode.
Print Ready:Center

*ENG

[120 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the heating roller for the print ready condition.
Print Ready:Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the print ready condition.
[After Reload/Job Target Temp.]
Center

*ENG

[120 to 180 / 150 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the heating roller after re-load or job.


Press

*ENG

[100 to 200 / 120 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller after re-load or job.


[Environment Correction:Fusing]
Temp.: Threshold: Low

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 17 / 1 deg/step]

001 Specifies the threshold temperature for low temperature. If the fusing temperature is 17C
or less, the machine executes the fusing mode for low temperature.

50

System SP1-xxx

Temp.: Threshold: High

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 deg/step]

002 Sepcifies the threshold temperature for high temperature. If the fusing temperature is 30C
or more, the machine executes the fusing mode for high temperature.
Low Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

003 Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature. If the fusing temperature is
in low temperature condition, this temperature is added to the taraget temperature.
High Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

004 Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature. If the fusing temperature is
in high temperature condition, this temperature is added to the taraget temperature.
005 Job Low Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.1 deg/step]

006 Job High Temp. Correction

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

007 Job Low Temp. Correction:Sp. *ENG


008

1112

Job High Temp.


Correction:Sp.

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 0.1 deg/step]


[0 to 100 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

[Repeat Temperature Correction]


Control Time 1

*ENG

[0 to 300 / 100 / 1 sec/step]

001 Specifies the threshold time for entering the repeat temperature correction mode after the first
sheet of paper has reached to the registration roller.
Control Time 2

*ENG

[0 to 300 / 300 / 1 sec/step]

002 Specifies the threshold time for entering the repeat temperature correction mode after the
control time 1 (specified with SP1112-001) has elapsed.
Temp.:Plain:Center:1

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

003 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for plain paper when the operation
time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1 and control time 2.
Temp.:Plain:Press:1

*ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

004 Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for plain paper when the operation
time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1 and control time 2.

51

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Temp.:Plain:Center:2

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / -5 / 0.1 deg/step]

005 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for plain paper when the operation
time of the machine is more than control time 2.
Temp.:Plain:Press:2

*ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

006 Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for plain paper when the operation
time of the machine is more than control time 2.

Temp.:M-thick:Center:1

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / -5 / 0.1 deg/step]

007 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for middle thick paper when the
operation time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1 and control time 2.
Temp.:M-thick:Press:1

*ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

008 Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for middle thick paper when the
operation time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1 and control time 2.
Temp.:M-thick:Center:2

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / -5 / 0.1 deg/step]

009 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for middle thick paper when the
operation time of the machine is more than control time 2.
Temp.:M-thick:Press:2

*ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

010 Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for middle thick paper when the
operation time of the machine is more than control time 2.
Temp.:Others:Center:1

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

011 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for paper type other than plain and
middle thick paper when the operation time of the machine is in the interval between control
time 1 and control time 2.
Temp.:Others:Press:1

*ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for other than palin and middle
012 thick paper when the operation time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1
and control time 2.
[Image Processing Temp. Correct]
Temp.:Plain:Center: Level1

*ENG

[-20 to 20 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

013 Specifies the correction temperature for the level 1 of the job image control in black and
white printing mode.

52

System SP1-xxx

Temp.:Plain:Center: Level2

*ENG

[-20 to 20 / 0 / 0.1 deg/step]

014 Specifies the correction temperature for the level 2 of the job image control in black and
white printing mode.
1113

[Curl Correction]
Execute Pattern

001

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On (No Decurl), 2: On

Selects the curl correction type.

0: The curl correction is not done.


1: The curl correction is done only when paper is fed to the 1 bin tray.
2: The curl correction is always done.

002

003

Humidity:Threshold:M-humid

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 1 / 1 %/step]

Specifies the threshold between low and middle humidity.


Humidity:Threshold:H-humid

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]

Specifies the threshold between middle and high humidity.

Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:M*ENG
004 humid

[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in middle humidity.
Permit
005 humid

Temp.:Delta:Press:H-

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 50 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in high humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:M*ENG
006 humid:No Decurl

[0 to 200 / 50 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for the no curl control in middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:H*ENG
007 humid:No Decurl

[0 to 200 / 40 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature for the no curl control in high humidity.

53

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

CPM:M-humid

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %/step]

008 Specifies the CPM ratio of the decurl control against to the normal operation in middle
humidity.
009

CPM:H-humid

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]

Specifies the CPM ratio of the decurl control against to the normal operation in high humidity.
CPM:M-humid:No Decurl

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %/step]

010 Specifies the CPM ratio against of the no decurl control to the normal operation in middle
humidity.
CPM:H-humid:No Decurl

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]

011 Specifies the CPM ratio against of the no decurl control to the normal operation in high
humidity.
1114
001

[Heat Storage Status]


Temp.:Threshold:Press

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 80 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature of the pressure roller for the heat storage status.

Temp.:Threshold:Atmospher
002 e

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the threshold temperature inside the machine for the heat storage feedback control.
1115
001

1116

001

[Target Temp. Correction]


Temp.:Delta:End

*ENG

[-100 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the different temperature between end and center of the heating roller.
[Heat Storage FB Control]
Execution mode

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: OFF, 1: ON (BW), 2: ON (BW/FC)

Selects the heat storage FB control mode.


011

54

Time Out

*ENG

[0 to 500 / 5 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the no-entry time for the heat strorage FB control after the LD units have fired.

System SP1-xxx

021 Delay:Standard Speed:FC:1 *ENG

[0 to 20,000 / 3500 / 1 msec/step]

Delay:Standard Speed:BW:
*ENG
1

[0 to 20,000 / 1400 / 1 msec/step]

031 Delay:Standard Speed:FC:2 *ENG

[0 to 20,000 / 3500 / 1 msec/step]

Delay:Standard Speed:BW:
*ENG
2

[0 to 20,000 / 1400 / 1 msec/step]

Press Reference Temp.

[0 to 200 / 80 / 1 deg/step]

022

032

041

042

043

*ENG

Specifies the standard temperature for the pressure roller during the heat storage FB control.
Temp. Correction Lower Limit *ENG

[-30 to 0 / -2 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the lower llimit temperature for the heat storage FB control.
Temp. Correction Upper Limit *ENG

[0 to 30 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the upper llimit temperature for the heat storage FB control.

Paper Thickness
051 Coefficient:Plain1

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 /step]

Specifies the additional temperatreu to the heat strage FB control for plain paper 1.
Paper Thickness
052 Coefficient:Plain2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 /step]

Specifies the additional temperatreu to the heat strage FB control for plain paper 2.
1121

[Switch:Rotation Start/Stop]
Time:After Reload

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 sec/step]

001 Specifies the ON time of the pressure roler lamp after the fusing temperature has reached
the reload temperature.
Time:After Recovery

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 15 / 1 sec/step]

002 Specifies the ON time of the pressure roler lamp after the fusing temperature has reached
the target temperature.
003

Time:After Job

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the ON time of the pressure roler lamp after the paper feeding has finished.

55

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Press Temp.:After Reload

*ENG

[0 to 160 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

004 Specifies the target temperature of the pressure roller center area after the fusing temperature
has reached the reload temperature.
End Uniform Start Temp.:B4

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 200 / 1 deg/step]

005 Specifies the target temperature of the pressure roller end arear after the B4 paper feeding
has finished.

End Uniform Start Temp.:A4

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 185 / 1 deg/step]

006 Specifies the target temperature of the pressure roller end arear after the A4 paper feeding
has finished.
End Uniform Start Temp.:A5

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 170 / 1 deg/step]

007 Specifies the target temperature of the pressure roller end arear after the A5 paper feeding
has finished.
008

009

1122
001

002

1124

Overshoot Prevent Temp.

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 220 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the temperature of the heating roller for the overshoot prevention.
Overshoot Prevent Time

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the interval of the fusing unit rotation for the overshoot prevention.
[Standby Rotation Setting] DFU
Rotation Interval

*ENG

[0 to 240 / 60 / 1 min/step]

Specifies the rotation interval of the fusing unit in the stand-by mode.
Rotation Time

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 0.7 / 0.1 sec/step]

Specifies the rotation time of the fusing unit in the stand-by mode.
[CPM Down Setting]
Specifies the settings for the CPM down mode.
Low:Down Temp.

*ENG

[-50 to 0 / -20 / 1 deg/step]

001 Specifies the CPM down threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature decreases -20C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM down mode.

56

System SP1-xxx

Low:Up Temp.

*ENG

[-50 to 0 / -15 / 1 deg/step]

002 Specifies the CPM up threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature increases -15C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM up mode.
003

004

005

006

007

008

Low :1st CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 80 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
Low :2nd CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 65 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 2nd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
Low :3rd CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 50 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
High :1st CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 75 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
High:2nd CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 50 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
High:3rd CPM

*ENG

[10 to 100 / 25 / 5 %/step]

Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.

High:1st CPM Down


009 Temp.:A3

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 230 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A3 paper size.
High:2nd CPM Down
010 Temp.:A3

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 233 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A3 paper size.
High:3rd CPM Down
011 Temp.:A3

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 235 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A3 paper size.
High:1st CPM Down
012 Temp.:A4

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 180 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A4 paper size.

57

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

High:2nd CPM Down


013 Temp.:A4

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 183 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A4 paper size.
High:3rd CPM Down
014 Temp.:A4

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 185 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A4 paper size.

High:1st CPM Down


015 Temp.:B5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 175 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of B5 paper size.
High:2nd CPM Down
016 Temp.:B5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 180 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of B5 paper size.
High:3rd CPM Down
017 Temp.:B5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 185 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of B5 paper size.
High:1st CPM Down
018 Temp.:A5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 180 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A5 paper size.
High:2nd CPM Down
019 Temp.:A5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 185 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A5 paper size.
High:3rd CPM Down
020 Temp.:A5:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 190 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A5 paper size.
High:1st CPM Down
021 Temp.:A6:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 160 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A6 paper size.
High:2nd CPM Down
022 Temp.:A6:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 165 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A6 paper size.
58

System SP1-xxx

High:3rd CPM Down


023 Temp.:A6:Press

*ENG

[100 to 250 / 170 / 1 deg/step]

Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A6 paper size.
024

1131

Judging Interval

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 5 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the interval for CPM down judgement.


[Continues Print Mode Switch]
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]

001

Feed Permit Condition

*ENG

0: Productivity priority
1: Fusing quality priority 1
2: Fusing quality priority 2

Selects the paper feed permission type.


1132

[Maximum Duty Switch]

001 Control Method Switch

1141

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Fixed Duty, 1: Power Control

[Fusing SC Issue Time Info]

001 SC Number

*ENG

Displays the issued SC number.

002 SC Cause

*ENG

[0 to 9 / - / 1/step]

101 Htg Roller:Ctr Diff1

*ENG

102 Htg Rolloer:Ctr Det1

*ENG

103 Htg Roller:Ctr Corr1

*ENG

104 Htg Roller:End Diff1

*ENG

105 Htg Roller:End Det1

*ENG

106 Htg Roller:End Corr1

*ENG

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Displays the temperature at the center of
the heating roller when an SC was issued.
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Displays the temperature at the end of the
heating roller when an SC was issued.
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

107 Press Roller Temp Value1

*ENG

Displays the temperature at the pressure


roller when an SC was issued.

59

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

151 Htg Roller:Ctr Diff2

*ENG

152 Htg Rolloer:Ctr Det2

*ENG

153 Htg Roller:Ctr Corr2

*ENG

154 Htg Roller:End Diff2

*ENG

155 Htg Roller:End Det2

*ENG

156 Htg Roller:End Corr2

*ENG

157 Press Roller Temp Value2

*ENG

201 Htg Roller:Ctr Diff3

*ENG

202 Htg Rolloer:Ctr Det3

*ENG

203 Htg Roller:Ctr Corr3

*ENG

204 Htg Roller:End Diff3

*ENG

205 Htg Roller:End Det3

*ENG

206 Htg Roller:End Corr3

*ENG

207 Press Roller Temp Value3

*ENG

1142

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]

[Fusing Jam Detection]


SC Display

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]

001 Enables or disables the fusing consecutive jam (three times) SC detection.
0: No detection, 1: Detection
1151

[Pressure Setting]
Pressure Change ON/OFF

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

001 Enables or disables the pressure switching control for the fusing unit.
0: OFF , 1: ON
002

60

Pressure Position1

*ENG

[0 to 10,000 / 420 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 1.

System SP1-xxx

003

004

Pressure Position2

*ENG

[0 to 10,000 / 660 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 2.
Pressure Position3

*ENG

[0 to 10,000 / 2130 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 3.
Depressure Position

*ENG

[0 to 10,000 / 220 / 10 msec/step]

005 Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the depression position (no
pressure).
Shift Time

*ENG

[0 to 3600 / 5 / 1 sec/step]

010 Specifies the timing for depressing the fusing unit. If the machine does not get any jobs for
specified time by this SP after copying or printing, the machine depresses the fusing unit.
101 Pressure:Plain1/2

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for each paper type in normal speed.
0: Depression position (no pressure)
1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)
102 Pressure:Thin

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

103 Pressure:M-thick

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

104 Pressure:Thick1

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

105 Pressure:Thick2

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

106 Pressure:Thick3

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

107 Pressure:Special1

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

108 Pressure:Special2

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

109 Pressure:Special3

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

110 Pressure:Envelope

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1 / 1 /step]

151 Pressure:Plain1/2:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

61

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for each paper type in low speed.
0: Depression position (no pressure)
1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)

152 Pressure:M-thick:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

153 Pressure:Thick1:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

154 Pressure:Special1:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

155 Pressure:Special2:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

156 Pressure:Plain1/2:Glossy

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

157 Pressure:M-thick:Glossy

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

158 Pressure:OHP

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

159 Pressure:Envelope:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1 / 1 /step]

160 Pressure:Thin:Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

Pressure:Thick4

Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for thick 4 paper.
161

0: Depression position (no pressure)


1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)

201

1152

Filler Edge Detection Counter

ENG

[0 to 9,000,000 / - / 1 /step]

Displays the detection time for the edge of the pressure roller actuator.
[Fusing Nip Band Check]

001 Execute

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]

Executes the nip band measurement between heating roller and pressure roller.
If the nip band width is not 8 mm, and fusing is not good, replace the pressure roller or install
a new fusing unit.

62

System SP1-xxx

002

003

004

1153

Pre-Idling Time

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 240 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the fusing rotation time before executing SP1109-001.


Stop Time

* ENG

[5 to 30 / 20 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the time for measuring the nip.


Pressure Position

* ENG

[1 to 3 / 3 / 1 ]

Specifies the pressure position for measuring the nip.

[Fuser Cleaning]

001 Compulsion execution


Operation interval

*ENG

Execute the fusing cleaning mode.


[1 to 300 / 0 / 1 K/step]

002 Adjusts the execution interval for the fusing cleaning mode.
1K= 100 sheets
003

004

1801

Control Temp.

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 180 / 1C/step]

Specifies the heating roller temperature for the fusing cleaning mode.
Page Count

*ENG

[1 to 300000 / - / 1 page/step]

Displays the page counter for the fusing cleaning mode.


[Motor Speed Adj.] FA

001 Registration:Plain:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

002 Registration:Plain:High

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

003 Registration:Middle Thick:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

004 Registration:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

005 Registration:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

006 Registration:Thick 1:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

007 Registration:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

008 Registration:Thick 2:Low

*ENG

009 Registration:Thick 3:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

63

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

64

010 Duplex CW:Plane:Low

*ENG

011 Duplex CW:Normal:High

*ENG

012 Duplex CW:Middle Thick:Low

*ENG

013 Duplex CW:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

014 Duplex CW:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

015 Duplex CW:Thick1:Low

*ENG

016 Duplex CW:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

017 Duplex CW:Thick2:Low

*ENG

018 Duplex CW:Thick3:Low

*ENG

019 Duplex CCW:Normal:High

*ENG

020 Duplex CCW:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

021 Duplex CCW:Middle Thick:high

*ENG

023 Duplex CCW:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

024 Reverse CW:Normal:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0.5 / 0.1%/step]

025 Reverse CW:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

026 Reverse CW:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0.5 / 0.1%/step]

028 Reverse CW:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

029 Reverse CCW:Normal:High

*ENG

030 Reverse CCW:Middle Thick:Mid

*ENG

031 Reverse CCW:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

033 Reverse CCW:Thick1:Mid

*ENG

034 Feed:Plain:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

035 Feed:Plain:High

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

036 Feed:Middle thick:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

037 Feed:Middle thick:Mid

*ENG

038 Feed:Middle thick:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

System SP1-xxx

039 Feed:Thick 1:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

040 Feed:Thick 1:Mid

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

041 Feed:Thick 2:Low

*ENG

042 Feed:Thick 3:Low

*ENG

043 Bridge Motor:Low

*ENG

044 Bridge Motor:Mid

*ENG

045 Bridge Motor:High

*ENG

060 KOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

061 KOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

062 KOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

063 MOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]

064 MOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]

065 MOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]

066 COpcDevMot:High

*ENG

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]

067 COpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]

068 COpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]

069 YOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]

070 YOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]

071 YOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]

072 Fusing: High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.9 / 0.01 %/step]

073 Fusing: Mid

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.4 / 0.01 %/step]

074 Fusing: Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.7 / 0.01 %/step]

075 TransferMot:High

*ENG

076 TransferMot:Mid

*ENG

077 TransferMot:Low

*ENG

078 TonerMot

*ENG

[2 to 2 / 1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.01 %/step]

[4 to 4 / 0.2 / 0.01 %/step]

[30 to 30 / 10 / 5 %/step]
65

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

079 Fusing Exit Motor: 1200

100

Drum Adjust

*ENG
*ENG

[4 to 4 / 2.1 / 0.01 %/step]


[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Off, 1: On

Enables or disables the drum amplitude adjustment.

101 MOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

102 COpcDevMot:High

*ENG

103 YOpcDevMot:High

*ENG

104 MOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

105 COpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

106 YOpcDevMot:Mid

*ENG

107 MOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

108 COpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

109 YOpcDevMot:Low

*ENG

110 MOpcDevMot:1200

*ENG

111 COpcDevMot:1200

*ENG

[7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]

[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]

[ 7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]

112 YOpcDevMot:1200

*ENG

120 Long:Registration:Plain:High

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

121 Long:Registration:Plain:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

122 Long:Registration:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

123

66

[7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]

Long:Registration:Middle
Thick:Middle

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -0.1 / 0.1 %/step]

124 Long:Registration:Middle Thick:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

125 Long:Registration:Thick 1:Middle

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1 / 0.1 %/step]

126 Long:Registration:Thick 1:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

127 Long:Registration:Thick 2:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

128 Long:Registration:Thick 3:Low

*ENG

[2 to 2 / -1.1 / 0.1 %/step]

System SP1-xxx

129 Long:Fusing:Plain:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.9 / 0.01 %/step]

130 Long:Fusing:Plain:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 2.1 / 0.01 %/step]

131 Long:Fusing:Middle Thick:High

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.9 / 0.01 %/step]

132 Long:Fusing:Middle Thick:Middle

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.4 / 0.01 %/step]

133 Long:Fusing:Middle Thick:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 2.1 / 0.01 %/step]

134 Long:Fusing:Thick 1:Middle

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 2.0 / 0.01 %/step]

135 Long:Fusing:Thick 1:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.7 / 0.01 %/step]

136 Long:Fusing:Thick 2:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.7 / 0.01 %/step]

137 Long:Fusing:Thick 3:Low

*ENG

[4 to 4 / 1.7 / 0.01 %/step]

1902

[Amplitude Control]

001 Execute

Execute drum phase adjustment.


[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
Displays the result of drum phase adjustment.

002 Result

*ENG

0: Successfully done
2: Sampling failure
3: Insufficient detection number
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

003 Auto Execution

*ENG

Turns the automatic drum phase adjustment on or


off.
0: Off, 1: On

1907

[Paper Feed Timing Adj.] DFU

002 Feed Solenoid ON: Plain

*ENG

[35 to 85 / 60 / 5 %/step]

67

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003 Feed Clutch OFF: Plain

*ENG

004 Feed Clutch ON: Plain

*ENG

005 Inverter Stop Position

*ENG

006 Reverse Stop Position

*ENG

007 Re-Feed Stop Position S Size

*ENG

008 By-pass Solenoid OFF

*ENG

[0 to 40 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

009 By-pass Solenoid Re-ON

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

010 By-pass Feed Clutch ON

*ENG

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

012 Feed Solenoid ON: Thick

*ENG

[10 to 40 / 0 / 2.5 mm/step]

013 Feed Clutch OFF: Thick

*ENG

014 Feed Clutch ON: Thick

*ENG

015 Re-Feed Stop Position

*ENG

1908

68

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[LCT Feed Timing Adj.] DFU

010 Bridge Junction Gate Sol-ON

*ENG

011 Bridge Junction Gate Sol-OFF

*ENG

012 1 Bin Junction Gate Sol-ON

*ENG

013 1 Bin Junction Gate Sol-OFF

*ENG

015 Junction Gate SOL1:ON:Plain

*ENG

016 Junction Gate SOL1:ON:Thick

*ENG

017 Junction Gate SOL1:OFF:Plain

*ENG

018 Junction Gate SOL1:OFF:Thick

*ENG

1950

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Fan Cooling Time Set]


Adjust the rotation time for each fan motor after a job end.

System SP1-xxx

002 Fusing Exit Fan

*ENG

006 Main Suction Fan

*ENG

007 Paper Exit Fan

*ENG

008 PSU Fan

*ENG

009 Fusing IH Coil Fan

*ENG

010 IH Power Supply Fan

*ENG

011 Second Duct Fan

*ENG

012 Third Duct Fan

*ENG

1951

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

[Fan Start Time Set]


Adjust the start time for each fan motor after a job end.

002 Fusing Exit Fan

*ENG

[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

006 Main Suction Fan

*ENG

[0 to 900 / 120 / 1 sec/step]

007 Paper Exit Fan

*ENG

[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

008 PSU Fan

*ENG

[0 to 900 / 120 / 1 sec/step]

009 Fusing IH Coil Fan

*ENG

010 IH Power Supply Fan

*ENG

011 Second Duct Fan

*ENG

012 Third Duct Fan

*ENG

1952

[Fan Control Off Mode Time Set]

001 1953

001

[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

*ENG

[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 min./step]

[Extra Fan Control]


Extra Fan Cooling State

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On

Displays the extra fan cooling is On or Off.

69

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Extra Fan Cooling: Time:


002 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 180 / C2.5a: 110, C2.5b: 100 / 1 min./


step]

Specifies the judgement time for entering the extra fan rotation mode.

003

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

Specifies the threshold rotation of the black development unit for entering the extra fan
rotation mode.

004 Extra Fan Cooling: Start Date

*ENG

Displays the execution time and date of the extra


fan cooling.

Extra Fan Cooling Time

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 30 / 0.1 min./step:

005

1954

70

Extra Fan Cooling: Rotat:


Threshold

Specifies the execution time for the extra fan cooling.


[Extra Fan Control]
Specifies the execution time of the extra fan rotaion mode for each fan motor.

002

Fan Cooling Time:Fusing Exit


Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

006

Fan Cooling Time:Main


Suction Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

007

Fan Cooling Time:Paper Exit


Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

008

Fan Cooling Time:PSU


Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

009

Fan Cooling Time:Fusing IH


Coil Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

010

Fan Cooling Time:IH Power


Supply Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

011

Fan Cooling Time:Second


Duct Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

012

Fan Cooling Time:Third Duct


Fan:Initial

*ENG

[0 to 120 / 0 / 0.1 min./step]

System SP2-xxx

System SP2-xxx
SP2-XXX (Drum)
[Charge DC Voltage] Charge Roller DC Voltage Adjustment
2005

(Paper Type, Process Speed, Color)


Paper Type > Plain, Thick 1, Thick 2
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&FINE: Low speed

Adjusts the DC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes.
Charge bias (DC component) is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore,
adjusting these settings does not effect while process control mode (SP3-041-1 Default: ON)
is activated. When deactivating process control mode with SP3-041-1, the values in these
SP modes are used for printing.
001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2&FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2&FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2&FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2&FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 690 / 10 V/step]

[Charge DC: Correction]


013 PCU:Plain

*ENG

[100 to 100 / -29 / 1 V/step]

014 PCU:Thick 1

*ENG

[100 to 100 / -28 / 1 V/step]

71

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

015 PCU:Thick 2&FINE

*ENG

[100 to 100 / -28 / 1 V/step]

016 HVP:Plain

*ENG

[100 to 100 / 20 / 1 V/step]

017 HVP:Thick 1

*ENG

[100 to 100 / 20 / 1 V/step]

018 HVP: Thick 2&FINE

*ENG

[100 to 100 / 29 / 1 V/step]

[Charge AC Voltage] Charge Roller AC Voltage Adjustment

(Paper Type, Process Speed, Color)


Paper Type > Plain, Thick 1, Thick 2
2006

Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&FINE: Low speed
Adjusts the AC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes.
Charge bias (AC component) is adjusted by environment correction (SP2-007-xxx to
SP2-011-xxx). These SPs are activated only when SP2-012-1 is set to "1: manual control".

72

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.9 / 0.01 KV/step]

002 Plain: M

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

003 Plain: C

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.9 / 0.01 KV/step]

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

009 Thick 2&FINE: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.9 / 0.01 KV/step]

010 Thick 2&FINE: M

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

011 Thick 2&FINE: C

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

012 Thick 2&FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 2.2 / 0.01 KV/step]

System SP2-xxx

[Charge AC Current: LL] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for LL


2007

(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for LL environment (Low temperature
and Low humidity). DFU

001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 0.68 / 0.01 mA/step]

[0 to 3 / 0.83/ 0.01 mA/step]

[Charge AC Current: ML] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MM


2008

(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for ML environment (Meddle
temperature and Low humidity). DFU

001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 0.7 / 0.01 mA/step]

[0 to 3 / 0.87 / 0.01 mA/step]

[Charge AC Current: MM] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MM


2009

(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for MM environment (Middle
temperature and Middle humidity). DFU

001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 0.73 / 0.01 mA/step]

[0 to 3 / 0.89 / 0.01 mA/step]

73

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Charge AC Current: MH] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for MH


2010

(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for MH environment (Middle
temperature and High humidity). DFU

001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 0.74 / 0.01 mA/step]

[0 to 3 / 0.89 / 0.01 mA/step]

[Charge AC Current: HH] Charge Roller AC Current Adjustment for HH


2011

(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for HH environment (High
temperature and High humidity). DFU

001 Environmental Target: Bk

*ENG

002 Environmental Target: M

*ENG

003 Environmental Target: C

*ENG

004 Environmental Target: Y

*ENG

2012

[0 to 3 / 0.74 / 0.01 mA/step]

[0 to 3 / 0.87 / 0.01 mA/step]

[Charge Output Control]


Selects the AC voltage control type.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 AC Voltage

*ENG

0: Process control
1: Manual control (AC voltages are decided
with SP2006.)

2013

74

[Environmental Correction: PCU]

System SP2-xxx

Displays the environmental condition, which is


measured in absolute humidity.
[1 to 5 / / 1 /step]
Current Environmental:
001
Display

*ENG

1: LL (LL <= 4.3 g/m3)


2: ML (4.3 < ML <= 11.3 g/m3)
3: MM (11.3 < MM <= 18.0 g/m3)
4: MH (18.0 < MH <= 24.0 g/m3)
5: HH (24.0 g/m3 < HH)

Selects the environmental condition manually.


[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 /step]
002 Forced Setting

*ENG

0: The environmental condition is determined


automatically.
1: LL, 2: ML, 3: MM, 4: MH, 5: HH

003

Absolute Humidity: Threshold


1

Absolute Humidity: Threshold


004
2

Absolute Humidity: Threshold


005
3

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold between LL and


ML.
[0 to 100 / 3.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold between ML


and MM.
[0 to 100 / 8.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold between MM


and MH.
[0 to 100 / 15.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

Absolute Humidity: Threshold


006
4

*ENG

007 Current Temp.: Display

*ENG

Changes the humidity threshold between MH


and HH.
[0 to 100 / 15.0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

008

Current Relative Humidity:


Display

*ENG

009

Current Absolute Humidity:


Display

*ENG

Displays the current temperature.


[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
Displays the current relative humidity.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1%RH/step]
Displays the absolute humidity.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

75

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

010

Previous Environmental:
Display

*ENG

Displays the previous environmental condition,


which is measured in absolute humidity.
[1 to 5 / / 1 /step]
1: LL, 2: ML, 3: MM, 4: MH, 5: HH

011 Previous Temp.: Display

012

Previous Relative Humidity:


Display

*ENG

013

Previous Absolute Humidity:


Display

*ENG

2014

Displays the previous temperature.


[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
Displays the previous relative humidity.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1%RH/step]
Displays the previous absolute humidity.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 0.01 g/m3/step]

[Charge AC Control: Setting] DFU


Specifies the charge AC control interval or thresholod for each condition.

001 Exec Interval: Power ON

*ENG

002 Exec Interval: Print

*ENG

003 Page Interval

*ENG

[0 to 500 / 10 / 5 page/step]

004 Temperature

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 99 / 1 deg/step]

005 Relative Humidity

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

006 Absolute Humidity

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 12 / 1 g/m3/step]

007 Temp Threshold M

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

008 RH Threshold M

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 25 / 1 %RH/step]

009 AH Threshold M

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]

010 Temp Threshold S

*ENG

[0 to 20 / 1 / 0.1 deg/step]

011 RH Threshold S

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 5 / 1 %RH/step]

012 AH Threshold S

*ENG

[0 to 20 / 1 / 0.1 g/m3/step]

013 Non-use Time

*ENG

[0 to 1440 / 360 / 10 min/step]

2015

76

*ENG

[Charge AC Control:Result]

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

System SP2-xxx

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Success
1: Out of tolerance range
2: Out of adjustable range
3: Adjustment incompleted

[Color Registration Correction] FA


2101

These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment and are adjusted
at the factory. However, you must input a value for SP2101-001 after replacing the laser
optics housing unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and
Adjustment" section. The value should be provided with the new laser optics housing unit.

001 Main Dot: Bk

*ENG

002 Main Dot: Ma

*ENG

003 Main Dot: Cy

*ENG

004 Main Dot: Ye

*ENG

005 Sub Line: Bk

*ENG

006 Sub Line: Ma

*ENG

007 Sub Line: Cy

*ENG

008 Sub Line: Ye

*ENG

2102

[512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

[Magnification Adjustment] DFU

77

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Main Mag.: High Speed: Bk

*ENG

002 Main Mag.: Medium Speed: Bk

*ENG

003 Main Mag.: Low Speed: Bk

*ENG

004 Main Mag.: High Speed: M

*ENG

005 Main Mag.: Medium Speed: M

*ENG

006 Main Mag.: Low Speed: M

*ENG

These are results of the main scan


length adjustment.

007 Main Mag.: High Speed: C

*ENG

[0 to 560 / 280 / 1 /step]

008 Main Mag.: Medium Speed: C

*ENG

009 Main Mag.: Low Speed: C

*ENG

010 Main Mag.: High Speed: Y

*ENG

011 Main Mag.: Medium Speed: Y

*ENG

012 Main Mag.: Low Speed: Y

*ENG

013 Offset: Mag Bk1-2

*ENG

014 Offset: Mag M1-2

*ENG

015 Offset: Mag C1-2

*ENG

016 Offset: Mag Y1-2

*ENG

2103

[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

[Erase Margin Adjustment] (Area, Paper Size)


Adjusts the erase margin by deleting image data at the margins.

78

001 Lead Edge Width

*ENG

002 Trail. Edge Width

*ENG

003 Left

*ENG

004 Right

*ENG

006 Duplex Trail. L Size

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]

007 Duplex Trail. M Size

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]

008 Duplex Trail. S Size

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]

[0 to 9.9 / 4.2 / 0.1 mm/step]

[0 to 9.9 / 2 / 0.1 mm/step]

System SP2-xxx

009 Duplex Left Edge

*ENG

010 Duplex Right Edge

*ENG

011 Duplex Trail. L Size:Thick

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1 mm/step]

012 Duplex Trail. M Size:Thick

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0.8 / 0.1 mm/step]

013 Duplex Trail. S Size:Thick

*ENG

[0 to 4 / 0.6 / 0.1 mm/step]

014 Duplex Left Edge:Thick

*ENG

015 Duplex Right Edge:Thick

*ENG

2105

[0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1 mm/step]

[0 to 1.5 / 0.3 / 0.1 mm/step]

[LD Power Adj.] (Process Speed, Color)


Adjusts the LD power of each color for each process speed.
Each LD power setting is decided by process control.

001 High Speed: Bk

*ENG

[50 to 120 / 100 / 1%/step]


Decreasing a value makes lines thinner on the
output.

002 High Speed: Ma

*ENG

003 High Speed: Cy

*ENG

004 High Speed: Ye

*ENG

Increasing a value makes lines thicker on the


output.

005 Middle Speed: Bk

*ENG

[50 to 120 / 100 / 1%/step]

006 Middle Speed: Ma

*ENG

007 Middle Speed: Cy

*ENG

Decreasing a value makes lines thinner on the


output.

008 Middle Speed: Ye

*ENG

Increasing a value makes lines thicker on the


output.

009 Low Speed: Bk

*ENG

[50 to 120 / 100 / 1%/step]

010 Low Speed: Ma

*ENG

011 Low Speed: Cy

*ENG

Decreasing a value makes lines thinner on the


output.

012 Low Speed: Ye

*ENG

2106

Increasing a value makes lines thicker on the


output.

[Polygon Rotation Time]


Adjusts the time of the polygon motor rotation. DFU

79

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Warming-Up

*ENG

002 Job End

*ENG

2107

[Image Parameter]
DFU

001 Image Gamma Flag

*ENG

002 Shading Correction Flag

*ENG

2109

[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 sec/step]

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]

[Test Pattern]
Generates the test pattern using "COPY Window" tab in the LCD.

003 Pattern Selection

[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]

0 None

11. Independent Pattern (1dot)

1: Vertical Line (1dot)

12. Independent Pattern (2dot)

2: Vertical Line (2dot)

13. Independent Pattern (4dot)

3: Horizontal (1dot)

14. Trimming Area

4: Horizontal (2dot)

16: Hounds Tooth Check (Horizontal)

5: Grid Vertical Line

17: Band (Horizontal)

6: Grid Horizontal Line

18: Band (Vertical)

7: Grid pattern Small

19: Checker Flag Pattern

8: Grid pattern Large

20: Grayscale Vertical Margin

9: Argyle Pattern Small

21: Grayscale Horizontal Margin

10: Argyle Pattern Large

23: Full Dot Pattern


Specifies the color for the test pattern.

005 Color Selection

[1 to 4 / 1 / 1/step]
1: All colors, 2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan

80

006 Density: Bk

007 Density: Ma

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

008 Density: Cy

0: Lightest density

009 Density: Ye

Specifies the color density for the test pattern.

15: Darkest density

System SP2-xxx

2111

[Forced Line Position Adj.]


Executes the fine line position adjustment twice.

001 Mode a

If this SP is not completed (NG is displayed), do


SP2111-003 first and then try this SP again.
Executes the fine line position adjustment once.

002 Mode b

If this SP is not completed, do SP2111-003 first and


then try this SP again.
Executes the rough line position adjustment once.

003 Mode c

2112

After doing this SP, make sure to execute


SP2111-001 or -002. Otherwise, the line position
adjustment is not perfectly done.

[TM/ID Sensor Check] ID Sensor Check FA


This SP is used to check the ID sensors at the factory.
The results of this SP are displayed in SP2140 to
SP2145.

001 Execute

[Skew Adjustment]
2117

Specifies a skew adjustment value for the skew motor M, C or Y.


These SPs must be used when a new laser optics housing unit is installed or when SC285
occurs. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and Adjustment"
section.

001 Pulse: M

*ENG

002 Pulse: C

*ENG

003 Pulse: Y

*ENG

2118

[100 to 100 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[Skew Adjustment]

001 Execute: M

*ENG

002 Execute: C

*ENG

003 Execute: Y

*ENG

Changes the current skew adjustment values to the


values specified with SP2117.
These SPs must be used when a new laser optics
housing unit is installed or when SC285 occurs. For
details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the
"Replacement and Adjustment" section.

81

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2119

[Skew Adjustment Display]


Displays the current skew adjustment value for each skew motor.

001 M

*ENG

002 C

*ENG

003 Y

*ENG

2120

[50 to 50 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[Thick Paper Skew Adj] Not used


Selects the skew adjustment for thick paper.

001 On/Off

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On

[ID Sensor Check Result] DFU


2140

Displays the results of the ID sensor check.


Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control
Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

005 Front

*ENG

006 Center

*ENG

007 Rear

*ENG

[0 to 1024 / 0 / 1/step]

[ID Sensor Check Result: Ave.] DFU


2141

Displays the average result values of the ID sensor check.


Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control
Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

82

System SP2-xxx

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

005 Front

*ENG

006 Center

*ENG

007 Rear

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[ID Sensor Check Result] DFU


2142

Displays the maximum result values of the ID sensor check.


Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control
Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

001 Maximum: Bk

*ENG

002 Maximum: M

*ENG

003 Maximum: C

*ENG

004 Maximum: Y

*ENG

005 Maximum: Front

*ENG

006 Maximum: Center

*ENG

007 Maximum: Rear

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[ID Sensor Check Result] DFU


2143

Displays the minimum result values of the ID sensor check.


Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control
Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

83

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Minimum: Bk

*ENG

002 Minimum: M

*ENG

003 Minimum: C

*ENG

004 Minimum: Y

*ENG

005 Minimum: Front

*ENG

006 Minimum: Center

*ENG

007 Minimum: Rear

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[ID Sensor Check Result] DFU


2144

Displays the maximum result 2 values of the ID sensor check.


Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control
Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

001 Maximum 2: Bk

*ENG

002 Maximum 2: M

*ENG

003 Maximum 2: C

*ENG

004 Maximum 2: Y

*ENG

005 Maximum 2: Front

*ENG

006 Maximum 2: Center

*ENG

007 Maximum 2: Rear

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[ID Sensor Check Result] DFU


2145

Displays the minimum result 2 values of the ID sensor check.


Bk, M, C, Y: ID sensors for the process control
Front, Center, Rear: ID sensors for the automatic line position adjustment

84

System SP2-xxx

001 Minimum 2: Bk

*ENG

002 Minimum 2: M

*ENG

003 Minimum 2: C

*ENG

004 Minimum 2: Y

*ENG

005 Minimum 2: Front

*ENG

006 Minimum 2: Center

*ENG

007 Minimum 2: Rear

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]

[Area Mag. Correction] LD Pulse Area Correction (Color, Area) FA

2150

Adjusts the magnification for each area. The main scan (297 mm) is divided into 8 areas.
Area 1 is at the front side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 8 is at the rear
side of the machine (right side of the image).
Decreasing a value makes the image shift to the left side on the print.
Increasing a value makes the image shift to the right side on the print.
1 pulse = 1/16 dot

027 Area 0: Bk

*ENG

[-256 to 255 / 0 / 1sub-dot/step]

028 Area 1: Bk

*ENG

029 Area 2: Bk

*ENG

030 Area 3: Bk

*ENG

031 Area 4: Bk

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0.

032 Area 5: Bk

*ENG

[256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step ]

033 Area 6: Bk

*ENG

034 Area 7: Bk

*ENG

035 Area 8: Bk

*ENG

036 Area 9: Bk

*ENG

037 Area 10: Bk

*ENG

038 Area 11: Bk

*ENG

039 Area 12: Bk

*ENG

Not used

85

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

86

079 Area 0: Ma

*ENG

Not used

080 Area 1: Ma

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0. [255to


255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

081 Area 2: Ma

*ENG

082 Area 3: Ma

*ENG

083 Area 4: Ma

*ENG

084 Area 5: Ma

*ENG

085 Area 6: Ma

*ENG

086 Area 7: Ma

*ENG

087 Area 8: Ma

*ENG

088 Area 9: Ma

*ENG

089 Area 10: Ma

*ENG

090 Area 11: Ma

*ENG

091 Area 12: Ma

*ENG

131 Area 0: Cy

*ENG

132 Area 1: Cy

*ENG

133 Area 2: Cy

*ENG

134 Area 3: Cy

*ENG

135 Area 4: Cy

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0.

136 Area 5: Cy

*ENG

[256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

137 Area 6: Cy

*ENG

138 Area 7: Cy

*ENG

139 Area 8: Cy

*ENG

[256to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

Not used

Not used

System SP2-xxx

140 Area 9: Cy

*ENG

141 Area 10: Cy

*ENG

142 Area 11: Cy

*ENG

143 Area 12: Cy

*ENG

183 Area 0: Ye

*ENG

184 Area 1: Ye

*ENG

185 Area 2: Ye

*ENG

186 Area 3: Ye

*ENG

187 Area 4: Ye

*ENG

Adjusts the area magnification for LD 0.

188 Area 5: Ye

*ENG

[256 to 255 / 0 / 1 sub-dot/step]

189 Area 6: Ye

*ENG

190 Area 7: Ye

*ENG

191 Area 8: Ye

*ENG

192 Area 9: Ye

*ENG

193 Area 10: Ye

*ENG

194 Area 11: Ye

*ENG

195 Area 12: Ye

*ENG

Not used

Not used

Not used

[Area Shad. Correct. Setting] FA


Adjusts the area correction value for each LD power.
2152

The main scan is divided into 16 areas. However, the image areas are limited from area 1
to area 14.
For BK and Magenta, area 1 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image) and
area 14 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image).
For Cyan and Yellow, area 1 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image) and
area 14 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image).

87

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

88

001 Area 0: Bk

*ENG

002 Area 1: Bk

*ENG

003 Area 2: Bk

*ENG

004 Area 3: Bk

*ENG

005 Area 4: Bk

*ENG

006 Area 5: Bk

*ENG

007 Area 6: Bk

*ENG

008 Area 7: Bk

*ENG

009 Area 8: Bk

*ENG

010 Area 9: Bk

*ENG

011 Area 10: Bk

*ENG

012 Area 11: Bk

*ENG

013 Area 12: Bk

*ENG

014 Area 13: Bk

*ENG

015 Area 14: Bk

*ENG

016 Area 15: Bk

*ENG

033 Area 0: M

*ENG

This is for the synchronizing detection board.


[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area.


[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
This is for the synchronizing detection board.

System SP2-xxx

034 Area 1: M

*ENG

035 Area 2: M

*ENG

036 Area 3: M

*ENG

037 Area 4: M

*ENG

038 Area 5: M

*ENG

039 Area 6: M

*ENG

040 Area 7: M

*ENG

041 Area 8: M

*ENG

042 Area 9: M

*ENG

043 Area 10: M

*ENG

044 Area 11: M

*ENG

045 Area 12: M

*ENG

046 Area 13: M

*ENG

047 Area 14: M

*ENG

048 Area 15: M

*ENG

065 Area 0: C

*ENG

3
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area.


[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
This is for the synchronizing detection board.
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

89

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

90

066 Area 1: C

*ENG

067 Area 2: C

*ENG

068 Area 3: C

*ENG

069 Area 4: C

*ENG

070 Area 5: C

*ENG

071 Area 6: C

*ENG

072 Area 7: C

*ENG

073 Area 8: C

*ENG

074 Area 9: C

*ENG

075 Area 10: C

*ENG

076 Area 11: C

*ENG

077 Area 12: C

*ENG

078 Area 13: C

*ENG

079 Area 14: C

*ENG

080 Area 15: C

*ENG

097 Area 0: Y

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area.


[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
This is for the synchronizing detection board.
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

System SP2-xxx

098 Area 1: Y

*ENG

099 Area 2: Y

*ENG

100 Area 3: Y

*ENG

101 Area 4: Y

*ENG

102 Area 5: Y

*ENG

103 Area 6: Y

*ENG

104 Area 7: Y

*ENG

105 Area 8: Y

*ENG

106 Area 9: Y

*ENG

107 Area 10: Y

*ENG

108 Area 11: Y

*ENG

109 Area 12: Y

*ENG

110 Area 13: Y

*ENG

111 Area 14: Y

*ENG

112 Area 15: Y

*ENG

2160

3
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]

This is out of the image area.

[Vertical Line Width] DFU


Adjusts the width of the vertical line.

001 600dpi:Bk

*ENG

002 600dpi:Ma

*ENG

003 600dpi:Cy

*ENG

004 600dpi:Ye

*ENG

005 1200dpi:Bk

*ENG

006 1200dpi:Ma

*ENG

007 1200dpi:Cy

*ENG

008 1200dpi:Ye

*ENG

[10 to 15 / 13 / 1 /step]

[10 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

91

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2180

001 Color Regist.

002 Main Scan Length Detection

003 MUSIC Result

004

[Line Position Adj. Setting Clear]

2181

Area Magnification
Correction

DFU

[Line Position Adj. Result]


Displays the values for each correction.
"Paper Int. Mag: Subdot" indicates the magnification correction value between two
sheets of paper.
"Mag.Cor. Subdot" indicates the magnification correction value.
"M. Scan Erro." indicates the shift correction value in the main scan direction.
"S. Scan Erro." Indicates the shift correction value in the sub scan direction.
"M. Cor.: Dot" indicates the dot correction value in the main scan direction.
"M. Cor.: Subdot" indicates the sub dot correction value in the main scan direction.
Bk: Black, M: Magenta, C: Cyan, Y: Yellow

92

001 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: Bk

*ENG

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

002 Mag.Cor. Subdot: Bk

*ENG

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

003 Skew: M

*ENG

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

005 M. Scan Erro.: Left: M

*ENG

006 M. Scan Erro.: Center: M

*ENG

007 M. Scan Erro.: Right: M

*ENG

008 S. Scan Erro.: Left: M

*ENG

009 S. Scan Erro.: Center: M

*ENG

010 S. Scan Erro.: Right: M

*ENG

011 M. Cor.: Dot: M

*ENG

[512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

012 M. Cor.: Subdot: M

*ENG

[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

System SP2-xxx

013 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: M

*ENG

014 Mag.Cor. Subdot: M

*ENG

015 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

016 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

017 S. Cor.: 600 Line: M

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

018 S. Cor.: 600 Sub: M

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

019 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: M

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

020 S. Cor.: 1200 Sub: M

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

021 Skew: C

*ENG

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

023 M. Scan Erro.: Left: C

*ENG

024 M. Scan Erro.: Center: C

*ENG

025 M. Scan Erro.: Right: C

*ENG

026 S. Scan Erro.: Left: C

*ENG

027 S. Scan Erro.: Center: C

*ENG

028 S. Scan Erro.: Right: C

*ENG

029 M. Cor.: Dot: C

*ENG

[512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

030 M. Cor.: Subdot: C

*ENG

[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

031 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: C

*ENG

032 Mag.Cor. Subdot: C

*ENG

033 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

034 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

035 S. Cor.: 600 Line: C

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

036 S. Cor.: 600 Sub: C

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

037 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: C

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

038 S. Cor.: 1200 Sub: C

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

93

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

039 Skew: Y

*ENG

041 M. Scan Erro.: Left: Y

*ENG

042 M. Scan Erro.: Center: Y

*ENG

043 M. Scan Erro.: Right: Y

*ENG

044 S. Scan Erro.: Left: Y

*ENG

045 S. Scan Erro.: Center: Y

*ENG

046 S. Scan Erro.: Right: Y

*ENG

047 M. Cor.: Dot: Y

*ENG

[512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

048 M. Cor.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

049 Paper Int. Mag: Subdot: Y

*ENG

050 Mag.Cor. Subdot: Y

*ENG

051 M. Left Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

052 M. Right Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

053 S. Cor.: 600 Line: Y

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

054 S. Cor.: 600 Sub: Y

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

055 S. Cor.: 1200 Line: Y

*ENG

[16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

056 S. Cor.: 1200 Sub: Y

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]

[5000 to 5000 / 0 / 0.001 um/step]

[32768 to 32767 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

[Line Position Adj. Offset]


2182

(Color) M. Scan: Main scan, S. Scan: Sub-scan


High: 154 mm/sec, Medium: 111 mm/sec, Low: 77 mm/sec

94

System SP2-xxx

001 M Magnification

*ENG

002 C Magnification

*ENG

003 Y Magnification

*ENG

Adjusts the line position manually.


[-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001%/step]
When line shifts are not corrected by the
automatic line position adjustment, do this
SP.
Increasing a value reduces the image in
the main scan direction.
Decreasing a value enlarges the image in
the main scan direction.

004 M. Scan: High: Dot: M

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

005 M. Scan: High: Subdot: M

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

006 M. Scan: Medium: Dot: M

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

007 M. Scan: Medium: Subdot: M

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

008 M. Scan: Low: Dot: M

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

009 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: M

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

010 M. Scan: High: Dot: C

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

011 M. Scan: High: Subdot: C

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

012 M. Scan: Medium: Dot: C

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

013 M. Scan: Medium: Subdot: C

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

014 M. Scan: Low: Dot: C

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

015 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: C

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

016 M. Scan: High: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

017 M. Scan: High: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

018 M. Scan: Medium: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

019 M. Scan: Medium: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

020 M. Scan: Low: Dot: Y

*ENG

[-512 to 511 / 0 / 1 dot/step]

021 M. Scan: Low: Subdot: Y

*ENG

[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]

022 S. Scan: High: Line: M

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

95

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

023 S. Scan: High: Subline: M

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

024 S. Scan: Medium: Line: M

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

025 S. Scan: Medium: Subline: M

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

026 S. Scan: Low: Line: M

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

027 S. Scan: Low: Subline: M

*ENG

Not used

028 S. Scan: High: Line: C

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

029 S. Scan: High: Subline: C

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

030 S. Scan: Medium: Line: C

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

031 S. Scan: Medium: Subline: C

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

032 S. Scan: Low: Line: C

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

033 S. Scan: Low: Subline: C

*ENG

Not used

034 S. Scan: High: Line: Y

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

035 S. Scan: High: Subline: Y

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

036 S. Scan: Medium: Line: Y

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

037 S. Scan: Medium: Subline: Y

*ENG

[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]

038 S. Scan: Low: Line: Y

*ENG

[-16384 to 16383 / 0 / 1 line/step]

039 S. Scan: Low: Subline: Y

*ENG

Not used

2183

96

[Main Scan Length Detection] DFU

System SP2-xxx

001 Execute: High: Bk

002 Execute: Medium: Bk

003 Execute: Low: Bk

004 Execute: High: M

005 Execute: Medium: M

006 Execute: Low: M

007 Execute: High: C

008 Execute: Medium: C

009 Execute: Low: C

010 Execute: High: Y

011 Execute: Medium: Y

012 Execute: Low: Y

2184

Executes the adjustment for the main scan length


detection manually.

[Main Scan Length Detection Target] DFU

001 Execute: Bk

002 Execute: M

003 Execute: C

004 Execute: Y

Executes the target value for the main scan length


detection.

[Main Scan Length Detection Disp.]

2185

Displays/adjusts the target value for the main scan magnification correction of the line
position adjustment.
After replacing the laser optics housing unit, input the standard value for Bk provided with
the new unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement Adjustment"
section. It is not necessary to input the values for the other colors; these are automatically
adjusted after doing the line position adjustment.

97

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

2186

[0 to 266667 / 249449 / 1 sub-dot/step]

[Main Scan Length Detection] DFU

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
001

Selection

*ENG

0: Mag. Correction OFF,


1: Mag. Correction ON

Enables or disables the main scan length detection for the laser.
002

2190

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 1 / 1 sec/step]

Adjusts the interval of the main scan length detection for the laser.
[Line Position Adj.] DFU

001 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: Bk

*ENG

002 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

003 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

004 Paper Int. Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

005 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

006 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

007 M. Scan Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

008 Area Mag.: Subdot: M

*ENG

009 Area Mag.: Subdot: C

*ENG

010 Area Mag.: Subdot: Y

*ENG

012 Detection Error Level

*ENG

2191

98

Paper Interval

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Disable correction,
1: Enable correction

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]

[-3500 to 3500 / 0 / 1 m/step]

[MUSIC Coefficient Setting] Line Position Adjustment: Coefficient Setting DFU


ch 0: ID sensor at rear, ch 1: ID sensor at center, ch 2: ID sensor at front

System SP2-xxx

001 ch 0: Filter: Front: a1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]

002 ch 0: Filter: Front: a2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 60488 / 1 bit/step]

003 ch 0: Filter: Front: b0

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

004 ch 0: Filter: Front: b1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]

005 ch 0: Filter: Front: b2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

006 ch 0: Filter: Rear: a1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]

007 ch 0: Filter: Rear: a2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 63398 / 1 bit/step]

008 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b0

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

009 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]

010 ch 0: Filter: Rear: b2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

011 ch 1: Filter: Front: a1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]

012 ch 1: Filter: Front: a2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 60488 / 1 bit/step]

013 ch 1: Filter: Front: b0

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

014 ch 1: Filter: Front: b1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]

015 ch 1: Filter: Front: b2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

016 ch 1: Filter: Rear: a1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]

017 ch 1: Filter: Rear: a2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 63398 / 1 bit/step]

018 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b0

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

019 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]

020 ch 1: Filter: Rear: b2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

021 ch 2: Filter: Front: a1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 125869 / 1 bit/step]

022 ch 2: Filter: Front: a2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 60488 / 1 bit/step]

023 ch 2: Filter: Front: b0

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

024 ch 2: Filter: Front: b1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 77 / 1 bit/step]

025 ch 2: Filter: Front: b2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 39 / 1 bit/step]

026 ch 2: Filter: Rear: a1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 128596 / 1 bit/step]

99

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

027 ch 2: Filter: Rear: a2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 63398 / 1 bit/step]

028 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b0

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

029 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b1

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 168 / 1 bit/step]

030 ch 2: Filter: Rear: b2

*ENG

[131071 to 131071 / 84 / 1 bit/step]

031 Q Format Selection

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1/step]

2192

[MUSIC Threshold Setting] Line Position Adjustment: Threshold Setting DFU


ch 0: ID sensor at rear, ch 1: ID sensor at center, ch 2: ID sensor at front

001 ch 0: 1st

*ENG

002 ch 0: 2nd

*ENG

003 ch 0: 3rd

*ENG

004 ch 0: 4th

*ENG

005 ch 1: 1st

*ENG

006 ch 1: 2nd

*ENG

007 ch 1: 3rd

*ENG

008 ch 1: 4th

*ENG

009 ch 2: 1st

*ENG

010 ch 2: 2nd

*ENG

011 ch 2: 3rd

*ENG

012 ch 2: 4th

*ENG

2193

001

[0.5 to 3 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

[MUSIC Condition Set] Line Position Adjustment: Condition Setting


Auto Execution

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

Enables/disables the automatic line position adjustment

100

System SP2-xxx

Page: Job End: BW+FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 500 / 1 page/step]

002 Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode after
job end.
003

Page: Job End: FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode after job end.
Page: Interrupt: BW+FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

004 Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode during
job.
005

Page: Interrupt: FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode during jobs.
Page: Stand-By: BW

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 100 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode.
006 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW printing mode reaches
the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is
satisfied.
Page: Stand-By: FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 100 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode.
007 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in color printing mode
reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009
is satisfied.
Temp.

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 1deg/step]

008 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment
once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions. Section Descriptions" section.
Time

*ENG

[1 to 1440 / 300 / 1 minute/step]

009 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment once). The
timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions.
Magnification

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01%/step]

010 Adjusts the magnification threshold for line position adjustment. If the length of the main scan
is changed by this amount since the previous MUSIC, then MSUIC is done again.

101

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Temp. 2

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 1deg/step]

011 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment
twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions.
Time 2

*ENG

[1 to 9999 / 600 / 1 minute/step]

012 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment twice). The
timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions.
Page: Power ON:BW+FC

*ENG

[0 to 999 / 200 / 1 page/step]

Adjusts the threshold for the condition of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing
013 mode. The condition of the line position adjustment is determined for large condition
difference and small condition difference when the number of outputs in color printing mode
reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP3-510-009 or SP3-510-010
is satisfied. However, it is basically not necessary to adjust this SP.
2194
001

002

003

004

005

006

[MUSIC Execution Result] Line Position Adjustment: Execution Result


Year

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 year/step]

Displays the year of the last MUSIC execution.


Month

*ENG

[1 to 12 / 1 / 1 month/step]

Displays the month of the last MUSIC execution.


Day

*ENG

[1 to 31 / 1 / 1 day/step]

Displays the date of the last MUSIC execution.


Hour

*ENG

[0 to 23 / 0 / 1 hour/step]

Displays the time (hour) of the last MUSIC execution.


Minute

*ENG

[0 to 59 / 0 / 1 minute/step]

Displays the time (minute) of the last MUSIC execution.


Temperature

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

Displays the temperature of the last MUSIC execution.

007 Execution Result

102

*ENG

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed

System SP2-xxx

008 Number of Execution

*ENG

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]

009 Number of Failure

*ENG

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]

010 Error Result: M

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]

011 Error Result: C

*ENG

0: Not done
1: Completed successfully
2: Cannot detect patterns
3: Fewer lines on the pattern than the target

012 Error Result: Y

*ENG

4: Not used

5: Out of the adjustment range


6 to 9: Not used

2197

[MUSIC Start Time]


DFU

001 MUSIC Start Time (EDT)

*ENG

[10 to 40 / 20 / 10ms/step]

002 TM Sensor Position

*ENG

[50 to 500 / 105.5 / 0.1mm/step]

2198

[Music A/D Interval]


ADC Trigger Counter

001 ADC Trigger Counter

2199

[7.5 to 20 / 10 / 0.1 s/step]

[Music Error Time Setting]


DFU

001 Error Detection Counter

2220

*ENG

*ENG

[0.5 to 4 / 2.5 / 0.1 sec /step]

[Skew Origin Set]


Executes the skew motor initialization in the laser optics unit.

001 M: Skew Motor

002 C: Skew Motor

003 Y: Skew Motor

103

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[LD Power] LD Power Control


2221

Adjusts the fixed LD power for each line speed and color.
These SPs are activated only when SP3-041-002 is set to "0".
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1%/step]

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

Increasing this value makes the image density


darker.

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2&FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2&FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2&FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2&FINE: Y

*ENG

[Development DC Vias] Development DC Bias Adjustment


Adjusts the development bias.
2229

Development bias is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore, adjusting these
settings has no effect while Process Control (SP3-041-001 Default: ON) is activated.
After deactivating Process Control with SP3-041-001, the values in these SP modes are used
for printing.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

104

System SP2-xxx

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2&FINE:Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2&FINE:M

*ENG

011 Thick 2&FINE:C

*ENG

012 Thick 2&FINE:Y

*ENG

2241

[0 to 800 / 550 / 10 V/step]

[Temperature/Humidity: Display]
Displays the environment temperature and humidity.

001 Temperature

[1280 to 1270 / - / 0.1deg/step]

002 Relative Humidity

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1 %RH/step]

003 Absolute Humidity

[0 to 100 / - / 0.01 g/m3/step]

2302

001

[Environmental Correction: Transfer]


Environmental Correction: Image Transfer Belt Unit
Current Environmental
Display

Displays the current environment condition.

105

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Sets the environment condition manually.


[0 to 6 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Automatic environment control
002 Forced Setting

*ENG

1: LL (Low temperature/ Low humidity)


2: ML (Middle temperature/ Low humidity)
3: MM (Middle temperature/ Middle humidity)
4: MH (Middle temperature/ High humidity)

5: HH (High temperature/ High humidity)


003

Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 1

*ENG

004

Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 2

*ENG

005

Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 3

*ENG

006

Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 4

*ENG

007 Temp Threshold

2308

*ENG

Adjusts the threshold value between LL and ML.


[0 to 100 / 4 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between ML and MM.
[0 to 100 / 8 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between MM and MH.
[0 to 100 / 16 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
Adjusts the threshold value between MH and HH.
[0 to 100 / 24 / 0.01 g/m3/step]
[5 to 30 / 5 / 1 deg/step]

[Paper Size Correction]


Adjusts the threshold value for the paper size correction.
[0 to 350 / 297 / 1 mm/step]

001 Threshold 1

*ENG

Threshold 1 < paper:


Paper is detected as "S1" size.
[0 to 350 / 257 / 1 mm/step]

002 Threshold 2

*ENG

Threshold 2 < paper < Threshold 1:


Paper is detected as "S2" size.
[0 to 350 / 210 / 1 mm/step]

003 Threshold 3

*ENG

Threshold 3 < paper < Threshold 2:


Paper is detected as "S3" size.

106

System SP2-xxx

[0 to 350 / 148 / 1 mm/step]


Threshold 4 < paper < Threshold 3:
004 Threshold 4

*ENG

Paper is detected as "S4" size.


Paper < Threshold 4:
Paper is detected as "S5" size.

2311

[Non Image Area: Bias]

001 Image Transfer

*ENG

Adjusts the bias of the image transfer belt between


images. This value is added to the value of the
image transfer belt bias.

[10 to 250 / 100 / 5 %/step]

002 Paper Transfer

*ENG

Adjusts the bias of the paper transfer roller between


images.
[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 V/step]

2326
001

002

[Transfer Roller CL: Bias] Transfer Roller Cleaning: Bias Adjustment


Positive

*ENG

[0 to 2100 / 500 / 100 V /step]

Adjusts the positive voltage of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
Negative

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 10 %/step]

Adjusts the negative current of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
Positive

*ENG

[0 to 2100 / 2000 / 100 V/step]

003 Adjusts the negative current limit of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer
roller.
004 Negative

2351

001

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 10 %/step]

[Common: BW: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: B/W: Bias Adjustment


Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
ITB unit: Plain

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for plain paper.

107

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

002

003

2357

001

002

003

004

005

006

007

008

009

108

ITB unit: Thick 1

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 2 paper or FINE mode.
[Common: FC: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: Full Color: Bias Adjustment
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
ITB unit: Plain: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: M

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: C

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 28 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: M

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: C

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 14 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for Thick 2 and fine.

System SP2-xxx

ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: M

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]

010 Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for Thick 2 and
fine.
011

ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: C

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]

Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for Thick 2 and fine.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 14 / 1 A]

012 Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for Thick 2 and
fine.
2360

[Common: BW Environment Correction Table]

001 Image Transfer: Plain

*ENG

002 Image Transfer: Thick 1

*ENG

004 Image Transfer: Plain: Bk

*ENG

005 Image Transfer: Plain: M

*ENG

006 Image Transfer: Plain: C

*ENG

007 Image Transfer: Plain: Y

*ENG

008 Image Transfer: Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

009 Image Transfer: Thick 1: M

*ENG

010 Image Transfer: Thick 1: C

*ENG

011 Image Transfer: Thick 1: Y

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 13/ 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 31 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]

[Plain: Bias]
2401

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for plain paper.


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Page

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

004 Separation DC: 1200: 2nd side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
109

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Plain: Bias: BW]


2403

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 7 / 1 A /step]

004

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

[Plain: Bias: FC]


2407

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 27 / 1 A /step]

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]

004

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

[Plain: Paper Size Correction]


2411

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

110

System SP2-xxx

001

Paper Transfer: Plain : 1st


Side: S1

*ENG

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S1

*ENG

003

Separation DC: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

004

Separation DC: 1200: 2nd


Side

*ENG

005

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side:


S2

*ENG

006

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S2

*ENG

007

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side: S2

*ENG

008

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


Side: S2

*ENG

009

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side:


S3

*ENG

010

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S3

*ENG

011

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side: S3

*ENG

012

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


Side: S3

*ENG

013

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side:


S4

*ENG

014

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S4

*ENG

015

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side: S4

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)

3
[100 to 600 / 105 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 150 / 5%/step]
[100 to 600 / 110 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)

[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]


275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)

[100 to 600 / 300 / 5%/step]


[100 to 600 / 115 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 240 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)

111

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

016

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


Side: S4

*ENG

017

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side:


S5

*ENG

018

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side: S5

*ENG

019

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side: S5

*ENG

020

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


Side: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 340 / 5%/step]


[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 300 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 400 / 5%/step]

[Plain: Leading Edge Correction] Plain Paper: Leading Edge Correction


Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.

2421

Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed


The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2422.
001

Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st


Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


004
side

2421

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


*ENG

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2401 is multiplied by these SPs values.

005-008
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2422.

112

System SP2-xxx

005

Separation DC: Plain: 1st


Side

*ENG

006

Separation DC: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

Separation DC: 1200: 1st


007
Side

*ENG

008

Separation DC: 1200: 2nd


Side

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

*ENG

[Plain: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2422

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

004

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006

Separation DC: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

007

Separation DC: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

008

Separation DC: 1200: 2nd


Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

113

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Plain: Trailing Edge Correction] Plain Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2423

Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2424.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002

Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

003

Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

004

Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd


side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006

Separation DC: Plain: 2nd


Side

*ENG

007

Separation DC: 1200: 1st


Side

*ENG

008

Separation DC: 1200: 2nd


Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Plain: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2424

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

114

System SP2-xxx

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: 1200: 2nd side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

008 Separation DC: 1200: 2nd Side

*ENG

2430

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Plain: Environment Correction] DFU


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Page

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Page

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 39 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Page

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

008 Separation DC: 1200: 2nd side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

010 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 2

*ENG

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

012 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 2

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 49 / 1 /step]

[Thin: Bias]
2451

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thin paper.


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

115

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Page

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 2000 / 10 V/
step]

[Thin: Bias: BW]


2453

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

[Thin: Bias: FC]


2457

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thin: Paper Size Correction]


2461

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

009 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S4

116

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Pape r


width)

System SP2-xxx

017 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]

[Thin: Leading Edge Correction] Thin Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2471

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2471

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2451 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thin: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2472

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed,

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

117

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Thin: Trailing Edge Correction] Thin Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2473

Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2474.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thin: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2474

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2480

118

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Thin: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

System SP2-xxx

2481
001

2482
001

2483
001

2484

[Glossy: Bias]
Separation DC: Glossy: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 2000 / 10 V/step]

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for glossy paper.


[Glossy: Bias: BW]
Paper Transfer: Glossy: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for glossy paper in black-and-white mode.
[Glossy: Bias: FC]
Paper Transfer: Glossy: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for glossy paper in full color mode.
[Glossy: Paper Size Correction]

001 Paper Transfer: Glossy: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Glossy: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Glossy: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

013 Paper Transfer: Glossy: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

017 Paper Transfer: Glossy: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

005 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

[10 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]]

2485

2486

[Glossy: Leading Edge Correction]

[Glossy: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2487

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Glossy: Trailing Edge Correction]

119

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2488

[Glossy: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2489

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5 %/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Glossy: Environment Correction]

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[Thick 1: Bias]
2501

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick 1 paper.


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 1000 / 10 V/step]

[Thick 1: Bias: BW]


2502

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 24 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

[Thick 1: Bias: FC]


2507

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

120

System SP2-xxx

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thick 1: Paper Size Correction]


2511

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 105 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 130 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

007 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 110 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)

121

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[100 to 600 / 115 / 5%/step]


013 Paper Transfer: Plain 1: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

014 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 190 / 5%/step]

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

015 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

017 Paper Transfer: Plain 1: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

019 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 220 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick 1: Leading Edge Correction] Thick 1 Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2521

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2522.

122

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

System SP2-xxx

[Thick 1: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2522

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 2nd Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Thick 1: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Thick 1: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 1: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2523

Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2524.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 1: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2524

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

123

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2530

[Thick 1: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW:2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

2551

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[Thick 2: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick 2 paper.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

2553

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[Thick 2: Bias: BW]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 2 paper in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

124

[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 7 / 1 A /step]

System SP2-xxx

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

2558

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

[Thick 2: Bias: FC]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 2 paper in full color mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 16 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thick 2: Paper Size Correction]


2561

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)

003 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

007 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

008 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

009 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 105 / 5%/step]


297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 110 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 260 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 430 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 600 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

125

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Thick 2: Leading Edge Correction] Thick 2 Paper: Leading Edge Correction


2571

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

2571

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2551 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 2: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2572

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2mm/step]

[Thick 2: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 2 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction


2573

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2574.

126

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

System SP2-xxx

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 2: Switch Trailing Edge Correction]


2574

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

2580

3
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 2 Environment Correction]

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 53 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

2601

[0 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[OHP: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for OHP.

001 Separation DC

2603

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[OHP: Bias: BW]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for OHP in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

127

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2608

[OHP: Bias: FC]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for OHP in full color mode.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[OHP: Paper Size Correction]


2611

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Paper Transfer: S1

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: S2

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: S3

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: S4

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 200 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 260 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 330 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[OHP: Leading Edge Correction] OHP: Leading Edge Correction


2621

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.

001 Paper Transfer

2621

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2601 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.

002 Separation DC

128

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

System SP2-xxx

[OHP: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2622

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

002 Separation DC

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[OHP: Trailing Edge Correction] OHP: Trailing Edge Correction


2623

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.

The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2624.


001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

002 Separation DC

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[OHP: Trailing Edge Correction]


2624

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer

*ENG

[100 to 0 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

002 Separation DC

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

001 Separation DC

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

002 Paper Transfer: BW

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

003 Paper Transfer: FC

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

2630

2650

[OHP: Environment Correction]

[Thick3: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick paper 3.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 1000 / 10 V/step]

129

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2651

[Thick 3: Bias: BW]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]

2652

[Thick 3: Bias: FC]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 3 in full color mode.

001 Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thick 3: Paper Size Correction]


2653

130

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.

001

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 1st


Side: S1

*ENG

002

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 1st


Side: S2

*ENG

003

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 1st


Side: S3

*ENG

004

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 1st


Side: S4

*ENG

005

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 1st


Side: S5

*ENG

006

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 2nd


Side: S1

*ENG

007

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 2nd


Side: S2

*ENG

008

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 2nd


Side: S2

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 260 / 5%/step]
S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 430 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)

System SP2-xxx

009

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 2nd


Side: S4

*ENG

010

Paper Transfer: Thick 3: 2nd


Side: S4

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 600 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick 3: Leading Edge Correction] Thick 3 Paper: Leading Edge Correction


2654

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.

The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.


001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2654

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2650 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 3: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2655

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

131

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Thick 3: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 3 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction


2656

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2657.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 3: Trailing Edge Correction]


2657

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 3: Environment Correction] Thick 3 Paper: MM Environment Coefficient Adjustment


2660

Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2650 is multiplied by these SP values.

132

003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 55 / 1 /step]

System SP2-xxx

006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2st Side

2670

*ENG

[Thick4: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick paper 4.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

2671

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[Thick4: Bias: BW]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 4 in black-and-white mode.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

2672

[Thick4: Bias: FC]


Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick paper 4 in full color mode.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Thick4: Paper Size Correction]


2673

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]


S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)

133

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

004 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

006 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

007 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 260 / 5%/step]
S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 430 / 5%/step]

008 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 600 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

[Thick 4: Leading Edge Correction] Thick 4 Paper: Leading Edge Correction


2674

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2675.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

2674

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2670 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.

134

System SP2-xxx

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 4: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2675

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

3
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Thick 4: Trailing Edge Correction] Thick 4 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction


2676

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2677.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Thick 4: Trailing Edge Correction]


2677

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

135

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Thick 4: Environment Correction] Thick 4 Paper: MM Environment Coefficient Adjustment


2680

Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Separation DC: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2670 is multiplied by these SP values.
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: BW: 2nd Side:

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 55 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: FC: 2st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[Special1: Bias]
2751

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for special paper 1.


Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Thick 1: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step

[Special1: Bias: BW]


2753

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode.
P Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed

136

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

System SP2-xxx

[Special1: Bias: FC]


2757

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

[Special 1: Paper Size Correction]


2761

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)

009 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)

013 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

014 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)

017 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]

018 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

137

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Special 1: Leading Edge Correction] Special 1 Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2771

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

2771

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2751 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 1: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2772

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

138

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

System SP2-xxx

[Special 1: Trailing Edge Correction] Special 1 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2773

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2774.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

3
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 1: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2774

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2780

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Special 1: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]

139

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW:2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[Special 2: Bias]
2801

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for special paper 2.


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 3000 / 10 V/step]

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 2000 / 10 V/step]

[Special2: Bias: BW]


2803

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 A /step]

[Special2: Bias: FC]


2807

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

140

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

System SP2-xxx

[Special2: Paper Size Correction]


2811

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)


[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)

[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]


006 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

013 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

014 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

017 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

141

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Special 2: Leading Edge Correction] Special 2 Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2821

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

2821

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2801 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 2: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2822

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

142

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

System SP2-xxx

[Special 2: Trailing Edge Correction] Special 2 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2823

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2824.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 2: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2824

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2830

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Special 2: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]

143

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

004 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]

007 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[Special 3: Bias]
2851

Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for special paper 3.


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]

[Special 3: Bias: BW]


2852

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]

[Special 3: Bias: FC]


2857

Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

144

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]

System SP2-xxx

[Special 3: Paper Size Correction]


2861

Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.

001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1

*ENG

[100 to 600 / 100 / 5%/step]

002 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S1

*ENG

S1 size > 297 mm (Paper width)


[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]

005 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)

[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]


006 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S2

*ENG

297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S3

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 140 / 5%/step]

010 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S3

*ENG

013 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S4

*ENG

275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]
210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper
width)
[100 to 600 / 160 / 5%/step]

014 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S4

*ENG

017 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S5

*ENG

018 Paper Transfer: 2nd Side: S5

*ENG

210 mm > S4 size > 148 mm (Paper


width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 180 / 5%/step]
148 mm > S5 size (Paper width)

145

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Special 3: Leading Edge Correction] Special 3 Paper: Leading Edge Correction

2871

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005-00
8

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2851 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]


[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 3: Switch Timing: Lead. Edge]


2872

Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

146

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Page

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

System SP2-xxx

[Special 3: Trailing Edge Correction] Special 3 Paper: Trailing Edge Correction

2873

Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2874.

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

3
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]

[Special 3: Switch Timing: Trail. Edge]


2874

Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Paper Transfer: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

002 Paper Transfer: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

003 Paper Transfer: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

005 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

006 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

2880

[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]

[Special 3: Environment Correction]


Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed

001 Separation DC: Plain: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

002 Separation DC: Plain: 2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]

147

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

004 Paper Transfer: Plain: BW:2nd Side

*ENG

005 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

006 Paper Transfer: Plain: FC:2nd Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

007 Separation DC: 1200: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]

009 Paper Transfer: 1200: BW: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

011 Paper Transfer: 1200: FC: 1st Side

*ENG

[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]

[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]

[OPC Drum Brake Time]


2901

Adjusts the time when the OPC drum motor reverses from normal rotation after job end. DFU
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

001 Plain

*ENG

002 Thick 1

*ENG

003 Thick 2 & FINE

*ENG

2902

[300 to 1500 / 500 / 10 msec/step]

[OPC Drum Reverse Time]


Adjusts the time for how long the OPC drum motor reverses after job end. DFU

001 All: BW

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 50 / 10 msec/step]

002 All: FC

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 50 / 10 msec/step]

[Image Transfer Roller Brake Time]


2903

Adjusts the time when the image transfer belt motor reverses from normal rotation after job
end. DFU
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed

148

003 Plain

*ENG

004 Thick 1

*ENG

005 Thick 2 & FINE

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 500 / 10 msec/step]

System SP2-xxx

2904

[OPC Drum Reverse Time]


Adjusts the time for how long the image transfer belt motor reverses after job end. DFU

003 All

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 40 / 10 msec/step]

[Dev Rvs Time] Development Roller Reverse Time


2905

Specifies the time of the development roller reverse rotation after the development unit has
stopped. The reverse rotation of the development roller is used for removing dust from the
development roller.

001 K

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 80 / 10 msec/step]

[Dev Rvs Threshold Counter]


005

All

*ENG

[0 to 400000 / 4000/ 10 mm/step]

Specifies the threshold distance for the development roller reverse mode. This sp refers to
the counters for SP2905-006 to -009.
[Dev Rvs Counter]
006 K

*ENG

007 M

*ENG

008 C

*ENG

009 Y

*ENG

2906

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step]

[Phase Angle]
DFU

001 Y Drum

*ENG

002 C Drum

*ENG

003 M Drum

*ENG

004 K Drum

*ENG

[0 to 359 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

149

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2906

[Amplitude Setting]
DFU

006 Y Drum

*ENG

007 C Drum

[0 to 100 / 0.0 / 0.1 m/step]

008 M Drum

009 K Drum
[ACS Setting (FC to Bk)]

2907

Adjusts the threshold for moving away the image transfer belt from the color PCDUs. This SP
moves the image transfer belt away from the color PCDUs when the number of B/W image
printouts reaches the number of sheets specified with this SP after consecutive full color image
printouts in the full color mode.
If this SP is set to "0", the image transfer belt does not move away.

001 Continuous Bk Pages

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

[Gain Adjust] Gain Adjustment of Image Transfer Belt Motor DFU


0: High speed (Low level)
2908

1: Middle high speed


2: Middle low speed
3: Low speed (High level)

001 255 mm/sec

*ENG

002 230 mm/sec

*ENG

003 205 mm/sec

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]

004 154 mm/sec

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 2 / 1/step]

005 77 mm/sec

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 3 / 1/step]

2911

150

[Offset Angle] DFU

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

System SP2-xxx

001 Y Drum

*ENG

002 C Drum

*ENG

003 M Drum

*ENG

004 K Drum

*ENG

2912

[Offset Amplitude Setting] DFU

001 Y Drum

*ENG

002 C Drum

*ENG

003 M Drum

*ENG

004 K Drum

*ENG

2913

3
[0 to 100 / 0.0 / 0.1 m/step]

[Drum Control]

001 Rotation Direction


2920

[0 to 359 / 0 / 1 deg/step]

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / -/step]

[Transfer Motor Control]


0: Encorder 1 :FG

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 Selects the speed control mode for the ITB.


If SC443 occurs and machine does not recover, change this setting to "1".
SC443 Count

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]

002 Displays the number of the ITB encodre error. SC443 is displayed if this counter counts to
"3".
[SecondaryFB: Threshold] Paper Transfer Roller Feed-back: Threshold Adjustment
2930

Adjusts the threshold between high resistance (division 1) and low resistance (division 2) at
the paper transfer roller. This SP affects SP2931 to SP2939.

001 Voltage
2960

*ENG

[0 to 7000 / 6000 / 10 V/step]

[Process Interval]

151

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001

2970

Additional Time

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sec/step]

Adjusts the additional time for ending the machine's process.


[Cleaning After JOB]
No Refresh

*ENG

*ENG

001

[0 to 100 / 50 / 1 /step]
0: No cleaning

Specifies the threshold sheets for the cleaning of the paper transfer roller without the refresh
mode.
002 Refresh

003

2971
001

Cleaning Counter

*ENG
*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: No cleaning, 1: Cleaning
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 page/step]

This counter is used for the cleaning of the paper transfer roller.
T1 Non Image Area ON Timing
Standard Speed

*ENG

[400 to 290 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

Adjusts the timing for the non-image area bias of the image transfer roller.

002 Medium Speed

*ENG

[790 to 410 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

003 Low Speed

*ENG

[790 to 410 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

2972

B/W Image Request Timing


Adjusts the LD firing timing in black and white mode for each process speed.

001 Standard Speed

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

002 Medium Speed

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

003 Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]

*ENG

[0 to 5000 / 0 / 10 page/step]

2973

Forced Process Down Threshold


-

001 Specifies the threshold pages for the forced processing stop at a continuous printing job.
0: No forced processing stop (default)
152

System SP2-xxx

2974

OPC PreCharge Time Control


Adjusts the pre-charge time of the drum for each process speed.

001 Standard Speed

*ENG

[0 to 940 / 90 / 10 msec/step]

002 Medium Speed

*ENG

[0 to 1240 / 90 / 10 msec/step]

003 Low Speed

*ENG

[0 to 2480 / 580 / 10 msec/step]

2980

001 Continuous Job Page

*ENG

[0 to 300 / 100 / 10 page/step]

002 OPC Drum Idling Time BW

*ENG

[0 to 600 / 30 / 10 sec/step]

003 OPC Drum Idling Time FC

*ENG

[0 to 600 / 30 / 10 sec/step]

2990

001

Print Duty Control


Duty Control State

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: No limit, 1: Limit

Limit or does not limit the duty control for a continuous printing job.
002

Duty Control Thresh Time

*ENG

[0 to 195 / 100 / 10 min./step]

Specifies the judgment time for the duty control for a continuous printing job.
Duty Control Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

003 Specifies the threshold for the duty control for a continuous printing job.
0: No duty control (default)
Forced CPM Down Thresh:
004 No Duty Control

*ENG

[0 to 5000 / 0 / 1 page/step]

Specifies the threshold page for the forced processing stop without the duty limit.
Drum Stop Time: No Duty
005 Control

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 500 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the drum brake time without the duty limit.

153

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

ITB Stop Time: No Duty


006 Control

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 500 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the ITB brake time without the duty limit.


Forced CPM Down Thresh:
007 Duty Control

*ENG

[0 to 5000 / 1 / 1 page/step]

Specifies the threshold page for the forced processing stop with the duty limit.

008

009

010

154

Drum Stop Time: Duty Control

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 1500 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the drum brake time with the duty limit.


ITB Stop Time: Duty Control

*ENG

[300 to 1500 / 1500 / 10 msec/step]

Specifies the ITB brake time with the duty limit.


Duty Control: Start Time

*ENG

Displays the execution time of the duty limit control.

System SP3-xxx

System SP3-xxx
SP3-XXX (Process)
3011

[Process Cont. Manual Execution]

001 Normal

002 Density Adjustment

Executes the normal process control manually


(potential control).
Check the result with SP3-325-001 and
3-012-001 after executing this SP.
Executes the toner density adjustment manually.
Executes the process control that is normally done
before ACC.

003 Pre-ACC

004 Full MUSIC

Executes the process control that is normally done


at the same time as MUSIC. This SP does the
MUSIC (line position adjustment) twice.

Executes the process control that is normally done


at the same time as MUSIC. This SP does the
MUSIC (line position adjustment) once.

005 Normal MUSIC

The type of process control is selected with


SP3-041-004.

[Process Cont. Check Result] Process Control Self-check Result


Displays the result of the latest process control self-check.
3012

All colors are displayed. The results are displayed in the order "Y C M K"
e.g., 11 (Y) 99 (C) 11 (M) 11 (K): The self-check for Cyan failed but the others were
successful.
See the "Error Condition Tables" in the Process Control Error section for details.

155

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 History: Latest

*ENG

002 Result: Latest 1

*ENG

003 Result: Latest 2

*ENG

004 Result: Latest 3

*ENG

005 Result: Latest 4

*ENG

006 Result: Latest 5

*ENG

007 Result: Latest 6

*ENG

008 Result: Latest 7

*ENG

009 Result: Latest 8

*ENG

010 Result: Latest 9

*ENG

3013

[T Sensor Initial Set: Execution] Developer Initialization Setting

001 Execution: ALL

002 Execution: COL

003 Execution: Bk

004 Execution: M

005 Execution: C

006 Execution: Y

3014

[1111 to 99999999 / - / 1/step]

Executes the developer initialization for each color.

[T Sensor Initial Set Result: Display] Developer Initialization Result: Display


[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step ]
Display: YCMK

*ENG

1: Success
2 to 9: Failure

001 Displays the developer initialization result. See section "Developer Initialization Result" in the
"Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions" section for details on the meaning of each
code.
All colors are displayed. Values are displayed in the order Y C M Bk.
e.g., 1 (Y) 2 (C) 1 (M) 1 (Bk): Initialization of Cyan failed but the others succeeded.

156

System SP3-xxx

3015

[Forced Toner Supply: Execute] Forced Toner Supply ([Color])

001 Execution: ALL

002 Execution: COL

003 Execution: Bk

004 Execution: M

005 Execution: C

006 Execution: Y

3016

Executes the manual toner supply to the


development unit.

[Forced Toner Supply: Setting] Forced Toner Supply Setting ([Color])


Specifies the manual toner supply time for each color.

001 Supply Time: Bk

*ENG

002 Supply Time: M

*ENG

003 Supply Time: C

*ENG

004 Supply Time: Y

*ENG

3020

[0 to 30 / 4 / 1 sec/step]

[Vt Limit Error]


DFU

001 Delta Vt Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 5 / 0.01 V/step]

002 Upper Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4.7 / 0.01 V/step]

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 20 / 1 time/step]

004 Lower Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Number of Lower counter

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 times/step]

003

Threshold Number of Upper


counter

157

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

006 Upper Counter: Bk

*ENG

007 Upper Counter: M

*ENG

008 Upper Counter: C

*ENG

009 Upper Counter: Y

*ENG

010 Lower Counter: Bk

*ENG

011 Lower Counter: M

*ENG

012 Lower Counter: C

*ENG

013 Lower Counter: Y

*ENG

3021

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 times/step]

[TD Sensor Initial Set] Developer Initialization Setting


Specifies the developer agitation time for each color at the developer initialization. DFU
001 Agitation Time: Bk

*ENG

002 Agitation Time: M

*ENG

003 Agitation Time: C

*ENG

004 Agitation Time: Y

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

005-008 Sets the execution flag of the developer initialization for each color.
005 Execution Flag: Bk

*ENG

006 Execution Flag: M

*ENG

0: Flag OFF, 1: Flag ON

007 Execution Flag: C

*ENG

008 Execution Flag: Y

*ENG

This flag is cleared after executing TD sensor


initialization.

009 Prohibition

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

Enables or disables developer initialization.


DFU
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Enable, 1: Disable

3022

158

[Toner Replenishment Mode] DFU


Specifies the toner supply time for each color in the toner supply mode.

System SP3-xxx

001 Supply Number of times: Bk *ENG

[0 to 30 / 8 / 1 sec/step]

002 Supply Number of times: M *ENG


003 Supply Number of times: C

*ENG

004 Supply Number of times: Y

*ENG

[0 to 30 / 6 / 1 sec/step]

005-008 Sets the execution flag for the toner supply mode for each color.
005 Execution Flag: Bk

*ENG

006 Execution Flag: M

*ENG

0: Flag OFF, 1: Flag ON

007 Execution Flag: C

*ENG

008 Execution Flag: Y

*ENG

This flag is cleared after executing TD sensor


initialization.

3041

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

[Process Control Type]


[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step ] Alphanumeric

001

Voltage Control

*ENG

0: FIXED (Use the fixed values for the charge DC bias


and development DC bias set with SP2-005 and
SP2-229.)
1: CONTROL

Enables or disables potential control.


[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
002

LD Power Control

*ENG

0: FIXED (at the value in SP2221-xxx)


1: CONTROL (adjusted by process control)

Selects the LD power control mode.


AutoControl Prohibition
003 Set

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Permit, 1: Forbid

Enables or disables the automatic process control prohibition.

159

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
0: Not Executed
004

Pre-ACC

*ENG

1: Process Control
2: TC Control (TD Adjustment)
3: Not used

Selects the process control mode that is done before ACC.

[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
Pattern Calculation
005 Method

*ENG

0: FIXED
1: INITIALIZED
2: CALCULATED

Selects the process control method.


3043

[TD Adjustment Mode]


Repeat Number: Power ON

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at power on.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
001 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat Number: Initialization

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at the developer
initialization.
002

0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,


4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled

160

System SP3-xxx

Repeat Number: Non-use

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment in stand by mode.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
003 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat Number: ACC

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at ACC.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
004 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
005

Repeat Number: Recovery

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]

Not used
Repeat Number: Job End

Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at job end.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
006 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat: Interrupt

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]

007 Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment during printing.
DFU
008

Toner Supply Coefficient

*ENG

[0 to 25.5 / 10 / 0.1 sec/step]

Adjusts the time for the toner supply mode when a toner density is detected to be low.

161

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Consumption pattern: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

009 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the black toner density when toner density
is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: M

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

010 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the magenta toner density when toner
density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.

Consumption pattern: C

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

011 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the cyan toner density when toner density
is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: Y

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]

012 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the yellow toner density when toner
density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
013

014

015

016

017

T1 Bias: Bk

*ENG

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Black.


T2 Bias: M

*ENG

162

[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Magenta.


T3 Bias: C

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Cyan.


T4 Bias: Y

*ENG

[0 to 80 / 28 / 1 A/step]

Adjusts the image transfer belt bias for Yellow.


Developer Mixing Time

*ENG

[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 sec/step]

Specifies the developer mixing time at the toner density adjustment.


Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: Bk

018

[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A/step]

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-001) exceed the target values (SP3611-005) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).

System SP3-xxx

Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: M


019

*ENG

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-002) exceed the target values (SP3611-006) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: C

020

*ENG

3044

In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-003) exceed the target values (SP3611-007) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
*ENG

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-004) exceed the target values (SP3611-008) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
[Toner Supply Type] Toner Supply Type ([Color])
Selects the toner supply method type.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

3045

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.

Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: Y


021

[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]

[0 to 4 / 4 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
0: FIXED (with the supply rates stored with SP 3401)
1: PID (Vtref_Fixed)
2: PID (Vtref_Control)
3: MBD (Vtref_Fixed)
4: MBD (Vtref_Control)

[Toner End Detection: Set]


Enables/disables the toner alert display on the LCD.

001 ON/OFF

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Detect, 1: Not Detect

163

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Toner End/Near End]

3101

Displays the amount of each color toner. DFU


001 Toner Replenishment: Bk

*ENG

002 Toner Replenishment: M

*ENG

003 Toner Replenishment: C

*ENG

004 Toner Replenishment: Y

*ENG

[1 to 600 / 450 / 1 g/step]

[1 to 600 / 360 / 1 g/step]

005-008 Displays the consumed amount of each color toner.


005 K Toner Consumption

*ENG

006 M Toner Consumption

*ENG

007 C Toner Consumption

*ENG

008 Y Toner Consumption

*ENG

009-012

[0 to 3000 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]

Displays the remaining amount of each color toner. These are calculated by the operating
times of the toner supply pumps.

009 K Toner Remaining

*ENG

010 M Toner Remaining

*ENG

011 C Toner Remaining

*ENG

012 Y Toner Remaining

*ENG

[50000 to 600 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]

Adjusts the threshold of toner near end for each color. The toner near end message appears
on the LCD when the remaining toner amount reaches this threshold. When one of these
013-016
SPs (SP3-101-009 to 012 or -032 to -035) reaches this threshold, toner near end is
detected.
013 Near End Threshold: Bk

*ENG

014 Near End Threshold: M

*ENG

015 Near End Threshold: C

*ENG

016 Near End Threshold: Y

*ENG

017-020 DFU

164

[0 to 600 / 30 / 1 g/step]

[0 to 600 / 25 / 1 g/step]

System SP3-xxx

017 Cartridge Error Threshold: Bk

*ENG

018 Cartridge Error Threshold: M

*ENG

019 Cartridge Error Threshold: C

*ENG

020 Cartridge Error Threshold: Y

*ENG

Delta Vt Threshold

*ENG

[50000 to 0 / 50000 / 1 g/step]

[0 to 5 / 0.3 / 0.01 V/step]

021 This SP is the threshold for toner end. Delta Vt: Vt-Vtref
When both this SP and SP3-101-026 occur at same time, toner end is determined.
022-025

Displays the total delta Vt (Vt-Vtref) value for each color.These are calculated by pixel
counting.

022 Delta Vt Sum: Bk

*ENG

023 Delta Vt Sum: M

*ENG

024 Delta Vt Sum: C

*ENG

025 Delta Vt Sum: Y

*ENG

026 Delta Vt Sum Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 655 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 V/step]

028-031 Displays the consumed toner amount calculated with the pixel count for each color.
028 Pixel: Consumption: Bk

*ENG

029 Pixel: Consumption: M

*ENG

030 Pixel: Consumption: C

*ENG

031 Pixel: Consumption: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3000 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]

032-035 Displays the remaining toner amount for each color, using pixel count.
032 Pixel: Remaining : Bk

*ENG

033 Pixel: Remaining : M

*ENG

034 Pixel: Remaining : C

*ENG

035 Pixel: Remaining : Y

*ENG

[-50000 to 600 / 0 / 0.001 g/step]

036-039 Adjusts the threshold of toner end for each color.

165

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

036 End Threshold: Bk

*ENG

037 End Threshold: M

*ENG

038 End Threshold: C

*ENG

039 End Threshold: Y

*ENG

Not used

040-043 Displays the pixel M/A for each color.

040 Pixel M/A: Bk

*ENG

041 Pixel M/A: M

*ENG

042 Pixel M/A: C

*ENG

043 Pixel M/A: Y

*ENG

Delta Vt Threshold Before Near


044
End

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.4 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]

Adjusts the delta Vt (Vt Vtref) of toner end


before toner near end is detected.
[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step]

Delta Vt Sum Threshold Before


045
Near End

*ENG

Adjusts the total delta Vt (Vt Vtref) of toner


end before toner near end is detected.
[0 to 255 / 10 / 1 V/step]

046-049 Displays the latest mohno off time.


046 Mohno Off Time: Bk

*ENG

047 Mohno Off Time: M

*ENG

048 Mohno Off Time: C

*ENG

049 Mohno Off Time: Y

*ENG

[0 to 0xFFFFFFFF / 0 / 1 sec/step]

[Toner End Recovery]


3102

166

Adjusts the number of times toner supply is attempted for each color when the TD sensor
continues to detect toner end during toner recovery.

001 Repeat: Bk

*ENG

002 Repeat: M

*ENG

003 Repeat: C

*ENG

004 Repeat: Y

*ENG

[1 to 20 / 5 / 1 time/step]

System SP3-xxx

005

3131

Bottle Pre-Rotation Control


Threshold

*ENG

[TE Count m: Display]


Display the number of toner end detections for each color.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

3201

[0 to 255 / 110 / 1 /step]

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 time/step]

[TD Sensor: Vt Display]


Display the current voltage of the TD sensor for each color.

001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: M

*ENG

003 Current: C

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0.01 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vt Shift: Display/Set]


3211

Adjusts the Vt correction value for each line speed.


Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
001 Thick 1 Shift: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.35 / 0.01 V/step]

002 Thick 1 Shift: M

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.33 / 0.01 V/step]

003 Thick 1 Shift: C

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.28 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Thick 1 Shift: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.29 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Thick 2 & FINE Shift: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.35 / 0.01 V/step]

006 Thick 2 & FINE Shift: M

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.33 / 0.01 V/step]

007 Thick 2 & FINE Shift: C

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.28 / 0.01 V/step]

008 Thick 2 & FINE Shift: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.29 / 0.01 V/step]


167

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3221

009 Mid TCShift: Bk

*ENG

010 Mid TCShift: M

*ENG

011 Mid TCShift: C

*ENG

012 Mid TCShift: Y

*ENG

013 Low TCShift: Bk

*ENG

014 Low TCShift: M

*ENG

015 Low TCShift: C

*ENG

016 Low TCShift: Y

*ENG

[-0.5 to 0.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[-0.5 to 0.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtcnt: Display/Set]
Displays or adjusts the current Vtcnt value for each color.

001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: M

*ENG

003 Current: C

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

[2 to 5 / 3.86 / 0.01 V/step]

005-00
Displays or adjusts the Vtcnt value for each color at developer initialization. DFU
8
005 Initial: Bk

*ENG

006 Initial: M

*ENG

007 Initial: C

*ENG

008 Initial: Y

*ENG

3222

168

[2 to 5 / 3.86 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtref: Display/Set]
Displays or adjusts the current Vtref value for each color.

System SP3-xxx

001 Current: Bk

*ENG

002 Current: M

*ENG

003 Current: C

*ENG

004 Current: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 3 / 0.01 V/step]

005-00
Displays or adjusts the Vtref value for each color at developer initialization. DFU
8
005 Initial: Bk

*ENG

006 Initial: M

*ENG

007 Initial: C

*ENG

008 Initial: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 3 / 0.01 V/step]

009-01
Displays and adjusts Vtref correction by pixel coverage for each color. DFU
2
009 Pixel Correction: Bk

*ENG

010 Pixel Correction: M

*ENG

011 Pixel Correction: C

*ENG

012 Pixel Correction: Y

*ENG

3223

[-5 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtref Upper Lower: Set] DFU


Adjusts the lower or upper limit value of Vtref for each color.

001 Lower: Bk

*ENG

002 Lower: M

*ENG

003 Lower: C

*ENG

004 Lower: Y

*ENG

005 Upper: Bk

*ENG

006 Upper: M

*ENG

007 Upper: C

*ENG

008 Upper: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

169

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

009 Initial TC

*ENG

010 Upper: TC

*ENG

011 Lower: TC

*ENG

012 Upper Sensitivity

*ENG

013 Lower Sensitivity

*ENG

[1 to 15 / 7 / 0.1 wt%/step]
Adjusts the upper limit of the toner concentration.
[1 to 15 / 9.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]
Adjusts the lower limit of the toner concentration.
[1 to 15 / 4 / 0.1 wt%/step]
Adjusts the upper limit of the TD sensor sensitivity.
[0.2 to 0.5 / 0.44 / 0.001 V/wt% /step]
Adjusts the lower limit of the TD sensor sensitivity.
[0.2 to 0.5 / 0.209 / 0.001 V/wt% /step]

014

Toner Density Between H and


M

*ENG

[1 to 10 / 3.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]

015

Toner Density Between M and


L

*ENG

[1 to 10 / 3.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]

016 Upper TC:K

*ENG

017 Upper TC:M

*ENG

018 Upper TC:C

*ENG

019 Upper TC:Y

*ENG

3224

170

Adjusts the initial toner concentration.

[1 to 15 / 9 / 0.1 wt%/step]

[Vtref Correction: Pixel] DFU


Adjusts the coefficient of Vtref correction for each coverage and color.

001 Low Coverage Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

002 Low Coverage Coefficient: M

*ENG

003 Low Coverage Coefficient: C

*ENG

004 Low Coverage Coefficient: Y

*ENG

005 High Coverage Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 /step]

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 V/step]

System SP3-xxx

006 High Coverage Coefficient: M

*ENG

007 High Coverage Coefficient: C

*ENG

008 High Coverage Coefficient: Y

*ENG

009 Low Coverage: Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 V/step]

Adjusts the threshold of the low


coverage.
[0 to 20 / 3 / 0.1 %/step]

010 High Coverage: Threshold

*ENG

Adjusts the threshold of the high


coverage.

[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %/step]
011 TC Upper Limit Correction

*ENG

012 Upper Limit TC: Display: Bk

*ENG

013 Upper Limit TC: Display: M

*ENG

014 Upper Limit TC: Display: C

*ENG

015 Upper Limit TC: Display: Y

*ENG

016 Process Control Execution Threshold

*ENG

3230

[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 wt%/step]

[1 to 15 / 10 / 0.1 wt% /step]

[0 to 255 / 50 / 1 time/step]

[Toner Supply MBD] DFU

001 ADD_TIME

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 200 / 10 msec./step]

002 ADD:K

*ENG

003 ADD:C

*ENG

004 ADD:M

*ENG

005 ADD:Y

*ENG

006 ADD_MidSpd

*ENG

[0.01 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

007 ADD:LowSpd

*ENG

[0.01 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

008 MSEC_V

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.08 / 0.001 /step]

009 N_Delay

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 27 / 1 /step]

[0 to 2 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

171

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

172

030 PID:I:K

*ENG

031 PID:I:C

*ENG

032 PID:I:M

*ENG

033 PID:I:Y

*ENG

034 PID:P:K

*ENG

035 PID:P:C

*ENG

036 PID:P:M

*ENG

037 PID:P:Y

*ENG

038 PID_I_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

039 PID:I:LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

040 PID_P_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 100 / 0.24 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 100 / 4.8 / 0.01 /step]

041 PID:P:LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

060 AWILOW:K

*ENG

061 AWILOW:C

*ENG

062 AWILOW:M

*ENG

063 AWILOW:Y

*ENG

064 AWPUP:K

*ENG

065 AWPUP:C

*ENG

066 AWPUP:M

*ENG

067 AWPUP:Y

*ENG

068 AWILOW_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

069 AWPUP_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

070 AWILOW:LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 2 / 0.01 /step]

071 AWPUP:LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[-1 to 1 / 0.208 / 0.01 /step]

[-1 to 1 / 1 / 0.0001 /step]

System SP3-xxx

090 SMITH:K

*ENG

091 SMITH:C

*ENG

092 SMITH:M

*ENG

093 SMITH:Y

*ENG

094 SMITH_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

095 SMITH:LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01 /step]

100 Int_conserve_I_K

*ENG

101 Int_conserve_I_C

*ENG

102 Int_conserve_I_M

*ENG

103 Int_conserve_I_Y

*ENG

110 ANC_ref_conserve_K

*ENG

111 ANC_ref_conserve_C

*ENG

112 ANC_ref_conserve_M

*ENG

113 ANC_ref_conserve_Y

*ENG

120 ANC_A3_K

*ENG

121 ANC_A3_C

*ENG

122 ANC_A3_M

*ENG

123 ANC_A3_Y

*ENG

124 ANC_A4_K

*ENG

125 ANC_A4_C

*ENG

126 ANC_A4_M

*ENG

127 ANC_A4_Y

*ENG

128 ANC_A3_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

129 ANCA4T_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

130 ANC_A3_LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.62 / 0.001 /step]

131 ANCA4T_LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.001 /step]

[0 to 2 / 0.12 / 0.01 /step]

[-1000 to 1000 / 0 / 0.0001 /step]

[-1000 to 1000 / 0 / 0.0001 /step]

[0 to 1 / 0.08 / 0.001 /step]

[0 to 1 / 0.08 / 0.001 /step]

173

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

174

150 AWPNI_K

*ENG

151 AWPNI_C

*ENG

152 AWPNI_M

*ENG

153 AWPNI_Y

*ENG

154 PID

*ENG

180 ANCLA_K

*ENG

181 ANCLA_C

*ENG

182 ANCLA_M

*ENG

183 ANCLA_Y

*ENG

184 ANCLB_K

*ENG

185 ANCLB_C

*ENG

186 ANCLB_M

*ENG

187 ANCLB_Y

*ENG

188 ANCLA_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

189 ANCLB_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

190 ANCLA_LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

191 ANCLB_LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.4 / 0.01 /step]

210 PIX_TBL_1

*ENG

211 PIX_TBL_2

*ENG

212 PIX_TBL_3

*ENG

213 PIX_TBL_4

*ENG

214 PIX_TBL_5

*ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0.2 / 0.001 /step]

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 1 / 0.12 / 0.001 /step]

[0 to 1 / 0.15 / 0.001 /step]

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

System SP3-xxx

215 PIX_TBL_6

*ENG

216 PIX_TBL_7

*ENG

217 PIX_TBL_8

*ENG

218 PIX_TBL_9

*ENG

219 PIX_TBL_10

*ENG

220 PIX_TBL_11

*ENG

221 PIX_TBL_12

*ENG

222 PIX_COR_K

*ENG

223 PIX_COR_C

*ENG

224 PIX_COR_M

*ENG

225 PIX_COR_Y

*ENG

226 SEL_PIX_AVE

*ENG

[1 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]

231 PID_I_LIM1_Std

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]

232 PID_I_LIM1_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]

233 PID_I_LIM1_LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.036 / 0.001/step]

234 PID_I_LIM2_Std

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]

235 PID_I_LIM2_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]

236 PID_I_LIM2_LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.036 / 0.001/step]

237 PID_P_LIM1_Std

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]

238 PID_ P _LIM1_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]

239 PID_ P _LIM1_LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.036 / 0.001/step]

240 PID_ P _LIM2_Std

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]

241 PID_ P _LIM2_MidSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]

242 PID_ P _LIM2_LowSpd

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.036 / 0.001/step]

243 PID_I_STDtoLOW

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]

244 PID_I_LOWtoSTD

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01/step]

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

175

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

245 PID_I_STDtoMID

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01/step]

246 PID_I_MIDtoSTD

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01/step]

247 PID_I_MIDtoLOW

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]

248 PID_I_LOWtoMID

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01/step]

3231

Adjusts the coefficient of the toner supply time for each color.

001 Conversion Coefficient:Bk

*ENG

[0.5 to 9.99 / 1.66 / 0.01 /step]

002 Conversion Coefficient: M

*ENG

[0.5 to 9.99 / 1.66/ 0.01 /step]

003 Conversion Coefficient: C

*ENG

[0.5 to 9.99 / 1.6 / 0.01 /step]

004 Conversion Coefficient: Y

*ENG

[0.5 to 9.99 / 1.66 / 0.01 /step]

3232

176

[Toner Supply: Setting] DFU

[Toner Supply Coefficient: Setting] DFU

001 Vt Proportion: Bk

*ENG

002 Vt Proportion: M

*ENG

003 Vt Proportion: C

*ENG

004 Vt Proportion: Y

*ENG

005 Pixel Proportion: Bk

*ENG

006 Pixel Proportion: M

*ENG

007 Pixel Proportion: C

*ENG

008 Pixel Proportion: Y

*ENG

009 Vt Integral Control: Bk

*ENG

010 Vt Integral Control: M

*ENG

011 Vt Integral Control: C

*ENG

012 Vt Integral Control: Y

*ENG

[0 to 2550 / 50 / 1 /step]

[0 to 2.55 / 0.47 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 2550 / 500 / 1 /step]

System SP3-xxx

013 Vt Sum Times: Bk

*ENG

014 Vt Sum Times: M

*ENG

015 Vt Sum Times: C

*ENG

016 Vt Sum Times: Y

*ENG

3233

[1 to 255 / 20 / 1 time/step]

[Pixel Proportion Coefficient 2: Setting] DFU

001 Correction Coefficient: 1

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

002 Correction Coefficient: 2

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

003 Correction Coefficient: 3

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 /step]

004 Correction Coefficient: 4

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0.25 / 0.01 /step]

005 Correction Coefficient: 5

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

3234

[Pixel Proportion Coefficient 3: Setting] DFU

001 Correction Value 1

*ENG

[-0.1 to 0 / -0.01 / 0.01 /step]

002 Correction Value 2

*ENG

[0 to 0.1 / 0.01 / 0.01 /step]

3235

[Toner Supply Coefficient: Display] DFU

001 Pixel Proportion 2: Bk

*ENG

002 Pixel Proportion 2: M

*ENG

003 Pixel Proportion 2: C

*ENG

004 Pixel Proportion 2: Y

*ENG

005 Pixel Proportion 3: Bk

*ENG

006 Pixel Proportion 3: M

*ENG

007 Pixel Proportion 3: C

*ENG

008 Pixel Proportion 3: Y

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[0.7 to 1.3 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

177

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

009 Vt Integral Value: Bk

*ENG

010 Vt Integral Value: M

*ENG

011 Vt Integral Value: C

*ENG

012 Vt Integral Value: Y

*ENG

3236

[Toner Supply Consumption: Display] DFU


Displays the toner amount of the latest toner supply for each color.

001 Latest: Bk

*ENG

002 Latest: M

*ENG

003 Latest: C

*ENG

004 Latest: Y

*ENG

3237

Displays the toner amount of the latest toner supply for each color.

178

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 sec/step]

[Vt Target: Setting] DFU


Displays the Vt target value at developer initialization.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

3239

[0 to 40000 / 0 / 0.1 mg/step]

[Developer Mixing Setting] DFU

001 Mixing Time

3238

[-255 to 255 / 0 / 0.01 /step]

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vtref Correction: Setting]


Adjusts the parameter for Vtref correction at the process control.

System SP3-xxx

001 (+)Consumption: Bk

*ENG

002 (+)Consumption: M

*ENG

003 (+)Consumption: C

*ENG

004 (+)Consumption: Y

*ENG

005 (-)Consumption: Bk

*ENG

006 (-)Consumption: M

*ENG

007 (-)Consumption: C

*ENG

008 (-)Consumption: Y

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.05 / 0.01 V/step]

009-012 Threshold for development gamma rank.


009 P Rank 1 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0.2 / 0.1 /step]

010 P Rank 2 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0.05 / 0.1 /step]

011 P Rank 3 Threshold

*ENG

[-2 to 0 / -0.05 / 0.1 /step]

012 P Rank 4 Threshold

*ENG

[-2 to 0 / -0.2 / 0.1 /step]

013-014 Threshold for image density rank on the image transfer belt.

3241

013 T Rank 1 Threshold

*ENG

[-1 to 0 / -0.2 / 0.01 V/step]

014 T Rank 2 Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.2 / 0.01 V/step]

[Background Potential Setting]

001 Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

002 Coefficient: M

*ENG

These are parameters for calculating the charge


bias referring to the development bias at process
control.

003 Coefficient: C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 0 / 1 /step]

004 Coefficient: Y

*ENG

DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 + 0.001


x these vales) + SP3-241-005 to -008

179

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

180

005 Offset: Bk

*ENG

006 Offset: M

*ENG

These are additional values for calculating the


charge bias referring to the development bias at
process control.

007 Offset: C

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 140 / 1 V/step]

008 Offset: Y

*ENG

DC charge bias = Development bias x (1 + 0.001


x SP3-241-001 to -004) + these values

3242

[LD Power Setting]


Adjusts the coefficient for LD power control value at the process control.

001 StdSpd:Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 101 / 1 /step]

002 StdSpd:Coefficient: M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 62 / 1 /step]

003 StdSpd:Coefficient: C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 99 / 1 /step]

004 StdSpd:Coefficient: Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 74 / 1 /step]

005 StdSpd:Offset: Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 69 / 1 /step]

006 StdSpd:Offset: M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 95 / 1 /step]

007 StdSpd:Offset: C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 63 / 1 /step]

008 StdSpd:Offset: Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 82 / 1 /step]

009 MidSpd:coef:Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 101 / 1 /step]

010 MidSpd:coef:M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 62 / 1 /step]

011 MidSpd:coef:C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 99 / 1 /step]

012 MidSpd:coef:Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 74 / 1 /step]

013 MidSpd:offset:Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 69 / 1 /step]

014 MidSpd:offset:M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 95 / 1 /step]

015 MidSpd:offset:C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 63 / 1 /step]

016 MidSpd:offset:Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 82 / 1 /step]

017 LowSpd:Coef:Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 81 / 1 /step]

018 LowSpd:Coef:M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 61 / 1 /step]

019 LowSpd:Coef:C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 86 / 1 /step]

System SP3-xxx

020 LowSpd:Coef:Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 67 / 1 /step]

021 LowSpd:offset:Bk

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 82 / 1 /step]

022 LowSpd:offset:M

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 92 / 1 /step]

023 LowSpd:offset:C

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 68 / 1 /step]

024 LowSpd:offset:Y

*ENG

[-1000 to 1000 / 87 / 1 /step]

3243

[DevBias_SpdCorrectSetting]
Adjusts the coefficient or offset value for development bias correction for each speed.

001 MidSpd:Coef:Bk

*ENG

002 MidSpd:Coef:M

*ENG

003 MidSpd:Coef:C

*ENG

004 MidSpd:Coef:Y

*ENG

005 MidSpd:offset:Bk

*ENG

006 MidSpd:offset:M

*ENG

007 MidSpd:offset:C

*ENG

008 MidSpd:offset:Y

*ENG

009 LowSpd:Coef:Bk

*ENG

[0.5 to 1.5 / 0.9 / 0.01 /step]

010 LowSpd:Coef:M

*ENG

[0.5 to 1.5 / 0.91 / 0.01 /step]

011 LowSpd:Coef:C

*ENG

012 LowSpd:Coef:Y

*ENG

013 LowSpd:offset:Bk

*ENG

014 LowSpd:offset:M

*ENG

015 LowSpd:offset:C

*ENG

016 LowSpd:offset:Y

*ENG

3251

[0.5 to 1.5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 V/step]

[0.5 to 1.5 / 0.9 / 0.01 /step]

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 V/step]

[Coverage]
These (-001 to -016) are coefficients for SP3-222-009 to -012.
181

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Latest Pixel: Bk

*ENG

002 Latest Pixel: M

*ENG

Displays the latest coverage for each color.

003 Latest Pixel: C

*ENG

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]

004 Latest Pixel: Y

*ENG

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.

005-008 "Average S" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-017.
005 Average S: Bk

*ENG

006 Average S: M

*ENG

007 Average S: C

*ENG

008 Average S: Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
009-012 "Average M" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-018.
009 Average M: Bk

*ENG

010 Average M: M

*ENG

011 Average M: C

*ENG

012 Average M: Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
013-016 "Average L" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3-251-019.
013 Average L: Bk

*ENG

014 Average L: M

*ENG

015 Average L: C

*ENG

016 Average L: Y

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]

017-019 Adjusts the threshold for SP3-251-005 to -016.


017 Total Page Setting: S

182

*ENG

[1 to 100 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

System SP3-xxx

018 Total Page Setting: M

*ENG

[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

019 Total Page Setting: L

*ENG

[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]

020-023 Adjusts the threshold for SP3-251-024 to -027.


020 Total Page Setting: S2

*ENG

[1 to 100 / 40 / 1 sheet/step]

021 Total Page Setting: M2

*ENG

[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]

022 Total Page Setting: L2

*ENG

[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]

024-027 Displays the latest coverage ratio for each color.


024 Latest Coverage: Bk

*ENG

025 Latest Coverage: M

*ENG

026 Latest Coverage: C

*ENG

027 Latest Coverage: Y

*ENG

028

3311

[0 to 100 / - / 0.01 %/step]

Displays the threshold of whether to perform developer churning or not.


DevMix Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]

[ID Sensor Detection Value: Vofset]


Displays the ID sensor (regular) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.
001 Voffset reg: Bk

*ENG

002 Voffset reg: M

*ENG

003 Voffset reg: C

*ENG

004 Voffset reg: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

005-007 Displays the ID sensor (diffusion) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.
005 Voffset dif: M

*ENG

006 Voffset dif: C

*ENG

007 Voffset dif: Y

*ENG

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

008-010 Displays the ID sensor offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.

183

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3321

*ENG

009 Voffset TM (Center)

*ENG

010 Voffset TM (Rear)

*ENG

Execute the ID sensor initialization setting for


all sensors

[Vsg Adjustment Result: Vsg]


Displays the result value of the Vsg adjustment for each sensor.

001 Vsg reg: Bk

*ENG

002 Vsg reg: M

*ENG

003 Vsg reg: C

*ENG

004 Vsg reg: Y

*ENG

005 Vsg dif: M

*ENG

006 Vsg dif: C

*ENG

007 Vsg dif: Y

*ENG

008 Vsg TM (Front)

*ENG

009 Vsg TM (Center)

*ENG

010 Vsg TM (Rear)

*ENG

3323

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vsg Adjustment: Execution]

010 P/TM Sensor All

3322

184

008 Voffset TM (Front)

[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vsg Adjustment Result: Ifsg] DFU

001 Ifsg: Bk

*ENG

002 Ifsg: M

*ENG

003 Ifsg: C

*ENG

004 Ifsg: Y

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 0 / 0.1 mA/step]

System SP3-xxx

005 Ifsg TM (Front)

*ENG

006 Ifsg TM (Center)

*ENG

007 Ifsg TM (Rear)

*ENG

3324

[0 to 50 / 0 / 0.1 mA/step]

[Vsg Adjustment: Set] DFU

003 Vofset Error Counter

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 0 / 0.1 time/step]

004 Vofset Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 V/step]

005 Vsg Upper Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4.5 / 0.01 V/step]

006 Vsg Lower Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3.5 / 0.01 V/step]

[Vsg Adjustment Result]


3325

Displays the result of the Vsg adjustment.


The displayed numbers mean the result of each sensor (sensor for Front, sensor for Bk, sensor
for Cyan, sensor for Center, sensor for Magenta, sensor for Yellow and sensor for Rear).

001 Latest

*ENG

002 Latest 1

*ENG

003 Latest 2

*ENG

004 Latest 3

*ENG

005 Latest 4

*ENG

006 Latest 5

*ENG

007 Latest 6

*ENG

008 Latest 7

*ENG

009 Latest 8

*ENG

010 Latest 9

*ENG

3361

[111111 to 999999 / 999999 / 1 /step]


9: Unexpected error
3: Offset voltage error
2: Vsg adjustment value error
1: O.K

[ID Sensor Sensitivity: Display] Not Used

185

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 K2K (Latest)

*ENG

002 K5K (Latest)

*ENG

003 K2M (Latest)

*ENG

004 K5M (Latest)

*ENG

005 K2C (Latest)

*ENG

006 K5C (Latest)

*ENG

007 K2Y (Latest)

*ENG

008 K5Y (Latest)

*ENG

3362

[ID Sensor Sensitivity: Setting] DFU

001 K2: Upper

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.32 / 0.01 /step]

002 K2: Lower

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.22 / 0.01 /step]

003 K5: Upper

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 5 / 0.01 /step]

004 K5: Lower

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01 /step]

005 Kn: Lower

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01 /step]

006 Kn: Upper

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

007 K5 Edit Point

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.15 / 0.01 /step]

008 K5 Target Voltage

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.63 / 0.01 V/step]

009 K5 Approximate Method

*ENG

010

186

[0 to 5 / - / 0.0001 /step]

K2: Upper/Lower Limit


Coefficient 1

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0:Linear, 1: Curve

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0 / 0.01 /step]

011 K2: Upper Limit Correction

*ENG

[0.2 to 0.4 / 0.03 / 0.01 /step]

012 K2: Lower Limit Correction

*ENG

[0.2 to 0.4 / 0.03 / 0.01 /step]

013 Diffusion Correction: M

*ENG

014 Diffusion Correction: C

*ENG

015 Diffusion Correction: Y

*ENG

[0.75 to 1.35 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

System SP3-xxx

016 K2: Check: M

*ENG

017 K2: Check: C

*ENG

018 K2: Check: Y

*ENG

3363

[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.001 /step]

[ID Pattern Timing Setting] DFU

001 Scan YCMBk

*ENG

Adjusts the detection timing for the process


control pattern.
[-500 to 500 / 13.7 / 1 mm/step]

002 Detection Delay Time

*ENG

Adjusts the timing when the paper transfer unit is


kept away from the image transfer belt.
[0 to 2500 / 0 / 1 msec/step]

003 Delay Time

*ENG

Adjusts the processing timing for the process


control pattern.
[0 to 2500 / 880 / 1 msec/step]

004 MUSIC Delay Time

*ENG

Adjusts the processing timing for the pattern that


is used for the line position adjustment.
[-2500 to 2500 / 300 / 1 msec/step]

3371

[M/A Calculation] DFU

001 Correction Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

002 Correction Coefficient: M

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

003 Correction Coefficient: C

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

004 Correction Coefficient: Y

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

005 Correction Coefficient: Bk

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

006 Correction Coefficient: M

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1 / 0.01 /step]

007 Correction Coefficient: C

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 0.96 / 0.01 /step]

008 Correction Coefficient: Y

*ENG

[0.5 to 2.0 / 1.04 / 0.01 /step]

187

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

3401

Adjusts the toner supply rate in the fixed toner supply mode.

001 Fixed Rate: Bk

*ENG

002 Fixed Rate: M

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 %/step]

003 Fixed Rate: C

*ENG

These SPs are used only when SP3-044 is set to


"1".

004 Fixed Rate: Y

*ENG

3411

[Toner Supply Rate: Display]


Displays the current toner supply rate.

001 Latest: Bk

*ENG

002 Latest: M

*ENG

003 Latest: C

*ENG

004 Latest: Y

*ENG

3421

[0 to 100 / - / 1 %/step]

[Toner Supply Range]

001 Upper Limit: Bk

*ENG

002 Upper Limit: M

*ENG

Adjusts the toner supply rate during printing.

003 Upper Limit: C

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 100 / 1%/step]

004 Upper Limit: Y

*ENG

005 Minimum Supply Time: Bk

*ENG

006 Minimum Supply Time: M

*ENG

Adjusts the minimum toner supply time.

007 Minimum Supply Time: C

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]

008 Minimum Supply Time: Y

*ENG

3451

188

[Fixed Supply Mode]

[Toner Supply Carry Over: Display] DFU

System SP3-xxx

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

3452

[Toner Supply Carry Over: Setting] DFU

001 Maximum: Bk

*ENG

002 Maximum: M

*ENG

003 Maximum: C

*ENG

004 Maximum: Y

*ENG

3501

3
[0 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 msec/step]

[Process Control Target M/A]


Adjusts the target M/A.

001 Maximum M/A: Bk

*ENG

002 Maximum M/A: M

*ENG

003 Maximum M/A: C

*ENG

004 Maximum M/A: Y

*ENG

3510

[0 to 10000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]

[0 to 1 / 0.444 / 0.001 mg/cm2/step]

[Pixel Adj. Sheet Counter: Display]


Displays the total page counter for each adjustment mode.

189

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Potential Control: BW

*ENG

002 Potential Control: FC

*ENG

003 Power ON: BW

*ENG

004 Power ON: FC

*ENG

005 MUSIC: BW

*ENG

006 MUSIC: FC

*ENG

007 Vsg Adj.

*ENG

008 Charge AC Control

*ENG

009 MUSIC: Power ON: BW

*ENG

010 MUSIC: Power ON: FC

*ENG

3511

190

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]

[Execution Interval: Setting]


Adjusts the threshold for each adjustment mode.

001 Job End: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]

002 Job End: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]

003 Interrupt: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

004 Interrupt: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]

005 Initial: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 250 / 1 page/step]

006 Initial: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 100 / 1 page/step]

007 Vsg Adj. Counter

*ENG

008 Charge AC Control Counter

*ENG

019 Environmental Correction

*ENG

020 Gamma Correction

*ENG

021 Non-use Time Correction

*ENG

022 Correction Coefficient 1: JE: BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.2 / 0.01 page/step]

023 Correction Coefficient 2: JE: BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Not Correct (OFF),
1: Correct (ON)

System SP3-xxx

024 Correction Coefficient 1: JE: FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]

025 Correction Coefficient 2: JE: FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

026

Correction Coefficient 1: Interrupt:


BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01/step]

027

Correction Coefficient 2: Interrupt:


BW

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

028

Correction Coefficient 1: Interrupt:


FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.01/step]

029

Correction Coefficient 2: Interrupt:


FC

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]

030 Max. Number Correction Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 5 / 1/step]

031 Max. Number Correction Counter

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]

3512

[Image Quality Adj.: Interval]


Adjusts the timing for execution of process control and line position adjustment.

001 During Job

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 page/step]

002 During Stand-by

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 minute/step]

[PCDU Motor Stop Time: Bk]


3513

Displays the last time that the PCDU motors stopped.


These are used for process control execution timing.

001 Year

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 0 / 1/step]

002 Month

*ENG

[1 to 12 / 1 / 1/step]

003 Date

*ENG

[1 to 31 / 1 / 1/step]

004 Hour

*ENG

[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]

005 Minute

*ENG

[0 to 59 / 0 / 1/step]

191

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Environmental Display: Job End]


3514

Displays the environmental conditions for the last job.


These are used for process control execution timing.

001 Temperature

*ENG

[-1280 to 1270 / - / 0.1C/step]

002 Relative Humidity

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1%RH/step]

003 Absolute Humidity

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1 g/cm3/step]

[Execution Interval: Display]


3515

Displays the current interval for process control execution.


When the machine calculates the timing for process control, it uses a number of conditions.
These are the results after considering all the conditions.

001 Job End: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

002 Job End: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]

003 Interrupt: Potential Control: BW

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 500 / 1 page/step]

004 Interrupt: Potential Control: FC

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 200 / 1 page/step]

[Refresh Mode] DFU


3516

192

While making prints with low coverage, the developer is agitated with less toner consumption
and the toner carrier attraction tends to increase. This may cause low image density or poor
transfer (white dots). To prevent this, the coagulated toner or overcharged toner has to be
consumed by performing the refresh mode.

001 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: Bk

*ENG

002 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: M

*ENG

003 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: C

*ENG

004 Dev. Motor Rotation: Display: Y

*ENG

005 Rotation Threshold

*ENG

[0 to 1000 / 0 / 0.1 m/step]

[0 to 1000 / 1 / 1 m/step]

System SP3-xxx

006 Pixel Coverage Sum: Bk

*ENG

007 Pixel Coverage Sum: M

*ENG

008 Pixel Coverage Sum: C

*ENG

009 Pixel Coverage Sum: Y

*ENG

010 Required Area: Bk

*ENG

011 Required Area: M

*ENG

012 Required Area: C

*ENG

013 Required Area: Y

*ENG

014 Refresh Threshold: Bk

*ENG

015 Refresh Threshold: M

*ENG

016 Refresh Threshold: C

*ENG

017 Refresh Threshold: Y

*ENG

018 Pattern Generation Number: Bk

*ENG

019 Pattern Generation Number: M

*ENG

020 Pattern Generation Number: C

*ENG

021 Pattern Generation Number: Y

*ENG

022 Pattern Generation Number: Upper limit

*ENG

023 Toner Consumption Pattern Area

*ENG

[10 to 2550 / 300 / 10 cm2/


step]

024 Supply Coefficient

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01/step]

025 Job End Area Coefficient

*ENG

[0.1 to 25.5 / 1 / 0.1/step]

026 Job End Vb Coefficient

*ENG

[0 to 100 / 40 / 1%/step]

027 Job End Length

*ENG

[0 to 56 / 12 / 1mm/step]

028 Job End Supply

*ENG

[0 to 1 / 0.45 / 0.001 mg/cm2/


step]

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]

[0 to 255 / 14 / 1 cm2/m/step]

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 time/step]

193

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Blade damage prevention mode]


3517

Adjusts the threshold temperature for preventing the cleaning blade in the transfer belt
cleaning unit from being damaged. If the temperature is above this value, toner is applied
to the transfer belt at set intervals during the job to prevent the blade from flipping over.

001 Execution Temp. Threshold

3518

*ENG

[0 to 50 / 40 / 1C/step]

[Image Quality Adj. Execution Flag] DFU

001 Toner End Recovery: Bk

*ENG

002 Toner End Recovery: M

*ENG

003 Toner End Recovery: C

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

004 Toner End Recovery: Y

*ENG

0: OFF. 1: ON

005 Vsg Adj.

*ENG

006 Developer Mixing

*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]

007 Process Control

*ENG

0: OFF. 1: ON (once),
2: ON (twice)
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]

008 MUSIC

*ENG

0: OFF. 1: ON (once),
2: ON (twice)

009 MUSIC (Skew Correction)

*ENG

010 Charge AC Control

*ENG

011 Blade Damage Prevention

*ENG

3519

194

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF. 1: ON

[Toner End Prohibition Setting]


Enables or disables each adjustment at toner near end.

System SP3-xxx

001 Process Control

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]

002 MUSIC

*ENG

0: Permit (adjustment is done even toner near


end condition)

003 TC Adj.

*ENG

1: Forbid (adjustment is not done at toner near


end condition)

3520

[ITB Idling Number]


Specifies the number of the ITB idling rotation for each condition.

001 Temperature: H

*ENG

002 Temperature: M

*ENG

003 Temperature: L

*ENG

004 Temperature: L: Power ON

*ENG

[0 or 3 / 0 / 1 revolution/step]

[Temperature Threshold]
3521

Specifies the threshold temperature for each condition. These settings affect the conditions
of SP3-520.
t1: Threshold between L (low temp.) and M (medium temp.)
t2: Threshold between M (medium temp.) and H (high temps)

001 Threshold: t2

*ENG

[20 or 30 / 25 / 1 deg/step]

002 Threshold: t1

*ENG

[0 or 15 / 15 / 1 deg/step]

[Initial Process Control Setting]


3522

Adjusts the threshold for the process control at power on.


When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when
compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process control at power on is
executed.

002 Non-use Time Setting

*ENG

[0 to 1440 / 360 / 1 minute/step]

003 Temperature Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1C/step]

004 Relative Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

005 Absolute Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]

195

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Rapi_timer]
100 Time Setting

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 30 / 1 sec/step]

Adjusts the time-out time for the Rapi timer.


[Non-use Time Process Control Setting]

3531

Adjusts the threshold for the process control at stand-by.


When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when
compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process control at stand-by is
executed.

001 Non-use Time Setting

*ENG

[0 to 1440 / 360 / 1 minute/step]

002 Temperature Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1C/step]

003 Relative Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]

004 Absolute Humidity Range

*ENG

[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]

*ENG

Adjusts the maximum execution time for the


process control at stand-by.

005 Maximum Execution Number

[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 time/step]
3611

196

[Development Gamma: Display/Set]

001 Bk (Current)

*ENG

002 M (Current)

*ENG

Displays the current development gamma for


each color.

003 C (Current)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / - / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

004 Y (Current)

*ENG

005 Bk (Target Display)

*ENG

006 M (Target Display)

*ENG

Displays the target development gamma for


each color.

007 C (Target Display)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.91 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

008 Y (Target Display)

*ENG

System SP3-xxx

009 Bk (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

010 M (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

Displays the standard target development


gamma for each color.

011 C (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 0.8 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

012 Y (Standard Target Set)

*ENG

013 Environmental Correction

*ENG

Turns on or off the environmental correction for


target development gamma.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not Correct, 1: Correct

014 K (Max Correction)

*ENG

015 M (Max Correction)

*ENG

016 C (Max Correction)

*ENG

017 Y (Max Correction)

*ENG

018 K (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

019 M (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

020 C (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

021 Y (Max Abs Hum)

*ENG

3612

Adjusts the maximum correction value for each


color. These SPs are effective only when the
setting of SP3-611-013 is set to "1".
[0 to 5 / 0.15 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kv/step]

Adjusts the maximum humidity correction value


for each color. These SPs are effective only when
the setting of SP3-611-013 is set to "1".
[1 to 99 / 20 / 1 g/m3/step]

[Vk Display]
Displays Vk for each color.

001 Bk

*ENG

002 M

*ENG

003 C

*ENG

004 Y

*ENG

[-300 to 300 / - / 1 V/step]

[Development DC Control: Display]


3621

Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the development DC bias adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.

197

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2 & FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2 & FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2 & FINE: Y

*ENG

3622

[0 to 700 / 550 / 1 -V/step]

[0 to 700 / 550 / 1 -V/step]

[0 to 700 / 550 / 1 -V/step]

[Development DC Control] DFU


Adjusts the limit of VB.

001 VB Limit

*ENG

[0 to 500 / 50 / 1 V/step]

[Charge DC Control: Display]


3631

Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the charge DC voltage adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.

198

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 690 / 1 -V/step]

System SP3-xxx

005 Thick 1 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1 & FINE: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1 & FINE: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1& FINE: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2 & FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2 & FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2 & FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 2000 / 690 / 1 -V/step]

[0 to 2000 / 690 / 1 -V/step]

[Charge AC Control: Display]


3641

Plain: High speed


Displays the charge AC voltage adjusted with the process control for each color.

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 1.75 / 0.01 kV/step]

[LD Power Control: Display]


3651

Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the LD power adjusted for each environment.

001 Plain: Bk

*ENG

002 Plain: M

*ENG

003 Plain: C

*ENG

004 Plain: Y

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 %/step]

199

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

005 Thick 1: Bk

*ENG

006 Thick 1: M

*ENG

007 Thick 1: C

*ENG

008 Thick 1: Y

*ENG

009 Thick 2 & FINE: Bk

*ENG

010 Thick 2 & FINE: M

*ENG

011 Thick 2 & FINE: C

*ENG

012 Thick 2 & FINE: Y

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 %/step]

[0 to 200 / 100 / 1 %/step]

[HST Concentration Control: Set]


3710

TD Sensor: Toner Concentration Control Setting


Selects the toner concentration control method by HST memory, which is in the TD sensor.

001 Control Method: Selection

3711

200

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not Use, 1: Use

[HST Concentration Control: Bk]


Displays the factory settings of the black PCDU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 1.05 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

System SP3-xxx

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3712

[HST Concentration Control: M]


Displays the factory settings of the magenta PCDU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3713

[0 to 2.55 / 1.05 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[HST Concentration Control: C]


Displays the factory settings of the cyan PCDU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
201

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3714

202

[0 to 2.55 / 1.05 / 0.01 V/step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[HST Concentration Control: Y]


Displays the factory settings of the yellow PCDU.

001 Vcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]

002 Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 2.5 / 0.1 V/step]

003 Sensitivity: HL

*ENG

[1.22 to 3.77 / 2.1 / 0.01 V/step]

004 Sensitivity: HM

*ENG

005 Sensitivity: ML

*ENG

006 Set Detection

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]

007 Without Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.2 / 0.1 V/step]

008 With Developer

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 1.3 / 0.1 V/step]

[0 to 2.55 / 1.05 / 0.01 V/step]

System SP3-xxx

009 Serial Number 1

*ENG

010 Serial Number 2

*ENG

011 Adjustment: Vt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

012 Adjustment: Vtref

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]

013 Adjustment: Vtcnt

*ENG

[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]

014 Adjustment: Gamma

*ENG

[0 to 2.55 / 0 / 0.01 mg/cm2/kV /step]

015 Adjustment: Vcnt Result

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]

3800

[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]

[Toner Collection Bottle Full Detection]


Displays/ adjusts the toner collection bottle detection settings. These SPs are used for NRS.

001 Condition

*CTL

[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]

002 Detection Times

*CTL

[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]

003 Print Page After Near Full

*CTL

[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

004 Pixel Count After Near Full

*CTL

[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]

*CTL

Displays the pixel counter after replacement of


toner collection bottle.

005 Pixel Count After Replacement

[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
008 Coefficient

*ENG

[0.5 to 1.5 / 1 / 0.1 /step]


Enables or disables the calling for @Remote.

Notice Setting

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Enable @Remote calling
1: Disable @Remote calling

011
NOTE:

If the toner collection bottle has been replaced before the machine detects used toner near
full when this setting is set to "0", the machine cannot detect toner collection bottle near full.
In that case, set SP3-902-017 to "1".

203

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Day Threshold: Toner


Collection bottle:NF

*ENG

[1 to 30 / 5 / 1 day/step]

012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the toner collection bottle is
displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the toner collection
bottle.

013 Total:Toner Collection Bottle

*ENG

014 Mechanism Full Detection Date

*ENG

3900

[0 to 999999999 / 1 / 1]
Displays the date of the full detection fot the
toner collection bottle.

[Waste Toner Full Detection]


Turns toner collection bottle full detection on or off.

001 ON/OFF Setting

3901

Displays the total amount of the used toner.

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

[New PCDU Detection]


Turns new PCDU detection on or off.

001 ON/OFF Setting

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

[Manual New Unit Set]


3902

204

Turns the new unit detection flag for each PM unit on or off.
The use of these counters is explained in the PM section and in the relevant parts of section
3 (Replacement and Adjustment).

001 Development Unit: Bk

*ENG

002 Development Unit: Y

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

003 Development Unit: C

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

004 Development Unit: M

*ENG

System SP3-xxx

005 Developer: Bk

*ENG

006 Developer: Y

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

007 Developer: C

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

008 Developer: M

*ENG

009 PCDU: Bk

*ENG

010 PCDU: Y

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

011 PCDU: M

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

012 PCDU: C

*ENG

013 Image Transfer Unit

*ENG

014 Fusing Unit

*ENG

0: OFF, 1: ON

015 Cleaning Unit

*ENG

Do not use 3902-013 if you only change the


cleaning unit.

016 Paper Transfer Unit

*ENG

017 Toner Collection Bottle

*ENG

3902-015: This is for the image transfer belt


cleaning unit.

018 Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

019 Pressure Roller

3903

*ENG

"Fusing Roller" is designated as "Heating Roller"


in this manual.

Last Print Counter


Displays the rotation counter of the black development unit at five minutes interval.

205

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Counter 1

*ENG

002 Counter 2

*ENG

003 Counter 3

*ENG

004 Counter 4

*ENG

005 Counter 5

*ENG

006 Counter 6

*ENG

007 Counter 7

*ENG

008 Counter 8

*ENG

009 Counter 9

*ENG

010 Counter 10

*ENG

011040

Counter 11 to 40

101 Last Fixed Date


102

206

Last PM Counter Save


Destination

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step]

*ENG
*ENG

Displays the time of the latest stored counter.

*ENG

Displays the counter number of the latest


stored counter.

System SP4-xxx

System SP4-xxx
SP4-XXX (Scanner)

4008

001

[Sub Scan Magnification Adjustment]


Adjusts the sub-scan magnification by changing the scanner motor speed.
Sub Scan Magnification
Adjustment

*ENG

[-1.0 to 1.0 / 0 / 0.1%/step] FA

[Leading Edge Registration Adjustment]


4010

Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the scanning start timing in the sub-scan
direction.

001

*ENG

[-2.0 to 2.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step] FA

[Side-to-Side registration Adjustment]


4011

Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the scanning start timing in the main scan
direction.

001 -

*ENG

[-2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

[Scanner Erase Margin: Scale] Scanner: Erase Margin: Scale


4012

Sets the blank margin at each side for erasing the original shadow caused by the gap
between the original and the scale.

001 Book: Leading Edge


002 Book: Trailing Edge
003 Book: Left

*ENG

[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

*ENG

[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ] FA

004 Book: Right


005 ADF: Leading Edge
007 ADF: Right
008 ADF: Left

207

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Scanner Free Run]


4013

Performs the scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off in the following mode.
Full color mode / Full Size / A3 or DLT

001 Lamp: ON
002 Lamp: OFF

4014

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

[Scan]
Execute the scanner free fun with each mode.

001 HP Detection Enable

Scanner free run with HP sensor check.

002 HP Detection Disable

Scanner free run without HP sensor check.

4020

[Dust Check]
Turns the ADF scan glass dust check on/ off.

001 Detection: ON/OFF

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Selects the detect level.

002 Dust Detect: Level

*ENG

[0 to 8 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: lowest detection level
8: highest detection level
Selects the level of the sub scan line correction
when using the ARDF.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]

003 Correction Level

*ENG

0: Off
1: Weakest
2: Weak
3: Strong
4: Strongest

208

011 Dust Detect:On/Off:Rear

*ENG

Not used

012 Dust Detect:Lvl:Rear

*ENG

Not used

System SP4-xxx

[APS Operation Check]


4301

Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original sensors. (See "Input
Check Table".)

001 APS Operation Check

4303

[APS Min Size (A5/HLT/16K)]


Specifies the result of the detection when the outputs from the original sensors are all OFF.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]

001

APS Min. Size (A5/HLT/


16K)

*ENG

0: No Original
1: A5-Lengthwise (16K SEF if 4305 is set to 3)
2: A5-Sideways (16K LEF if 4305 is set to 3)
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]

4305

[8K/16K Detection]

*ENG

0: Normal Detection (the machine detects A4/LT


size as A4 or LT, depending on the paper size setting)
1: A4-Sideways LT-Lengthwise
2: LT-Sideways A4-Lengthwise
3: 8K 16K

001 This program enables the machine to automatically recognize the 8K/16K size.
4308

[Scan Size Detection]


[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Detection ON/OFF

*ENG

0: OFF
1: ON

001

Turns on or off the CCD original size detection. This detection is used only when an original
is scanned in book scanning mode.
4309

[Scan Size Detect:Setting]


Original Density Thresh

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 32 / 1 digit/step]

001 Specifies the threshold between an original area and non-original area for the scan original
size detection in book scanning mode.

209

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

002

003

Detection Time

*ENG

[20 to 100 / 60 / 20 msec/step]

Specifies the detection time for the scan original size detection in book scanning mode.
Lamp ON:Delay Time

*ENG

[0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec/step]

Specifies the lamp on timing for the scan original size detection in book scanning mode.
[Scan Size Detect Value]

4310

Displays the detected value by CCD. Each detection point for paper size and color is
displayed on the LCD.

001 S1:R

*ENG

002 S1:G

*ENG

003 S1:B

*ENG

004 S2:R

*ENG

005 S2:G

*ENG

006 S2:B

*ENG

007 S3:R

*ENG

008 S3:G

*ENG

009 S3:B

*ENG

[Scanner Erase Margin]


4400

[0 to 255 / - / 1 digit/step]

*ENG

Set the Mask for Original.


These SPs set the area to be masked during platen (book) mode scanning.

210

System SP4-xxx

001 Book: Leading Edge


002 Book: Trailing Edge
003 Book: Left
004 Book: Right

[0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]

005 ADF: Leading Edge


007 ADF: Right

008 ADF: Left

4417

[IPU Test Pattern]


Selects the IPU test pattern.
[0 to 24 / 0 / 1/step ]

001

Test Pattern
Selection

0: Scanned image

13: Grid pattern CMYK

1: Gradation main scan A

14: Color patch CMYK

2: Gradation main scan B

15: Gray pattern (1)

3: Gradation main scan C

16: Gray pattern (2)

4: Gradation main scan D

17: Gray Pattern (3)

5: Gradation sub scan (1)

18: Shading pattern

6: Grid pattern

19: Thin line pattern

7: Slant grid pattern

20: Scanned + Grid pattern

8: Gradation RGBCMYK

21: Scanned + Gray scale

9: UCR pattern

22: Scanned + Color patch

10: Color patch 16 (1)

23: Scanned + Slant Grid C

11: Color patch 16 (2)

24: Scanned + Slant Grid D

12: Color patch 64


4429

[Illegal Copy Output]

001 Copy
002 Scanner

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]

003 Fax

211

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4450
001

002

Black Subtraction ON/OFF

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON

Uses or does not use the black reduction image path.


SH ON/OFF

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step] 0: ON, 1: OFF

Uses or does not use the shading image path.


[Digital AE Set] DFU

4460

Specifies the level of deleting the background in the ADS mode. You can adjust its level for
each scanning method (platen, ADF).

001 Lower Limit

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 364 / 4 digit/step]

002 Background Level

*ENG

[512 to 1532 / 932 / 1 digit/step]

4501

[ACC Target Density]


Selects the ACC result.

001 Copy: K: Text

*ENG

002 Copy: C: Text

*ENG

003 Copy: M: Text

*ENG

004 Copy: Y: Text

*ENG

[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]

005 Copy: K: Photo

*ENG

10: Darkest density

006 Copy: C: Photo

*ENG

007 Copy: M: Photo

*ENG

008 Copy: Y: Photo

*ENG

4505

212

[Scan Image Path Selection]

[ACC Cor:Bright]
Adjusts the offset correction for light areas of the ACC pattern.

System SP4-xxx

001 Text:K

*ENG

002 Text:C

*ENG

003 Text:M

*ENG

004 Text:Y

*ENG

005 Photo:K

*ENG

006 Photo:C

*ENG

007 Photo:M

*ENG

008 Photo:Y

*ENG

4506

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

[ACC Cor:Dark]
Adjusts the offset correction for dark areas of the ACC pattern.

001 Text:K

*ENG

002 Text:C

*ENG

003 Text:M

*ENG

004 Text:Y

*ENG

005 Photo:K

*ENG

006 Photo:C

*ENG

007 Photo:M

*ENG

008 Photo:Y

*ENG

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

[-128 to 127 / 0 / 1 /step]

[Printer Vector Correction]


4540

This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4 Colors [R, G, B,
Option]) for a total of 48 parameters.

213

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001-004 RY Phase: Option/R/G/B


005-008 YR Phase: Option/R/G/B
009-012 YG Phase: Option/R/G/B
013-016 GY Phase: Option/R/G/B
017-020 GC Phase: Option/R/G/B

021-024 CG Phase: Option/R/G/B


025-028 CB Phase: Option/R/G/B

*ENG

Specifies the printer vector correction


value.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

029-032 BC Phase: Option/R/G/B


033-036 BM Phase: Option/R/G/B
037-040 MB Phase: Option/R/G/B
041-044 MR Phase: Option/R/G/B
045-048 RM Phase: Option/R/G/B
4550

[Scanner Application: text/Printing]

4551

[Scanner Application: text]

4552

[Scanner Application: text (Drop Out Coor)]

4553

[Scanner Application: text-Photo]

4554

[Scanner Application: Photo]

4565

[Scanner Application: GrayScale]

4570

[Scanner Application: Color: Text/Photo]

4571

[Scanner Application: Color: Glossy Photo]

4572

[Scanner Application: AutoColor]


MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)

-005

*ENG

[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
0: MTF Off

Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.

214

System SP4-xxx

-006

-007

-008

Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]

Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
Brightness: 1255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.


Contrast: 1255

Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.
Independent Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]

-009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
4580

[FAX Application: Text/Chart]

4582

[FAX Application: Text/Photo]

4583

[FAX Application: Photo]


MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)

*ENG

-005

[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
0: MTF Off

Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-006

-007

-008

Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]

Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
Brightness: 1255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.


Contrast: 1255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.
Independent Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]

-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated

215

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Texture Erase: 0

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]

-010 Sets the erasure level of textures. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. This
SP (suffix "-010") only exists in SP4580, 4582 and 4583.
0: Not activated

4581

[FAX Application: Text] DFU

4584

[FAX Application: Original 1] DFU

4585

[FAX Application: Original 2] DFU


MTF: 0 (Off), 1-15 (Strong)

*ENG

-005

[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
0: MTF Off

Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-006

-007

-008

Smoothing: 0 (x1), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]

Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
Brightness: 1255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for darker, set lower for lighter.


Contrast: 1255

*ENG

[1 to 255 / 128 / 1 /step]

Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.
Independent Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]

-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
4600

216

[SBU Version Display]


[0 to 0xFF / - / 1 /step]

001 SBU_ID

002 GASBU-N_ID

[0 to 0xFF / - / 1 /step]

003 VSP5100_ID

[0 to 0xFF / - / 1 /step]

Displays the ID of the SBU.

System SP4-xxx

4602

[Scanner Memory Access]

001 Scanner Memory Access

002 Address Set

003 Data Set

4603

Enables the read and write check for the SBU


registers.
Not used

[AGC Execution]

001 HP Detection Enable

Executes the AGC.

002 HP Detection Disable

DFU

Opens or closes the FGATE signal. This SP


automatically returns to the default status (close)
after exiting this SP.

4604

[FGATE Open/Close] DFU

001 -

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
4609

[Gray Balance Set: R]

001 Book Read

[-512 to 511 / -46 / 1 digit/step]

002 DF Read

[-512 to 511 / -46 / 1 digit/step]

001 Book Read

[-512 to 511 / -20 / 1 digit/step]

002 DF Read

[-512 to 511 / -20/ 1 digit/step]

001 Book Read

[-512 to 511 / -28 / 1 digit/step]

002 DF Read

[-512 to 511 / -28 / 1 digit/step]

4610

4611

[Gray Balance Set: G]

[Gray Balance Set: B]

217

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4623

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

001 Latest: RE Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the even red signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Latest: RO Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4624

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

001 Latest: GE Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the even green signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Latest: GO Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4625

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

001 Latest: BE Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the


even blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Latest: BO Color

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment) for the


odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

218

System SP4-xxx

4628

[Analog Gain Adjustment] Gain Adjustment: Analog


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

001 Latest: R Color

4629

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
-

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for RE or RO.

002 Latest: RO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment] Gain Adjustment: Digital


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for GE or GO.

001 Latest: GE Color

002 Latest: GO Color

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment] Gain Adjustment: Digital


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for BE or BO.

001 Latest: BE Color

002 Latest: BO Color

4635

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment] Gain Adjustment: Digital

4633

Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

001 Latest: RE Color

4632

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjustment] Gain Adjustment: Analog

001 Latest: B Color

4631

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjustment] Gain Adjustment: Analog

001 Latest: G Color

4630

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[SSCG Correction Set] DFU

219

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Switches SSCG noise cancellation on/off.


0: Off, 1: On
001 Correction ON/OFF

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

002 Adj ON/OFF

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

4636

[SSCG Correction] DFU

001 Execution

Executes the SSCG correction.


[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Normal end

002 Error Flag

1: End during update


2: Do not apply correction

003 Apply 80H

Executes the 80H setting copy.

004 Apply Correction Value

Not used

4637

001 Latest Setting:RE

002 Latest Setting:RO

003 Latest Setting:GE

004 Latest Setting:GO

005 Latest Setting:BE

006 Latest Setting:BO

4638

220

[SSCG Correction Value] DFU

[SSCG Correction Value] DFU

[0 to 255 / 128 / 1 digit/step]

System SP4-xxx

001 Last Setting:RE

*ENG

002 Last Setting:RO

*ENG

003 Last Setting:GE

*ENG

004 Last Setting:GO

*ENG

005 Last Setting:BE

*ENG

006 Last Setting:BO

*ENG

4639

[SSCG Correction Value] DFU

001 Factory Setting:RE

*ENG

002 Factory Setting:RO

*ENG

003 Factory Setting:GE

*ENG

004 Factory Setting:GO

*ENG

005 Factory Setting:BE

*ENG

006 Factory Setting:BO

*ENG

4640

[0 to 255 / 128 / 1 digit/step]

[0 to 255 / 128 / 1 digit/step]

[SSCG Noise Amplitude] DFU

001 Before Adj: RE


002 Before Adj: RO
003 Before Adj: GE
004 Before Adj: GO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

005 Before Adj: BE


006 Before Adj: BO

221

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

007 After Adj: RE


008 After Adj: RO
009 After Adj: GE

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

010 After Adj: GO


011 After Adj: BE

012 After Adj: BO


4645

[Scan Adjust Error]

001 White level

002 Black level

4647

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Read Hard Error]


Displays the result of the SBU connection check.
[0 to 35535 / 0 / 1digit /step]

001 Power-ON

0: OK, Other: SBU connection check failure


If the SBU connection check fails, SC144 occurs.

4654

001

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

Last Correct Value: RE


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the even red signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002

Last Correct Value: RO


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the odd red signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4655

222

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

System SP4-xxx

001

Last Correct Value: GE


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the even green signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002

Last Correct Value: GO


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the odd green signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4656

001

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

Last Correct Value: BE


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the even blue signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002

Last Correct Value: BO


Color

*ENG

Displays the black offset value (rough adjustment)


for the odd blue signal in the CCD circuit board
(color printing speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4658

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

001 Last Correct Value: R Color

4659

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

001 Last Correct Value: G Color

4660

*ENG

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

001 Last Correct Value: B Color

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

223

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4661

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: RE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: RO Color

*ENG

4662

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: GE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: GO Color

*ENG

4663

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

001 Last Correct Value: BE Color

*ENG

002 Last Correct Value: BO Color

*ENG

4673

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


RE: Red Even signal, RO: Red Odd signal

001 Factory Setting: RE Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment for the even red signal in the CCD circuit
board (color printing speed)..
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Factory Setting: RO Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment (rough adjustment) for the odd red
signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4674

224

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


GE: Green Even signal, GO: Green Odd signal

System SP4-xxx

001 Factory Setting: GE Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment (rough adjustment) for the even green
signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Factory Setting: GO Color *ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment (rough adjustment) for the odd green
signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4675

[Black Level Fine Adj. Display]


BE: Blue Even signal, BO: Blue Odd signal

001 Factory Setting: BE Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment (rough adjustment) for the even blue
signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

002 Factory Setting: BO Color

*ENG

Displays the factory setting values of the black level


adjustment (rough adjustment) for the odd blue
signal in the CCD circuit board (color printing
speed).
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

4677

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Red.

001 Factory Setting: R Color

4678

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green.

001 Factory Setting: G Color

*ENG

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

225

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4679

[Analog Gain Adjustment]


Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue.

001 Factory Setting: BE Color

4680

*ENG

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.

001 Factory Setting: RE Color

*ENG

002 Factory Setting: RO Color

*ENG

4681

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.

001 Factory Setting: GE Color

*ENG

002 Factory Setting: GO Color

*ENG

4682

[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Digital Gain Adjustment]


Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.

001 Factory Setting: BE Color

*ENG

002 Factory Setting: BO Color

*ENG

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Scan Image Density Adjustment]


4688

Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF or 1-pass DF.
Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.

001 ARDF

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 98 / 1%/ step ]

002 1-pass DF

*ENG

[50 to 150 / 98 / 1%/ step ]

4690

226

[White Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.

System SP4-xxx

001 RE

002 RO

4691

[White Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.

001 GE

002 GO

4692

002 BO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 RE

002 RO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 GE

002 GO

4695

Displays the peak level of the white level scanning.


-

4694

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[White Level Peak Read]

001 BE

4693

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

[Black Level Peak Read]


Displays the peak level of the black level scanning.

001 BE

002 BO

[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]

227

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

228

4700

[CIS ID Display] Not used

4709

[CIS GB Chart Level: R] Not used

4710

[CIS GB Chart Level: G] Not used

4711

[CIS GB Chart Level: B] Not used

4712

[CIS GB Adj Value: R] Not used

4713

[CIS GB Adj Value: G] Not used

4714

[CIS GB Adj Value: G] Not used

4745

[CIS Image Level Error Flag] Not used

4746

[CIS GB Adj Error Flag] Not used

4747

[CIS GB Adj Error Flag] Not used

4748

[CIS M-Scan White Level: Avg. R] Not used

4749

[CIS M-Scan White Level: Avg. G] Not used

4750

[CIS M-Scan White Level: Avg. B] Not used

4784

[CIS White Level Peak Range: R] Not used

4785

[CIS White Level Peak Range: G] Not used

4786

[CIS White Level Peak Range: B] Not used

4787

[CIS White Level Peak Data: R] Not used

4788

[CIS White Level Peak Data: G] Not used

4789

[CIS White Level Peak Data: B] Not used

4790

[CIS White Level Peak Data: R] Not used

4791

[CIS White Level Peak Data: G] Not used

4792

[CIS White Level Peak Data: B] Not used

4793

[CIS Black Level Data: R] Not used

4794

[CIS Black Level Data: G] Not used

4795

[CIS Black Level Data: B] Not used

4796

[Low Density Color Correction] Not used

System SP4-xxx

4797

[Digital AE: Rear Side] Not used

4798

[CIS LED Duty] Not used

4799

[CIS TEST Pattern] Not used

4802

[DF Shading FreeRun]

001 Lamp ON
002 Lamp OFF

4803

[-1 to 1 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]

Executes the scanner HP detection.

[Home Position]

001 4806

Press "OFF" to stop this free run. Otherwise, the free


run lasts.

[Home Position Adjustment]

001 4804

Executes the scanner free run of shading movement


with exposure lamp on or off.

[Carriage Save]
Moves the carriage from the scanner home
position.

001 -

4807

Dust may fall through the DF exposure glass.


Therefore, do this SP when you transport the
machine a long distance.

[SBU Test Pattern Change]


[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
1: Grid pattern

001 -

2: Gradation main scan


3: Gradation sub scan
4 to 250: Default (Scanning Image)

4808

[Factory Setting Input]

002 Execution Flag

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

229

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

4810

001

[Lamp Clock Selection] DFU


-

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Brand T, 1: Brand U

Selects the scanner lamp brand.


[ACC Data Display]

4902

This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution.
A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

001 R DATA1

*ENG

Photo C Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

002 G DATA1

*ENG

Photo M Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

003 B DATA1

*ENG

Photo Y Patch Level 1 (8-bit)

004 R DATA2

*ENG

Photo C Patch Level 17 (8-bit)

005 G DATA2

*ENG

Photo M Patch Level 17(8-bit)

006 B DATA2

*ENG

Photo Y Patch Level 17 (8-bit)

4905

[Dither Selection] DFU


Changes the parameters for error diffusion.

001 Dither Selection

*ENG

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

[Manual Gamma Adj]


4918

Adjusts the offset data of the printer gamma for yellow in Photo mode.
See Printer Gamma Correction" in the Replacement and Adjustment for how to use.

009 -

4954

[Read/Restore Std]

001 Read New Chart


230

Enter the manual gamma adjustment screen (-001


to 008). For details, see the "Printer Gamma
Correction" in the section "Replace and
Adjustment".

Execute the scanning of the A4 chart.

System SP4-xxx

002 Recall Prev Chart

Clear the data of the scanned A4 chart.

003 Read Std Chart

Execute the scanning of the A4 standard chart.

004 Set Std Chart

Overwrite the standard data.

4958

[Read/Restore Std: Rear] Not used


[IPU Image Path Selection ]

4991

Selects the image path.


Enter the number to be selected using the 10-key pad.
RGB Frame Memory

*ENG

[0 to 11 / 2 / 1 /step ]

0: Scanner input RGB images


001

1: Scanner I/F RGB images


2: RGB images done by Shading correction (Shading ON, Black offset ON)
3: Shading data
4 to 11: Not used

4993

[High Light Correction]


Selects the Highlight correction level.

001 Sensitivity Selection

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest sensitivity
9: strongest sensitivity
Selects the range level of Highlight correction.

002 Range Selection

*ENG

[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest skew correction,
9: strongest skew correction

4994

[Text/Photo Detection Level Adj.]


Selects the definition level between Text and Photo for high compression PDF.

231

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]
001

PDF Sensitivity Level text/


photo

*ENG

0: Text priority
1: Normal
2: Photo priority

[White Paper Detect Level]

4996

Selects the threshold level of the original background density. Increasing this threshold level
machine easily judge that an original is white.
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1 /step]

001 -

*ENG

0: lightest
6: Darkest

232

System SP5-xxx

System SP5-xxx
SP5-XXX (Mode)

5024

[mm/inch Display Selection]


Display units (mm or inch) for custom paper sizes.

001 0:mm 1:inch

*CTL

0: mm (Europe/Asia)
1: inch (USA)

[Accounting Counter]
5045

Selects the counting method.


NOTE: The counting method can be changed only once, regardless of whether the counter
value is negative or positive.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

001 Counter Method

*CTL

0: Developments
1: Prints

5047

[Paper Display]
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.

001 -

5051

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON

[Toner Refill Detection Display]


Enables or disables the toner refill detection display.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] Alphanumeric

5051 1 Toner Refill Detection Display

*CTL

0: ON
1: OFF

5055

[Display IP Address]
Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.

233

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 -

5056

234

0: OFF 1: ON

Display or does not display the coverage counter on the LCD.


*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display

[Toner Remaining Icon Display]


Display or does not display the remaining toner display icon on the LCD.

001 -

5062

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

[Coverage Counter Display]

001 -

5061

*CTL

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display

[Parts Replacement Alert Display]


Display or does not display the PM part yield on the LCD.

001 Drum Unit: Bk

*CTL

002 Drum Unit: M

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

003 Drum Unit: C

*CTL

0: Not display, 1: Display

004 Drum Unit: Y

*CTL

005 Development Unit: Bk

*CTL

006 Development Unit: M

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

007 Development Unit: C

*CTL

0: Not display, 1: Display

008 Development Unit: Y

*CTL

009 Developer: Bk

*CTL

010 Developer: M

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

011 Developer: C

*CTL

0: Not display, 1: Display

012 Developer: Y

*CTL

System SP5-xxx

013 Image Transfer Belt

*CTL

014 Image Transfer Cleaning Unit

*CTL

015 Fusing Unit

*CTL

016 Paper Transfer Roller Unit

*CTL

017 Waster Toner Bottle

*CTL

018 Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)

*CTL

019 Pressure Roller

*CTL

5066

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display

[Parts PM Menu Display Setting]


Display or does not display the "PM parts" button on the LCD.

001 -

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: No display, 1: Display

[Parts PM System Setting]


5067

Selects the service maintenance or user maintenance for each PM parts.


If the user service is selected, PM alert is displayed on the LCD.

001 PCDU:Bk

*CTL

002 PCDU:M

*CTL

003 PCDU:C

*CTL

004 PCDU:Y

*CTL

005 Dev Unit:Bk

*CTL

006 Dev Unit:M

*CTL

007 Dev Unit:C

*CTL

008 Dev Unit:Y

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

[0: Service] or [1: User]

235

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

009 Developer:Bk

*CTL

010 Developer:M

*CTL

011 Developer:C

*CTL

012 Developer:Y

*CTL

013 Int Trans Unit

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

014 Belt Cleaning Unit

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

015 Fusing Unit

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

016 Transfer Roller

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

017 WasteToner Bottle

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

018 Fusing Roller (Heating Roller)

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

019 Pressure Roller

*CTL

[0: Service] or [1: User]

5071

[Set Bypass Paper Size]


-

001

[0: Service] or [1: User]

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up prevents
mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation panel and an actual paper
size on the by-pass tray.
[A3/DLT Double Count] SSP

5104

Specifies whether the counter is double clicked for A3/DLT size prints.
When you have to change this SP, ask your supervisor.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: NO (Normal count)

5104 1 Double Count

*CTL

1: YES (Double count)


2: YES except By-pass (Normal count for unknown
size)

5104*

236

A3/DLT Double Count (SSP)

System SP5-xxx

Specifies whether the counter is doubled for A3/DLT. "Yes" counts except from the bypass
tray. When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are counted twice, that is A4 x2 and LT
x2 respectively.
5113

[Optional Counter Type]


This program specifies the counter type.
0: None, 1: Key card (RK 3, 4)

001

Default Optional Counter


Type

*CTL

2: Key card (down), 3: Prepaid card


4: Coin rack, 5: MF key card

8: Key counter + Vendor


9: Bar-code Printer
This program specifies the external counter type.
External Optional Counter
002
Type

0: None
*CTL

1: Expansion Device 1
2: Expansion Device 2
3: Expansion Device 3

5114

[Optional Counter I/F]

001 MF Key Card Extension

5118

[Disable Copying]

*CTL

[0: Not installed/ 1: Installed (scanning


accounting)]

*CTL

[0: Not disabled/ 1: Disabled]

*CTL

[0: Yes (removed)/ 1: Standby (installed but not


used)/ 2: No (not removed)]

001 This program disables copying.

5120
001

5121
001

[Mode Clear Opt. Counter


Removal]

This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you install or remove
an optional counter, check the settings.
[Counter Up Timing]

*CTL

[0: Feed/ 1: Exit]

This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to "paper feed" and
"paper exit" respectively.

237

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
5126

[F Size Original Setting]

*ENG

0: 8 1/2" x 13" (Foolscap)


1: 8 1/4" x 13" (Folio)
2: 8" x 13" (F)

001 Selects F size original setting.

5127

[APS Mode]

*CTL

[0: Not disabled/ 1: Disabled]

001 This program disables the APS.


5128

[Code Mode With Key/Card Option]

*CTL

001 DFU
5131

[Paper Size Type Selection]

001

*ENG

[0: JP (Japan)/ 1: NA / 2: EU]

The program selects a paper size system from the following alternatives: the AB system (0),
the LT system (1), and the AF system (2).
[0: OFF/ 1: ON]

5148

Size Detection Off

*CTL

0: OFF (Detect)
1: ON (Not Detect)

001 Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection for the by-pass tray.
5150

[By-Pass Length Setting]

*CTL

[0: OFF/ 1: ON]

Determines whether the transfer sheet from the by-pass tray is used or not.
001 Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is limited to 600
mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.
5162

[App. Switch Method]

*CTL

[0: Soft Key Set/ 1: Hard Key Set]

001 This program specifies the switch that selects an application program.

238

System SP5-xxx

[Fax Printing Mode at Optional]


5167

Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device. This SP is used
when the receiving fax is accounted by an external accounting device.

Fax Printing Mode at Optional


001
*CTL
Counter Off

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Automatic printing
1: No automatic printing

[CE Login]
5169

If you will change the printer bit switches, you must log in to service mode with this SP before
you go into the printer SP mode.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

001 CE Login

*CTL

0: Disabled
1: Enabled

5181

[Size Adjust]
Adjusts the paper size for each tray.

001 TRAY 1

*ENG

002 TRAY 2: 1

*ENG

003 TRAY 2: 2

*ENG

004 TRAY 2: 3

*ENG

005 TRAY 2: 4

*ENG

006 TRAY 3/T-LCT: 1

*ENG

007 TRAY 3: 2

*ENG

[0 to 3 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / 1 /step]


0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF, 2: B5 LEF, 3: A5 LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT

239

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

008 TRAY 3: 3

*ENG

009 TRAY 3: 4

*ENG

010 TRAY 4: 1

*ENG

011 TRAY 4: 2

*ENG

012 TRAY 4: 3

*ENG

013 TRAY 4: 4

*ENG

018 LCT

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 to 2 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4LEF, 1: LTLEF, 2: B5LEF

[RK 4]
5186

Enables or disables the prevention for RK4 (accounting device) disconnection.


If the RK4 is disconnected for 10 seconds when this SP is set to "1 (Enable)", the machine
automatically jams a sheet of paper and stops.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]

001 -

*ENG

0: Disable
1: Enable

5188

[Copy NV Version]
Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.

001 5191

240

[Mode Set] DFU

System SP5-xxx

001

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

Enables or disables the STR (Suspend to RAM) mode.


5193

[External Controller Info. Settings]


-

Sets the external controller type. This setting is appropriately adjusted if an external controller
is installed in the machine.

[0 to 10 / 0 / 1/step]
001 0: No external controller installed
1: EFI controller
2: Ratio controller
3: Egret controller
4 to 10: Reserved
5195

[Limitless SW] DFU


[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
-

*CTL

0: Productivity priority
1: Tray priority

Selects the paper feed mode.


001

Productivity priority:
This changes the feeding tray as soon as the machine detects the priority tray even the paper
still remains in the feeding tray.
Tray priority:
This changes the feeding tray after the paper in the tray where the machine has been feeding
paper has been run out of.
This SP is activated only when a customer selects the "Auto Paper Selsct".

5196

[90 degree rotation (copy)] JPN only

001 5199

*CTL

[Paper Exit After Staple End.]

241

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 -

*CTL

[ 0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: OFF, 1: ON

Enables or disables the paper feeding out from the finisher without stapling.
If this setting is "1: ON", paper is fed out without stapling at the maximum number of
the finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum
number).
If this setting is "0: OFF", paper is fed out with stapling at the maximum number of the
finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum number).

3
5212

[Page Numbering]

*CTL

This program adjusts the position of the second side page numbers.
A " value" moves the page number positions to the left edge. A "+ value" moves the page
number positions to the right edge.
003 Duplex Printout Right/Left Position

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

004 Duplex Printout High/Low Position

[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Set Time]
Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone.
Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.)
DOM: +540 (Tokyo)
5302

NA: -300 (New York)


EU: + 60 (Paris)
CH: +480 (Peking)
TW: +480 (Taipei)
AS: +480 (Hong Kong)

002 Time Difference


5307

242

[Summer Time]

*CTL#

[-1440 to 1440 / Area / 1 min./step ]

System SP5-xxx

[ 0 to 1 / NA, EU, ASIA / 1 /step]


Setting
001

0: Disabled
1: Enabled
NA and EUR: 1, ASIA: 0

Enables or disables the summer time mode.


Make sure that both SP5-307-3 and -4 are correctly set. Otherwise, this SP is not
activated even if this SP is set to "1".
Rule Set (Start)

Specifies the start setting for the summer time mode.


There are 8 digits in this SP. For months 1 to 9, the "0" cannot be input in the first digit, so the
eight-digit setting for -2 or -3 becomes a seven-digit setting.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
003

3rd digit: The week of the month. [1 to 5]


4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 6 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]
7th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 9 / 1 hour /step]
8th digit: The length of the advanced time. [0 to 5 / 10 minutes /step]
The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".
For example: 3500010 (EU default)
The timer is advanced by 1 hour at am 0:00 on the 5th Sunday in March.

243

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Rule Set (End)

Specifies the end setting for the summer time mode.


There are 8 digits in this SP.
1st and 2nd digits: The month. [1 to 12]
004

3rd digit: The week of the month. [0 to 5]


4th digit: The day of the week. [0 to 7 = Sunday to Saturday]
5th and 6th digits: The hour. [00 to 23]

The 7th and 8 digits must be set to "00".


The digits are counted from the left.
Make sure that SP5-307-1 is set to "1".
[Access Control]

5401

When installing the SDK application, SAS (VAS) adjusts the following settings. DFU
Default Document ACL

*CTL

Whenever a new login user is added to the address book in external certification mode
(for Windows, LDAP, RDH), the default document ACL is updated according to this SP
setting.
103

[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
0: View
1: Edit
2: Edit/Delete
3: Full control
Note: This SP setting is ignored on a machine that is not using document server.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 sec./step]

104

Authentication Time

*CTL

0: 60 seconds
1 to 250 seconds

Specifies the timeout of the authentication.


Bit 0: Log-out without an IC card
162

Extend Certification Detail

*CTL

0: Not allowed (default)


1: Allowed

Selects the log out type for the extend authentication device.

244

System SP5-xxx

200 SDK1 Unique ID

*CTL

201 SDK1 Certification Method

*CTL

210 SDK2 Unique ID

*CTL

211 SDK2 Certification Method

*CTL

220 SDK3 Unique ID

*CTL

221 SDK3 Certification Method

*CTL

230 SDK certification device

*CTL

Detail Option

*CTL

"SDK" is the "Software Development Kit". This


data can be converted from SAS (VAS) when
installed or uninstalled. (DFU)

3
-

Enalbes or disables the log out confirmation option.


Bit 0: Log out confirmation option
240

0: Enable (default), 1: Disable


Selects the automatic log out time.
Bit 1 and 2: Automatic log out timer reduction
00: 60 seconds (default), 01: 10 seconds,
10: 20 seconds, 11: 30 seconds

5404

[User Code Counter Clear]


001 UCodeCtrClr

5411

Clears all counters for users.

[LDAP Certification]

004 Easy Certification

*CTL

Determines whether easy LDAP certification is


done.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -] 1: On, 0: Off
This SP is referenced only when SP5411-4 is set to
"1" (On).

005 Password Null Not Permit

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Password NULL not permitted.
1: Password NULL permitted.

245

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

006 Detail Option

*CTL

Determines whether LDAP option (anonymous


certification) is turned on or off.
Bit0
0: OFF, 1: ON

5413

[Lockout Setting]

001 Lockout On/Off

*CTL

Switches on/off the lock on the local address book


account.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

002 Lockout Threshold

*CTL

Sets a limit on the frequency of lockouts for account


lockouts.
[1 to 10 / 5 / 1/step]
Determines whether the system waits the prescribed
time for input of a correct user ID and password
after an account lockout has occurred.

003 Cancellation On/Off

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off (no wait time, lockout not cancelled)
1: On (system waits, cancels lockout if correct user
ID and password are entered.

004 Cancellation Time

*CTL

Determines the length of time that the system waits


for correct input of the user ID and password after
a lockout has occurred. This setting is used only if
SP5413-3 is set to "1" (on).
[1 to 999 / 60 / 1 min./step]

005 Counter Clear Time


5414

*CTL

Not Used

[Access Mitigation]

001 Mitigation On/Off

*CTL

Switches on/off masking of continuously used IDs


and passwords that are identical.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

246

System SP5-xxx

002 Mitigation Time

*CTL

Sets the length of time for excluding continuous


access for identical user IDs and passwords.
[0 to 60 / 15 / 1 min./step]

5415

[Password Attack]

001 Permissible Number

*CTL

Sets the number of attempts to attack the system with


random passwords to gain illegal access to the
system.
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 attempt/step]

002 Detect Time

*CTL

Sets the time limit to stop a password attack once


such an attack has been detected.
[1 to 10 / 5 / 1 sec./step]

5416

[Access Information]

001 Access User Max Number

*CTL

Limits the number of users used by the access


exclusion and password attack detection functions.
[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 users/step]

Access Password Max


002
Number

003 Monitor Interval

*CTL

Limits the number of passwords used by the access


exclusion and password attack detection functions.
[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 password/step]

*CTL

Sets the processing time interval for referencing


user ID and password information.
[1 to 10 / 3 / 1 sec./step]

5417

[Access Attack]

001 Access Permissible Number

*CTL

Sets a limit on access attempts when an excessive


number of attempts are detected for MFP features.
[0 to 500 / 100 / 1/step]

002 Attack Detect Time

*CTL

Sets the length of time for monitoring the frequency


of access to MFP features.
[10 to 30 / 10 / 1 sec./step]

247

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003 Productivity Fall Wait

*CTL

Sets the wait time to slow down the speed of


certification when an excessive number of access
attempts have been detected.
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 sec./step]

004 Attack Max Number

*CTL

Sets a limit on the number of requests received for


certification in order to slow down the certification
speed when an excessive number of access
attempts have been detected.
[50 to 200 / 200 / 1 attempt/step]

[User Authentication]
5420

These settings should be done with the System Administrator.


Note: These functions are enabled only after the user access feature has been enabled.

001 Copy

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required


before a user can use the copy applications.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
0: On, 1: Off

Color Security Setting

*CTL

Enables or disables the color copy limitation for each copy mode when the user
authentication is "ON".
0: Enable (default), 1: Disable
002

Bit0: B/W mode


Bit1: Mono color mode
Bit2: Two colors mode
Bit3: Full color mode
Bit4: Automatic color mode
Bit5 to 7: Reserved

011 Document Server

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the document server.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
0: On, 1: Off

248

System SP5-xxx

021 Fax

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the fax application.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
0: On, 1: Off

031 Scanner

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the scan applications.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
0: On, 1: Off

041 Printer

*CTL

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the printer applications.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
0: On, 1: Off

051 SDK1
061 SDK2

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
*CTL

071 SDK3
5430

Determines whether certification is required before


a user can use the SDK application.

[Auth Dialog Message Change]

001 Message Change On/Off

*CTL

Turns on or off the displayed message change for


the authentication.
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

002 Message Text Download

*CTL

Executes the message download for the


authentication.

003 Message Text ID

*CTL

Inputs message text for the authentication.

5431

[External Auth Preset]

010

Tag

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the tag copy permission for the external authentication.

249

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

011

Entry

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the entry information for the external authentication.

012

Group

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the group information for the external authentication.

3
020

Mail

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the mail information for the external authentication.

030

Fax

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax information for the external authentication.
FaxSub

*CTL

031

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax additional information for the external
authentication.

032

Folder

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the folder information for the external authentication.
ProtectCode

*CTL

033

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the protection code information for the external
authentication.

034

SmtpAuth

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMTP information for the external authentication.

250

System SP5-xxx

035

LdapAuth

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the LDAP information for the external authentication.
Smb Ftp Auth

*CTL

036

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMB/FTP information for the external
authentication.
AcntAcl

*CTL

037

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the account ACL information for the external
authentication.
DocumentAcl

*CTL

038

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the document ACL information for the external
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

CertCrypt

0: Not permit, 1: Permit

040

Turns on or off the copy permission of the authentication information for the external
authentication.
UserLimitCount

*CTL

050

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit

Turns on or off the copy permission of the maximum number information for the external
authentication.

5481

[Authentication Error Code]


These SP codes determine how the authentication failures are displayed.

001 System Log Disp

*CTL

Determines whether an error code appears in the


system log after a user authentication failure occurs.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Off, 1: On

251

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

002 Panel Disp

*CTL

Determines whether an error code appears on the


operation panel after a user authentication failure
occurs.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1]
1: On, 0: Off

5490

[MF Key Card (Japan only)]

Sets up operation of the machine with a keycard.


[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
001 -

*CTL

0: Disabled. Cancels operation without a user


code.
1: Enabled. Allows operation without a user code.

5501

[PM Alarm]

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 PM Alarm Level

0: Alarm off
1 to 9999: Alarm goes off when Value (1 to 9999) x 1000
> PM counter
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]

002 Original Count Alarm

5504

[Jam Alarm]

0: No alarm sounds
1: Alarm sounds after the number of originals passing
through the ARDF > 10,000
*CTL

Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included).
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
001

0: Zero (Off)
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)
3: High (6K jams)

252

System SP5-xxx

[Error Alarm]
Sets the error alarm level.
The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the error alarm
counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a set number of copied sheets
(for example, default 1500 sheets).

5505

The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5".
001 -

5507

[Supply Alarm]

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 255 / C2.5a: 25, C2.5b: 35 / 100 copies /


step]
-

001 Paper Supply Alarm

0: Off, 1: On, DFU

002 Staple Supply Alarm

0: Off, 1: On

003 Toner Supply Alarm

0: Off, 1: On, DFU

080 Toner Call Timing

Changes the timing of the "Toner Supply Call" via the


@Remote, when the following conditions occur.
0: At replacement (default)
1: At near end

128 Interval :Others


132 Interval :A3
133 Interval :A4
134 Interval :A5
141 Interval :B4
142 Interval :B5

[250 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 /step] DFU

160 Interval :DLT


164 Interval :LG
166 Interval :LT
172 Interval :HLT
5508*

[CC Call]

*CTL -

253

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001*

002*

003*

Jam Remains

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call for an unattended paper jam.


Continuous Jams

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call for consecutive paper jams.


Continuous Door Open

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables/disables initiating a call when the front door remains open.


Jam Detection: Time Length

[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute /step]

011* Sets the time a jam must remain before it becomes an "unattended paper jam". This setting
is enabled only when SP5508-004 is set to "1".
Jam Detection: Continuous Count

[2 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]

012* Sets the number of consecutive paper jams required to initiate a call. This setting is enabled
only when SP5508-004 is set to "1".
Door Open: Time Length

[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 /step]

013* Sets the length of time the door remains open before the machine initiates a call.
This setting is enabled only when SP5-508-004 is set to "1".
[SC/Alarm Setting]

254

*CTL

5515

With NRS (New Remote Service) in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when
an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when an SC error
occurs.

001

SC Call

002

Service Parts Near End Call

003

Service Parts End Call

004

User Call

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Off
1: On

System SP5-xxx

006

Communication Test Call

007

Machine Information Notice

008

Alarm Notice

009

Non Genuine Toner Alarm

010

Supply Automatic Ordering Call

011

Supply Management Report Call

012

Jam/Door Open Call

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

[Individual PM Part Alarm


Call]

5516

0: Off
1: On

*CTL

With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an PM alarm call when one of SP
parts reaches its yield.
001

Disable/Enable Setting (0: Not send, 1:


Send)

004 Percent yield for triggering PM alert


5610

005

006

001

0: Not send, 1: Send


[1 to 255 / 75 / 1 %/step]

[Base Gamma Control Point: Command]


004

5611

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

Get Factory Default

Recalls the factory settings.


Set Factory Default

Overwrites the current values onto the factory settings.


Restore Original Value

Recalls the previous settings.


[Toner Color in 2C]
B-C

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.

255

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

B-M

002

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
G-C

003

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.

G-Y

004

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
R-M

005

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
R-Y

006

*ENG

[0 to 128 / 100 / 1 /step]


128: Darkest density

Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
5618

[Color Mode Display Selection]


[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
001

*CTL

0: ACS, Colour, Black & White, Two Colour, Single


colour
1: ACD, Full Colour, Black & White

Selects the color selection display on the LCD.

Memory Clear (SP5-801)


The following tables list the items that are cleared. The serial number information, meter charge setting
and meter charge counters (SP8-581, 582, 583, 584, and 586) are not cleared.
5731

256

[Counter Effect] JPN only

System SP5-xxx

001

5801

Change Mk1 Cnt (Paper>Combine)

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

[Memory Clear]
001 All Clear

Resets all correction data for process control and all


software counters, and returns all modes and adjustments
to their default values.

002 Engine

Clears the engine settings.

003 SCS

Initializes default system settings, SCS (System Control


Service) settings, operation display coordinates, and ROM
update information.

004 IMH Memory Clr

Initializes the IMH settings.

005 MCS

Initializes the MCS settings.

006 Copier application

Initializes all copier application settings.

007 Fax application

Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX settings,
local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer.

The following service settings:


Bit switches
Gamma settings (User & Service)
Toner Limit
008 Printer application

The following user settings:


Tray Priority
Menu Protect
System Setting except for setting of Energy Saver
I/F Setup (I/O Buffer and I/O Timeout)
PCL Menu

009 Scanner application

Initializes the scanner defaults for the scanner and all the
scanner SP modes.

010 Web Service

Deletes the network file application management files and


thumbnails, and initializes the job login ID.

257

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

All setting of Network Setup (User Menu)

011 NCS

(NCS: Network Control Service)


Initializes the job login ID, SmartDeviceMonitor for

012 R-Fax

Admin, job history, and local storage file numbers.

014 Clear DCS Settings

Initializes the DCS (Delivery Control Service) settings.

015 Clear UCS Settings

Initializes the UCS (User Information Control Service)


settings.

016 MIRS Setting

Initializes the MIRS (Machine Information Report Service)


settings.

017 CCS

Initializes the CCS (Certification and Charge-control


Service) settings.

018 SRM Memory Check

Initializes the SRM (System Resource Manager) settings.

019 LCS

Initializes the LCS settings.

020 Web Uapli

Initializes the web user application settings.

021 ECS

Initializes the ECS settings.

[Free Run]
Performs a free run on the copier engine.
5802

The machine starts free run in the same condition as the sequence of A4/LT, A3 or
A4 SEF printing from the 1st or 2nd tray. Therefore, the correct paper should be
loaded in the 1st tray or 2nd tray, but paper is not fed.
The main switch has to be turned off and on after using the free run mode for a test.

258

001 B/W A4 LEF

002 FC A4 LEF

003 FC A3 LEF

5803

[Input Check]

See "Input Check Table" in this section.

5804

[Output Check]

See "Output Check Table" in this section.

System SP5-xxx

5805

[Anti-Condensation Heater]
002 0:OFF / 1:ON

5806

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]

[RFID CONT.READING]
001

002

003

TIMES

[0 to 65535 / - / 1 /step]

Displays the counter for the RFID communication test.


NOT 0

[0 to 65535 / - / 1 /step]

Displays the counter for the RFID communication failure.


RET.

[0 to 65535 / - / 1 /step]

Displays the counter for the RFID communication retry.

004 EXE.ALL

Execute the RFID communication test for all colors.

005 EXE.K

Execute the RFID communication test for balck.

006 EXE.M

Execute the RFID communication test for magenta.

007 EXE.C

Execute the RFID communication test for cyan.

008 EXE.Y

Execute the RFID communication test for yellow.

[SC Reset]
5810

Resets a type A service call condition.


Turn the main switch off and on after resetting the SC code.
001 Fusing SC Reset

5811

5812

[Machine Serial] Machine Serial Number Display


002 Display

Displays the machine serial number.

004 BICU

Inputs the machine serial number.

[Service Tel. No. Setting]

259

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Service

*CTL

001 Sets the telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List, which can be printed with the users "Counter" menu.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Facsimile

*CTL

002 Sets the fax or telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List.

This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Supply

*CTL

003 Use this to input the telephone number of your supplier for consumables. Enter the number
and press #.
Operation

*CTL

004 Use this to input the telephone number of your sales agency. Enter the number and press
#.
5816

[Remote Service]

*CTL

I/F Setting
Selects the remote service setting.
001

[0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step]
0: Remote service off
1: CSS remote service on
2: NRS remote service on
CE Call
Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service.

002

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Start of the service
1: End of the service
NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to "2".

260

System SP5-xxx

Function Flag
Enables or disables the remote service function.
003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
SSL Disable

007

Controls if RCG (Remote Communication Gate) confirmation is done by SSL during an


RCG send for the @Remote over a network interface.

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Yes. SSL not used.
1: No. SSL used.
RCG Connect Timeout

008 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the time-out when the RCG (Remote Communication
Gate) connects during a call via the @Remote network.
[1 to 90 / 30 / 1 second /step]
RCG Write Timeout
009 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the time-out when sent data is written to the RCG during
a call over the @Remote network.
[1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]
RCG Read Timeout
010 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the timeout when sent data is written from the RCG
during a call over the @Remote network.
[1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]
Port 80 Enable

011

Controls if permission is given to get access to the SOAP method over Port 80 on the
@Remote network.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
0: No. Access denied
1: Yes. Access granted.

261

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

RFU Timing
Selects the timing for the remote firmware updating.
013 [0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Any status of a target machine
1: Sleep or panel off mode only
RCG C Registed

021

This SP displays the RCG-N installation end flag.


0: Installation not completed
1: Installation completed
RCG C Regist Detail
This SP displays the RCG device installation status.

022 0: RCG device not registered


1: RCG device registered
2: Device registered
Connect Type (N/M)
This SP displays and selects the RCG-N connection method.
023 [0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step
0: Internet connection
1: Dial-up connection
061 Cert. Expire Timing DFU

Proximity of the expiration of the certification.

062 Use Proxy

This SP setting determines if the proxy server is used when the


machine communicates with the service center.

Proxy Host
This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between the RCG
device and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the customer proxy server address.
063

The address is necessary to set up the embedded RCG-N.


The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128
character are ignored.
This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.

262

System SP5-xxx

Proxy PortNumber
This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication between the
embedded RCG-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to set up the embedded
064
RCG-N.
This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy User Name
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name.

065
The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy Password
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password.
066
The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
067

CERT:Up State
Displays the status of the certification update.
0

The certification used by RCG-N is set correctly.

The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW
URL and certification is presently being updated.

The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
successful update.

The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update.

The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being
sent to the GW URL.

11

A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting
is in progress for the rescue GW connection.

263

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

12

The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
certification update request.

13

The notification of the request for certification update has completed successfully,
and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW
URL.

14

The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW
controller, and the certification is being stored.

15

The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful
completion of this event.

16

The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the
failure of this event.

17

The certification update request has been received from the GW URL, the GW URL
was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but an certification
error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded.

18

The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being
notified of the failure of the certification update.

CERT:Error
Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the
certification.

068

264

Normal. There is no request for certification update in progress.

Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired.

An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired.

Notification of shift from a common authentication to an individual certification.

Notification of a common certification without ID2.

Notification that no certification was issued.

Notification that GW URL does not exist.

069 CERT:Up ID

The ID of the request for certification.

083 FirmUp Status

Displays the status of the firmware update.

System SP5-xxx

085 Firm Up User Check

This SP setting determines if the operator can confirm the


previous version of the firmware before the firmware update
execution. If the option to confirm the previous version is
selected, a notification is sent to the system manager and the
firmware update is done with the firmware files from the URL.

086 Firmware Size

Allows the service technician to confirm the size of the


firmware data files during the firmware update execution.

087 CERT: Macro Version

Displays the macro version of the @Remote certification.

088 CERT: PAC Version

Displays the PAC version of the @Remote certification.

089 CERT: ID2 Code

Displays ID2 for the @Remote certification. Spaces are


displayed as underscores (_). Asteriskes (****) indicate that
no @Remote certification exists.

090 CERT: Subject

Displays the common name of the @Remote certification


subject. CN = the following 17 bytes. Spaces are displayed
as underscores (_). Asterisks (****) indicate that no DESS
exists.

091 CERT: Serial Number

Displays serial number for the NRS certification. Asterisks


(****) indicate that no DESS exists.

092 CERT: Issuer

Displays the common name of the issuer of the @Remote


certification. CN = the following 30 bytes. Asteriskes (****)
indicate that no DESS exists.

093 CERT: Valid Start

Displays the start time of the period for which the current
@Remote certification is enabled.

094 CERT: Valid End

Displays the end time of the period for which the current
@Remote certification is enabled.

Selection Country
Select the country where embedded RCG-M is installed in the machine. After selecting the
country, you must also set the following SP codes for embedded RCG-M:
150

SP5816-153
SP5816-154
SP5816-161
0: Japan, 1: USA, 2: Canada, 3: UK, 4: Germany, 5: France, 6: Italy,
7: Netherlands, 8: Belgium, 9: Luxembourg, 10: Spain

265

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Line Type AutomaticJudgment


Press [Execute].
Setting this SP classifies the telephone line where embedded RCG-M is connected as either
dial-up (pulse dial) or push (DTMF tone) type, so embedded RCG-M can automatically
151 distinguish the number that connects to the outside line.
The current progress, success, or failure of this execution can be displayed with
SP5816-152.

If the execution succeeded, SP5816-153 will display the result for confirmation and
SP5816-154 will display the telephone number for the connection to the outside line.
Line Type Judgment Result
Displays a number to show the result of the execution of SP5816 151. Here is a list of what
the numbers mean.
0: Success
1: In progress (no result yet). Please wait.
2: Line abnormal
152 3: Cannot detect dial tone automatically
4: Line is disconnected
5: Insufficient electrical power supply
6: Line classification not supported
7: Error because fax transmission in progress ioctl() occurred.
8: Other error occurred
9: Line classification still in progress. Please wait.
Selection Dial/Push
This SP displays the classification (tone or pulse) of the telephone line to the access point
for embedded RCG-M. The number displayed (0 or 1) is the result of the execution of
SP5816-151. However, this setting can also be changed manually.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
153 0: Tone Dialing Phone
1: Pulse Dialing Phone
Inside Japan "2" may also be displayed:
0: Tone Dialing Phone
1: Pulse Dialing Phone 10PPS
2: Pulse Dialing Phone 20PPS

266

System SP5-xxx

Outside LineOutgoing Number


The SP sets the number that switches to PSTN for the outside connection for embedded
RCG-M in a system that employs a PBX (internal line).
154

If the execution of SP5816-151 has succeeded and embedded RCG-M has


connected to the external line, this SP display is completely blank.
If embedded RCG-M has connected to an internal line, then the number of the
connection to the external line is displayed.
If embedded RCG-M has connected to an external line, a comma is displayed with
the number. The comma is inserted for a 2 sec. pause.

The number setting for the external line can be entered manually (including commas).
Dial Up User Name

156

Use this SP to set a user name for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules when setting
a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation
marks (").
Dial Up Password

157

Use this SP to set a password for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules when setting
a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation
marks (").
Local Phone Number

161 Use this SP to set the telephone number of the line where embedded RCG-M is connected.
This number is transmitted to and used by the Call Center to return calls.
Limit: 24 numbers (numbers only)
Connection Timing Adjustment: Incoming
When the Call Center calls out to an embedded RCG-M modem, it sends a repeating ID
tone (*#1#). This SP sets the time the line remains open to send these ID tones after the
162 number of the embedded RCG-M modem is dialed up and connected.
[0 to 24 / 1 / 1 /step]
The actual amount of time is this setting x 2 sec. For example, if you set "2" the line will
remain open for 4 sec.

267

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Access Point
This is the number of the dial-up access point for RCG-M. If no setting is done for this SP
163 code, then a preset value (determined by the country selected) is used.
Default: 0
Allowed: Up to 16 alphanumeric characters
164 Line Connecting

This SP sets the connection conditions for the customer. This setting dedicates the line to
RCG-M only, or sets the line for sharing between RCG-M and a fax unit.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Sharing Fax
1: No Sharing Fax
If this setting is changed, the copier must be cycled off and on.
SP5816 187 determines whether the off-hook button can be used to interrupt a RCGM transmission in progress to open the line for fax transaction.
173 Modem Serial Number

This SP displays the serial number registered for the RCG-M.

Retransmission Limit
Normally, it is best to allow unlimited time for certification and ID2 update requests, and
for the notification that the certification has been completed. However, RCG-M generates
174 charges based on transmission time for the customer, so a limit is placed upon the time
allowed for these transactions.
If these transactions cannot be completed within the allowed time, do this SP to cancel the
time restriction.
FAX TX Priority

This SP determines whether pushing the off-hook button will interrupt a RCG-M transmission
in progress to open the line for fax transaction. This SP can be used only if SP5816 164 is
187
set to "0".
[0 or 1/ 0 / - ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
200 Manual Polling

268

Executes the manual polling.

System SP5-xxx

Regist: Status
Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the registered device by the external nor embedded RCG device is set.
1: The embedded RCG device is being set. Only Box registration is completed. In this status,
this
unit cannot answer a polling request from the external RCG.
201
2. The embedded RCG device is set. In this status, the external RCG unit cannot answer a
polling request.
3. The registered device by the external RCG is being set. In this status the embedded RCG
device cannot be set.

4 The registered module by the external RCG has not started.


202 Letter Number

Allows entry of the number of the request needed for the RCGN device.

203 Confirm Execute

Executes the inquiry request to the @Remote GW URL.

204 Confirm Result


Displays a number that indicates the result of the inquiry executed with SP5816 203.
0: Succeeded
1: Inquiry number error
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Inquiry executing
Confirm Place
205 Displays the result of the notification sent to the device from the GW URL in answer to the
inquiry request. Displayed only when the result is registered at the GW URL.
206 Register Execute

Executes "Embedded RCG Registration".

269

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Register Result
Displays a number that indicates the registration result.
0: Succeeded
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
207 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)

5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)


6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Registration executing
208 Error Code
Displays a number that describes the error code that was issued when either SP5816-204
or SP5816-207 was executed.
Cause

Code

Meaning

-11001

Chat parameter error

Illegal Modem Parameter -11002

Chat execution error

-11003

Unexpected error

-12002

Inquiry, registration attempted without


acquiring device status.

-12003

Attempted registration without execution of an


inquiry and no previous registration.

Operation Error, Incorrect


Setting
-12004

-12005

270

Attempted setting with illegal entries for


certification and ID2.
@Remote communication is prohibited. The
device has an Embedded RC gate-related
problem.

System SP5-xxx

-12006

A confirmation request was made after the


confirmation had been already completed.

-12007

The request number used at registration was


different from the one used at confirmation.

Operation Error, Incorrect


Setting
-12008
-12009

ID2 mismatch between an individual


certification and NVRAM

-12010

Certification area is not initialized.

-2385

Attempted dial up overseas without the correct


international prefix for the telephone number.

-2387

Not supported at the Service Center

-2389

Database out of service

-2390

Program out of service

-2391

Two registrations for same device

Error Caused by Response -2392


from GW URL
-2393

5821

Update certification failed because mainframe


was in use.

Parameter error
Basil not managed

-2394

Device not managed

-2395

Box ID for Basil is illegal

-2396

Device ID for Basil is illegal

-2397

Incorrect ID2 format

-2398

Incorrect request number format

209 Instal Clear

Releases the machine from its embedded RCG setup.

250 CommLog Print

Prints the communication log.

[Remote Service Address]


002 RCG IP Address

*CTL

Sets the IP address of the RCG (Remote


Communication Gate) destination for call
processing at the remote service center.

271

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[NV-RAM Data Upload]


5824

Uploads the UP and SP mode data (except for counters and the serial number) from the
NVRAM to an SD card. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the
"System Maintenance Reference" of the Field Service Manual.
001 NV-RAM Data Upload

[NV-RAM Data Download]


5825

Downloads the UP and SP mode data from an SD card to the NVRAM. For details, see the
"NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the "System Maintenance Reference" of the Field
Service Manual.
001 NV-RAM Download

5828

[Network Setting]

*CTL

Enables or disables 1284 Compatibility.


050 1284 Compatibility (Centro)

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Enables or disables ECP Compatibility.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]

052 ECP (Centro)

0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
This SP is activated only when SP5-828-50 is set
to "1".
Enables/disables Job Spooling.

065 Job Spooling

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled

066 Job Spooling Clear: Start Time

Treatment of the job when a spooled job exists at power


on.
0: ON (Data is cleared)
1: OFF (Automatically printed)

272

System SP5-xxx

Validates or invalidates the job spooling function for


each protocol.
0: Validates
1: Invalidates
bit0: LPR
069 Job Spooling (Protocol)

bit1: FTP
bit2: IPP
bit3: SMB
bit4: BMLinkS

bit5: DIPRINT
bit6: sftp
bit7: (Reserved)
Enables or disables the Telnet protocol.
090 TELNET (0: OFF 1: ON)

[0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Enables or disables the Web operation.

091 Web (0: OFF 1: ON)

[0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
This is the IPv6 local address link referenced on the
Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:

145 Active IPv6 Link Local Address

"Link Local Address" + "Prefix Length"


The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured
in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.

147 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 1


149 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 2
151 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 3
153 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 4
155 Active IPv6 Stateless Address 5

These SPs are the IPv6 status addresses (1 to 5)


referenced on the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b)
in the format:
"Status Address" + "Prefix Length"
The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured
in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.

273

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

This SP is the IPv6 manually set address referenced on


the Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:
156 IPv6 Manual Address

"Manual Set Address" + "Prefix Length"


The IPv6 address consists of a total 128 bits configured
in 8 blocks of 16 bits each.

158 IPv6 Gateway Address

161 IPv6 Stateless Auto Setting

This SP is the IPv6 gateway address referenced on the


Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b). The IPv6 address
consists of a total 128 bits configured in 8 blocks of 16
bits each.
Enables or disables the automatic setting for IPv6
stateless.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Displays or does not display the Web system items.

236 Web Item visible

[0 x 0000 to 0 x ffff / 0 x ffff] 0: Not displayed, 1:


Displayed
bit0: Net RICOH
bit1: Consumable Supplier
bit2-15: Reserved (all)

237 Web shopping link visible

Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on


the top page and link page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display

238 Web supplies Link visible

Displays or does not display the link to Consumable


Supplier on the top page and link page of the web
system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display

274

239 Web Link1 Name

This SP confirms or changes the URL1 name on the link


page of the web system. The maximum characters for
the URL name are 31 characters.

240 Web URL

This SP confirms or changes the link to URL1 on the link


page of the web system. The maximum characters for
the URL are 127 characters.

System SP5-xxx

241 Web visible

Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top


page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display

242 Web Link2 Name

Same as "-239"

243 Web Link2 URL

Same as "-240"

244 Web Link2 visible

Same as "-241"

5832

[HDD] HDD Initialization

*CTL

3
-

001 HDD Formatting (ALL)


002 HDD Formatting (IMH)
003 HDD Formatting (Thumbnail)
004 HDD Formatting (Job Log)
005 HDD Formatting (Printer Fonts)
Initializes the hard disk. Use this SP
mode only if there is a hard disk error.

006 HDD Formatting (User Info)


007 Mail RX Data
008 Mail TX Data
009 HDD Formatting (Data for a Design)
010 HDD Formatting (Log)
011 HDD Formatting (Ridoc I/F)
5836

[Capture Settings]
Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)

*CTL

0: Disable, 1: Enable

001 With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot be initialized,
displayed, or selected.
002

Panel Setting

0: Displayed, 1: Not displayed

Displays or does not display the capture function buttons.

275

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

5836-71 to 5836-78, Copier and Printer Document Reduction


The following 6 SP modes set the default reduction for stored documents sent to the
document management server via the MLB.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.

071 Reduction for Copy Color

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

072 Reduction for Copy B&W Text

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4, 6: 2/3

073 Reduction for Copy B&W Other

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4, 6: 2/3

074 Reduction for Printer Color

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

075 Reduction for Printer B&W

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4, 6: 2/3

076 Reduction for Printer B&W HQ

0: 1to-1, 1: 1/2, 2: 1/3, 3: 1/4

077 Reduction for Printer Color 1200

1: 1/2, 3: 1/4, 4: 1/6, 5: 1/8 (2: skipped) ,


6: 2/3

078 Reduction for Printer B&W 1200

1: 1/2, 3: 1/4, 4: 1/6, 5: 1/8 (2: skipped) ,


6: 2/3

5836-81 to 5836-86, Stored document format


The following 6 SP modes set Sets the default format for stored documents sent to the
document management server via the MLB.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
081 Format for Copy Color

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
This SP is not used in this model.

082 Format for Copy B&W Text

083 Format Copy B&W Other

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,

084 Format for Printer Color

2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
This SP is not used in this model.

276

System SP5-xxx

085 Format for Printer B&W

086 Format for Printer B&W HQ


Default for JPEG

0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]

091 Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document management server via
the MLB with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.
101 Primary srv IP address

Sets the IP address for the primary capture server. This is


basically adjusted by the remote system.

102 Primary srv scheme

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

103 Primary srv port number

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

104 Primary srv URL path

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

111 Secondary srv IP address

Sets the IP address for the secondary capture server. This is


basically adjusted by the remote system.

112 Secondary srv scheme

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

113 Secondary srv port number This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
114 Secondary srv URL path

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

120 Default Reso Rate Switch

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.

Reso: Copy (Color)

[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]

121 Selects the resolution for color copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi
Reso: Copy (Mono)

[0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]

122 Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi

277

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Reso: Print (Color)


123

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for color print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi
Reso: Print (Mono)

124

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
Reso: Fax (Color)

125

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 6 / 4 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for color fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi

126 Reso: Fax (Mono)

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]

Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Reso: Scan (Color)

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 6 / 4 / 1/step]

127 Selects the resolution for color scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Reso: Scan (Mono)

This is basically adjusted by the remote system.


[0 to 6 / 3 / 1/step]

128 Selects the resolution for BW scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi

141

All Addr Info Switch

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Off, 1: On

Turns on or off the all address information transmission for the captured resources.

278

System SP5-xxx

142

5840

Stand-by Doc Max


Number

[10 to 10000 / 2000 / 1/step]

Selects the maximum number of captured documents to be transmitted to the document


server.
[IEEE 802.11]
[1 to 11 or 13 / 11 or 13 / 1 /step]
Channel Max

*CTL

Europe/Asia: 1 to 13

NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
006 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum
number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting.
[1 to 11 or 13 / 1 / 1 /step]
Channel Min

*CTL

Europe: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11

Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
007 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum
number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting.

279

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -]
0 x FF to Auto [Default]
0 x 11 55M Fix
0 x 10 48M Fix
0 x 0F 36M Fix
0 x 0E 18M Fix

0 x 0D 12M Fix
008 Transmission Speed

*CTL

0 x 0B 9M Fix
0 x 0A 6M Fix
0 x 07 11M Fix
0 x 05 5.5M Fix
0 x 08 1M Fix
0 x 13 0 x FE (reserved)
0 x 12 72M (reserved)
0 x 09 22M (reserved)
Selects the WEP key.
[00 to 11 / 00 / 1 binary]

011 WEP key Select

*CTL

00: Key #1
01: Key #2 (Reserved)
10: Key #3 (Reserved)
11: Key #4 (Reserved)
Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11
card.

042 Fragment Thresh

*CTL

[256 to 2346 / 2346 / 1]


This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11
card is installed.
Determines whether the CTS self function is turned
on or off.

043 1g CTS to Self

*CTL

[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11
card is installed.

044 11g Slot Time

280

*CTL

Selects the slot time for IEEE802.11.


[0 to 1 / 0 / 1] 0: 20 m, 1: 9 m

System SP5-xxx

Selects the debug level for WPA authentication


application.
045 WPA Debug Lvl

*CTL

[1 to 3 / 3 / 1] 1: Info, 2: warning, 3: error


This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11
card is installed.

5841

[Supply Name Setting]

001 Toner Name Setting: Black


002 Toner Name Setting: Cyan
003 Toner Name Setting: Yellow
004

Toner Name Setting:


Magenta

007 OrgStamp

*CTL

Specifies supply names. These appear on the


screen when the user presses the Inquiry button
in the user tools screen.

*CTL

Default: 00000000 do not change


Netfiles: Jobs to be printed from the document
server using a PC and the DeskTopBinder software

011 Staple Std1


012 Staple Std2
013 Staple Std3
014 Staple Std4
5842

[GWWS Analysis Mode] DFU


001 Setting 1

Adjusts the debug program modesetting.


Bit7: 5682 mmseg-log setting
002 Setting 2

*CTL

0: Date/Hour/Minute/Second
1: Minute/Second/Msec.
0 to 6: Not used

5844

[USB]

281

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001

Transfer Rate

0x01: Full speed

*CTL

0x04: Auto Change

Adjusts the USB transfer rate.

002 Vendor ID

*CTL

Displays the vendor ID. DFU

003 Product ID

*CTL

Displays the product ID. DFU

004 Device Release Number

*CTL

Displays the development release version number.


DFU

006 PnP Model Name

*CTL

Inputs the model name.

007 PnP Serial Number

*CTL

Inputs the serial number.

100

Notify Unsupport

[0 or 1 / 1 / -]

*CTL

0: Disable, 1: Enable

Enables or disables the unsupported USB display.


[Delivery Server Setting]

5845

*CTL

Provides items for delivery server settings.


001

FTP Port No.

[0 to 65535 / 3670 / 1 /step]

Sets the FTP port number used when image files to the Scan Router Server.
IP Address (Primary)

Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255

002 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab can
be referenced by the initial system setting.
Delivery Error Display Time

[0 to 999 / 300 / 1 second /step]

006 Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a
test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external
device.
IP Address (Secondary)

Range: 000.000.000.000 to 255.255.255.255

008 Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary
delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without
reference to the DNS setting.

282

System SP5-xxx

Delivery Server Model

[0 to 4/ 0 / 1 /step]

Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device.
0: Unknown
009 1: SG1 Provided
2: SG1 Package
3: SG2 Provided
4: SG2 Package
Delivery Svr Capability

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits
Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible
010

Bit5 = 1 Mail RX confirmation setting possible


Bit4 = 1 Address book automatic update function exists
Bit3 = 1 Fax RX delivery function exists
Bit2 = 1 Sender password function exists
Bit1 = 1 Function to link MK-1 user and Sender exists
Bit0 = 1 Sender specification required (if set to 1, Bit6 is set to "0")
Delivery Svr Capability (Ext)

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
011

Bit7 = 1 Address book usage limitation (Limitation for each authorized user)
Bit6 = 1 RDH authorization link
Bit5 to 0: Not used

013

014

Server Scheme (Primary) DFU


This is used for the scan router program.
Server Port Number (Primary) DFU
This is used for the scan router program.

283

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

015

016

017

3
018

Server URL Path (Primary) DFU


This is used for the scan router program.
Server Scheme (Secondary) DFU
This is used for the scan router program.
Server Port Number (Secondary) DFU
This is used for the scan router program.
Server URL Path (Secondary) DFU
This is used for the scan router program.
Rapid Sending Control

022

Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error.
[0 to 1 / 0 / -]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

5846

[UCS Settings]

*CTL

Machine ID (For Delivery Server)

Displays ID

001 Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only
displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394
EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary.
Machine ID Clear (For Delivery Server)

Clears ID

002 Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute
this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the
ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on.
Maximum Entries

[2000 to 20000/ 2000 /1 /step]

003 Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle.
If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the
data (excluding user code information) is displayed.
Delivery Server Retry Timer

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

006 Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery
server address book.

284

System SP5-xxx

Delivery Server Retry Times

[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]

007 Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server
address book.
Delivery Server Maximum Entries
008

010

020

040

[2000 to 50000 / 2000 / 1/


step]

Sets the maximum number account entries of the delivery server user information managed
by UCS.
LDAP Search Timeout

[1 to 255 / 60 / 1 /step]

Sets the length of the timeout for the search of the LDAP server.
WSD Maximum Entries

[5 to 250 / 250 / 1 /step]

Sets the maximum entries for the address book of the WSD (WS-scanner).
Addr Book Migration (USB => HDD)
Not used in this machine.
Fill Addr Acl Info.
This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine
that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD
installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it
onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only
by the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician
immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users.

041

Procedure
1. Turn the machine off.
2. Install the new HDD.
3. Turn the machine on.
4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically.
5. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system
administrator or key operator.
6. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846 041. After this SP executes successfully, any user
can access the address book.

285

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Displays the slot number where an address book data is in.


[0 to 30 / - /1]
0: Unconfirmed
043 Addr Book Media

1: SD Slot 1
2: SD Slot 2
4: USB Flash ROM
20: HDD

30: Nothing
047 Initialize Local Addr Book
048

Initialize Delivery Addr


Book

Clears the local address book information, including the


user code.
Clears the distribution address book information, except the
user code.

049 Initialize LDAP Addr Book

Clears the LDAP address book information, except the user


code.

050 Initialize All Addr Book

Clears all directory information managed by UCS, including


all user codes.

051 Backup All Addr Book

Uploads all directory information to the SD card.

052 Restore All Addr Book

Downloads all directory information from the SD card.


Deletes the address book data from the SD card in the
service slot.
Deletes only the files that were uploaded from this machine.
This feature does not work if the card is write-protected.

053 Clear Backup Info


After you do this SP, go out of the SP mode, and then
turn the power off.
Do not remove the SD card until the Power LED stops
flashing.

286

System SP5-xxx

Search Option
This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book.
Bit: Meaning
060

0: Checks both upper/lower case characters


1: Japan Only
2: Japan Only
3: Japan Only

4 to 7: Not Used
Complexity Option 1
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case and sets the length of the
password.
062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP does not normally require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password
policy to control access to the address book.
063 Complexity Option 2 DFU
064 Complexity Option 3 DFU
065 Complexity Option 4 DFU

091 FTP Auth Port Setting

Specifies the FTP port for getting a distribution server


address book that is used in the identification mode.
[0 to 65535 / 3671 / 1 /step]

094 Encryption Stat

Shows the status of the encryption function for the


address book data.

287

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Rep Resolution Reduction]

*CTL

5847 1 through 5847 8 changes the default settings of image data transferred externally
by the Net File page reference function.
5847

[0 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]
5847 21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files handled by NetFile.
"Net files" are jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the
DeskTopBinder software.

001 Rate for Copy Color

0: 1x

002 Rate for Copy B&W Text

1: 1/2x

003 Rate for Copy B&W Other

2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x

004 Rate for Printer Color

4: 1/6x

005 Rate for Printer B&W

5: 1/8x
0: 1x
1: 1/2x

006 Rate for Printer Color 1200dpi

2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
0: 1x
1: 1/2x

007 Rate for Printer B&W 1200dpi

2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x

Network Quality Default for JPEG


021 Sets the default value for the quality of JPEG images sent as NetFile pages. This function
is available only with the MLB (Media Link Board) option installed.
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]

288

System SP5-xxx

[Web Service]

*CTL

5848 2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. Setting of 0001 has
no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router.

5848

5848 100 sets the maximum size allowed for downloaded images. The default is equal
to 1 gigabyte.
Access Ctrl: Repository (only
002
Lower 4 bits)

003

Access Control: Doc. Svr. Print


(Lower 4 bits)

004

Access Control: User Directory


(only Lower 4 bits)

007

Access Ctrl: Comm. Log Fax


(Lower 4 bits)

009 Access Ctrl: Job Ctrl (Lower 4 bits)


Access Ctrl: Device management
011
(Lower 4 bits)

0000: No access control


0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder.
0010: No writing control

Switches access control on and off.


0000: No access control
0001: Denies access to DeskTop Binder.

021 Access Ctrl: Delivery (Lower 4 bits)


022

Access Ctrl: uAdministration


(Lower 4bits)

099

Repository: Download Image


Setting

Repository: Download Image


100
Max. Size

DFU
Specifies the max size of the image data that the
machine can download.
[1 to 1024 / 1024 / 1 MB /step]

289

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

210 Setting: LogType: Job1


211 Setting: LogType: Job2
212 Setting: LogType: Access
213 Setting: Primary Srv
214 Setting: Secondary Srv

NIA

215 Setting: Start Time

216 Setting: Interval Time


217 Setting: Timing
5849

[Installation Date]

5849 1 Display

*CTL

The "Counter Clear Day" has been changed to


"Installation Date" or "Inst. Date".
Determines whether the installation date is printed on
the printout for the total counter.

5849 2 Switch to Print

[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF (No Print)
1: ON (Print)

003 Total Counter


5850

[Address Book Function]

*CTL

Replacement of Circuit Classification Japan Only


003 The machine is sold ready to use with a G3 line. This SP allows you to switch all at once
to convert to G4 after you add a G4 line. Conversely, if for some reason the G4 line
becomes unusable, you can easily switch back to G3.
[Bluetooth Mode]
5851

Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key.
[0:Public] [1: Private]

290

System SP5-xxx

[Stamp Data Download]


Use this SP to download the fixed stamp data stored in the firmware of the ROM and copy
it to the HDD. This SP can be executed as many times as required. This SP must be executed
after replacing or formatting the hard disks.

5853

This SP can be executed only with the hard disks installed.

[Remote ROM Update]


5856

Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware using a local port (IEEE1284) when
updating the remote ROM.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 Local Port

*CTL

0: Disable
1: Enable

5857

[Save Debug Log]

*CTL

On/Off (1:ON 0:OFF)

0: OFF, 1: ON

001 Switches the debug log feature on and off. The debug log cannot be captured until this
feature is switched on.
Target (2: HDD 3: SD)

2: HDD, 3: SD Card

002 Selects the storage device to save debug logs information when the conditions set with
SP5-858 are satisfied.
[ 2 to 3 / 2 / 1 /step]
Save to HDD
005

006

Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the HDD.
A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card.
Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to
each SD Card.
Save to SD Card
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the SD card.

009 Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB)


010 Copy HDD to SD Card (Latest 4 MB Any Key)
291

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

011 Erase HDD Debug Data


012 Erase SD Card Debug Data
013 Free Space on SD Card
014 Copy SD to SD (Latest 4 MB)
015 Copy SD to SD (Latest 4 MB Any Key)
016 Make HDD Debug

017 Make SD Debug


[Debug Save When]
5858

*CTL

These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination
selected by SP5857-002.
SP5858-3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes.

001 Engine SC Error

Turns on/off the debug save for SC codes generated by


copier engine errors.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]
0: OFF, 1: ON

002 Controller SC Error

Turns on/off the debug save for SC codes generated by


GW controller errors.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]
0: OFF, 1: ON

003 Any SC Error

[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
Turns on/off the debug save for jam errors.

004 Jam

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]
0: OFF, 1: ON

5859

292

[Debug Save Key No.]

*CTL

System SP5-xxx

001 Key 1
002 Key 2
003 Key 3
004 Key 4
005 Key 5

These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for
functions that use common memory on the controller board.

006 Key 6

[9999999 to 9999999 / 0 / ]

007 Key 7

008 Key 8
009 Key 9
010 Key 10
5860

[SMTP/POP3/IMAP4]

*CTL

020 Partial Mail Receive Timeout

[1 to 168 / 72 / hour/step]

Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The
received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this
prescribed time.
021 MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance

[0 to 1 / 1 / ]

Determines whether RFC2298 compliance is switched on for MDN reply mail.


0: No
1: Yes
022 SMTP Auth. From Field Replacement

[0 to 1 / 0 / ]

Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the validated account
after the SMTP server is validated.
0: No. "From" item not switched.
1: Yes. "From item switched.
025 SMTP Auth. Direct Setting

[0 or 1 / 0 / ]

293

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Selects the authentication method for SMPT.


Bit switch:
Bit 0: LOGIN
Bit 1: PLAIN
Bit 2: CRAM MD5
Bit 3: DIGEST MD5
Bit 4 to 7: Not used

This SP is activated only when SMTP authorization is enabled by UP mode.


Selects the MIME header type of an E-mail sent
by S/MIME.
026

S/MIVE: MIME Header


Setting

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard
1: Internet Draft standard
2: RFC standard

5866

[E-mail Alert] Not Used


Enables or disables the e-mail alert.

001 Report Validity

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
0: Enable, 1: Disable

005 Add Date Field

*CTL

Adds or does not add the date field to the header


of the alert mail.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
0: Not added, 1: Added

5870

001 Writing

*CTL

Writes to flash ROM the common proof for


validating the device for @Remote specifications.

003 Initializing

*CTL

Initializes the data area of the common proof for


validating.

5873

294

[Common Key Info Writing]

[SD Card Appli Move]

System SP5-xxx

001 Move Exec

This SP copies the application programs from the original SD card in


SD card slot 3 to an SD card in SD card slot 1 or 2 (slot 1 has the
priority to be copied).

002 Undo Exec

This SP copies back the application programs from an SD card in SD


Card Slot 3 to the original SD card in SD card slot 1 or 2 (slot 1 has
the priority to be copied). Use this menu when you have mistakenly
copied some programs by using "Move Exec" (SP5873-1).

5875

[SC Auto Reboot]


Enables or disables the automatic reboot function when
an SC error occurs.
[0 or 1/ 0 / ]

001 Reboot Setting

0: The machine reboots automatically when the


machine issues an SC error and logs the SC error code.
If the same SC occurs again, the machine does not
reboot.

*CTL

1: The machine does not reboot when an SC error


occurs.
The reboot is not executed for Type A or C SC codes.
Selects the reboot method for SC.
002 Reboot Type

*CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot

5878

[Option Setup]

001 Data Overwrite Security

Enables the Data Overwrite Security unit. Press


"EXECUTE" on the operation panel. Then turn the
machine off and on.

002 HDD Encryption

Installs the HDD Encryption unit.

Deletes the fixed phrase.

5881

[Fixed Phrase Block Erasing]

001 -

5883

[Line Speed Selection]


Selects the line speed for middle thick paper.
295

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
001 Middle Thick

*ENG 0: MID CARD: Half Speed


1: MID CARD: Normal Speed

5885

[Set WIM Function] Web Image Monitor Settings


Close or disclose the functions of web image monitor.
0: OFF, 1: ON

Bit Meaning
0: Forbid all document server access (1)
1: Forbid user mode access (1)
020 Document Server ACC Ctrl

*CTL

2: Forbid print function (1)


3: Forbid fax TX (1)
4: Forbid scan sending (1)
5: Forbid downloading (1)
6: Forbid delete (1)
7: Reserved

050 Document Server List Def. Style *CTL

Selects the display type for the document box


list.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details

051 Document Server List Def. Lines *CTL

Sets the number of documents to be displayed


in the document box list.
[5 to 20 / 10 / 1]
Selects whether the signature is added to the
scanned documents with the WIM when they
are transmitted by an e-mail.

100 Signature Setting

*CTL

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Setting for each e-mail
1: Signature for all
2: No signature

296

System SP5-xxx

101 Set Encryption

*CTL

Determines whether the scanned documents


with the WIM are encrypted when they are
transmitted by an e-mail.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1]
0: Not encrypted, 1:Encryption

5887

[SD Get Counter]


This SP determines whether the ROM can be updated.

001 -

*CTL

This SP sends a text file to an SD card inserted in


SD card Slot 2 (lower slot). The operation stores.
The file is stored in a folder created in the root
directory of the SD card called SD_COUNTER.
The file is saved as a text file (*.txt) prefixed with
the number of the machine.
1. Insert the SD card in SD card Slot 2 (lower
slot).
2. Select SP5887 then touch [EXECUTE].
Touch [Execute] in the message when you are
prompted.

5888

[Personal Information Protect]


Selects the protection level for logs.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1}

001 -

*CTL

0: No authentication, No protection for logs


1: No authentication, Protected logs (only an
administrator can see the logs)

5893

[SDK Application Counter]

*CTL

Displays the counter name of each SDK application.

001

SDK-1

002

SDK-2

003

SDK-3

004

SDK-4

297

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

005

SDK-5

006

SDK-6

5894

[Test Name1]
-

001 Test Name1_1

*ENG

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]

[Application Invalidation]
5895

Enables or disables the printer or scanner application.


These SPs are used only when an external controller is installed in the machine.

001

Printer

*CTL

002

Scanner

*CTL

5907

[Plug & Play Maker/Model Name]

[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Enable
1: Disable

Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information
is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these names should be registered again.
After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting
is completed, the beeper sounds five times.
5913

[Switchover Permission Time]


Print Application Timer

*CTL

[3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second /step]

002 Sets the amount of time to elapse while the machine is in standby mode (and the operation
panel keys have not been used) before another application can gain control of the display.
5967

[Copy Server Set Function]

*CTL

0: ON, 1: OFF

Enables and disables the document server. This is a security measure that prevents image
data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must
switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting.

298

System SP5-xxx

5974

[Cherry Server]
Specifies which version of ScanRouter, "Lite" or "Full", is installed.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
*CTL

001 Cherry Server

0: Lite
1: Full

[Device Setting]
5985

The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this SP to enable
and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller
board, these SP codes must be set to "1".

[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation
When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is limited only
for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
001 On Board NIC
Other network applications than NRS or LDAP/NT
authentication are not available when this SP is set to "2". Even
though you can change the initial settings of those network
applications, the settings do not work.
002 On Board USB

5987

[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable

[Mech. Counter]
001 0: OFF / 1: ON

5990

This SP detects that a mechanical counter device is removed. If


it is detected, SC610 occurs.

[SP print mode]


Prints out the SMC sheets.

299

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 All (Data List)

002 SP (Mode Data List)

003 User Program

004 Logging Data

005 Diagnostic Report

006 Non-Default

007 NIB Summary

008 Capture Log

021 Copier User Program

022 Scanner SP

023 Scanner User Program

024 SDK/J Summary

025 SDK/J Application Info

5998

[Fusing Cont mode] Fusing Control Mode


Turns the silent fusing warm-up mode on or off.
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]

001 fast/silent

*ENG

0: Silent (less noise)


1: Fast (less time)

Turns on or off the fusing unit preceding mode.


The machine turns on the fusing unit first by default after power-on or recovery from the
energy save mode.
If a customer does not want the fusing unit to rotate before sending a job to the machine,
change this setting to "0". In this case, the first print time or recovery time may be little bit
longer than before.

300

System SP6-xxx

System SP6-xxx
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
6006

[ADF Adj.] ADF Adjustment


Adjusts the side-to-side and leading registration of originals with the ARDF.

001 Side-to-Side Registration


002

Side-to-Side Registration
(2nd side)

*ENG

003 Leading Edge Registration

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

Adjusts the amount of paper buckle to correct original skew for the front and rear sides.
005 Buckle: Duplex Front
006 Buckle: Duplex Rear

*ENG

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]


[-2.5 to 2.5 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

Adjusts the erase margin at the original trailing edge.


007 Rear Edge Erase

*ENG

[-10 to 10 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step ]

[ADF Input Check]


6007

Displays the signals received from the sensors and switches of the ARDF. Only Bit 0 is used
for ADF input check ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[ADF Output Check]

6008

Activates the electrical components for functional check.


It is not possible to activate more than one component at the same time (
and Output Check").

6009

p.392 "Input

[ADF Free Run]


Performs a DF free run in simplex, duplex mode or stamp mode.

301

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Free Run Simplex Motion

002 Free Run Duplex Motion

003 Free Run Stamp Motion

6010

[Stamp Position Adj.] Fax Stamp Position Adjustment


Adjusts the horizontal position of the stamp on the scanned originals.

6010 1 Stamp Position Adj.

*ENG

6011

[1-Pass ADF INPUT Check] Not used

6012

[1-Pass ADF OUTPUT Check] Not used

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

[Original Size Detection Priority] Original Size Detection Priority


6016

Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since original sensors
cannot recognize all sizes.
*ENG

Original Size Detection


001
Priority

NA

EU/
ASIA

6017

0: Setting 1, 1: Setting 2
Setting 1

Setting 2

DLT SEF

Folio SEF 11" x 15"

LG SEF

Foolscap SEF

LT SEF

US EXE 8" x 10"

LT LEF

US EXE LEF

DLT SEF

8K 267 x 390 mm

LT SEF

16K 195 x 267 mm

LT LEF

16K 267 x 195 mm

[DF Magnification Adj.] DF Magnification Adjustment


Adjusts the magnification in the sub-scan direction for the ARDF.

001 DF Magnification Adj.

302

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

*CTL

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]

System SP6-xxx

6020

[Skew Correction Moving Setting]


Turns the original skew correction in the ARDF for all original sizes on or off.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]

001 -

*ENG

0: Off (only for small original sizes)


1: On (for all original sizes)

6128

[Punch Position: Sub Scan]


Adjusts the punching position in the sub scan direction.

001 Domestic (Japan) 2Hole

*ENG

002 North America 3Hole

*ENG

003 Europe 4Hole

*ENG

004 North Europe 4Hole

*ENG

005 North Europe 2Hole

*ENG

6129

[-7.5 to 7.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm/step]]

[Punch Position: Main Scan]


Adjusts the punching position in the main scan direction.

001 Domestic (Japan) 2Hole

*ENG

002 North America 3Hole

*ENG

003 Europe 4Hole

*ENG

004 North Europe 4Hole

*ENG

005 North Europe 2Hole

*ENG

6130

[-2.0 to 2.0 / 0 / 0.4 mm/step]]

[Skew Correction: Buckle Adj.]


Adjusts the paper buckle for each paper size.

303

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 A3T

*ENG

002 B4T

*ENG

003 A4T

*ENG

004 A4Y

*ENG

005 B5T

*ENG

006 B5Y

*ENG

007 DLT-T

*ENG

008 LG-T

*ENG

009 LT-T

*ENG

010 LT-Y

*ENG

011 12" x 18"

*ENG

012 Other

*ENG

6131

304

[-5.0 to 5.0 / 0 / 0.25 mm/step]]

[Skew Correction Control]


Selects the skew correction control for each paper size. These are only activated for B793.

System SP6-xxx

001 A3T

*ENG

002 B4T

*ENG

003 A4T

*ENG

004 A4Y

*ENG

005 B5T

*ENG

006 B5Y

*ENG

007 DLT-T

*ENG

008 LG-T

*ENG

009 LT-T

*ENG

010 LT-Y

*ENG

011 12" x 18"

*ENG

012 Other

*ENG

[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]]
0: No (No skew correction)

1: Roller Stop Skew Correction

[Jogger Fence Fine Adj]


6132

This SP adjusts the distance between the jogger fences and the sides of the stack on the
finisher stapling tray in the Booklet Finisher B793. The adjustment is done perpendicular to
the direction of paper feed.

305

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 A3T

*ENG

002 B4T

*ENG

003 A4T

*ENG

004 A4Y

*ENG

005 B5T

*ENG

[-1.5 to 1.5 / 0 / 0.5 mm/step]

006 B5Y

*ENG

007 DLT-T

*ENG

+ Value: Increases distance between jogger


fences and the sides of the stack.

008 LG-T

*ENG

009 LT-T

*ENG

010 LT-Y

*ENG

011 12" x 18"

*ENG

012 Other

*ENG

- Value: Decreases the distance between the


jogger fences and the sides of the stack.

[Staple Position Adjustment]


6133

Adjusts the staple position for each finisher (B408/B793/D372).


+ Value: Moves the staple position to the rear side.
- Value: Moves the staple position to the front side.

001 Finisher (B408/B793)

306

*ENG

[-3.5 to 3.5 / 0 / 1/step]

6134

[Saddle Stitch Position Adjustment]

User SP

Use this SP to adjust the stapling position of the booklet stapler when paper is stapled and
folded in the Booklet Finisher B793.

System SP6-xxx

001 A3T
002 B4T
003 A4T
004 B5T

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.2 mm/step]


+ Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease.
- Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease.

005 DLT-T
006 LG-T

007 LT-T
008 12" x 18"
009 Other
6135

[Folder Position Adj.]

User SP

This SP corrects the folding position when paper is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher
B793.

001 A3T
002 B4T
003 A4T
004 B5T

[-3.0 to 3.0 / 0 / 0.2 mm/step]


+ Value: Shifts staple position toward the crease.
- Value: Shifts staple position away from the crease.

005 DLT-T
006 LG-T
007 LT-T
008 12" x 18"
009 Other
6136

[Folding Number]

User SP

Sets the number of times that folding is done in the Booklet Finisher B793.

001 -

[2 to 30 / 2 / 1 time/step]

307

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

6137

3
6138

[Finisher Free Run]


These SPs are used only for B793 finisher.
001 Free Run 1

Free run for paper edge stapling.

002 Free Run 2

Free run for booklet stapling.

003 Free Run 3

Shipping free run. Simulates standby conditions during shipping.

004 Free Run 4

DFU

[FIN (TIG) INPUT Check] Finisher (B793) Input Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Input and Output Check")

6139

[FIN (KIN) INPUT Check] Finisher (B408) Input Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Input and Output Check")

6140

[FIN (EUP) INPUT Check] Not used

6141

[FIN (ELB) INPUT Check] Finisher (D372) Input Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Input and Output Check")

6143

308

p.392

p.392

[FIN (KIN) OUPUT Check] Finisher (B408) Output Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Input and Output Check")

6145

p.392

[FIN (TIG) OUPUT Check] Finisher (B793) Output Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the booklet finisher. (
"Input and Output Check")

6144

p.392

[FIN (EUP) OUPUT Check] Not used

p.392

System SP6-xxx

6146

[FIN (ELB) OUPUT Check] Finisher (D372) Output Check


Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 500-sheet finisher. (
p.392 "Input and Output Check")
[Max. Pre-Stack Sheet]

6149

*ENG

Number of Pre-Stack Sheets

This SP sets the number of sheets sent to the pre-stack tray.


Note:
You may need to adjust this setting or switch it off when feeding thick or slick paper.

001 -

[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheet/step]
[INPUT Check]

6150

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the bridge unit (D386)/ side tray
(D542) ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[OUTPUT Check]

6151

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the bridge unit (D386)/ side tray
(D542) ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[INPUT Check]

6152

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the shift tray (D388) (
p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[OUTPUT Check]

6153

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the shift tray (D388) (
p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[INPUT Check]

6154

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 1 bin tray (D536) (
p.392 "Input and Output Check").

309

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[OUTPUT Check]
6155

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 1 bin tray (D414) (
p.392 "Input and Output Check").

001 1 bin: Junction Solenoid

6157

[OUTPUT Check]
Not used in this machine
[INPUT Check]

6160

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the two-tray paper feed unit
(D537), LCT 2000 (D538) and LCT 1200 (D539) ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[OUTPUT Check]

6161

Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the two-tray paper feed unit
(D537), LCT 2000 (D538) and LCT 1200 (D539) ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").

6801

[1-pass Stamp Unit] Not used

6830

[Extra Staples] Not used

6900

[ADF Bottom Plate Setting]


This SP setting determines whether the bottom plate lift motor of the of the ADF switches on:
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]

001 A3T

*ENG

0: Bottom plate lifts immediately after originals


are set (Default)
1: Bottom plate does not lift until [Start] key is
pushed.

310

System SP7-xxx

System SP7-xxx
SP7-XXX (Data Log)

7401

[Total SC Counter]
Displays the number of SC codes detected.

001 SC Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step ]

[SC History]
7403

Logs the SC codes detected.


The 10 most recently detected SC Codes are not displayed on the screen, but can be seen
on the SMC (logging) outputs.

001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
006 Latest 5

*CTL

007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
[SC991 History]
7404

Logs the SC991 detected.


The 10 most recently detected SC991 are not displayed on the screen, but can be seen on
the SMC (logging) outputs.

311

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4

006 Latest 5

*CTL

007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9

7502

[Total Paper Jam Counter]


Displays the total number of jams detected.

001 Total Jam

7503

* CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]

[Total Original Jam Counter]


Displays the total number of original jams.

001 Original Jam counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 original/step ]

[Paper Jam Location]


7504

ON: On check, OFF: Off Check


Displays the number of jams according to the location where jams were detected.
NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station.

312

System SP7-xxx

001 At Power On

*CTL

003 Tray 1: ON

*CTL

004 Tray 2: ON

*CTL

005 Tray 3: ON

*CTL

006 Tray 4: ON

*CTL

007 LCT : ON

*CTL

008 Bypass: ON

*CTL

009 Duplex: ON

*CTL

011 Vertical Transport 1: ON

*CTL

012 Vertical Transport 2: ON

*CTL

013 Bank: Transport Sn1

*CTL

014 Bank: Transport Sn2

*CTL

017 Registration: ON

*CTL

018 Fusing Entrance: ON

*CTL

019 Fusing Exit: ON

*CTL

020 Paper Exit: ON

*CTL

021 Bridge Exit: ON

*CTL

022 Bridge Transport: ON

*CTL

024 Junction Gate Sensor : On

*CTL

For details, ( "Jam Detection" in the


"Main Chapters: Jam Detection" section.)

For details, ( "Jam Detection" in the


"Main Chapters: Jam Detection" section.)

313

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

314

025 Duplex Exit: ON

*CTL

026 Duplex Entrance: ON (Out)

*CTL

027 Duplex Entrance: ON (Out)

*CTL

051 Vertical Transport 1: Off

*CTL

052 Vertical Transport 2: Off

*CTL

053 Bank Transport 1: Off

*CTL

054 Bank Transport 2: Off

*CTL

057 Registration Sensor: Off

*CTL

058 LCT Feed Sensor : Off

*CTL

060 Paper Exit Off

*CTL

061 Bridge Exit: Off

*CTL

062 Bridge Transport: Off

*CTL

064 Junction Gate Sensor : Off

*CTL

065 Duplex Exit: Off

*CTL

066 Duplex Entrance: Off (In)

*CTL

067 Duplex entrance : Off (Out)

*CTL

100 Finisher Entrance: KIN

*CTL

101 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: KIN

*CTL

102 Finisher Staple: KIN

*CTL

103 Finisher Exit: KIN

*CTL

105 Finisher Tray Lift Motor: KIN

*CTL

106 Finisher Jogger Motor: KIN

*CTL

107 Finisher Shift Motor: KIN

*CTL

108 Finisher Staple Motor: KIN

*CTL

For details, ( "Jam Detection" in the


"Main Chapters: Jam Detection" section.)

For details, ( "Jam Detection" in the


"Main Chapters: Jam Detection" section.)

System SP7-xxx

7505

109 Finisher Exit Motor: KIN

*CTL

191 Finisher Entrance: EUP

*CTL

192 Finisher Proof Exit: EUP

*CTL

193 Finisher Shift Tray Exit: EUP

*CTL

194 Finisher Stapler Exit: EUP

*CTL

195 Finisher Exit: EUP

*CTL

198 Finisher Folder: EUP

*CTL

199 Finisher Tray Motor: EUP

*CTL

200 Finisher Jogger Motor: EUP

*CTL

201 Finisher Shift Motor: EUP

*CTL

202 Finisher Staple Moving Motor: EUP

*CTL

203 Finisher Staple Motor: EUP

*CTL

204 Finisher Folder Motor: EUP

*CTL

206 Finisher Punch Motor: EUP

*CTL

230 Fin Exit

*CTL

231 Insufficient Data

*CTL

For details, ( "Jam Detection" in the


"Main Chapters: Jam Detection" section.)

For details, ( "Jam Detection" in the


"Main Chapters: Jam Detection" section.)

[Original Jam Detection]


Displays the total number of original jams by location.

001 At Power On

*CTL

003 Separation Sensor: On

*CTL

004 Skew Correction Sensor: On

*CTL

005 Scanning Entrance Sensor: On

*CTL

315

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

006 Registration Sensor: On

*CTL

007 Original Exit Sensor: On

*CTL

008 Reverse Sensor: On

*CTL

013 Separation Sensor: On

*CTL

014 Skew Correction Sn: On

*CTL

015 Scanning Entrance Sn: On

*CTL

016 Registration Sensor: On

*CTL

017 Original Exit Sensor: On

*CTL

053 Separation Sensor: Off

*CTL

054 Skew Correction Sensor: Off

*CTL

055 Scanning Entrance Sensor: Off

*CTL

056 Registration Sensor: Off

*CTL

057 Original Exit Sensor: Off

*CTL

058 Reverse Sensor: Off

*CTL

063 Separation Sensor: Off

*CTL

064 Skew Correction Sn: Off

*CTL

065 Scanning Entrance Sn: Off

*CTL

066 Registration Sensor: Off

*CTL

067 Original Exit Sensor: Off

*CTL

7506

316

[Jam Count by Paper Size]


Displays the number of jams according to the paper size.

Not used

Not used

System SP7-xxx

005 A4 LEF
006 A5 LEF
014 B5 LEF
038 LT LEF
044 HLT LEF
132 A3 SEF

133 A4 SEF
134 A5 SEF

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]

141 B4 SEF
142 B5 SEF
160 DLT SEF
164 LG SEF
166 LT SEF
172 HLT SEF
255 Others

7507

[Plotter Jam History]


Displays the 10 most recently detected paper jams.

317

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4

006 Latest 5

*CTL

007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9

7508

[Original Jam History]


Displays the 10 most recently detected original jams.

001 Latest
002 Latest-1
003 Latest-2
004 Latest-3
005 Latest-4
006 Latest-5

*CTL

007 Latest-6
008 Latest-7
009 Latest-8
010 Latest-9

7624

318

Part Replacement Operation ON/OFF


Selects the PM maintenance for each part.

System SP7-xxx

001

Drum Unit: Bk

002

Drum Unit: M

003

Drum Unit: C

004

Drum Unit: Y

005

Development Unit: Bk

006

Development Unit: M

007

Development Unit: C

008

Development Unit: Y

009

Developer: Bk

010

Developer: M

011

Developer: C

012

Developer: Y

013

Image Transfer Belt

014

Image Transfer Cleaning Unit

015

Fusing Unit

016

Paper Transfer Roller Unit

017

Waste Toner Bottle

018

Fusing Roller

019

Pressure Roller

7801

[ROM No/ Firmware Version]


255 Engine

7803

[0 or 1 / 1 -]
0: No (Not PM maintenance)

1: Yes (PM maintenance)

[0 or 1 / 1 -]
0: Not PM maintenance
1: PM maintenance

*CTL

Displays all versions and ROM numbers in the


machine.

[PM Counter Display]


(Page, Unit, [Color])

319

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Displays the number of sheets printed for each current maintenance unit.
PM counters click up based on the number of A4 (LT) LEF size sheets printed. Therefore,
the A3 (DLT) Double Count is activated. The Double Count cannot be deactivated.
When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-1 to 10) and is reset to 0.

320

The total number of sheets printed with the last unit replaced can be checked with
SP7-906-1 to 10.
NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station.
001 Paper

*CTL

002 Page: PCU: Bk

*ENG

003 Page: PCU: M

*ENG

004 Page: PCU: C

*ENG

005 Page: PCU: Y

*ENG

006 Page: Development Unit: Bk

*ENG

007 Page: Development Unit: M

*ENG

008 Page: Development Unit: C

*ENG

009 Page: Development Unit: Y

*ENG

010 Page: Developer: Bk

*ENG

011 Page: Developer: M

*ENG

012 Page: Developer: C

*ENG

013 Page: Developer: Y

*ENG

[0 to 9999999 / - / 1 sheet/ step]

[0 to 9999999 / - / 1 sheet/ step]

System SP7-xxx

014 Page: Image Transfer

*ENG

015 Page: Cleaning Unit

*ENG

016 Page: Fusing Unit

*ENG

017 Page: Paper Transfer Unit

*ENG

018 Page: Toner Collection Bottle

*ENG

019 Page: Fusing Roller

*ENG

020 Page: Pressure Roller

*ENG

[0 to 9999999 / - / 1 sheet/ step]

Displays the number of revolutions of motors or clutches for each current maintenance unit.
[ 0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 revolution/step ]
When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-11 to 20) and is reset to 0. The total number of revolutions made with the last
unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-11 to 20.
031 Rotation: PCU: Bk
032 Rotation: PCU: M
033 Rotation: PCU: C
034 Rotation: PCU: Y
035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk
036 Rotation: Development Unit: M
037 Rotation: Development Unit: C

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]

038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y


039 Rotation: Developer Bk
040 Rotation: Developer M
041 Rotation: Developer C
042 Rotation: Developer Y

321

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

043 Rotation: Image Transfer


044 Rotation: Cleaning Unit
045 Rotation: Fusing Unit

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mg/step ]

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]

046 Rotation: Paper Transfer Unit


047 Measurement: Toner Collection bottle

048 Rotation: Fusing Roller


049 Rotation: Pressure Roller

Displays the value given by the following formula:


(Current revolution Target revolution) 100. This shows how much of the units expected
lifetime has been used up.
The Rotation% counter is based on rotations, not prints. If the number of rotations reaches
the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the print count lifetime is reached
first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the R% counter is still less than
100%.
061 Rotation (%): PCU: Bk
062 Rotation (%): PCU: M
063 Rotation (%): PCU: C
064 Rotation (%): PCU: Y
065 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Bk
066 Rotation (%): Development Unit: M
067 Rotation (%): Development Unit: C
068 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Y
069 Rotation (%): Developer Bk
070 Rotation (%): Developer M
071 Rotation (%): Developer C
072 Rotation (%): Developer Y

322

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

System SP7-xxx

073 Rotation (%): Image Transfer Belt


074 Rotation (%): Cleaning Unit
075 Rotation (%): Fusing Unit
076 Rotation (%): Paper Transfer Unit

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

077 Measurement (%): Toner Collection bottle


078 Rotation (%): Fusing Roller

079 Rotation (%): Pressure Roller


Displays the value given by the following formula:
(Current printouts Target printouts) 100. This shows how much of the units expected
lifetime has been used up.
The Page% counter is based on printouts, not revolutions. If the number of printouts reaches
the limit, the machine enters the end condition for that unit. If the revolution count lifetime is
reached first, the machine also enters the end condition, even though the Page% counter
is still less than 100%.
091 Page (%): PCU Bk (Drum Unit)
092 Page (%): PCU M (Drum Unit)
093 Page (%): PCU C (Drum Unit)
094 Page (%): PCU Y (Drum Unit)
095 Page (%): Development Unit: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

096 Page (%): Development Unit: M


097 Page (%): Development Unit: C
098 Page (%): Development Unit: Y

323

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

099 Page (%): Developer: Bk


100 Page (%): Developer: M
101 Page (%): Developer: C
102 Page (%): Developer: Y
103 Page (%): Image Transfer

*ENG

104 Page (%): Cleaning Unit

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

105 Page (%): Fusing Unit


106 Page (%): Paper Transfer Unit
107 Page (%): Fusing Roller
108 Page (%): Pressure Roller

7804

[PM Counter Reset] PM Counter Clear


(Unit, [Color])
Clears the PM counter.
Press the Enter key after the machine asks Execute?, which will store the PM counter value
in SP7-906 (PM Counter - Previous) and reset the value of the current PM counter
(SP7-803) to 0.
002 PCU (Drum Unit): Bk
003 PCU (Drum Unit): M
004 PCU (Drum Unit): C
005 PCU (Drum Unit): Y
006 PCU (Drum Unit): All
007 Development Unit: Bk
008 Development Unit: M
009 Development Unit: C
010 Development Unit: Y
011 Development Unit: All

324

System SP7-xxx

012 Developer: Bk
013 Developer: M
014 Developer: C
015 Developer: Y
016 Developer: All
017 Image Transfer Belt
018 Cleaning Unit

019 Fusing Unit


020 Paper Transfer Unit
021 Toner Collection Bottle
022 Fusing Roller
023 Pressure Roller
100 All

7807

[SC/Jam Counter Reset]


Clears the counters related to SC codes and paper jams.

001 SC/Jam Clear


7826

[MF Error Counter] Japan Only

001 Error Total


002 Error Staple
7827

7832

[MF Error Counter Clear] Japan Only


[Self-Diagnose Result Display]
Displays the result of the diagnostics.

001 Diag. Result

*CTL

325

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

7835

001 Copy ACC

*CTL

002 Printer ACC

*CTL

7836

Displays the ACC exectuion times for each mode.

Total Memory Size


Displays the memory capacity of the controller system.
[DF Scan Glass Dust Check Counter]

7852

Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on the scanning
glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1
(ADF Scan Glass Dust Check) is switched on.

001 Dust Detection Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]

002 Dust Detection Clear Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]

003 Dust Detection Counter: Back

*CTL

[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]

7853

326

[ACC Counter]

[Replacement Counter]
Displays the PM parts replacement number.

System SP7-xxx

001 PCU: Bk

*CTL

002 PCU: M

*CTL

003 PCU: C

*CTL

004 PCU: Y

*CTL

005 Development Unit: Bk

*CTL

006 Development Unit: M

*CTL

007 Development Unit: C

*CTL

008 Development Unit: Y

*CTL

009 Developer: Bk

*CTL

010 Developer: M

*CTL

011 Developer: C

*CTL

012 Developer: Y

*CTL

013 Image Transfer

*CTL

014 Cleaning Unit

*CTL

015 Fusing Unit

*CTL

016 Paper Transfer Unit

*CTL

017 Toner Collection Bottle

*CTL

018 Fusing Roller

*CTL

019 Pressure Roller

*CTL

[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]

[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]

327

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[Coverage Range]
Sets the color coverage threshold.
Coverage rate = Coverage per page / A4 full coverage (dots) x 100
There are three coverage counters: Color 1, Color 2, and Color 3
[A] 5% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-001.
[B] 20% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-002.

7855

The setting value [B] must be set larger than [A].


The total numbers of printouts (BW printing plus color printing) for each coverage range
are displayed with the following SPs.
Color1 counter: SP8601-021
Color2 counter: SP8601-022
Color3 counter: SP8601-023
001 Coverage Range 1

*CTL

[1 to 200 / 5 /1]

002 Coverage Range 2

*CTL

[1 to 200 / 20 /1]

[Assert Info] DFU


7901

Records the location where a problem is detected in the program. The data stored in this
SP is used for problem analysis.
001 File Name
002 Number of Lines

*CTL

003 Location
[Prev. Unit PM Counter]
7906

(Page or Rotations, Unit, [Color]), Dev.: Development Unit


Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance units.
001 Paper

328

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / - / 1 sheet/ step]

System SP7-xxx

002 Page: PCU: Bk

*ENG

003 Page: PCU: M

*ENG

004 Page: PCU: C

*ENG

005 Page: PCU: Y

*ENG

006 Page: Development Unit: Bk

*ENG

007 Page: Development Unit: M

*ENG

008 Page: Development Unit: C

*ENG

009 Page: Development Unit: Y

*ENG

010 Page: Developer: Bk

*ENG

011 Page: Developer: M

*ENG

012 Page: Developer: C

*ENG

013 Page: Developer: Y

*ENG

014 Page: Image Transfer

*ENG

015 Page: Cleaning Unit

*ENG

016 Page: Fusing Unit

*ENG

017 Page: Paper Transfer Unit

*ENG

018 Page: Toner Collection Bottle

*ENG

019 Page: Fusing Roller

*ENG

020 Page: Pressure Roller

*ENG

[0 to 9999999 / - / 1 sheet/ step]

[0 to 9999999 / - / 1 sheet/ step]

Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units.

329

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

031 Rotation: PCU: Bk


032 Rotation: PCU: M
033 Rotation: PCU: C
034 Rotation: PCU: Y
035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk

036 Rotation: Development Unit: M


037 Rotation: Development Unit: C

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mg/step ]

*ENG

[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]

038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y


039 Rotation: Developer Bk
040 Rotation: Developer M
041 Rotation: Developer C
042 Rotation: Developer Y
043 Rotation: Image Transfer
044 Rotation: Cleaning Unit
045 Rotation: Fusing Unit
046 Rotation: Paper Transfer Unit
047 Measurement: Toner Collection bottle
048 Rotation: Fusing Roller
049 Rotation: Pressure Roller

Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance unit or toner cartridge.

330

System SP7-xxx

061 Rotation (%): PCU: Bk


062 Rotation (%): PCU: M
063 Rotation (%): PCU: C
064 Rotation (%): PCU: Y
065 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Bk
066 Rotation (%): Development Unit: M
067 Rotation (%): Development Unit: C

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

068 Rotation (%): Development Unit: Y


069 Rotation (%): Developer Bk
070 Rotation (%): Developer M
071 Rotation (%): Developer C
072 Rotation (%): Developer Y
073 Rotation (%): Image Transfer Belt
074 Rotation (%): Cleaning Unit
075 Rotation (%): Fusing Unit
076 Rotation (%): Paper Transfer Unit
077 Measurement (%): Toner Collection bottle
078 Rotation (%): Fusing Roller
079 Rotation (%): Pressure Roller
Displays the value given by the following formula:
(Current count Yield count) x 100, where Current count is the current values in the
counter for the part, and Yield count is the recommended yield.

331

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

091 Page (%): PCU Bk (Drum Unit)


092 Page (%): PCU M (Drum Unit)
093 Page (%): PCU C (Drum Unit)
094 Page (%): PCU Y (Drum Unit)
095 Page (%): Development Unit: Bk

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

*ENG

[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]

096 Page (%): Development Unit: M

097 Page (%): Development Unit: C


098 Page (%): Development Unit: Y
099 Page (%): Developer: Bk
100 Page (%): Developer: M
101 Page (%): Developer: C
102 Page (%): Developer: Y
103 Page (%): Image Transfer
104 Page (%): Cleaning Unit
105 Page (%): Fusing Unit
106 Page (%): Paper Transfer Unit
107 Page (%): Fusing Roller
108 Page (%): Pressure Roller

7931

332

[Toner Bottle Bk]


Displays the toner bottle information for Bk.
001 Machine Serial ID

*ENG

002 Cartridge Ver

*ENG

003 Brand ID

*ENG

004 Area ID

*ENG

005 Product ID

*ENG

System SP7-xxx

7932

006 Color ID

*ENG

007 Maintenance ID

*ENG

008 New Product Information

*ENG

009 Recycle Counter

*ENG

010 Date

*ENG

011 Serial No.

*ENG

012 Toner Remaining

*ENG

013 EDP Code

*ENG

014 End History

*ENG

015 Refill Information

*ENG

016 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

017 Attachment: Color Counter

*ENG

018 End: Total Counter

*ENG

019 End: Color Counter

*ENG

020 Attachment Date

*ENG

021 End Date

*ENG

[Toner Bottle M]
Displays the toner bottle information for M.
001 Machine Serial ID

*ENG

002 Cartridge Ver

*ENG

003 Brand ID

*ENG

004 Area ID

*ENG

005 Product ID

*ENG

006 Color ID

*ENG

007 Maintenance ID

*ENG

333

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

7933

334

008 New Product Information

*ENG

009 Recycle Counter

*ENG

010 Date

*ENG

011 Serial No.

*ENG

012 Toner Remaining

*ENG

013 EDP Code

*ENG

014 End History

*ENG

015 Refill Information

*ENG

016 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

017 Attachment: Color Counter

*ENG

018 End: Total Counter

*ENG

019 End: Color Counter

*ENG

020 Attachment Date

*ENG

021 End Date

*ENG

[Toner Bottle C]
Displays the toner bottle information for C.
001 Machine Serial ID

*ENG

002 Cartridge Ver

*ENG

003 Brand ID

*ENG

004 Area ID

*ENG

005 Product ID

*ENG

006 Color ID

*ENG

007 Maintenance ID

*ENG

008 New Product Information

*ENG

009 Recycle Counter

*ENG

System SP7-xxx

7934

010 Date

*ENG

011 Serial No.

*ENG

012 Toner Remaining

*ENG

013 EDP Code

*ENG

014 End History

*ENG

015 Refill Information

*ENG

016 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

017 Attachment: Color Counter

*ENG

018 End: Total Counter

*ENG

019 End: Color Counter

*ENG

020 Attachment Date

*ENG

021 End Date

*ENG

[Toner Bottle Y]
Displays the toner bottle information for Y.
001 Machine Serial ID

*ENG

002 Cartridge Ver

*ENG

003 Brand ID

*ENG

004 Area ID

*ENG

005 Product ID

*ENG

006 Color ID

*ENG

007 Maintenance ID

*ENG

008 New Product Information

*ENG

009 Recycle Counter

*ENG

010 Date

*ENG

011 Serial No.

*ENG

335

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

7935

012 Toner Remaining

*ENG

013 EDP Code

*ENG

014 End History

*ENG

015 Refill Information

*ENG

016 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

017 Attachment: Color Counter

*ENG

018 End: Total Counter

*ENG

019 End: Color Counter

*ENG

020 Attachment Date

*ENG

021 End Date

*ENG

[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: Bk]


001 Serial No.
002 Attachment Date
003 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for Bk.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for Bk.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for Bk.

004 Refill Information


011 Serial No.
012 Attachment Date
013 Attachment: Total Counter
014 Refill Information
021 Serial No.
022 Attachment Date
023 Attachment: Total Counter
024 Refill Information

336

System SP7-xxx

031 Serial No.


032 Attachment Date
033 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for Bk.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for Bk.

034 Refill Information


041 Serial No.
042 Attachment Date
043 Attachment: Total Counter

044 Refill Information


7936

[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: M]


001 Serial No.
002 Attachment Date
003 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for M.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for M.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for M.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for M.

004 Refill Information


011 Serial No.
012 Attachment Date
013 Attachment: Total Counter
014 Refill Information
021 Serial No.
022 Attachment Date
023 Attachment: Total Counter
024 Refill Information
031 Serial No.
032 Attachment Date
033 Attachment: Total Counter
034 Refill Information

337

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

041 Serial No.


042 Attachment Date
043 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for M.

044 Refill Information


7937

[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: C]

001 Serial No.


002 Attachment Date
003 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for C.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for C.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for C.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for C.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for C.

004 Refill Information


011 Serial No.
012 Attachment Date
013 Attachment: Total Counter
014 Refill Information
021 Serial No.
022 Attachment Date
023 Attachment: Total Counter
024 Refill Information
031 Serial No.
032 Attachment Date
033 Attachment: Total Counter
034 Refill Information
041 Serial No.
042 Attachment Date
043 Attachment: Total Counter
044 Refill Information

338

System SP7-xxx

7938

[Toner Bottle Log 1/2/3/4/5: Y]

001 Serial No.


002 Attachment Date
003 Attachment: Total Counter

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 1 for Y.

004 Refill Information


011 Serial No.
012 Attachment Date
013 Attachment: Total Counter

3
*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 2 for Y.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 3 for Y.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 4 for Y.

*ENG

Displays the toner bottle information log 5 for Y.

014 Refill Information


021 Serial No.
022 Attachment Date
023 Attachment: Total Counter
024 Refill Information
031 Serial No.
032 Attachment Date
033 Attachment: Total Counter
034 Refill Information
041 Serial No.
042 Attachment Date
043 Attachment: Total Counter
044 Refill Information
7950

[Unit Replacement Date]

339

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

001 Image Transfer Belt


002 Cleaning Unit
003 Paper Transfer Unit

*ENG

Displays the replacement date of each PM


unit.

*ENG

Displays the replacement date of each PM


unit.

004 Fusing Unit


005 Toner Collection Bottle
006 PCDU:Bk (Drum Unit)

007 PCDU:M (Drum Unit)


008 PCDU:C (Drum Unit)
009 PCDU:Y (Drum Unit)
010 Fusing Roller
011 Pressure Roller

7951

340

[Remaining Day Counter]


Displays the remaining unit life of each PM unit.
001 Page: PCU (Drum): Bk

002 Page: PCU (Drum): M

003 Page: PCU (Drum): C

004 Page: PCU (Drum): Y

005 Page: Development Unit: Bk

006 Page: Development Unit: M

007 Page: Development Unit: C

008 Page: Development Unit: Y

009 Page: Developer: Bk

010 Page: Developer: M

011 Page: Developer: C

012 Page: Developer: Y

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step]

System SP7-xxx

013 Page: Image Transfer


014 Page: Cleaning Unit
015 Page: Fusing Unit
016 Page: Paper Transfer Unit

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step]

017 Page: Fusing Roller


018 Page: Pressure Roller

031 Rotation: PCU (Drum): Bk


032 Rotation: PCU (Drum): M
033 Rotation: PCU (Drum): C
034 Rotation: PCU (Drum): Y
035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk
036 Rotation: Development Unit: M
037 Rotation: Development Unit: C

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step]

[0 to 255 / 255 / 1 day/step]

038 Rotation: Development Unit: Y


039 Rotation: Developer: Bk
040 Rotation: Developer: M
041 Rotation: Developer: C
042 Rotation: Developer: Y
043 Rotation: Image Transfer
044 Rotation: Cleaning Unit
045 Rotation: Fusing Unit
046 Rotation: Paper Transfer Unit
047

Measurement: Toner Collection


bottle

048 Page: Fusing Roller


049 Page: Pressure Roller

341

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

[PM Yield Setting]

7952

Adjusts the unit yield of each PM unit.


001

Rotation: Image Transfer


Belt

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 312707000 / 1 mm/step]

002 Rotation: Cleaning Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 104236000 / 1 mm/step]

003 Rotation: Fusing Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 172023000 / 1 mm/step]

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 156354000 / 1 mm/step]

011 Page: Image Transfer Belt

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 600000 / 1 sheet/step]

012 Page: Cleaning Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 200000 / 1 sheet/step]

013 Page: Fusing Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 300000 / 1 sheet/step]

014 Page: Paper Transfer Unit

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 300000 / 1 sheet/step]

004

Rotation: Paper Transfer


Unit

021

Day Threshold: PCU


(Drum): Bk

022

Day Threshold: PCU


(Drum): M

023

Day Threshold: PCU


(Drum): C

024

Day Threshold: PCU


(Drum): Y

Day Threshold:
025
Development Unit: Bk

342

026

Day Threshold:
Development Unit: M

027

Day Threshold:
Development Unit: C

028

Day Threshold:
Development Unit: Y

*CTL

Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each
PM unit.
[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
These threshold days are used for @Remote alarms.

System SP7-xxx

029

Day Threshold: Developer:


Bk

030

Day Threshold: Developer:


M

031

Day Threshold: Developer:


C

032

Day Threshold: Developer:


Y

033

Day Threshold: Image


Transfer Belt

034

Day Threshold: Cleaning


Unit

*CTL

Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each
PM unit.

[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
These threshold days are used for @Remote alarms.

035 Day Threshold: Fusing Unit


036 Day Threshold: PTR Unit
037

Day Threshold: Toner


Collection Bottle

038

Rotation: PCU (Drum Unit):


Bk

039

Rotation: PCU (Drum Unit):


M

Rotation: PCU (Drum Unit):


040
C
041

Rotation: PCU (Drum Unit):


Y

042

Rotation: Development
Unit: Bk

043

Rotation: Development
Unit: M

Rotation: Development
044
Unit: C
045

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

Rotation: Development
Unit: Y
343

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

046 Rotation: Developer: Bk


047 Rotation: Developer: M

*CTL

[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

055 Page: Development Unit: M *CTL

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

048 Rotation: Developer: C


049 Rotation: Developer: Y
050 Page: PCU (Drum Unit): Bk
051 Page: PCU (Drum Unit): M

052 Page: PCU (Drum Unit): C


053 Page: PCU (Drum Unit): Y
054

Page: Development Unit:


Bk

056 Page: Development Unit: C


057 Page: Development Unit: Y
058 Page: Developer: Bk
059 Page: Developer: M
060 Page: Developer: C

*CTL

[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]

061 Page: Developer: Y


7953

[Operation Env. Log: PCDU: Bk]


Displays the PCDU rotation distance in each specified operation environment.
T: Temperature (C), H: Relative Humidity (%)

344

001 T<=5: 0<=H<30

*CTL

002 T<=5: 30<=H<55

*CTL

003 T<=5: 55<=H<80

*CTL

004 T<=5: 80<=H<=100

*CTL

005 5<T<15: 0<=H<30

*CTL

006 5<T<15: 30<=H<55

*CTL

[0 to 99999999 / - / 1 mm/step]

System SP7-xxx

007 5<T<15: 55<=H<80

*CTL

008 5<T<15: 80<=H<=100

*CTL

009 15<=T<25: 0<=H<30

*CTL

010 15<=T<25: 30<=H<55

*CTL

011 15<=T<25: 55<=H<80

*CTL

012 15<=T<25: 80<=H<=100

*CTL

013 25<=T<30: 0<=H<30

*CTL

014 25<=T<30: 30<=H<55

*CTL

015 25<=T<30: 55<=H<80

*CTL

016 25<=T<30: 80<=H<=100

*CTL

017 30<=T: 0<=H<30

*CTL

018 30<=T: 30<=H<55

*CTL

019 30<=T: 55<=H<80

*CTL

020 30<=T: 80<=H<=100

*CTL

[Operation Env. Log Clear]

7954

Clears the operation environment log.


001

7955

[Fusing: Stop] Not Used

345

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

System SP8-xxx
SP8-xxx: Data Log2
Many of these counters are provided for features that are currently not available, such as sending color
faxes, and so on. However, here are some Group 8 codes that when used in combination with others, can
provide useful information.

SP Numbers

What They Do

SP8 211 to SP8 216

The number of pages scanned to the document server.

SP8 401 to SP8 406

The number of pages printed from the document server

SP8 691 to SP8 696

The number of pages sent from the document server

Specifically, the following questions can be answered:


How is the document server actually being used?
What application is using the document server most frequently?
What data in the document server is being reused?
Most of the SPs in this group are prefixed with a letter that indicates the mode of operation (the mode of
operation is referred to as an "application"). Before reading the Group 8 Service Table, make sure that
you understand what these prefixes mean.
Prefixes

346

What it means

T:

Total: (Grand Total).

C:

Copy application.

F:

Fax application.

P:

Print application.

S:

Scan application.

Grand total of the items counted for all applications (C, F, P,


etc.).

Totals (pages, jobs, etc.) executed for each application when


the job was not stored on the document server.

System SP8-xxx

L:

Local storage (document


server)

O:

Other applications
(external network
applications, for
example)

Totals (jobs, pages, etc.) for the document server. The L:


counters work differently case by case. Sometimes, they
count jobs/pages stored on the document server; this can be
in document server mode (from the document server
window), or from another mode, such as from a printer driver
or by pressing the Store File button in the Copy mode
window. Sometimes, they include occasions when the user
uses a file that is already on the document server. Each
counter will be discussed case by case.
Refers to network applications such as Web Image Monitor.
Utilities developed with the SDK (Software Development Kit)
will also be counted with this group in the future.

The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on the small
LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations below and refer to it
again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand.
Key for Abbreviations
Abbreviation

What it means

"By", e.g. "T:Jobs/Apl" = Total Jobs "by" Application

>

More (2> "2 or more", 4> "4 or more"

AddBook

Address Book

Apl

Application

B/W

Black & White

Bk

Black

Cyan

ColCr

Color Create

ColMode

Color Mode

Comb

Combine

Comp

Compression

Deliv

Delivery

347

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Abbreviation

348

What it means

DesApl

Designated Application. The application (Copy, Fax, Scan, Print) used to


store the job on the document server, for example.

Dev Counter

Development Count, no. of pages developed.

Dup, Duplex

Duplex, printing on both sides

Emul

Emulation

FC

Full Color

FIN

Post-print processing, i.e. finishing (punching, stapling, etc.)

Full Bleed

No Margins

GenCopy

Generation Copy Mode

GPC

Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does not count
up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number
that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page job, the counter counts up
11-10 =1)

IFax

Internet Fax

ImgEdt

Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border
removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.

Black (YMCK)

LS

Local Storage. Refers to the document server.

LSize

Large (paper) Size

Mag

Magnification

MC

One color (monochrome)

NRS

New Remote Service, which allows a service center to monitor machines


remotely. "NRS" is used overseas, "CSS" is used in Japan.

Org

Original for scanning

OrgJam

Original Jam

Palm 2

Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows print jobs
to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files
to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats.

System SP8-xxx

Abbreviation

What it means

PC

Personal Computer

PGS

Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original. Duplex pages
count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two pages if the A3/DLT
counter SP is switched ON.

PJob

Print Jobs

Ppr

Paper

PrtJam

Printer (plotter) Jam

PrtPGS

Print Pages

Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2 only. This
machine is under development and currently not available.

Rez

Resolution

SC

Service Code (Error SC code displayed)

Scn

Scan

Sim, Simplex

Simplex, printing on 1 side.

S-to-Email

Scan-to-E-mail

SMC

SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8 counters are recorded
in the SMC report.

Svr

Server

TonEnd

Toner End

TonSave

Toner Save

TXJob

Send, Transmission

YMC

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan

YMCK

Yellow, Magenta, Cyan, Black

All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801 1 Memory All Clear.

349

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

T:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 002

C:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 003

F:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 004

P:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 005

S:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 006

L:Total Jobs

*CTL

8 001

These SPs count the number of times each application is used


to do a job.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: The L: counter is the total number of times the other
applications are used to send a job to the document server,
plus the number of times a file already on the document server
is used.

These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages processed.
When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.
Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer using the
SP modes are not counted.
When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is counted at
the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified.
A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.
When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not (the
document server is not used).
A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are not
counted separately).
A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one
transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission has been
completed.
A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.
The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.
When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a print job
stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.
When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters both
increment.
When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.
When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server, only the
L: counter increments.
When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server, only the
L: counter increments.

350

System SP8-xxx

When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.
When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However,
for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter increments.
8 011

T:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 012

C:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 013

F:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 014

P:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 015

S:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 016

L:Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 017

O:Jobs/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of jobs stored to the document


server by each application, to reveal how local storage is
being used for input.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from within


the document server mode screen at the operation panel.

When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document
server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.
When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.
When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.
When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.
When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.
8 021

T:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 022

C:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 023

F:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 024

P:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 025

S:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 026

L:Pjob/LS

*CTL

8 027

O:Pjob/LS

*CTL

These SPs reveal how files printed from the document


server were stored on the document server originally.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.

When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter
increments.
When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document server
with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment.
When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter
increments.
351

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter
increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter
increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed
with another application, the O: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image
Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.
When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.

8 031

T:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 032

C:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 033

F:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 034

P:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 035

S:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 036

L:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

8 037

O:Pjob/DesApl

*CTL

These SPs reveal what applications were used to output


documents from the document server.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs printed from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.

When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application
that started the print job is incremented.
When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.)
the L: counter increments.
8 041

T:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 042

C:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 043

F:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 044

P:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 045

S:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 046

L:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

8 047

O:TX Jobs/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the applications that stored files on the


document server that were later accessed for
transmission over the telephone line or over a network
(attached to an e-mail, or as a fax image by I-Fax).
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: Jobs merged for sending are counted
separately.
The L: counter counts the number of jobs scanned from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.

When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an email, the O: counter increments.

352

System SP8-xxx

8 051

T:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 052

C:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 053

F:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 054

P:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 055

S:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 056

L:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

8 057

O:TX Jobs/DesApl

*CTL

These SPs count the applications used to send files


from the document server over the telephone line or
over a network (attached to an e-mail, or as a fax
image by I-Fax). Jobs merged for sending are
counted separately.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of jobs sent from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.

If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter
increments.
T:FIN Jobs
8 061

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
F:FIN Jobs

8 063

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by the
application.
C:FIN Jobs

8 062

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time.
P:FIN Jobs

8 064

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
S:FIN Jobs

8 065

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.

353

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

L:FIN Jobs
8 066

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external application, over the
network. The finishing method is specified by the application.

8 06x 1 Sort

Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored copy job is set for
Sort and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments.
(See SP8 066 1)

8 06x 2 Stack

Number of jobs started out of Sort mode.

8 06x 3 Staple

Number of jobs started in Staple mode.

8 06x 4 Booklet

Number of jobs started in Booklet mode. If the machine is in staple mode,


the Staple counter also increments.

8 06x 5 Z-Fold

Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Z-fold).

8 06x 6 Punch

Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch is set for a print job,
the P: counter increments. (See SP8 064 6.)

8 06x 7 Other

Reserved. Not used.

8 06x 8

8 06x 9

8 06x 10

InsideFold
ThreeIN-Fold
ThreeOUT-Fold
T:Jobs/PGS

8 071

354

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode
screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window
within document server mode.
O:FIN Jobs

8 067

*CTL

Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Inside-fold).
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Inside-IN-fold).
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Inside-OUT-fold).
*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in the job,
regardless of which application was used.

System SP8-xxx

C:Jobs/PGS
8 072

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of pages in the job.
O:Jobs/PGS

8 077

These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
L:Jobs/PGS

8 076

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the number of
pages in the job.
S:Jobs/PGS

8 075

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the number of
pages in the job.
P:Jobs/PGS

8 074

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
F:Jobs/PGS

8 073

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs (Web Image
Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job.

8 07x 1 1 Page

8 07x 8

21 to 50 Pages

8 07x 2 2 Pages

8 07x 9

51 to 100 Pages

8 07x 3 3 Pages

8 07x 10

101 to 300 Pages

8 07x 4 4 Pages

8 07x 11

301 to 500 Pages

8 07x 5 5 Pages

8 07x 12

501 to 700 Pages

8 07x 6 6 to 10 Pages

8 07x 13

701 to 1000 Pages

8 07x 7 11 to 20 Pages

8 07x 14

1001 to Pages

For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode,
the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.
Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).
Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
355

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.


If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the time the
error occurs.
For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the number
of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)
The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of pages of the
copy job (SP 8072).

When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted.
T:FAX TX Jobs
8 111

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax, either
directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
F: FAX TX Jobs

8 113

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax directly
on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.

8 11x 1 B/W
8 11x 2 Color
These counters count jobs, not pages.
This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including documents stored
on the document server.
If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job started.
If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where both are
available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (8 12x) also increments.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
T:IFAX TX Jobs
8 121

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, either directly
or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.

356

System SP8-xxx

F: IFAX TX Jobs
8 123

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not stored on the
document server), as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.

8 12x 1 B/W
8 12x 2 Color

These counters count jobs, not pages.


The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at this time.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
T:S-to-Email Jobs
8 131

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and
attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not.
S: S-to-Email Jobs

8 135

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached
to e-mail, without storing the original on the document server.

8 13x 1 B/W
8 13x 2 Color
8 13x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color or blackand-white then counted.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be
sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC, or if one
job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For example, if the same
document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is counted twice (once for Scan-toEmail and once for Scan-to-PC).

357

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

T:Deliv Jobs/Svr
8 141

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
to a Scan Router server.
S: Deliv Jobs/Svr

8 145

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned in scanner mode
and sent to a Scan Router server.

8 14x 1 B/W
8 14x 2 Color
8 14x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router server
cannot be confirmed.
If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a "Color"
job.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be
delivered, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.
T:Deliv Jobs/PC
8 151

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC).
Note: At the present time, 8 151 and 8 155 perform identical counts.
S:Deliv Jobs/PC

8 155

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
with Scan-to-PC.

8 15x 1 B/W
8 15x 2 Color
8 15x 3 ACS

358

*CTL

System SP8-xxx

These counters count jobs, not pages.


If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted.
If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.
8 161

T:PCFAX TX Jobs

*CTL

These SPs count the number of PC Fax transmission


jobs. A job is counted from when it is registered for
sending, not when it is sent.

8 163

F:PCFAX TX Jobs

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Note: At the present time, these counters perform


identical counts.
This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to the
destination from the PC through the copier.
8 171

T:Deliv Jobs/WSD

*CTL

These SPs count the pages scanned by WS.

8 175

S:Deliv Jobs/WSD

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

-001 B/W
-002 Color
-003 ACS
8 181

T:Scan to Media Jobs

*CTL

These SPs count the scanned pages in a media by the


scanner application.

8 185

S:Scan to Media Jobs

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

-001 B/W
-002 Color
-003 ACS

359

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 191

T:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

8 192

C:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

8 193

F:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

8 195

S:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

8 196

L:Total Scan PGS

*CTL

These SPs count the pages scanned by each


application that uses the scanner to scan images.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

SP 8 191 to 8 196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages.
These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.
Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.
A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.
Scans made in SP mode are not counted.
Examples
If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S: count
is 4.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File button
in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
T:LSize Scan PGS
8 201

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan and
copy jobs. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
F: LSize Scan PGS

8 203

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for fax
transmission.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
S:LSize Scan PGS

8 205

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan jobs
only. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.

360

System SP8-xxx

8 211

T:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 212

C:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 213

F:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 215

S:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

8 216

L:Scan PGS/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages scanned into the


document server .
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen

Reading user stamp data is not counted.


If a job is cancelled, the pages output as far as the cancellation are counted.

If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4.
If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the
L: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
ADF Org Feeds
8 221

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back side
scanning.
Number of front sides fed for scanning:

8 221 1

Front

With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is
the same as the number of pages fed for either simplex or duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count
is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The
front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.)
Number of rear sides fed for scanning:

8 221 2

Back

With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the
same as the number of pages fed for duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is
the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning.

When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.
If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the
pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.

361

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Scan PGS/Mode
8 231

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to determine the
work load on the ADF.

8 231 1 Large Volume

Selectable. Large copy jobs that cannot be loaded in the


ADF at one time.

8 231 2 SADF

Selectable. Feeding pages one by one through the ADF.

8 231 3 Mixed Size

Selectable. Select "Mixed Sizes" on the operation panel.

8 231 4 Custom Size

Selectable. Originals of non-standard size.

8 231 5 Platen

Book mode. Raising the ADF and placing the original


directly on the platen.

8 231 6 Mixed 1side/ 2side

Simplex and Duplex mode.

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the original's
page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.
If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled.
In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the
Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.
T:Scan PGS/Org
8 241

8 242

8 243

8 245

362

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all jobs,
regardless of which application was used.
C:Scan PGS/Org

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy jobs.
F:Scan PGS/Org

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax jobs.
S:Scan PGS/Org

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan jobs.

System SP8-xxx

L:Scan PGS/Org
8 246

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document
server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within
the Copy mode screen
8 241

8 242

8 243

8 245

8 246

8 24x 1: Text

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 2: Text/Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 3: Photo

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

8 24x 4: GenCopy, Pale

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

8 24x 5: Map

Yes

Yes

No

Yes

Yes

8 24x 6: Normal/Detail

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

8 24x 7: Fine/Super Fine

Yes

No

Yes

No

No

8 24x 8: Binary

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

8 24x 9: Grayscale

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

8 24x 10: Color

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

8 24x 11: Other

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.

363

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 251

T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 252

C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 255

S:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

8 256

L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

These SPs show how many times Image Edit features


have been selected at the operation panel for each
application. Some examples of these editing features
are:
Erase> Border
Erase> Center
Image Repeat

Centering
8 257

O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt

*CTL

Positive/Negative
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: The count totals the number of times the edit
features have been used. A detailed breakdown of
exactly which features have been used is not given.

The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.
8 261

T:Scan PGS/ColCr

*CTL

8 262

C:Scan PGS/ ColCr

*CTL

8 265

S:Scn PGS/Color

*CTL

8 266

L:Scn PGS/ColCr

*CTL

8 26x 1 Color Conversion


8 26x 2 Color Erase

These SPs show how many times color creation features


have been selected at the operation panel.

8 26x 3 Background
8 26x 4 Other

364

8 281

T:Scan PGS/TWAIN

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages scanned using a


TWAIN driver. These counters reveal how the TWAIN
driver is used for delivery functions.

8 285

S:Scan PGS/TWAIN

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.

System SP8-xxx

8 291

T:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

8 293

F:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

8 295

S:Scan PGS/Stamp

*CTL

T:Scan PGS/Size
8 301

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan application.
Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP
8-445].
L:Scan PGS/Size

8 306

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax application. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-443].
S:Scan PGS/Size

8 305

*CTL

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application.
Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page
size [SP 8-442].
F:Scan PGS/Size

8 303

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all applications. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size
[SP 8-441].
C:Scan PGS/Size

8 302

These SPs count the number of pages stamped with the


stamp in the ADF unit.

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored from within the
document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size
(scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446].

365

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 30x 1 A3
8 30x 2 A4
8 30x 3 A5
8 30x 4 B4
8 30x 5 B5

8 30x 6 DLT
8 30x 7 LG

8 30x 8 LT
8 30x 9 HLT
8 30x 10 Full Bleed
8 30x 254 Other (Standard)
8 30x 255 Other (Custom)
T:Scan PGS/Rez
8 311

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
S: Scan PGS/Rez

8 315

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
Note: At the present time, SP8-311 and SP8-315 perform identical counts.

8 31x 1

1200dpi <

8 31x 2

600dpi to 1199dpi

8 31x 3

400dpi to 599dpi

8 31x 4

200dpi to 399dpi

8 31x 5

< 199dpi

Copy resolution settings are fixed so they are not counted.


The Fax application does not allow finely-adjusted resolution settings so no count is done for the Fax
application.
366

System SP8-xxx

8 381

T:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 382

C:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 383

F:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 384

P:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 385

S:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 386

L:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

8 387

O:Total PrtPGS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed by the


customer. The counter for the application used for
storing the pages increments.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen go to the C: counter.

When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as
2.
When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages
are not counted as printed pages:
- Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
- Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
- Reports printed to confirm counts.
- All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
- Test prints for machine image adjustment.
- Error notification reports.
- Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.
LSize PrtPGS
8 391

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also
displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.

367

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 401

T:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 402

C:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 403

F:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 404

P:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 405

S:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

8 406

L:PrtPGS/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed from the


document server. The counter for the application used
to print the pages is incremented.
The L: counter counts the number of jobs stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.
Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.

8 411

Prints/Duplex

*CTL

This SP counts the amount of paper (front/back


counted as 1 page) used for duplex printing. Last
pages printed only on one side are not counted.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 421

368

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the printer application.
S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 425

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 424

*CTL

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the copier application.
F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 423

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

8 422

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the scanner application.

System SP8-xxx

L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation
panel.

8 426

O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 427

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by Other applications

8 42x 1 Simplex> Duplex

8 42x 2 Duplex> Duplex


8 42x 3 Book> Duplex
8 42x 4 Simplex Combine
8 42x 5 Duplex Combine
8 42x 6 2>

2 pages on 1 side (2-Up)

8 42x 7 4>

4 pages on 1 side (4-Up)

8 42x 8 6>

6 pages on 1 side (6-Up)

8 42x 9 8>

8 pages on 1 side (8-Up)

8 42x 10 9>

9 pages on 1 side (9-Up)

8 42x 11 16>

16 pages on 1 side (16-Up)

8 42x 12 Booklet
8 42x 13 Magazine
These counts (SP8 421 to SP8 427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their
compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.
Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.
Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:
Booklet

Magazine

Original Pages

Count

Original Pages

Count

369

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 431

370

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document server mode
window at the operation panel with the three features below.
O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 437

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
print application.
L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 436

*CTL

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
copy application.
P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 434

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below,
regardless of which application was used.
C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt

8 432

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with
Other applications.

8 43x 1 Cover/Slip Sheet

Total number of covers or slip sheets inserted. The count for a


cover printed on both sides counts 2.

8 43x 2 Series/Book

The number of pages printed in series (one side) or printed as


a book with booklet right/left pagination.

8 43x 3 User Stamp

The number of pages printed where stamps were applied,


including page numbering and date stamping.

System SP8-xxx

8 441

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 443

F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 447

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the printer
application.
*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the scanner
application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 446

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax application.

S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 445

*CTL

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy
application.

P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 444

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

8 442

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.
O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other applications.

371

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 44x 1 A3
8 44x 2 A4
8 44x 3 A5
8 44x 4 B4
8 44x 5 B5

8 44x 6 DLT
8 44x 7 LG
8 44x 8 LT
8 44x 9 HLT
8 44x 10 Full Bleed
8 44x 254 Other (Standard)
8 44x 255 Other (Custom)
These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF.
8 451

372

PrtPGS/Ppr Tray

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station.

8 451 1 Bypass

Bypass Tray

8 451 2 Tray 1

Copier

8 451 3 Tray 2

Copier

8 451 4 Tray 3

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

8 451 5 Tray 4

Paper Tray Unit (Option)

8 451 6 Tray 5

LCT (Option)

8 451 7 Tray 6

Currently not used.

8 451 8 Tray 7

Currently not used.

8 451 9 Tray 8

Currently not used.

8 451 10 Tray 9

Currently not used.

System SP8-xxx

T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications.
8 461

These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is based on
feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However,
these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page printed
on one side counts as 1.

8 462

8 463

8 464

C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy application.
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type

8 466

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel.

8 46x 1 Normal
8 46x 2 Recycled
8 46x 3 Special
8 46x 4 Thick
8 46x 5 Normal (Back)
8 46x 6 Thick (Back)
8 46x 7 OHP
8 46x 8 Other

8 471

PrtPGS/Mag

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by magnification rate the number of pages printed.

373

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 471 1 < 49%


8 471 2 50% to 99%
8 471 3 100%
8 471 4 101% to 200%
8 471 5 201% <

Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but performed
remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification adjustment as
well.
Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also
counted.
Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document server
are not counted.
Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are
counted.
The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate of
100%.
8 481

T:PrtPGS/TonSave

*CTL

8 484

P:PrtPGS/TonSave

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on.
Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 491

T:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 492

C:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 493

F:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 496

L:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 497

O:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 49x 1 B/W
8 49x 2 Single Color

374

These SPs count the number of pages


printed in the Color Mode by each
application.

System SP8-xxx

8 49x 3 Two Color


8 49x 4 Full Color
8 501

T:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 504

P:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

8 057

O:PrtPGS/Col Mode

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages


printed in the Color Mode by the print
application.

8 50x 1 B/W
8 50x 2 Mono Color
8 50x 3 Full Color
8 50x 4 Single Color
8 50x 5 Two Color

8 511

8 514

T:PrtPGS/Emul

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed.
P:PrtPGS/Emul

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed.

375

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 514 1

RPCS

8 514 2

RPDL

8 514 3

PS3

8 514 4

R98

8 514 5

R16

8 514 6

GL/GL2

8 514 7

R55

8 514 8

RTIFF

8 514 9

PDF

8 514 10

PCL5e/5c

8 514 11

PCL XL

8 514 12

IPDL-C

8 514 13

BM-Links

8 514 14

Other

8 514 15

IPDS

Japan Only

SP8 511 and SP8 514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.
Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.
8 521

T:PrtPGS/FIN

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy
application.
F:PrtPGS/FIN

8 523

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications.
C:PrtPGS/FIN

8 522

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Fax
application.
NOTE: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available.

376

System SP8-xxx

P:PrtPGS/FIN
8 524

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Scanner
application.
L:PrtPGS/FIN

8 526

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print
application.
S:PrtPGS/FIN

8 525

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.

8 52x 1 Sort
8 52x 2 Stack
8 52x 3 Staple
8 52x 4 Booklet
8 52x 5 Z-Fold
8 52x 6 Punch
8 52x 7 Other
8 52x 8 Inside-Fold
8 52x 9 Three-IN-Fold
8 52x 10 Three-OUT-Fold
8 52x 11 Four-Fold
8 52x 12 KANNON-Fold
8 52x 13 Perfect-Bind
8 52x 14 Ring-Bind

If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still
counted.
The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted.

377

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 531

Staples

*CTL

T:Counter
8 581

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
*CTL

[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the
application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.

8 581 1 Total
8 581 2 Total: Full Color
8 581 3 B&W/Single Color
8 581 4 Development: CMY
8 581 5 Development: K
8 581 6 Copy: Color
8 581 7 Copy: B/W
8 581 8 Print: Color
8 581 9 Print: B/W
8 581 10 Total: Color
8 581 11 Total: B/W
8 581 12 Full Color: A3
8 581 13 Full Color: B4 JIS or Smaller
8 581 14 Full Color Print
8 581 15 Mono Color Print
8 581 16 Full Color GPC
8 581 17 Twin Colour Mode Print
8 581 18 Full Colour Print (Twin)
8 581 19 Mono Colour Print (Twin)
8 581 20 Full Colour Total (CV)

378

This SP counts the amount of staples used by the machine.

System SP8-xxx

8 581 21 Mono Colour Total (CV)


8 581 22 Full Colour Print (CV)
8 582

C:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the copy application broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W

8 582 2 Single Color


8 582 3 Two Color
8 582 4 Full Color
8 583

F:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the fax application broken down by color output.
8 583 1 B/W
8 583 2 Single Color
8 584

P:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the print application broken down by color output.
8 584 1 B/W
8 584 2 Mono Color
8 584 3 Full Color
8 584 4 Single Color
8 584 5 Two Color
8 586

L:Counter

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total output of the local storage broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W
8 582 2 Single Color

379

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 582 3 Two Color


8 582 4 Full Color
O:Counter
8 591

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages printed, and
the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:) applications only.

8 591 1 A3/DLT
8 591 2 Duplex
Coverage Counter
8 601

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the total coverage for each color and the total printout pages for each
printing mode.

8 601 1 B/W
8 601 2 Color
8 601 11 B/W Printing Pages
8 601 12 Color Printing Pages
8 601 21 Coverage Counter 1
8 601 22 Coverage Counter 2
8 601 23 Coverage Counter 3

8 617

SDK Apli Counter

*CTL

These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK applicaion.

8 617 1 SDK-1
8 617 2 SDK-2
8 617 3 SDK-3
8 617 4 SDK-4
8 617 5 SDK-5
8 617 6 SDK-6

380

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

System SP8-xxx

8 631

8 633

T:FAX TX PGS

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
F:FAX TX PGS

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.

8 63x 1 B/W
8 63x 2 Color

If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
T:IFAX TX PGS
8 641

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using
I-Fax.
F:IFAX TX PGS

8 643

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax images using
I-Fax.

8 64x 1 B/W
8 64x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.

381

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.


Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
T:S-to-Email PGS
8 651

8 655

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for both
the Scan and document server applications.
S:S-to-Email PGS

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for the
Scan application only.

8 65x 1 B/W
8 65x 2 Color

The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is
cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.
If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are
sent to the same SMTP server together).
If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent
to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).
Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large
number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page
document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also
10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20.).
T:Deliv PGS/Svr
8 661

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server
by the Scan application.

8 66x 1 B/W
8 66x 2 Color

382

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server
by both Scan and LS applications.
S:Deliv PGS/Svr

8 665

*CTL

System SP8-xxx

The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router
server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done.
The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server.
T:Deliv PGS/PC
8 671

*CTL

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on a PC (Scanto-PC) with the Scan and LS applications.
S:Deliv PGS/PC

8 675

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with Scan-to-PC with the
Scan application.

8 67x 1 B/W
8 67x 2 Color
8 681

T:PCFAX TXPGS

*CTL

8 683

F:PCFAX TXPGS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages sent by PC Fax.


These SPs are provided for the Fax application only,
so the counts for SP8 681 and SP8 683 are the same.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the
destination.
When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only
counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes
up by 10, not 20.)
8 691

T:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 692

C:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 693

F:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 694

P:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 695

S:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

8 696

L:TX PGS/LS

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages sent from the


document server. The counter for the application that
was used to store the pages is incremented.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel. Pages stored with the Store File
button from within the Copy mode screen go to the C:
counter.

383

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.
If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages
sent to each destination.

TX PGS/Port
8 701

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send them. For
example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN
(G3, G4) is 12.

8 701 1 PSTN-1
8 701 2 PSTN-2
8 701 3 PSTN-3
8 701 4 ISDN (G3,G4)
8 701 5 Network
8 711
8 715

T:Scan PGS/Comp

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

S:Scan PGS/Comp

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages sent by each compression mode.

8 715 1 JPEG/JPEG2000
8 715 2 TIFF(Multi/Single)
8 715 3 PDF
8 715 4 Other
8 715 5 PDF/Comp
8 721
8 725

T:Deliv PGS/WSD

*CTL

S: Dvliv PGS/WSD

*CTL

These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode.
x 1 B/W

384

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

System SP8-xxx

x 2 Color
8 731

8 735

8 741

T:Scan PGS/Media

*CTL

S:Scan PGS/Media

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by each scanner
mode.
x 1 B/W

x 2 Color

RX PGS/Port

*CTL

3
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to receive them.

8 741 1 PSTN-1
8 741 2 PSTN-2
8 741 3 PSTN-3
8 741 4 ISDN (G3,G4)
8 741 5 Network
Dev Counter
8 771

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the development rollers)
for black and other color toners.

8 771 1 Total
8 771 2 K
8 771 3 Y
8 771 4 M
8 771 5 C

385

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Toner Bottle Info.


8 781

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of already replaced toner bottles.


NOTE: Currently, the data in SP7-833-011 through 014 and the data in SP8-781-001
through 004 are the same.

8 781 1 Toner: BK

The number of black-toner bottles

8 781 2 Toner: Y

The number of yellow-toner bottles

8 781 3 Toner: M

The number of magenta-toner bottles

8 781 4 Toner: C

The number of cyan-toner bottles

8 791

LS Memory Remain

*CTL

This SP displays the percent of space available


on the document server for storing documents.
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1]

Toner Remain
8 801

*CTL

[0 to 100/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP allows the user
to check the toner supply at any time.
Note: This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better than
other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10% steps).

8 801 1 K
8 801 2 Y
8 801 3 M
8 801 4 C
Coverage Count: 0-10%
8 851

386

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 0% to 10%.

8 851 11 0 to 2%: BK

8 851 31 5 to 7%: BK

8 851 12 0 to 2%: Y

8 851 32 5 to 7%: Y

8 851 13 0 to 2%: M

8 851 33 5 to 7%: M

8 851 14 0 to 2%: C

8 851 34 5 to 7%: C

System SP8-xxx

8 851 21 3 to 4%: BK

8 851 41 8 to 10%: BK

8 851 22 3 to 4%: Y

8 851 42 8 to 10%: Y

8 851 23 3 to 4%: M

8 851 43 8 to 10%: M

8 851 24 3 to 4%: C

8 851 44 8 to 10%: C

Coverage Count: 11-20%


8 861

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 11% to 20%.

8 861 1 BK
8 861 2 Y
8 861 3 M
8 861 4 C
Coverage Count: 21-30%
8 871

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 21% to 30%.

8 871 1 BK
8 871 2 Y
8 871 3 M
8 871 4 C
Coverage Count: 31%8 881

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is 31% or higher.

8 881 1 BK
8 881 2 Y
8 881 3 M
8 881 4 C

387

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 891

Page/Toner Bottle

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner for each color.

8 891 1 BK
8 891 2 Y
8 891 3 M

8 891 4 C

8 901

Page/Toner_prev1

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner for each color.

8 901 1 BK
8 901 2 Y
8 901 3 M
8 901 4 C

8 911

Page/Toner_prev2

*ENG

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner for each color.

8 911 1 BK
8 911 2 Y
8 911 3 M
8 911 4 C

8 921

388

Coverage Count: Total

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.

System SP8-xxx

8 921 1 BK (%)
8 921 2 Y (%)
8 921 3 M (%)
8 921 4 C (%)
8 921 11 Coverage /P: Bk
8 921 12 Coverage /P: Y

8 921 13 Coverage /P: M


8 921 14 Coverage /P: C
Machine Status
8 941

*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation mode. These
SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for
improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards.

8 941 1 Operation Time

Engine operation time. Does not include time while controller


is saving data to HDD (while engine is not operating).

8 941 2 Standby Time

Engine not operating. Includes time while controller saves


data to HDD. Does not include time spent in Energy Save,
Low Power, or Off modes.

8 941 3 Energy Save Time

Includes time while the machine is performing background


printing.

8 941 4 Low Power Time

Includes time in Energy Save mode with Engine on. Includes


time while machine is performing background printing.

8 941 5 Off Mode Time

Includes time while machine is performing background


printing. Does not include time machine remains powered off
with the power switches.

8 941 6 SC

Total time when SC errors have been staying.

8 941 7 PrtJam

Total time when paper jams have been staying during


printing.

8 941 8 OrgJam

Total time when original jams have been staying during


scanning.

389

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

8 941 9 Supply PM Unit End

8 951

AddBook Register

*CTL

These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data registration.

8 951 1 User Code

User code registrations.

8 951 2 Mail Address

Mail address registrations.

8 951 3 Fax Destination

Fax destination registrations.

8 951 4 Group

Group destination registrations.

8 951 5 Transfer Request

Fax relay destination registrations


for relay TX.

8 951 6 F-Code

F-Code box registrations.

8 951 7 Copy Program

Copy application registrations with


the Program (job settings) feature.

8 951 8 Fax Program

Fax application registrations with the


Program (job settings) feature.

8 951 9 Printer Program

Printer application registrations with [0 to 255 / 0 / 255]


the Program (job settings) feature.

8 951 10 Scanner Program

8 999

390

Total time when toner end has been staying

Adomin. Counter List

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Scanner application registrations


with the Program (job settings)
feature.
*CTL

[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]

Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.

System SP8-xxx

8 999 1 Total
8 999 2 Copy: Full Color
8 999 3 Copy: BW
8 999 4 Copy: Single Color
8 999 5 Copy: Two Color
8 999 6 Printer Full Color
8 999 7 Printer BW

8 999 8 Printer Single Color


8 999 9 Printer Two Color
8 999 10 Fax Print: BW
8 999 12 A3/DLT
8 999 13 Duplex
8 999 14 Coverage: Color (%)
8 999 15 Coverage: BW (%)
8 999 16 Coverage: Color Print Page (%)
8 999 17 Coverage: BW Print Page (%)
8 999 101 Transmission Total: Color
8 999 102 Transmission Total: BW
8 999 103 FAX Transmission
8 999 104 Scanner Transmission: Color
8 999 105 Scanner Transmission: BW

391

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Input and Output Check


Input Check Table
When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit corresponds to a
different device as shown in the table.

Bit No.

Result

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

0 or 1

Copier

5803

Description

5803 1 2nd Tray Size Detection


5803 2 1st Tray Set Detection

See table 2 following this table.


Set

Not set

5803 3 1st Tray Paper Height Sensor1

See table 1 following this table.

5803 4 1st Tray Paper Height Sensor2

See table 1 following this table.

5803 5 2nd Tray Paper Height Sensor1

See table 1 following this table.

5803 6 2nd Tray Paper Height Sensor2

See table 1 following this table.

5803 7 1st Tray Paper End Detection

No paper

Paper remaining

5803 8 2nd Tray Paper End Detection

No paper

Paper remaining

5803 9 1st Tray Upper Limit Sensor

Not upper limit

Upper limit

5803 10 2nd Tray Upper Limit Sensor

Not upper limit

Upper limit

5803 11 Bypass Paper Width Detection


5803 12 Bypass Paper End Detection
5803 13 Bypass Paper Length Detection

392

Reading

See table 3 following this table.


No paper

Paper remaining

See table 3 following this table.

5803 14 1st Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 15 2nd Paper Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Input and Output Check

5803 16 Exit Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Paper not full

Paper full

Paper not detected

Paper detected

5803 19 Fusing Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 20 1st Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 21 2nd Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 22 Duplex Exit Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 23 Registration Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 24 Duplex Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

5803 25 Junction Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Set

Not set

5803 30 Toner End Sensor: Bk

Toner end

Toner remaining

5803 31 Toner End Sensor: M

Toner end

Toner remaining

5803 32 Toner End Sensor: C

Toner end

Toner remaining

5803 33 Toner End Sensor: Y

Toner end

Toner remaining

5803 34 Drum Phase Sensor: Bk

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 35 Drum Phase Sensor: M

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 36 Drum Phase Sensor: C

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 37 Drum Phase Sensor: Y

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 38 Interlock Release Detection 1

Front door open

Front door closed

5803 39 Interlock Release Detection 2

Front door open

Front door closed

5803 40 Right Door

Closed

Open

5803 41 Duplex Cover

Closed

Open

5803 17 Tray Full Exit Sensor


5803 18 Fusing Exit Sensor

5803 26 2nd Tray Set Detection

393

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

394

5803 42 Toner Collection Bottle Set

Set

Not set

5803 43 Toner Collection Full Sensor

Not full

Full

5803 46 ITB New Unit Detection

Not new

New

5803 49 Duplex Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 50 Airflow Fan: Front: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 51 Airflow Fan: Rear: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 52 Fusing Exit Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 53 2nd Duct Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 54 3rd Duct Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 55 Paper Exit Fan:Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 56 Fusing Coil Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 57 IH Power Supply Cooling Fan: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 58 Airflow Fan: Middle 1: Lock

Not used

5803 59 Airflow Fan: Middle 2: Lock

Not used

5803 60 ITB Contact Motor Position

Not contact

Contact

5803 61 Paper Transfer Contact Motor Position

Not contact

Contact

5803 62 Toner Relay Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 63 ITB Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 64 K Drum/Development Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 65 M Drum/Development Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 66 C Drum/Development Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 67 Y Drum/Development Drive Motor: Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 68 Fusing Exit Motor:Lock

Normal

Lock

5803 80 HVPS:TTS:SC Detection

SC detected

No SC

5803 81 HVPS:CB:SC Detection

SC detected

No SC

5803 82 HVPS:D:SC Detection

SC detected

No SC

Input and Output Check

5803 83 Fusing Destination Detection: DOM (Dom)

Set

Not set

5803 84 Fusing Destination Detection: NA

Set

Not set

New

Not new

5803 91 Fusing Rotation Sensor

Actuator not
detected

Actuator detected

5803 92 Fusing Pressure Release Sensor

Not contact

Contact

Closed

Open

(LD5V ON)

(LD5V OFF)

5803 100 Keycard: Set

Set

Not set

5803 101 Mechanical Counter: Set

Set

Not set

5803 102 Mechanical Counter FC: Set

Set

Not set

5803 103 Key Counter: Set

Set

Not set

5803 200 Scanner HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

5803 201 Platen Cover Sensor

Open

Closed

5803 87 Fusing New Unit Detection


5803 90 Zero-cross Signal

5803 94 GAVD Open/Close Detection

5803 110 IOB Version

Table 1: Paper Height Sensor


0: Deactivated, 1: Activated (actuator inside sensor)
Remaining paper

Paper height sensor 1

Paper height sensor 2

Full

Nearly full

Near end

Almost empty

Table 2: Paper Size Switch (Tray 2)


Switch 1 is used for tray set detection.
395

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

0: Pushed, 1: Not pushed


Models
North America

Switch Location
Europe/Asia

4 (bit0)

3 (bit1)

2 (bit2)

11" x 17" SEF*1

A3 SEF*1

(A3 SEF)

(11" x 17" SEF)

8.5" x 14" SEF*2

B4 SEF*2

(B4 SEF)

(8.5" x 14" SEF)

A4 SEF

A4 SEF

8.5" x 11" SEF

8.5" x 11" SEF

B5 SEF

B5 SEF

11" x 81/2" LEF*3

A4 LEF*3

(A4 LEF)

(11" x 81/2" LEF)

10.5" x 7.25" LEF*4

B5 LEF*4

(B5 LEF)

(10.5" x 7.25" LEF)

A5 LEF

A5 LEF

*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003.
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004.
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002.
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-005.

ADF (D541)

6007

396

Description

Reading
0

6007 1 Original Length 1 (B5 Detection Sensor)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 2 Original Length 2 (A4 Detection Sensor)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 3 Original Length 3 (LG Detection Sensor)

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 4 Original Width S

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Input and Output Check

6007 5 Original Width M

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 6 Original Width L

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 7 Original Width LL

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 9 Original Detection

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 10 Rear Edge Detection

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 11 Skew Correction

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 13 Registration Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 14 Exit Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6007 15 Feed Cover

ADF cover close

ADF cover open

6007 16 Lift Up

ADF cover close

ADF cover open

1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher (B793)

6138

6138 1

6138 2

6138 3

6138 4

6138 5

6138 6

Description
Interference Escape Sensor
(Stapler Safety Sensor)
Staple Moving HP Sensor
(Staple Unit HP Sensor)
Stuck Relay1 Release HP Sensor (Stopper
S HP Sensor)
Exit Junction Gate HP Sensor
(Stack Feed Out HP Sensor)
Jogger HP Sensor
(Jogger Fence HP Sensor)
Staple Tray Paper Sensor
(Staple Tray Paper Sensor)

Reading
0

Not interfered

Interfered

Not home position

Home position

Not home position

Home position

Home position

Not home position

Not home position

Home position

Paper not detected

Paper detected

397

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

6138

6138 7

Description
Rear Edge Fence HP Sensor
(Paper Stack Stopper HP Sensor)

6138 8 Saddle Stitch Exit Sensor

6138 9

6138 10

6138 11

6138 12

6138 13

6138 14

6138 15

6138 16

Stuck Relay2 Roller HP Sensor


(Clamp Roller HP Sensor)
Folder Tray Full Sensor 1
(Bottom Tray HP 1 Sensor)
Folder Tray Full Sensor 2
(Bottom Tray HP 2 Sensor)
Folder Plate HP Sensor
(Fold Plate HP Sensor)
Saddle Stitch Arrival Sensor
(Fold Unit Entrance Sensor)
Folder Cam HP Sensor
(Fold Plate Cam HP Sensor)
Staple Exit Sensor
(Stapler Tray Exit Sensor)
Shift Tray Paper Sensor
(Shift Tray Paper Position Sensor)

6138 17 Shift Tray Full


6138 18 Shift Roller HP Sensor
6138 20

6138 21

398

Entrance Sensor
(Finisher Entrance Sensor)
Shift Exit Sensor
(Shift Tray Exit Sensor)

Reading
0

Not home position

Home position

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Home position

Not home position

Full

Not full

Not full

Full

Not home position

Home position

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Not home position

Home position

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Shift tray not detected

Shift tray detected

Full

Nor full

Not home position

Home position

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Input and Output Check

6138

6138 22

Description
Proof Exit Sensor
(Proof Tray Exit Sensor)

6138 23 Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor


6138 24

Proof Full Sensor


(Proof Tray Full Sensor)

6138 25 Upper Cover Sensor


6138 26

Door SW
(Front Door Switch)

Reading
0

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Not home position

Home position

Not full

Full

Open

Close

Close

Open

6138 27 Clincher Timing Sensor


6138 28 Clincher HP Sensor

Encoder
Home position

6138 29 Driver Timing Sensor

Not home position

Encoder

6138 30 Staple Near End

Staple remaining

Staple near end

6138 31 Self Priming

Staple detected

Staple not detected

6138 32 Driver HP Sensor

Home position

Not home position

Not home position

Home position

Not home position

Home position

Home position

Not home position

6138 33 Punch Registration Detection HP Sensor


6138 34

6138 35

6138 36

6138 37

6138 38

Punch Moving HP Sensor


(Punch Movement HP Sensor)
Punch HP Sensor
(Punch HP Sensor)
Punch Pulse Count Sensor

Encoder

(Punch Encoder Sensor)


Punch Chad Full Sensor
(Punch Hopper Full Sensor)
Punch Registration Detection Sensor
(Paper Position Sensor)

Not full

Full

Paper detected

Paper not detected

399

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

1000-Sheet Finisher (B408)

6139

Bit

Description

6139 1 Entrance Sensor

6139 2

6139 3

6139 4

6139 5

Shift Exit Sensor


(Lower Tray Exit Sensor)
Staple Entrance Sensor
(Stapler Tray Entrance Sensor)
Staple Moving HP Sensor
(Stapler HP Sensor)
Jogger HP Sensor
(Jogger Fence HP Sensor)

6139 6 Stack Feed-out Belt HP Sensor


6139 7 Staple Tray Paper Sensor
6139 8

Staple Rotation Sensor


(Staple Rotation HP Sensor)

6139 9 Staple Sensor


6139 10 Staple READY Detection
6139 11

Exit Guide Plate HP


(Exit Guide Plate HP Sensor)

6139 12 Shift HP Sensor


6139 13

6139 14

6139 15

400

Paper Sensor
(Stack Height Sensor)
Tray Lower Sensor
(Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor)
Proof Full Sensor
(Paper Limit Sensor)

Reading
0

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Not home position

Home position

Not home position

Home position

Home position

Not home position

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Not home position

Home position

Staple detected

Staple not detected

Staple detected

Staple not detected

Not home position

Home position

Not home position

Home position

Output tray not


detected

Output tray
detected

Lower limit

Not lower limit

Not full

Full

Input and Output Check

500-Sheet Finisher (D372)

6145

Description

Reading
0

6145 1 Entrance Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

6145 2 Hitroll HP Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Home position

Not home position

Home position

Not home position

6145 5 Staple Tray Paper Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

6145 6 Staple Moving HP Sensor

Not HP

HP

6145 7 Stack Feed-out Belt HP

Not HP

HP

6145 8 Shift Tray Paper Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

6145 9 Upper Cover Sensor

HP

Not HP

6145 10 Staple Rotation Sensor

HP

Not HP

6145 11 Staple Near End

HP

Not HP

6145 12 Self Priming

HP

Not HP

Not full

Full

6145 3

6145 4

Front Jogger HP Sensor


(Front Jogger Fence HP Sensor)
Rear Jogger HP Sensor
(Rear Jogger Fence HP Sensor)

6145 13 Shift Tray Limit Sensor

Bridge Unit (D386)/ Side Tray (D542)

6150

Description

Reading
0

6150 1 Bridge/Left: Exit Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

6150 2 Bridge/Left: Feed Sensor

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Set

Not set

Closed

Open

6150 3 Bridge/Left: Shift Set Detection


6150 4 Bridge/Left: Exit Cover Detection

401

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

6150 5 Bridge/Left: Feed Cover Detection


6150 6 Left/Left Exit Sensor

Closed

Open

Paper detected

Paper not detected

Internal Shift Tray (D388)

6152

Description

6152 1 Shift:Set Sensor


6152 2 Shift: Position Sensor

Reading
0

Set

Not Set

Tray position: front

Tray position: rear

1 Bin Tray (D536)

6154

Description

6154 1 1 bin: Set Sensor


6154 2 1 bin: Paper Sensor

Reading
0

Set

Not Set

Paper detected

Paper not detected

One or Two-Tray PFU (D387/D537)/ LCIT 2000 (D538)/ LCIT 1200 (D539)

6160

Description

6160 1 Bank: Tray3: Feed Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 2 Bank: Tray4: Feed Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 3 Bank: Tray5: Feed Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 4 Bank: Tray3: Relay Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 5 Bank: Tray4: Relay Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

6160 6 Bank: Tray5: Relay Sensor

Paper not detected

Paper detected

Closed

Open

6160 7 Bank: Feed Cover Detection

402

Reading

Input and Output Check

6160 11 Bank: Palau: Paper Supply Switch

Closed

Open

6160 12 Bank: Palau: Slide Switch

Closed

Open

Output Check Table


Copier
5804

Display

Description

5804 3 Drum/Dev Motor: K: HighSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-K: HighSpeed

5804 4 Drum/Dev Motor: K: MiddleSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-K: Middle


Speed

5804 5 Drum/Dev Motor: K: LowSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-M: Low Speed

5804 10 Drum/Dev Motor: M: HighSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor- C:


HighSpeed

5804 11 Drum/Dev Motor: M: MiddleSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Middle


Speed

5804 12 Drum/Dev Motor: M: LowSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Low Speed

5804 17 Drum/Dev Motor: C: HighSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor- C:


HighSpeed

5804 18 Drum/Dev Motor: C: MiddleSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Middle


Speed

5804 19 Drum/Dev Motor: C: LowSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Low Speed

5804 24 Drum/Dev Motor: Y: HighSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor- C:


HighSpeed

5804 25 Drum/Dev Motor: Y: MiddleSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Middle


Speed

5804 26 Drum/Dev Motor: Y: LowSpeed

Drum/Development Drive Motor-Y: Low Speed

5804 31 Fusing Exit Motor: HighSpeed

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor: HighSpeed

5804 32 Fusing Exit Motor: MiddleSpeed

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor: Middle Speed

403

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

5804 33 Fusing Exit Motor: LowSpeed

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor: Low Speed

5804 35 Fusing Exit Motor: LLowSpeed

Fusing/Paper Exit Motor: LLowSpeed

5804 37 Toner Relay Motor

Toner Transport Motor

5804 40 Image Transfer Motor: HighSpeed

ITB Drive Motor: HighSpeed

5804 41 Image Transfer Motor: MiddleSpeed

ITB Drive Motor: Middle Speed

5804 42 Image Transfer Motor: LowSpeed

ITB Drive Motor: Low Speed

5804 50 Feed Motor: HighSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: High Speed

5804 51 Feed Motor: IncreaseSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Increase Speed

5804 52 Feed Motor: MiddleSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Middle Speed

5804 53 Feed Motor: MiddleIncreaseSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Middle Increase Speed

5804 54 Feed Motor: LowSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Low Speed

5804 55 Feed Motor: LowInceraseSpeed

Paper Feed Motor: Low Incerase Speed

5804 60 Regist Motor: HighSpeed

Registration Motor: High Speed

5804 61 Regist Motor: MiddleSpeed

Registration Motor: Middle Speed

5804 62 Regist Motor: LowSpeed

Registration Motor: Low Speed

5804 67 Duplex Feed M:CW:HighSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CW: High Speed

5804 68 Duplex Feed M:CW:MiddleSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CW: Middle Speed

5804 69 Duplex Feed Motor: CW: LowSpeed

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CW: Low Speed

5804 74 Duplex Feed M:CCW:HighSpeed

5804 75 Duplex Feed M:CCW:MiddleSpeed

5804 76 Duplex Feed Motor: CCW: LowSpeed

404

Duplex/By-pass Motor: CCW:


High Speed
Duplex/By-pass Motor: CCW:
Middle Speed
Duplex/By-pass Motor: CCW:
Low Speed

5804 81 Duplex Reverse M:CW:HighSpeed

Duplex Inverter Motor: CW: High Speed

5804 82 Duplex Reverse M:CW:MiddleSpeed

Duplex Inverter Motor: CW: Middle Speed

Input and Output Check

5804 83

Duplex Reverse Motor: CW:


LowSpeed

5804 88 Duplex Reverse M:CCW:HighSpeed

Duplex Inverter Motor: CW: Low Speed


Duplex Inverter Motor: CCW:
High Speed

5804 89

Duplex Reverse
M:CCW:MiddleSpeed

Duplex Inverter Motor: CCW:

5804 90

Duplex Reverse Motor: CCW:


LowSpeed

Duplex Inverter Motor: CCW:

Middle Speed

Low Speed

5804 95 ITB Contact Motor

Image Transfer Belt Contact Motor

5804 96 Paper Transfer Contact Motor

Paper Transfer Contact Motor

5804 97 1st Tray Lift Motor: Up

Tray Lift Motor 1: Lift Up

5804 98 1st Tray Lift Motor: Down

Tray Lift Motor 1: Lift Down

5804 99 2nd Tray Lift Motor: Up

Tray Lift Motor 2: Lift Up

5804 100 2nd Tray Lift Motor: Down

Tray Lift Motor 2: Lift Down

5804 102 Fusing Pressue Release Motor

Pressure Roller Contact Motor

5804 104 Polygon Moter: LL

Polygon Motor: LL

5804 105 Polygon Moter: L

Polygon Motor: L

5804 107 Polygon Moter: HH

Polygon Motor: HH

5804 110 Air Flow Fan: Front

Ventilation Fan Front

5804 111 Air Flow Fan:Rear

Ventilation Fan Rear

5804 112 Fusing Fan:H

Fusing Fan: High Speed

5804 113 Fusing Fan:L

Fusing Fan: Low Speed

5804 114 PSU Cooling Fan

PSU Fan 1: High Speed

5804 115 2nd Duct Fan: H

Duct Fan 2: High Speed

5804 117 3rd Duct Fan: H

Duct Fan 3: High Speed

5804 119 Paper Exit Fan:H

Paper Exit Fan: High Speed

5804 121 Fusing Coil Fan

IH Coil Fan

405

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

5804 122

IH Power Supply Cooling Fan

5804 126 Development Clutch: Bk

Development Clutch-K

5804 127 Development Clutch: M

Development Clutch-M

5804 128 Development Clutch: C

Development Clutch-C

5804 129 Development Clutch: Y

Development Clutch-Y

5804 130 Toner Bottle Clutch: Bk

Toner Bottle Clutch-K

5804 131 Toner Bottle Clutch: M

Toner Bottle Clutch-M

5804 132 Toner Bottle Clutch: C

Toner Bottle Clutch-C

5804 133 Toner Bottle Clutch:Y

Toner Bottle Clutch-Y

5804 134 Toner Supply Pump: Bk

Toner Supply Clutch: Bk

5804 135 Toner Supply Pump: M

Toner Supply Clutch: M

5804 136 Toner Supply Pump: C

Toner Supply Clutch: C

5804 137 Toner Supply Pump: Y

Toner Supply Clutch: Y

5804 138 1st Paper Feed Clutch

Paper Feed Clutch 1

5804 139 2nd Paper Feed Clutch

Paper Feed Clutch 2

5804 140 Bypass Feed Clutch

By-pass Feed Clutch

5804 141 Bypass Pickup Solenoid

Bypass Pickup Solenoid

5804 143 TD Sensor Shutter Solenoid

ID Sensor Shutter Solenoid

5804 144 Exit Junction Solenoid

Junction Gate 1 Solenoid

5804 145 1st Feed Pickup Solenoid

1st Pickup Solenoid

5804 146 2nd Feed Pickup Solenoid

2nd Pickup Solenoid

5804 150 Duplex Fan: HighSpeed


5804 151 Duplex Fan: LowSpeed
5804 152 Air Flow Fan: Middle 1
5804 153 Reserve Fan1: LowSpeed
5804 154 Air Flow Fan: Middle 2
406

IH Inverter Fan

Input and Output Check

5804 155 Reserve Fan2: LowSpeed


5804 161 PCL: Bk
5804 162 PCL: M
5804 163 PCL: C
5804 164 PCL: Y
5804 166 HST Sensor:Bk

TD Sensor:Bk

5804 167 HST Sensor: M

TD Sensor: M

5804 168 HST Sensor: C

TD Sensor: C

5804 169 HST Sensor: Y

TD Sensor: Y

5804 170 Toner End Sensor: Bk

Toner End Sensor: Bk

5804 171 Toner End Sensor: M

Toner End Sensor: M

5804 172 Toner End Sensor: C

Toner End Sensor: C

5804 173 Toner End Sensor: Y

Toner End Sensor: Y

5804 174 TM Sensor: Front

ID Sensor: Front

5804 175 TM Sensor: Center

ID Sensor: Center

5804 176 TM Sensor: Rear

ID Sensor: Rear

5804 177 TM Sensor: M

ID Sensor: M

5804 178 TM Sensor: C

ID Sensor: C

5804 179 TM Sensor: Y

ID Sensor: Y

5804 181 PP:Charge AC:Y:HighSpeed

5804 182 PP:Charge AC:Y:MiddleSpeed

5804 183 PP:Charge AC:Y:LowSpeed

5804 186 PP:Development:K

5804 187 PP:Development:M

5804 188 PP:Development:C

5804 189 PP:Development:Y

407

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

408

5804 190 PP:Separation

5804 192 RFID ON/OFF: K

5804 193 RFID ON/OFF: Y

5804 194 RFID ON/OFF: C

5804 195 RFID ON/OFF: M

5804 196 RFID COM ON:K

5804 197 RFID COM ON: Y

5804 198 RFID COM ON: C

5804 199 RFID COM ON: M

5804 202 Scanner Lamp

5804 216 LD1: K

5804 217 LD2: K

5804 218 LD1: Ma

5804 219 LD2: Ma

5804 220 LD1: Cy

5804 221 LD2: Cy

5804 222 LD1: Ye

5804 223 LD2: Ye

5804 224 PP:ITB:K

PP: Image Transfer Roller: K

5804 225 PP:ITB:M

PP: Image Transfer Roller: M

5804 226 PP:ITB:C

PP: Image Transfer Roller: C

5804 227 PP:ITB:Y

PP: Image Transfer Roller: Y

5804 228 PP:PTR:+

PP: Paper Transfer Roller:+

5804 229 PP:PTR:-

PP: Paper Transfer Roller:-

5804 231

PP: ChargeDC: K

5804 232

PP: ChargeDC: M

Input and Output Check

5804 233

PP: ChargeDC: C

5804 234

PP: ChargeDC: Y

5804 237

PP:Charge AC:K:HighSpeed

5804 238

PP:Charge AC:K:MiddleSpeed

5804 239

HVPS: ChargeAC: K: LowSpeed

5804 244

PP:Charge AC:M:HighSpeed

5804 245

PP:Charge AC:M:MiddleSpeed

5804 246

HVPS: ChargeAC: M: LowSpeed

5804 251

PP:Charge AC:C:HighSpeed

5804 252

PP:Charge AC:C:MiddleSpeed

5804 253

HVPS: ChargeAC: C: LowSpeed

ARDF (D541)
6008

Display

Description

6008 3 Feed Motor Forward

Feed Motor-Forward rotation

6008 4 Feed Motor Reverse

Feed Motor-Reverse rotation

6008 5 Relay Motor Forward

Transport Motor- Forward rotation

6008 6 Relay Motor Reverse

Transport Motor- Forward rotation

6008 9 Feed Clutch

6008 10 Feed Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid

6008 11 Inverter Solenoid

6008 12 Stamp

Stamp Solenoid

1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher (B793)


6143

Display

Description

409

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

6143 1 Shift Motor

Shift Tray Motor

6143 2 Entrance Motor

6143 3 Staple Relay Motor

Stapler Unit Motor

6143 4 Knock Solenoid

6143 5 Junction Gate SOL 1

Proof Tray Gate Solenoid

6143 6 Junction Gate SOL 2

Staple Tray Gate Solenoid

6143 7 Folder Roller Rotation Motor

Fold Roller Motor

6143 8 Staple Motor

Staple Fold Motor

6143 10 Exit Guide Plate Motor

6143 11 Shift Relay Motor

Upper Transport Motor

6143 12 Tray Motor

Shift Tray Motor

6143 13 Stack Feed-out Motor

Positioning Roller Solenoid

6143 14 Stuck Relay1 Motor

Upper Clamp Roller Motor

6143 15 Stuck Relay1 Release Motor

Upper Retraction Motor

6143 16 Rear Edge Fence Drive Motor

Bottom Fence Lift Motor

6143 17 Folder Plate Motor

6143 18 Drive Roller Oscillating Motor

Lower Retraction Motor

6143 19 Staple Moving Motor

Staple Unit Driver Motor

6143 20 Jogger Motor

Jogger Motor

6143 21 Punch Registration Moving Motor

Paper Position Sensor Slide Motor

6143 22 Punch Motor

6143 23 Punch Moving Motor

Punch Movement Motor

1000-Sheet Finisher (B408)


6144

410

Display

Description

Input and Output Check

6144 1 Relay Up Motor

Upper Transport Motor

6144 2 Relay Down Motor

Lower Transport Motor

6144 3 Exit Motor

6144 4 Proof Junction Gate SOL

Tray Junction Gate Solenoid

6144 5 Tray Up Motor

Lower Tray Lift Motor

6144 6 Jogger Motor

Jogger Fence Motor

6144 7 Staple Moving Motor

Stapler Motor

6144 8 Staple Motor

Stapler Hammer

6144 9 Staple Junction Gate SOL

Stapler Junction Gate Solenoid

6144 10 Positioning Roller Solenoid

Positioning Roller Solenoid

6144 11 Stack Feed-out Motor

6144 12 Shift Motor

6144 13 Exit Guide Plate Motor

500-Sheet Finisher (D372)


6146

Display

Description

6146 1 Carry Motor

Transport Motor

6146 2 Hitroll Motor

Positioning Roller Arm Motor

6146 3 Front Jogger Motor

Front Fence Motor

6146 4 Rear Jogger Motor

Rear Fence Motor

6146 5 Staple Moving Motor

Stapler Movement Motor

6146 6 Stack Feed-out Motor

Feed-Out Belt Motor

6146 7 Tray Motor

Tray Lift Motor

6146 8 Staple Motor

Stapler Motor

6146 9 Stopper Solenoid

Stack Depressor Solenoid

411

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Bridge Unit (D386)/ Side Tray (D542)


6151
6151 1

Display
Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: Current
Selection

Description
Bridge: Feed Motor: Current switching signal

6151 2 Bridge/Left: Feed Motor:Reset

Bridge: Feed Motor:Reset

6151 3 Bridge/Left: Feed Motor:Enable

Bridge: Feed Motor:Enable

6151 6 Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: High Speed

Bridge: Feed Motor: High Speed

6151 7

Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: Middle


Speed

6151 8 Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: Low Speed


6151 11 Bridge/Left: Junction Solenoid

Bridge: Feed Motor: Middle Speed


Bridge: Feed Motor: Low Speed
Bridge: Junction Solenoid

Shift Tray (D388)


6153

Display

6153 1 Shift: Lift-up Motor

Description
-

1 Bin Tray (D414)


6155

Display

6155 1 1 bin: Junction Solenoid

Description
-

One or Two-Tray PFU (D387/D537)/ LCIT 2000 (D538)/ LCIT 1200 (D539)
6161

Display

6161 7 Bank1: Feed Motor:242mm/s

412

Description
Feed Motor:242mm/s
(D537/ D538)

6161 17 Bank2: Feed Motor:242mm/s

Feed Motor:242mm/s (D539)

6161 21 Bank2: Feed Motor:154mm/s

Feed Motor:154mm/s (D539)

Input and Output Check

6161 30 Bank:Tray3: PU Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid (D537/D538 or D387)

6161 31 Bank:Tray4: PU Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid (D537/D539)

6161 32 Bank:Tray5: PU Solenoid

Pick-up Solenoid (D539)

6161 35 Bank:Tray3: Feed Clutch

Pick-up Solenoid (D537/D538 or D387)

6161 36 Bank:Tray4: Feed Clutch

Pick-up Solenoid (D537/D539)

6161 37 Bank:Tray5: Feed Clutch

Pick-up Solenoid (D539)

413

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

Printer Service Mode


SP1-XXX (Service Mode)
1001

Bit Switch

001 Bit Switch 1

bit 0

DFU

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

DFU

bit 3

No I/O Timeout

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur.
bit 4

SD Card Save Mode

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot (* "Card Save
Function" in the System Maintenance Reference of the Field Service Manual).
bit 5

DFU

bit 6

DFU

bit 7

[RPCS,PCL]: Printable area frame border

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the
printable area.
1001

414

Bit Switch

Printer Service Mode

002 Bit Switch 2

bit 0

DFU

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

Applying a collation Type

Shift Collate

Normal Collate

A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a
Collate Type configured.

If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect.


bit 3

[PCL5e/c,PS]: PDL Auto Switching

0: Enable

1: Disable

Disable: The MFPs ability to change the PDL processor mid-job.


Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto PDL switching
is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly.

1001

bit 4

DFU

bit 5

DFU

bit 6

DFU

bit 7

DFU

Bit Switch

415

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

003 Bit Switch 3

bit 0

DFU

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

[PCL5e/c]: Legacy HP compatibility

0: Disable

1: Enable

Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000.
In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "<ESC>*r0A") will be changed
to "<ESC>*r1A"

1001

bit 3

DFU

bit 4

DFU

bit 5

DFU

bit 6

DFU

bit 7

DFU

Bit Switch

004 Bit Switch 4 DFU


1001

416

Bit Switch

Printer Service Mode

005 Bit Switch 5


Show "Collate Type", "Staple Type" and "Punch
Type" buttons on the operation panel.
bit 0

Disable

Enable

If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type
from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured
options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:

"User Tools > Printer Features > System"


bit 1

DFU

bit 2

DFU

bit 3

[PS] PS Criteria

Pattern3

Pattern1

Change the number of PS criterion used by the PS interpreter to determine whether a


job is PS data or not.
Pattern3: includes most PS commands.
Pattern1: A small number of PS tags and headers
bit 4

Increase max number of the stored jobs to 1000


jobs.

Disable
(100)

Enable (1000)

Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job
Type settings to 1000. The default is 100.
bit 5

Face-up output

Disable

Enable

Enable: All print jobs will be output face-up in the destination tray.

1001

bit 6

DFU

bit 7

DFU

Bit Switch

006 Bit Switch 6 DFU


1001

Bit Switch

007 Bit Switch 7 DFU

417

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

1001

Bit Switch

008 Bit Switch 8

bit 0

DFU

bit 1

DFU

bit 2

DFU

bit 3

[PCL,PS]: Allow BW jobs to print without requiring


User Code

Disable

Enable

Enable: BW jobs submitted without a user code will be printed even if usercode
authentication is enabled.
Color jobs will not be printed without a valid user code.
bit 4

DFU

bit 5

DFU

bit 6

[PS]: Orientation Auto Detect Function

Enable

Disable

Disable: Automatically chooses page orientations of PostScript jobs (Landscape or


Portrait) based on the content printed on the page.
bit 7

[PDF]: Orientation Auto Detect Function

Enable

Disable

Automatically chooses page orientations of PDF jobs (Landscape or Portrait) based on


the content printed on the page.
1003
1003 1

[Clear Setting]
Initialize Printer System
Initializes settings in the "System" menu of the user mode.

1003 3 Delete Program


1004
1004 1

418

[Print Summary]
Print Summary
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).

Printer Service Mode

1005
1005 1

1006

[Display Version]
Disp. Version
Displays the version of the controller firmware.
[Sample/Locked Print]

*CTL

0: Linked, 1: On

Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the document server is
1006 1 enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select
"1," the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.

[Data Recall]
1101

Recalls a set of gamma settings. This can be either a) the factory setting, b) the previous
setting, or c) the current setting.

1101 1 Factory
1101 2 Previous
1101 3 Current

*CTL

1101 4 ACC

1102

1102 1

1103

[Resolution Setting]
Selects the printing mode (resolution) for the printer gamma adjustment.
2400x600 Photo, 1800x600 Photo, 600 x 600 Photo, 2400x600 Text, 1800x600, Text,
600x600 Text
[Test Page]
Prints the test page to check the color balance before and after the gamma adjustment.

1103 1 Color Gray Scale


1103 2 Color Pattern

1104

[Gamma Adjustment]
Adjusts the printer gamma for the mode selected in the "Mode Selection" menu.

419

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

1104 1 Black: Highlight


1104 2 Black: Shadow
1104 3 Black: Middle
1104 4 Black: IDmax
1104 21 Cyan: Highlight

1104 22 Cyan: Shadow


1104 23 Cyan: Middle
1104 24 Cyan: IDmax
1104 41 Magenta: Highlight

*CTL

[0 to 30 / 15 / 1/step ]

1104 42 Magenta: Shadow


1104 43 Magenta: Middle
1104 44 Magenta: IDmax
1104 61 Yellow: Highlight
1104 62 Yellow: Shadow
1104 63 Yellow: Middle
1104 64 Yellow: IDmax
[Save Tone Control Value]
1105

Stores the print gamma adjusted with the "Gamma Adj." menu item as the current setting.
Before the machine stores the new "current setting", it moves the data currently stored as the
"current setting" to the "previous setting" memory storage location.

1105 1 Save Tone Control Value

1106

[Toner Limit]
Adjusts the maximum toner amount for image development.

1106 1 Toner Limit Value

420

*CTL

[100 to 400 / 260 / 1 %/step ]

Scanner SP Mode

Scanner SP Mode
SP1-xxx (System and Others)

1004

[Compression Type]
Selects the compression type for binary picture processing.

1004 1 Compression Type

*CTL

[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step ]
1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR

[Erase margin]
1005

Creates an erase margin for all edges of the scanned image.


If the machine has scanned the edge of the original, create a margin. This SP is activated
only when the machine uses TWAIN scanning.

1005 1 Range from 0 to 5 mm

1009

[Remote scan disable]

*CTL

*CTL

[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: enable, 1: disable

1009 1 Enable or disable remote scan.

1010

[Non Display Clear Light PDF] *CTL

[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Display, 1: No display

1010 1 Enable or disable remote scan.

SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality)


[Compression Level (Gray-scale)]
2021

Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the three settings that
can be selected at the operation panel.

421

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

2021 1 Level 3 (Middle Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ]

2021 2 Level 2 (High Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step ]

2021 3 Level 4 (Low Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 30 / 1 /step ]

2021 4 Level 1 (Highest Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 60 / 1 /step ]

2021 5 Level 5 (Lowest Image Quality)

[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

[Compression ratio of ClearLight PDF]


2024

Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at
the operation panel.

2024 1 Compression Ratio (Normal image)


2024 2 Compression Ratio (High comp image)

422

*CTL

*CTL

[5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]

Test Pattern Printing

Test Pattern Printing


Printing Test pattern: SP2-109
Some of these test patterns are used for copy image adjustments but most are used primarily for design
testing.
Do not operate the machine until the test pattern is printed out completely. Otherwise, an SC occurs.

1. Enter the SP mode and select SP2-109-003.


2. Enter the number for the test pattern that you want to print and press [#].
3. When you want to select the single color of Magenta, Yellow or Cyan for printing a test pattern, select
the color with SP2-109-005 (2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan).
4. When you want to change the density of printing a test pattern, select the density with SP2-109-006
to -009 for each color.
If you select "0" with SP2-109-006 to -009, the color to be adjusted to "0" does not come up
on a test pattern.
5. When you are prompted to confirm your selection, touch "Yes" to select the test pattern for printing.
6. Touch "Copy Window" to open the copy window, then select the settings for the test print (paper size
etc.).
If you want to use black and white printing, touch "Black & White" on the LCD. If you want to
use color printing, touch "Full Colour" on the LCD.
7. Press the "Start" key to start the test print.
8. After checking the test pattern, touch "SP Mode" on the LCD to return to the SP mode display.
9. Reset all settings to the default values.
10. Touch "Exit" twice to exit SP mode.
No.

Pattern

No.

Pattern

None

11

Independent Pattern (1-dot)

Vertial Line (1dot)

12

Independent Pattern (2-dot)

Vertial Line (2dot)

13

Independent Pattern (4-dot)

Horizontal Line (1dot)

14

Triming Area

Horizontal Line (2dot)

16

Tooth Check (Horizontal)

423

3. Appendix: SP Mode Tables

424

Grid Vertical Line

17

Band (Horizontal)

Grid Horizontal Line

18

Band (Vertical)

Grid Pattern Small

19

Checker Flag Pattern

Grid Pattern Large

20

Grayscale (Vertical Margin)

Argyle Pattern Small

21

Grayscale (Horizontal Margin)

10

Argyle Pattern Large

23

Full Dot Pattern

You might also like